Es451c sh-v15
-
Upload
jonadhiguera -
Category
Technology
-
view
221 -
download
14
description
Transcript of Es451c sh-v15
SERVICE HANDBOOKMULTIFUNCTIONAL DIGITAL COLOR SYSTEMS
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c
Model: FC-281C/351C/451CPublish Date: June 2005File No. SHE050003O0R05032182702-TTECVer15_2010-06
Trademarks
• The official name of Windows 95 is Microsoft Windows 95 Operating System.• The official name of Windows 98 is Microsoft Windows 98 Operating System.• The official name of Windows Me is Microsoft Windows Millennium Edition Operating System.• The official name of Windows 2000 is Microsoft Windows 2000 Operating System.• The official name of Windows XP is Microsoft Windows XP Operating System.• Microsoft, Windows, Windows NT and the brand names and product names of other Microsoft prod-
ucts are trademarks or registered trademarks of Microsoft Corporation in the U.S. and/or other coun-tries.
• Apple, AppleTalk, Macintosh, and Mac are trademarks of Apple Computer, Inc. in the U.S. and other countries.
• PostScript is a trademark of Adobe Systems Incorporated.• NOVELL, NetWare, and NDS are trademarks or registered trademarks of Novell, Inc.• Molykote is a registered trademark of Dow Corning Corporation.• iCLASS is a trademark of HID Corporation.• MIFARE is a trademark of Royal Philips Electronics.• Other company names and product names in this manual are the trademarks of their respective
companies.
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved
Under the copyright laws, this manual cannot be reproduced in any form without prior written permission of TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION. No patent liability is assumed, however, with respect to the use of the information contained herein.
08/04
GENERAL PRECAUTIONS REGARDING THE SERVICE FOR e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c
The installation and service should be done by a qualified service technician.
1) Transportation/Installation- When transporting/installing the equipment, employ four persons and be sure to hold the posi-
tions as shown in the figure. The equipment is quite heavy and weighs approximately 113 kg (249 lb), therefore pay full atten-tion when handling it.
- Be sure not to hold the movable parts or units (e.g. the control panel, ADU or RADF) when trans-porting the equipment.
- Be sure to use a dedicated outlet with AC 110 V / 13.2 A, 115 V or 127 V / 12 A, 220-240 V or 240 V / 8 A for its power source.
- The equipment must be grounded for safety.- Select a suitable place for installation. Avoid excessive heat, high humidity, dust, vibration and
direct sunlight.- Provide proper ventilation since the equipment emits a slight amount of ozone.- To insure adequate working space for the copying operation, keep a minimum clearance of 80
cm (32”) on the left, 80 cm (32”) on the right and 10 cm (4”) on the rear.- The equipment shall be installed near the socket outlet and shall be accessible.- Be sure to fix and plug in the power cable securely after the installation so that no one trips over
it.
2) General Precautions at Service- Be sure to turn the power OFF and unplug the power cable during service (except for the service
should be done with the power turned ON).- Unplug the power cable and clean the area around the prongs of the plug and socket outlet once
a year or more. A fire may occur when dust lies on this area.- When the parts are disassembled, reassembly is the reverse of disassembly unless otherwise
noted in this manual or other related documents. Be careful not to install small parts such as screws, washers, pins, E-rings, star washers in the wrong places.
- Basically, the equipment should not be operated with any parts removed or disassembled.- The PC board must be stored in an anti-electrostatic bag and handled carefully using a wristband
since the ICs on it may be damaged due to static electricity.
- Avoid expose to laser beam during service. This equipment uses a laser diode. Be sure not to expose your eyes to the laser beam. Do not insert reflecting parts or tools such as a screwdriver on the laser beam path. Remove all reflecting metals such as watches, rings, etc. before starting service.
- Be sure not to touch high-temperature sections such as the exposure lamp, fuser unit, damp heater and areas around them.
- Be sure not to touch high-voltage sections such as the chargers, transfer belt, 2nd transfer roller, developer, IH control circuit, high-voltage transformer, exposure lamp control inverter, inverter for the LCD backlight and power supply unit. Especially, the board of these components should not be touched since the electric charge may remain in the capacitors, etc. on them even after the power is turned OFF.
- Make sure that the equipment will not operate before touching potentially dangerous places (e.g. rotating/operating sections such as gears, belts pulleys, fans and laser beam exit of the laser optical unit).
- Be careful when removing the covers since there might be the parts with very sharp edges underneath.
- When servicing the equipment with the power turned ON, be sure not to touch live sections and rotating/operating sections. Avoid exposing your eyes to laser beam.
- Use designated jigs and tools.- Use recommended measuring instruments or equivalents.- Return the equipment to the original state and check the operation when the service is finished.- Be very careful to treat the touch panel gently and never hit it. Breaking the surface could cause
malfunctions.
3) Important Service Parts for Safety- The breaker, door switch, fuse, thermostat, thermofuse, thermistor, batteries, IC-RAMs including
lithium batteries, etc. are particularly important for safety. Be sure to handle/install them properly. If these parts are short-circuited and their functions become ineffective, they may result in fatal accidents such as burnout. Do not allow a short-circuit or do not use the parts not recommended by Toshiba TEC Corporation.
4) Cautionary Labels- During servicing, be sure to check the rating plate and cautionary labels such as “Unplug the
power cable during service”, “CAUTION. HOT”, “CAUTION. HIGH VOLTAGE”, “CAUTION. LASER BEAM”, etc. to see if there is any dirt on their surface and if they are properly stuck to the equipment.
Caution: Before using the wristband, unplug the power cable of the equipment and make sure that there are no charged objects which are not insulated in the vicinity.
06/08
5) Disposal of the Equipment, Supplies, Packing Materials, Used Batteries and IC-RAMs- Regarding the recovery and disposal of the equipment, supplies, packing materials, used batter-
ies and IC-RAMs including lithium batteries, follow the relevant local regulations or rules.
Caution:Dispose of used batteries and IC-RAMs including lithium batteries according to this manual.
Attention:Se débarrasser de batteries et IC-RAMs usés y compris les batteries en lithium selon ce manuel.
Vorsicht:Entsorgung der gebrauchten Batterien und IC-RAMs (inclusive der Lithium-Batterie) nach diesem Handbuch.
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cCONTENTS
1
CONTENTS
1. SPECIFICATIONS/ACCESSORIES/OPTIONS/SUPPLIES ......................................... 1-11.1 Specifications....................................................................................................................... 1-11.2 Accessories ......................................................................................................................... 1-71.3 Options ................................................................................................................................ 1-81.4 Supplies ............................................................................................................................. 1-101.5 System List ........................................................................................................................ 1-11
2. ERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE........................................................ 2-12.1 Error Code List..................................................................................................................... 2-1
2.1.1 Jam........................................................................................................................... 2-12.1.2 Service call ............................................................................................................... 2-82.1.3 Error in Internet FAX / Scanning Function.............................................................. 2-152.1.4 Printer function error............................................................................................... 2-23
2.2 Self-diagnosis Modes ....................................................................................................... 2-252.2.1 Input check (Test mode 03).................................................................................... 2-272.2.2 Output check (test mode 03) .................................................................................. 2-362.2.3 Test print mode (test mode 04) .............................................................................. 2-392.2.4 Adjustment mode (05) ............................................................................................ 2-402.2.5 Setting mode (08)................................................................................................... 2-872.2.6 Pixel counter......................................................................................................... 2-2282.2.7 Classification List of Adjustment Mode (05) / Setting Mode (08).......................... 2-238
3. ADJUSTMENT .............................................................................................................. 3-13.1 Adjustment Order (Image Related Adjustment)................................................................... 3-13.2 Adjustment of the Auto-Toner Sensor ................................................................................. 3-23.3 Performing Image Quality Control ....................................................................................... 3-53.4 Image Dimensional Adjustment ........................................................................................... 3-6
3.4.1 General description .................................................................................................. 3-63.4.2 Paper alignment at the registration roller ................................................................. 3-83.4.3 Printer related adjustment ........................................................................................ 3-93.4.4 Scanner related adjustment ................................................................................... 3-14
3.5 Image Quality Adjustment (Copying Function) .................................................................. 3-213.5.1 Automatic gamma adjustment ................................................................................ 3-213.5.2 Color Deviation Adjustment .................................................................................... 3-223.5.3 Density adjustment ................................................................................................. 3-283.5.4 Color balance adjustment....................................................................................... 3-293.5.5 Gamma balance adjustment .................................................................................. 3-303.5.6 Offsetting adjustment for background processing .................................................. 3-303.5.7 Judgment threshold for ACS .................................................................................. 3-313.5.8 Sharpness adjustment............................................................................................ 3-313.5.9 Setting range correction ......................................................................................... 3-323.5.10 Setting range correction (Adjustment of background peak) ................................... 3-323.5.11 Adjustment of smudged/faint text ........................................................................... 3-333.5.12 Adaptation to highlighter......................................................................................... 3-333.5.13 Beam level conversion setting................................................................................ 3-343.5.14 Maximum toner density adjustment to paper type.................................................. 3-343.5.15 Maximum text density adjustment .......................................................................... 3-353.5.16 Text/Photo reproduction level adjustment .............................................................. 3-353.5.17 Black reproduction switching at the Twin color copy mode.................................... 3-363.5.18 Background adjustment(Black Mode) .................................................................... 3-36
3.6 Image Quality Adjustment (Printing Function) ................................................................... 3-373.6.1 Automatic gamma adjustment ................................................................................ 3-373.6.2 Color deviation adjustment ..................................................................................... 3-38
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedCONTENTS
2
3.6.3 Gamma balance adjustment (Black Mode) ............................................................ 3-383.6.4 Color balance adjustment (Color Mode)................................................................. 3-393.6.5 Adjustment of smudged/faint text ........................................................................... 3-393.6.6 Upper limit value at Toner Saving Mode ................................................................ 3-403.6.7 Dot size adjustment in black printing...................................................................... 3-403.6.8 Maximum toner density adjustment to paper type.................................................. 3-403.6.9 Image processing: Gamma correction table all clearing......................................... 3-40
3.7 Image Quality Adjustment (Scanning Function) ................................................................ 3-413.7.1 Gamma balance adjustment .................................................................................. 3-413.7.2 Density adjustment (Black Mode)........................................................................... 3-423.7.3 Background adjustment (Gray Scale Mode) .......................................................... 3-433.7.4 Background adjustment (Color Mode).................................................................... 3-433.7.5 Judgment threshold for ACS .................................................................................. 3-443.7.6 Sharpness adjustment............................................................................................ 3-443.7.7 Setting range correction ......................................................................................... 3-453.7.8 Setting range correction (Adjustment of background peak) ................................... 3-453.7.9 Fine adjustment of black density ............................................................................ 3-463.7.10 RGB conversion method selection ......................................................................... 3-463.7.11 Reproduction ratio of primary scanning direction (black) ....................................... 3-473.7.12 Reproduction ratio of primary scanning direction (color) ........................................ 3-47
3.8 High-Voltage Transformer Setting ..................................................................................... 3-483.8.1 General description ................................................................................................ 3-48
3.9 Adjustment of the Scanner Section ................................................................................... 3-493.9.1 Carriages................................................................................................................ 3-493.9.2 Lens unit ................................................................................................................. 3-53
3.10 Adjustment of the Paper Feeding System ......................................................................... 3-553.10.1 Sheet sideways deviation caused by paper feeding .............................................. 3-55
3.11 Adjustment of the Developer Unit ...................................................................................... 3-573.11.1 Doctor-to-sleeve gap (black developer unit)........................................................... 3-573.11.2 Doctor-to-sleeve gap (color developer unit) ........................................................... 3-593.11.3 Black developer unit lift up/down timing adjustment............................................... 3-613.11.4 Adjustment of the drum-sleeve gap........................................................................ 3-63
3.12 Adjustment of the RADF (MR-3018).................................................................................. 3-703.12.1 Adjustment of RADF Position................................................................................. 3-703.12.2 Adjustment of RADF Height ................................................................................... 3-753.12.3 Adjustment of Skew................................................................................................ 3-773.12.4 Adjustment of the Leading Edge Position .............................................................. 3-803.12.5 Adjustment of Horizontal Position .......................................................................... 3-813.12.6 Adjustment of Copy Ratio....................................................................................... 3-833.12.7 Adjustment of RADF Opening/Closing Sensor....................................................... 3-84
3.13 Adjustment of the Finisher (MJ-1022)................................................................................ 3-853.13.1 Adjusting the jogging plate width............................................................................ 3-853.13.2 Adjusting the angle of the jogging plate ................................................................. 3-873.13.3 Adjusting the overlap of the sensor flag ................................................................. 3-883.13.4 Adjusting the tension of the stack processing motor belt ....................................... 3-893.13.5 Releasing the stack tray guide lever fixing plate .................................................... 3-913.13.6 Adjustment of the upper tray angle ........................................................................ 3-923.13.7 DIP switch functions ............................................................................................... 3-94
3.14 Adjustment of the Finisher (MJ-1023/1024)....................................................................... 3-963.14.1 Adjusting the alignment position (Finisher unit)...................................................... 3-963.14.2 Adjusting the staple position (Finisher unit)............................................................ 3-973.14.3 Adjusting the folding position (Saddle stitcher unit)................................................ 3-983.14.4 Fine adjustment of binding/folding position (Saddle stitcher unit) ........................ 3-1013.14.5 Sensor output adjustment (Puncher unit) ............................................................. 3-1013.14.6 Registering the number of punch holes (Puncher unit) ........................................ 3-102
10/02
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cCONTENTS
3
3.15 Adjustment of the Finisher (MJ-1101).............................................................................. 3-1033.15.1 Adjusting the Alignment Position.......................................................................... 3-1033.15.2 Adjusting the Stapling Position............................................................................. 3-1053.15.3 B4-size recycled paper mode settings ................................................................. 3-107
4. PREVENTIVE MAINTENANCE (PM)............................................................................ 4-14.1 PM Support Mode................................................................................................................ 4-1
4.1.1 General description .................................................................................................. 4-14.1.2 Operational flow and operational screen.................................................................. 4-14.1.3 Work flow of parts replacement ................................................................................ 4-8
4.2 General Descriptions for PM Procedure .............................................................................. 4-94.3 Operational Items in Overhauling ...................................................................................... 4-104.4 Preventive Maintenance Checklist..................................................................................... 4-114.5 PM KIT............................................................................................................................... 4-314.6 Jig List ............................................................................................................................... 4-324.7 Grease List ........................................................................................................................ 4-334.8 Precautions for Storing and Handling Supplies ................................................................. 4-34
4.8.1 Precautions for storing TOSHIBA supplies ............................................................ 4-344.8.2 Checking and cleaning of photoconductive drum................................................... 4-344.8.3 Checking and cleaning of drum cleaning blade and transfer belt cleaning blade... 4-354.8.4 Handling of drum cleaner brush ............................................................................. 4-354.8.5 Handling of transfer belt ......................................................................................... 4-354.8.6 Checking and cleaning of fuser belt and pressure roller ........................................ 4-364.8.7 Checking and replacing the oil roller and cleaning roller ........................................ 4-364.8.8 Checking and cleaning of discharge brush ............................................................ 4-37
5. TROUBLESHOOTING .................................................................................................. 5-15.1 Diagnosis and Prescription for Each Error Code................................................................. 5-1
5.1.1 Paper transport jam (paper exit section) .................................................................. 5-15.1.2 Paper misfeeding ..................................................................................................... 5-35.1.3 Paper transport jam................................................................................................ 5-105.1.4 Other paper jam ..................................................................................................... 5-185.1.5 Cover open jam ...................................................................................................... 5-205.1.6 RADF jam............................................................................................................... 5-245.1.7 Finisher jam............................................................................................................ 5-295.1.8 Drive system related service call ............................................................................ 5-525.1.9 Paper feeding system related service call .............................................................. 5-535.1.10 Scanning system related service call ..................................................................... 5-595.1.11 Fuser unit related service call................................................................................. 5-605.1.12 Communication related service call........................................................................ 5-635.1.13 RADF related service call ....................................................................................... 5-645.1.14 Circuit related service call ...................................................................................... 5-645.1.15 Laser optical unit related service call ..................................................................... 5-675.1.16 Finisher related service call .................................................................................... 5-685.1.17 Image control related service call ........................................................................... 5-875.1.18 Copy process related service call........................................................................... 5-915.1.19 Toner density control related service call ............................................................... 5-955.1.20 Other service call.................................................................................................... 5-995.1.21 Error in Internet FAX / Scanning Function............................................................ 5-100
5.2 Troubleshooting for the Image......................................................................................... 5-1145.3 Replacement of PC Boards and HDD ............................................................................. 5-147
5.3.1 Replacing HDD..................................................................................................... 5-1475.3.2 Replacing SYS board ........................................................................................... 5-1505.3.3 Replacing SLG board ........................................................................................... 5-1515.3.4 Replacing or clearing NVRAM.............................................................................. 5-1515.3.5 Cautions when Data overwrite kit (GP-1060) is installed .................................... 5-153
06/08
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedCONTENTS
4
5.3.6 HDD information display....................................................................................... 5-1545.4 Other errors ..................................................................................................................... 5-156
6. FIRMWARE UPDATING ............................................................................................... 6-16.1 Firmware Updating with Download Jig ................................................................................ 6-2
6.1.1 PWA-DWNLD-350-JIG2 (48 MB) ............................................................................. 6-46.1.2 Writing the data to the download jig (PWA-DWNLD-350-JIG) ............................... 6-186.1.3 K-PWA-DLM-320.................................................................................................... 6-20
6.2 Firmware Updating with USB Storage Device ................................................................... 6-376.2.1 Appendix ................................................................................................................ 6-59
7. POWER SUPPLY UNIT ................................................................................................ 7-17.1 Output Channel ................................................................................................................... 7-17.2 Fuse..................................................................................................................................... 7-37.3 Configuration of Power Supply Unit..................................................................................... 7-4
8. REMOTE SERVICE....................................................................................................... 8-18.1 Auto Supply Order ............................................................................................................... 8-1
8.1.1 Outline ...................................................................................................................... 8-18.1.2 Setting Item .............................................................................................................. 8-28.1.3 Setting procedure ..................................................................................................... 8-48.1.4 Order Sheet Format ............................................................................................... 8-11
8.2 Service Notification............................................................................................................ 8-138.2.1 Outline .................................................................................................................... 8-138.2.2 Setting .................................................................................................................... 8-138.2.3 Items to be notified ................................................................................................. 8-19
9. DATA CLONING with USB STORAGE DEVICE ......................................................... 9-1
10. WIRE HARNESS CONNECTION DIAGRAMS ........................................................... 10-110.1 AC Wire Harness ............................................................................................................... 10-110.2 DC Wire Harness....................................................................................................... Appendix10.3 Electric Parts Layout.................................................................................................. Appendix
05/11
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
1. SPECIFICATIONS/ACCESSORIES/OPTIONS/SUPPLIES
2. ERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
3. ADJUSTMENT
4. PREVENTIVE MAINTENANCE (PM)
5. TROUBLESHOOTING
6. FIRMWARE UPDATING
7. POWER SUPPLY UNIT
8. REMOTE SERVICE
9. DATA CLONING with USB STORAGE DEVICE
10. WIRE HARNESS CONNECTION DIAGRAMS
05/11
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cSPECIFICATIONS/ACCESSORIES/OPTIONS/SUPPLIES
1 - 1
1
1. SPECIFICATIONS/ACCESSORIES/OPTIONS/SUPPLIES
1.1 SpecificationsCopy process .......................... Indirect electrophotographic process (dry)Type......................................... Desktop type (Console type: when optional Paper Feed Pedestal
(PFP) or optional Large Capacity Feeder (LCF) is installed.)Original table ........................... Fixed type (the left rear corner used as guide to place originals)Accepted originals ................... Original type: Sheets, books and 3-dimensional objects
Note that when the optional Reversing Automatic Document Feeder is used, carbon, bounded or stapled originals cannot be accepted, and
paper type of the original should be 35-157g/m2 (9.3 lb. Bond -58 lb.
Cover) for single-sided copy and 50-157 g/m2 (13.3 lb. Bond -58 lb. Cover) for double-sided copy.Maximum size: A3/LD
• Copy speed (Copies/min.)
e-STUDIO281c
e-STUDIO351c
e-STUDIO451c
* "-" means "Not acceptable".* When originals are manually placed for single-sided, continuous copying.* Plain paper is selected for the paper type.* When the Reversing Automatic Document Feeder is used, copying in the speed of 28, 35 and 45
sheets per minute are only possible under the following conditions:
Paper supplyPaper size
DrawerBypass feed
PFPLCF
(A4/LT only)Size specifiedSize not specified
A4, LT 28 (11) 28 (11) 16 (5) 28 (11) 28 (11)
B5, A5-R, ST-R -
A4-R, B5-R, LT-R 21 (5) 21 (5) 16 (5) 21 (5) -
B4, LG 18 (5) 18 (5) 16 (5) 18 (5) -
A3, LD 16 (5) 16 (5) 16 (5) 16 (5) -
Paper supplyPaper size
DrawerBypass feed
PFPLCF
(A4/LT only)Size specifiedSize not specified
A4, LT 35 (11) 35 (11) 21 (5) 35 (11) 35 (11)
B5, A5-R, ST-R -
A4-R, B5-R, LT-R 28 (5) 28 (5) 21 (5) 28 (5) -
B4, LG 24 (5) 24 (5) 21 (5) 24 (5) -
A3, LD 21 (5) 21 (5) 21 (5) 21 (5) -
Paper supplyPaper size
DrawerBypass feed
PFPLCF
(A4/LT only)Size specifiedSize not specified
A4, LT 45 (11) 45 (11) 22 (5) 45 (11) 45 (11)
B5, A5-R, ST-R -
A4-R, B5-R, LT-R 32 (5) 32 (5) 22 (5) 32 (5) -
B4, LG 26 (5) 26 (5) 22 (5) 26 (5) -
A3, LD 22 (5) 22 (5) 22 (5) 22 (5) -
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedSPECIFICATIONS/ACCESSORIES/OPTIONS/SUPPLIES
1 - 2
• Original: A4 or LT (single-sided)• Mode: APS and Automatic density not selected, Plain paper mode• Number of copies:
Black mode: 28 sheets or more (e-STUDIO281c), 35 sheets or more (e-STUDIO351c), 45 sheets or more (e-STUDIO451c)Color mode: 11 sheets or more
• Reproduction ratio: 100%* The values in ( ) can be realized in the color mode.
Thick paper / OHPe-STUDIO281c
Thick1 (81 g/m2 to 105 g/m2, 21 lb. Bond to 28 lb. Bond)
Thick2 (106 g/m2 to 163 g/m2, 29 lb. Bond to 90 lb. Index)
Thick3 (164 g/m2 to 209 g/m2, 91 lb. Index to 110 lb. Index)
OHP
Paper supplyPaper size
DrawerBypass feed
PFPLCF
(A4/LT only)Size specifiedSize not specified
A4, LT 28 (11) 28 (11) 16 (5) 28 (11) 28 (11)
B5, A5-R, ST-R -
A4-R, B5-R, LT-R 20 (5) 20 (5) 16 (5) 20 (5) -
B4, LG 18 (5) 18 (5) 16 (5) 18 (5) -
A3, LD 16 (5) 16 (5) 16 (5) 16 (5) -
Paper supplyPaper size
DrawerBypass feed
PFPLCF
(A4/LT only)Size specifiedSize not specified
A4, LT, B5, A5-R, ST-R - 20 (6) 10 (2) - -
A4-R, B5-R, LT-R - 14 (3) 10 (2) - -
B4, LG - 11 (3) 10 (2) - -
A3, LD - 10 (2) 10 (2) - -
Paper supplyPaper size
DrawerBypass feed
PFPLCF
(A4/LT only)Size specifiedSize not specified
A4, LT, B5, A5-R, ST-R - 20 (2) 10 (2) - -
A4-R, B5-R, LT-R - 14 (2) 10 (2) - -
B4, LG - 11 (2) 10 (2) - -
A3, LD - 10 (2) 10 (2) - -
Paper supplyPaper size
DrawerBypass feed
PFPLCF
(A4/LT only)Size specifiedSize not specified
A4, LT - 10 (3) - - -
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cSPECIFICATIONS/ACCESSORIES/OPTIONS/SUPPLIES
1 - 3
1
e-STUDIO351c
Thick1 (81 g/m2 to 105 g/m2, 21 lb. Bond to 28 lb. Bond)
Thick2 (106 g/m2 to 163 g/m2, 29 lb. Bond to 90 lb. Index)
Thick3 (164 g/m2 to 209 g/m2, 91 lb. Index to 110 lb. Index)
OHP
Paper supplyPaper size
DrawerBypass feed
PFPLCF
(A4/LT only)Size specifiedSize not specified
A4, LT 30 (11) 30 (11) 16 (5) 30 (11) 30 (11)
B5, A5-R, ST-R -
A4-R, B5-R, LT-R 23 (5) 23 (5) 16 (5) 23 (5) -
B4, LG 19 (5) 19 (5) 16 (5) 19 (5) -
A3, LD 16 (5) 16 (5) 16 (5) 16 (5) -
Paper supplyPaper size
DrawerBypass feed
PFPLCF
(A4/LT only)Size specifiedSize not specified
A4, LT, B5, A5-R, ST-R - 20 (6) 10 (2) - -
A4-R, B5-R, LT-R - 14 (3) 10 (2) - -
B4, LG - 11 (3) 10 (2) - -
A3, LD - 10 (2) 10 (2) - -
Paper supplyPaper size
DrawerBypass feed
PFPLCF
(A4/LT only)Size specifiedSize not specified
A4, LT, B5, A5-R, ST-R - 20 (2) 10 (2) - -
A4-R, B5-R, LT-R - 14 (2) 10 (2) - -
B4, LG - 11 (2) 10 (2) - -
A3, LD - 10 (2) 10 (2) - -
Paper supplyPaper size
DrawerBypass feed
PFPLCF
(A4/LT only)Size specifiedSize not specified
A4, LT - 10 (3) - - -
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedSPECIFICATIONS/ACCESSORIES/OPTIONS/SUPPLIES
1 - 4
e-STUDIO451c
Thick1 (81 g/m2 to 105 g/m2, 21 lb. Bond to 28 lb. Bond)
Thick2 (106 g/m2 to 163 g/m2, 29 lb. Bond to 90 lb. Index)
Thick3 (164 g/m2 to 209 g/m2, 91 lb. Index to 110 lb. Index)
OHP
* "-" means "Not acceptable".* When originals are manually placed for single side, continuous copying.* The bypass copying speed is measured with the paper size specified.* The values in ( ) can be realized in the color mode.
Paper supplyPaper size
DrawerBypass feed
PFPLCF
(A4/LT only)Size specifiedSize not specified
A4, LT 30 (11) 30 (11) 16 (5) 30 (11) 30 (11)
B5, A5-R, ST-R -
A4-R, B5-R, LT-R 23 (5) 23 (5) 16 (5) 23 (5) -
B4, LG 19 (5) 19 (5) 16 (5) 19 (5) -
A3, LD 16 (5) 16 (5) 16 (5) 16 (5) -
Paper supplyPaper size
DrawerBypass feed
PFPLCF
(A4/LT only)Size specifiedSize not specified
A4, LT, B5, A5-R, ST-R - 20 (6) 10 (2) - -
A4-R, B5-R, LT-R - 14 (3) 10 (2) - -
B4, LG - 11 (3) 10 (2) - -
A3, LD - 10 (2) 10 (2) - -
Paper supplyPaper size
DrawerBypass feed
PFPLCF
(A4/LT only)Size specifiedSize not specified
A4, LT, B5, A5-R, ST-R - 20 (2) 10 (2) - -
A4-R, B5-R, LT-R - 14 (2) 10 (2) - -
B4, LG - 11 (2) 10 (2) - -
A3, LD - 10 (2) 10 (2) - -
Paper supplyPaper size
DrawerBypass feed
PFPLCF
(A4/LT only)Size specifiedSize not specified
A4, LT - 10 (3) - - -
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cSPECIFICATIONS/ACCESSORIES/OPTIONS/SUPPLIES
1 - 5
1
* System copy speed
* Shows the period of time from when the [START] button is pressed until the message "Ready" is dis-played. (10 sheets of A4/LT size original are set on the RADF and one of the copy modes above is selected.)
* Setting: when in the Text/Photo mode with Automatic density and APS/AMS set to OFF, or when in the sort mode with paper fed from the upper drawer.
* The Saddle Stitch Finisher and hole punch unit not installed.* The values in ( ) are the speeds of when in the color mode.
• Copy paper
First copy time......................... Approx. 6.8 sec. or less (black), approx. 16.2 sec. or less (color)(A4/LT, upper drawer, 100%, original placed manually)
Warming-up time ..................... Approx. 40 sec. (Stand-alone, temperature: 20°C)Multiple copying....................... Up to 999 copies; Key in set numbersReproduction ratio ................... Actual ratio: 100±0.5%
Zooming: 25 to 400% in increments of 1%(25 to 200% when using RADF)
Resolution/Gradation............... Scanning: 600 dpi x 600 dpiPrinting: Equivalent to 2400 dpi x 600 dpi (black)Equivalent to 600 dpi x 600 dpi (color)
Copy modeSec.
e-STUDIO281c e-STUDIO351c e-STUDIO451c
Single-sided originals↓
Single-sided copies
1 set 31.26 (71.97) 28.15 (71.97) 24.99 (71.97)
3 sets 74.07 (182.19) 61.02 (182.19) 50.03 (182.19)
5 sets 116.64 (289.94) 95.19 (289.94) 76.63 (289.94)
Single-sided originals↓
Double-sided copies
1 set 32.61 (81.63) 29.65 (81.63) 28.49 (81.63)
3 sets 74.69 (189.38) 64.92 (189.38) 60.76 (189.38)
5 sets 117.45 (299.04) 101.75 (299.04) 92.2 (299.04)
Double-sided originals↓
Double-sided copies
1 set 64.24 (138.12) 63.54 (138.12) 63.01 (138.12)
3 sets 150.73 (355.91) 134.25 (355.91) 126.36 (355.91)
5 sets 234.59 (574.51) 205.69 (574.51) 189.67 (574.51)
Double-sided originals↓
Single-sided copies
1 set 58.85 (128.31) 58.76 (128.31) 58.09 (128.31)
3 sets 143.68 (347.08) 126.57 (347.08) 110.94 (347.08)
5 sets 228.58 (565.02) 194.49 (565.02) 165.19 (565.02)
Drawer ADU PFP LCF Bypass copy Remarks
Size A3 to A5-R, LD to ST-R,
13" LG, 8.5"SQ
A4, LT
A3 to A6-R, LD to ST-R, 13" LG, 8.5"SQ, 305 x 457 mm
(12" x 18") (Non-standard or userspec-
ified sizes can be set.)
Weight64 to 105 g/m2
17 to 28 lb. Bond
64 to 209 g/m2, 17 lb. Bondto 110 lb. Index
(Continuous feeding)64 to 209 g/m2, 17 lb. Bond
to 110 lb. Index(Single paper feeding)
Special paper - Labels, OHP film
(thickness: 80µm or thicker)Special paper recom-
mended by Toshiba Tec
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedSPECIFICATIONS/ACCESSORIES/OPTIONS/SUPPLIES
1 - 6
Eliminated portion.................... Leading edges: 3.0±2.0 mm, Side/trailing edges: 2.0±2.0 mm (black copy)Leading edges: 5.0±2.0 mm, Side/trailing edges: 2.0±2.0 mm (color copy)Leading / trailing edges: 5.0±2.0 mm, Side edges: 5.0±2.0 mm (black / color print)
Paper feeding .......................... Standard drawers:2 drawers (stack height 60.5 mm, equivalent to 550 sheets; 64 to 80 g/
m2 (17 to 22 lb. Bond))PFP:Option (One drawer or two: stack height 60.5 mm, equivalent to 550
sheets; 64 to 80 g/m2 (17 to 22 lb. Bond))LCF:Option (Stack height 137.5 mm x 2: equivalent to 2500 sheets; 64 to 80
g/m2 (17 to 22 lb. Bond))Bypass feeding:
Stack height 11 mm: equivalent to 100 sheets; 64 to 80 g/m2 (17 to 22 lb. Bond)
Capacity of originals in the reversing automatic document feeder (Option).................................................. A3 to A5-R, LD to ST-R:
100 sheets / 80 g/m2 (Stack height 16 mm or less)Automatic duplexing unit ......... Stackless, Switchback typeToner supply ............................ Automatic toner density detection/supply
Toner cartridge replacing methodDensity control......................... Automatic density mode and manual density mode selectable in 11
stepsWeight ..................................... Approximately 113 kg (249 lb.)Power requirements ................ AC 110 V / 13.2 A, 115 V or 127 V / 12 A
220-240 V or 240 V / 8 A (50/60 Hz)* The acceptable value of each voltage is ±10%.Power consumption................. 1.5 kW or less (100 V series), 17 kW or less (200 V series)* The electric power is supplied to the RADF, Finisher, PFP and LCF through the equipment.Total counter............................ Electronical counterDimensions of the equipment...................... See the figure below (W 660 x D 758 x H 739 (mm))* When the tilt angle of the control panel is 45 degrees.
Fig. 1-1
660
758
45°
739
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cSPECIFICATIONS/ACCESSORIES/OPTIONS/SUPPLIES
1 - 7
1
1.2 Accessories
* Machine versionNAD: North AmericaMJD: EuropeAUD: AustraliaASD: Asia, ArgentineTWD: TaiwanSAD Saudi ArabiaASU Saudi Arabia, AsiaCND ChinaKRD KoreaJPD: Japan
Unpacking/Setup instruction 1 set
Operator’s manual 4 pcs. (except for MJD and ASU)
Operator's manual pocket 1 pc.
Power cable 1 pc.
Warranty sheet 1 pc. (for NAD)
Setup report 1 set (for NAD, MJD and CND)
PM sticker 1 pc. (for MJD)
Drum (installed inside of the equipment) 1 pc.
Control panel stopper 1 pc.
Color developer holder 6 pc.
Rubber plug 4 pcs.
Blind seal (small / large) 3 pcs. /1 pc.
CD-ROM 3 pcs.
Developer material (Y, M, C, K) 1 pc. each (for CND)
Screw M4 x 8 1 pc.
Guide 1 pc.
Approval sheet 1 set (for CND)
Toner cartridge (Y, M, C, K) 1 pc. each (for CND)
Platen cover 1 pc. (for CND)
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedSPECIFICATIONS/ACCESSORIES/OPTIONS/SUPPLIES
1 - 8
1.3 Options
Platen cover KA-3511PC / -C
Reversing Automatic Document Feeder (RADF) MR-3018
Drawer module MY-1021 / -C
Paper Feed Pedestal (PFP) KD-1011 / -C
Large Capacity Feeder (LCF) KD-1012 A4/LT / A4-C
Hanging Finisher MJ-1022 / -C
Finisher MJ-1023 / -CMJ-1101
Saddle Stitch Finisher MJ-1024 / -C
Hole punch unit MJ-6004 N/E/F/S / E-C (for MJ-1023/1024)MJ-6101 N/E/F/S (for MJ-1101)
Staple cartridge STAPLE-1600 (for MJ-1022)STAPLE-2000 (for MJ-1023/1024)STAPLE-600 (for saddle stitcher of MJ-1024)STAPLE-2400 (for MJ-1101)
Bridge kit KN-3511 / -C
Work table KK-3511 / -C
Damp heater kit MF-3511U/E
FAX unit GD-1200 NA/AU/AS/EU/C/TWGD-1201 NA/AU/AS/EU/C/TW
2nd line for fax unit GD-1160 NA/EU-N/C/TWGD-1260 NA/EU-N/C/TW
128 MB Expansion memory GC-1181
512 MB Expansion memory GC-1230
Wireless LAN module GN-1040/1041
PCI slot GO-1060
Scrambler board GP-1040
Bluetooth module GN-2010
Antenna GN-3010
Parallel interface kit GF-1140
Data overwrite kit GP-1060
e-BRIDGE ID Gate (HID iClass) KP-2004
e-BRIDGE ID Gate (MIFARE) KP-2005
Desk MH-1700
Harness kit for coin controller GQ-1020
08/12
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cSPECIFICATIONS/ACCESSORIES/OPTIONS/SUPPLIES
1 - 9
1
Notes: 1. The bridge kit (KN-3511) is necessary for installation of the finisher (MJ-1022, MJ-1023,
MJ-1024 or MJ-1101).2. The finisher (MJ-1023 or MJ-1024) is necessary for installation of the hole punch unit
(MJ-6004N/E/F/S).3. The finisher (MJ-1101) is necessary for installation of the hole punch unit (MJ-6101N/E/F/S).4. The PCI slot (GO-1060) is necessary for the installation of the scrambler board (GP-1040)
and the parallel interface kit (GF-1140).5. The antenna (GN-3010) is necessary to enable the wireless LAN module (GN-1040/1041)
and the bluetooth module (GN-2010).6. Up to 1 antenna (GN-3010) can be connected to the wireless LAN module (GN-1040/1041).7. When the wireless LAN module (GN-1040/1041) and the bluetooth module (GN-2010) are
installed together, only 1 antenna (GN-3010) can be connected to each.
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedSPECIFICATIONS/ACCESSORIES/OPTIONS/SUPPLIES
1 - 10
1.4 Supplies
Drum OD-3511N
Toner bag PS-TB-281C/ C-E/ C-C
Developer (K) D-3511-K
Developer (Y) D-281C-Y
Developer (M) D-281C-M
Developer (C) D-281C-C
Toner cartridge (K) PS-ZT281C-K(4) NAD
PS-ZT281C-EK(1) MJD
PS-ZT3511DK Others
PS-ZT3511TK TWD
PS-ZT3511CK CND
Toner cartridge (Y) PS-ZT281C-Y(4) NAD
PS-ZT281C-EY(1) MJD
PS-ZT3511DY Others
PS-ZT3511TY TWD
PS-ZT3511CY CND
Toner cartridge (M) PS-ZT281C-M(4) NAD
PS-ZT281C-EM(1) MJD
PS-ZT3511DM Others
PS-ZT3511TM TWD
PS-ZT3511CM CND
Toner cartridge (C) PS-ZT281C-C(4) NAD
PS-ZT281C-EC(1) MJD
PS-ZT3511DC Others
PS-ZT3511TC TWD
PS-ZT3511CC CND
08/04
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cSPECIFICATIONS/ACCESSORIES/OPTIONS/SUPPLIES
1 - 11
1
1.5 System List
Fig. 1-2
Sta
ple
Cart
ridge
ST
AP
LE
-1600
Pla
ten C
over
KA
-3511P
C
Revers
ing A
uto
matic
Docum
ent F
eeder
( RA
DF
)
MR
-3018
Bridge K
it
KN
-3511
Blu
eto
oth
module
GN
-2010
Expansio
n
mem
ory
GC
-1181
Expansio
n
mem
ory
GC
-1230
Ante
nna
GN
-3010
FA
X u
nit
GD
-1200/1
201
2nd L
ine for
FA
X u
nit
GD
-1160/1
260
Wirele
ss L
AN
module
GN
-1040/1
041
Para
llel
inte
rface k
it
GF
-1140
PC
I slo
t
GO
-1060
Scra
mble
r
board
GP
-1040
Data
overw
rite
kit
GP
-1060
Dra
wer
Module
MY
-1021
Larg
e C
apacity
Feeder
(LC
F)
KD
-1012 A
4/L
T
Paper
Feed
Pedesta
l (P
FP
)
KD
-1011
Hangin
g F
inis
her
MJ-1
022
Fin
isher
MJ-1
101
Hole
Punch U
nit
MJ-6
101 N
/E/F
/S
Sta
ple
Cart
ridge
ST
AP
LE
-2000
Sta
ple
Cart
ridge
ST
AP
LE
-2400
Hole
Punch U
nit
MJ-6
004 N
/E/F
/S
Sta
ple
Cart
ridge
ST
AP
LE
-600
Fin
isher
MJ-1
023
Saddle
stitc
hF
inis
her
MJ-1
024
Work
Tra
y
KK
-3511
Dam
p H
eate
r
MF
-3511U
/E
e-B
RID
GE
ID G
ate
KP
-20
05
e-B
RID
GE
ID G
ate
KP
-20
04
08/12
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedSPECIFICATIONS/ACCESSORIES/OPTIONS/SUPPLIES
1 - 12
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 1
2
2. ERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2.1 Error Code List
2.1.1 Jam
The following error codes is displayed at the upper right of the screen when the “CLEAR PAPER” or “CALL SERVICE” symbol is blinking.
Error code Classification Contents Troubleshooting
E010 Paper exit jam Jam not reaching the exit sensor : The paper which has passed through the fuser unit does not reach the exit sensor.
P. 5-1
E020 Paper exit jam Stop jam at the exit sensor: The trailing edge of the paper does not pass the exit sensor after its leading edge has reached this sensor.
P. 5-2
E030 Other paper jam Power-ON jam: The paper is remaining on the paper transport path when power is turned ON.
P. 5-18
E061 Incorrect paper size setting for upper drawer: The size of paper in the 1st drawer differs from size set-ting of the equipment.
P. 5-18
E062 Incorrect paper size setting for lower drawer: The size of paper in the 2nd drawer differs from size set-ting of the equipment.
P. 5-18
E063 Incorrect paper size setting for PFP upper drawer: The size of paper in the 3rd drawer differs from size setting of the equipment.
P. 5-18
E064 Incorrect paper size setting for PFP lower drawer: The size of paper in the 4th drawer differs from size setting of the equipment.
P. 5-18
E065 Incorrect paper size setting for bypass tray: The size of paper in the bypass tray differs from size setting of the equipment.
P. 5-18
E090 Image data delay jam: Image data to be printed cannot be prepared.
P. 5-19
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 2
E110 Paper misfeeding ADU misfeeding (Paper not reaching the registra-tion sensor): The paper which has passed through ADU does not reach the registration sensor during duplex printing.
P. 5-3
E120 Bypass misfeeding (Paper not reaching the regis-tration sensor): The paper fed from the bypass tray does not reach the registration sensor.
P. 5-4
E130 Upper drawer misfeeding (Paper not reaching the upper drawer feed sensor): The paper fed from the upper drawer does not reach the upper drawer feed sensor.
P. 5-5
E140 Lower drawer misfeeding (Paper not reaching the lower drawer feed sensor): The paper fed from the lower drawer does not reach the lower drawer feed sensor.
P. 5-6
E150 PFP upper drawer misfeeding (Paper not reaching the PFP upper drawer feed sensor): The paper fed from the PFP upper drawer does not reach the PFP upper drawer feed sensor.
P. 5-7
E160 PFP lower drawer misfeeding (Paper not reaching the PFP lower drawer feed sensor): The paper fed from the PFP lower drawer does not reach the PFP lower drawer feed sensor.
P. 5-8
E190 LCF misfeeding (Paper not reaching the LCF feed sensor): The paper fed from the LCF does not reach the LCF feed sensor.
P. 5-9
E200 Paper transport jam Upper drawer transport jam (Paper not reaching the registration sensor): The paper does not reach the registration sensor after it has passed the upper drawer feed sensor.
P. 5-10
Error code Classification Contents Troubleshooting
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 3
2
E210 Paper transport jam Lower drawer transport jam (Paper not reaching the registration sensor): The paper does not reach the registration sensor after it has passed the upper drawer feed sensor.
P. 5-10
E220 Lower drawer transport jam (Paper not reaching the upper drawer feed sensor): The paper does not reach the upper drawer feed sensor after it has passed the lower drawer feed sensor.
P. 5-11
E300 PFP upper drawer transport jam (Paper not reach-ing the registration sensor): The paper does not reach the registration sensor after it has passed the upper drawer feed sensor.
P. 5-10
E310 PFP upper drawer transport jam (Paper not reach-ing the upper drawer feed sensor): The paper does not reach the upper drawer feed sensor after it has passed the lower drawer feed sensor.
P. 5-11
E320 PFP upper drawer transport jam (Paper not reach-ing the lower drawer feed sensor): The paper does not reach the lower drawer feed sensor after it has passed the PFP upper drawer feed sensor.
P. 5-12
E330 PFP lower drawer transport jam (Paper not reach-ing the registration sensor): The paper does not reach the registration sensor after it has passed the upper drawer feed sensor.
P. 5-10
E340 PFP lower drawer transport jam (Paper not reach-ing the upper drawer feed sensor): The paper does not reach the upper drawer feed sensor after it has passed the lower drawer feed sensor.
P. 5-11
E350 PFP lower drawer transport jam (Paper not reach-ing the lower drawer feed sensor): The paper does not reach the lower drawer feed sensor after it has passed the PFP upper drawer feed sensor.
P. 5-12
E360 PFP lower drawer transport jam (Paper not reach-ing the PFP upper drawer feed sensor): The paper does not reach the PFP upper drawer feed sensor after it has passed the PFP lower drawer feed sen-sor.
P. 5-13
E3C0 LCF transport jam (Paper not reaching the registra-tion sensor): Paper fed from the LCF and passed through the upper drawer feed sensor does not reach the registration sensor.
P. 5-10
E3D0 LCF transport jam (Paper not reaching the upper drawer feed sensor): Paper fed from the LCF and passed through the lower drawer feed sensor does not reach the upper drawer feed sensor.
P. 5-11
E3E0 LCF transport jam (Paper not reaching the lower drawer feed sensor): Paper fed from the LCF and passed through the LCF feed sensor does not reach the lower drawer feed sensor.
P. 5-12
E400 Cover open jam Jam access cover open jam: The jam access cover has opened during printing.
P. 5-20
E410 Front cover open jam: The front cover has opened during printing.
P. 5-20
Error code Classification Contents Troubleshooting
08/04
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 4
E420 Cover open jam PFP side cover open jam: The PFP side cover has opened during printing.
P. 5-21
E430 ADU open jam: The ADU has opened during print-ing.
P. 5-21
E440 Side cover open jam: The side cover has opened during printing.
P. 5-22
E450 LCF side cover open jam: The LCF side cover has opened during printing.
P. 5-22
E480 Bridge unit open jam: The bridge unit has opened during printing.
P. 5-23
E510 Paper transport jam (ADU section)
Jam not reaching the ADU entrance sensor: The paper does not reach the ADU entrance sensor after it is switchbacked in the exit section.
P. 5-14
E520 Stop jam in the ADU: The paper does not reach the ADU exit sensor after it has passed the ADU entrance sensor.
P. 5-15
E550 Other paper jam Paper remaining jam on the transport path: The paper is remaining on the transport path when print-ing is finished (caused by a multiple paper feeding).
P. 5-19
E712 RADF jam Jam not reaching the original registration sensor: The original fed from the original feeding tray does not reach the original registration sensor.
P. 5-24
E713 Cover open jam in the read ready status: Jam caused by opening of the RADF jam access cover or front cover while the RADF is waiting for the scanning start signal from the equipment.
P. 5-24
E714 Feed signal reception jam: The feed signal is received even no original exists on the original feeding tray.
P. 5-25
E721 Jam not reaching the read sensor: The original does not reach the read sensor after it has passed the registration sensor (when scanning obverse side) or the reverse sensor (when scanning reverse side).
P. 5-25
E722 Jam not reaching the original exit/reverse sensor (during scanning): The original which passed the read sensor does not reach the original exit/reverse sensor when it is transported from the scanning section to exit section.
P. 5-26
E724 Stop jam at the original registration sensor: The trailing edge of the original does not pass the origi-nal registration sensor after its leading edge has reached this sensor.
P. 5-26
E725 Stop jam at the read sensor: The trailing edge of the original does not pass the read sensor after its lead-ing edge has reached this sensor.
P. 5-27
E731 Stop jam at the original exit/reverse sensor: The trailing edge of the original does not pass the origi-nal exit/reverse sensor after its leading edge has reached this sensor.
P. 5-27
E860 RADF jam access cover open: The RADF jam access cover has opened during RADF operation.
P. 5-27
E870 RADF open jam: RADF has opened during RADF operation.
P. 5-28
Error code Classification Contents Troubleshooting
06/08
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 5
2
E910 Finisher jam (Bridge unit)
Jam at the bridge unit transport sensor 1: The paper does not reach the bridge unit transport sen-sor 1 after it has passed the exit sensor.
P. 5-29
E920 Stop jam at the bridge unit transport sensor 1: The trailing edge of the paper does not pass the bridge unit transport sensor 1 after its leading edge has reached the sensor.
P. 5-29
E930 Jam at the bridge unit transport sensor 2: The trail-ing edge of the paper does not reach the bridge unit transport sensor 2 after its leading edge has reached the bridge unit transport sensor 1.
P. 5-29
E940 Stop jam at the bridge unit transport sensor 2: The trailing edge of the paper does not pass the bridge unit transport sensor 2 after its leading edge has reached the bridge unit transport sensor 2.
P. 5-29
E9F0 Finisher jam(Punch unit)
Punching jam: Punching is not performed properly.[MJ-1023/1024 (when MJ-6004 is installed)][MJ-1101 (when MJ-6101 is installed)]
P. 5-46
EA10 Finisher jam(Finisher section)
Paper transport delay jam: The paper which has passed the bridgeunit does not reach the inlet sensor. [MJ-1022/1023/1024/1101]
P. 5-30
EA20 Paper transport stop jam:(1) The paper does not pass through the inlet sen-
sor.[MJ-1022/1023/1024]
(2) The paper has passed through the inlet sensor but does not reach or pass the feed path sensor or processing tray sensor.[MJ-1023/1024]
(3) The paper which has passed through the inlet sensor does not reach the transport sensor. [MJ-1101]
P. 5-32
EA21 Paper size error jam: Paper does not reach the sen-sor because the paper is shorter than spec. [MJ-1101]
P. 5-33
EA30 Power-ON jam:(1) Paper exists at the inlet sensor when power is
turned ON.[MJ-1022/1023/1024]
(2) Paper exists at the feed path sensor or pro-cessing tray sensor when power is turned ON. [MJ-1023/1024]
P. 5-34
EA31 Transport path paper remaining jam: The paper which has passed through the inlet sensor does not reach the transport sensor. [MJ-1101]
P. 5-35
EA32 Exit paper remaining jam: The paper is remaining on the finishing tray when the power is turned ON. [MJ-1101]
P. 5-35
Error code Classification Contents Troubleshooting
06/08
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 6
EA40 Finisher jam(Finisher section)
Door open jam:1) The finisher has been released from the equip-
ment during printing. [MJ-1022]2) The upper/front cover of the finisher section or
the upper/ front door of the puncher section has opened during printing. [MJ-1023/1024]
3) The front cover or stationary tray cover is opened during paper transport. [MJ-1101]
P. 5-36
EA50 Stapling jam: Stapling is not performed properly. [MJ-1022/1023/1024/1101]
P. 5-38
EA60 Early arrival jam: The inlet sensor detects the paper earlier than a specified timing. [MJ-1022/1023/1024/1101]
P. 5-40
EA70 Stack delivery jam: It cannot deliver the stack of paper on the intermediary process tray to the stack tray. [MJ-1022]
P. 5-41
Stack exit belt home position error: The stack exit belt is not at the home position. [MJ-1101]
EA80 Finisher jam (Saddle stitcher sec-tion)
Stapling jam: Stapling is not performed properly. [MJ-1024]
P. 5-43
EA90 Door open jam: The delivery cover or inlet cover has opened dur-ing printing [MJ-1024].
P. 5-43
EAA0 Power-ON jam: Paper exists at No.1 paper sensor, No. 2 paper sensor, No.3 paper sensor, vertical path paper sensor or delivery sensor when power is turned ON. [MJ-1024]
P. 5-44
EAB0 Transport stop jam: The paper which passed through the inlet sensor does not reach or pass No.1 paper sensor, No. 2 paper sensor, No.3 paper sensor or delivery sensor. [MJ-1024]
P. 5-44
EAC0 Transport delay jam: The paper which has reached the inlet sensor does not pass through the inlet sen-sor. [MJ-1024]
P. 5-45
EAD0 Other paper jam Print end command time-out jam: The printing has not finished normally because of the communica-tion error between the SYS board and LGC board at the end of printing.
P. 5-47
EAE0 Finisher jam Receiving time time-out jam: The printing has been interrupted because of the communication error between the equipment and finisher when the paper is transported from the equipment to the fin-isher.
P. 5-47
EAF0 Finisher jam(Finisher section)
Stack return jam: It cannot load the paper which passed through the delivery roller on the intermedi-ary process tray. [MJ-1022]
P. 5-42
EB30 Finisher jam Ready time time-out jam: The equipment judges that the paper transport to the finisher is disabled because of the communication error between the equipment and finisher at the start of printing.
P. 5-47
EB50 Paper transport jam Paper remaining on the transport path: The multiple feeding of preceding paper caused the misfeeding of upcoming paper.
P. 5-16
EB60 Paper remaining on the transport path: The multiple feeding of preceding paper caused the misfeeding of upcoming paper (redetection after no jam is detected at [EB50]).
P. 5-17
Error code Classification Contents Troubleshooting
07/11
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 7
2
ED10 Finisher jam Skew adjustment motor (M1) home position detec-tion abnormality: The Skew adjustment motor is not at the home position. [MJ-1101 (when MJ-6101 is installed)]
P. 5-48
ED11 Sideways adjustment motor (M2) home position detection error: The Sideways adjustment motor is not at the home position. [MJ-1101 (when MJ-6101 is installed)]
P. 5-48
ED12 Shutter home position error: The shutter is not at the home position. [MJ-1101]
P. 5-49
ED13 Front alignment plate home position error: The front alignment plate is not at the home position. [MJ-1101]
P. 5-49
ED14 Rear alignment plate home position error: The rear alignment plate is not at the home position. [MJ-1101]
P. 5-50
ED15 Paddle home position error: The paddle is not at the home position. [MJ-1101]
P. 5-50
ED16 Buffer tray home position error: The buffer tray is not at the home position. [MJ-1101]
P. 5-51
Error code Classification Contents Troubleshooting
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 8
2.1.2 Service call
Error code Classification Contents Troubleshooting
C010 Drive system related service call
Main motor abnormality: The main motor is not rotating normally.
P. 5-52
C020 Developer motor abnormality: The developer motor is not rotating normally.
P. 5-52
C030 Transport motor abnormality: The transport motor is not rotating normally.
P. 5-52
C040 Paper feeding system related service call
PFP motor abnormality: The PFP motor is not rotat-ing normally. (the case that paper can be fed from any drawer except the PFP)
P. 5-53
C130 Upper drawer tray abnormality: The upper drawer tray-up motor is not rotating or the upper drawer tray is not moving normally. (the case that paper can be fed from any drawer except the upper drawer)
P. 5-54
C140 Lower drawer tray abnormality: The lower drawer tray-up motor is not rotating or the lower drawer tray is not moving normally. (the case that paper can be fed from any drawer except the lower drawer)
P. 5-54
C150 PFP upper drawer tray abnormality: The PFP upper drawer tray-up motor is not rotating or the PFP upper drawer tray is not moving normally. (the case that paper can be fed from any drawer except the PFP upper drawer)
P. 5-55
C160 PFP lower drawer tray abnormality: The PFP lower drawer tray-up motor is not rotating or the PFP lower drawer tray is not moving normally. (the case that paper can be fed from any drawer except the PFP lower drawer)
P. 5-55
C180 LCF tray-up motor abnormality: The LCF tray-up motor is not rotating or the LCF tray is not moving normally. (the case that paper can be fed from any drawer except the LCF)
P. 5-56
C1A0 LCF end fence motor abnormality: The LCF end fence motor is not rotating or the LCF end fence is not moving normally. (the case that paper can be fed from any drawer except the LCF)
P. 5-57
C1B0 LCF transport motor abnormality: The LCF trans-port motor is not rotating normally. (the case that paper can be fed from any drawer except the LCF)
P. 5-58
C260 Scanning system related service call
Peak detection error: Lighting of the exposure lamp (white reference) is not detected when power is turned ON.
P. 5-59
C270 Carriage home position sensor not turning OFF within a specified period of time: The carriage does not shift from its home position in a specified time.
P. 5-59
C280 Carriage home position sensor not turning ON within a specified period of time: The carriage does not reach to its home position in a specified period of time.
P. 5-59
C360 Copy process related service call
Charger cleaner motor abnormality: Charger cleaner motor is not rotating or wire cleaner is not moving normally.
P. 5-91
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 9
2
C411 Fuser unit related ser-vice call
Thermistor or heater abnormality at power-ON: Abnormality of the thermistor is detected when power is turned ON or the temperature of the fuser roller does not rise in a specified period of time after power is turned ON.
P. 5-60
C412 Thermistor/heater abnormality at power-ON: Ther-mistor abnormality is detected at power-ON or the fuser roller temperature does not rise within a spec-ified period of time after power-ON.
P. 5-60
C443 Heater abnormality after abnormality judgment (not reaching to intermediate temperature)
P. 5-61
C445 Heater abnormality after abnormality judgment (pre-running end temperature abnormality)
P. 5-61
C446 Heater abnormality after abnormality judgment (pre-running end temperature abnormality)
P. 5-61
C447 Heater abnormality after abnormality judgment (temperature abnormality at ready status)
P. 5-61
C449 Heater abnormality after abnormality judgment (overheating)
P. 5-61
C471 IH power voltage abnormality or IH initial abnormal-ity(IH board initial abnormality)
P. 5-61
C472 IH power voltage abnormality (power supply abnor-mality)
P. 5-61
C475 IH power voltage abnormality (power supply abnor-mality when door is opened)
P. 5-61
C480 Overheating of IGBT: The temperature of the IGBT rises abnormally.
P. 5-61
C490 IH control circuit or IH coil abnormality: Abnormality is detected in IH control circuit or IH coil is broken/shorted.
P. 5-62
C4B0 Fuser unit counter abnormality P. 5-62
C550 Optional communica-tion related service call
RADF I/F error: Communication error has occurred between the RADF and the scanner.
P. 5-63
C570 Communication error between Engine-CPU and IPC board
P. 5-63
C580 Communication error between IPC board and fin-isher
P. 5-63
C900 Circuit related service call
Connection error between SYS board and LGC board
P. 5-64
C940 Engine-CPU abnormality P. 5-64
C950 LGC board memory abnormality P. 5-64
C960 Connection error between LGC board and DRV board, ID abnormality
P. 5-64
C970 Process related ser-vice call
High-voltage transformer abnormality: Leakage of the main charger is detected.
P. 5-91
C9E0 Circuit related service call
Connection error between SLG board and SYS board, ID abnormality
P. 5-65
CA10 Laser optical unit related service call
Polygonal motor abnormality: The polygonal motor is not rotating normally.
P. 5-67
CA20 H-Sync detection error: H-Sync signal detection PC board cannot detect laser beams.
P. 5-67
Error code Classification Contents Troubleshooting
06/08
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 10
CB10 Finisher related service call
Entrance motor abnormality: The entrance motor is not rotating normally. [MJ-1101]
P. 5-68
CB11 Buffer tray guide motor abnormality: The buffer tray guide motor is not rotating or the buffer tray guide is not moving normally. [MJ-1101]
P. 5-68
CB12 Buffer roller drive motor abnormality: The buffer roller drive motor is not rotating or the buffer roller is not moving normally. [MJ-1101]
P. 5-68
CB20 Delivery motor abnormality: Delivery motor or deliv-ery roller is not rotating normally. [MJ-1022]
P. 5-69
CB30 Tray 1/Tray 2 shift motor abnormality: Tray 1/Tray 2 shift motor is not rotating or delivery tray is not mov-ing normally. [MJ-1023/1024]
P. 5-69
Movable tray shift motor abnormality: The movable tray shift motor is not rotating or the movable tray is not moving normally. [MJ-1101]
P. 5-69
CB31 Movable tray paper-full detection error: The actua-tor of the movable tray paper-full detection sensor does not move smoothly. [MJ-1101]
P. 5-70
CB40 Rear aligning plate motor abnormality: Rear align-ing plate motor is not rotating or aligning plate is not moving normally. [MJ-1023/1024]
P. 5-70
Front alignment motor abnormality: The front align-ment motor is not rotating or the front alignment plate is not moving normally. [MJ-1101]
P. 5-70
CB50 Staple motor abnormality: Staple motor is not rotat-ing or stapler is not moving normally. [MJ-1022/1023/1024]
P. 5-71
Stapler home position error: The stapler home posi-tion sensor does not work. [MJ-1101]
P. 5-71
CB51 Stapler shift home position error: The stapler is not at the home position. [MJ-1101]
P. 5-71
CB60 Stapler shift motor abnormality: Stapler shift motor is not rotating or staple unit is not moving normally. [MJ-1023/1024/1101]
P. 5-72
CB80 Backup RAM data abnormality:1) Abnormality of checksum value on finisher con-
troller PC board is detected when the power is turned ON. [MJ-1023/1024]
2) Abnormality of checksum value on punch con-troller PC board is detected when the power is turned ON. [MJ-1023/1024 (when MJ-6004 is installed)]
P. 5-72
RAM abnormality: Abnormality of checksum value on finisher controller PC board is detected when the power is turned on. [MJ-1101]
P. 5-72
CB81 Flash ROM abnormality: Abnormality of checksum value on finisher controller PC board is detected when the power is turned on. [MJ-1101]
P. 5-73
CB90 Paper pushing plate motor abnormality: Paper pushing plate motor is not rotating or paper pushing plate is not moving normally. [MJ-1024]
P. 5-73
CBA0 Stitch motor (front) abnormality: Stitch motor (front) is not rotating or rotary cam is not moving normally. [MJ-1024]
P. 5-73
CBB0 Stitch motor (rear) abnormality: Stitch motor (rear) is not rotating or rotary cam is not moving normally. [MJ-1024]
P. 5-73
Error code Classification Contents Troubleshooting
06/08
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 11
2
CBC0 Finisher related service call
Alignment motor abnormality: Alignment motor is not rotating or aligning plate is not moving normally. [MJ-1024]
P. 5-73
CBD0 Guide motor abnormality: Guide motor is not rotat-ing or guide is not moving normally. [MJ-1024]
P. 5-74
CBE0 Paper folding motor abnormality: Paper folding motor or paper folding roller is not rotating normally. [MJ-1024]
P. 5-74
CBF0 Paper positioning plate motor abnormality: Paper positioning plate motor is not rotating or paper posi-tioning plate is not moving normally. [MJ-1024]
P. 5-74
CC00 Sensor connector abnormality: Connector of guide home position sensor, paper pushing plate home position sensor or paper pushing plate top position sensor is disconnected. [MJ-1024]
P. 5-75
CC10 Micro switch abnormality: With all covers closed, inlet door switch, delivery door switch or front cover switch is open. [MJ-1024]
P. 5-75
CC20 Communication error between finisher and saddle stitcher: Communication error between finisher con-troller PC board and saddle stitcher controller board [MJ-1023/1024]
P. 5-75
CC30 Stack processing motor abnormality: The stack pro-cessing motor is not rotating or the stack delivery belt is not moving normally. [MJ-1022]
P. 5-76
Stack transport motor abnormality: The stack trans-port motor is not rotating or the stack transport belt is not moving normally. [MJ-1101]
P. 5-77
CC31 Transport motor abnormality: The transport motor is not rotating or the stack transport roller -1 and -2 is not rotating normally. [MJ-1101]
P. 5-77
CC40 Swing motor abnormality: Swing motor is not rotat-ing or swing unit is not moving normally. [MJ-1023/1024]
P. 5-77
CC41 Paper holder cam home position abnormality: The paper holder cam is not at the home position. [MJ-1101]
P. 5-78
CC50 Horizontal registration motor abnormality: Horizon-tal registration motor is not rotating or puncher is not shifting normally. [MJ-1023/1024 (when MJ-6004 is installed)]
P. 5-78
CC51 Sideways adjustment motor (M2) abnormality: Sideways adjustment motor is not rotating or puncher is not shifting normally. [MJ-1101 (when MJ-6101 is installed)
P. 5-78
CC52 Skew adjustment motor (M1) abnormality: Skew adjustment motor is not rotating or puncher is not shifting normally. [MJ-1101 (when MJ-6101 is installed)]
P. 5-79
CC60 Punch motor abnormality: Punch motor is not rotat-ing or puncher is not shifting normally. [MJ-1023/1024 (when MJ-6004 is installed)]
P. 5-79
CC61 Punch motor (M3) home position detection error: Punch motor is not rotating or puncher is not shift-ing normally. [MJ-1101 (when MJ-6101 is installed)]
P. 5-80
Error code Classification Contents Troubleshooting
06/08
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 12
CC71 Finisher related service call
Punch ROM checksum error: Abnormality of check-sum value on Hole punch controller PC board is detected when the power is turned on. [MJ-1101 (when MJ-6101 is installed)]
P. 5-80
CC72 Punch RAM read/write error: Abnormality of check-sum value on Hole punch controller PC board is detected when the power is turned on. [MJ-1101 (when MJ-6101 is installed)]
P. 5-80
CC80 Front alignment motor abnormality: Front alignment motor is not rotating or front aligning plate is not moving normally. [MJ-1022]Front aligning plate motor abnormality: Front align-ing plate motor is not rotating or aligning plate is not moving normally. [MJ-1023/1024]
P. 5-81
Rear alignment motor abnormality: The rear align-ment motor is not rotating or the rear alignment plate is not moving normally. [MJ-1101]
P. 5-81
CC90 Upper stack tray lift motor abnormality: The upper stack tray lift motor is not rotating or the upper stack tray is not moving normally. [MJ-1022]
P. 5-82
CCA0 Lower stack tray lift motor abnormality: The lower stack tray lift motor is not rotating or the lower stack tray is not moving normally. [MJ-1022]
P. 5-83
CCB0 Rear jogging motor abnormality: The rear jogging motor is not rotating or the rear jogging plate is not moving normally. [MJ-1022]
P. 5-83
CCD0 Stack ejection motor abnormality: Stack ejection motor or stack ejection roller is not rotating nor-mally. [MJ-1023/1024]
P. 5-84
CCE0 Paper trailing edge assist motor abnormality: Paper trailing edge assist motor is not rotating or paper trailing edge assist is not moving normally. [MJ-1023/1024]
P. 5-84
CCF0 Gear changing motor abnormality: Gear changing motor is not rotating normally. [MJ-1023/1024]
P. 5-84
CDE0 Paddle motor abnormality: The paddle motor is not rotating or the paddle is not rotating normally. [MJ-1101]
P. 5-85
CE00 Communication error between finisher and punch unit: Communication error between finisher control-ler PC board and punch controller PC board [MJ-1023/1024 (when MJ-6004 is installed)][MJ-1101 (when MJ-6101 is installed)]
P. 5-85
CE10 Image control related service call
Image quality sensor abnormality (OFF level): The output value of this sensor is out of a specified range when sensor light source is OFF.
P. 5-87
CE20 Image quality sensor abnormality (no pattern level): The output value of this sensor is out of a specified range when the image quality control test pattern is not formed.
P. 5-88
CE40 Image quality control test pattern abnormality: The test pattern is not formed normally.
P. 5-89
CE50 Temperature/humidity sensor abnormality: The out-put value of this sensor is out of a specified range.
P. 5-90
CE90 Drum thermistor abnormality: The output value of the drum thermistor is out of a specified range.
P. 5-90
Error code Classification Contents Troubleshooting
07/04
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 13
2
CEA0 Copy process related service call
Revolver home position detection abnormality: It cannot detect that the revolver is at its home posi-tion.
P. 5-91
CEB0 Black developer unit lifting movement abnormality: The black developer unit does not move up or down normally (lifting cam does not operate normally).
P. 5-92
CEC0 Copy process related service call
2nd transfer roller position detection abnormality: The 2nd transfer roller does not contact/release normally.
P. 5-93
CEE0 Transfer belt position detection abnormality (normal speed): The home position of the transfer belt can-not be detected.
P. 5-94
CEE1 Transfer belt position detection abnormality (when decelerating): Reference position of the transfer belt cannot be detected.
P. 5-94
CEF0 Revolver motor abnormality: Revolver motor is not rotating or revolver is not moving normally.
P. 5-94
CF10 Finisher related ser-vice call
Undefined error code processing: If the engine of the equipment judges that a code (command) other than the defined error codes is sent from the fin-isher, it regards this as a CF10 error. [MJ-1022/1023/1024]Communication module SRAM writing failure. [MJ-1101]
P. 5-86
CF20 Toner density control related service call
Toner density detection voltage abnormality: The output value of the color auto-toner sensor in print-ing is out of a specified range.
P. 5-95
CF30 Reference plate detection voltage abnormality: The output value of the color auto-toner sensor against the reference plate is out of a specified range at the light amount correction during an auto-toner adjust-ment or when a print job has finished.
P. 5-96
CF40 Light amount correction voltage abnormality: The light amount correction is not finished normally dur-ing an auto-toner adjustment or when a print job has finished, or the output value of the sensor is out of a specified range when the light amount correc-tion has finished.
P. 5-97
CF50 Color auto-toner sensor abnormality: The connec-tion of the color auto-toner sensor cannot be detected at the initialization, or the output value of color auto-toner sensor when the revolver starts rotating for initialization is out of a specified range.
P. 5-98
F070 Communication related service call
Communication error between System-CPU and Engine-CPU
P. 5-63
F090 Circuit related service call
SRAM abnormality on the SYS board P. 5-65
F091 NVRAM abnormality on the SYS board P. 5-65
F092 SRAM and NVRAM abnormality on the SYS board P. 5-66
Error code Classification Contents Troubleshooting
05/11
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 14
F100 Other service call HDD format error: HDD cannot be initialized nor-mally.
P. 5-99
F101 HDD unmounted: Connection of HDD cannot be detected.
P. 5-99
F102 HDD start error: HDD cannot become ‘Ready’ state. P. 5-99
F103 HDD transfer time-out: Reading/writing cannot be performed in the specified period of time.
P. 5-99
F104 HDD data error: Abnormality is detected in the data of HDD.
P. 5-99
F105 HDD other error P. 5-99
F106 Point and Print partition damage P. 5-99
F107 /BOX partition damage P. 5-99
F108 /SHA partition damage P. 5-99
F110 Communication related service call
Communication error between System-CPU and Scanner-CPU
P. 5-63
F111 Scanner response abnormality P. 5-63
F120 Other service call Database abnormality: Database is not operating normally.
P. 5-99
F130 Invalid MAC address P. 5-99
F200 Data overwrite kit (GP-1060) is taken off P. 5-100
F350 Circuit related service call
SLG board abnormality P. 5-66
Error code Classification Contents Troubleshooting
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 15
2
2.1.3 Error in Internet FAX / Scanning Function1) Internet FAX related error
Error code Classification Troubleshooting
1C10 System access abnormality P. 5-100
1C11 Insufficient memory P. 5-100
1C12 Message reception error P. 5-100
1C13 Message transmission error P. 5-100
1C14 Invalid parameter P. 5-100
1C15 Exceeding file capacity P. 5-100
1C20 System management module access abnormality P. 5-100
1C21 Job control module access abnormality P. 5-100
1C22 Job control module access abnormality P. 5-100
1C30 Directory creation failure P. 5-101
1C31 File creation failure P. 5-101
1C32 File deletion failure P. 5-100
1C33 File access failure P. 5-101
1C40 Image conversion abnormality P. 5-101
1C60 HDD full failure during processing P. 5-101
1C61 Address Book reading failure P. 5-101
1C62 Memory acquiring failure P. 5-101
1C63 Terminal IP address unset P. 5-101
1C64 Terminal mail address unset P. 5-101
1C65 SMTP address unset P. 5-101
1C66 Server time time-out error P. 5-101
1C67 NIC time time-out error P. 5-101
1C68 NIC access error P. 5-101
1C69 SMTP server connection error P. 5-101
1C6A HOST NAME error P. 5-101
1C6B Terminal mail address error P. 5-102
1C6C Destination mail address error P. 5-102
1C6D System error P. 5-101
1C70 SMTP client OFF P. 5-102
1C71 SMTP authentication error P. 5-102
1C72 POP before SMTP error P. 5-102
1C80 Internet FAX transmission failure when processing E-mail job received P. 5-102
1C81 Onramp Gateway transmission failure P. 5-102
1C82 Internet FAX transmission failure when processing FAX job received P. 5-102
1CC0 Job canceling -
1CC1 Power failure P. 5-102
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 16
2) RFC related error
Error codeMessage displayed in the TopAccess screen
Contents Troubleshooting
2500 Syntax error, command unrecog-nized
HOST NAME error(RFC: 500)Destination mail address error(RFC: 500)Terminal mail address error(RFC: 500)
P. 5-103
2501 Syntax error in parameters or argu-ments
HOST NAME error(RFC: 501)Destination mail address error(RFC: 501)Terminal mail address error(RFC: 501)
P. 5-103
2503 Bad sequence of commands Destination mail address error(RFC: 503)
P. 5-103
2504 Command parameter not imple-mented
HOST NAME error(RFC: 504)
P. 5-103
2550 Mailbox unavailable Destination mail address error(RFC: 550)
P. 5-103
2551 User not local Destination mail address error(RFC: 551)
P. 5-103
2552 Insufficient system storage Terminal/Destination mail address error(RFC: 552)
P. 5-103
2553 Mailbox name not allowed Destination mail address error(RFC: 553)
P. 5-103
07/11
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 17
2
3) Electronic Filing related error
Error codeMessage displayed inthe TopAccess screen
Contents Troubleshooting
2B10 There was no applicable job. No applicable job error in job control module
P. 5-104
2B11 Job status failed. JOB status abnormality P. 5-104
2B20 Failed to access file. File library function error P. 5-104
2B21 Message size exceeded limit or max-imum size.
Exceeding file capacity P. 5-104
2B30 Insufficient disk space. Insufficient disk space in /BOX parti-tion
P. 5-104
2B31 Failed to access Electronic Filing. Status of specified Electronic Filing or folder is undefined or being cre-ated/deleted
P. 5-104
2B32 Failed to print Electronic Filing docu-ment.
Electronic Filing printing failure: Specified document can not be printed because of client’s access (being edited, etc.).
P. 5-104
2B50 Failed to process image. Image library error P. 5-104
2B51 Failed to process print image. List library error P. 5-104
2B60 The folder was renamed. A folder of the same name already existed.
A folder with the same name exists in a box.
-
2B70 The document was renamed. A doc-ument of the same name already existed.
A document with the same name exists in a box or folder.
-
2B71 Document(s) expire(s) in a few days Documents expiring in a few days exist
-
2B80 Hard Disk space for Electronic Filing nearly full.
Hard disk space in /BOX partition is nearly full (90%).
-
2B90 Insufficient Memory. Insufficient memory capacity P. 5-104
2BA0 Invalid Box password specified. Invalid Box password P. 5-104
2BA0 Invalid Box password specified. Invalid Box password P. 5-104
2BA1 Incorrect paper size A Paper size not supported in the Electronic Filing function is being selected.
P. 5-105
2BB1 Power failure occurred Power failure P. 5-105
2BC0 System fatal error. Fatal failure occurred P. 5-104
2BC1 Failed to acquire resource. System management module resource acquiring failure
P. 5-104
2BD0 Power failure occurred during e-Fil-ing restoring.
Power failure occurred during restor-ing of Electronic Filing
P. 5-105
2BE0 Failed to get machine parameter. Machine parameter reading failure P. 5-105
2BF0 Maximum number of page range is reached.
Exceeding maximum number of pages
P. 5-105
2BF1 Maximum number of document range is reached.
Exceeding maximum number of doc-uments
P. 5-105
2BF2 Maximum number of folder range is reached.
Exceeding maximum number of fold-ers
P. 5-105
07/11
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 18
4) E-mail related error
Error codeMessage displayed inthe TopAccess screen
Contents Troubleshooting
2C10 Illegal Job status System access abnormality P. 5-106
2C11 Not enough memory Insufficient memory P. 5-106
2C12 Illegal Job status Message reception error P. 5-106
2C13 Illegal Job status Message transmission error P. 5-106
2C14 Invalid parameter specified Invalid parameter P. 5-106
2C15 Message size exceeded limit or max-imum size
Exceeding file capacity P. 5-106
2C20 Illegal Job status System management module access abnormality
P. 5-106
2C21 Illegal Job status Job control module access abnor-mality
P. 5-106
2C22 Illegal Job status Job control module access abnor-mality
P. 5-106
2C30 Failed to create directory Directory creation failure P. 5-106
2C31 Failed to create file File creation failure P. 5-106
2C32 Failed to delete file File deletion failure P. 5-106
2C33 Failed to create file File access failure P. 5-106
2C40 Failed to convert image file format Image conversion abnormality P. 5-106
2C43 Encryption error. Failed to create file Encryption error P. 5-106
2C44 Creating the image file was not per-mitted.
Encryption PDF enforced mode error P. 5-106
2C60 Failed to process your Job. Insuffi-cient disk space.
HDD full failure during processing P. 5-106
2C61 Failed to read AddressBook Address Book reading failure P. 5-107
2C62 Not enough memory Memory acquiring failure P. 5-106
2C63 Invalid Domain Address Terminal IP address unset P. 5-107
2C64 Invalid Domain Address Terminal mail address unset P. 5-107
2C65 Failed to connect to SMTP server SMTP address unset P. 5-107
2C66 Failed to connect to SMTP server Server time time-out error P. 5-107
2C67 Failed to send E-Mail message NIC time time-out error P. 5-107
2C68 Failed to send E-Mail message NIC access error P. 5-107
2C69 Failed to connect to SMTP server SMTP server connection error P. 5-107
2C6A Failed to send E-Mail message HOST NAME error (No RFC error) P. 5-107
2C6B Invalid address specified in From: field
Terminal mail address error P. 5-107
2C6C Invalid address specified in To: field Destination mail address error (No RFC error)
P. 5-107
2C6D NIC system error System error P. 5-107
2C70 SMTP service is not available SMTP client OFF P. 5-107
2C71 Failed SMTP Authentication SMTP authentication error P. 5-107
2C72 POP Before SMTP Authentication Failed
POP before SMTP error P. 5-107
2C80 Failed to process received E-mail job E-mail transmission failure when pro-cessing E-mail job received
P. 5-108
2C81 Failed to process received Fax job Process failure of FAX job received P. 5-108
2CC0 Job canceled Job canceling -
2CC1 Power failure occurred Power failure P. 5-108
07/11
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 19
2
5) File sharing related error
Error codeMessage displayed inthe TopAccess screen
Contents Troubleshooting
2D10 Illegal Job status System access abnormality P. 5-1092D11 Not enough memory Insufficient memory P. 5-1092D12 Illegal Job status Message reception error P. 5-1092D13 Illegal Job status Message transmission error P. 5-1092D14 Invalid parameter specified Invalid parameter P. 5-1092D15 There are too many documents in the
folder. Failed in creating new docu-ment.
Exceeding document number P. 5-109
2D20 Illegal Job status System management module access abnormality
P. 5-109
2D21 Illegal Job status Job control module access abnor-mality
P. 5-109
2D22 Illegal Job status Job control module access abnor-mality
P. 5-109
2D30 Failed to create directory Directory creation failure P. 5-1092D31 Failed to create file File creation failure P. 5-1092D32 Failed to delete file File deletion failure P. 5-1092D33 Failed to create file File access failure P. 5-1092D40 Failed to convert image file format Image conversion abnormality P. 5-1092D43 Encryption error. Failed to create file Encryption error P. 5-1092D44 Creating the image file was not per-
mitted.Encryption PDF enforced mode error P. 5-109
2D60 Failed to copy file File library access abnormality P. 5-1092D62 Failed to connect to network destina-
tion. Check destination pathFile server connection error P. 5-110
2D63 Specified network path is invalid. Check destination path
Invalid network path P. 5-110
2D64 Logon to file server failed. Check username and password
Login failure P. 5-110
2D65 There are too many documents in the folder. Failed in creating new docu-ment.
Exceeding documents in folder:Creating new document is failed.
P. 5-110
2D66 Failed to process your Job. Insuffi-cient disk space.
HDD full failure during processing P. 5-110
2D67 FTP service is not available FTP service not available P. 5-1102D68 File Sharing service is not available File sharing service not available P. 5-1102DA0 Expired scan documents deleted
from share folder.Periodical deletion of scanned docu-ments completed properly.
-
2DA1 Expired Sent Fax documents deleted from shared folder.
Periodical deletion of transmitted FAX documents completed properly.
-
2DA2 Expired Received Fax documents deleted from shared folder.
Periodical deletion of received FAX documents completed properly.
-
2DA3 Scanned documents in shared folder deleted upon user’s request.
Manual deletion of scanned docu-ments completed properly.
-
2DA4 Sent Fax Documents in shared folder deleted upon user’s request.
Manual deletion of transmitted FAX documents completed properly.
-
2DA5 Received Fax Documents in shared folder deleted upon user’s request.
Manual deletion of received FAX documents completed properly.
-
2DA6 Failed to delete file. File deletion failure P. 5-1092DA7 Failed to acquire resource. Resource acquiring failure P. 5-1092DA8 The HDD is running out of capacity
for the shared folder.Hard disk space in /SHA partition is nearly full (90%).
-
2DC0 Job canceled Job canceling -2DC1 Power failure occurred Power failure P. 5-110
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 20
6) E-mail reception related error
Error codeMessage displayed inthe TopAccess screen
Contents Troubleshooting
3A10 MIME Error has been detected in the received mail.
E-mail MIME error P. 5-111
3A11 MIME Error has been detected in the received mail. This mail has been transferred to the administrator.
P. 5-111
3A12 MIME Error has been detected in the received mail. This mail could not be transferred to the administrator.
P. 5-111
3A20 Analyze Error has been detected in the received mail.
E-mail analysis error P. 5-111
3A21 Analyze Error has been detected in the received mail. This mail has been transferred to the administrator.
P. 5-111
3A22 Analyze Error has been detected in the received mail. This mail could not be transferred to the administrator.
P. 5-111
3A30 Whole partial mails were not reached by timeout.
Partial mail time-out error P. 5-111
3A40 Partial Mail Error has been detected in the received mail.
Partial mail related error P. 5-111
3A50 HDD Full Error has been occurred in this mail.
Insufficient HDD capacity error P. 5-111
3A51 HDD Full Error has been occurred in this mail. This mail has been trans-ferred to the administrator.
P. 5-111
3A52 HDD Full Error has been occurred in this mail. This mail could not be transferred to the administrator.
P. 5-111
3A60 HDD Full Warning has been occurred in this mail.
Warning of insufficient HDD capacity P. 5-111
3A61 HDD Full Warning has been occurred in this mail. This mail could not be transferred to the administrator.
P. 5-111
3A62 HDD Full Warning has been occurred in this mail. This mail could not be transferred to the administrator.
P. 5-111
3A70 Receiving partial mail was aborted since the partial mail setting has been changed to Disable.
Warning of partial mail interruption P. 5-111
3A80 Partial mail was received during the partial mail setting is disabled.
Partial mail reception setting OFF P. 5-111
3A81 Partial mail was received during the partial mail setting is disabled. This mail has been transferred to the administrator.
P. 5-111
3A82 Partial mail was received during the partial mail setting is disabled. This mail could not be transferred to the administrator.
P. 5-111
3B10 Format Error has been detected in the received mail.
E-mail format error P. 5-111
3B11 Format Error has been detected in the received mail. This mail has been transferred to the administrator.
P. 5-111
3B12 Format Error has been detected in the received mail. This mail could not be transferred to the administrator.
P. 5-111
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 21
2
3B20 Content-Type Error has been detected in the received mail.
Content-Type error P. 5-111
3B21 Content-Type Error has been detected in the received mail. This mail has been transferred to the administrator.
P. 5-111
3B22 Content-Type Error has been detected in the received mail. This mail could not be transferred to the administrator.
P. 5-111
3B30 Charset Error has been detected in the received mail.
Charset error P. 5-111
3B31 Charset Error has been detected in the received mail. This mail has been transferred to the administrator.
P. 5-111
3B32 Charset Error has been detected in the received mail. This mail could not be transferred to the administrator.
P. 5-111
3B40 Decode Error has been detected in the received mail.
E-mail decode error P. 5-111
3B41 Decode Error has been detected in the received mail. This mail has been transferred to the administrator.
P. 5-111
3B42 Decode Error has been detected in the received mail. This mail could not be transferred to the administrator.
P. 5-111
3C10 Tiff Analyze Error has been detected in the received mail.
TIFF analysis error P. 5-111
3C11 Tiff Analyze Error has been detected in the received mail. This mail has been transferred to the administrator.
P. 5-111
3C12 Tiff Analyze Error has been detected in the received mail. This mail could not be transferred to the administra-tor.
P. 5-111
3C13 Tiff Analyze Error has been detected in the received mail.
P. 5-111
3C20 Tiff Compression Error has been detected in the received mail.
E-mail format error P. 5-111
3C21 Tiff Compression Error has been detected in the received mail. This mail has been transferred to the administrator.
P. 5-111
3C22 Tiff Compression Error has been detected in the received mail. This mail could not be transferred to the administrator.
P. 5-111
3C30 Tiff Resolution Error has been detected in the received mail.
Content-Type error P. 5-112
3C31 Tiff Resolution Error has been detected in the received mail. This mail has been transferred to the administrator.
P. 5-112
3C32 Tiff Resolution Error has been detected in the received mail. This mail could not be transferred to the administrator.
P. 5-112
Error codeMessage displayed inthe TopAccess screen
Contents Troubleshooting
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 22
3C40 Tiff Paper Size Error has been detected in the received mail.
Charset error P. 5-112
3C41 Tiff Paper Size Error has been detected in the received mail. This mail has been transferred to the administrator.
P. 5-112
3C42 Tiff Paper Size Error has been detected in the received mail. This mail could not be transferred to the administrator.
P. 5-112
3C50 Offramp Destination Error has been detected in the received mail.
E-mail decode error P. 5-112
3C51 Offramp Destination Error has been detected in the received mail. This mail has been transferred to the administrator.
P. 5-112
3C52 Offramp Destination Error has been detected in the received mail. This mail could not be transferred to the administrator.
P. 5-112
3C60 Offramp Security Error has been detected in the received mail.
TIFF analysis error P. 5-112
3C61 Offramp Security Error has been detected in the received mail. This mail has been transferred to the administrator.
P. 5-112
3C62 Offramp Security Error has been detected in the received mail. This mail could not be transferred to the administrator.
P. 5-112
3C70 Power Failure has been occurred in Email receiving.
Power failure error P. 5-112
3D10 SMTP Destination Error has been detected in the received mail. This mail was deleted.
Destination address error P. 5-112
3D20 Offramp Destination limitation Error has been detected in the received mail.
Offramp destination limitation error P. 5-112
3D30 Fax Board Error has been occurred in the received mail.
FAX board error P. 5-112
3E10 POP3 Connection Error has been occurred in the received mail.
POP3 server connection error P. 5-112
3E20 POP3 Connection Timeout Error has been occurred in the received mail.
POP3 server connection time-out error
P. 5-112
3E30 POP3 Login Error has been occurred in the received mail.
POP3 login error P. 5-112
3E40 POP3 Login Error occurred in the received mail.
POP3 login method error P. 5-112
3F00 File I/O Error has been occurred in this mail. The mail could not be received until File I/O is recovered.
File I/O error P. 5-1123F10 P. 5-1123F20 P. 5-1123F30 P. 5-1123F40 P. 5-112
Error codeMessage displayed inthe TopAccess screen
Contents Troubleshooting
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 23
2
2.1.4 Printer function errorFollowing codes are displayed at the end of the user name on the print job log screen.
Error code Contents Troubleshooting402F Page memory size error - 1200 dpi network print is performed by the equip-
ment with 128 MB (standard) memory.P. 5-113
4031 HDD full during print - Large quantity image data by private print or invalid network print are saved in HDD.
P. 5-113
4032 Private-print-only error: Jobs other than Private print jobs cannot be per-formed.
P. 5-113
4033 Printing data storing limitation error: Printing with its data being stored to the HDD temporarily (Proof print, Private print, Scheduled print, etc.) cannot be performed.
P. 5-113
4034 e-Filing storing limitation error: Printing with its data being stored to the HDD (print and e-Filing, print to e-Filing, etc.) cannot be performed.
P. 5-113
4035 Local file storing limitation error: Network FAX or Internet FAX cannot be sent when "Local" is selected for the destination of the file to save.
P. 5-113
4036 User authentication error: The user who intended to print a document is not registered as a user.
P. 5-113
A221 Print job cancellation - Print job (copy, list print, network print) is deleted from the print job screen.
P. 5-113
A222 Print job power failure - The power of the equipment is turned OFF during print job (copy, list print, network print).
P. 5-113
A290 Limit over error (Black): The numbers of output pages have exceeded those specified with both of the department code and the user code at the same time.
P. 5-113
A291 Limit over error (Black): The number of output pages has exceeded the one specified with the user code.
P. 5-113
A292 Limit over error (Black): The number of output pages has exceeded the one specified with the department code.
P. 5-113
A2A0 Limit over error (Color): The numbers of output pages have exceeded those specified with both of the department code and the user code at the same time.
P. 5-113
A2A1 Limit over error (Color): The number of output pages has exceeded the one specified with the user code.
P. 5-113
A2A2 Limit over error (Color): The number of output pages has exceeded the one specified with the department code.
P. 5-113
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 24
<<Error history>>In the setting mode (08-253), the latest twenty groups of error data will be displayed.Display exampleEA10 99999999 05 06 14 17 57 32 064 064 23621000000
Error code Total counter YY MM DD HH MM SS MMM NNN ABCDEFHIJLO
4 digits 8 digits 12 digits (Year is indicated with its last two digits.)
3 digits 3 digits 11 digits
A Paper source0: Not selected 1: Bypass feed 2: LCF 3: Upper drawer 4: Lower drawer 5: PFP upper drawer6: PFP lower drawer 7: Unused 8: Unused
B Paper size code0: A5/ST 1: A5-R 2: ST-R 3: LT, 4: A4 5: B5-R 6: LT-R 7: A4-R 8: OTHER/UNIV 9: B5,A: FOLIO/COMP B: LG C: B4 D: LD E: A3 F: 13"LG G: Unsed H: A6-R I: Post card J: 8.5"SQ K: A3-wide L: 305×457 mm M: 8K N: 16K-R O: 16K Z: Not selected
C Sort mode/staple mode0: Non-sort/Non-staple 1: Group 2: Sort 7: Front staple8: Double staple 9: Rear staple A: Saddle stitch
D ADF mode0: Unused 1: AUTO FEED (SADF) 2: STACK FEED
E APS/AMS mode0: Not selected 1: APS 2: AMS
F Duplex mode0: Not selected 1: Book 2: Double-sided/Single-sided 4: Double-sided/Duplex copying 8: Single-sided/Duplex copying
G UnusedH Image shift
0: Unused 1: Book 2: Left 4: RightI Editing
0: Unused 1: Masking 2: Trimming 3: Mirror image 4: UnusedJ Edge erase/Dual-page
0: Unused 1: Edge erase 2: Dual-page 3: Edge erase & Dual-pageK UnusedL Function
0: Unused 1: Copying 2: FAX/Internet FAX transmission 3: FAX/Internet FAX/E-mail reception printing4: Unused 5: Printing/List print 6: Scan/E-mail transmission
MMM Primary scanning reproduction ratio (Display in hexadecimal)(Mx256)+(Mx16)+M
NNN Secondary scanning reproduction ratio (Display in hexadecimal)(Nx256)+(Nx16)+N
O Color mode0: Auto color 1: Full color 2: Black 3: Unused 4: Twin color copy 5: Gray scale6: Unused 7: Image smoothing
06/08
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 25
2
2.2 Self-diagnosis Modes
Notes: 1. To enter the desired mode, turn ON the power while two digital keys designated to each mode
(e.g. [0] and [5]) are pressed simultaneously.2. When the optional FAX unit is installed, Faxes received automatically during the self-diagno-
sis mode may not be printed out. Be sure to disconnect the modular code from the line con-nectors (LINE1, LINE2) of the equipment before starting the self-diagnosis mode. Also, be sure to finish the self-diagnosis mode by turning the power OFF and back ON before connect-ing the modular code.
<Operation procedure>• Control panel check mode (01):
Notes: 1. A mode can be canceled by [POWER] OFF/ON when the LED is lit and the LCD is blinking.2. Button Check
Buttons with LED (Press to turn OFF the LED.)Buttons without LED (Press to display the message on the control panel.)Button on touch panel (Press to display the screen on the control panel at power-ON.)
• Test mode (03): Refer to “2.2.1. Input check (test mode 03)” and “2.2.2. Output check (test mode 03)”.
• Test print mode (04): Refer to “2.2.3. Test print mode (04)”.
• Adjustment mode (05): Refer to “2.2.4. Adjustment mode (05)”.
• Setting mode (08): Refer to “2.2.5. Setting mode (08)”.
Mode For start Contents For exit Display
Control panel check mode
[0]+[1]+[POWER]
All LEDs on the control panel are lit, and all the LCD pixels blink.
[POWER]OFF/ON
-
Test mode [0]+[3]+[POWER]
Checks the status of input/output signals. [POWER]OFF/ON
100% C A4 TEST MODE
Test print mode [0]+[4]+[POWER]
Outputs the test patterns. [POWER]OFF/ON
100% P A4 TEST PRINT
Adjustment mode
[0]+[5]+[POWER]
Adjusts various items. [POWER]OFF/ON
100% A A4 TEST MODE
Setting mode [0]+[8]+[POWER]
Sets various items. [POWER]OFF/ON
100% D TEST MODE
List print mode [9]+[START]+[POWER]
Prints out the data lists of the codes 05 and 08, PM support mode and pixel counter.
[POWER]OFF/ON
100% UA A4 LIST PRINT
PM support mode
[6]+[START]+[POWER]
Clears each counter. [POWER]OFF/ON
100% K TEST MODE
Firmware update mode
[8]+[9]+[POWER]
Performs updating of the system firmware. [POWER]OFF/ON
-
To exit from Adjustment mode and Setting mode:Shut down the equipment. When the power should be turned OFF, be sure to shut down the equip-ment by pressing the [ENERGY SAVER] button for a few seconds.
[0][1]
[POWER]
LED lit/
LCD blinking[START]
[START]
(Button check)
[POWER] OFF/ON
(Exit)
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 26
• List print mode (9S): The procedure varies depending on the code.
• PM support mode (6S):
• Firmware update mode (89): Refer to “6. FIRMWARE UPDATING”.
Fig. 2-1
*1 Turn OFF the power after using the self-diagnosis mode, and leave the equipment to the user.
[9][START]
[POWER] (Code)
101: Adjustment mode (05)
102: Setting mode (08)
(Code)
103: PM support mode
104: Stored information of pixel counter (toner cartridge reference)
105: Stored information of pixel counter (service technician reference)
106: Error history (Maximum 1000 items)
107: Error history (Latest 80 items)
[Digital keys]
Key in the first
code to be printed
[Digital keys]
Key in the last
code to be printed
[POWER]
OFF/ON
(Exit)
[START]
List starts to
be printed
[START] [START]
[6][START]
[POWER](Code)
2: PM Support Screen
[START]
(Operation started)
[POWER] OFF/ON
(Exit)
Warming upControl panelcheck mode
Test mode Test printmode
Adjustmentmode
Settingmode
List printmode
PM supportmode
Firmwareupdate mode
[POWER]ON
Normal
Ready
[POWER]OFF
To user
*1
[0][1] [0][3] [0][4] [0][5] [0][8] [9][START] [6][START] [8][9]
State transition diagram of self-diagnosis modes
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 27
2
2.2.1 Input check (Test mode 03)
<Operation procedure>
Note: Note: Initialization is performed before the equipment enters the test mode.
Fig. 2-2 Example of display during input check
Items to be checked and the condition of the equipment when the buttons [A] to [H] are highlighted are listed in the following pages.
The status of each input signal can be checked by pressing the [FAX] button, [COPY] button and the digital keys in the test mode (03).
[0][3]
[POWER][START]
[FAX]or
[COPY][Digital keys]
[CLEAR]
(LCD ON) [POWER] OFF/ON
(Exit)
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 28
[FAX] button: OFF/[COPY] button: OFF ([FAX] LED: OFF/[COPY] LED: OFF)
Digital key
Button Items to check
Contents
Highlighted display
e.g.
Normal display
e.g.
[1]
A Bypass unit connection Not connected Connected
B ADU connection Not connected Connected
C - - -
D LCF connection Not connected Connected
E - - -
F - - -
G - - -
H LCF drawer detection switch Drawer not installed Drawer present
[2]
A PFP upper drawer detection switch Drawer not installed Drawer present
B - - -
C PFP upper drawer paper stock sensor Paper almost empty Paper present
D PFP upper drawer feed sensor Paper present No paper
E PFP connection Not connected Connected
F PFP side cover open/close switch Cover opened Cover closed
G PFP upper drawer empty sensor No paper Paper present
H PFP upper drawer tray-up sensor Tray at upper limit position
Other than upper limit position
[3]
A LCF tray bottom sensor Tray at bottom posi-tion
Other than upper limit position
B LCF standby side paper misload detection sen-sor
Properly loaded Paper misload
C - - -
D - - -
E - - -
F - - -
G - - -
H Paper stock sensor at LCF feed side Paper present No paper
[4]
A PFP lower drawer detection switch Drawer not installed Drawer present
B - - -
C PFP lower drawer paper stock sensor Paper almost empty Paper present
D PFP lower drawer feed sensor Paper present No paper
E PFP motor rotation status (Motor is rotating at output mode (03))
Abnormal rotation Normal rotation
F - - -
G PFP lower drawer empty sensor No paper Paper present
H PFP lower drawer tray-up sensor Tray at upper limit position
Other than upper limit position
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 29
2
[5]
A LCF end fence home position sensor Fence home posi-tion
Other than home position
B LCF end fence stop position sensor Fence stop position Other than stop position
C Empty sensor at LCF standby side No paper Paper present
D LCF side cover open/close switch Cover closed Cover opened
E LCF motor rotation status (Motor is rotating at output mode (03))
Abnormal rotation Normal rotation
F LCF tray-up sensor Tray at upper limit position
Other than upper limit position
G LCF feed sensor No paper Paper present
H Empty sensor at LCF feed side No paper Paper present
[6]
A Lower drawer detection switch Drawer not installed Drawer present
B Upper drawer detection switch Drawer not installed Drawer present
C Lower drawer paper stock sensor Paper almost empty Paper present
D Upper drawer paper stock sensor Paper almost empty Paper present
E Lower drawer empty sensor No paper Paper present
F Upper drawer empty sensor No paper Paper present
G Lower drawer tray-up sensor Tray at upper limit position
Other than upper limit position
H Upper drawer tray-up sensor Tray at upper limit position
Other than upper limit position
[7]
A - - -
B - - -
C - - -
D - - -
E Side cover open/close switch Cover opened Cover closed
F Front cover opening/closing switch Cover opened Cover closed
G - - -
H Exit sensor Paper present No paper
[8]
A Bypass feed paper width sensor 3(Refer to table1)
Bit 1 Bit 0
B Bypass feed paper width sensor 2(Refer to table1)
Bit 1 Bit 0
C Bypass feed paper width sensor 1(Refer to table1)
Bit 1 Bit 0
D Bypass feed paper width sensor 0(Refer to table1)
Bit 1 Bit 0
E Bypass sensor No paper Paper present
F ADU opening/closing switch ADU opened ADU closed
G ADU exit sensor Paper present No paper
H ADU entrance sensor Paper present No paper
Digital key
Button Items to check
Contents
Highlighted display
e.g.
Normal display
e.g.
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 30
Table 1. Relation between the status of the bypass paper width sensor and paper size (width).
[9]
A - - -
B - - -
C - - -
D - - -
E - - -
F Key copy counter connection Not connected Connected
G - - -
H - - -
[0]
A - - -
B - - -
C - - -
D - - -
E - - -
F - - -
G - - -
H - - -
Bypass paper width sensorPaper width size
3 2 1 0
0 1 1 1 A3/LD
1 0 1 1 A4-R/LT-R
1 1 0 1 A5-R/ST-R
1 1 1 0 Card size
0 0 1 1 B4-R/LG
1 0 0 1 B5-R
Digital key
Button Items to check
Contents
Highlighted display
e.g.
Normal display
e.g.
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 31
2
[FAX] button: ON/[COPY] button: OFF ([FAX] LED: ON/[COPY] LED: OFF)
Digital key
Button Items to check
Contents
Highlighted display
e.g.
Normal display
e.g.
[1]
A 2nd transfer roller position detection sensor Released Contacted
B Black developer contact timing detection sensor Releasing move-ment
Contacting move-ment
C Black developer contact position detection sen-sor
Released position Contacted position
D Main motor rotation status(Motor is rotating at Output Mode (03))
Abnormal rotation Normal rotation
E Developer motor rotation status(Motor is rotating at Output Mode (03))
Abnormal rotation Normal rotation
F Transport motor rotation status(Motor is rotating at Output Mode (03))
Abnormal rotation Normal rotation
G Polygonal motor rotation status(Motor is rotating at Output Mode (03))
Abnormal rotation Normal rotation
H 24V Power supply Power OFF Power ON
[2]
A IPC board connection Not connected Connected
B Color toner cartridge sensor Normally Installation fault
C Revolver home position sensor Home position Other than home position
D - - -
E - - -
F Toner bag full detection sensor Toner bag full Not full
G Black auto-toner sensor connection Not connected Connected
H - - -
[3]
A - - -
B - - -
C - - -
D - - -
E - - -
F - - -
G Lower drawer feed sensor No paper Paper present
H Upper drawer feed sensor Paper present No paper
[4]
A - - -
B - - -
C - - -
D - - -
E Bridge unit connection Not connected Connected
F Color auto-toner sensor connection Not connected Connected
G - - -
H - - -
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 32
[5]
A - - -
B - - -
C - - -
D - - -
E - - -
F RADF connection RADF connected Not connected
G Platen sensor Platen cove opened Platen cover closed
H Carriage home position sensor Home position Other than home position
[6]
A - - -
B - - -
C - - -
D APS sensor (APS-R) No original Original present
E APS sensor (APS-C) No original Original present
F APS sensor (APS-3) No original Original present
G APS sensor (APS-2) No original Original present
H APS sensor (APS-1) No original Original present
[7]
A [RADF] Original tray sensor Original present No original
B [RADF] Original empty sensor Original present No original
C [RADF] Jam access cover sensor Cover opened Cover closed
D [RADF] RADF opening/closing sensor RADF opened RADF closed
E [RADF] Original exit/reverse sensor Original present No original
F [RADF] Original intermediate transport sensor Original present No original
G [RADF] Read sensor Original present No original
H [RADF] Original registration sensor Original present No original
[8]
A [RADF] Original tray width sensor (TWID0S) (Refer to table2)
OFF (H) ON (L)
B [RADF] Original tray width sensor (TWID1S) (Refer to table2)
OFF (H) ON (L)
C [RADF] Original tray width sensor (TWID2S) (Refer to table2)
OFF (H) ON (L)
D - - -
E [RADF] Original length detection sensor Original present No original
F [RADF] Original width detection sensor-1 Original present No original
G [RADF] Original width detection sensor-2 Original present No original
H - - -
[9]
A Black toner cartridge switch Cartridge not installed
Cartridge installed
B - - -
C - - -
D Bypass feed sensor No paper Paper present
E Registration sensor Paper present No paper
F - - -
G - - -
H Transfer belt home position sensor Home position Other than home position
Digital key
Button Items to check
Contents
Highlighted display
e.g.
Normal display
e.g.
08/04
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 33
2
Table 2. Relation between the status of the original tray width sensor and paper size (width).
H (= high level): Open L (= low level): Short
[0]
A Bridge unit transport sensor 2 Paper present No paper
B Bridge unit cover open/close detection switch Cover opened Cover closed
C Bridge unit transport sensor 1 Paper present No paper
D Bridge unit paper full detection sensor Paper not full Paper full
E - - -
F Charger cleaner front position detection switch Cleaner home posi-tion
Other than home position
G Charger cleaner rear position detection switch Cleaner rear posi-tion
Other than rear posi-tion
H - - -
Original tray width sensor Paper width size (LT series)
Paper width size (A4 series)TWID2S TWID1S TWID0S
H H H LD/LT A3/A4
H H L - B5-R
H L H ST-R A5-R
L H H LD/LT A3/A4
L H L - -
L L H 8.5" x 8.5" / LT-R / LG / 13" LG
A4-R/FOLIO
L L L COMPUTER B4/B5
Digital key
Button Items to check
Contents
Highlighted display
e.g.
Normal display
e.g.
08/04
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 34
[FAX] button: OFF/[COPY] button: ON ([FAX] LED: OFF/[COPY] LED: ON)
Digital key
Button Items to check
ContentsHighlighted display
e.g.
Normal display
e.g.
[1] - Temperature/humidity sensor (displays temper-ature inside of the equipment)
- Temperature [°C]
[2] - Temperature/humidity sensor (displays humidity inside of the equipment)
- Humidity [%RH]
[3]- Drum thermistor (displays drum surface temper-
ature)- Temperature [°C]
[4]
A - - -B - - -C - - -D - - -E - - -F - - -G - - -H - - -
[5]
A - - -B - - -C - - -D - - -E - - -F - - -G - - -H - - -
[6]
A - - -B - - -C - - -D - - -E - - -F - - -G - - -H - - -
[7]
A - - -B - - -C - - -D - - -E - - -F - - -G - - -H - - -
[8]
A - - -B - - -C - - -D - - -E - - -F - - -G - - -H - - -
05/11
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 35
2
*1• Be sure to install the USB storage device to the equipment and check if the device can be used with
this code.• Be sure to turn OFF the write protection (the function to prevent data from erasure by the accidental
recording or deleting) of the USB storage device before performing the check, otherwise this code cannot be used.
• It may take some time (2 sec. to 10 sec.) before this check is completed depending on the USB stor-age device.
[9]
A - - -B - - -C - - -D - - -E - - -F - - -G - - -H - - -
[0]
A - - -B - - -C - - -D Dongles for other equipments / Other USB
devicesConnectable Not connectable
E Judgement for acceptable USB storage device (*1)
Acceptable Not acceptable
F - - -G - - -H - - -
Digital key
Button Items to check
ContentsHighlighted display
e.g.
Normal display
e.g.
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 36
2.2.2 Output check (test mode 03)
<Operation procedure>
Procedure 1
Procedure 2
Procedure 3
Procedure 4
Status of the output signals can be checked by entering the following codes in the test mode 03.
Code Function Code Function Procedure
101 Main motor ON (Operational without black developer unit)
151 Code No.101 function OFF 1
102 Toner motor K (normal rotation) ON 152 Code No.102 function OFF 1
103 Polygonal motor (600dpi) ON 153 Code No.103 function OFF 1
108 Registration clutch ON 158 Code No.108 function OFF 1
109 PFP motor ON 159 Code No.109 function OFF 1
110 ADU motor ON 160 Code No.110 function OFF 1
112 Developer motor ON (Operational with black developer unit)
162 Code No.112 function OFF 1
115 Drum cleaning brush motor ON 165 Code No.115 function OFF 1
116 Transfer belt cleaner auger motor ON 166 Code No.116 function OFF 1
118 Laser ON 168 Code No.118 function OFF 1
120 Exit motor (normal rotation) ON 170 Code No.120 function OFF 1
121 Exit motor (reversal rotation) ON 171 Code No.121 function OFF 1
122 LCF motor ON 172 Code No.122 function OFF 1
123 Transport motor ON 173 Code No.123 function OFF 1
124 Toner motor K (reversal rotation) ON 174 Code No.124 function OFF 1
125 Color auto-toner sensor shutter sole-noid ON (open)
175 Code No.125 function OFF 1
126 Color auto-toner sensor LED ON 176 Code No.126 function OFF 1
[0][3]
[POWER][POWER] OFF/ON
(Exit)[START](Code)
OperationON
Stopcode
OperationOFF
[START]
[0][3]
[POWER][POWER] OFF/ON
(Exit)[START] [CLEAR]
OperationOne direction
Test modestandby
(Code)
[0][3]
[POWER]
[POWER]OFF/ON
(Exit)(Code) [START] [START]
OperationON
Test modestandby
[CLEAR]Operation
OFF
[0][3]
[POWER][POWER] OFF[START](Code)
06/08
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 37
2
Code Function Procedure
201 Upper drawer feed clutch ON/OFF 3
202 Lower drawer feed clutch ON/OFF 3
203 Lower transport clutch (high speed) ON/OFF 3
204 Bypass feed clutch ON/OFF 3
205 Lower transport clutch (low speed) ON/OFF 3
206 LCF pickup solenoid ON/OFF 3
207 LCF end fence reciprocating movement 2
208 LCF end fence motor ON/OFF 3
209 LCF feed clutch ON/OFF 3
210 LCF transport clutch ON/OFF 3
218 Key copy counter count up 2
225 PFP transport clutch ON/OFF 3
226 PFP upper drawer feed clutch ON/OFF 3
228 PFP lower drawer feed clutch ON/OFF 3
232 Bridge unit gate solenoid ON/OFF 3
235 Discharge LED ON/OFF 3
241 IH board cooling fan (low speed) ON/OFF 3
242 Upper drawer tray-up motor ON (tray up) 2
243 Lower drawer tray-up motor ON (tray up) 2
248 Developer bias (Black) [+DC] ON/OFF 3
249 Developer bias (Black) [-DC] ON/OFF 3
252 Main charger ON/OFF 3
261 Scan motor ON (Automatically stops at limit position, speed can be changed by using ZOOM button)
2
264 SLG board cooling fan / Scanner unit cooling fan ON (high/low speed) 1
265 SLG board cooling fan / Scanner unit cooling fan OFF 1
267 Scanner exposure lamp ON/OFF 3
268 Laser unit cooling fan (high speed) ON/OFF 3
271 LCF tray-up motor UP/DOWN 2
278 PFP upper drawer tray-up motor ON (tray up) 2
280 PFP lower drawer tray-up motor ON (tray up) 2
281 RADF original feed motor ON/OFF (normal rotation) 3
282 RADF original feed motor ON/OFF (reverse rotation) 3
283 RADF read motor ON/OFF 3
284 RADF original exit/reverse motor ON/OFF (normal rotation) 3
285 RADF original exit/reverse motor ON/OFF (reverse rotation) 3
294 RADF gate solenoid ON/OFF 3
295 Power OFF mode (for 200V series) 4
297 RADF fan motor ON/OFF 3
410 Power supply cooling fan (low speed) ON/OFF 3
411 Power supply cooling fan (high speed) ON/OFF 3
412 Internal cooling fan ON/OFF (low speed) 3
08/04
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 38
413 Internal cooling fan ON/OFF (high speed) 3
416 IH board cooling fan (high speed) ON/OFF 3
417 Ozone exhaust fan (low speed) ON/OFF 3
418 Ozone exhaust fan (high speed) ON/OFF 3
419 Developer bias (Black) [AC] ON/OFF 3
420 Developer bias (Color) [+DC] ON/OFF 3
421 Developer bias (Color) [-DC1] ON/OFF 3
422 Developer bias (Color) [AC] ON/OFF 3
424 1st transfer roller bias [+] ON/OFF 3
425 1st transfer roller bias [-] ON/OFF 3
426 2nd transfer roller bias [+] ON/OFF 3
427 2nd transfer roller bias [-] ON/OFF 3
428 Drum cleaning blade bias ON/OFF 3
430 Image quality sensor shutter solenoid ON/OFF 3
431 Color developer drive clutch ON/OFF 3
432 Black developer drive clutch ON/OFF 3
433 Black developer lifting clutch ON/OFF 3
435 2nd transfer roller contact clutch ON/OFF 3
437 Transfer belt cleaner clutch ON/OFF 3
439 Upper transport clutch (high speed) ON/OFF 3
440 Upper transport clutch (low speed) ON/OFF 3
442 Color developer toner supply clutch ON/OFF 3
450 Revolver motor ON/OFF (printing operation) 3
451 Revolver motor operation (at standby position) 2
452 Revolver motor operation (at toner cartridge Y access position) 2
453 Revolver motor operation (at toner cartridge M access position) 2
454 Revolver motor operation (at toner cartridge C access position) 2
455 Revolver motor operation (at developer unit Y access position) 2
456 Revolver motor operation (at developer unit M access position) 2
457 Revolver motor operation (at developer unit C access position) 2
458 Revolver motor operation (at home position) 2
459 Revolver motor operation (at developing position) 2
460 Black developer unit lifting movement ON/OFF (continuous lifting movement) 3
461 Charger cleaner motor movement (one reciprocating movement) 2
Code Function Procedure
06/08
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 39
2
2.2.3 Test print mode (test mode 04)
<Procedure 1>
<Procedure 2>
Notes: 1. When an error occurs, it is indicated on the panel, but the recovery operation is not per-
formed.Turn OFF the power and then back ON to clear the error.
2. During test printing, the [CLEAR] button is disabled when “Wait adding toner” is displayed.
The embedded test pattern can be printed out by keying in the following codes in the test print mode (04).
Code Types of test pattern Remarks Remarks
142 Grid pattern (black) Pattern width: 2 dots, Pitch: 10 mm 1
204 Grid pattern (color) Pattern width: 1 dot, Pitch: 10 mm 2
219 6% test pattern 2
220 8% test pattern 2
231 Secondary scanning direction 33 grada-tion steps
3 pixels standard, Width: 10 mm 2
237 Halftone 2
250 Test pattern for KCMY secondary scan-ning position adjustment
For color deviation check 1
262 Pattern for jitter evaluation (4 lines ON / 4 lines OFF)
1 pixel standard, for color deviation cor-rection
2
270 Image quality control test pattern For checking the image quality control 2
[0][4]
[POWER][POWER] OFF/ON
(Exit)(Code) [START] [CLEAR]Operation
ContinuousTest Printing
[0][4]
[POWER][POWER] OFF/ON
(Exit)(Code) [START] [START] [CLEAR]
[CLEAR]
OperationContinuousTest Printing
Colorselection
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 40
2.2.4 Adjustment mode (05)
Procedure 1
Procedure 2
Procedure 3
Procedure 4
Procedure 5
Items in the adjustment mode list in the following pages can be corrected or changed in this adjustment mode (05). Turn ON the power with pressing the digital keys [0] and [5] simultaneously in order to enter this mode.When the power should be turned OFF, be sure to shut down the equipment by pressing the [ENERGY SAVER] button for a few seconds.
[0][5]
[POWER]
[POWER]
OFF/ON
(Exit)
[Digital key]
(Code)[START]
[CANCEL]
[Digital key]
*[FUNCTION CLEAR]
(Key in a value)
[CLEAR]
(Corrects value)
[ENTER]
or
[INTERRUPT]
(Stores value in RAM)
[FAX]
[START]
(Test copy)
*Press [FUNCTION CLEAR] to enter minus (-).
([FAX] [START])(Test copy)
[0][5]
[POWER]
[POWER]
OFF/ON
(Exit)
[Digital key](Code)
[START][ENTER]
or[INTERRUPT]
(Value unchangeable)
Value
displayed( )
([FAX] [START])(Test copy)
[0][5]
[POWER]
[POWER]
OFF/ON
(Exit)
[Digital key]
(Code)[START]
[CANCEL]
[UP]or
[DOWN](Adjust a value)
[CLEAR](Corrects value)
[ENTER]or
[INTERRUPT](Stores value in RAM)
[0][5]
[POWER][Digital key]
(Code)[Digital key](Sub code)
[CLEAR](Corrects value)
[ENTER]or
[INTERRUPT]
*Press [FUNCTION CLEAR] to enter minus (-).
([FAX]
[START])
(Test copy)
[CANCEL]
[START]
[START]
[START] [Digital key]
*[FUNCTION CLEAR](Key in a value)
[CLEAR](Corrects value)
Stores valuein RAM
[POWER]OFF/ON
(Exit)
[0][5]
[POWER]
[CANCEL] or [CLEAR]
[Digital key](Code)
[START] Automaticadjustment
[UP]or
[DOWN]
(Adjust a value)
[ENTER]or
[INTERRUPT]
Stores valuein RAM
[FAX]
[START](Test copy)
[POWER]OFF/ON
(Exit)
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 41
2
Procedure 6
* When the automatic adjustment ends abnormally, an error message is displayed.* Return to standby screen by pressing the [CANCEL] or [CLEAR]
button.
Procedure 7
* When the automatic adjustment ends abnormally, an error message is displayed.* Return to standby screen by pressing the [CANCEL] or [CLEAR] button.
Procedure 10
Procedure 14
Note: Note: The fuser roller temperature control at the adjustment mode is different from that at the normal state.Therefore, the problem of fusing efficiency may be occurred in the test copy at the adjustment mode.In that case, turn ON the power normally, leave the equipment for approx. 3 minutes after it has become ready state and then start up the adjustment mode again.
[0][5]
[POWER]
[POWER]OFF/ON
(Exit)
[Digital key]
(Code)[START] [FAX] [COPY])
(Test copy)
*[CANCEL] or [CLEAR]
Automaticadjustment
[0][5]
[POWER]
[POWER]
OFF/ON
(Exit)
[Digital key]
(Code)[START]
Automatic
adjustment
[FAX]
[START](Test copy)*[CANCEL] or [CLEAR]
[CANCEL]
[ENTER]
Stores valuein RAM
[0][5]
[POWER]
[POWER]
OFF/ON
(Exit)
[Digital key]
(Code)
[Digital key]
(Sub code)[START] [START][START]
[ENTER] or [INTERRUPT]
(Value unchangeable)
Value
displayed
[0][5]
[POWER]
[POWER]
OFF/ON
(Exit)
[Digital key]
(Code)[START] [START][Digital key]
(Sub code)
[CANCEL](Corrects value)
[CLEAR]
(Corrects value)
[ENTER]
or
[INTERRUPT]
[FAX]
[START]
(Test copy)
[UP] or [DOWN]
(Adjust a value)
Stores value
in RAM
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 42
Test print pattern in Adjustment Mode (05)Operation:One test print is printed out when the [FAX] button is pressed after the code is keyed in at Standby Screen.
Code Types of test pattern Remarks
1 Grid pattern (Black) Refer to 3.4.3 Printer related adjustment
3 Grid pattern (Black/Duplex printing) Refer to 3.4.3 Printer related adjustment
4 For gamma adjustment (Color/Black integrated pattern)
Refer to 3.5.1 Automatic gamma adjustment
5 For gamma adjustment (Color) Refer to 3.5.1 Automatic gamma adjustment
6 For gamma adjustment (Black) For checking the gradation reproduction
7 For gamma adjustment (Color) For checking the gradation reproduction
10 For gamma adjustment (Black) Refer to 3.5.1 Automatic gamma adjustment
12 Secondary scanning direction 33 gradation steps (Y)
For checking the image of printer section
13 Secondary scanning direction 33 gradation steps (M)
For checking the image of printer section
14 Secondary scanning direction 33 gradation steps (C)
For checking the image of printer section
15 Secondary scanning direction 33 gradation steps (K)
For checking the image of printer section
47 Gamma adjustment for printer (PS/ 600 x 600 dpi)
Refer to 3.6.1 Automatic gamma adjustment
48 Gamma adjustment for printer (PS/ 1,200 x 600 dpi)
Refer to 3.6.1 Automatic gamma adjustment
49 Gamma adjustment for printer (PCL/ 600 x 600 dpi)
Refer to 3.6.1 Automatic gamma adjustment
50 Gamma adjustment for printer (PCL/ 1,200 x 600 dpi)
Refer to 3.6.1 Automatic gamma adjustment
51 Gamma checking for printer (PS/ 600 x 600 dpi) For checking the gradation reproduction
52 Gamma checking for printer (PS/ 1,200 x 600 dpi)
For checking the gradation reproduction
55 Grid pattern (Full Color / Thick paper 2) Refer to 3.4.2 Paper alignment at the registration roller
56 Grid pattern (Full Color / Thick paper 3) Refer to 3.4.2 Paper alignment at the registration roller
57 Grid pattern (Full Color / OHP) Refer to 3.4.2 Paper alignment at the registration roller
58 Grid pattern (Black / Thick paper 2) Refer to 3.4.2 Paper alignment at the registration roller
59 Grid pattern (Black / Thick paper 3) Refer to 3.4.2 Paper alignment at the registration roller
60 Grid pattern (Black / OHP) Refer to 3.4.2 Paper alignment at the registration roller
62 For color deviation correction (Full Color) Only for A3/LD size
63 For color deviation correction (Full Color) Only for A3/LD size
64 For color deviation correction (Full Color) Only for A3/LD size
68 For color deviation correction (Full Color) Only for A4/LT size
69 For color deviation correction (Full Color) Only for A4/LT size
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 43
2
Notes: 1. The digit after the hyphen in “Code” of the following table is a sub code.2. In “RAM”, the NVRAM of the board in which the data of each code is stored is indicated. “M”
stands for the LGC board and “SYS” stands for the SYS board.
Adjustment mode (05)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
200 Develop-ment
Automatic adjustment of auto-toner sensor
All(Y,M,C,K)
ALL -<0-255>
M The value starts chang-ing approx. 3 minutes after this adjustment started.The value is automati-cally set during this adjustment (approx. 2 minutes).(As the value increases, the sensor output increases correspond-ingly.) (Chap. 3.2)
5
201 Y ALL -<0-255>
M 5
202 M ALL -<0-255>
M 5
203 C ALL -<0-255>
M 5
204 K ALL -<0-255>
M 5
205 Standard setting value of K auto-toner initial adjust-ment
ALL 116<0-255>
M 3
206 Automatic adjustment of auto-toner sensor
YMC ALL -<0-255>
M The value starts chang-ing approx. 3 minutes after this adjustment started.The value is automati-cally set during this adjustment (approx. 2 minutes).(As the value increases, the sensor output increases correspond-ingly.) (Chap. 3.2)
5
207 Develop-ment
Initialization of color auto-toner sensor light amount correction target value
ALL(color)
- M Initializes the color auto-toner sensor light amount correction tar-get value.
6
208 Develop-ment
Enforced correction of color auto-toner sensor light amount
ALL(color)
- M Performs the color auto-toner sensor light amount correction forc-ibly.
6
210 Transfer 1st transfer roller bias out-put adjustment (When not transferred)
ALL 225<0-225>
M When the value decreases, the 1st transfer roller bias out-put increases.The adjustment value becomes effective when the Setting Mode (08- 541, 549 and 551) is 0 (invalid).
3
224 Transfer 2nd transfer roller bias out-put adjustment (When cleaning the roller [+] )
ALL 147<0-187>
M When the value decreases, the 2nd transfer roller bias out-put increases.
3
225 Transfer 2nd transfer roller bias out-put adjustment (When cleaning the roller [-] )
ALL 229<188-255>
M When the value decreases, the 2nd transfer roller bias out-put increases.
3
10/06
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 44
226 Transfer 2nd transfer roller bias out-put adjustment (Paper interval/When not trans-ferred)
ALL 191<188-255>
M When the value decreases, the 2nd transfer roller bias out-put increases.
3
227-0 Transfer 2nd transfer roller bias out-put adjust-ment(Plain paper)
Single side
ALL(black)
159<0-187>
M When the value decreases, the 2nd transfer roller bias out-put increases.The adjustment value becomes effective when the Setting Mode (08- 544, 549 and 551) is 0 (invalid).
14
227-1 Reverse side at duplexing
ALL(black)
134<0-187>
M 14
227-2 Single side
ALL(color)
147<0-187>
M 14
227-3 Reverse side at duplexing
ALL(color)
128<0-187>
M 14
229-0 Transfer 2nd transfer roller bias out-put adjust-ment(Thick paper 1)
Single side
ALL(black)
144<0-187>
M When the value decreases, the 2nd transfer roller bias out-put increases.The adjustment value becomes effective when the Setting Mode (08-544, 549 and 551) is 0 (invalid).
14
229-1 Reverse side at duplexing
ALL(black)
119<0-187>
M 14
229-2 Single side
ALL(color)
125<0-187>
M 14
229-3 Reverse side at duplexing
ALL(color)
112<0-187>
M 14
230-0 Transfer 2nd transfer roller bias out-put (Thick paper 2)
ALL(black)
153<0-187>
M When the value decreases, the 2nd transfer roller bias out-put increases.The adjustment value becomes effective when the Setting Mode (08- 544, 549 and 551) is 0 (invalid).
14
230-1 ALL(color)
150<0-187>
M 14
231-0 Transfer 2nd transfer roller bias out-put (Thick paper 3)
ALL(black)
131<0-187>
M When the value decreases, the 2nd transfer roller bias out-put increases.The adjustment value becomes effective when the Setting Mode (08- 544, 549 and 551) is 0 (invalid).
14
231-1 ALL(color)
131<0-187>
M 14
232-0 Transfer 2nd transfer roller bias out-put (OHP film)
ALL(black)
119<0-187>
M When the value decreases, the 2nd transfer roller bias out-put increases.The adjustment value becomes effective when the Setting Mode (08- 544, 549 and 551) is 0 (invalid).
14
232-1 ALL(color)
119<0-187>
M 14
Adjustment mode (05)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 45
2
234-0 Transfer 2nd transfer roller bias off-setting adjust-ment(Plain paper)
Single side
ALL(black)
5<0-10>
M Sets the offset amount of 2nd transfer roller bias.0: -500V 1: -400V2: -300V 3: -200V4: -100V 5: 0V6: +100V 7: +200V8: +300V 9: +400V10: +500V
4
234-1 Reverse side at duplexing
ALL(black)
5<0-10>
M 4
234-2 Single side
ALL(color)
5<0-10>
M 4
234-3 Reverse side at duplexing
ALL(color)
5<0-10>
M 4
236-0 Transfer 2nd transfer roller bias off-setting adjust-ment (Thick paper 1)
Single side
ALL(black)
5<0-10>
M Sets the offset amount of 2nd transfer roller bias.0: -500V 1: -400V2: -300V 3: -200V4: -100V 5: 0V6: +100V 7: +200V8: +300V 9: +400V10: +500V
4
236-1 Reverse side at duplexing
ALL(black)
5<0-10>
M 4
236-2 Single side
ALL(color)
5<0-10>
M 4
236-3 Reverse side at duplexing
ALL(color)
5<0-10>
M 4
237-0 Transfer 2nd transfer roller bias off-setting adjustment (Thick paper 2)
ALL(black)
5<0-10>
M Sets the offsetting amount of 2nd transfer roller bias.0: -1,000V 1: -800V2: -600V 3: -400 V4: -200V 5: 0 V6: +200V 7: +400V8: +600V 9: +800 V10: +1,000V
4
237-1 ALL(color)
5<0-10>
M 4
238-0 Transfer 2nd transfer roller bias off-setting adjustment(Thick paper 3)
ALL(black)
5<0-10>
M 4
238-1 ALL(color)
5<0-10>
M 4
239-0 Transfer 2nd transfer roller bias off-setting adjustment(OHP film)
ALL(black)
5<0-10>
M 4
239-1 ALL(color)
5<0-10>
M 4
241 Main charger
Main charger grid bias adjustment
Y ALL 78<0-255>
M As the value increases, the transformer output increases. The adjust-ment value becomes effective only when the setting mode (08-549, 551, 556, 557) is 0 (invalid).
3
242 M ALL 84<0-255>
M 3
243 C ALL 87<0-255>
M 3
244 K ALL 94<0-255>
M 3
245 Transfer 1st transfer roller bias off-setting
ALL(black)
5<0-10>
M Sets the offsetting amount of 1st transfer roller bias.0: -500 V 1: -400 V2: -300 V 3: -200 V4: -100 V 5: 0 V6: +100 V 7: +200 V8: +300 V 9: +400 V10: +500 V
1
247 Transfer Temperature/humidity sen-sor Humidity display
ALL 50<0-100>
M The humidity of the inside of the equipment is displayed.[Unit: RH%]
2
Adjustment mode (05)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 46
248 Transfer Drum thermistor Tempera-ture displa
ALL 23<0-100>
M The ambient tempera-ture of the drum surface is displayed.[Unit: °C]
2
250 Transfer 1st transfer roller bias out-put voltage
+Low ALL 4000<3600-4400>
M Transformer output set-ting of the 1st transfer roller bias.When replacing the high-voltage trans-former, the values listed in attached data sheet are entered.(Unit: V)
1
251 +High ALL 400<200-600>
M 1
252 Transfer 2nd transfer roller bias out-put voltage
+Low ALL 6000<5400-6600>
M Transformer output set-ting of the 2nd transfer roller bias (plus output).When replacing the high-voltage trans-former, the values listed in attached data sheet are entered.(Unit: V)
1
253 +High ALL 500<200-800>
M 1
254 Transfer 2nd transfer roller bias out-put voltage
-Low ALL -500<-9999-
0>
M Transformer output set-ting of the 2nd transfer roller bias (minus out-put).When replacing the high-voltage trans-former, the values listed in attached data sheet are entered.(Unit: V)
1
255 -High ALL -2000<-9999-
0>
M 1
270 Transfer Temperature/humidity sen-sor Temperature display
ALL 23<0-100>
M The temperature of the inside of the equipment is displayed.[Unit: °C]
2
275 Transfer 2nd transfer roller bias actual value (When clean-ing the roller)
(+) ALL 147<0-255>
M Displays the value of 2nd transfer roller bias when printing is oper-ated.
2
276 (-) ALL 229<0-255>
M 2
277-0 Transfer 2nd transfer roller bias actual value display (Plain paper)
Single side
ALL(black)
159<0-187>
M Displays the value of 2nd transfer roller bias when printing is oper-ated.
10
277-1 Reverse side at duplexing
ALL(black)
134<0-187>
M 10
277-2 Single side
ALL(color)
147<0-187>
M 10
277-3 Reverse side at duplexing
ALL(color)
128<0-187>
M 10
Adjustment mode (05)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
10/06
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 47
2
279-0 Transfer 2nd transfer roller bias actual value display (Thick paper 1)
Single side
ALL(black)
144<0-187>
M Displays the value of 2nd transfer roller bias when printing is oper-ated.
10
279-1 Reverse side at duplexing
ALL(black)
119<0-187>
M 10
279-2 Single side
ALL(color)
125<0-187>
M 10
279-3 Reverse side at duplexing
ALL(color)
112<0-187>
M 10
281 Transfer 1st transfer roller bias resistance detection con-trol
ALL -<0-255>
M The RMS value of the main charger grid bias is displayed..
2
284 Transfer Transfer belt cleaning unit contact timing adjustment
ALL 141<88-168>
M When the value increases, the contact timing of transfer belt cleaning unit is delayed.
1
285 Transfer Transfer belt cleaning unit release timing adjustment
ALL 121<88-168>
M When the value increases, the release timing of transfer belt cleaning unit is delayed.
1
290-0 Transfer 2nd transfer roller bias off-setting adjustment(Thick paper 2)
ALL(black)
153<0-187>
M Displays the value of 2nd transfer roller bias when printing is oper-ated.
10
290-1 ALL(color)
150<0-187>
M 10
291-0 Transfer 2nd transfer roller bias off-setting adjustment(Thick paper 3)
ALL(black)
131<0-187>
M Displays the value of 2nd transfer roller bias when printing is oper-ated.
10
291-1 ALL(color)
131<0-187>
M 10
292-0 Transfer 2nd transfer roller bias off-setting adjustment(OHP film)
ALL(black)
119<0-187>
M Displays the value of 2nd transfer roller bias when printing is oper-ated.
10
292-1 ALL(color)
119<0-187>
M 10
293-0 Transfer 2nd transfer roller bias cor-rection of leading/trail-ing edge of paper
Plain paper
ALL 85<0-255>
M Corrects the 2nd trans-fer roller bias output of leading/trailing edge of paper (05-227, 229, 230, 231 and 232).Correcting factor: %
14
293-1 Thick paper 1
ALL 75<0-255>
M 14
293-2 Thick paper 2
ALL 80<0-255>
M 14
293-3 Thick paper 3
ALL 80<0-255>
M 14
293-4 OHP film ALL 80<0-255>
M 14
Adjustment mode (05)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 48
294-0 Transfer Actual value display of 2nd transfer roller bias of lead-ing/trailing edge of paper (Plain paper)
Single side
ALL(black)
164<0-255>
M Displays the value of 2nd transfer roller bias on the leading/trailing edge of paper when printing is performed.(The value corrected in 05-293 is displayed.)
10
294-1 Reverse side at duplexing
ALL(black)
142<0-255>
M 10
294-2 Single side
ALL(color)
153<0-255>
M 10
294-3 Reverse side at duplexing
ALL(color)
137<0-255>
M 10
296-0 Transfer Actual value display of 2nd transfer roller bias of lead-ing/trailing edge of paper (Thick paper 1)
Single side
ALL(black)
155<0-255>
M 10
296-1 Reverse side at duplexing
ALL(black)
136<0-255>
M 10
296-2 Single side
ALL(color)
141<0-255>
M 10
296-3 Reverse side at duplexing
ALL(color)
131<0-255>
M 10
297-0 Transfer Actual value display of 2nd transfer roller bias of lead-ing/trailing edge of paper (Thick paper 2)
ALL(black)
160<0-255>
M 10
297-1 ALL(color)
158<0-255>
M 10
298-0 Transfer Actual value display of 2nd transfer roller bias of lead-ing/trailing edge of paper (Thick paper 3)
ALL(black)
142<0-255>
M 10
298-1 ALL(color)
143<0-255>
M 10
299-0 Transfer Actual value display of 2nd transfer roller bias of lead-ing/trailing edge of paper (OHP film)
ALL(black)
133<0-255>
M Displays the value of 2nd transfer roller bias on the leading/trailing edge of paper when printing is performed.(The value corrected in 05-293 is displayed.)
10
299-1 ALL(color)
133<0-255>
M 10
305 Scanner Image location adjustment of secondary scanning direction(scanner section)
ALL 124<92-164>
SYS When the value increases by “1”, the image shifts by approx. 0.137 mm toward the trailing edge of the paper.
1
306 Scanner Image location adjustment of secondary scanning direction(scanner section)
ALL 113<0-255>
SYS When the value increases by “1”, the image shifts by approx. 0.0423 mm toward the front side of the paper.
1
308 Scanner Distortion mode ALL - - Moves carriages to the adjusting position. (Chap. 3.4.4)
6
Adjustment mode (05)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
06/08
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 49
2
330-0 Image control
Image quality closed-loop control con-trast voltage correction/Mode 2 maxi-mum number of time cor-rected
Y ALL 3<0-255>
M Sets the maximum cor-rection number of time of the contrast voltage in the closed-loop con-trol mode 2.
4
330-1 M ALL 3<0-255>
M 4
330-2 C ALL 3<0-255>
M 4
330-3 K ALL 3<0-255>
M 4
331-0 Image control
Image quality closed-loop control laser power correc-tion/Mode 2 maximum number of time corrected
Y ALL 2<0-255>
M Sets the maximum cor-rection number of time of the laser power in the closed-loop control mode 2.
4
331-1 M ALL 2<0-255>
M 4
331-2 C ALL 2<0-255>
M 4
331-3 K ALL 2<0-255>
M 4
332-0 Image control
Image quality closed-loop control con-trast voltage correction/Mode 1 maxi-mum number of time cor-rected
Y ALL 1<0-255>
M Sets the maximum cor-rection number of time of the contrast voltage in the closed-loop con-trol mode 1.
4
332-1 M ALL 1<0-255>
M 4
332-2 C ALL 1<0-255>
M 4
332-3 K ALL 1<0-255>
M 4
333-0 Image control
Image quality closed-loop control laser power correc-tion/Mode 1 maximum number of time corrected
Y ALL 1<0-255>
M Sets the maximum cor-rection number of time of the laser power in the closed-loop control mode 1.
4
333-1 M ALL 1<0-255>
M 4
333-2 C ALL 1<0-255>
M 4
333-3 K ALL 1<0-255>
M 4
334 Image control
Main charger grid calibra-tion voltage 1 (low)
ALL 300<210-390>
M Transformer output cali-bration of the main charger grid bias. When replacing the high-volt-age transformer, the values listed in attached data sheet are entered. (Unit: V)
1
335 Image control
Main charger grid calibra-tion voltage 2 (high)
ALL 1000<900-1100>
M 1
338 Image control
Color developer bias DC (-) calibration voltage 1 (low)
ALL 100<70-130>
M Transformer output cali-bration of the color developer bias. When replacing the high-volt-age transformer, the values listed in attached data sheet are entered. (Unit: V)
1
339 Image control
Color developer bias DC (-) calibration voltage 2 (high)
ALL 900<810-990>
M 1
340 Scanner Reproduction ratio adjust-ment of secondary scan-ning direction (scanner section)
ALL 127<0-255>
SYS When the value increases by “1”, the reproduction ratio in the secondary scanning direction (vertical to paper feeding direc-tion) increases by approx. 0.223%.
1
Adjustment mode (05)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 50
350 Scanner Shading posi-tion adjust-ment
Original glass
ALL 128<118-138>
SYS 0.1369 mm/step 1
351 RADF ALL 128<118-138>
SYS 0.1369 mm/step 1
354 RADF Adjustment of RADF paper alignment
for single-sided orig-inal
ALL 10<0-20>
SYS When the value increases by “1”, the aligning amount increases by approx. 0.5 mm.
1
355 for double sided orig-inal
ALL 10<0-20>
SYS 1
357 RADF Fine adjustment of RADF transport speed
ALL 50<0-100>
SYS When the value increases by “1”, the reproduction ratio of the secondary scanning direction on original (fed from the RADF) increases by approx. 0.1%.
1
358 RADF RADF sideways deviation adjustment
ALL 128<0-255>
SYS When the value increases by “1”, the image of original fed from the RADF shifts toward the rear side of paper by approx. 0.0423 mm.
1
359 Scanner Carriage position adjust-ment during scanning from RADF
ALL(black)
128<0-255>
SYS When the value increases by “1”, the carriage position shifts by approx. 0.1 mm toward the exit side when using the RADF.
1
360 ALL(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 1
361 Scanner Log table switching for RADF copying
ALL(color)
0<0-4>
SYS 0: Same log table as the one used at copying with original glass
1: Background repro-duction - Light 2
2: Background repro-duction - Light 1
3: Background repro-duction - Dark 1
4: Background repro-duction - Dark 2
1
362 ALL(black)
0<0-4>
SYS 0: Same log table as the one used at copying with original glass
1: Background repro-duction - Light 2
2: Background repro-duction - Light 1
3: Background repro-duction - Dark 1
4: Background repro-duction - Dark 2
1
Adjustment mode (05)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 51
2
363 Scanner Data transfer of character-istic value of scanner / SYS board → SLG board
SCN - SYS Transfers the character-istic values of the scan-ner (shading correction factor / RGB color cor-rection / reproduction ratio color aberration correction) from the NVRAM of the SYS board to the NVRAM of the SLG board.
6
364 Scanner Data transfer of character-istic value of scanner / SLG board → SYS board
SCN - SYS Transfers the character-istic values of the scan-ner (shading correction factor / RGB color cor-rection / reproduction ratio color aberration correction) from the NVRAM of the SLG board to the NVRAM of the SYS board.
6
365 RADF RADF lead-ing edge posi-tion 1 adjustment
for single-sided orig-inal
ALL 50<0-100>
SYS When the value increases by “1”, the copied image of original fed from the RADF shifts toward the trail-ing edge of paper by approx. 0.1 mm.
1
366 for double sided orig-inal
ALL 50<0-100>
SYS 1
367 RADF RADF original guide width adjustment(Minimum)
ALL - - Stores the current width of RADF original guide by keying in this code with the guide set at the minimum width. Per-form this adjustment when the RADF board or volume is replaced, or when the code (05-356) is performed.
6
368 RADF RADF original guide width adjustment(Maximum)
ALL - - Stores the current width of RADF original guide by keying in this code with the guide set at the maximum width. Per-form this adjustment when the RADF board or volume is replaced, or when the code (05-356) is performed.
6
372 Image control
Black developer bias DC (-) calibration voltage 1 (low)
ALL 100<70-130>
M Transformer output cali-bration of the black developer bias. When replacing the high-volt-age transformer, the values listed in attached data sheet are entered. (Unit: V)
1
373 Image control
Black developer bias DC(-) calibration voltage 2 (high)
ALL 900<810-990>
M 1
Adjustment mode (05)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 52
380-0 Image control
Image quality open-loop control/ con-trast voltage initial value display
Y ALL 320<0-999>
M Displays the contrast voltage initial value set by the open-loop con-trol. (Unit: V)
10
380-1 M ALL 330<0-999>
M 10
380-2 C ALL 340<0-999>
M 10
380-3 K ALL 375<0-999>
M 10
381-0 Image control
Contrast volt-age actual value display
Y ALL 320<0-999>
M Displays the contrast voltage when printing is operated. (Unit: V)
10
381-1 M ALL 330<0-999>
M 10
381-2 C ALL 340<0-999>
M 10
381-3 K ALL 375<0-999>
M 10
382-0 Image control
Image quality open-loop control/ laser power initial value display
Y ALL 408<0-999>
M Displays the laser power initial value set by the open-loop con-trol. (Unit: µW)
10
382-1 M ALL 408<0-999>
M 10
382-2 C ALL 408<0-999>
M 10
382-3 K ALL 408<0-999>
M 10
383-0 Image control
Laser power actual value display
Y ALL 92<0-255>
M Displays the laser power when printing is operated. (bit value)
10
383-1 M ALL 92<0-255>
M 10
383-2 C ALL 92<0-255>
M 10
383-3 K ALL 92<0-255>
M 10
384-0 Image control
Laser power actual value display
Y ALL 408<0-999>
M Displays the laser power when printing is operated. (Unit: µW)
10
384-1 M ALL 408<0-999>
M 10
384-2 C ALL 408<0-999>
M 10
384-3 K ALL 408<0-999>
M 10
385-0 Image control
Main charger grid bias actual value display
Y ALL 78<0-255>
M Displays the main charger grid bias when printing is operated. (bit value)
10
385-1 M ALL 84<0-255>
M 10
385-2 C ALL 87<0-255>
M 10
385-3 K ALL 94<0-255>
M 10
Adjustment mode (05)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 53
2
386-0 Image control
Developer bias DC (-) actual value display
Y ALL 135<0-255>
M Displays the developer bias when printing is operated. (bit value)
10
386-1 M ALL 137<0-255>
M 10
386-2 C ALL 139<0-255>
M 10
386-3 K ALL 146<0-255>
M 10
388 Image control
Output value display of image quality sensor
When the light source is OFF
ALL 0<0-1023>
M Displays the output value of image quality sensor when the sensor light source is OFF.
2
389 Transfer belt sur-face
ALL 0<0-1023>
M Displays the output value of image quality sensor (when there is no test pattern) on the transfer belt.
2
390-0 Highden-sity pat-tern Y
ALL 0<0-1023>
M Displays the output value of image quality sensor when a high-density test pattern is written.The larger the value is, the smaller the toner amount adhered becomes.
10
390-1 Highden-sity pat-tern M
ALL 0<0-1023>
M 10
390-2 Highden-sity pat-tern C
ALL 0<0-1023>
M 10
390-3 Highden-sity pat-tern K
ALL 0<0-1023>
M 10
391-0 Image control
Output value display of image quality sensor
Lowden-sity pat-tern Y
ALL 0<0-1023>
M Displays the output value of image quality sensor when a low-den-sity test pattern is writ-ten.The larger the value is, the smaller the toner amount adhered becomes.
10
391-1 Lowden-sity pat-tern M
ALL 0<0-1023>
M 10
391-2 Lowden-sity pat-tern C
ALL 0<0-1023>
M 10
391-3 Lowden-sity pat-tern K
ALL 0<0-1023>
M 10
392 Image control
Light amount adjustment result of image quality sen-sor
ALL 0<0-255>
M The LED light amount adjustment value of this sensor is the reference value to set the reflected light from the belt surface.
2
393 Image control
Relative humidity display during latest closed-loop control
ALL 0<0-100>
M Displays the relative humidity at the latest performing of the closed-loopcontrol.
2
394 Image control
Enforced performing of image quality open-loop control
ALL - - Performs the image quality open-loop con-trol.
6
Adjustment mode (05)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
06/10
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 54
395 Image control
Enforced performing of image quality closed-loop control
ALL - M Performs the image quality closedloop con-trol.
6
396 Image control
Image quality control initial-ization
ALL - M Performs the image quality control, initialize each control value.
6
398-0 Image control
Target value of the high image den-sity control
Y ALL 265<220-360>
M Sets the target value of high image density con-trol at the time of the image quality control.
4
398-1 M ALL 300<220-360>
M 4
398-2 C ALL 320<220-360>
M 4
398-3 K ALL 370<300-420>
M 4
401 Laser Fine adjustment of polygo-nal motor rotation speed (reproduction ratio adjust-ment)
PRT 134<0-255>
M When the value increases by “1”, the reproduction ratio of pri-mary scanning direction increases by approx. 0.07%. (approx. 0.1 mm/step)
1
405 PPC 135<0-255>
M 1
410 Laser Adjustment of primary scanning laser writing start position
PPC 128<0-255>
M When the value increases by “1”, the writing start position shifts to the front side by approx. 0.0423 mm.
1
411 PRT 120<0-255>
M 1
417-0 Image Color devia-tion correc-tion 1(A3/LD)
K ALL 128<118-138>
M When the value increases by “1”, the image shifts toward the trailing edge of the paper by 0.0423 mm.
4
417-1 C ALL 128<118-138>
M 4
417-2 M ALL 128<118-138>
M 4
417-3 Y ALL 128<118-138>
M 4
418-0 Image Color devia-tion correc-tion 2(A3/LD)
K ALL 128<118-138>
M When the value increases by “1”, the image shifts toward the trailing edge of the paper by 0.0423 mm.
4
418-1 C ALL 128<118-138>
M 4
418-2 M ALL 128<118-138>
M 4
418-3 Y ALL 128<118-138>
M 4
Adjustment mode (05)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 55
2
421 Drive Adjustment of secondary scanning direction repro-duction ratio (fine adjust-ment of main motor speed)
PPC/PRT
127<0-255>
M When the value increases by “1”, the reproduction ratio of secondary scanning direction increases by approx. 0.04%.
1
422 FAX 144<0-255>
M 1
424 Drive Fine adjustment of exit motor speed
PPC/PRT
JPN: 140Others:
128<0-255>
M When the value increases by “1”, the rotation becomes faster by approx.0.05%.
1
425 FAX 128<0-255>
M 1
426 Drive Adjustment of secondary scanning direction repro-duction ratio (fine adjust-ment of transport motor speed)
PPC/PRT
153<0-255>
M When the value increases by “1”, the reproduction ratio of secondary scanning direction increases by approx. 0.04%.
1
427 FAX 128<0-255>
M 1
430 Image Top margin adjustment (blank area at the leading edge of the paper))
PPC 26<0-255>
M When the value increases by “1”, the blank area becomes wider by approx.0.0423 mm.
1
431 Image Left margin adjustment (blank area at the left of the paper along the paper feeding direction)
PPC 0<0-255>
M 1
432 Image Right margin adjustment (blank area at the right of the paper along the paper feeding direction)
PPC 15<0-255>
M 1
433 Image Bottom margin adjustment (blank area at the trailing edge of the paper)
PPC 43<0-255>
M 1
434-0 Image Bottom margin adjustment (blank area at the trailing edge of the paper)/Reverse side at duplexing
PPC/PRT
EUR: 45UC: 28JPN: 28Others:
45<0-255>
M 4
434-1 Image Right margin adjustment (blank area at the right of the paper along the paper feeding direction)/Reverse side at duplexing
PPC/PRT
18<0-255>
M 4
435 Image Top margin adjustment (blank area at the leading edge of the paper)
PRT 24<0-255>
M 1
436 Image Left margin adjustment (blank area at the left of the paper along the paper feeding direction)
PRT 0<0-255>
M When the value increases by “1”, the blank area becomes wider by approx.0.0423 mm.
1
437 Image Right margin adjustment (blank area at the right of the paper along the paper feeding direction)
PRT 0<0-255>
M 1
438 Image Bottom margin adjustment (blank area at the trailing edge of the paper)
PRT 0<0-255>
M 1
Adjustment mode (05)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 56
439 Image Bottom margin adjustment (blank area at the trailing edge of the paper along the paper feeding direc-tion) when paper size is not specified at bypass feed
ALL 128<0-255>
M When the value increases by “1”, the margin increases by approx. 0.2 mm.
1
440 Laser Secondary scanning laser writing start position
Upper drawer
ALL 21<0-40>
M When the value increases by “1”, the image shifts toward the trailing edge of the paper by approx. 0.2 mm.
1
441 Lower drawer
ALL 47<0-80>
M 1
442 Bypass feeding
ALL 22<0-40>
M 1
443 LCF ALL 20<0-40>
M 1
444 PFP ALL 20<0-40>
M 1
445 Duplex feeding
ALL 21<0-40>
M 1
448-0 Paper feeding
Paper aligning amount adjustment at the registra-tion section (PFP upper drawer / Plain paper)
Longsize
ALL 15<0-63>
M When the value increases by “1”, the aligning amount increases by approx.0.8 mm.<Paper length>Long size: 330 mm or longerMiddle size: 220 mm to 329 mmShort size 1: 205 mm to 219 mmShort size 2: 204 mm or shorter
4
448-1 Middle size
ALL 15<0-63>
M 4
448-2 Shortsize 1
ALL 15<0-63>
M 4
448-3 Shortsize 2
ALL 15<0-63>
M 4
449-0 Paper feeding
Paper aligning amount adjustment at the registra-tion section (PFP lower drawer / Plain paper)
Longsize
ALL 15<0-63>
M 4
449-1 Middle size
ALL 15<0-63>
M 4
449-2 Shortsize 1
ALL 15<0-63>
M 4
449-3 Shortsize 2
ALL 15<0-63>
M 4
450-0 Paper feeding
Paper aligning amount adjustment at the registra-tion section (Upper drawer / Plain paper)
Longsize
ALL 18<0-63>
M 4
450-1 Middle size
ALL 18<0-63>
M 4
450-2 Shortsize 1
ALL 18<0-63>
M 4
450-3 Shortsize 2
ALL 18<0-63>
M 4
452-0 Paper feeding
Paper aligning amount adjustment at the registra-tion section (Lower drawer / Plain paper)
Longsize
ALL 18<0-63>
M When the value increases by “1”, the aligning amount increases by approx.0.8 mm.<Paper length>Long size: 330 mm or longerMiddle size: 220 mm to 329 mmShort size 1: 205 mm to 219 mmShort size 2: 204 mm or shorter
4
452-1 Middle size
ALL 18<0-63>
M 4
452-2 Shortsize 1
ALL 15<0-63>
M 4
452-3 Shortsize 2
ALL 15<0-63>
M 4
Adjustment mode (05)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 57
2
455-0 Paper feeding
Paper aligning amount adjustment at the registra-tion section (Duplex feed-ing / Plainpaper)
Longsize
ALL 8<0-63>
M When the value increases by “1”, the aligning amount increases by approx.0.8 mm.<Paper length>Long size:330 mm or longerMiddle size:220 mm to 329 mmShort size:219 mm or shorter* Postcard is sup-
ported only for JPN model.
4
455-1 Middle size
ALL 8<0-63>
M 4
455-2 Shortsize
ALL 12<0-63>
M 4
457 Paper feeding
Paper aligning amount adjustment at the registra-tion section (LCF / Plain paper)
ALL 15<0-63>
M 1
458-0 Paper feeding
Paper aligning amount adjustment at the registra-tion section (Bypass feed-ing/Plainpaper)
Longsize
ALL 14<0-63>
M 4
458-1 Middle size
ALL 14<0-63>
M 4
458-2 Shortsize
ALL 14<0-63>
M 4
460-0 Paper feeding
Paper aligning amount adjustment at the registra-tion section (Bypass feed-ing/Thickpaper 1)
Longsize
ALL 16<0-63>
M 4
460-1 Middle size
ALL 16<0-63>
M 4
460-2 Shortsize
ALL 16<0-63>
M 4
461-0 Paper feeding
Paper aligning amount adjustment at the registra-tion section (Bypass feed-ing/Thickpaper 2)
Longsize
ALL 17<0-63>
M 4
461-1 Middle size
ALL 17<0-63>
M 4
461-2 Shortsize
ALL 17<0-63>
M 4
462-0 Paper feeding
Paper aligning amount adjustment at the registra-tion section (Bypass feed-ing/Thickpaper 3)
Longsize
ALL 17<0-63>
M 4
462-1 Middle size
ALL 17<0-63>
M 4
462-2 Shortsize
ALL 17<0-63>
M 4
462-3 Postcard
ALL 16<0-63>
M 4
463-0 Paper feeding
Paper aligning amount adjustment at the registra-tion section (Bypass feed-ing/OHP film)
Longsize
ALL 16<0-63>
M 4
463-1 Middle size
ALL 16<0-63>
M 4
463-2 Shortsize
ALL 16<0-63>
M 4
Adjustment mode (05)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 58
466-0 Paper feeding
Adjustment of paper push-ing amount / Bypass feed-ing
Plainpaper
ALL 143<0-255>
M When the value increases by “1”, the driving speed of bypass feed roller increases by approx. 2 ms when the paper transport is started from the regis-tration section.* Post card is sup-
ported only for JPN model.
4
466-1 Post card ALL 170<0-255>
M 4
466-4 Thickpaper 1
ALL 143<0-255>
M 4
466-5 Thickpaper 2
ALL 143<0-255>
M 4
466-6 Thickpaper 3
ALL 143<0-255>
M 4
466-7 OHP film ALL 143<0-255>
M 4
467 Paper feeding
Adjustment of paper push-ing amount/Duplex feed-ing (short size)
ALL 128<0-255>
M When the value increases by “1”, the driving speed of ADU transport roller increases by approx. 2 ms when the paper transport is started from the registration section.
1
468-0 Finisher Fine adjust-ment of bind-ing position/folding posi-tion
A4-R/LT-R
ALL 0<-14-14>
M When the value increases by “1”, the binding/folding position shifts toward the right page by 0.25 mm.
4
468-1 B4 ALL 0<-14-14>
M 4
468-2 A3/LD ALL 0<-14-14>
M 4
469-0 Paper feeding
Paper aligning amount adjustment at the registra-tion section (Upper drawer / Thick paper 1)
Longsize
ALL 18<0-63>
M When the value increases by "1", the aligning amount increases by approx.0.8 mm.<Paper length>Long size: 330 mm or longerMiddle size: 220 mm to 329 mmShort size 1: 205 mm to 219 mmShort size 2: 204 mm or shorter
4
469-1 Middle size
ALL 18<0-63>
M 4
469-2 Shortsize 1
ALL 18<0-63>
M 4
469-3 Shortsize 2
ALL 18<0-63>
M 4
470-0 Paper feeding
Paper aligning amount adjustment at the registra-tion section (Lower drawer / Thickpaper 1)
Longsize
ALL 15<0-63>
M 4
470-1 Middle size
ALL 15<0-63>
M 4
470-2 Shortsize 1
ALL 15<0-63>
M 4
470-3 Shortsize 2
ALL 15<0-63>
M 4
471-0 Paper feeding
Paper aligning amount adjustment at the registra-tion section (PFP upper drawer / Thick paper 1)
Longsize
ALL 15<0-63>
M 4
471-1 Middle size
ALL 15<0-63>
M 4
471-2 Shortsize 1
ALL 15<0-63>
M 4
471-3 Shortsize 2
ALL 15<0-63>
M 4
Adjustment mode (05)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 59
2
472-0 Paper feeding
Paper aligning amount adjustment at the registra-tion section (PFP lower drawer / Thick paper 1)
Longsize
ALL 15<0-63>
M When the value increases by "1", the aligning amount increases by approx.0.8 mm.<Paper length>Long size: 330 mm or longerMiddle size: 220 mm to 329 mmShort size: 219 mm or shorterShort size 1: 205 mm to 219 mmShort size 2: 204 mm or shorter* Post card is sup-
ported only for JPN model.
4
472-1 Middle size
ALL 15<0-63>
M 4
472-2 Shortsize 1
ALL 15<0-63>
M 4
472-3 Shortsize 2
ALL 15<0-63>
M 4
473 Paper feeding
Paper aligning amount adjustment at the registra-tion section (LCF / Thick paper 1)
ALL 15<0-63>
M 1
474-0 Paper feeding
Paper aligning amount adjustment at the registra-tion section (ADU / Thick paper 1)
Longsize
ALL 8<0-63>
M 4
474-1 Middle size
ALL 8<0-63>
M 4
474-2 Shortsize
ALL 12<0-63>
M 4
475-0 Paper feeding
Paper aligning amount adjustment at the registra-tion section (Bypass feed-ing)
Thick paper 2 Long size
ALL 28<0-63>
M 4
475-1 Thick paper 2 Middle size
ALL 28<0-63>
M 4
475-2 Thick paper 2 Short size
ALL 28<0-63>
M 4
475-3 Thick paper 3 Long size
ALL 28<0-63>
M 4
475-4 Thick paper 3 Middle size
ALL 28<0-63>
M 4
475-5 Thick paper 3 Short size
ALL 28<0-63>
M 4
475-6 OHP filmLong size
ALL 24<0-63>
M 4
475-7 OHP filmMiddle size
ALL 24<0-63>
M 4
475-8 OHP filmShort size
ALL 24<0-63>
M 4
475-9 Post card ALL 28<0-63>
M 4
Adjustment mode (05)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
06/10
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 60
494 Laser Secondary scanning data laser writing start position
When decelerat-ing to 1/2
ALL 135<0-255>
M When the value increases by “1”, the image shifts by approx. 0.2 mm toward the trailing edge of the paper.
1
495 When decelerat-ing to 1/3
ALL 135<0-255>
M 1
496 When decelerat-ing to 1/4
ALL 140<0-255>
M 1
497-0 Laser Adjustment of drawer side-ways devia-tion
Upper drawer
ALL 128<0-255>
M When the value increases by “1”, the image shifts toward the front side by 0.0423 mm.
4
497-1 Lower drawer
ALL 128<0-255>
M 4
497-2 PFP upper drawer
ALL 128<0-255>
M 4
497-3 PFP lower drawer
ALL 128<0-255>
M 4
497-4 LCF ALL 128<0-255>
M 4
497-5 Bypass feeding
ALL 128<0-255>
M 4
498-0 Laser Adjustment of duplex feed-ing sideways deviation
Long size ALL 131<0-255>
M When the value increases by “1”, the image shifts toward the front side by 0.0423 mm.
4
498-1 Short size(A4/LT or smaller)
ALL 131<0-255>
M 4
499 Develop-ment
Black developer unit lift up/down timing adjustment
ALL 2<0-255>
M Change the lift up/down timing of the black developer unit when a CEB0 error occurs.(Chap. 3.11.3)
1
501 Image Density adjustmentFine adjust-ment of “man-ual density”/Center value
Photo PPC(black)
128<0-255>
SYS When the value increases, the image of the center step density becomes darker.
1
503 Text/Photo PPC(black)
128<0-255>
SYS 1
504 Text PPC(black)
128<0-255>
SYS 1
505 Image Density adjustmentFine adjust-ment of “man-ual density”/Light step value
Text/Photo PPC(black)
20<0-255>
SYS Sets the changing amount by 1 step at the density adjustment.When the value increases, the image of the “light” steps becomes lighter.
1
506 Photo PPC(black)
20<0-255>
SYS 1
507 Text PPC(black)
20<0-255>
SYS 1
508 Image Density adjustmentFine adjust-ment of “man-ual density”/Dark step value
Text/Photo PPC(black)
20<0-255>
SYS Sets the changing amount by 1 step at the density adjustment.When the value increases, the image of the “dark” steps becomes darker.
1
509 Photo PPC(black)
20<0-255>
SYS 1
510 Text PPC(black)
20<0-255>
SYS 1
Adjustment mode (05)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 61
2
512 Image Density adjustmentFine adjust-ment of “auto-matic density”
Photo PPC(black)
128<0-255>
SYS When the value increases, the image becomes darker.
1
514 Text/Photo PPC(black)
128<0-255>
SYS 1
515 Text PPC(black)
128<0-255>
SYS 1
532 Image Range correc-tion Back-ground peak adjustment
Text/Photo PPC(black)
40<0-255>
SYS When the value increases, the back-ground of the image (low density area) becomes harder to be printed out.
1
533 Photo PPC(black)
16<0-255>
SYS 1
534 Text PPC(black)
40<0-255>
SYS 1
570 Image Range correc-tion on origi-nal manually set on the original glass
Text/Photo PPC(black)
22<11-14, 21-24, 31-34, 41-44>
SYS Sets whether the values of the background peak and text peak are fixed or not. One’s place is an adjustment for “auto-matic density” and ten’s place is for “manual density”. Once they are fixed, the range correc-tion is performed with standard values. The values of the back-ground peak and text peak affect the repro-duction of the back-ground density and text density respectively.
1: fixed/fixed2: varied/fixed3: fixed/varied4: varied/varied* Background peak/
Text peak
1
571 Photo PPC(black)
12<11-14, 21-24, 31-34, 41-44>
SYS 1
572 Text PPC(black)
22<11-14, 21-24, 31-34, 41-44>
SYS 1
580 Image Automatic gamma adjust-ment
PPC(black)
- - Adjusts the gradation reproduction automati-cally.
7
Adjustment mode (05)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 62
590-0 Image Adjustment of gamma bal-ance (Text/Photo)
L PPC(black)
128<0-255>
SYS When the value increases, the density in the target area becomes higher.L : Low density areaM : Medium density areaH : High density area
4
590-1 M PPC(black)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
590-2 H PPC(black)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
591-0 Image Adjustment of gamma bal-ance (Text)
L PPC(black)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
591-1 M PPC(black)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
591-2 H PPC(black)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
592-0 Image Adjustment of gamma bal-ance (Photo)
L PPC(black)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
592-1 M PPC(black)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
592-2 H PPC(black)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
596-0 Image Adjustment of gamma bal-ance (PS/Smooth)
L PRT(black)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
596-1 M PRT(black)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
596-2 H PRT(black)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
597-0 Image Adjustment of gamma bal-ance (PS/Detail)
L PRT(black)
128<0-255>
SYS When the value increases, the density in the target area becomes higher.L: Low density areaM: Medium density
areaH : High density area
4
597-1 M PRT(black)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
597-2 H PRT(black)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
598-0 Image Adjustment of gamma bal-ance (PCL/Smooth)
L PRT(black)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
598-1 M PRT(black)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
598-2 H PRT(black)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
599-0 Image Adjustment of gamma bal-ance (PCL/Detail)
L PRT(black)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
599-1 M PRT(black)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
599-2 H PRT(black)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
600 Image Background adjustment
Text/Photo PPC(black)
5<1-9>
SYS When the value decreases, the back-ground becomes darker. When the value increases, the back-ground becomes lighter.
1
601 Text PPC(black)
5<1-9>
SYS 1
602 Photo PPC(black)
5<1-9>
SYS 1
Adjustment mode (05)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 63
2
604 Image Sharpness adjustment
Text/Photo PPC(black)
0<0-31>
SYS When the value increases, the image becomes sharper. When the value decreases, the image becomes softer.The smaller the value is, the less the moire becomes.* The default value 0
is equivalent to 16 (center value).
1
605 Text PPC(black)
0<0-31>
SYS 1
606 Photo PPC(black)
0<0-31>
SYS 1
648 Image Adjustment of smudged/faint text
Text/Photo PPC(black)
30<0-255>
SYS Adjustment of the smudged/faint text.With increasing the value, the faint text is suppressed, and with decreasing it, the smudged text is sup-pressed.
1
654 Image Adjustment of smudged/faint text
PS PRT(black)
5<0-9>
SYS When the value decreases, the width of text becomes wider.
1
655 PCL PRT(black)
5<0-9>
SYS 1
663 Image Dot size adjustment in black printing
PRT(black)
255<0-255>
SYS Adjusts the dot size of primary scanning direc-tion in black printing.The smaller the value is, the dot becomes smaller.
1
664 Image Upper limit in toner saving mode
PS PRT(black)
176<0-255>
SYS When the value decreases, the printing density becomes lighter.
1
665 PCL PRT(black)
176<0-255>
SYS 1
667-0 Image Setting beam level conver-sion
Beamlevel 0/4
PPC(black)
0<0-255>
M Sets the beam level for 4 divided smoothing. The primary scanning direction is divided into 4 and the dot width is set at the 5 levels (incl. level “0”). The smaller the value is, the smaller the primary scanning direction of the dot becomes.
4
667-1 Beamlevel 1/4
PPC(black)
63<0-255>
M 4
667-2 Beamlevel 2/4
PPC(black)
127<0-255>
M 4
667-3 Beamlevel 3/4
PPC(black)
191<0-255>
M 4
667-4 Beamlevel 4/4
PPC(black)
255<0-255>
M 4
Adjustment mode (05)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 64
693 Image Range correc-tion on origi-nal set on the RADF
Text/Photo PPC(black)
22<11-14, 21-24,31-34,41-44>
SYS Sets whether the values of the background peak and text peak are fixed or not. One’s place is an adjustment for “auto-matic density” and ten’s place is for “manual density”. Once they are fixed, the range correc-tion is performed with standard values.The values of the back-ground peak and text peak affect the repro-duction of the back-ground density and text density respectively.1: fixed/fixed2: varied/fixed3: fixed/varied4: varied/varied* Background peak/
Text peak
1
694 Photo PPC(black)
12<11-14, 21-24, 31-34, 41-44>
SYS 1
695 Text PPC(black)
22<11-14, 21-24, 31-34, 41-44>
SYS 1
700 Image Adjustment of binarized threshold (Text)
Center value
FAX(black)
125<0-255>
SYS When the value increases, the image of center value density becomes darker.
1
701 Light step value
FAX(black)
20<0-255>
SYS Sets the changing amount by 1 step at the density adjustment.When the value increases, the image of “light” side becomes lighter.
1
702 Dark step value
FAX(black)
20<0-255>
SYS Sets the changing amount by 1 step at the density adjustment.
1
710 Image Density adjustment “manual den-sity” fine adjustment/Center value
Photo FAX(black)
128<0-255>
SYS When the value increases, the image of the center step density becomes darker.
1
714 Text/Photo FAX(black)
128<0-255>
SYS 1
715 Image Density adjustment “manual den-sity” fine adjustment/Light step value
Photo FAX(black)
20<0-255>
SYS Sets the changing amount by 1 step at the density adjustment.When the value increases, the image of the “light” steps becomes lighter.
1
719 Text/Photo FAX(black)
20<0-255>
SYS 1
720 Image Density adjustment “manual den-sity” fine adjustment/Dark step value
Photo FAX (black)
20 <0-255>
SYS Sets the changing amount by 1 step at the density adjustment.When the value increases, the image of the “dark” steps becomes darker.
1
724 Text/Photo FAX (black)
20 <0-255>
SYS 1
Adjustment mode (05)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 65
2
725 Image Density adjustment “automatic density” fine adjustment
Photo FAX (black)
128 <0-255>
SYS When the value increases, the image becomes darker.
1
729 Text/Photo FAX (black)
128 <0-255>
SYS 1
825 Image Range correc-tion on origi-nal manually set on the original glass
Text/Photo SCN (black)
12<11-14,21-24,31-34,41-44>
SYS Sets whether the values of the background peak and text peak are fixed or not. One’s place is an adjustment for “auto-matic density” and ten’s place is for “manual density”. Once they are fixed, the range correc-tion is performed with standard values. The values of the back-ground peak and text peak affect the repro-duction of the back-ground density and text density respectively.1: fixed/fixed2: varied/fixed3: fixed/varied4: varied/varied* Background peak/
Text peak
1
826 Text SCN (black)
12<11-14,21-24,31-34,41-44>
SYS 1
827 Photo SCN (black)
12<11-14,21-24,31-34,41-44>
SYS 1
828 Gray scale SCN (black)
12<11-14,21-24,31-34,41-44>
SYS 1
830 Image Range correc-tion on origi-nal set on the RADF
Text/Photo SCN (black)
12<11-14,21-24,31-34,41-44>
SYS Sets whether the values of the background peak and text peak are fixed or not. One’s place is an adjustment for “auto-matic density” and ten’s place is for “manual density”. Once they are fixed, the range correc-tion is performed with standard values.The values of the back-ground peak and text peak affect the repro-duction of the back-ground density and text density respectively.1: fixed/fixed2: varied/fixed3: fixed/varied4: varied/varied* Background peak/
Text peak
1
831 Text SCN (black)
12<11-14,21-24,31-34,41-44>
SYS 1
832 Photo SCN (black)
12<11-14,21-24,31-34,41-44>
SYS 1
833 Gray scale SCN (black)
12<11-14,21-24,31-34,41-44>
SYS 1
835 Image Range correc-tion Back-ground peak adjustment
Text/Photo SCN (black)
56<0-255>
SYS When the value increases, the back-ground of the image (low density area) becomes harder to be printed out.
1
836 Text SCN (black)
48<0-255>
SYS 1
837 Photo SCN (black)
16<0-255>
SYS 1
838 Gray scale SCN (black)
32<0-255>
SYS 1
Adjustment mode (05)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 66
840 Image Sharpness adjustment
Text/Photo SCN (black)
0<0-31>
SYS When the value increases, the image becomes sharper. When the value decreases, the image becomes softer.The smaller the value is, the less the moire becomes.* The default value 0
is equivalent to 16 (center value).
1
841 Text SCN (black)
0<0-31>
SYS 1
842 Photo SCN (black)
0<0-31>
SYS 1
843 Gray scale SCN (black)
0<0-31>
SYS 1
845 Image Density adjustment “manual den-sity” fine adjustment/Center value
Text/Photo SCN (black)
128<0-255>
SYS When the value increases, the image becomes darker.
1
846 Text SCN (black)
128<0-255>
SYS 1
847 Photo SCN (black)
128<0-255>
SYS 1
848 Image Fine adjustment of back-ground / Center value
SCN (black)
128<0-255>
SYS When the value increases, the back-ground becomes darker.
1
850 Image Density adjustment “manual den-sity” fine adjustment/Light step value
Text/Photo SCN (black)
20<0-255>
SYS When the value increases, the image of the “light” steps becomes lighter.
1
851 Text SCN (black)
20<0-255>
SYS 1
852 Photo SCN (black)
20<0-255>
SYS 1
853 Image Fine adjustment of back-ground / Light step value (Image smoothing)
SCN (black)
50<0-255>
SYS Sets the changing amount by 1 step at background adjust-ment. When the value increases, the back-ground of the “light” steps becomes lighter.
1
855 Image Density adjustment “manual den-sity” fine adjustment/Dark step value
Text/Photo SCN (black)
20<0-255>
SYS When the value increases, the image of the “dark” steps becomes darker.
1
856 Text SCN (black)
20<0-255>
SYS 1
857 Photo SCN (black)
20<0-255>
SYS 1
858 Image Fine adjustment of back-ground / Dark step value (Image smoothing)
SCN (black)
50<0-255>
SYS Sets the changing amount by 1 step at background adjust-ment. When the value increases, the back-ground of the “dark” steps becomes darker.
1
860 Image Density adjustment “automatic density” fine adjustment
Text/Photo SCN (black)
128<0-255>
SYS When the value increases, the image becomes darker.
1
861 Text SCN (black)
128<0-255>
SYS 1
862 Photo SCN (black)
128<0-255>
SYS 1
Adjustment mode (05)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 67
2
880-0 Image Adjustment of gamma bal-ance (Text/Photo)
L SCN(black)
128<0-255>
SYS When the value increases, the density in the target area becomes higher.L: Low density areaM: Medium density areaH: High density area
4
880-1 M SCN(black)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
880-2 H SCN(black)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
881-0 Image Adjustment of gamma bal-ance (Text)
L SCN(black)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
881-1 M SCN(black)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
881-2 H SCN(black)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
882-0 Image Adjustment of gamma bal-ance (Photo)
L SCN(black)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
882-1 M SCN(black)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
882-2 H SCN(black)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
883-0 Image Adjustment of gamma bal-ance (Gray scale)
L SCN(black)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
883-1 M SCN(black)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
883-2 H SCN(black)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
884 Image Reproduction ratio fine adjustment of primary scanning direction
SCN(black)
128<0-255>
SYS When the value increases by “1”, the reproduction ratio of pri-mary scanning direction increases by approx. 0.1%.Effective with the reso-lution other than 600 dpi.
1
953-0 Image Color devia-tion correc-tion 3(A4/LT)
K ALL 128<118-138>
M When the value increases by "1", the image shifts toward the trailing edge of the paper by 0.0423 mm.
4
953-1 C ALL 128<118-138>
M 4
953-2 M ALL 128<118-138>
M 4
953-3 Y ALL 128<118-138>
M 4
Adjustment mode (05)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 68
954-0 Image Color devia-tion correc-tion 4(A4/LT)
K ALL 128<118-138>
M When the value increases by "1", the image shifts toward the trailing edge of the paper by 0.0423 mm.
4
954-1 C ALL 128<118-138>
M 4
954-2 M ALL 128<118-138>
M 4
954-3 Y ALL 128<118-138>
M 4
955-0 Image Color devia-tion correc-tion 5(A4/LT)
K ALL 128<118-138>
M When the value increases by "1", the image shifts toward the trailing edge of the paper by 0.0423 mm.
4
955-1 C ALL 128<118-138>
M 4
955-2 M ALL 128<118-138>
M 4
955-3 Y ALL 128<118-138>
M 4
956-0 Image Color devia-tion correc-tion 6(A4/LT)
K ALL 128<118-138>
M When the value increases by "1", the image shifts toward the trailing edge of the paper by 0.0423 mm.
4
956-1 C ALL 128<118-138>
M 4
956-2 M ALL 128<118-138>
M 4
956-3 Y ALL 128<118-138>
M 4
976 Mainte-nance
Equipment number (serial number) display
ALL - SYS When this adjustment is performed with this code, the setting code (08-995) is also per-formed automatically. (10 digits)
1
1000 Image Automatic gamma adjustment
PS/600x600
dpi
PRT(color)
- SYS Adjusts the gradation reproduction for each color, Y, M, C and K.
7
1001 PS/1200x600
dpi
PRT(color)
- SYS 7
1002 PCL/600x600
dpi
PRT(color)
- SYS 7
1003 PCL/1200x600
dpi
PRT(color)
- SYS 7
Adjustment mode (05)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 69
2
1010-0 Image Color bal-ance adjust-ment for “Y” (PS/600x600dpi/Smooth)
L PRT(color)
128<0-255>
SYS The target color, mode and density area become darker as the value increases.L: Low density areaM: Medium density
areaH: High density area
4
1010-1 M PRT(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
1010-2 H PRT(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
1011-0 Image Color bal-ance adjust-ment for “M” (PS/600x600dpi/ Smooth)
L PRT(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
1011-1 M PRT(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
1011-2 H PRT(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
1012-0 Image Color bal-ance adjust-ment for “C” (PS/600x600dpi/ Smooth)
L PRT(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
1012-1 M PRT(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
1012-2 H PRT(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
1013-0 Image Color bal-ance adjust-ment for “K” (PS/600x600dpi/ Smooth)
L PRT(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
1013-1 M PRT(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
1013-2 H PRT(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
1014-0 Image Color bal-ance adjust-ment for “Y” (PS/600x600dpi/ Detail)
L PRT(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
1014-1 M PRT(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
1014-2 H PRT(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
1015-0 Image Color bal-ance adjust-ment for “M” (PS/600x600dpi/Detail)
L PRT(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
1015-1 M PRT(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
1015-2 H PRT(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
1016-0 Image Color bal-ance adjust-ment for “C” (PS/600x600dpi/Detail)
L PRT(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
1016-1 M PRT(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
1016-2 H PRT(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
1017-0 Image Color bal-ance adjust-ment for “K” (PS/600x600dpi/ Detail)
L PRT(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
1017-1 M PRT(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
1017-2 H PRT(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
1018-0 Image Color bal-ance adjust-ment for “Y” (PS/1200x600dpi/Smooth)
L PRT(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
1018-1 M PRT(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
1018-2 H PRT(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
Adjustment mode (05)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 70
1019-0 Image Color bal-ance adjust-ment for “M” (PS/1200x600dpi/Smooth)
L PRT(color)
128<0-255>
SYS The target color, mode and density area become darker as the value increases.L: Low density areaM: Medium density
areaH: High density area
4
1019-1 M PRT(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
1019-2 H PRT(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
1020-0 Image Color bal-ance adjust-ment for “C” (PS/1200x600dpi/Smooth)
L PRT(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
1020-1 M PRT(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
1020-2 H PRT(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
1021-0 Image Color bal-ance adjust-ment for “K” (PS/1200x600dpi/Smooth)
L PRT(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
1021-1 M PRT(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
1021-2 H PRT(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
1022-0 Image Color bal-ance adjust-ment for “Y” (PS/1200x600dpi/Detail)
L PRT(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
1022-1 M PRT(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
1022-2 H PRT(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
1023-0 Image Color bal-ance adjust-ment for “M” (PS/1200x600dpi/Detail)
L PRT(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
1023-1 M PRT(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
1023-2 H PRT(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
1024-0 Image Color bal-ance adjust-ment for “C” (PS/1200x600dpi/Detail)
L PRT(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
1024-1 M PRT(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
1024-2 H PRT(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
1025-0 Image Color bal-ance adjust-ment for “K” (PS/1200x600dpi/Detail)
L PRT(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
1025-1 M PRT(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
1025-2 H PRT(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
1026-0 Image Color bal-ance adjust-ment for “Y” (PCL/600x600dpi/Smooth)
L PRT(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
1026-1 M PRT(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
1026-2 H PRT(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
1027-0 Image Color bal-ance adjust-ment for “M” (PCL/600x600dpi/Smooth)
L PRT(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
1027-1 M PRT(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
1027-2 H PRT(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
Adjustment mode (05)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 71
2
1028-0 Image Color bal-ance adjust-ment for “C” (PCL/600x600dpi/Smooth)
L PRT(color)
128<0-255>
SYS The target color, mode and density area become darker as the value increases.L: Low density areaM: Medium density
areaH: High density area
4
1028-1 M PRT(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
1028-2 H PRT(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
1029-0 Image Color bal-ance adjust-ment for “K” (PCL/600x600dpi/Smooth)
L PRT(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
1029-1 M PRT(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
1029-2 H PRT(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
1030-0 Image Color bal-ance adjust-ment for “Y” (PCL/600x600dpi/Detail)
L PRT(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
1030-1 M PRT(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
1030-2 H PRT(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
1031-0 Image Color bal-ance adjust-ment for “M” (PCL/600x600dpi/Detail)
L PRT(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
1031-1 M PRT(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
1031-2 H PRT(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
1032-0 Image Color bal-ance adjust-ment for “C” (PCL/600x600dpi/Detail)
L PRT(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
1032-1 M PRT(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
1032-2 H PRT(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
1033-0 Image Color bal-ance adjust-ment for “K” (PCL/600x600dpi/Detail)
L PRT(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
1033-1 M PRT(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
1033-2 H PRT(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
1034-0 Image Color bal-ance adjust-ment for “Y” (PCL/1200x600dpi/Smooth)
L PRT(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
1034-1 M PRT(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
1034-2 H PRT(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
1035-0 Image Color bal-ance adjust-ment for “M” (PCL/1200x600dpi/Smooth)
L PRT(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
1035-1 M PRT(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
1035-2 H PRT(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
1036-0 Image Color bal-ance adjust-ment for “C” (PCL/1200x600dpi/Smooth)
L PRT(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
1036-1 M PRT(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
1036-2 H PRT(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
Adjustment mode (05)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 72
1037-0 Image Color bal-ance adjust-ment for “K” (PCL/1200x600dpi/Smooth)
L PRT(color)
128<0-255>
SYS The target color, mode and density area become darker as the value increases.L: Low density areaM: Medium density
areaH: High density area
4
1037-1 M PRT(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
1037-2 H PRT(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
1038-0 Image Color bal-ance adjust-ment for “Y” (PCL/1200x600dpi/Detail)
L PRT(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
1038-1 M PRT(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
1038-2 H PRT(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
1039-0 Image Color bal-ance adjust-ment for “M” (PCL/1200x600dpi/Detail)
L PRT(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
1039-1 M PRT(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
1039-2 H PRT(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
1040-0 Image Color bal-ance adjust-ment for “C” (PCL/1200x600dpi/Detail)
L PRT(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
1040-1 M PRT(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
1040-2 H PRT(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
1041-0 Image Color bal-ance adjust-ment for “K” (PCL/1200x600dpi/Detail)
L PRT(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
1041-1 M PRT(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
1041-2 H PRT(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
1046-0 Image Adjustment of maximum toner amount (Plain paper)
PS PRT(color)
255<0-255>
SYS When the value decreases, the image becomes lighter.
Note: Note: When the value increases, the image offsetting may occur.
4
1046-1 PCL PRT(color)
255<0-255>
SYS 4
1047-0 Image Adjustment of maximum toner amount (Thick paper 1)
PS PRT(color)
255<0-255>
SYS 4
1047-1 PCL PRT(color)
255<0-255>
SYS 4
1048-0 Image Adjustment of maximum toner amount (Thick paper 2)
PS PRT(color)
255<0-255>
SYS 4
1048-1 PCL PRT(color)
255<0-255>
SYS 4
1049-0 Image Adjustment of maximum toner amount (Thick paper 3)
PS PRT(color)
255<0-255>
SYS 4
1049-1 PCL PRT(color)
255<0-255>
SYS 4
1050-0 Image Adjustment of maximum toner amount (OHP film)
PS PRT(color)
200<0-255>
SYS 4
1050-1 PCL PRT(color)
200<0-255>
SYS 4
Adjustment mode (05)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 73
2
1055 Image Upper limit in toner saving mode
PRT(color)
176<0-255>
SYS When the value decreases, the printing density becomes lighter.
1
1056 PRT(color)
176<0-255>
SYS 1
1057 PRT(color)
176<0-255>
SYS 1
1058 PRT(color)
176<0-255>
SYS 1
1060 Image Reproduction ratio fine adjustment of primary scanning direction
SCN(color)
128<0-255>
SYS When the value increases by “1”, the reproduction ratio of pri-mary scanning direction increases by approx. 0.1%.Effective with the reso-lution other than 600 dpi.
1
1065 Image Judgment threshold for ACS
SCN(color)
70<0-255>
SYS When the value increases, originals tend to be judged as monochrome, and when the value decreases, they tend to be judged as color in autocolor mode.
1
1066 Image Judgment threshold for ACS on original set on the RADF
SCN(color)
70<0-255>
SYS 1
1070 Image Fine adjust-ment of back-ground
Text SCN(color)
0<0-50>
SYS Adjusts the level of background. When the value increases, the background becomes more brightened.
1
1071 Printed image
SCN(color)
0<0-50>
SYS 1
1072 Photo SCN(color)
0<0-50>
SYS 1
1075 Image Fine adjust-ment of black density
Text SCN(color)
0<0-4>
SYS Adjusts the black den-sity of the scanned image. When the value increases, the black density becomes darker.
1
1076 Printed image
SCN(color)
0<0-4>
SYS 1
1077 Photo SCN(color)
0<0-4>
SYS 1
1080 Image RGB conver-sion method selection
Text SCN(color)
0<0-3>
SYS Sets the color space format of the output image.0: sRGB 1: AppleRGB2: ROMMRGB 3: AdobeRGB
1
1081 Printed image
SCN(color)
0<0-3>
SYS 1
1082 Photo SCN(color)
0<0-3>
SYS 1
1086 Image Sharpness adjustment
Text SCN(color)
0<0-31>
SYS When the value increases, the image becomes sharper. When the value decreases, the image becomes softer.The smaller the value is, the less the moire becomes.* The default value 0
is equivalent to 16 (center value).
1
1087 Printed image
SCN(color)
0<0-31>
SYS 1
1088 Photo SCN(color)
0<0-31>
SYS 1
Adjustment mode (05)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 74
1550 Image Density adjustment “manual den-sity” fine adjustment/Center value
Text/Photo PPC(color)
128<0-255>
SYS When the value increases, the image becomes darker.
1
1551 Text PPC(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 1
1552 Printed image
PPC(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 1
1553 Photo PPC(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 1
1554 Map PPC(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 1
1560 Image Density adjustment “manual den-sity” fine adjustment/Dark step value
Text/Photo PPC(color)
20<0-255>
SYS Sets the changing amount by 1 step at the density adjustment.When the value increases, the image of the “dark” steps becomes darker.
1
1561 Text PPC(color)
20<0-255>
SYS 1
1562 Printed image
PPC(color)
20<0-255>
SYS 1
1563 Photo PPC(color)
20<0-255>
SYS 1
1564 Map PPC(color)
20<0-255>
SYS 1
1570 Image Density adjustment “manual den-sity” fine adjustment/Light step value
Text/Photo PPC(color)
20<0-255>
SYS Sets the changing amount by 1 step at the density adjustment.When the value increases, the image of the “light” steps becomes lighter.
1
1571 Text PPC(color)
20<0-255>
SYS 1
1572 Printed image
PPC(color)
20<0-255>
SYS 1
1573 Photo PPC(color)
20<0-255>
SYS 1
1574 Map PPC(color)
20<0-255>
SYS 1
1580 Image Density adjustment “automatic density” fine adjustment
Text/Photo PPC(color)
128<0-255>
SYS When the value increases, the image becomes darker.
1
1581 Text PPC(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 1
1582 Printed image
PPC(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 1
1583 Photo PPC(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 1
1584 Map PPC(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 1
1612 Image Adjustment of maximum toner amount
Plain paper
PPC(color)
255<0-255>
SYS When the value decreases, the image becomes lighter.
Note: Note: When the value increases, image offsetting may occur.
1
1613 Thick paper 1
PPC(color)
249<0-255>
SYS 1
1614 Thick paper 2
PPC(color)
237<0-255>
SYS 1
1615 Thick paper 3
PPC(color)
237<0-255>
SYS 1
1616 OHP film PPC(color)
249<0-255>
SYS 1
Adjustment mode (05)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 75
2
1630 Image Maximum text density adjustment
Y PPC(color)
5<0-10>
SYS When the value increases by “1”, the maximum text density of each color becomes darker.
1
1631 M PPC(color)
5<0-10>
SYS 1
1632 C PPC(color)
5<0-10>
SYS 1
1633 K PPC(color)
5<0-10>
SYS 1
1642 Image Automatic gamma adjustment
Color/Black
PPC - SYS Automatic adjustment of gradation reproduc-tion in the Full Color Mode (each color of Y, M, C and K) and Black Mode.
7
1643 Color PPC - SYS Automatic adjustment of gradation reproduc-tion in the Full Color Mode (each color of Y, M, C and K).
7
1675 Image Judgment threshold for ACS
PPC(color)
70<0-255>
SYS When the value increases, originals tend to be judged as black, and when the value decreases, they tend to be judged as color in auto-color mode.
1
1676 Image Judgment threshold for ACS on original set on the RADF
PPC(color)
70<0-255>
SYS 1
1688 Image Automatic off-setting adjust-ment for background processing (background density)
Text/Photo PPC(color)
128<0-255>
SYS When the value increases, the back-ground becomes darker.
1
1689 Text PPC(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 1
1690 Printed image
PPC(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 1
1691 Photo PPC(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 1
1692 Map PPC(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 1
1693 Image Automatic off-setting adjust-ment for background processing (text density)
Text/Photo PPC(color)
128<0-255>
SYS When the value increases, the text becomes darker.
1
1694 Text PPC(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 1
1695 Printed image
PPC(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 1
1696 Photo PPC(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 1
1697 Map PPC(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 1
Adjustment mode (05)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 76
1698 Image Manual offset-ting adjust-ment for background processing (background density)
Text/Photo PPC(color)
128<0-255>
SYS When the value increases, the back-ground becomes darker.
1
1699 Text PPC(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 1
1700 Printed image
PPC(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 1
1701 Photo PPC(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 1
1702 Map PPC(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 1
1708 Image Manual offset-ting adjust-ment for background processing (text density)
Text/Photo PPC(color)
128<0-255>
SYS When the value increases, the text becomes darker.
1
1709 Text PPC(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 1
1710 Printed image
PPC(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 1
1711 Photo PPC(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 1
1712 Map PPC(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 1
1725 Image Text/Photo reproduction level adjustment
PPC(color)
0<0-5>
SYS 0: Default1: Photo oriented 2
(The printed image reproduction level higher than that of the Photo oriented 1)
2: Photo oriented 1 (The printed image reproduction level higher than that of the Default)
3: Equivalent to the Default
4: Text oriented 1 (The text reproduction level higher than that of the Default)
5: Text oriented 2 (The text reproduction level higher than that of the Text ori-ented 1)
1
1737 Image Sharpness adjustment / Full Color Mode
Text/Photo PPC(color)
0<0-31>
SYS When the value increases, the image becomes sharper. When the value decreases, the image becomes softer.The smaller the value is, the less the moire becomes.* The default value 0
is equivalent to 16 (center value).
1
1738 Text PPC(color)
0<0-31>
SYS 1
1739 Printed image
PPC(color)
0<0-31>
SYS 1
1740 Photo PPC(color)
0<0-31>
SYS 1
1741 Map PPC(color)
0<0-31>
SYS 1
Adjustment mode (05)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 77
2
1757 Image Sharpness adjustment /Auto Color Mode (Text/Photo)
PPC(color)
EUR: 0UC: 0
JAPN: 22<0-31>
SYS When the value increases, the image becomes sharper. When the value decreases, the image becomes softer. The smaller the value is, the less the moire becomes.* The default value 0
is equivalent to 16(center value).
1
1761 Image Black reproduction switch-ing
PPC(color)
0<0-1>
SYS 0: Default1: Black reproduction
oriented
1
1769 Image Setting for highlighter
Vivid PPC(color)
0<0-2>
SYS Sets the reproduction mode for highlighter for four types of one touch adjustment.0: Default1: Highlighter 12: Highlighter 2
1
1770 Clear PPC(color)
0<0-2>
SYS 1
1771 Warm PPC(color)
0<0-2>
SYS 1
1772 Cool PPC(color)
0<0-2>
SYS 1
1779-0 Image Color bal-ance adjust-ment for “Y” (Text/Photo)
L PPC(color)
128<0-255>
SYS The target color, mode and density area become darker as the value increases.L: Low density areaM: Medium density
areaH: High density area
4
1779-1 M PPC(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
1779-2 H PPC(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
1780-0 Image Color bal-ance adjust-ment for “Y” (Text)
L PPC(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
1780-1 M PPC(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
1780-2 H PPC(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
1781-0 Image Color bal-ance adjust-ment for “Y” (Printed image)
L PPC(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
1781-1 M PPC(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
1781-2 H PPC(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
1782-0 Image Color bal-ance adjust-ment for “Y” (Photo)
L PPC(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
1782-1 M PPC(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
1782-2 H PPC(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
1783-0 Image Color bal-ance adjust-ment for “Y” (Map)
L PPC(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
1783-1 M PPC(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
1783-2 H PPC(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
Adjustment mode (05)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 78
1784-0 Image Color bal-ance adjust-ment for “M” (Text/Photo)
L PPC(color)
128<0-255>
SYS The target color, mode and density area become darker as the value increases.L: Low density areaM: Medium density
areaH: High density area
4
1784-1 M PPC(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
1784-2 H PPC(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
1785-0 Image Color bal-ance adjust-ment for “M” (Text)
L PPC(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
1785-1 M PPC(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
1785-2 H PPC(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
1786-0 Image Color bal-ance adjust-ment for “M” (Printed image)
L PPC(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
1786-1 M PPC(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
1786-2 H PPC(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
1787-0 Image Color bal-ance adjust-ment for “M” (Photo)
L PPC(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
1787-1 M PPC(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
1787-2 H PPC(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
1788-0 Image Color bal-ance adjust-ment for “M” (Map)
L PPC(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
1788-1 M PPC(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
1788-2 H PPC(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
1789-0 Image Color bal-ance adjust-ment for “C” (Text/Photo)
L PPC(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
1789-1 M PPC(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
1789-2 H PPC(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
1790-0 Image Color bal-ance adjust-ment for “C” (Text)
L PPC(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
1790-1 M PPC(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
1790-2 H PPC(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
1791-0 Image Color bal-ance adjust-ment for “C” (Printed image)
L PPC(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
1791-1 M PPC(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
1791-2 H PPC(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
1792-0 Image Color bal-ance adjust-ment for “C” (Photo)
L PPC(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
1792-1 M PPC(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
1792-2 H PPC(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
Adjustment mode (05)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 79
2
1793-0 Image Color bal-ance adjust-ment for “C” (Map)
L PPC(color)
128<0-255>
SYS The target color, mode and density area become darker as the value increases.L: Low density areaM: Medium density
areaH: High density area
4
1793-1 M PPC(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
1793-2 H PPC(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
1794-0 Image Color bal-ance adjust-ment for “K” (Text/Photo)
L PPC(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
1794-1 M PPC(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
1794-2 H PPC(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
1795-0 Image Color bal-ance adjust-ment for “K” (Text)
L PPC(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
1795-1 M PPC(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
1795-2 H PPC(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
1796-0 Image Color bal-ance adjust-ment for “K” (Printed image)
L PPC(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
1796-1 M PPC(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
1796-2 H PPC(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
1797-0 Image Color bal-ance adjust-ment for “K” (Photo)
L PPC(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
1797-1 M PPC(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
1797-2 H PPC(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
1798-0 Image Color bal-ance adjust-ment for “K” (Map)
L PPC(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
1798-1 M PPC(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
1798-2 H PPC(color)
128<0-255>
SYS 4
1800-0 Image control
Upper limit value of con-trast voltage
Y ALL 650<0-999>
M Sets the upper limit value of the contrast voltage at the image quality control. (Unit: V)
4
1800-1 M ALL 650<0-999>
M 4
1800-2 C ALL 650<0-999>
M 4
1800-3 K ALL 600<0-999>
M 4
1801-0 Image control
Lower limit value of con-trast voltage
Y ALL 120<0-999>
M Sets the lower limit value of the contrast voltage at the image quality control. (Unit: V)
4
1801-1 M ALL 120<0-999>
M 4
1801-2 C ALL 120<0-999>
M 4
1801-3 K ALL 120<0-999>
M 4
Adjustment mode (05)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 80
1802-0 Image control
Upper limit value of laser power
Y ALL 800<0-999>
M Sets the upper limit value of the laser power at the image quality control. (Unit: µW)
4
1802-1 M ALL 800<0-999>
M 4
1802-2 C ALL 800<0-999>
M 4
1802-3 K ALL 800<0-999>
M 4
1803-0 Image control
Lower limit value of laser power
Y ALL 350<0-999>
M Sets the lower limit value of the laser power at the image quality control. (Unit: µW)
4
1803-1 M ALL 350<0-999>
M 4
1803-2 C ALL 350<0-999>
M 4
1803-3 K ALL 350<0-999>
M 4
1804-0 Image control
Background voltage actual value display
Y ALL 125<0-999>
M Displays the back-ground voltage when printing is operated. (Unit: V)
10
1804-1 M ALL 125<0-999>
M 10
1804-2 C ALL 125<0-999>
M 10
1804-3 K ALL 125<0-999>
M 10
1805-0 Image control
Drum surface potential char-acteristic/ slope factor display
Y ALL 979<0-999>
M Displays the slope fac-tor of the approximate expression of the drum surface potential to the main charger grid volt-age at the open-loop control.
10
1805-1 M ALL 979<0-999>
M 10
1805-2 C ALL 979<0-999>
M 10
1805-3 K ALL 990<0-999>
M 10
1806-0 Image control
Drum surface potential char-acteristic/off-set factor display
Y ALL -6<-999-999>
M Displays the offset fac-tor of the approximate expression of the drum surface potential to the main charger grid volt-age at the open-loop control.
10
1806-1 M ALL -6<-999-999>
M 10
1806-2 C ALL -6<-999-999>
M 10
1806-3 K ALL -4<-999-999>
M 10
1807-0 Image control
Drum expo-sure voltage characteristic/slope factor display (main charger grid low voltage area)
Y ALL 58<0-999>
M Displays the slope fac-tor of the approximate expression of the drum exposure voltage to the main charger grid volt-age at the open-loop control.
10
1807-1 M ALL 58<0-999>
M 10
1807-2 C ALL 58<0-999>
M 10
1807-3 K ALL 60<0-999>
M 10
Adjustment mode (05)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 81
2
1808-0 Image control
Drum expo-sure voltage characteristic/offset factor display (main charger grid low voltage area)
Y ALL 35<-999-999>
M Displays the offset fac-tor of the approximate expression of the drum exposure voltage to the main charger grid volt-age at the open-loop control.
10
1808-1 M ALL 35<-999-999>
M 10
1808-2 C ALL 35<-999-999>
M 10
1808-3 K ALL 42<-999-999>
M 10
1809-0 Image control
Drum expo-sure voltage characteristic/slope factor display (main charger grid high voltage area)
Y ALL 49<0-999>
M Displays the slope fac-tor of the approximate expression of the drum exposure voltage to the main charger grid volt-age at the open-loop control.
10
1809-1 M ALL 49<0-999>
M 10
1809-2 C ALL 49<0-999>
M 10
1809-3 K ALL 53<0-999>
M 10
1810-0 Image control
Drum expo-sure voltage characteristic/offset factor display (main charger grid high voltage area)
Y ALL 41<-999-999>
M Displays the offset fac-tor of the approximate expression of the drum exposure voltage to the main charger grid volt-age at the open-loop control.
10
1810-1 M ALL 41<-999-999>
M 10
1810-2 C ALL 41<-999-999>
M 10
1810-3 K ALL 47<-999-999>
M 10
1811-0 Image control
Contrast volt-age/upper limit actual value display
Y ALL 500<0-999>
M Displays the upper limit value of the contrast voltage when printing is operated. (Unit: V)
10
1811-1 M ALL 500<0-999>
M 10
1811-2 C ALL 500<0-999>
M 10
1811-3 K ALL 600<0-999>
M 10
1812-0 Image control
Contrast volt-age/lower limit actual value display
Y ALL 120<0-999>
M Displays the lower limit value of the contrast voltage when printing is operated. (Unit: V)
10
1812-1 M ALL 120<0-999>
M 10
1812-2 C ALL 120<0-999>
M 10
1812-3 K ALL 120<0-999>
M 10
Adjustment mode (05)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 82
1813-0 Image control
Display of background voltage/upper limit actual value
Y ALL 170<0-999>
M Displays the upper limit value of the background voltage when printing is operated. (Unit: V)
10
1813-1 M ALL 170<0-999>
M 10
1813-2 C ALL 170<0-999>
M 10
1813-3 K ALL 170<0-999>
M 10
1814-0 Image control
Background voltage/lower limit actual value display
Y ALL 80<0-999>
M Displays the lower limit value of the background voltage when printing is operated. (Unit: V)
10
1814-1 M ALL 80<0-999>
M 10
1814-2 C ALL 80<0-999>
M 10
1814-3 K ALL 80<0-999>
M 10
1815-0 Image control
Contrast volt-age/correc-tion number of time display
Y ALL 0<0-255>
M Displays the actual number of time the con-trast voltage has been corrected at the closed-loop control.
10
1815-1 M ALL 0<0-255>
M 10
1815-2 C ALL 0<0-255>
M 10
1815-3 K ALL 0<0-255>
M 10
1816-0 Image control
Laser power correction/number of time display
Y ALL 0<0-255>
M Displays the actual number of time the laser power has been corrected at the closed-loop control.
10
1816-1 M ALL 0<0-255>
M 10
1816-2 C ALL 0<0-255>
M 10
1816-3 K ALL 0<0-255>
M 10
1817 Image control
Laser power actual value display
PPC (black)
92<0-255>
M Displays the laser power value when copying in the Black Mode. (Bit value)
2
1819 Image control
Laser power correcting fac-tor
PPC (black)
100<100-255>
M Perform the correction of the setting 05-1817. (Unit: %)
1
1820 Image control
Laser power actual value display
PRT (black)
92<0-255>
M Displays the laser power value when print-ing in the Black Mode. (Bit value)
2
1821 Image control
Laser power correcting fac-tor
PRT (black)
100<100-255>
M Perform the correction of the setting 05-1820. (Unit: %)
1
Adjustment mode (05)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 83
2
1822-0 Transfer 2nd transfer roller bias cor-rection of trail-ing edge of paper
Plain paper
ALL 92<0-255>
M Corrects the 2nd trans-fer roller bias output of the trailing edge of paper (05-227, 229, 230, 231 and 232). Correction factor: %
14
1822-1 Thick paper 1
ALL 88<0-255>
M 14
1822-2 Thick paper 2
ALL 90<0-255>
M 14
1822-3 Thick paper 3
ALL 90<0-255>
M 14
1822-4 OHP film ALL 90<0-255>
M 14
1823-0 Transfer Display of intermediate level of 2nd transfer roller bias actual value of trail-ing edge of paper (Plain paper)
Single side
ALL (black)
162<0-255>
M Displays the value of 2nd transfer roller bias when the actual printing is operated.(The value corrected in 05-1822 is displayed.)
10
1823-1 Reverse side at
duplexing
ALL (black)
139<0-255>
M 10
1823-2 Single side
ALL (color)
150<0-255>
M 10
1823-3 Reverse side at
duplexing
ALL (color)
133<0-255>
M 10
1825-0 Transfer Display of intermediate level of 2nd transfer roller bias actual value of trail-ing edge of paper (Thick paper 1)
Single side
ALL (black)
149<0-255>
M 10
1825-1 Reverse side at
duplexing
ALL (black)
127<0-255>
M 10
1825-2 Single side
ALL (color)
133<0-255>
M 10
1825-3 Reverse side at
duplexing
ALL (color)
121<0-255>
M 10
1826-0 Transfer Display of intermediate level of 2nd transfer roller bias actual value of trailing edge of paper (Thick paper 2)
ALL (black)
157<0-255>
M 10
1826-1 ALL (color)
154<0-255>
M 10
1827-0 Transfer Display of intermediate level of 2nd transfer roller bias actual value of trailing edge of paper (Thick paper 3)
ALL (black)
137<0-255>
M 10
1827-1 ALL (color)
137<0-255>
M 10
1828-0 Transfer Display of intermediate level of 2nd transfer roller bias actual value of trailing edge of paper (OHP film)
ALL (black)
126<0-255>
M 10
1828-1 ALL (color)
126<0-255>
M 10
1829-0 Transfer 1st transfer roller bias cor-rection at deceleration
Thick paper 2
ALL 80<0-100>
M Corrects the 1st trans-fer roller bias output.Correction factor: %
14
1829-1 Thick paper 3
ALL 80<0-100>
M 14
1829-2 OHP film ALL 80<0-100>
M 14
Adjustment mode (05)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 84
1831 Transfer 1st transfer roller bias actual value display at deceleration (Thick paper 2)
ALL (black)
187<0-255>
M Displays the value of 1st transfer roller bias at deceleration when the actual printing is operated.(The value corrected in 05-1829 is displayed.)
2
1832 Transfer 1st transfer roller bias actual value display at deceleration(Thick paper 3)
ALL (black)
187<0-255>
M 2
1833 Transfer 1st transfer roller bias actual value display at deceleration(OHP film)
ALL (black)
187 <0-255>
M 2
1836 Transfer 1st transfer roller bias actual value display in low-speed color printing(Plain paper / Thick paper 1)
ALL(color)
178<0-255>
M Displays the actual value of the 1st transfer roller bias when the transfers of all colors (Y, M, C and K) have fin-ished.This adjustment is valid only when the value of the code 08-497 is “1”(6 pages/minute).
2
1839-0 Transfer 2nd transfer roller bias cor-rection of leading/trail-ing edge of paper(Tab paper)
Intermedi-ate level bias of trailing edge
ALL 100<0-100>
M Corrects the 2nd trans-fer roller bias output of leading/trailing edge of paper (05-1840).(Correcting factor: %)
14
1839-1 Bias of leading/trailing edge
ALL 90<0-100>
M 14
1840-0 Transfer 2nd transfer roller biasoutput adjustment(Tab paper)
ALL(black)
153<0-187>
M As the value decreases, the 2nd transfer roller bias output increases correspondingly.The adjustment value becomes effective when the Setting Mode (08-544, 549 and 551) is 0 (invalid).
14
1840-1 ALL(color)
150<0-187>
M 14
1841-0 Transfer 2nd transfer roller biasoffsetting adjustment(Tab paper)
ALL(black)
5<0-10>
M Sets the offset amount of 2nd transfer roller bias.0: -500V 1: -400V 2: -300V 3: -200V 4: -100V 5: 0V6: +100V 7: +200V 8: +300V 9: +400V 10: +500V
4
1841-1 ALL(color)
5<0-10>
M 4
Adjustment mode (05)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 85
2
1842-0 Transfer Actual valuedisplay of 2ndtransfer roller biasof leading/trailingedge of paper(Tab paper)
Intermedi-ate level bias of trailing edge
ALL(black)
153<0-225>
M Displays the value of 2nd transfer roller bias on the leading/trailing edge of paper when printing is performed.(The value corrected in 05-1839 is displayed.)
10
1842-1 Bias of leading/trailing edge
ALL(black)
157<0-225>
M 10
1842-2 Intermedi-ate level bias of trailing edge
ALL(color)
150<0-225>
M 10
1842-3 Bias of leading/trailing edge
ALL(color)
154<0-225>
M 10
1845-0 Transfer 2nd transfer roller biasactual value display(Tab paper)
ALL(black)
153<0-187>
M Displays the value of 2nd transfer roller bias when printing is oper-ated.
10
1845-1 ALL(color)
150<0-187>
M 10
1847 Transfer 1st transfer roller bias actual value display(Tab paper)
ALL 400<300-800>
M The drum surface potential at the 1st transfer bias resistance detection control is adjusted.[Unit: V]
1
1848 Transfer 1st transfer bias resis-tance detection control Result value display
ALL -<0-9999>
M The result value of the 1st transfer bias resis-tance detection control is displayed.[Unit: V]
2
1849 Transfer 1st transfer roller bias out-put adjustment
ALL(black)
154<0-225>
M When the value decreases, the 1st transfer roller bias out-put increases.This setting is enabled when "0" (disabled) is set at the codes 08-541, -549 and -551.
1
1850-0 Transfer 1st transfer roller bias out-put adjust-ment
Y ALL(color)
138<0-225>
M When the value decreases, the 1st transfer roller bias out-put increases.This setting is enabled when "0" (disabled) is set at the codes 08-541, -549 and -551.
4
1850-1 M ALL(color)
143<0-225>
M 4
1850-2 C ALL(color)
154<0-225>
M 4
1850-3 K ALL(color)
154<0-225>
M 4
1861 Transfer 1st transfer roller bias RMS value display
ALL(black)
154<0-225>
M The RMS value of the 1st transfer roller bias at the time of printing is displayed.
2
Adjustment mode (05)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 86
1862-0 Transfer 1st transfer roller bias RMS value display
Y ALL(color)
138<0-225>
M The RMS value of the 1st transfer roller bias at the time of printing is displayed.
10
1862-1 M ALL(color)
143<0-225>
M 10
1862-2 C ALL(color)
154<0-225>
M 10
1862-3 K ALL(color)
154<0-225>
M 10
1863 Transfer 1st transfer roller bias resistance detection Cur-rent offset adjustment
ALL 5<0-10>
M The current offset amount of the 1st trans-fer roller bias resistance detection is adjusted.0: -10 1: -8 2: -63: -4 4: -2 5: 0 6: +2 7: +4 8: +69: +8 10: +10[Unit: μA]
1
1864 Transfer 1st transfer roller bias cor-rection at low-speed color printing
ALL(color)
100<0-100>
M The 1st transfer roller bias output after the completion of transfer of all colors (Y, M, C and K) is corrected.This setting is enabled when "1" (6 sheets/minute) is set at the code 08-497.
1
9960 Mainte-nance
Machine information dis-play
ALL 0<0-2>
SYS Displays the machine information stored in NVRAM.0: Not used1: e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c2: e-STUDIO283c/353c/453c
2
Adjustment mode (05)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
10/06
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 87
2
2.2.5 Setting mode (08)
Procedure 1
* Press [FUNCTION CLEAR] to enter minus (-).
Procedure 2
Procedure 3
Procedure 4
* Press [FUNCTION CLEAR] to enter minus (-).
The items in the setting code list can be set or changed in this setting mode (08).When the power should be turned OFF, be sure to shut down the equipment by pressing the [ENERGY SAVER] button for a few seconds.
(Stores value in RAM)
[0][8]
[POWER]
[POWER] OFF/ON
(Exit)
[Digital key]
(Code)[START] [Digital key]
*[FUNCTION CLEAR]
[ENTER]
or
[INTERRUPT]Sets or
changes value
[CLEAR]
(Corrects value)
[CANCEL]
[0][8]
[POWER][POWER]OFF/ON
(Exit)
[Digital key]
(Code)[START]
[ENTER]
or
[INTERRUPT]
Adjustment value
cannot be changed
[0][8]
[POWER]
[POWER] OFF/ON
(Exit)
[Digital key]
(Code)[START]
[CANCEL] or [CLEAR]
(Automatic setting)
[ENTER]
or
[INTERRUPT](Stores value in RAM)
[0][8]
[POWER]
[POWER]
OFF/ON
(Exit)
[Digital key]
(Code)
[Digital key]
(Sub-code)[Digital key]
* [FUNCTION CLEAR]Sets or
changes value
[START] [START]
[ENTER]
or
[INTERRUPT](Stores value
in RAM)
[CLEAR]
(Corrects value)
[CLEAR]
(Corrects value)
[START]
[CANCEL]
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 88
Procedure 5
* Press [HELP] to enter "-".
Procedure 7
Procedure 9
Procedure 10
[0][8]
[POWER]
[POWER] OFF/ON
(Exit)
[Digital key]
(Code)
[Digital key]
*[HELP][START]
[CANCEL][ENTER]
or
[INTERRUPT]
[CLEAR](Corrects value)
(Stores value in RAM)Sets or
changes value
[0][8]
[POWER] [POWER] OFF/ON
(Exit)
[Digital key]
(Code)
[Digital key]
(Setting)
[CLEAR](Corrects value)
[START] (HDD formatting)
[CANCEL][ENTER]
or
[INTERRUPT]
(Stores value in RAM)
[0][8]
[POWER]
[POWER] OFF/ON
(Exit)
[Digital key]
(Code)[Select button][START]
[CANCEL][ENTER]
or
[INTERRUPT]
[CLEAR](Corrects value)
(Stores value in RAM)
[0][8]
[POWER]
[POWER]OFF/ON
(Exit)
[Digital key]
(Code)
[Digital key]
(1st setting)
[Digital key]
(2nd setting)[START] [START]
[CANCEL]
[ENTER]or
[INTERRUPT]
[CLEAR]
(Corrects value)
[CLEAR](Corrects value)
(Stores value in RAM)
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 89
2
Procedure 11 and 12
*1 Press [MONITOR/PAUSE] to enter "-", when entering telephone number.*2 The data are stored in SYS-RAM in procedure 11 and stored in NIC-RAM
in procedure 12.
Procedure 14
[0][8]
[POWER]
[POWER] OFF/ON
(Exit)
[Digital key]
(Code)
[Digital key]
or
[Software keyboard][START]
[CANCEL]
[CLEAR]
(Corrects value)
*2(Stores value in RAM)*1 [MONITOR/PAUSE]
Sets orchanges value
[ENTER]
[0][8]
[POWER][POWER]
OFF/ON
(Exit)
[Digital key]
(Code)
[Digital key]
(Sub-code)
[CLEAR]
(Corrects value)
[START] [START]
[CANCEL][ENTER]
or
[INTERRUPT]
Adjustment value
cannot be changed
07/05
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 90
Notes: 1. The digit after the hyphen in “Code” of the following table is a sub code.2. In “RAM”, the NVRAM of the board in which the data of each code is stored is indicated. “M”
stands for the LGC board, “SYS”, “NIC” and “UTY” stands for the SYS board.
Setting mode (08)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
200 General Date and time setting ALL -<13 dig-
its>
- Year/month/date/day/hour/minute/secondExample:03 07 0 13 13 27 48“Day” - “0” is for “Sun-day”. Proceeds Monday through Saturday from “1” to “6”.
5
201 General Destination selection ALL EUR: 0UC: 1JPN: 2<0-3>
M 0: EUR1: UC2: JPN3: Other
1
202 User interface
Counter installed externally ALL 0<0-4>
M 0: No external counter1: Coin controller2: Copy key card
(This value is valid only when “2” is set to 08-201.)
3: Key copy counter4: Key card for OEM1
1
203 General Line adjustment mode ALL 0<0-1>
M 0: For factory ship-ment
1: For line* Field: “0” must be
selected
1
204 User interface
Auto-clear timer setting ALL 3<0-10>
SYS Timer to return the equipment to the default settings when the [START] button is not pressed after the function and the mode are set0: Not cleared1 to 10:
Set number x 15 sec.
1
205 User interface
Auto power save mode timer setting
ALL 11<0, 6-15>
SYS Timer to automatically switch to the energy saving mode when the equipment has not been used0: Invalid 6: 3min.7: 4min. 8: 5min. 9: 7min.10: 10min.11: 15min.12: 20min.13: 30min.14: 45min.15: 60min.
1
07/04
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 91
2
206 User interface
Auto Shut Off Mode timer setting (Sleep Mode)
ALL Refer to content<0-20>
SYS Timer to enter the Sleep Mode automatically when the equipment has not been used0: 3min. 1: 5min. 2: 10min. 3: 15min. 4: 20min. 5: 25min.6: 30min. 7: 40min. 8: 50min. 9: 60min. 10: 70min.11: 80min.12: 90min.13: 100min.14: 110min.15: 120min.16: 150min.17:180min.18: 210min.19:240min.20: Not used<Default value>e-STUDIO281c: 9e-STUDIO351c: 9e-STUDIO451c: 12
1
207 User interface
Highlighting display on LCD
ALL 0<0-1>
SYS 0: Black letter on white background
1: White letter on black background
1
209 User interface
Default setting of filing for-mat when E-mailing (com-mon in all color modes)
ALL(color)
1<0-6>
SYS 0: TIFF (Multi)1: PDF (Multi)2: Not used3: TIFF (Single)4: PDF (Single)5: XPS (Multi)6: XPS (Single)
1
210 Paper feeding
Paper size (A6-R)feeding/widthwise direction
PRT 148/105<148-
432/105-297>
- 10
218 User interface
Default setting of filing for-mat when storing files(at color/ACS modes)
SCN(color)
1<0-4>
SYS 0: TIFF (Multi)1: PDF (Multi) 2: JPG3: TIFF (Single)4: PDF (Single)
1
219 User interface
Default setting of filing for-mat when storing files(at black mode)
ALL (black)
0<0-6>
SYS 0: TIFF (Multi)1: PDF (Multi) 2: JPG3: TIFF (Single)4: PDF (Single)5: XPS (Multi)6: XPS (Single)
1
220 User interface
Language displayed at power-ON
ALL EUR: 0UC: 0JPN: 5<0-6>
SYS 0: Language 11: Language 22: Language 33: Language 44: Language 55: Language 66: Language 7
1
Setting mode (08)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 92
221 User interface
Language selection in UI data at Web power ON
ALL EUR: 0UC: 0JPN: 5<0-6>
SYS 0: Language 11: Language 22: Language 33: Language 44: Language 55: Language 66: Language 7
1
223 Mainte-nance
Switching of output pages/ driving counts at PM
ALL 0<0-1>
M Selects the reference to notify the PM timing. (The message is dis-played on the LCD screen.)0: PM sheet counter
(The number of out-put pages is set at 08-251.)
1: PM driving counter (The timing is set at 08-375.)
1
224 Paper feeding
Paper size for bypass feed PPC UNDEF SYS Press the button on the LCD to select the size.
9
225 Paper feeding
Paper size for upper drawer
ALL EUR: A4UC: LT
JPN: A4
M Press the button on the LCD to select the size.
9
226 Paper feeding
Paper size for lower drawer
ALL EUR: A3UC: LDJPN: A3
M Press the button on the LCD to select the size.
9
227 Paper feeding
Paper size for PFP upper drawer
ALL EUR:A4-R
UC:LT-R
JPN:A4-R
M Press the button on the LCD to select the size.
9
228 Paper feeding
Paper size for PFP lower drawer
ALL EUR: A4UC: LGJPN: B4
M Press the button on the LCD to select the size.
9
229 Paper feeding
Paper size (A3)feeding/widthwise direction
ALL 420/297<182-
432/140-297>
M 10
230 Paper feeding
Paper size (A4-R)feeding/widthwise direction
ALL 297/210<182-
432/140-297>
M 10
231 Paper feeding
Paper size (A5-R)feeding/widthwise direction
ALL 210/148<182-
432/140-297>
M 10
232 Paper feeding
Paper size (B4)feeding/widthwise direction
ALL 364/257<182-
432/140-297>
M 10
233 Paper feeding
Paper size (B5-R)feeding/widthwise direction
ALL 257/182<182-
432/140-297>
M 10
Setting mode (08)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 93
2
234 Paper feeding
Paper size (LT-R)feeding/widthwise direction
ALL 279/216<182-
432/140-297>
M 10
235 Paper feeding
Paper size (LD)feeding/widthwise direction
ALL 432/279<182-
432/140-297>
M 10
236 Paper feeding
Paper size (LG)feeding/widthwise direction
ALL 356/216<182-
432/140-297>
M 10
237 Paper feeding
Paper size (ST-R)feeding/widthwise direction
ALL 216/140<182-
432/140-297>
M 10
238 Paper feeding
Paper size (COMPUTER)feeding/widthwise direction
ALL 356/257<182-
432/140-297>
M 10
239 Paper feeding
Paper size (FOLIO)feeding/widthwise direction
ALL 330/210<182-
432/140-297>
M 10
240 Paper feeding
Paper size (13”LG)feeding/widthwise direction
ALL 330/216<182-
432/140-297>
M 10
241 Paper feeding
Paper size (8.5”X8.5”)feeding/widthwise direction
ALL 216/216<182-
432/140-297>
M 10
242 Paper feeding
Paper size (Non-standard)feeding/widthwise direction
ALL 432/279<148-
432/105-297>
SYS 10
243 Paper feeding
Memory 1Paper size (bypass feed-ing/non-standard type)feeding/widthwise direction
ALL 148/100<148-
432/100-297>
SYS Registers the paper size of bypass feed (non-standard type) into [MEMORY 1].
10
244 Paper feeding
Paper size (8K)feeding/widthwise direction
ALL 390/270<182-
432/140-297>
M 10
245 Paper feeding
Paper size (16K-R)feeding/widthwise direction
ALL 270/195<182-
432/140-297>
M 10
246 Paper feeding
Paper size (A3-wide)feeding/widthwise direction
ALL 457/305<182-
457/140-305>
M 10
247 Paper feeding
Memory 2Paper size (bypass feed-ing/non-standard type)feeding/widthwise direction
ALL 148/100<148-
432/100-297>
SYS Registers the paper size of bypass feed (non-standard type) into [MEMORY 2].
10
Setting mode (08)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
06/08
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 94
248 Paper feeding
Memory 3Paper size (bypass feed-ing/non-standard type)feeding/widthwise direction
ALL 148/100<148-
432/100-297>
SYS Registers the paper size of bypass feed (non-standard type) into [MEMORY 3].
10
249 Paper feeding
Memory 4Paper size (bypass feed-ing/non-standard type)feeding/widthwise direction
ALL 148/100<148-
432/100-297>
SYS Registers the paper size of bypass feed (non-standard type) into [MEMORY 4].
10
250 Mainte-nance
Service technician tele-phone number
ALL 0<32 dig-
its>
SYS A telephone number can be entered up to 32 digits. Use the [MONI-TOR/PAUSE] button to enter a hyphen(-).
11
251 Mainte-nance
Setting value of PM sheet counter
ALL Refer to content
<8 digits>
M <Default>e-STUDIO281c
UC, EUR:100,000 JPN: 0
e-STUDIO351cUC, EUR:120,000 JPN: 0
e-STUDIO451cUC, EUR: 150,000 JPN: 0
1
252 Mainte-nance
Current value of PM driving counter Display/0 clearing
ALL 0<8 digits>
M Counts up when the registration sensor is ON.
1
253 Mainte-nance
Error history display ALL - SYS Displays the latest 20 errors data
2
254 Paperfeeding
LT↔A4/LD↔A3 PRT 0<0-1>
SYS Sets whether the data is printed on the different but similar size paper or not when the paper of corresponding size is not available.0: Valid (The data is
printed on A4/A3 when LT/LD is selected or vice versa.)
1: Invalid (The mes-sage to use the selected paper size is displayed.)
1
255 Paperfeeding
PFP/LCF installation ALL 0<0-4>
M 0: Automatic1: PFP single-drawer
type installed2: PFP dual-drawer
type installed3: LCF installed4: Not installed
1
256 Paperfeeding
Paper size setting /LCF ALL EUR: A4UC: LT
JPN: A4
M Press the icon on the LCD to select the size.
9
Setting mode (08)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
07/04
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 95
2
257 Counter Counter copy ALL -<1-2>
- 1: Electrical counter → Backup counter (LGC board → SYS board)
2: Backup counter → Electrical counter (SYS board → LGC board)(P. 2-226)
-
258 Mainte-nance
FSMS acceptance ALL 1<0-2>
SYS Sets whether the FSMS connection is accepted or not.0: Prohibited1: Accepted (serial
connection only)2: Accepted (both
serial and USB con-nections)
1
259 Network Storage period at trail and private
PRT 14<0-35>
SYS 0: No limits1 to 30: 1 to 30 days31: 1 hour32: 2 hours33: 4 hours34: 8 hours35: 12 hours
1
260 Network Web data retention period ALL 10<3 digits>
SYS When a certain period of time has passed without operation after accessing TopAccess, the data being regis-tered is automatically reset. This period is set at this code.(Unit: Minute)
1
263 User interface
Administrator's password(Maximum 10 digits)
ALL 123456<10 dig-
its>
- The password can be entered in alphabets and figures (A-Z, a-z and 0-9) within 10 dig-its.
11
264 Network File retention period ALL 30<0-999>
SYS 0: No limits1 to 999: 1 to 999 days
1
265 Network Maximum data capacity at E-mailing
ALL 30<2-30>
SYS 2 to 30 M bytes 1
266 Network Maximum data capacity at Internet FAX
ALL 30<2-30>
SYS 2 to 30 M bytes 1
Setting mode (08)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
05/11
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 96
267 Elec-tronicfiling
Full guarantee of docu-ments in Electronic Filing when HDD is full
ALL 1<0-1>
SYS Sets the file retention level when editing the files in the Electronic Filing (at CutDoc/Save-Doc command execu-tion).0: Not full retained 1: Fully retained• Retains the source
file until CutDoc/ SaveDoc command is completed.
* The file is not deleted even if the HDD has become full during the exe-cution of command when “1” is set.
1
268 Userinterface
Binarizing level selection (When judging as black in the ACS Mode)
ALL 3<1-5>
SYS 0: Step -2 1: Step -12: Step 0 (center) 3: Step 14: Step 2* The binarizing level
of each step is set at 08-609.
1
270 Elec-tronicfiling
Default setting of user box retention period
ALL 0<0-999>
SYS Sets the data retention period when creating a user box.0: Not deleted 1 to 999:
Retention period (Unit: Day)
1
271 General Warning notification of the File Share and e-Filling partitions are filled
ALL 90<0-100>
SYS Sets the percentage of HDD partition filled when warning notifica-tion is sent.0 to 100: 0 to 100%* Related code
08-288
1
272 Scanning Notification setting of E-mail saving time limit
ALL 3<0-99>
SYS Sets the days left the notification of E-mail saving time limit appears0 to 99: 0 to 99 days
1
273 Scanning Default setting of partial size when transmitting E-mail
ALL 0<0-6>
SYS Sets the default value for the partial size of E-mail to be transmitted when creating a tem-plate.0: Not divided1: 64 2: 128 3: 256 4: 5125: 10246: 2048 (Unit: KB)
1
Setting mode (08)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 97
2
274 FAX Default setting of page by page when transmitting Internet FAX
ALL 0<0-4>
SYS Sets the default value for the page by page of Internet FAX to be transmitted when creat-ing a template.0: Not divided1: 2562: 5123: 10244: 2048 (Unit: KB)
1
276 Userinterface
Default setting of density adjustment (Black)
SCN(black)
0<0-11>
SYS 0: Automatic density1: Step -52: Step -43: Step -34: Step -25: Step -16: Step 0 (center)7: Step +18: Step +29: Step +310: Step +411: Step +5(1 to 11: Manual den-sity)
1
277 Userinterface
Default setting of back-ground adjustment (Full Color)
SCN(color)
3<1-5>
SYS 1: Step -22: Step -13: Step 0 (center)4: Step +15: Step +2
1
278 Userinterface
Default setting of color mode
SCN 0<0-4>
SYS 0: Black 1: Gray Scale2: Unused3: Full Color4: Auto Color
1
279 Userinterface
Default setting of resolution (Full Color)
SCN(color)
2<0-3>
SYS 0: 100 dpi1: 150 dpi2: 200 dpi3: 300dpi
1
280 Userinterface
Default setting of resolution (Gray Scale)
SCN(black)
2<0-4>
SYS 0: 100 dpi1: 150 dpi2: 200 dpi3: 300dpi4: 400 dpi
1
281 Userinterface
Default setting of resolution (Black)
SCN(black)
1<0-4>
SYS 0: 150 dpi1: 200 dpi2: 300 dpi3: 400dpi4: 600 dpi
1
282 Userinterface
Default setting of original mode (Full Color)
SCN(color)
0<0-2>
SYS 0: Text1: Photo2: Printed Image
1
283 Userinterface
Default setting of original mode (Black)
SCN(black)
0<0-2>
SYS 0: Text1: Text/Photo2: Photo
1
284 Userinterface
Default setting of scanning mode
SCN 0<0-2>
SYS 0: Single1: Book2: Tablet
1
Setting mode (08)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
07/04
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 98
285 Userinterface
Default setting of rotation mode
SCN 0<0-3>
SYS 0: 0 degree1: 90 degrees2: 180 degrees3: 270 degrees
1
286 Userinterface
Default setting of original paper size
ALL 0<0-22>
SYS 0: Automatic1: A3 2: A43: LD 4: LT5: A4-R 6: A5-R7: LT-R 8: LG9: B4 10: B511: ST-R 12: COMP13: B5-R 14: FOLIO15: 13"LG 16: 8.5"x 8.5"18: A6-R19: Size mixed20: 8K 21: 16K22: 16K-R
1
288 General Searching interval of delet-ing expired files and check-ing capacity of HDD partitions
ALL 12<1-24>
SYS Sets the search inter-val of deleting expired files and checking capacity of HDD parti-tions.(Unit: Hour)* Related code
08-271
1
289 User interface
Default setting of back-ground adjustment(Gray Scale)
ALL 3<1-5>
SYS 1: Step -22: Step -13: Step 0 (center)4: Step +15: Step +2
1
290 Network Raw printing job (Duplex) PRT 1<0-1>
SYS 0: Valid1: Invalid
1
291 Network Raw printing job (Paper size)
PRT EUR: 6UC: 2JPN: 6<0 -13>
SYS 0: LD 1: LG2: LT 3: COMP4: ST 5: A3 6: A4 7: A58: A6 9: B4 10: B5 11: FOLIO12: 13 "LG 13: 8.5" x 8.5"
1
292 Network Raw printing job(Paper type)
PRT 0<0-4>
SYS 0: Plain paper 1: Thick paper 12: Thick paper 23: Thick paper 34: OHP film
1
293 Network Raw printing job(Paper direction)
PRT 0<0-1>
SYS 0: Portrait1: Landscape
1
294 Network Raw printing job (Staple) PRT 1<0-1>
SYS 0: Valid1: Invalid
1
295 Network Raw printing job (Exit tray) PRT 0<0-6>
SYS 0: Inner tray1: Finisher tray 12: Finisher tray 23: Unused4: Unused5: Unused6: Unused
1
Setting mode (08)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 99
2
296 Network Raw printing job(Number of form lines)
PRT 1200<500-
12800>
SYS Sets the number of form lines from 5 to 128. (A hundredfold of the number of form lines is defined as the setting value.)
1
297 Network Raw printing job(PCL font pitch)
PRT 1000<44-
9999>
SYS Sets the font pitch from 0.44 to 99.99. (A hun-dredfold of the font pitch is defined as the setting value.)
1
298 Network Raw printing job(PCL font size)
PRT 1200<400-
99975>
SYS Sets the font size from 4 to 999.75.(A hundredfold of the font size is defined as the setting value.)
1
299 Network Raw printing job(PCL font number)
PRT 0<0-79>
SYS Sets the PCL font num-ber.
1
300 User interface
Maximum number of copyvolume (MAX9)
PPC 0<0-2>
SYS 0: 999 1: 99 2: 9 1
301-0 Counter Number of output pages at Full Color Mode in Copier Func-tion
A3 PPC(color)
0<8 digits>
SYS Counts the output pages at the Full Color Mode in the Copier Function for each paper size according to the setting for the count setting of largesized paper (08-352) and the definition setting of large-sized paper (08-353).
4301-1 A4301-2 A5301-3 A6301-4 B4301-5 B5301-6 FOLIO301-7 LD301-8 LG301-9 LT301-10 ST301-11 COMP301-12 13”LG301-13 8.5” x 8.5”301-14 16K301-15 8K301-16 Others
302 User interface
Original counter display PPC EUR: 2UC: 0JPN: 0
<0, 2, 4>
SYS Sets whether the origi-nal counter is dis-played or not.0: Not displayed2: Displayed4: Displayed (Double-
sized original is counted as 2.)
1
Setting mode (08)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 100
303-0 Counter Number of output pages at Full Color Mode in Printer Func-tion
A3 PRT(color)
0<8 digits>
SYS Counts the output pages at the Full Color Mode in the Printer Function for each paper size according to the setting for the count setting of largesized paper (08-352) and the definition setting of large-sized paper (08-353).
4303-1 A4303-2 A5303-3 A6303-4 B4303-5 B5303-6 FOLIO303-7 LD303-8 LG303-9 LT303-10 ST303-11 COMP303-12 13”LG303-13 8.5” x 8.5”303-14 16K303-15 8K303-16 Others304-0 Counter Number of
output pages at Twin Color Mode in Copier Func-tion
A3 PPC(color)
0<8 digits>
SYS Counts the output pages at the Twin Color Mode in the Copier Function for each paper size according to the setting for the count setting of largesized paper (08-352) and the definition setting of large-sized paper (08-353).
4304-1 A4304-2 A5304-3 A6304-4 B4304-5 B5304-6 FOLIO304-7 LD304-8 LG304-9 LT304-10 ST304-11 COMP304-12 13”LG304-13 8.5” x 8.5”304-14 16K304-15 8K304-16 Others
Setting mode (08)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 101
2
305-0 Counter Number of output pages at Black Mode in Copier Function
A3 PPC(black)
0<8 digits>
SYS Counts the output pages at the Black Mode in the Copier Function for each paper size according to the setting for the count setting of large-sized paper (08-352) and the definition setting of large-sized paper (08-353).
4305-1 A4305-2 A5305-3 A6305-4 B4305-5 B5305-6 FOLIO305-7 LD305-8 LG305-9 LT305-10 ST305-11 COMP305-12 13”LG305-13 8.5” x 8.5”305-14 16K305-15 8K305-16 Others306-0 Counter Number of
output pages at Black Mode in Printer Function
A3 PRT(black)
0<8 digits>
SYS Counts the output pages at the Black Mode in the Printer Function for each paper size according to the setting for the count setting of large-sized paper (08-352) and the definition setting of large-sized paper (08-353).
4306-1 A4306-2 A5306-3 A6306-4 B4306-5 B5306-6 FOLIO306-7 LD306-8 LG306-9 LT306-10 ST306-11 COMP306-12 13”LG306-13 8.5” x 8.5”306-14 16K306-15 8K306-16 Others
Setting mode (08)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 102
307-0 Counter Number of output pages at List Print Mode
A3 PRT(black)
0<8 digits>
SYS Counts the output pages at the List Print Mode for each paper size according to the setting for the count setting of large-sized paper (08-352) and the definition setting of largesized paper (08-353).
4307-1 A4307-2 A5307-3 A6307-4 B4307-5 B5307-6 FOLIO307-7 LD307-8 LG307-9 LT307-10 ST307-11 COMP307-12 13”LG307-13 8.5” x 8.5”307-14 16K307-15 8K307-16 Others308-0 Counter Number of
output pages in FAX Func-tion
A3 FAX 0<8 digits>
SYS Counts the output pages in the FAX Func-tion for each paper size according to the setting for the count setting of large-sized paper (08-352) and the definition setting of large-sized paper (08-353).
4308-1 A4308-2 A5308-3 A6308-4 B4308-5 B5308-6 FOLIO308-7 LD308-8 LG308-9 LT308-10 ST308-11 COMP308-12 13”LG308-13 8.5” x 8.5”308-14 16K308-15 8K308-16 Others
Setting mode (08)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 103
2
309-0 Counter Number of scanning pages at Full Color Mode in Copier Func-tion
A3 PPC(color)
0<8 digits>
SYS Counts the scanning pages at the Full Color Mode in the Copier Function for each paper size according to the setting for the count setting of large-sized paper (08-352) and the definition setting of large-sized paper (08-353).
4309-1 A4309-2 A5309-3 A6309-4 B4309-5 B5309-6 FOLIO309-7 LD309-8 LG309-9 LT309-10 ST309-11 COMP309-12 13”LG309-13 8.5” x 8.5”309-14 16K309-15 8K309-16 Others310-0 Counter Number of
scanning pages at Full Color Mode in Scanning Function
A3 SCN(color)
0<8 digits>
SYS Counts the scanning pages at the Full Color Mode in the Scanning Function for each paper size according to the setting for the count setting of large-sized paper (08-352) and the definition setting of large-sized paper (08-353).
4310-1 A4310-2 A5310-3 A6310-4 B4310-5 B5310-6 FOLIO310-7 LD310-8 LG310-9 LT310-10 ST310-11 COMP310-12 13”LG310-13 8.5” x 8.5”310-14 16K310-15 8K310-16 Others
Setting mode (08)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 104
311-0 Counter Number of scanning pages at Twin Color Mode in Copier Func-tion
A3 PPC(color)
0<8 digits>
SYS Counts the scanning pages at the Twin Color Mode in the Copier Function for each paper size according to the setting for the count setting of large-sized paper (08-352) and the definition setting of large-sized paper (08-353).
4311-1 A4311-2 A5311-3 A6311-4 B4311-5 B5311-6 FOLIO311-7 LD311-8 LG311-9 LT
311-10 ST311-11 COMP311-12 13”LG311-13 8.5” x 8.5”311-14 16K311-15 8K311-16 Others312-0 Counter Number of
scanning pages at Black Mode in Copier Func-tion
A3 PPC(black)
0<8 digits>
SYS Counts the scanning pages at the Black Mode in the Copier Function for each paper size according to the setting for the count setting of largesized paper (08-352) and the definition setting of large-sized paper (08-353).
4312-1 A4312-2 A5312-3 A6312-4 B4312-5 B5312-6 FOLIO312-7 LD312-8 LG312-9 LT312-10 ST312-11 COMP312-12 13”LG312-13 8.5” x 8.5”312-14 16K312-15 8K312-16 Others
Setting mode (08)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 105
2
313-0 Counter Number of scanning pages in Scanning Function
A3 SCN(black)
0<8 digits>
SYS Counts the scanning pages at the Black Mode in the Scanning Function for each paper size according to the setting for the count setting of largesized paper (08-352) and the definition setting of large-sized paper (08-353).
4313-1 A4313-2 A5313-3 A6313-4 B4313-5 B5313-6 FOLIO313-7 LD313-8 LG313-9 LT313-10 ST313-11 COMP313-12 13”LG313-13 8.5” x 8.5”313-14 16K313-15 8K313-16 Others314-0 Counter Number of
scanning pages in FAX Function
A3 FAX 0<8 digits>
SYS Counts the scanning pages in the FAX Func-tion for each paper size according to the setting for the count setting of large-sized paper (08-352) and the definition setting of largesized paper (08-353).
4314-1 A4314-2 A5314-3 A6314-4 B4314-5 B5314-6 FOLIO314-7 LD314-8 LG314-9 LT314-10 ST314-11 COMP314-12 13”LG314-13 8.5” x 8.5”314-14 16K314-15 8K314-16 Others
Setting mode (08)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 106
315-0 Counter Number of transmitted pages in FAX Function
A3 FAX 0<8 digits>
SYS Counts the transmitted pages in the FAX Func-tion for each paper size according to the setting for the count setting of large-sized paper (08-352) and the definition setting of largesized paper (08-353).
4315-1 A4315-2 A5315-3 A6315-4 B4315-5 B5315-6 FOLIO315-7 LD315-8 LG315-9 LT315-10 ST315-11 COMP315-12 13”LG315-13 8.5” x 8.5”315-14 16K315-15 8K315-16 Others316-0 Counter Number of
received pages in FAX Function
A3 FAX 0<8 digits>
SYS Counts the received pages in the FAX Func-tion for each paper size according to the setting for the count setting of large-sized paper (08-352) and the definition setting of largesized paper (08-353).
4316-1 A4316-2 A5316-3 A6316-4 B4316-5 B5316-6 FOLIO316-7 LD316-8 LG316-9 LT316-10 ST316-11 COMP316-12 13”LG316-13 8.5” x 8.5”316-14 16K316-15 8K316-16 Others
Setting mode (08)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 107
2
317-0 Counter Display of number of output pages at Full Color Mode in Copier Func-tion
Large PPC(color)
0<8 digits>
SYS Counts the number of output pages at the Full Color Mode in the Copier Function according to its size (large/small).Large:
Number of output pages of large-sized paper defined at 08-353
Small:Number of output pages other than set as large-sized paper
Total:Total number out-put pages of all paper sizes.
14
317-1 Counter Small PPC(color)
0<8 digits>
SYS 14
317-2 Counter Total PPC(color)
0<8 digits>
SYS 14
318-0 Counter Display of number of output pages at Full Color Mode in Printer Func-tion
Large PRT(color)
0<8 digits>
SYS Counts the number of output pages at the Full Color Mode in the Printer Function according to its size (large/small).Large:
Number of output pages of large-sized paper defined at 08-353
Small:Number of output pages other than set as large-sized paper
Total:Total number out-put pages of all paper sizes.
14
318-1 Counter Small PRT(color)
0<8 digits>
SYS 14
318-2 Counter Total PRT(color)
0<8 digits>
SYS 14
319-0 Counter Display of number of output pages at Twin Color Mode in Copier Func-tion
Large PPC(color)
0<8 digits>
SYS Counts the number of output pages at the Twin Color Mode in the Copier Function according to its size (large/small).Large:
Number of output pages of large-sized paper defined at 08-353
Small:Number of output pages other than set as large-sized paper
Total:Total number out-put pages of all paper sizes.
14
319-1 Counter Small PPC(color)
0<8 digits>
SYS 14
319-2 Counter Total PPC(color)
0<8 digits>
SYS 14
Setting mode (08)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 108
320-0 Counter Display of number of output pages at Black Mode in Copier Function
Large PPC(black)
0<8 digits>
SYS Counts the number of output pages at the Black Mode in the Copier Function according to its size (large/small).Large:
Number of output pages of large-sized paper defined at 08-353
Small:Number of output pages other than set as large-sized paper
Total:Total number out-put pages of all paper sizes.
14
320-1 Counter Small PPC(black)
0<8 digits>
SYS 14
320-2 Counter Total PPC(black)
0<8 digits>
SYS 14
321-0 Counter Display of number of output pages at Black Mode in Printer Function
Large PRT(black)
0<8 digits>
SYS Counts the number of output pages at the Black Mode in the Printer Function according to its size (large/small).Large:
Number of output pages of large-sized paper defined at 08-353
Small:Number of output pages other than set as large-sized paper
Total:Total number out-put pages of all paper sizes.
14
321-1 Counter Small PRT(black)
0<8 digits>
SYS 14
321-2 Counter Total PRT(black)
0<8 digits>
SYS 14
322-0 Counter Display of number of output pages at List Print Mode
Large PRT(black)
0<8 digits>
SYS Counts the number of output pages at the List Print Mode Function according to its size (large/small).Large:
Number of output pages of large-sized paper defined at 08-353
Small:Number of output pages other than set as large-sized paper
Total:Total number out-put pages of all paper sizes.
14
322-1 Counter Small PRT(black)
0<8 digits>
SYS 14
322-2 Counter Total PRT(black)
0<8 digits>
SYS 14
Setting mode (08)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 109
2
323-0 Counter Display of number of output pages in FAX Func-tion
Large FAX 0<8 digits>
SYS Counts the number of output pages in the FAX Function according to its size (large/small).Large:
Number of output pages of large-sized paper defined at 08-353
Small:Number of output pages other than set as large-sized paper
Total:Total number out-put pages of all paper sizes.
14
323-1 Counter Small FAX 0<8 digits>
SYS 14
323-2 Counter Total FAX 0<8 digits>
SYS 14
324-0 Counter Display of number of scanning pages at Full Color Mode in Copier Func-tion
Large PPC(color)
0<8 digits>
SYS Counts the number of scanning pages at the Full Color Mode in the Copier Function according to its size (large/small).Large:
Number of output pages of large-sized paper defined at 08-353
Small:Number of output pages other than set as large-sized paper
Total:Total number out-put pages of all paper sizes.
14
324-1 Counter Small PPC(color)
0<8 digits>
SYS 14
324-2 Counter Total PPC(color)
0<8 digits>
SYS 14
325-0 Counter Display of number of scanning pages at Full Color Mode in Scanning Function
Large SCN(color)
0<8 digits>
SYS Counts the number of scanning pages at the Full Color Mode in the Scanning Function according to its size (large/small).Large:
Number of output pages of large-sized paper defined at 08-353
Small:Number of output pages other than set as large-sized paper
Total:Total number out-put pages of all paper sizes.
14
325-1 Counter Small SCN(color)
0<8 digits>
SYS 14
325-2 Counter Total SCN(color)
0<8 digits>
SYS 14
Setting mode (08)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 110
326-0 Counter Display of number of scanning pages at Twin Color Mode in Copier Func-tion
Large PPC(color)
0<8 digits>
SYS Counts the number of scanning pages at the Twin Color Mode in the Copier Function according to its size (large/small).Large:
Number of output pages of large-sized paper defined at 08-353
Small:Number of output pages other than set as large-sized paper
Total:Total number out-put pages of all paper sizes.
14
326-1 Counter Small PPC(color)
0<8 digits>
SYS 14
326-2 Counter Total PPC(color)
0<8 digits>
SYS 14
327-0 Counter Display of number of scanning pages at Black Mode in Copier Func-tion
Large PPC(black)
0<8 digits>
SYS Counts the number of scanning pages at the Black Mode in the Copier Function according to its size (large/small).Large:
Number of output pages of large-sized paper defined at 08-353
Small:Number of output pages other than set as large-sized paper
Total:Total number out-put pages of all paper sizes.
14
327-1 Counter Small PPC(black)
0<8 digits>
SYS 14
327-2 Counter Total PPC(black)
0<8 digits>
SYS 14
328-0 Counter Display of number of scanning pages in FAX Function
Large FAX 0<8 digits>
SYS Counts the number of scanning pages in the FAX Function according to its size (large/small).Large:
Number of output pages of large-sized paper defined at 08-353
Small:Number of output pages other than set as large-sized paper
Total:Total number out-put pages of all paper sizes.
14
328-1 Counter Small FAX 0<8 digits>
SYS 14
328-2 Counter Total FAX 0<8 digits>
SYS 14
Setting mode (08)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
07/04
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 111
2
329-0 Counter Display of number of scanning pages in Scanning Function
Large SCN(black)
0<8 digits>
SYS Counts the number of scanning pages in the Scanning Function according to its size (large/small).Large:
Number of output pages of large-sized paper defined at 08-353
Small:Number of output pages other than set as large-sized paper
Total:Total number out-put pages of all paper sizes.
14
329-1 Counter Small SCN(black)
0<8 digits>
SYS 14
329-2 Counter Total SCN(black)
0<8 digits>
SYS 14
330-0 Counter Display of number of transmitted pages in FAX Function
Large FAX 0<8 digits>
SYS Counts the number of transmitted pages in the FAX Function according to its size (large/small).Large:
Number of output pages of large-sized paper defined at 08-353
Small:Number of output pages other than set as large-sized paper
Total:Total number out-put pages of all paper sizes.
14
330-1 Counter Small FAX 0<8 digits>
SYS 14
330-2 Counter Total FAX 0<8 digits>
SYS 14
331 Userinterface
Default setting of screen ALL 0<0-5>
SYS Sets the screen to be displayed after the auto-clear time has passed or it has recov-ered from the energy saving mode or sleep mode.0: Copier 1: Fax 2: Scan 3: Box4: Job Status5: Template
1
Setting mode (08)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 112
332-0 Counter Display of number of received pages in FAX Function
Large FAX 0<8 digits>
SYS Counts the number of received pages in the FAX Function according to its size (large/small).Large:
Number of output pages of large-sized paper defined at 08-353
Small:Number of output pages other than set as large-sized paper
Total:Total number out-put pages of all paper sizes.
14
332-1 Counter Small FAX 0<8 digits>
SYS 14
332-2 Counter Total FAX 0<8 digits>
SYS 14
333-0 Counter Display of total number of pages at Full Color Mode
Large ALL(color)
0<8 digits>
SYS Displays the total num-ber of pages at Full Color Mode in the Copier/Printer/Scan-ning Functions.
14
333-1 Counter Small ALL(color)
0<8 digits>
SYS 14
333-2 Counter Total ALL(color)
0<8 digits>
SYS 14
334-0 Counter Display of total number of pages at Twin Color Mode
Large ALL(color)
0<8 digits>
SYS Displays the total num-ber of pages at Twin Color Mode in the Copier Function.
14
334-1 Counter Small ALL(color)
0<8 digits>
SYS 14
334-2 Counter Total ALL(color)
0<8 digits>
SYS 14
335-0 Counter Display of total number of pages at Black Mode
Large ALL(black)
0<8 digits>
SYS Displays the total num-ber of pages at Black Mode in the Copier/Printer/Scanning/FAX Functions.
14
335-1 Counter Small ALL(black)
0<8 digits>
SYS 14
335-2 Counter Total ALL(black)
0<8 digits>
SYS 14
342 User interface
Displaying number of original pages placed on original glass
PPC 0<0-1>
SYS This setting is whether the number of pages of originals placed on the original glass is dis-played or not.0: Not displayed1: Displayed
1
343 User interface
Black-free function ALL 0<0-1>
SYS 0: Disabled1: EnabledWhen "1" (enabled) is set at this code, "1" (black) is automatically set at the code 08-588.
1
344 Counter Count setting of tab paper (PM)
ALL 1<0-1>
M 0: Counted as 11: Counted as 2
1
346 Counter Count setting of large-sized paper (PM)
ALL 1<0-1>
M 0: Counted as 11: Counted as 2
1
347 Counter Definition setting of large-sized paper (PM)
ALL 1<0-1>
M 0: A3/LD1: A3/LD/B4/LG/
FOLIO/COMP
1
Setting mode (08)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 113
2
348 Counter Count setting of thick paper (PM)
ALL 1<0-1>
M 0: Counted as 11: Counted as 2
1
349 Counter Count setting of OHP film (PM)
ALL 1<0-1>
M 0: Counted as 1 1: Counted as 2
1
352 Counter Count setting of large-sized paper (Fee charging system counter)
ALL JPN: 0 OTHER:
1<0-2>
M 0: Counted as 11: Counted as 22: Counted as 1
(Mechanical counter is double counter)
1
353 Counter Definition setting of large-sized paper (Fee charging system counter)
ALL 0<0-1>
M 0: A3/LD1: A3/LD/B4/LG/
FOLIO/COMP/8k
1
356 Counter Counter for upper drawer feeding
ALL 0<8 digits>
M Counts the number of sheets fed from upper drawer
2
357 Counter Counter for lower drawer feeding
ALL 0<8 digits>
M Counts the number of sheets fed from lower drawer
2
358 Counter Counter for bypass feeding ALL 0<8 digits>
M Counts the number of sheets fed from bypass feed
2
359 Counter Counter for LCF feeding ALL 0<8 digits>
M Counts the number of sheets fed from LCF
2
360 Counter Counter for PFP upper drawer feeding
ALL 0<8 digits>
M Counts the number of sheets fed from PFP upper drawer
2
370 Counter Counter for PFP lower drawer feeding
ALL 0<8 digits>
M Counts the number of sheets fed from PFP lower drawer
2
372 Counter Counter for ADU ALL 0<8 digits>
M Counts the number of output pages of duplex printing.
2
374 Counter Counter for RADF ALL 0<8 digits>
SYS Counts the number of originals fed from RADF
2
375 Mainte-nance
Setting value of PM driving counter display/0 clearing
ALL Refer to content
<8 digits>
M <Default>e-STUDIO281c
JPN:0UC, EUR: 315,000
e-STUDIO351cJPN:0UC, EUR: 315,000
e-STUDIO451cJPN: 0UC, EUR: 315,000
1
376 Mainte-nance
Current value of PM driving counter
ALL 0<8 digits>
M Counts the drum driving time (main motor ON).
1
381 Counter Setting for counter installed externally
ALL 1<0-7>
M Selects the job to count up for the external counter.0: Not selected 1: Copier 2: FAX3: Copier/FAX4: Printer5: Copier/Printer6: Printer/FAX7: Copier/Printer/FAX
1
Setting mode (08)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
10/06
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 114
390 Counter Number of errors in HDD (Copying)
PPC 0<8 digits>
SYS The number of error is reset at HDD format-ting.
2
391 Counter Number of errors in HDD (FAX)
FAX 0<8 digits>
SYS 2
392 Counter Number of errors in HDD (Scanning)
SCN 0<8 digits>
SYS 2
393 Counter Number of errors in HDD (Printer)
PRT 0<8 digits>
SYS 2
398 Laser Number of polygonal motor rotational speed switching
ALL 0<8 digits>
M Counts the number of time the polygonal motor has switched its rotational speed between normal rota-tion and standby rota-tion
2
399 Laser Accumulated time of polyg-onal motor at normal rota-tion
ALL 0<8 digits>
M Accumulates the time the polygonal motor has rotated at normal rota-tion.
2
400 Fuser Fuser unit error status counter
ALL 0<0-29>
M 0: No error 1: C411 2: C4123: C433 4: -5: C445 6: C4467: C447 8: -9: C449 10: C47511: C471 12: C47213: - 14: -15: C480 16: -17: C490 18: -19: C449 20: -21: C449 22: C44923: C449 24: C44725: C449 26: -27: C449 28: -29: C449
1
409 Fuser Fuser roller temperature at a energy saver mode (Center thermistor)
ALL 13<0-16>
M 0: OFF 1: 40°C2: 45°C 3: 50°C4: 55°C 5: 60°C6: 65°C 7: 70°C8: 75°C 9: 80°C10: 85°C 11: 90°C12: 95°C 13: 100°C14: 105°C 15: 110°C16:115°C
1
410-0 Fuser Fuser roller temperature during printing (Center thermistor/Plain paper)
ALL(black)
12<0-16>
M 0: 120°C 1: 125°C 2: 130°C 3: 135°C4: 140°C 5: 145°C6: 150°C 7: 155°C8: 160°C 9: 165°C10: 170°C 11: 175°C12: 180°C 13: 185°C14: 190°C 15: 195°C16: 200°C
4
410-1 Fuser ALL(color)
11<0-16>
M 4
Setting mode (08)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 115
2
411 Fuser Fuser roller temperature on standby (Center ther-mistor)
ALL 12<0-16>
M 0: 120°C 1: 125°C2: 130°C 3: 135°C4: 140°C 5: 145°C6: 150°C 7: 155°C8: 160°C 9: 165°C10: 170°C 11: 175°C12: 180°C 13: 185°C14: 190°C 15: 195°C16: 200°C
1
412-0 Fuser Fuser roller temperature during printing (Center thermistor/Thick paper 3)
ALL(black)
12<0-16>
M 0: 120°C 1: 125°C2: 130°C 3: 135°C4: 140°C 5: 145°C6: 150°C 7: 155°C8: 160°C 9: 165°C10: 170°C 11: 175°C12: 180°C 13: 185°C14: 190°C 15: 195°C16: 200°C
4
412-1 ALL(color)
12<0-16>
M 4
413-0 Fuser Fuser roller temperature during printing (Center thermistor/Thick paper 1)
ALL(black)
12<0-16>
M 0: 120°C 1: 125°C2: 130°C 3: 135°C4: 140°C 5: 145°C6: 150°C 7: 155°C8: 160°C 9: 165°C10: 170°C 11: 175°C12: 180°C 13: 185°C14: 190°C 15: 195°C16: 200°C
4
413-1 ALL(color)
12<0-16>
M 4
415-0 Fuser Period of time retaining print-start temperature (Thick paper 3)
ALL(black)
3<0-10>
M 0: Invalid 1: 1 sec.2: 2 sec 3: 3 sec 4: 4 sec. 5: 5 sec.6: 6 sec. 7: 7 sec.8: 8 sec. 9: 9 sec.10: 10 sec.
4
415-1 ALL(color)
2<0-10>
M 4
416 Fuser Temperature setting to start solving abnormality (Center/Side thermistor/ Thick paper 3)
ALL 9<0-12>
M 0: 120°C 1: 125°C2: 130°C 3: 135°C4: 140°C 5: 145°C6: 150°C 7: 155°C8: 160°C 9: 165°C10: 170°C 11: 175°C12: Invalid
1
417-0 Fuser Pre-running time for first printing (Thick paper 3)
ALL(black)
16<0-16>
M 0: Invalid 1: 0 sec.2: 2 sec. 3: 3 sec.4: 4 sec. 5: 5 sec.6: 6 sec. 7: 7 sec.8: 8 sec. 9: 10 sec.10: 12 sec. 11: 14 sec.12: 16 sec. 13: 18 sec.14: 20 sec. 15: 25 sec.16: 30 sec.
4
417-1 ALL(color)
0<0-16>
M 4
422 Fuser Fuser roller temperature setting at the end of pre-running during warming-up
ALL 4<0-16>
M 0: 120°C 1: 125°C2: 130°C 3: 135°C4: 140°C 5: 145°C6: 150°C 7: 155°C8: 160°C 9: 165°C10: 170°C 11: 175°C12: 180°C 13: 185°C14: 190°C 15: 195°C16: 200°C
1
Setting mode (08)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 116
428-0 Fuser Period of time retaining print-start temperature (Thick paper 2)
ALL(black)
3<0-10>
M 0: Invalid 1: 1 sec.2: 2 sec. 3: 3 sec. 4: 4 sec. 5: 5 sec.6: 6 sec. 7: 7 sec. 8: 8 sec. 9: 9 sec.10: 10 sec.
4
428-1 ALL(color)
2<0-10>
M 4
430 Fuser Transport motor speed deceleration (OHP film)
ALL(color)
1<0-3>
M Sets deceleration ratio of paper transport speed.0: 1/1 1: 1/22: 1/3 3: 1/4
1
431 Transport motor speed deceleration (Thick paper 2)
ALL(color)
1<0-3>
M 1
432 Transport motor speed deceleration (Thick paper 3)
ALL(color)
2<0-3>
M 1
436 Fuser Temperature setting to start solving abnormal-ity(Center/Side thermistor/Thick paper2)
ALL 9<0-12>
M 0: 120°C 1: 125°C 2: 130°C 3: 135°C 4: 140°C 5: 145°C6: 150°C 7: 155°C 8: 160°C 9: 165°C 10: 170°C 11: 175°C12: Invalid
1
437-0 Fuser Fuser roller temperature during printing (Center thermistor /Thick paper 2)
ALL(black)
12<0-16>
M 0: 120°C 1: 125°C2: 130°C 3: 135°C4: 140°C 5: 145°C6: 150°C 7: 155°C8: 160°C 9: 165°C10: 170°C 11: 175°C12: 180°C 13: 185°C14: 190°C 15: 195°C16: 200°C
4
437-1 ALL(color)
12<0-16>
M 4
438-0 Fuser Fuser roller temperature during printing (Center thermistor/OHP film)
ALL(black)
12<0-16>
M 0: 120°C 1: 125°C2: 130°C 3: 135°C 4: 140°C 5: 145°C6: 150°C 7: 155°C8: 160°C 9: 165°C 10: 170°C 11: 175°C12: 180°C 13: 185°C14: 190°C 15: 195°C16: 200°C
4
438-1 ALL(color)
10<0-16>
M 4
439-0 Fuser Pre-running time for first printing (Thick paper 2)
ALL(black)
14<0-16>
M 0: Invalid 1: 0 sec.2: 2 sec. 3: 3 sec.4: 4 sec. 5: 5 sec.6: 6 sec. 7: 7 sec.8: 8 sec. 9: 10 sec.10: 12 sec.11: 14 sec.12: 16 sec.13: 18 sec.14: 20 sec.15: 25 sec.16: 30 sec.
4
439-1 ALL(color)
0<0-16>
M 4
Setting mode (08)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 117
2
440-0 Fuser Pre-running time for first printing (Plain paper/Low tempera-ture environment)
ALL(black)
12<0-16>
M 0: Invalid 1: 0 sec.2: 2 sec. 3: 3 sec. 4: 4 sec. 5: 5 sec.6: 6 sec. 7: 7 sec. 8: 8 sec. 9: 10 sec. 10: 12 sec.11: 14 sec.12: 16 sec.13: 18 sec.14: 20 sec.15: 25 sec.16: 30 sec.
4
440-1 ALL(color)
0<0-16>
M 4
441-0 Fuser Pre-running time for first printing (Thick paper 1)
ALL(black)
9<0-16>
M 0: Invalid 1: 0 sec.2: 2 sec. 3: 3 sec. 4: 4 sec. 5: 5 sec.6: 6 sec. 7: 7 sec.8: 8 sec. 9: 10 sec.10: 12 sec.11: 14 sec.12: 16 sec.13: 18 sec.14: 20 sec.15: 25 sec.16: 30 sec.
4
441-1 ALL(color)
5<0-16>
M 4
449 Paper feeding
Switching for incorrect paper size jam detection
ALL 0<0-1>
M 0: Enabled1: Disabled
1
458 Fuser Threshold for warming-up temperature(Low-tempera-ture environment)
ALL 6<0-11>
M 0: 0°C 1: 5°C2: 9°C 3: 10°C4: 12°C 5: 14°C6: 15°C 7: 16°C8: 17°C 9: 18°C 10: 19°C 11: 20°C
1
459 Fuser Warming-up time(Low-tem-perature environment)
ALL 7<0-11>
M 0: No warming-up 1: 30 sec. 2: 40 sec. 3: 50 sec. 4: 60 sec.5: 70 sec. 6: 80 sec. 7: 90 sec.8: 100 sec.9: 120 sec.10: 180 sec.11: 300 sec.
1
460 Fuser Threshold of temperature for pre-running time for first printing(Low-temperature environment)
ALL 9<0-11>
M 0: 0°C 1: 5°C2: 9°C 3: 10°C4: 12°C 5: 14°C6: 15°C 7: 16°C8: 17°C 9: 18°C10: 19°C 11: 20°C
1
461 Fuser Pre-running time for first printing(Plain paper/Low-temperature environment)
ALL 8<0-11>
M 0: Invalid (always) 1: 0 min. 2: 0.5 min.3: 1 min. 4: 2 min.5: 3 min. 6: 5 min.7: 7 min. 8: 10 min.9: 15 min. 10: 30 min.11: 60 min.
1
Setting mode (08)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
06/08
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 118
462 RADF Setting for switchback operation in mixed-size copying using RADF
ALL 0<0-2>
SYS This setting is whether the original length is detected or not by transporting without scanning in reverse when A4-R/FOLIO paper or LT-R/LG paper is detected in a mixed-size copying. 0: Disabled - AMS:
A series - Judges as A4-R without trans-porting in reverse with no scanning. LT series - Judges whether it is LT-R or LG by its length without transporting in reverse with no scanning.
APS:A series - Judges whether it is A4-R or FOLIO without transporting in reverse with no scanning.LT series - Judges whether it is LT-R or LG without trans-porting in reverse with no scanning.
1: Enable 1 AMS:
A series - Judges whether it is A4-R or FOLIO by transport-ing without scanning in reverse to detect its length.LT series - Judges whether it is LT-R or LG by transporting without scanning in reverse to detect its length.
APS:The same as that of APS in 0: Disabled.
2: Enable 2 AMS/APS:
The same as that of AMS in 1: Enable 1.
1
463-0 Paper feeding
Feeding retry number set-ting (upper drawer)
Plain paper
ALL 5<0-5>
M Sets the number of times of the feeding retry from the upper drawer.
4
463-1 Others ALL 5<0-5>
M 4
Setting mode (08)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 119
2
464-0 Paper feeding
Feeding retry number set-ting (lower drawer)
Plain paper
ALL 5<0-5>
M Sets the number of times of the feeding retry from the lower drawer.
4
464-1 Others ALL 5<0-5>
M 4
465-0 Paper feeding
Feeding retry number set-ting (PFP upper drawer)
Plain paper
ALL 5<0-5>
M Sets the number of times of the feeding retry from the PFP upper drawer.
4
465-1 Others ALL 5<0-5>
M 4
466-0 Paper feeding
Feeding retry number set-ting (PFP lower drawer)
Plain paper
ALL 5<0-5>
M Sets the number of times of the feeding retry from the PFP lower drawer.
4
466-1 Others ALL 5<0-5>
M 4
467-0 Paper feeding
Feeding retry number set-ting (bypass feed)
Plain paper
ALL 5<0-5>
M Sets the number of times of the feeding retry from the bypass tray.
4
467-1 Others ALL 5<0-5>
M 4
468-0 Paper feeding
Feeding retry number set-ting (LCF)
Plain paper
ALL 5<0-5>
M Sets the number of times of the feeding retry from the LCF.
4
468-1 Others ALL 5<0-5>
M 4
470 Paper feeding
Paper size (305x457 mm) feeding/widthwise direction
ALL 457/305<148-
457/105-305>
M 10
471 Paper feeding
Paper size (Post card) feeding/widthwise direction
ALL 148/100<148-
432/100-297>
M * Post card is sup-ported only for JPN model.
10
478 Laser Judged number of polygo-nal motor rotation error (Normal rotation)
ALL 0<0-1>
M Displays the error [CA10] when the set number of rotation error has been detected.0: 2 times1: 12 times
1
479 Laser Judged number of polygo-nal motor rotation error (At acceleration/deceleration)
ALL 0<0-1>
M 0: Waiting time for polygonal motor rotation overshoot-ing 0.6 sec.
1: Waiting time for polygonal motor rotation overshoot-ing 2.2 sec.
1
480 Paper feeding
Default setting of paper source
PPC 0<0-5>
SYS 0: A4/LT1: LCF2: Upper drawer 3: Lower drawer4: PFP upper drawer5: PFP lower drawer
1
Setting mode (08)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 120
481 Paper feeding
Automatic change of paper source
PPC 1<0-2>
SYS Sets whether or not changing the drawer automatically to the other drawer with the paper of the same size when paper in the selected drawer has run out.0: OFF1: ON (Changes to the
drawer with the same paper direc-tion and size: ex. A4 to A4)
2: ON (Changes to the drawer with the same paper size. Paper with the dif-ferent direction is acceptable as long as the size is the same: ex., A4 to A4-R, LT-R to LT. “1” is applied when the staple/holepunch is specified.)
1
482 Paper feeding
Feeding retry setting ALL 0<0-1>
M 0: ON 1: OFF
1
483 Laser Pre-running rotation of polygonal motor
ALL 0<0-2>
SYS Sets whether or not switching the polygonal motor from the standby rotation to the normal rotation when the origi-nal is set on the RADF or the platen cover is opened.0: Valid (when using
RADF and the origi-nal is set manually)
1: Invalid2: Valid (when using
RADF only)
1
484 Laser Polygonal motor rotational status switching at the Auto Clear Mode
ALL 0<0-1>
SYS Sets whether or not switching the polygonal motor from the normal rotation to the standby rotation at the Auto Clear Mode.0: Valid 1: Invalid
1
485 Laser Rotational status of polygo-nal motor on standby
ALL 0<0-1>
SYS Sets the rotational sta-tus of polygonal motor on standby.0: Rotated (The rota-
tional speed is set at 08-490.)
1: Stopped
1
Setting mode (08)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 121
2
486 Laser Timing of auto-clearing of polygonal motor pre-run-ning rotation
ALL 0<0-2>
SYS Switches the polygonal motor to the standby rotation when a certain period of time has passed from the pre-running. At this code, the period to switch the status to the standby rotation is set.0: 15 sec.1: 30 sec.2: 45 sec.* This setting is effec-
tive when “0” or “2” is set at 08-483.
1
487 Transfer Selection of performing the 2nd transfer roller cleaning (Bypass feed)
ALL 0<0-1>
M 0: Performs only at no paper size is desig-nated
1: Performs regardless of designation of paper size
1
488 Laser Setting of polygonal motor type
ALL 3<2-3>
M Set the type of polygo-nal motor.2: 2 clock type3: 3 clock type
1
489 Laser Polygonal motor rotation number on standby
ALL 5<0-5>
M 0: 38090.55rpm1: 35000rpm2: 30000rpm3: 25000rpm4: 20000rpm 5: 10000rpm
1
490 Laser Polygonal motor rotation in the energy saving mode
ALL 0<0-1>
M 0: Stopped1: 10000rpm.
1
497 General Speed switching for color printing
ALL(color)
0<0-1>
M Sets the speed for color printing.0: 11 pages/minute1: 6 pages/minute
1
502 Image Error diffusion and dither setting at photo mode
PPC(black)
0<0-1>
SYS Sets the image repro-duction method at photo mode.0: Error diffusion1: Dither
1
503 User interface
Default setting of density adjustment
PPC(black)
0<0-1>
SYS 0: Automatic1: Manual (Center)
1
511 Main charger
Main charger wire auto-cleaning setting
ALL 1<0-1>
M 0: Invalid1: Valid
1
526-0 Fuser Pre-running time for first printing(OHP film)
ALL(black)
16<0-16>
M 0: Invalid 1: 0 sec. 2: 2 sec. 3: 3 sec. 4: 4 sec. 5: 5 sec.6: 6 sec. 7: 7 sec. 8: 8 sec. 9: 10 sec. 10: 12 sec.11: 14 sec.12: 16 sec.13: 18 sec.14: 20 sec.15: 25 sec.16: 30 sec.
4
526-1 ALL(color)
0<0-16>
M 4
Setting mode (08)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 122
544 Imagecontrol
Environment correction control of 2nd transfer roller bias
ALL 1<0-1>
M Sets whether or not cor-recting the 2nd transfer roller bias depending on the environment.0: Invalid 1: Valid
1
545 Imagecontrol
Transfer belt life correction of 2nd transfer roller bias
ALL 1<0-1>
M Sets whether or not cor-recting the 2nd transfer roller bias depending on the transfer belt life.0: Invalid1: Valid
1
546 Imagecontrol
2nd transfer roller life cor-rection of 2nd transfer roller bias
ALL 1<0-1>
M Sets whether or not cor-recting the 2nd transfer roller bias depending on the 2nd transfer roller life.0: Invalid1: Valid
1
548 Transfer Setting of 2nd transfer roller bias table (for each destination/paper thick-ness)
ALL EUR:0UC:1JPN:2<0-2>
M 0:80 g/m2 (21.3 lb.)/EUR1: 75 g/m2 (20 lb.)/UC2: 64 g/m2 (17.1 lb.)/
JPN
1
549 Imagecontrol
Image quality control/open-loop control 1
ALL 1<0-1>
M Sets whether or not performing the open-loop control 1.The open-loop control 1 is performed in advance of the closed-loop con-trol.0: Invalid1: Valid
1
550 Image Default setting of Original mode
PPC(black)
0<0-3>
SYS 0: Text/Photo1: Photo2: Text3: Gray Scale
1
551 Imagecontrol
Image quality control/open-loop control 2
ALL 1<0-1>
M Sets whether or not performing the open-loop control 2.The open-loop control 2 is performed before or during printing.0: Invalid 1: Valid
1
552 Imagecontrol
Drum life correction control ALL 1<0-1>
M Sets whether or not cor-recting the drum volt-age depending on the drum life in open-loop control.0: Invalid 1: Valid
1
Setting mode (08)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 123
2
553 Imagecontrol
Drum temperature correc-tion control
ALL 1<0-1>
M Sets whether or not cor-recting the drum volt-age depending on the drum surface tempera-ture in open-loop con-trol.0: Invalid 1: Valid
1
554 Imagecontrol
Image quality open-loop control/Contrast voltage initial value
ALL 1<0-1>
M Sets whether or not deciding the initial value of contrast voltage in open-loop control.0: Invalid1: Valid
1
555 Image control
Drum life correction of laser power initial value
ALL 1<0-1>
M Sets whether or not cor-recting the laser power depending on the drum life when the laser power initial value is set in open-loop control.0: Invalid1: Valid
1
556 Image control
Image quality closed-loop control/Contrast voltage
ALL 1<0-1>
M Sets whether or not cor-recting the contrast volt-age in closed-loop control.0: Invalid 1: Valid
1
557 Image control
Image quality closed-loop control/Laser power
ALL 1<0-1>
M Sets whether or not cor-recting the laser power in closed-loop control.0: Invalid 1: Valid
1
558 Image control
Contrast voltage/Correc-tion gain environment set-ting
ALL 1<0-1>
M Sets whether or not switching the correc-tion amount once at contrast voltage correc-tion depending on the environment.0: Invalid 1: Valid
1
559 Image control
Image quality closed-loop control automatic start-up/At power-ON
ALL (color)
1<0-2>
M Sets whether perform-ing closed-loop control automatically at power-ON when the fuser roller temperature becomes below the specified level.0: Invalid 1: Valid (at mode 1)2: Valid (at mode 2)
1
560 Imagel Process switching for image smoothing (Text/Photo)
PPC (black)
1<0-1>
M Sets whether or not performing a smooth-ing process (primary scanning direction, 2,400 dpi or equiva-lent).0: Invalid1: Valid
1
Setting mode (08)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 124
561 Image Process switching for image smoothing (Photo)
PPC (black)
0<0-1>
M Sets whether or not performing a smooth-ing process (primary scanning direction, 2,400 dpi or equiva-lent).0: Invalid1: Valid
1
562 Image Process switching for image smoothing (Text)
PPC (black)
1<0-1>
M 1
565 Image control
Image quality closed-loop control automatic start-up/ Relative humidity variation
ALL (color)
1<0-2>
M Sets whether or not performing closed-loop control automatically when the relative humidity becomes below the specified level from the previous control.0: Invalid 1: Valid (at mode 1)2: Valid (at mode 2)
1
566 Image control
Image quality closed-loop control automatic start-up/ Period of time unattended
ALL (color)
1<0-2>
M Sets whether or not performing closed-loop control automatically when the equipment has not been used for a specified period of time.0: Invalid1: Valid (at mode 1)2: Valid (at mode 2)
1
567 Image control
Image quality closed-loop control automatic start-up/ Accumulated print volume
ALL (color)
2<0-2>
M Sets whether or not performing closed-loop control automatically when the specified number of sheets has been printed out from the previous control.0: Invalid 1: Valid (at mode 1)2: Valid (at mode 2)
1
568 Image control
Image quality closed-loop control automatic start-up/When recovered from “Toner empty”
ALL(color)
2<0-2>
M Sets whether or not performing closed-loop control automatically when recovered from “Toner empty”.0: Invalid 1: Valid (at mode 1)2: Valid (at mode 2)
1
Setting mode (08)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 125
2
569 Image control
Image quality closed-loop control automatic start-up/Temperature setting of fuser roller at power-ON
ALL(color)
8<0-20>
M Sets the fuser roller temperature to perform closed-loop control when “1” or “2” (valid) is set in 08-559. 0: 20°C 1: 25°C2: 30°C 3: 35°C4: 40°C 5: 45°C6: 50°C 7: 55°C8: 60°C 9: 65°C10: 70°C 11: 75°C12: 80°C 13: 85°C14: 90°C 15: 95°C16: 100°C 17: 105°C18: 110°C 19: 115°C20: 120°C
1
570 Image control
Image quality closed-loop control automatic start-up/Relative humidity differ-ence setting
ALL(color)
4<0-6>
M Sets the relative humid-ity difference to per-form the closed-loop control when “1” or “2” (valid) is set in 08-565.0: 0% 1: 5%2: 10% 3: 15%4: 20% 5: 25% 6: 30%
1
571 Image control
Image quality closed-loop control automatic start-up/Setting of period of time unattended
ALL(color)
4<0-24>
M Sets the period of time unattended to perform closed-loop control when “1” or “2” (valid) is set in 08-566.Setting value x 1 (hour)
1
572 Image control
Image quality closed-loop control automatic start-up/Setting of accumulated print volume
ALL(color)
10<0-30>
M Sets the number of accumulated print vol-ume to perform closed-loop control when “1” or “2” (valid) is set in 08-567.Setting value x 100 (pages)
1
573 Image control
Abnormality detection count (Y)Display/0 clearing
ALL 0<0-16>
M Counts the abnormality detection of image qual-ity control. Accumulat-ing total of [CE10], [CE20] and [CE40]
1
574 Image control
Abnormality detection count (M)Display/0 clearing
ALL 0<0-16>
M Counts the abnormality detection of image qual-ity control. Accumulat-ing total of [CE10], [CE20] and [CE40]
1
575 Image control
Abnormality detection count (C)Display/0 clearing
ALL 0<0-16>
M Counts the abnormality detection of image qual-ity control. Accumulat-ing total of [CE10], [CE20] and [CE40]
1
576 Image control
Abnormality detection count (K)Display/0 clearing
ALL 0<0-16>
M Counts the abnormality detection of image qual-ity control. Accumulat-ing total of [CE10], [CE20] and [CE40]
1
Setting mode (08)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 126
583-0 Fuser Pre-running time at power-ON and ready status
Transport motor speed 1/1
ALL 1<0-10>
M 0: 3 sec. 1: 6 sec.2: 9 sec. 3: 12 sec.4: 15 sec. 5: 18 sec.6: 21 sec. 7: 24 sec.8: 27 sec. 9: 30 sec.10: 33 sec.
4
583-1 Transport motor speed 1/2
ALL 4<0-10>
M 4
583-2 Transport motor speed 1/3
ALL 7<0-10>
M 4
584 Fuser Transport motor speed of pre-running at ready status
ALL 0<0-2>
M 0: Decelerating to 1/11: Decelerating to 1/22: Decelerating to 1/3
1
585 User interface
Default setting of Original mode
PPC(color)
0<0-4>
SYS 0: Text/Photo 1: Text2: Printed image3: Photo4: Map
1
586 Image Image quality switching when selecting the Image Smoothing Mode
PPC(black)
0<0-1>
SYS Selects the method of image processing when the Image Smoothing is selected in the original modes.0: Processing for
Image Smoothing1: Processing when
judging as black in the ACS Mode
1
587 User interface
Default setting of Density mode
PPC(color)
1<0-1>
SYS 0: Automatic1: Manual (Center)
1
588 User interface
Default setting of Color mode
PPC 1<0-2>
SYS 0: Auto color1: Black2: Full color
1
589 Image Image quality switching when judging as black in the ACS Mode
PPC(black)
1<0-1>
SYS Selects the method of image processing when the original is judged as black in the ACS Mode.0: Processing for
Image Smoothing1: Processing when
judging as black in the ACS Mode
1
595 Image Scanning operation switch-ing at automatic calibration
PPC(color)
0<0-1>
SYS 0: Scanning color/black integrated pat-tern
1: Scanning color pat-tern only
1
597 Image Gamma correction table all clearing
PRT(color)
- SYS Initializes the status of automatic gamma adjustment in color printing.
3
602 User interface
Screen setting for auto-matic energy saver/auto-matic power OFF
ALL EUR:0UC:1JPN:1<0-1>
SYS 0: OFF1: ON
1
Setting mode (08)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 127
2
603 User interface
Setting for automatic duplexing mode
ALL 0<0-3>
SYS 0: Invalid1: Single-sided to
duplex copying2: Two-sided to duplex
copying3: User selection
1
604 User interface
Default setting for APS/AMS
ALL 0<0-2>
SYS 0: APS (Automatic Paper Selection)
1: AMS (Automatic Magnification Selec-tion)
2: Not selected
1
605 User interface
Centering printing of pri-mary/secondary direction at AMS
PPC 1<0-1>
SYS 0: Invalid 1: Valid
1
607 User interface
Default setting of RADF mode
PPC 0<0-1>
SYS 0: Continuous feeding (by pressing the [START] button)
1: Single feeding(by setting original on the tray)
1
609-0 Image Binarizing level setting(When judg-ing as black in the ACS Mode)
Step -2 ALL 88<0-255>
SYS Sets the binarizing level of each step.When the value increases, the image becomes darker. When the value decreases, the image becomes lighter.* Refer to 08-268.
4
609-1 Step -1 ALL 108<0-255>
SYS 4
609-2 Step 0 (center)
ALL 148<0-255>
SYS 4
609-3 Step +1 ALL 178<0-255>
SYS 4
609-4 Step +2 ALL 208<0-255>
SYS 4
610 User interface
Key touch sound of control panel
ALL 1<0-1>
SYS 0: OFF1: ON
1
611 User interface
Book type original priority PPC 0<0-1>
SYS 0: Left page to right page
1: Right page to left page
1
612 General Summer time mode ALL 0<0-1>
SYS 0: Not summer time1: Summer time
1
613 User interface
Paper size selection for [OTHER] button
PPC EUR: FOLIO
UC:COMP
JPN:A5-R
SYS Press the icon on the LCD to select the size.
9
614 Network Local I/F time-out period ALL 6<1-50>
SYS Sets the period of time when the job is judged as completed in local I/F printing (USB or par-allel).1: 1.0 sec.2: 1.5 sec.50: 25.5 sec. (in increments of 0.5 sec.)
1
Setting mode (08)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 128
615 General Size information of main memory and page memory
ALL - SYS Displays the sizes of the main memory and page memory. Enables to check if each mem-ory is properly recog-nized.
2
616 Counter Counting method in Twin Color Mode(Limitation Function)
ALL JPN: 1UC: 0
EUR: 0<0-1>
SYS Sets the counting method in Twin Color Mode with the Limita-tion Function.0: Count as color1: Count as black
1
617 User interface
Print setting without department code
ALL 1<0-2>
SYS 0: Printed forcibly1: Not printed2: Deleted forcibly
1
618 User interface
Default setting of RADF original size
PPC 0<0-1>
SYS 0: Same size originals1: Mixed size originals
1
619 Paper feeding
Time lag before auto-start of bypass feeding
ALL 4<0-10>
SYS Sets the time taken to add paper feeding when paper in the bypass tray has run out during the bypass feed copying.0: No delay1-10: Setting value x
0.5sec.
1
620 User interface
Department management setting (Copier)
PPC 1<0-1>
SYS 0: Invalid1: Valid
1
621 User interface
Department management setting (FAX)
FAX 1<0-1>
SYS 0: Invalid1: Valid
1
622 User interface
Department management setting (Printer)
PRT 1<0-1>
SYS 0: Invalid1: Valid
1
623 User interface
Department management setting (Scanner)
SCN 1<0-1>
SYS 0: Invalid1: Valid
1
624 User interface
Department management setting (List print)
PRT 1<0-1>
SYS 0: Invalid1: Valid
1
625 User interface
Blank copying prevention mode during RADF jam-ming
PPC 0<0-1>
SYS 0: OFF1: ON (Start printing
when the scanning of each page is fin-ished)
1
627 User interface
Rotation printing at the nonsorting
ALL 0<0-1>
SYS 0: Not rotating1: Rotating
1
628 User interface
Direction priority of original image
PPC 0<0-1>
SYS 0: Automatic1: Portrait
1
629 User interface
Department management setting
ALL 0<0-1>
SYS 0: Invalid1: Valid
1
632 User interface
Automatic calibration dis-closure level
PPC 1<0-2>
SYS Sets the disclosing level of automatic calibration.0: Service technician1: Administrator 2: User
1
633 Dataoverwrite
kit
Releasing F200 service call
ALL 0<0-2>
SYS 0: Not used1: Board installed2: Service call
1
634 User interface
Inner receiving tray priority at Non-sort Mode
ALL 0<0-1>
SYS 0: Normal1: Inner receiving tray
1
Setting mode (08)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
09/01
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 129
2
636 User interface
Width setting for image shift copying (linkage of front side and back side)
PPC 0<0-1>
SYS 0: ON1: OFF
1
638 General Time differences ALL EUR: 24UC: 40JPN: 6<0-47>
SYS 0: +12.0h 1: +11.5h2: +11.0h 3: +10.5h4: +10.0h 5: 9.5h6: +9.0h 7: +8.5h8: +8.0h 9: +7.5h10: +7.0h 11: +6.5h12: +6.0h 13: +5.5h14: +5.0h 15: +4.5h16: +4.0h 17: +3.5h18: +3.0h 19: +2.5h20: +2.0h 21: +1.5h22: +1.0h 23: +0.5h24: 0.0h 25:-0.5h 26: -1.0h 27: -1.5h28: -2.0h 29: -2.5h30: -3.0h 31: -3.5h32: -4.0h 33: -4.5h34: -5.0h 35: -5.5h36: -6.0h 37: -6.5h38: -7.0h 39: -7.5h40: -8.0h 41: -8.5h42: -9.0h 43: -9.5h44: -10.0h 45: -10.5h46: -11.0h 47: -11.5h
1
640 User interface
Date display format ALL EUR:1UC:2JPN:0<0-2>
SYS 0: YYYY.MM.DD.1: DD.MM.YYYY2: MM.DD.YYYY
1
641 User interface
Automatic Sorting Mode setting (RADF)
PPC 2<0-4>
SYS 0: Invalid1: STAPLE2: SORT3: GROUP4: ROTATE SORT
1
642 User interface
Default setting of Sorter Mode
PPC 0<0-4>
SYS 0: NON-SORT1: STAPLE2: SORT3: GROUP4: ROTATE SORT
1
643 User interface
Color 1 at twin color selec-tion (Select what color black in original is copied)
PPC (color)
0<0-6>
SYS 0: K 1: Y 2: M3: C 4: R 5: G6: B
1
644 User interface
Color 2 at twin color selec-tion (Select what color other than black in original is copied)
PPC (color)
4<0-6>
SYS 0: K 1: Y 2: M3: C 4: R 5: G6: B
1
Setting mode (08)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
07/04
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 130
645 User interface
Correction of reproduction ratio in editing copy
PPC 10<0-10>
SYS Sets the reproduction ratio for the “X in 1” printing (including mag-azine sort) to the “Reproduction ratio x Correction ratio”.0: 90% 1: 91%2: 92% 3: 93%4: 94% 5: 95%6: 96% 7: 97%8: 98% 9: 99%10: 100%
1
646 User interface
Image position in editing PPC 2<0-3>
SYS Sets the page pasted position for “X in 1” to the upper left corner/center.0: PPC:Cornering/
PRT:Cornering1: PPC:Centering/
PRT:Cornering2: PPC:Cornering/
PRT:Centering3: PPC:Centering/
PRT:Centering
1
648 User interface
Returning finisher tray when printing is finished
ALL 0<0-1>
SYS Sets whether or not returning the finisher tray to the bin 1 when printing is finished.0: Not returned1: Returned
1
649 User interface
Magazine sort setting PPC 0<0-1>
SYS 0: Left page to right page
1: Right page to left page
1
650 User interface
2 in 1/4 in 1 page allocating order setting
PPC 0<0-1>
SYS 0: Horizontal1: Vertical
1
651 User interface
Printing format setting for Time Stamp and Page Number
PPC 2<0-3>
SYS Hyphen(with page number)/Dropout (with date, time and page number)0: OFF/OFF1: ON/OFF2: OFF/ON3: ON/ON
Note: Note: Hyphen printing formatON: -1- OFF: 1
1
652 User interface
Cascade operation setting PPC 0<0-1>
SYS 0: OFF1: ON
1
653 User interface
Cascade operation setting PRT 0<0-1>
SYS 0: OFF1: ON
1
657 User interface
Default setting of printing direction for Time Stamp and Page Number
PPC 0<0-1>
SYS 0: Short edge1: Long edge
1
Setting mode (08)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
05/11
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 131
2
658 User interface
Auto-start setting for bypass feed printing
PRT 0<0-1>
SYS Sets whether or not feeding a paper auto-matically into the copier when it is placed on the bypass tray.0: OFF (Press the
[START] button to start feeding.)
1: ON (Automatical feeding)
1
659 User interface
Auto-start setting for bypass feed printing
PPC 1<0-1>
SYS Sets whether or not feeding a paper auto-matically into the copier when it is placed on the bypass tray.0: OFF (Press the
[START] button to start feeding.)
1: ON (Automatical feeding)
1
660 Network Auto-forwarding setting of received FAX
ALL 0<0-1>
SYS 0: Invalid1: Valid
1
661 Network Auto-forwarding setting of received E-mail
ALL 0<0-1>
SYS 0: Invalid1: Valid
1
662 General Clearing of SMS partition ALL - SYS Clears SMS partition. (Performs when the service call [F106] has occurred.)
3
663 Counter Counting method in Twin Color Mode
PPC 0<0-2>
SYS Sets the counting method of fee charging or department count in Twin Color Mode.0: Count as Twin Color
Mode1: Count as Black
Mode2: Count as Full Color
Mode
1
665 General M/SYS all clearing ALL - M/SYS
Initializes all the adjust-ment modes and setting modes.
3
666 General BOX partition clearing ALL - SYS Initializes the Elec-tronic Filing.
3
667 General /SHA partition clearing ALL - SYS Initializes the shared folder.
3
669 General System all clearing ALL - SYS Initializes system NVRAM area.
3
670 General HDD diagnostic menu dis-play
ALL - SYS Display the HDD infor-mation (Chap. 5.3.6)
2
671 User interface
Size indicator ALL 0<0-1>
SYS 0: Invalid 1: Valid 1
Setting mode (08)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 132
672 General Initialization of department management information
- - SYS Initializing of the depart-ment management information* Enter the code with
the digital keys and press the [INITIAL-IZE] button to per-form the initialization.If the area storing the department management infor-mation is destroyed for some reason, “Enter Department Code” is displayed on the control panel even if the depart-ment management function is not set on. In this case, ini-tialize the area with this code. This area is normally initial-ized at the factory.
3
675-0 Paper feeding
Coated Paper Mode setting for paper source
Upper drawer
ALL 0<0-1>
SYS Sets whether or not applying the Coated Paper Mode to each paper source.0: Normal mode1: Coated Paper Mode* Coated Paper Mode
- This mode is selected when the paper which often causes the misfeed-ing (ex. coated paper) is used. The occurrence of mis-feeding is reduced by lengthening the jam detection time. However, the print-ing speed is low-ered since the printing cycle is also lengthened with the lengthened jam detection time.
4
675-1 Lower drawer
ALL 0<0-1>
SYS 4
675-2 PFP upper drawer
ALL 0<0-1>
SYS 4
675-3 PFP lower drawer
ALL 0<0-1>
SYS 4
675-4 LCF ALL 0<0-1>
SYS 4
Setting mode (08)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 133
2
676 Paper feeding
Bypass copy printing [COATED] button display
PPC 0<0-1>
SYS Sets whether or not dis-playing the [COATED] button on the LCD screen at bypass feed-ing.0: Not displayed1: Displayed (The
Coated Paper Mode is applied by press-ing the [COATED] button at bypass feeding.)
* Coated Paper Mode - This mode is selected when the paper which often causes the misfeed-ing (ex. coated paper) is used. The occurrence of mis-feeding is reduced by lengthening the jam detection time. However, the print-ing speed is low-ered since the printing cycle is also lengthened with the lengthened jam detection time.
1
677-0 Paper feeding
Coated Paper Mode setting at bypass feeding
Plain paper
PRT 0<0-1>
SYS Sets whether or not applying the Coated Paper Mode on each paper type at bypass printing.0: Normal mode1: Coated Paper Mode* Coated Paper Mode
- This mode is selected when the paper which often causes the misfeed-ing (ex. coated paper) is used. The occurrence of mis-feeding is reduced by lengthening the jam detection time. However, the print-ing speed is low-ered since the printing cycle is also lengthened with the lengthened jam detection time.
4
677-1 Thick paper 1
PRT 0<0-1>
SYS 4
677-2 Thick paper 2
PRT 0<0-1>
SYS 4
677-3 Thick paper 3
PRT 0<0-1>
SYS 4
677-4 OHP film PRT 0<0-1>
SYS 4
677-5 Envelop PRT 0<0-1>
SYS 4
Setting mode (08)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
06/08
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 134
678 General Setting of banner advertis-ing display
ALL 0<0-1>
SYS Sets whether or not dis-playing the banner advertising. The setting contents of 08-679 and 08-680 are displayed at the time display section on the right top of the screen. When both are set, each content is dis-played alternately.0: Not displayed1: Displayed
1
679 General Banner advertising display 1
ALL - SYS Maximum 27 letters (one-byte character)
11
680 General Banner advertising display 2
ALL - SYS Maximum 27 letters (one-byte character)
11
681 General Display of [BANNER MES-SAGE] button
ALL 0<0-1>
SYS 0: Not displayed1: Displayed* This button enables
the entry of “Banner advertising display 1 (08-679)” and “Ban-ner advertising dis-play 2 (08-680)” on the control panel.
1
682 Use interface
Offsetting between jobs ALL 1<0-1>
SYS 0: Invalid1: Valid
1
683 General Duplex printing setting when coin controller is used
ALL 1<0-1>
SYS When the duplex print-ing is short paid with a coin controller, reverse side of the original is not printed and is con-sidered as a defect (printing job may be cleared). To solve this problem, the selection of printing method is enabled with this set-ting.0: Invalid (Both sides
printed)1: Valid (Only one side
printed)
1
684 General Rebuilding all databases ALL - SYS Rebuilds all databases. 3685 General Rebuilding all databases
related to Address BookALL - SYS Rebuilds all databases
related to the Address Book.
3
686 General Rebuilding all databases related to log
ALL - SYS Rebuilds all databases related to the logs.
3
689 FAX Adaptation of paper source priority selection
FAX 0<0-1>
SYS 0: Not subjected for APS judgment
1: Subjected for APS judgment
1
690 General HDD formatting ALL -<2>
SYS 2: Normal formatting 7
691 General HDD type display ALL -<0-2>
SYS 0: Not formatted1: Not used2: Normal format
7
Setting mode (08)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 135
2
692 Mainte-nance
Performing panel calibra-tion
ALL - SYS Performs the calibration of the pressing position on the touch panel (LCD screen). The cali-bration is performed by pressing 2 reference positions after this code is started up.
1
693 General Initialization of NIC infor-mation
ALL - SYS Returns the value to the factory shipping default value.
3
694 General Performing HDD testing ALL - SYS Checks the bad sector. 3696 Scram-
bler board
Installation of scrambler board (Option)
ALL 0<0-1>
- 0: Not installed1: Installed
2
697 Paper feeding
Paper type priority PPC 1<1-2>
SYS Sets the paper type pri-ority during copying.1: Normal paper 2: Thick paper 1
1
698 Scram-bler
board
Entering the key code for scrambler board
ALL - - Start up this code and have the user enter the key code.Once the key code has been set, this code can-not be set again on security grounds.
5
699 Scram-bler
board
Erasing all data in HDD ALL - - This setting is effective only when the scram-bler board is installed.
3
701 FAX Destination setting for FAX FAX EUR: 5UC: 4JPN: 0
Other: 1<0-25>
SYS 0: Japan1: Asia2: Australia3: Hong Kong4: U.S.A./Canada5: Germany6: U.K. 7: Italy8: Belgium9: Netherlands10: Finland11: Spain12: Austria 13: Switzerland14: Sweden15: Denmark16: Norway 17: Portugal18: France 19: Greece20: Poland 21: Hungary22: Czech 23: Turkey24: South Africa25: Taiwan
1
Setting mode (08)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
07/04
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 136
702 Mainte-nance
Remote-controlled service function
ALL 2<0-2>
SYS 0: Valid (Remote-con-trolled server)
1: Valid (L2) 2: Invalid
1
703 Mainte-nance
Remote-controlled service HTTP server URL setting
ALL - SYS Maximum 256 Bytes 11
704-0 Interruption of stapling oper-ation (no sta-ple)
Copying ALL 1<0-1>
SYS 0: Continues printing by switching sort setting
1: Interrupts printing
4
704-1 Printing / BOX print-ing
ALL 0<0-1>
SYS 0: Continues printing by switching sort setting
1: Interrupts printing
4
707 Mainte-nance
Remote-controlled service HTTP initially-registered serverURL setting
ALL https://device.mf
p-sup-port.com:
443/device/fir-
streg-ist.ashx
SYS Maximum 256 Bytes 11
710 Mainte-nance
(Remote)
Short time interval setting of recovery from Emer-gency Mode
ALL 24<1-48>
SYS Sets the time interval to recover from the Emer-gency Mode to the Nor-mal Mode.(Unit: Hour)
1
711 Mainte-nance
Short time interval setting of Emergency Mode
ALL 60<30-360>
SYS Unit: Minute 1
715 Mainte-nance
Remote-controlled service periodical polling timing (Hour/Hour/Minute/Minute)
ALL 1230 SYS 0 (0:00) to 2359 (23:59) 1
716 Mainte-nance
Remote-controlled serviceWriting data of self-diag-nostic code
ALL 0<0-1>
SYS 0: Prohibited 1: Accepted
1
717 Mainte-nance
Remote-controlled service response waiting time (Timeout)
ALL 3<1-30>
SYS Unit: Minute 1
718 Mainte-nance
Remote-controlled service initial registration
ALL 0<0-3>
SYS 0: OFF 1: Start2: Only certification is
scanned3: Satellite communi-
cation starts
1
719 Mainte-nance
Remote-controlled service tentative password
ALL - SYS Maximum 10 letters 11
720 Mainte-nance
Status of remote-con-trolled service initial regis-tration (Display only)
ALL 0<0-1>
SYS 0: Not registered1: Registered
2
721 Mainte-nance
Service center call function ALL 2<0-2>
SYS 0: OFF1: Notifies all service
calls2: Notifies all but
paper jams
1
723 Mainte-nance
Service center call HTTP server URL setting
ALL - SYS Maximum 256 letters 11
Setting mode (08)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 137
2
726 Mainte-nance
HTTP proxy setting ALL 1<0-1>
SYS 0: Valid 1: Invalid
1
727 Mainte-nance
HTTP proxy IP address setting
ALL - SYS 000.000.000.000 - 255.255.255.255(Default value 000.000.000.000)
11
728 Mainte-nance
HTTP proxy port number setting
ALL 0<0-
65535>
SYS 1
729 Mainte-nance
HTTP proxy ID setting ALL - SYS Maximum 30 letters 11
730 Mainte-nance
HTTP proxy password set-ting
ALL - SYS Maximum 30 letters 11
731 Mainte-nance
HTTP proxy panel display ALL 1<0-1>
SYS 0: Valid1: Invalid
1
732 Mainte-nance
(Remote)
Automatic ordering func-tion of supplies
ALL 3<0-3>
SYS 0: Ordered by FAX1: Ordered by E-mail2: Ordered by HTTP3: OFF
1
733 Mainte-nance
(Remote)
Automatic ordering func-tion of supplies FAX number
ALL - SYS Maximum 32 digitsEnter hyphen with the [Monitor/Pause] button
11
734 Mainte-nance
(Remote)
Automatic ordering func-tion of supplies E-mail address
ALL - SYS Maximum 192 lettersList: 256 digits
11
738 Mainte-nance
(Remote)
Automatic ordering func-tion of suppliesUser's name
ALL SYS Maximum 50 letters 11
739 Mainte-nance
(Remote)
Automatic ordering func-tion of suppliesUser's telephone number
ALL SYS Maximum 32 digitsEnter hyphen with the [Monitor/Pause] button
11
740 Mainte-nance
(Remote)
Automatic ordering func-tion of suppliesUser's E-mail address
ALL SYS Maximum 192 lettersList: 256 digits
11
741 Mainte-nance
(Remote)
Automatic ordering func-tion of suppliesUser's address
ALL SYS Maximum 100 letters 11
742 Mainte-nance
(Remote)
Automatic ordering func-tion of suppliesService number
ALL SYS Maximum 5 digits 11
743 Mainte-nance
(Remote)
Automatic ordering func-tion of suppliesService technician's name
ALL SYS Maximum 50 letters 11
744 Mainte-nance
(Remote)
Automatic ordering func-tion of suppliesService technician's tele-phone number
ALL SYS Maximum 32 digitsEnter hyphen with the [Monitor/Pause] button
11
745 Mainte-nance
(Remote)
Automatic ordering func-tion of suppliesService technician's E-mail address
ALL SYS Maximum 192 lettersList: 256 digits
11
746 Mainte-nance
(Remote)
Automatic ordering func-tion of suppliesSupplier's name
ALL SYS Maximum 50 letters 11
Setting mode (08)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
07/11
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 138
747 Mainte-nance
(Remote)
Automatic ordering func-tion of suppliesSupplier's address
ALL SYS Maximum 100 letters 11
748 Mainte-nance
(Remote)
Automatic ordering func-tion of suppliesNotes
ALL SYS Maximum 128 letters 11
749 Mainte-nance
(Remote)
Information about suppliesPart number of toner car-tridge C
ALL SYS Maximum 20 digits 11
750 Mainte-nance
(Remote)
Information about suppliesOrder quantity of toner car-tridge C
ALL 1<1-99>
SYS 1
751 Mainte-nance
(Remote)
Information about suppliesCondition number of toner cartridge C
ALL 1<1-99>
SYS 1
752 Mainte-nance
(Remote)
Information about suppliesPart number of toner car-tridge M
ALL SYS Maximum 20 digits 11
753 Mainte-nance
(Remote)
Information about suppliesOrder quantity of toner car-tridge M
ALL 1<1-99>
SYS 1
754 Mainte-nance
(Remote)
Information about suppliesCondition number of toner cartridge M
ALL 1<1-99>
SYS 1
755 Mainte-nance
(Remote)
Information about suppliesPart number of toner car-tridge Y
ALL - SYS Maximum 20 digits 11
756 Mainte-nance
(Remote)
Information about suppliesOrder quantity of toner car-tridge Y
ALL 1<1-99>
SYS 1
757 Mainte-nance
(Remote)
Information about suppliesCondition number of toner cartridge Y
ALL 1<1-99>
SYS 1
758 Mainte-nance
(Remote)
Information about suppliesPart number of toner car-tridge K
ALL - SYS Maximum 20 digits 11
759 Mainte-nance
(Remote)
Information about suppliesOrder quantity of toner car-tridge K
ALL 1<1-99>
SYS 1
760 Mainte-nance
(Remote)
Information about suppliesCondition number of toner cartridge K
ALL 1<1-99>
SYS 1
761 Mainte-nance
(Remote)
Information about suppliesPart number of toner bag
ALL - SYS Maximum 20 digits 11
762 Mainte-nance
(Remote)
Information about suppliesOrder quantity of toner bag
ALL 1<1-99>
SYS 1
763 Mainte-nance
(Remote)
Information about suppliesCondition number of toner bag
ALL 1<1-99>
SYS 1
765 Mainte-nance
(Remote)
Automatic ordering sup-pliesDisplay
ALL JPN: 2UC: 0
EUR: 2Others: 2
<0-2>
SYS 0: Valid (FAX/Internet FAX)
1: Valid (FAX/Internet FAX/HTTP)
2: Invalid
1
Setting mode (08)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
07/04
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 139
2
767 Mainte-nance
(Remote)
Service Notification setting ALL 0<0-2>
SYS Enables to set up to 3 E-mailaddresses to be sent.(08-768, 777, 778)0: Invalid1: Valid (E-mail)2: Valid (FAX)
1
768 Mainte-nance
(Remote)
Destination E-mail address 1
ALL - SYS Maximum 192 letters 11
769 Mainte-nance
(Remote)
Total counter information transmission setting
ALL 0<0-1>
SYS 0: Invalid1: Valid
1
770 Mainte-nance
(Remote)
Total counter transmission date setting
ALL 0<0-31>
SYS 0 to 31 1
771 Mainte-nance
(Remote)
PM counter notification set-ting
ALL 0<0-1>
SYS 0: Invalid 1: Valid
1
772 Mainte-nance
Dealer's name ALL - SYS Maximum 100 lettersNeeded at initial regis-tration
11
773 Mainte-nance
Login name ALL - SYS Maximum 20 lettersNeeded at initial regis-tration
11
774 Mainte-nance
(Remote)
Display setting of [Service Notification] button
ALL JPN: 0UC: 1
EUR: 0<0-1>
SYS 0: Not displayed1: Displayed
1
775 Mainte-nance
(Remote)
Sending error contents of equipment
ALL 0<0-1>
SYS 0: Invalid 1: Valid
1
776 Mainte-nance
(Remote)
Setting total counter trans-mission interval(Hour/Hour/Minute/Minute)
ALL - SYS 1
777 Mainte-nance
(Remote)
Destination E-mail address 2
ALL - SYS Maximum 192 letters 11
778 Mainte-nance
(Remote)
Destination E-mail address 3
ALL - SYS Maximum 192 letters 11
780 Mainte-nance
Remote-controlled service polling day selection Day-1
ALL 0<0-31>
SYS 0: OFF1 to 31:
1st to 31st of a month
1
781 Mainte-nance
Remote-controlled service polling day selection Day-2
ALL 0<0-31>
SYS 0: OFF1 to 31:
1st to 31st of a month
1
782 Mainte-nance
Remote-controlled service polling day selection Day-3
ALL 0<0-31>
SYS 0: OFF1 to 31:
1st to 31st of a month
1
783 Mainte-nance
Remote-controlled service polling day selection Day-4
ALL 0<0-31>
SYS 0: OFF1 to 31:
1st to 31st of a month
1
Setting mode (08)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
07/04
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 140
784 Mainte-nance
Remote-controlled service polling day selection Sun-day
ALL 0<0-1>
SYS 0: Invalid1: Valid
1
785 Mainte-nance
Remote-controlled service polling day selection Mon-day
ALL 0<0-1>
SYS 0: Invalid1: Valid
1
786 Mainte-nance
Remote-controlled service polling day selection Tues-day
ALL 0<0-1>
SYS 0: Invalid1: Valid
1
787 Mainte-nance
Remote-controlled service polling day selection Wednesday
ALL 0<0-1>
SYS 0: Invalid1: Valid
1
788 Mainte-nance
Remote-controlled service polling day selection Thursday
ALL 0<0-1>
SYS 0: Invalid1: Valid
1
789 Mainte-nance
Remote-controlled service polling day selection Friday
ALL 0<0-1>
SYS 0: Invalid1: Valid
1
790 Mainte-nance
Remote-controlled service polling day selection Satur-day
ALL 0<0-1>
SYS 0: Invalid1: Valid
1
791 Mainte-nance
Information of supplies set-ting of toner cartridge C
ALL 0<0-1>
SYS 0: Invalid1: Valid
1
792 Mainte-nance
Information of supplies set-ting of toner cartridge M
ALL 0<0-1>
SYS 0: Invalid1: Valid
1
793 Mainte-nance
Information of supplies set-ting of toner cartridge Y
ALL 0<0-1>
SYS 0: Invalid1: Valid
1
794 Mainte-nance
Information of supplies set-ting of toner cartridge K
ALL 0<0-1>
SYS 0: Invalid1: Valid
1
795 Mainte-nance
Information of supplies set-ting of toner bag
ALL 0<0-1>
SYS 0: Invalid1: Valid
1
796 Mainte-nance
Remote-controlled service lengthened interval polling (End of month)
ALL 0<0-1>
SYS 0: Invalid1: Valid
1
816 Transfer 1st transfer roller bias resistance detection con-trol
ALL 1<0-1>
M 0: Disabled1: Enabled
1
817 Transfer 2nd transfer roller bias temperature detection con-trol
ALL 1<0-1>
M 0: Disabled1: Enabled
1
818 Transfer Temperature correction factor table setting
ALL JPN: 1UC: 0
EUR: 0Others: 1
<0-1>
M 0: No Damp Heater1: Damp Heater
installed
1
819-0 Develop-ment
Color auto-toner sensor output setting for initial developer material
Y ALL (color)
256<0-1023>
M Sets the target output value of color auto-toner sensor to the sleeve in the auto-toner control. (This is set when performing the automatic adjustment of auto-toner sensor.)
4
819-1 M ALL (color)
256<0-1023>
M 4
819-2 C ALL (color)
256<0-1023>
M 4
Setting mode (08)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 141
2
820-0 Develop-ment
Color auto-toner sensor output display for developer material
Y ALL (color)
-<0-1023>
M Displays the output value of the color auto-toner sensor to the sleeve in color printing.
4
820-1 M ALL (color)
-<0-1023>
M 4
820-2 C ALL (color)
-<0-1023>
M 4
821 Develop-ment
ON/OFF of the mode for developer material stabili-zation
ALL (color)
0<0-1>
M Sets whether or not performing an aging to stabilize the status of developer material when the toner density is uneven or the toner charging amount is low-ered.0: ON1: OFF
1
822-0 Develop-ment
Number of times the mode for developer material stabi-lization is per-formed
Y ALL (color)
0<0-255>
M Displays the number of times the developer material stabilization is performed.
4
822-1 M ALL (color)
0<0-255>
M 4
822-2 C ALL (color)
0<0-255>
M 4
823-0 Develop-ment
Color auto-toner sensor/light amount correction voltage abnor-mal detection
Y ALL(color)
0<0-1>
M Displays “1” when the abnormal output volt-age is detected for the color auto-toner sensor light amount correction. ([CF40] error)0: Normal1: Abnormality
detected
4
823-1 M ALL(color)
0<0-1>
M 4
823-2 C ALL(color)
0<0-1>
M 4
824-0 Develop-ment
Color auto-toner sensor/toner density detection volt-age abnormal detection
Y ALL(color)
0<0-1>
M Displays “1” when the abnormal toner density detection voltage is detected. ([CF20] error)0: Normal1: Abnormality
detected
4
824-1 M ALL(color)
0<0-1>
M 4
824-2 C ALL(color)
0<0-1>
M 4
849 Fuser Fusing control switching for TWD and SAD models
ALL Other than
TWD and SAD: 0
TWD andSAD: 1<0-1>
M 1
858-0 Develop-ment
Color toner forced supply level display
Y ALL(color)
0<0-1>
M Becomes “1” when the toner density decreases and it is judged forced toner supply is needed.0: Normal level1: Forced supply level
14
858-1 M ALL(color)
0<0-1>
M 14
858-2 C ALL(color)
0<0-1>
M 14
Setting mode (08)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 142
859-0 Develop-ment
Toner empty detection
Y ALL(color)
0<0-1>
M Becomes “1” when detecting the toner empty.0: Normal1: Empty detected
14
859-1 M ALL(color)
0<0-1>
M 14
859-2 C ALL(color)
0<0-1>
M 14
860-0 Develop-ment
Color auto-toner sensor/proper range setting of OFF level voltage
Upper limit ALL(color)
20<0-1023>
M Sets the range for judg-ing whether the sensor output value when the sensor light source is OFF is corrector not.
4
860-1 Lower limit ALL(color)
0<0-1023>
M 4
861-0 Develop-ment
Color auto-toner sensor/proper range setting of standard light amount volt-age
Upper limit ALL(color)
205<0-255>
M Sets the range for judg-ing whether the adjust-ment result of sensor light amount is correct or not.
4
861-1 Lower limit ALL(color)
40<0-255>
M 4
862-0 Develop-ment
Color auto-toner sensor/proper range setting of ref-erence plate output
Upper limit ALL(color)
950<0-1023>
M Sets the range for judg-ing whether the sensor output value for the ref-erence plate is correct or not.
4
862-1 Lower limit ALL(color)
205<0-1023>
M 4
863-0 Develop-ment
Color auto-toner sensor/proper range setting of developer out-put
Upper limit ALL(color)
450<0-1023>
M Sets the range for judg-ing whether the sensor output value for the sleeve is correct or not.
4
863-1 Lower limit ALL(color)
155<0-1023>
M 4
864 Develop-ment
Color auto-toner sensor/ sensor OFF output value display at power ON
ALL (color)
-<0-1023>
M Displays the sensor output value when the sensor light source is OFF at power ON.
2
865 Develop-ment
Color auto-toner sensor/ reference plate output value display at power ON
ALL (color)
-<0-1023>
M Displays the sensor output value with the standard light amount for the reference plate at power ON.
2
866-0 Develop-ment
Color auto-toner sensor/abnormal detection potential dif-ference set-ting of reference plate output
Upper limit ALL (color)
820<0-1023>
M Sets the range for judg-ing whether the differ-ence between the sensor output when the sensor light source is OFF and the sensor output for the reference plate is correct or not.
4
866-1 Develop-ment
Lower limit ALL (color)
205<0-1023>
M 4
867 Develop-ment
Color auto-toner control environment and life light amount correction setting
ALL (color)
0<0-1>
M Sets whether the sen-sor light amount is cor-rected or not depending on the environment and life.0: Correction1: No correction
1
Setting mode (08)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 143
2
868 Develop-ment
Color auto-toner adjust-ment finishing range set-ting
ALL (color)
4<0-255>
M Sets the difference from the target value for judging whether the color auto-toner adjust-ment finishes correctly or not.
1
869 Develop-ment
Color auto-toner control environment and life light amount correction/correc-tion finishing range setting
ALL (color)
5<0-255>
M Sets the difference from the target value for judging whether the light amount correction finishes correctly or not.
1
870 Develop-ment
Color auto-toner sensor/setting of number of times of error detection at light amount correction
ALL (color)
3<0-255>
M Sets the number of times of continuous error detection before the light amount correc-tion abnormality is dis-played.
1
871 Develop-ment
Color auto-toner control environment and life light amount correction/display of number of times of refer-ence plate detection error
ALL (color)
0<0-255>
M Displays the number of times of the reference plate detection error for the environment and life light amount correction.
2
872 Develop-ment
Color auto-toner control environment and life light amount correction/display of number of times of light amount control voltage adjustment error
ALL (color)
0<0-255>
M Displays the number of times of the light amount control voltage adjustment error for the environment and life light amount correction.
2
873-0 Develop-ment
Color auto-toner control/developer ini-tial output set-ting
Y ALL (color)
256<0-1023>
M Sets the initial devel-oper output target value.
4
873-1 Develop-ment
M ALL (color)
256<0-1023>
M 4
873-2 Develop-ment
C ALL (color)
256<0-1023>
M 4
874 Develop-ment
Color developer life correc-tion
ALL (color)
0<0-1>
M Sets whether the toner density detection volt-age correction is per-formed or not depending on the developer life in the color auto-toner control.0: Corrected 1: Not corrected
1
875-0 Develop-ment
Color devel-oper life cor-rection value (segment 0)
Y ALL (color)
0<-512-511>
M Sets the correction amount of the toner density detection volt-age depending on the developer life. In this code, the life count within 0-2000 is set as the correction amount.
4
875-1 M ALL (color)
0<-512-511>
M 4
875-2 C ALL (color)
0<-512-511>
M 4
Setting mode (08)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 144
876-0 Develop-ment
Color devel-oper life cor-rection value (segment 1)
Y ALL (color)
-4<-512-511>
M Sets the correction amount of the toner density detection volt-age depending on the developer life. In this code, the life count within 2001-5000 is set as the correction amount.
4
876-1 M ALL (color)
-2<-512-511>
M 4
876-2 C ALL (color)
-2<-512-511>
M 4
877-0 Develop-ment
Color devel-oper life cor-rection value (segment 2)
Y ALL (color)
-6<-512-511>
M Sets the correction amount of the toner density detection volt-age depending on the developer life. In this code, the life count within 5001-10000 is set as the correction amount.
4
877-1 M ALL (color)
-3<-512-511>
M 4
877-2 C ALL (color)
-3<-512-511>
M 4
878-0 Develop-ment
Color devel-oper life cor-rection value (segment 3)
Y ALL (color)
-8<-512-511>
M Sets the correction amount of the toner density detection volt-age depending on the developer life. In this code, the life count within 10001-20000 is set as the correction amount.
4
878-1 M ALL (color)
-4<-512-511>
M 4
878-2 C ALL (color)
-4<-512-511>
M 4
879-0 Develop-ment
Color devel-oper life cor-rection value (segment 4)
Y ALL (color)
-10<-512-511>
M Sets the correction amount of the toner density detection volt-age depending on the developer life. In this code, the life count within 20001-30000 is set as the correction amount.
4
879-1 M ALL (color)
-5<-512-511>
M 4
879-2 C ALL (color)
-5<-512-511>
M 4
880-0 Develop-ment
Color devel-oper life cor-rection value (segment 5)
Y ALL (color)
-12<-512-511>
M Sets the correction amount of the toner density detection volt-age depending on the developer life. In this code, the life count within 30001-37500 is set as the correction amount.
4
880-1 M ALL (color)
-6<-512-511>
M 4
880-2 C ALL (color)
-6<-512-511>
M 4
881-0 Develop-ment
Color devel-oper life cor-rection value (segment 6)
Y ALL (color)
-12<-512-511>
M Sets the correction amount of the toner density detection volt-age depending on the developer life. In this code, the life count 37501 or more is set as the correction amount.
4
881-1 M ALL (color)
-6<-512-511>
M 4
881-2 C ALL (color)
-6<-512-511>
M 4
Setting mode (08)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
06/08
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 145
2
900 Version System firmware ROM ver-sion
ALL - - JPN: T410SY0JXXXUC: T410SY0UXXXEUR: T410SY0EXXXOthers: T410SY0XXXX
2
903 Version Engine ROM version ALL - - 410M-XXX 2905 Version Scanner ROM version ALL - - 410S-XXX 2907 Version RADF ROM version ALL - - DF-XXXX 2908 Version Finisher ROM version ALL - - SDL-XX FIN-XX 2911 Version Finisher punch ROM ver-
sionALL - - PUN-XXX 2
915 Version FAX board ROM version FAX - - F562-XXX 2920 Version FROM basic section soft-
ware versionALL - - VX.XX/X.XX 2
921 Version FROM internal program ALL - - VXXX.XXX X 2922 Version UI data fixed section ver-
sionALL - - VXXX.XXX X 2
923 Version UI data common section version
ALL - - VXXX.XXX X 2
924 Version Version of UI data lan-guage 1 in HDD
ALL - - VXXX.XXX X 2
925 Version Version of UI data lan-guage 2 in HDD
ALL - - VXXX.XXX X 2
926 Version Version of UI data lan-guage 3 in HDD
ALL - - VXXX.XXX X 2
927 Version Version of UI data lan-guage 4 in HDD
ALL - - VXXX.XXX X 2
928 Version Version of UI data lan-guage 5 in HDD
ALL - - VXXX.XXX X 2
929 Version Version of UI data lan-guage 6 in HDD
ALL - - VXXX.XXX X 2
930 Version Version of UI data in FROM displayed at power-ON
ALL - - VXXX.XXX X 2
931 Version Version of UI data lan-guage 7 in HDD
ALL - - VXXX.XXX X 2
933 Version Web data whole version ALL - - VXXX.XXX X 2934 Version Web UI data in HDD
Version: Language 1ALL - - VXXX.XXX X 2
935 Version Web UI data in HDDVersion: Language 2
ALL - - VXXX.XXX X 2
936 Version Web UI data in HDDVersion: Language 3
ALL - - VXXX.XXX X 2
937 Version Web UI data in HDDVersion: Language 4
ALL - - VXXX.XXX X 2
938 Version Web UI data in HDDVersion: Language 5
ALL - - VXXX.XXX X 2
939 Version Web UI data in HDDVersion: Language 6
ALL - - VXXX.XXX X 2
944 Version HD version ALL - - JPN: T410HD0JXXXUC: T410HD0UXXXEUR: T410HD0EXXXOthers: T410HD0XXXX
2
945 Network Two-way setting of Raw-Port 9100
ALL 2<1-2>
UTY 1: Valid2: Invalid
12
Setting mode (08)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
06/08
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 146
947 General Initialization after software version upgrade
ALL - - Perform this code when the software in this equipment has been upgraded.
3
949 General Automatic interruption page setting during black printing
ALL 0<0-100>
SYS Sets the number of pages to interrupt the printing automatically.0-100: 0 to 100 pages
1
950 Elec-tronicfiling
Start-up method of Elec-tronic Filing
ALL 0<0-2>
SYS Sets the start-up method of the Elec-tronic Filing.0: Standard1: Forced start-up
(Not recovered)2: Forced start-up
(Recovered)
1
951 Userinterface
Image setting for Electronic Filing printing (Only for color image)
ALL 0<0-3>
SYS 0: General 1: Photograph2: Presentation 3: Line art
1
953 Userinterface
Access code entry for Electronic Filing printing
ALL 0<0-1>
SYS 0: Renewed automati-cally
1: Enter every time
1
954 Userinterface
Clearing timing for files and Electronic Filing Agent
ALL 1<0-1>
SYS 0: Immediately after the completion of scanning
1: Cleared by Auto Clear
1
969 Userinterface
Error sound ALL 1<0-1>
SYS 0: OFF1: ON
1
970 Userinterface
Sound setting when switching to Energy Saving Mode
ALL EUR: 1UC: 1JPN: 0<0-1>
SYS 0: OFF1: ON
1
973 Network PCL line feed code setting PRT 0<0-3>
SYS Sets the PCL line feed code.0: Automatic setting1: CR=CR, LF=LF2: CR=CR+LF, LF=LF3: CR=CR, LF=CR+LF
1
975 General Job handling when print-ing is short paid with coin controller
ALL 1<0-1>
SYS Sets whether pause or stop the printing job when it is short paid using a coin controller.0: Pause the job 1: Stop the job
1
976 Scanning Equipment name and user name setting to a folder when saving files
ALL 0<0-2>
SYS Sets whether or not adding the equipment name and user name to the folder when saving files.0: Not add 1: Add the equipment
name2: Add the user name
1
Setting mode (08)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
06/08
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 147
2
978 Network Raw printing job(Paper feeding drawer)
PRT 0<0-5>
SYS 0: AUTO1: Upper drawer2: Lower drawer3: PFP upper drawer4: PFP lower drawer5: LCF
1
979 Network Raw printing job(PCL symbol set)
PRT 0<0-39>
SYS 0: Roman-81: ISO 8859/1 Latin 12: ISO 8859/2 Latin 23: ISO 8859/9 Latin 54: PC-8, Code Page
4375: PC-8 D/N, Danish/
Norwegian6: PC-850, Multilingual7: PC-852, Latin28: PC-8 Turkish9: Windows 3.1 Latin 110: Windows 3.1 Latin 211: Windows 3.1 Latin 512: DeskTop13: PS Text14: Ventura Interna-
tional15: Ventura US16: Microsoft Publishing17: Math-818: PS Math19: Ventura Math20: Pi Font21: Legal22: ISO 4: United King-
dom23: ISO 6: ASCII24: ISO 1125: ISO 15: Italian26: ISO 1727: ISO 21: German28: ISO 60: Danish/Nor-
wegian29: ISO 69: French30: Windows 3.0 Latin 131: MC Text32: PC Cyrillic33: ITC Zapf Dingbats34: ISO 8859/10 Latin 635: PC-77536: PC-100437: Symbol38: Windows Baltic39: Wingdings
1
983 User interface
JOB STATUS initial screen setting
ALL 0<0-1>
SYS 0: Print1: Private
1
986 General Copy function setting PPC 0<0-1>
SYS Sets the copy function to be invalid.0: Valid1: Invalid
1
Setting mode (08)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 148
988 Paper feeding
Setting of paper size switching to 13" LG
ALL 0<0-2>
SYS 0: Not switched1: LG→13"LG2: FOLIO→13"LG
1
995 Mainte-nance
Equipment number (serial number) display
ALL 0<10 dig-
its>
SYS This code can be also keyed in from the adjustment mode (05-976).10 digits
11
999 Mainte-nance
FSMS total counter ALL 0<8 digits>
SYS Refer to values of total counter.
1
1002 Network Selection of NIC board sta-tus information
ALL 1<1-2>
NIC 1: Not printed out when the copier is restarted
2: Printed out when the copier is restarted
12
1003 Network Communication speed and settings of Ethernet
ALL 1<1-5>
NIC 1: Auto2: 10MBPS Half Duplex3: 10MBPS Full Duplex4: 100MBPS Half Duplex5: 100MBPS Full Duplex
12
1006 Network Address Mode ALL 2<1-3>
NIC 1: Fixed IP address2: Dynamic IP address3: Dynamic IP address
without AutoIP
12
1007 Network Domain name ALL - NIC Maximum 96 letters 121008 Network IP address ALL - NIC 000.000.000.000-
255.255.255.255(Default value 000.000.000.000)
12
1009 Network Subnet mask ALL - NIC 000.000.000.000-255.255.255.255(Default value 000.000.000.000)
12
1010 Network Gateway ALL - NIC 000.000.000.000-255.255.255.255(Default value 000.000.000.000)
12
1011 Network Availability of IPX ALL 1<1-2>
NIC 1: Available 2: Not available
12
1012 Network Network frame type ALL 1<1-5>
NIC 1: Automatic 2: IEEE802.33: Ethernet II 4: IEEE802.3 SNAP5: IEEE802.2
12
1014 Network Availability of AppleTalk ALL 1<1-2>
NIC 1: Available 2: Not available
12
1015 Network Zone setting of AppleTalk ALL * NIC Maximum 32 letters*: Wildcard character
12
1016 Network Availability of LDAP ALL 1<1-2>
NIC 1: Available 2: Not available
12
1017 Network Availability of DNS ALL 1<1-2>
NIC 1: Available 2: Not available
12
Setting mode (08)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
05/11
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 149
2
1018 Network IP address to DNS server(Primary)
ALL - NIC 000.000.000.000-255.255.255.255(Default value 000.000.000.000)
12
1019 Network IP address to DNS server(Secondary)
ALL - NIC 000.000.000.000-255.255.255.255(Default value 000.000.000.000)
12
1020 Network DDNS Desired level ALL 1<1-5>
NIC 1: Invalid 2: Via DHCP3: Insecure DDNS 4: Secure DDNS5: Multi-secure DDNS
12
1022 Network From Name Creation set-ting in SMTP authentica-tion
ALL 0<0-1>
SYS 0: Not edited1: Account name of
From Address +Device name
1
1023 Network NetBios name ALL MFP_serial
UTY Maximum 15 lettersThe network-related serial number of the equipment appears at "serial"
12
1024 Network Name of WINS server or IP address (Primary)
ALL - UTY 000.000.000.000-255.255.255.255(Default value 000.000.000.000)
12
1025 Network Name of WINS server or IP address (Secondary)
ALL - UTY 000.000.000.000-255.255.255.255(Default value 000.000.000.000)
12
1026 Network Availability of Bindery ALL 1<1-2>
NIC 1: Available 2: Not available
12
1027 Network Availability of NDS ALL 1<1-2>
NIC 1: Available 2: Not available
12
1028 Network Directory service context ALL - NIC Maximum 127 letters 121029 Network Directory service tree ALL - NIC Maximum 47 letters 121030 Network Availability of HTTP server ALL 1
<1-2>NIC 1: Available
2: Not available12
1031 Network Port number to NIC HTTP server
ALL 80<1-
65535>
NIC 12
1032 Network Port number to system HTTP server
ALL 8080<1-
65535>
NIC 12
1037 Network Availability of SMTP client ALL 1<1-2>
NIC 1: Available 2: Not available
12
1038 Network FQDN or IP address to SMTP server
ALL - NIC Maximum 128 Bytes 12
1039 Network TCP port number of SMTP client
ALL 25<1-
65535>
NIC 12
1040 Network Availability of SMTP server ALL 1<1-2>
UTY 1: Available 2: Not available
12
1041 Network TCP port number of SMTP server
ALL 25<1-
65535>
UTY 12
Setting mode (08)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 150
1042 Network E-mail box name to SMTP server
ALL - UTY Maximum 192 letters 12
1043 Network Availability of Offramp ALL 2<1-2>
UTY 1: Available 2: Not available
12
1044 Network Offramp security ALL 1<1-2>
UTY 1: Available 2: Not available
12
1045 Network Printing at Offramp ALL 1<1-2>
UTY 1: Available 2: Not available
12
1046 Network Availability of POP3 clients ALL 1<1-2>
NIC 1: Available 2: Not available
12
1047 Network FQDN or IP address to POP3 server
ALL - NIC Maximum 128 Bytes 12
1048 Network Types of POP3 server ALL 1<1-3>
NIC 1: Automatic 2: POP33: APOP
12
1049 Network Login name to POP3 server
ALL - NIC Maximum 96 letters 12
1050 Network Login password to POP3 ALL - NIC Maximum 96 letters 121051 Network E-mail reception interval ALL 5
<0-4096>NIC Unit: Minute 12
1052 Network TCP port number of POP3 client
ALL 110<1-
65535>
NIC 12
1055 Network TCP port number of FTP client
ALL 21<1-
65535>
UTY 12
1059 Network Availability of FTP server ALL 1<1-2>
NIC 1: Available 2: Not available
12
1060 Network TCP port number of FTP server
ALL 21<1-
65535>
UTY 12
1063 Network MIB function ALL 1<1-2>
NIC 1: Valid 2: Invalid
12
1065 Network Setting of read Community ALL public NIC Maximum 31 letters 121066 Network Setting of read/Write Com-
munityALL private NIC Maximum 31 letters 12
1069 Network TRAP destination IP address
ALL - UTY 000.000.000.000-255.255.255.255(Default value 000.000.000.000)
12
1070 Network Community setting of TRAP (via IP)
ALL public NIC Maximum 31 letters 12
1073 Network Availability of Raw/TCP ALL 1<1-2>
NIC 1: Valid 2: Invalid
12
1074 Network TCP port number of Raw ALL 9100<1-
65535>
NIC 12
1075 Network Availability of LPD client ALL 1<1-2>
NIC 1: Valid 2: Invalid
12
1076 Network TCP port number of LPD ALL 515<1-
65535>
NIC 12
1077 Network LPD queue name ALL - NIC Maximum 31 letters 121078 Network Availability of IPP ALL 1
<1-2>NIC 1: Valid
2: Invalid12
Setting mode (08)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
05/11
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 151
2
1079 Network Availability of IPP port number “80”
ALL 1<1-2>
NIC 1: Valid 2: Invalid
12
1080 Network TCP port number of IPP ALL 631<1-
65535>
NIC 12
1081 Network IPP printer name ALL MFP_serial
NIC Maximum 127 lettersThe network-related serial number of the equipment appears at "serial"
12
1082 Network IPP printer location ALL - NIC Maximum 127 letters 121083 Network IPP printer information ALL - NIC Maximum 127 letters 121084 Network IPP printer information
(more)ALL - NIC Maximum 127 letters 12
1085 Network Installer of IPP printer driver
ALL - NIC Maximum 127 letters 12
1086 Network IPP printer “Make and Model”
ALL - NIC Maximum 127 letters 12
1087 Network IPP printer information (more) MFGR
ALL - NIC Maximum 127 letters 12
1088 Network IPP message from opera-tor
ALL - NIC Maximum 127 letters 12
1089 Network Availability of FTP print ALL 1<1-2>
NIC 1: Available 2: Not available
12
1090 Network Printer user name of FTP ALL print NIC Maximum 31 letters 121091 Network Printer user password of
FTPALL - NIC Maximum 31 letters 12
1092 Network TCP port number to FTP print server
ALL 21<1-
65535>
NIC 12
1093 Network Login name to Novell print server
ALL MFP_serial
NIC Maximum 47 lettersThe network-related serial number of the equipment appears at "serial"
12
1094 Network Login password to Novell print server
ALL - NIC Maximum 31 letters 12
1095 Network Name of SearchRoot server
ALL - NIC Maximum 31 letters 12
1096 Network Scan rate setting of print queue
ALL 5<1-255>
NIC Unit: Second 12
1097 Network Page number limitation for printing text of received Email
ALL 5<1-99>
UTY 12
1098 Network MDN return mail setting when receiving E-mail
ALL 2<1-2>
UTY 1: Valid 2: Invalid
12
1099 Network Trap destination of IPX ALL - UTY 24 letters(Valid from 0 to 9 and from A to F)
12
Setting mode (08)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
06/08
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 152
1100 Network Method of SMTP server authentication
ALL 1<1-7,10>
NIC 1: Disable2: Plain3: Login4; Cram-MD55: Digest MD56: Kerberos7: NTLM10: Auto
12
1101 Network Login name for SMTP server authentication
ALL - NIC Maximum 64 letters 12
1102 Network Login password for SMTP server authentication
ALL - NIC Maximum 64 letters 12
1103 Network Rendezvous setting ALL 1<1-2>
NIC 1: Valid 2: Invalid
12
1104 Network Link local host name ALL MFP_serial
NIC Maximum 127 lettersThe network-related serial number of the equipment appears at "serial"
12
1105 Network Service name setting ALL Refer to contents
NIC Maximum 63 lettersThe network-related serial number of the equipment appears at "serial"<Default value>e-STUDIO281C:TOSHIBA e-STUDIO281C_seriale-STUDIO351C:TOSHIBA e-STUDIO351C_seriale-STUDIO451C:TOSHIBA e-STUDIO451C_serial
12
1111 Network POP Before SMTP setting ALL 2<1-2>
NIC 1: Valid2: Invalid
12
1112 Network Host name ALL MFP_serial
NIC Maximum 63 lettersThe network-related serial number of the equipment appears at "serial"
12
1113 Network Windows domain No.1 of user authentication
ALL - UTY Maximum 128 letters 12
1114 Network Sending mail text of Inter-netFAX
ALL 1<0-1>
SYS 0: Invalid1: Valid
1
1117 Network SMB time-out period ALL 300<1-9999>
SYS Unit: Second 1
1118 General Clearing of TAT partition ALL - SYS 31119 Network Initialization of NIC infor-
mationALL - - Initializes only the infor-
mation of the Network setting items.
3
1121 Network PDC (Primary Domain Controller) name No.1 of authentication
ALL - UTY Maximum 128 letters 12
1122 Network BDC (Backup Domain Controller) name No.1 of authentication
ALL - UTY Maximum 128 letters 12
Setting mode (08)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
06/08
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 153
2
1123 Network Windows domain of device authentication
ALL 4<3-4>
UTY 3: ON (Domain selected)
4: OFF (Work group selected)
12
1124 Network Workgroup name ALL work-group
UTY Maximum 15 letters 12
1125 General Data writing of address book data import (overwriting method)
ALL 0<0-1>
SYS 0: Invalid1: Valid
1
1126 Counter Validity of interrupt copy-ing when external counters are installed
ALL 0<0-1>
SYS 0: Invalid1: Valid
1
1128 Network NetwareUserAuthTreeName1
ALL - UTY Maximum 47 letters 12
1129 Network NetwareUserAuthContextName1
ALL - UTY Maximum 127 letters 12
1130 User interface
Job Build Function ALL 1<0-1>
SYS Sets the Job Build Function.0: Invalid1: Valid
1
1131 User interface
Maximum number of time job build performed
ALL 1000<5-1000>
SYS Sets the maximum number of time a job build has been per-formed.5-1000: 5 to 1000 times
1
1132 General Default screen selection of the User Function menu
ALL 1<0-1>
SYS Selects the default screen when entering the User Function menu by pressing the [USER FUNCTIONS] button.0: ADDRESS 1: COUNTER
1
1134 Network NetwareUserAuthTreeName2
ALL - UTY Maximum 47 letters 12
1135 Paper feeding
Default setting of drawers (Printer/BOX)
ALL 1<1-5>
SYS 1: LCF2: Upper drawer3: Lower drawer4: PFP upper drawer5: PFP lower drawer
1
1138 Network LDAP search method set-ting
ALL 0<0-3>
SYS Sets the search method when performing a LDAP search.0: Partial match1: Prefix match2: Suffix match3: Full match
1
1139 Network LDAP authentication set-ting
ALL 0<0-1>
SYS 0: Not authenticated1: Authenticated
1
1140 User interface
Restriction of the template function with the adminis-trator privilege
ALL 0<0-1>
SYS Selects the restriction of the template function usage setting.0: No restriction1: Only available with
the administrator privilege.
1
Setting mode (08)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
07/11
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 154
1141 Network Display of MAC address ALL - SYS (**:**:**:**:**:**)The address is dis-played as above (6-byte data is divided by a colon at every 2 bytes).
2
1143 Network NetwareUserAuthContextName2
ALL - UTY Maximum 127 letters 12
1144 Network NetwareUserAuthTreeName3
ALL - UTY Maximum 47 letters 12
1145 Mainte-nance
(Remote)
Counter notification Remote FAX setting
ALL - SYS Maximum 32 digits Enter a hyphen with the [MONITOR/PAUSE] button.
11
1148 Network NetwareUserAuthContextName3
ALL - UTY Maximum 127 letters 12
1149 General Enhanced bold for PCL6 ALL 0<0-1>
SYS 0: OFF1: ON
1
1370 Image process-
ing
Image quality control time accumulating counter
ALL 0<8 digits>
M Counts driving count of the drum (image qual-ity control time).Counts up when drum motor and image quality control are ON.
1
1371 Image process-
ing
Accumulated counter of output pages since the per-forming of image quality control
ALL 0<4 digits>
M Cleared to “0” by the image quality closed-loop control. Counts up with the number of printing job received after this control.
2
1372 Image process-
ing
Heater and energizing time accumulating counter Dis-play/0 clearing
ALL 0<8 digits>
M Counts up the heater control time accumu-lated (when power of the copier is ON) but does not count at the Sleep Mode. When the counter value of the fuser belt is cleared, this counter value is also cleared in sync at PM support mode.
1
1378 Image process-
ing
Fuser roller ready tempera-ture time accumulating counter
ALL 0<8 digits>
M Counts up the heater control time accumu-lated (on standby). When the counter value of the fuser belt is cleared, this counter value is also cleared in sync at PM support mode.
2
1380 Image process-
ing
Fuser roller printing tem-perature time accumulating counter
ALL 0<8 digits>
M Counts up the heater control time accumu-lated (during printing). When the counter value of the fuser belt is cleared, this counter value is also cleared in sync at PM support mode.
2
Setting mode (08)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 155
2
1382 Image process-
ing
Fuser roller energy saving temperature time accumu-lating counter Display/0 clearing
ALL 0<8 digits>
M Counts up the heater control time accumu-lated (at energy saving mode). When the counter value of the fuser belt is cleared, this counter value is also cleared in sync at PM support mode.
2
1385 Image process-
ing
Number of output pages (Thick paper 1)
ALL 0<8 digits>
M Counts up when the registration sensor is ON. When the counter value of the fuser belt is cleared, this counter value is also cleared in sync at PM support mode.
1
1386 Image process-
ing
Number of output pages (Thick paper 2)
ALL 0<8 digits>
M Counts up when the registration sensor is ON. When the counter value of the fuser belt is cleared, this counter value is also cleared in sync at PM support mode.
1
1387 Image process-
ing
Number of output pages (Thick paper 3)
ALL 0<8 digits>
M Counts up when the registration sensor is ON. When the counter value of the fuser belt is cleared, this counter value is also cleared in sync at PM support mode.
1
1388 Image process-
ing
Number of output pages (OHP film)
ALL 0<8 digits>
M Counts up when the registration sensor is ON. When the counter value of the fuser belt is cleared, this counter value is also cleared in sync at PM support mode.
1
1389 Main charger
Main charger wire clean-ing counter display/0 clear-ing
ALL 0<5 digits>
M Does not count up when cleaning is not effective.
1
1390 Paper feeding
Feeding retry counter (upper drawer)
ALL 0<8 digits>
M Counts the number of times of the feeding retry from the upper drawer.
1
1391 Paper feeding
Feeding retry counter (lower drawer)
ALL 0<8 digits>
M Counts the number of times of the feeding retry from the lower drawer.
1
1392 Paper feeding
Feeding retry counter (PFP upper drawer)
ALL 0<8 digits>
M Counts the number of times of the feeding retry from the PFP upper drawer.
1
Setting mode (08)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
05/11
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 156
1393 Paper feeding
Feeding retry counter (PFP lower drawer)
ALL 0<8 digits>
M Counts the number of times of the feeding retry from the PFP lower drawer.
1
1394 Paper feeding
Feeding retry counter (bypass feed)
ALL 0<8 digits>
M Counts the number of times of the feeding retry from the bypass tray.
1
1395 Paper feeding
Feeding retry counter (LCF)
ALL 0<8 digits>
M Counts the number of times of the feeding retry from the LCF.
1
1396 Paper feeding
Feeding retry counter upper limit value (upper drawer)
ALL 10<8 digits>
M When the number of feeding retry (08-1390 to 08-1395) exceeds the setting value, the feeding retry will not be performed subse-quently. In case “0” is set as a setting value, however, the feeding retry continues regard-less of the counter set-ting value.Refer to (Note 1).
1
1397 Paper feeding
Feeding retry counter upper limit value (lower drawer)
ALL 10<8 digits>
M 1
1398 Paper feeding
Feeding retry counter upper limit value(PFP upper drawer)
ALL 10<8 digits>
M 1
1399 Paper feeding
Feeding retry counter upper limit value(PFP lower drawer)
ALL 10<8 digits>
M 1
1400 Paper feeding
Feeding retry counter upper limit value(bypass feed)
ALL 10<8 digits>
M 1
1401 Paper feeding
Feeding retry counter upper limit value (LCF)
ALL 10<8 digits>
M 1
1410 Counter Black toner cartridge drive counts/0 clearing
ALL 0<8 digits>
M 1
1412 Counter Counter for tab paper ALL 0<8 digits>
M Counts up when the registration sensor is ON. When the counter value of the fuser roller is reset, this counter is reset in sync at the PM support mode.
1
1414 Image process-
ing
Toner cartridge wrong installation detection ON/OFF setting
ALL 0<0-1>
M 0: ON1: OFF
1
1415 Image process-
ing
Detection/control that the toner cartridge is nearly empty
ALL 0<0-2>
M Sets ON or OFF of the detection/control that the toner cartridge is nearly empty.0: All colors (Y/M/C/K)
OFF 1: Black (K) ON2: All colors (Y/M/C/K)
ON
1
1416 Image process-
ing
Threshold for detecting that black toner cartridge is nearly empty
ALL 322500<8 digits>
M 1
Setting mode (08)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
05/11
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 157
2
1422 Data over-
write kit
HDD data overwriting type setting
ALL 0<0-2>
SYS Select the type of the overwriting level; LOW, MEDIUM, or HIGH for deleting HDD data. (This setting is enabled only when the GP-1060 is installed.)0: LOW1: MEDIUM2: HIGH
1
1424 Data over-
write kit
HDD data clearing type setting (forcible clearing)
ALL 0<0-2>
SYS Select the type of the overwriting level; LOW, MEDIUM, or HIGH for deleting HDD data. (This setting is enabled only when the GP-1060 is installed.) 0: LOW1: MEDIUM2: HIGH
1
1426 Data over-
write kit
Forcible HDD data clearing ALL - - HDD data is cleared in the procedure set in 08-1424.* This setting is
enabled only when the GP-1060 is installed.
3
1427 Data over-
write kit
Forcible NVRAM data all clearing
ALL - - When this code is per-formed, the equipment cannot be started up.* This setting is
enabled only when the GP-1060 is installed.
3
1428 Data over-
write kit
Forcible SRAM backup data all clearing
ALL - - When this code is per-formed, the equipment cannot be started up.* This setting is
enabled only when the GP-1060 is installed.
3
1429 Userinterface
Margin width (Top/Bottom, Left/Right)
ALL Front: 7/Back: 7<2-100/-100-100>
SYS This setting is not reflected in "Right", even if the value less than 2 is set for "Back".
10
1430 Userinterface
Margin width (Bookbinding margin)
ALL 14<2-30>
SYS 1
1431 Network ACC (AT_CASETTE_CHANGE) for Printer/Box printing
ALL 1<0-2>
SYS 0: ACC prohibited1: Only in the same
paper direction2: In both same direc-
tion and different directions
1
1432 Network Private-print-only mode ALL 0<0-1>
SYS 0: Normal1: Private-print-only
mode
1
Setting mode (08)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
06/08
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 158
1435 Network "Disable private and proof print save" function
ALL 0<0-1>
SYS 0: Function OFF (no restriction on data saving or other operations)
1: Function ON (Data saving or other operations are restricted)
1
1436 Network "Disable fax save" function ALL 0<0-1>
SYS 0: Function OFF (no restriction on data saving or other operations)
1: Function ON (Data saving or other operations are restricted
1
1440 Network IP Conflict Detect ALL 1<1-2>
- OFF/ON1: Valid2: Invalid
12
1441 Network SNTP Enable ALL 2<1-2>
- OFF/ON1: Valid2: Invalid
12
1442 Network SNTP Polling rate ALL 24<1-168>
- Data obtaining interval(Unit: Hour)
12
1444 Network Primary SNTP Address ALL - - SNTP server IP Address (Primary)
12
1445 Network Secondary SNTP Address ALL - - SNTP server IP Address (Secondary)
12
1446 Network Port number to SNTP ALL 123<1-
65535>
- 12
1447 Network IPP administrator name ALL - - This should be an account which can con-trol all IPP jobs.
12
1448 Network IPP administrator pass-word
ALL - - This should be the password of an account which can control all IPP jobs.
12
1449 Network IPP authentication method ALL 1<1-4>
- 1: Disabled2: Basic3: Digest4: Basic Digest
12
1450 Network User name for IPP authen-tication
ALL - - This should be the account at the time IPP authentication was per-formed.
12
1451 Network Password for IPP authenti-cation
ALL - - This should be the password of the account at the time IPP authentication was per-formed.
12
1464 Network Samba server ON/OFF setting
ALL 1<1-4>
NIC 1: Samba enabled2: Samba disabled3: Print Share disabled4: File Share disabled
12
1468 General User data management limitation setting
ALL(color)
0<0-1>
SYS 0: Disabled1: Enabled
1
Setting mode (08)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
05/11
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 159
2
1469 General User data management limitation Setting by num-ber of printouts
ALL(color)
0<7 digits>
SYS 0-9,999,999:0-9,999,999 sheets
1
1470 General Device authentication func-tion setting
ALL 0<0-1>
SYS 0: OFF1: ON
1
1471 General User authentication method
ALL 0<0-5>
SYS 0: Local1: NTLM (NT Domain)2: LDAP3: Kerberos (Active
Directory)4: Netware
1
1472 General User data management automatic registration func-tion setting
ALL 0<0-1>
SYS 0: Disabled1: Enabled
1
1473 General User data management limitation setting
ALL(black)
0<0-1>
SYS 0: Disabled1: Enabled
1
1474 General User data management limitation Setting by num-ber of printouts
ALL(black)
0<7 digits>
SYS 0-9,999,999:0-9,999,999 sheets
1
1476 Network Restriction on Address book operation by adminis-trator
ALL 0<0-1>
SYS Some restrictions can be given on the admin-istrator for operating the Address book.0: No restriction1: Can be operated
only under the administrator's authorization
1
1477 Network Restriction on "To" ("cc") address
ALL 0<0-3>
SYS 0: No restriction1: Can be set from
both of the Address book and LDAP server
2: Can be set only from the Address book
3: Can be set only from the LDAP server
1
1478 Userinterface
Display of paper size set-ting by installation opera-tion of drawers
ALL JPN: 0UC: 1
EUR: 1<0-1>
SYS 0: Not displayed1: Displayed
1
1479 Userinterface
Default setting of sharp-ness
ALL 5<1-9>
SYS 1: -4 2: -33: -2 4: -15: 0 6: +17: +2 8: +3 9: +4
1
1481 General User data management clearing
ALL - - All the user data in the database and backup files can be deleted.
3
1482 General User data department management
ALL 0<0-1>
SYS 0: Disabled1: Enabled
1
1483 General User data recovery ALL - - The data in the data-base is overwritten with the data in the backup file.
3
Setting mode (08)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
10/06
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 160
1484 Network Authentication method of "Scan to Email"
ALL 0<0-2>
SYS 0: Disabled1: SMTP authentica-
tion2: LDAP authentica-
tion
1
1485 Network Setting whether use of the Internet FAX is permitted at the time of authentication
ALL 0<0-1>
SYS 0: Not permitted1: Permitted
1
1487 Network "From" address assign-ment method at the time of authentication
ALL 0<0-2>
SYS 0: User name + @ + Domain name
1: LDAP searching2: Use the address
registered at "From" field of E-mail set-ting
1
1489 Network Setting for "From" address edit at "Scan to Email"
ALL 0<0-1>
SYS 0: Not permitted1: Permitted
1
1491 Network E-mail domain name ALL - SYS 96 + 2 (delimiter) char-acter* ASCll sequence
only
11
1492 Paper feeding
Detection method of 13" LG for single-size docu-ment
ALL 0<0-1>
SYS 0: Disabled1: Enabled
1
1493 Network Role Base Access Func-tion
ALL 0<0-1>
SYS 0: Function off (No restriction on data saving and other operations)
1: Function on (Data saving and other operations have some restrictions)
1
1494 General Limitation check method ALL 0<0-1>
SYS 0: Checked at every page printed
1: Checked at every job printed
1
1495 Mainte-nance
Service call checking period setting
ALL 6<0-12>
- 0: No checking period specified (= Calls service technician immediately)
0: 10 minutes1: 30 minutes3: 1 hour 4: 6 hours5: 12 hours6: 24 hours7: 48 hours8: 7 days9: 1 month10: 1 year11: 5 years12: Not limited (= Calls
service technician if such error has occurred in the past even once or more)
1
Setting mode (08)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
06/08
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 161
2
1496 General Operation setting for User authentication/registration
ALL 1<0-1>
SYS 0 : Disables operation setting for User authentication/regis-tration
1 : Enables operation setting for User authentication/regis-tration
1
1497 Elec-tronic Fil-
ing
e-Filing Access Mode (for Client)
ALL 0<0-2>
SYS 0: Mode 11: Mode 22: Mode 3
1
1498 FAX Inbound FAX function(Forwarding by TSI)
FAX 1<0-1>
SYS 0: OFF(Function disabled)
1: ON(Function enabled)
1
1530-0 Counter Number of output pages in black mode
1-UP / Duplex printing
PPC(black)
0<8 digits>
SYS Counts the number of output pages printed only in the black mode.
4
1530-1 2-UP / Duplex printing
PPC(black)
0<8 digits>
SYS Counts the number of output pages printed in the black mode using [2IN1] or [MAGAZINE SORT].
4
1530-2 2-UP /Simplex printing
PPC(black)
0<8 digits>
SYS Counts the number of sheets printed in the black mode using [2IN1] or [MAGAZINE SORT].
4
1530-3 4-UP / Duplex printing
PPC(black)
0<8 digits>
SYS Counts the number of output pages printed in the black mode using [4IN1].
4
1530-4 4-UP /Simplex printing
PPC(black)
0<8 digits>
SYS Counts the number of sheets printed in the black mode using [4IN1].
4
1530-7 1-UP /Simplex printing
PPC(black)
0<8 digits>
SYS Counts the number of sheets printed only in the black mode.
4
Setting mode (08)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
06/08
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 162
1531-0 Counter Number of output pages in full color mode
1-UP /Duplex printing
PPC(color)
0<8 digits>
SYS Counts the number of output pages printed only in the full color mode.
4
1531-1 2-UP /Duplex printing
PPC(color)
0<8 digits>
SYS Counts the number of output pages printed in the full color mode using [2IN1] or [MAGA-ZINE SORT].
4
1531-2 2-UP /Simplex printing
PPC(color)
0<8 digits>
SYS Counts the number of sheets printed in the full color mode using [2IN1] or [MAGAZINE SORT].
4
1531-3 4-UP /Duplex printing
PPC(color)
0<8 digits>
SYS Counts the number of output pages printed in the full color mode using [4IN1].
4
1531-4 4-UP /Simplex printing
PPC(color)
0<8 digits>
SYS Counts the number of sheets printed in the full color mode using [4IN1].
4
1531-7 1-UP /Simplex printing
PPC(color)
0<8 digits>
SYS Counts the number of sheets printed only in the full color mode.
4
1532-0 Counter Number of output pages in twin color mode
1-UP /Duplex printing
PPC(color)
0<8 digits>
SYS Counts the number of output pages printed only in the twin color mode.
4
1532-1 2-UP /Duplex printing
PPC(color)
0<8 digits>
SYS Counts the number of output pages printed in the twin color mode using [2IN1] or [MAGA-ZINE SORT].
4
1532-2 2-UP /Simplex printing
PPC(color)
0<8 digits>
SYS Counts the number of sheets printed in the twin color mode using [2IN1] or [MAGAZINE SORT].
4
1532-3 4-UP /Duplex printing
PPC(color)
0<8 digits>
SYS Counts the number of output pages printed in the twin color mode using [4IN1].
4
1532-4 4-UP /Simplex printing
PPC(color)
0<8 digits>
SYS Counts the number of sheets printed in the twin color mode using [4IN1].
4
1532-7 1-UP /Simplex printing
PPC(color)
0<8 digits>
SYS Counts the number of sheets printed only in the twin color mode.
4
Setting mode (08)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
06/08
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 163
2
1533-0 Counter Number of output pages of the printer or BOX
1-UP /Duplex printing
PRT(black)
0<8 digits>
SYS Counts the number of output pages printed in the black mode.
4
1533-1 2-UP /Duplex printing
PRT(black)
0<8 digits>
SYS Counts the number of output pages printed in the black mode using [2IN1] or [MAGAZINE SORT].* When printing is
performed using a Windows driver, the 1-UP image will be output.
4
1533-2 2-UP /Simplex printing
PRT(black)
0<8 digits>
SYS Counts the number of sheets printed in the black mode using [2IN1] or [MAGAZINE SORT].
4
1533-3 4-UP /Duplex printing
PRT(black)
0<8 digits>
SYS Counts the number of output pages printed in the black mode using [4IN1].
4
1533-4 4-UP /Simplex printing
PRT(black)
0<8 digits>
SYS Counts the number of sheets printed in the black mode using [4IN1].
4
1533-5 N-UP /Duplex printing
PRT(black)
0<8 digits>
SYS Counts the number of output pages printed in the black mode using [N IN1].
4
1533-6 N-UP /Simplex printing
PRT(black)
0<8 digits>
SYS Counts the number of sheets printed in the black mode using [N IN1].
4
1533-7 1-UP /Simplex printing
PRT(black)
0<8 digits>
SYS Counts the number of sheets printed only in the black mode.
4
Setting mode (08)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
07/11
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 164
1534-0 Counter Number of output pages of the printer or BOX(Full color)
1-UP /Duplex printing
PRT(color)
0<8 digits>
SYS Counts the number of output pages printed only in the full color mode.
4
1534-1 2-UP /Duplex printing
PRT(color)
0<8 digits>
SYS Counts the number of output pages printed in the full color mode using [2IN1] or [MAGA-ZINE SORT].* When printing is
performed using a Windows driver, the 1-UP image will be output.
4
1534-2 2-UP /Simplex printing
PRT(color)
0<8 digits>
SYS Counts the number of sheets printed in the full color mode using [2IN1] or [MAGAZINE SORT].
4
1534-3 4-UP /Duplex printing
PRT(color)
0<8 digits>
SYS Counts the number of output pages printed in the full color mode using [4IN1].
4
1534-4 4-UP /Simplex printing
PRT(color)
0<8 digits>
SYS Counts the number of sheets printed in the full color mode using [4IN1].
4
1534-5 N-UP /Duplex printing
PRT(color)
0<8 digits>
SYS Counts the number of output pages printed in the full color mode using [N IN1].
4
1534-6 N-UP /Simplex printing
PRT(color)
0<8 digits>
SYS Counts the number of sheets printed in the full color mode using [N IN1].
4
1534-7 1-UP /Simplex printing
PRT(color)
0<8 digits>
SYS Counts the number of sheets printed only in the full color mode.
4
1535-0 Counter Number of output pages of the FAX printing(1-UP / Duplex print-ing)
1-UP /Duplex printing
FAX(black)
0<8 digits>
SYS Counts the number of sheets in the default settings.
4
1535-7 1-UP /Simplex printing
FAX(black)
0<8 digits>
SYS 4
1661 Wireless LAN
Wireless LAN driver SSID
ALL - - Maximum 32 letters 12
1662 Wireless LAN
Wireless LAN driver Network type
ALL 1<1-2>
- 1: Infrastructure2: Ad-Hoc
12
1663 Wireless LAN
Wireless LAN driver Security
ALL 4<1-7>
- 1: 802.1x 2: WPA-PSK3: WEP 4: NONE5: WPA 6: WPA27: WPA2PSK
12
1664 Wireless LAN
Wireless LAN driver Encryption system
ALL 1<1-3>
- 1: TKIP 2: AES3: Dynamic WEP
12
1665 Wireless LAN
Wireless LAN driver Transmission output power
ALL 1<1-5>
- 1: 100% 2: 50%3: 25% 4: 12.5%5: min
12
Setting mode (08)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
06/08
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 165
2
1666 Wireless LAN
Wireless LAN driver Transmission rate
ALL 1<1-2>
- 1: Auto 2: Manual 12
1667 Wireless LAN
Wireless LAN driver Transmission rate value
ALL 1<1-12>
- 1: 1 2: 23: 5.5 4: 115: 6 6: 97: 12 8: 189: 2410: 3611: 4812: 54
12
1668 Wireless LAN
Wireless LAN driver Operation channel
ALL 1<1-2>
- 1: Auto 2: Manual 12
1669 Wireless LAN
Wireless LAN driver Operation channel value
ALL 1<1-11>
- 12
1670 Wireless LAN
Wireless LAN driver WEP bit number
ALL 1<1-3>
- 1:64 2: 1283: 152
12
1671 Wireless LAN
Wireless LAN driverWEP key entry system
ALL 2<1-2>
- 1: Hex 2: ASCII 12
1672 Wireless LAN
Wireless LAN driver WEP key value
ALL - - Maximum 32 letters 12
1673 Wireless LAN
Wireless LAN driver WPA-PSK passphrase
ALL - - Maximum 64 letters 12
1674 Wireless LAN
Wireless LAN driver Sleep mode setting
ALL 1<1-3>
- 1: Off 2: Max3: Normal
12
1675 Wireless LAN
Wireless LAN driverSlot-time limitation
ALL 1<1-2>
- 1: Long 2: Short 12
1676 Wireless LAN
Wireless LAN driver Number of times of soft-ware retry
ALL 5<0-1000>
- 12
1677 Wireless LAN
Wireless LAN driver Preamble
ALL 1<1-2>
- 1: Long 2: Longshort 12
1678 Wireless LAN
Wireless LAN driverOperation mode
ALL 1<1-3>
- 1: All 2: 11b3: 11g
12
1679 Wireless LAN
Wireless LAN supplicantWireless LAN setting
ALL 1<1-3>
- This setting is whether the wireless LAN con-nection is enabled or disabled.1: Unset 2: Enabled3: Disabled
12
1681 Wireless LAN
Wireless LAN supplicantPath name for client certifi-cate
ALL - - This should be the path name in full where the client certificate is located.(Maximum 255 letters)
12
1682 Wireless LAN
Wireless LAN supplicantPath name for secret key of client certificate
ALL - - This should be the path name in full where the client certificate is located.(Maximum 255 letters)
12
1684 Wireless LAN
Wireless LAN supplicantPath name for CA self-cer-tificate
ALL - - This should be the path name in full where the CA self-certificate is located.(Maximum 255 letters)
12
1685 Wireless LAN
Wireless LAN supplicantEAP user name
ALL - - This should be the user name when the EAP-TLS is used.
12
Setting mode (08)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
06/08
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 166
1686 Wireless LAN
Wireless LAN supplicantEAP user name
ALL - - This should be the user name when the PEAP is used.
12
1689 Wireless LAN
Wireless LAN supplicantAuthentication interval
ALL 30<30-
65535>
- This should be the time-out interval between EAP responses. 30: 30 seconds
12
1690 Wireless LAN
Wireless LAN supplicantHolding interval
ALL 60<60-
65535>
M The EAP authentica-tion will start after hav-ing been waited in this period when an EAP failure was received.60: 60 seconds
12
1691 Wireless LAN
Wireless LAN supplicantEAPOL-StartNumber of times of packet retry
ALL 3<1-
65535>
M When an EAPOL-Start packet has been sent and the request ID can-not be received, this EAPOL-Start packet will be re-sent for the num-ber of times set in this code. 3: 3 times
12
1692 Wireless LAN
Wireless LAN supplicantSession resume
ALL 2<1-2>
- This setting is whether the pre-master key should be updated or not upon a TLS re-negotiation.1: Session is resumed2: Session is not
resumed
12
1693 Wireless LAN
Wireless LAN supplicantMAC Frame size
ALL 1398<1-1398>
- This is a MAC frame size used in the wire-less LAN connection. The data is fragmented into this size.1398: 1398 bytes
12
1696 Wireless LAN
Wireless LAN supplicantDevice file setting for obtaining random number
ALL /dev/urandom
- This should be the device file name which can obtain a seed to ini-tialize the WEP PRNG for xsupplicant.(Maximum 255 letters)
12
1697 Wireless LAN
Wireless LAN supplicantCRL directory designation
ALL - - This should be the path name of the directory in full where the CRL file is located.(Maximum 255 letters)
12
1699 Wireless LAN
Wireless LAN supplicantEAP authentication type
ALL 1<1-3>
- This setting is for the EAP authentication type which xsupplicant can authenticate.1: EAP-TLS 2: PEAP3: EAP-TLS and PEAP
12
1700 Wireless LAN
Wireless LAN supplicantCN name
ALL - - This should be an authentication server name (basically a domain name in full).(Maximum 255 letters)
12
Setting mode (08)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
06/08
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 167
2
1701 Wireless LAN
Wireless LAN supplicantCN name check
ALL 1<1-2>
- 1: NO 2: YES 12
1704 Wireless LAN
Wireless LAN supplicantUpdate interval of PTK (Pairwise Transient Key)
ALL 0<0-720>
- The update interval of a secret key across AP (Access Point) and STA (Station) can be set. This interval is for updating the secret key from STA.0: Not updated1-720: 1-720 minutes of interval
12
1705 Wireless LAN
Wireless LAN supplicantStrict packet check
ALL 1<1-2>
- The Ack bit and request bit of EAPOL-Key is checked.1: Not checked2: Checked
12
1706 Wireless LAN
Wireless LAN supplicantPriority change at 4-way handshake
ALL 1<1-2>
- A higher priority is given to the xsupplicant task when a 4-way hand-shake is started.1: Priority not changed2: Priority changed
12
1707 Wireless LAN
Wireless LAN supplicantSecurity level
ALL 1<1-3>
- The encryption capabil-ity output in TLS clien-tHello message can be selected.1: LOW 2: MIDDLE3: HIGH
12
1708 Selectable security level (EAP-TLS)
ALL 1<1-3>
- These are the security level which can be selected from the user interface. This setting is not applied in case of PEAP. ("LOW" and "MIDDLE" is manda-tory for PEAP)1: LOW + MIDDLE +
HIGH2: MIDDLE + HIGH3: HIGH
12
1710 Blue-tooth
BluetoothON/OFF setting
ALL 1<0-1>
SYS 0: OFF1: ON
1
1711 Blue-tooth
BluetoothDevice name
ALL MFP SYS Maximum 32 letters 11
1712 Blue-tooth
BluetoothDiscovery
ALL 1<0-1>
SYS 0: Not allowed1: Allowed
1
1713 Blue-tooth
BluetoothSecurity
ALL 1<0-1>
SYS 0: Security function OFF
1: Security function ON
1
1714 Blue-tooth
BluetoothPIN
ALL 0000 SYS Maximum 8 digits (8-digit sequence) This setting is valid only when the bluetooth security function is ON.
11
Setting mode (08)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 168
1715 Blue-tooth
BluetoothData encryption
ALL 1<0-1>
SYS 0: Not encrypted1: EncryptedThis setting is valid only when the bluetooth security function is ON.
1
1719 Blue-tooth
BluetoothBIP Paper type
ALL 0<0-3>
SYS 0: Fit page1: 1/2 size2: 1/4 size3: 1/8 size
1
1720 Network IP address range for IP fil-ter (Minimum area 1)
ALL - - IP filter minimum area 1000.000.000.000-255.255.255.255(Default value: 000.000.000.000)
12
1721 Network IP address range for IP fil-ter (Maximum area 1)
ALL - - IP filter maximum area 1000.000.000.000-255.255.255.255(Default value: 000.000.000.000)
12
1722 Network IP address range for IP fil-ter I(Minimum area 2)
ALL - - IP filter minimum area 2000.000.000.000-255.255.255.255(Default value: 000.000.000.000)
12
1723 Network IP address range for IP fil-ter (Maximum area 2)
ALL - - IP filter maximum area 2000.000.000.000-255.255.255.255(Default value: 000.000.000.000)
12
1724 Network IP address range for IP fil-ter (Minimum area 3)
ALL - - IP filter minimum area 3000.000.000.000-255.255.255.255(Default value: 000.000.000.000)
12
1725 Network IP address range for IP fil-ter (Maximum area 3)
ALL - - IP filter maximum area 3000.000.000.000-255.255.255.255(Default value: 000.000.000.000)
12
1726 Network IP address range for IP fil-ter (Minimum area 4)
ALL - - IP filter minimum area 4000.000.000.000-255.255.255.255(Default value: 000.000.000.000)
12
1727 Network IP address range for IP fil-ter (Maximum area 4)
ALL - - IP filter maximum area 4000.000.000.000-255.255.255.255(Default value: 000.000.000.000)
12
1728 Network IP address range for IP fil-ter(Minimum area 5)
ALL - - IP filter minimum area 5000.000.000.000-255.255.255.255(Default value: 000.000.000.000)
12
Setting mode (08)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
06/08
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 169
2
1729 Network IP address range for IP fil-ter (Maximum area 5)
ALL - - IP filter maximum area 5000.000.000.000-255.255.255.255(Default value: 000.000.000.000)
12
1730 Network IP address range for IP fil-ter (Minimum area 6)
ALL - - IP filter minimum area 6000.000.000.000-255.255.255.255(Default value: 000.000.000.000)
12
1731 Network IP address range for IP fil-ter (Maximum area 6)
ALL - - IP filter maximum area 6000.000.000.000-255.255.255.255(Default value: 000.000.000.000)
12
1732 Network IP address range for IP fil-ter (Minimum area 7)
ALL - - IP filter minimum area 7000.000.000.000-255.255.255.255(Default value: 000.000.000.000)
12
1733 Network IP address range for IP fil-ter (Maximum area 7)
ALL - - IP filter maximum area 7000.000.000.000-255.255.255.255(Default value: 000.000.000.000)
12
1734 Network IP address range for IP fil-ter (Minimum area 8)
ALL - - IP filter minimum area 8000.000.000.000-255.255.255.255(Default value: 000.000.000.000)
12
1735 Network IP address range for IP fil-ter(Maximum area 8)
ALL - - IP filter maximum area 8000.000.000.000-255.255.255.255(Default value: 000.000.000.000)
12
1736 Network IP address range for IP fil-ter (Minimum area 9)
ALL - - IP filter minimum area 9000.000.000.000-255.255.255.255(Default value: 000.000.000.000)
12
1737 Network IP address range for IP fil-ter (Maximum area 9)
ALL - - IP filter maximum area 9000.000.000.000-255.255.255.255(Default value: 000.000.000.000)
12
1738 Network IP address range for IP fil-ter (Minimum area 10)
ALL - - IP filter minimum area 10000.000.000.000-255.255.255.255(Default value: 000.000.000.000)
12
Setting mode (08)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
06/08
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 170
1739 Network IP address range for IP fil-ter (Maximum area 10)
ALL - - IP filter maximum area 10000.000.000.000-255.255.255.255(Default value: 000.000.000.000)
12
1740 Network SSL settingSSL ftp server OFF/ON
ALL 2<1-2>
- 1: Enabled2: Disabled
12
1741 Network SSL settingHTTP server port number
ALL 10443<1-
65535>
- SSL HTTP server port number
12
1742 Network SSL settingIPP server OFF/ON setting
ALL 2<1-2>
- 1: Enabled2: Disabled
12
1743 Network SSL settingIPP server port number
ALL 443<1-
65535>
- SSL IPP server port number
12
1744 Network SSL settingSSL ftp server OFF/ON
ALL 2<1-2>
- OFF/ON1: Valid2: Invalid
12
1745 Network SSL settingSSL ftp server Port
ALL 990<1-
65535>
- Port number to FTP Server
12
1746 Network SSL settingSSL LDAP Client OFF/ON
ALL 2<1-3>
- OFF/ON1: Valid2: Invalid3: Use imported certifi-cate
12
1747 Network SSL setting SSL LDAP Client Port
ALL 636<1-
65535>
- Port number to LDAP Server
12
1748 Network SSL settingSSL POP3 Client OFF/ON
ALL 2<1-3>
- OFF/ON1: Valid2: Invalid3: Use imported certifi-cate
12
1749 Network SSL settingSSL POP3 Client Port
ALL 995<1-
65535>
- Port number to POP3 Server
12
1750 Network SSL settingSSL SMTP Client OFF/ON
ALL 2<2-6>
- 2: Invalid3: Accept all certifi-
cates of SMTP with TLS (STARTTLS) server
4: Accept all certifi-cates of SMTPS (SMTP OverSSL) server
5: Use imported certifi-cates of SMTP with TLS (STARTTLS) server
6: Use imported certifi-cates of SMTPS (SMTP OverSSL) server
12
1751 Network SSL settingSSL SMTP Client Port
ALL 465<1-
65535>
- Port number to SMTP Server
12
Setting mode (08)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
06/08
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 171
2
1755 Network Enabling server's IP address acquired by DHCP
ALL 2<1-2>
- Domain Name Server option (6)1: Enabled2: Disabled* This value is used
only when DHCP is enabled.
12
1756 Network Enabling server's IP address acquired by DHCP
ALL 2<1-2>
- NetBIOS over TCP/IP Name Server option (44) = Primary and Secondary Wins NAME1: Enabled2: Disabled* This value is used
only when DHCP is enabled.
12
1757 Network Enabling server's IP address acquired by DHCP
ALL 1<1-2>
- The Host Name Ven-dor Extension option (12)1: Enabled2: DisabledThis value is used only when DHCP is enabled.
12
1762 Network Enabling server's IP address acquired by DHCP
ALL 2<1-2>
- SNTP Server Option (42) NTP Server Address1: Enabled2: Disabled* This value is used
only when DHCP is enabled.
12
1764 Wireless LAN
Wireless LAN supplicant Control sequence setting of "Cipher Suite"
ALL - - Maximum 255 letters 12
1765 Wireless LAN
Wireless LAN supplicant Path name for user certifi-cate
ALL - - Maximum 63 letters 12
1766 Wireless LAN
Wireless LAN supplicant Path name entered for CA self-certificate
ALL - - Maximum 63 letters 12
1767 Network Enabling server's IP address acquired by DHCP
ALL 2<1-2>
SYS DNS domain name Option (15) DNS domain name of the cli-ent1: Enabled2: Disabled* This value is used
only when DHCP is enabled.
12
1768 Network Previous IP address ALL - - 000.000.000.000-255.255.255.255(Default value: 000.000.000.000)
12
Setting mode (08)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
07/04
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 172
1772 General Card reading device set-ting
ALL 0<8 digits>
SYS To enable the e-Bridge ID Gate, a card reading device should be set in the order of "ABYYZZZZ". (Enter the corresponding val-ues to "A", "B", "YY" and "ZZZZ".)- AB:Special setting- A :Debugging NIC
0: Not used1: Used
- B :Interface0: USB connection1: N/A
- YY: Authentication00: No authentica-tion using a noncon-tact IC card02: Authentication using a noncontact IC card (KP-2003)03: Authentication using a noncontact IC card (KP-2005)04: Authentication using a noncontact IC card (KP-2004)
- ZZZZ: Sub-code0000: No authenti-cation using a non-contact IC card0001: Use CSN (Card Serial Num-ber) of a noncon-tact IC card0002: Use the Data Area Address Infor-mation of a noncon-tact IC card
5
Setting mode (08)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
07/04
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 173
2
1773 General Card reader format infor-mation -1
ALL - SYS To access the data in the noncontact IC card, the Key Information "LLLL" and the Sector Number "MMMM" should be set. The "LLLL" should be set first, and then "MMMM".KP-2003:LLLL: System code (hexadecimal number)MMMM: Service code (hexadecimal number)
KP-2005:LLLL : Key informationMMMM: Sector number (hexadecimal number)
5
1774 General Card reader format infor-mation -2
ALL - SYS The data of the block number in the noncon-tact IC is set.KP-2003: <PPQRSSTU (hexadecimal number)>PP:1st blockQ: 1st block beginning
byteR: 1st block ending-
byteSS:2nd blockT: 2nd block begin-
ning byteU: 2nd block ending
byte
KP-2005: <RRBSEbse (hexadecimal number)>RR:00 (Fixed)B: 1st area block num-
berS: 1st area beginning
byte offsetE: 1st area ending byte
offsetb: 2nd area block
numbers: 2nd area beginning
byte offsete: 2nd area ending
byte offset
* If the 2nd block/area is not used, set the SSTU to "FFFF" (hexadeci-mal number), the bse to"FFF" (hexadecimal number).
5
Setting mode (08)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
07/04
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 174
1775 General Card reader format infor-mation -3
ALL - SYS Security key “KKKKKKKKKKKK” (12 digits) <hexadecimal number> in the [Key Information] of the [Sec-tor Number] set in the code 08-1773 should be entered.
5
1776 General Card authentication LDAP server
ALL 0<0-100>
SYS LDAP server number for the card authentica-tion when a noncontact IC card is used should be set.
1
1777 General Card authentication LDAP search index
ALL - SYS LDAP search index when a noncontact IC card is used is set.
11
1778 General Hang-up period of control panel at the 3rd misentry of administrator's password
ALL 1<0-7>
SYS 0: No hang-up1: 0.5 minutes (= 30
seconds)2: 1 minute3: 3 minutes4: 5 minutes5: 10 minutes6: 15 minutes7: 30 minutes
1
1779 Network Default data saving direc-tory of "Scan to File"
ALL 0<0-2>
SYS 0: Local directory1: REMOTE 12: REMOTE 2
1
1781-0 Network Notification of scan job
When job completed
ALL 0<0-1>
SYS Sets the notification method of scan job completion. 0: Invalid1: Valid
4
1781-1 On error ALL 0<0-1>
SYS 4
1782 Network File name format of "Save as file" and Email transmis-sion
ALL 0<0-6>
SYS Sets the naming method of the file of "Save as file" and Email transmission. 0: [FileName]-[Data]-
[Page]1: [FileName]-[Page]-
[Data]2: [Data]-[FileName]-
[Page]3: [Data]-[Page]-[File-
Name]4: [Page]-[FileName]-
[Data]5: [Page]-[Data]-[File-
Name]6: [HostName]_[Data]-
[Page]
1
Setting mode (08)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
06/08
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 175
2
1783 Network Date display format of the file name of "Save as file" and Email transmission
ALL 0<0-5>
SYS Sets the data display format of the file of "Save as file" and Email transmission. 0: [YYYY][MM][DD]
[HH][mm][SS]1: [YY][MM][DD]
[HH][mm][SS]2: [YYYY][MM][DD]3: [YY][MM][DD]4: [HH][mm][SS]5: [YYYY][MM][DD]
[HH][mm][SS][mm0]
The order of [YY], [MM] and [DD] varies depending on the set-ting of the code 08-640 (Data display format).
1
1784 Network Single page data saving directory at "Save as file"
ALL 0<0-1>
SYS Sets the directory where the file of "Save as file" is saved. 0: Save it under a sub-
folder1: Save it without cre-
ating a subfolder
1
1785 Network Page number display for-mat of the file of "Save as file" and Email transmis-sion
ALL 4<3-6>
SYS Sets the digit of a page number attached on the file.3-6: 3-6 digits
1
1786 Network Extension (suffix) format of the file of "Save as file"
ALL 3<3-6>
SYS Sets the extension dig-its of the file to be saved.3: Auto4: 4 digits5: 5 digits6: 6 digits
1
1800-0 Image process-
ing
Color toner forced supply time setting
Y ALL(color)
70<0-255>
M Sets the motor driving time of the developer unit at the time of the color toner forced sup-ply.0-255: Setting value x 0.1 seconds
4
1800-1 M ALL(color)
70<0-255>
M 4
1800-2 C ALL(color)
70<0-255>
M 4
1801 Image process-
ing
Color toner forced supply count setting
ALL(color)
7<1-10>
M Sets the number of times of the color toner forced supply.
1
Setting mode (08)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
07/04
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 176
1802-0 Image process-
ing
Start up set-ting of the developer material stabi-lizing mode.
Level ALL 3<2-8>
M Sets the performing level of the developer material stabilizing operation.
4
1802-1 Pattern interval
ALL 50<0-100>
M Set the interval time between performances of developer material stabilizing operation.
4
1802-2 Number of repeating
time
ALL 10<0-20>
M Set the number of repeating times of the developer material sta-bilizing operation.
4
1911 Finisher Manual stapling time-out period
ALL 15<3-30>
M 3-30sec.(In increments of 1sec.)
1
1912 Finisher Finisher model switching setting value
ALL 0<0-1>
M 0: MJ-10231: MJ-1101
1
1913 General Page number addition on multipage file names of "File/Email"
ALL 0<0-1>
SYS 1
1914 General Maximum number of deci-mals in extension fields
ALL 2<0-6>
SYS 0: 0 digit1: 1 digit2: 2 digits3: 3 digits4: 4 digits5: 5 digits6: 6 digits
1
1915 Network Filing size for Network scanning function
ALL 0<0-1>
SYS 0: Eliminates 2 mm from circumference (Void: 2 mm)
1: No space eliminated (Void: 0 mm)
1
1916 General Default saving/attachment files of "File/Email"
ALL 0<0-1>
SYS 1
1920 Network Device domain name of device authentication
ALL - UTY Maximum 128 letters 12
1921 Network Windows domain No. 2 of user authentication
ALL - UTY Maximum 128 letters 12
1922 Network Windows domain No. 3 of user authentication
ALL - UTY Maximum 128 letters 12
1923 Network LDAP authenticationServer type
ALL 1<1-2>
NIC 1: Windows Server2: Not Windows Server
12
1924 Network LDAP authenticationUser attribute
ALL - NIC Sets a user attribute name.
12
1925 Network Execution of user authenti-cation when the user ID is not entered
ALL 2<0-2>
SYS 0: Forcible execution1: Execution impossi-
ble (pooled in the invalid queue)
2: Forcible deletion
1
1926 FAX Tab/cover sheet printing at FAX reception Printing stop function
ALL 0<0-1>
SYS Sets on or off of the printing function of spe-cial sheets such as tab or cover sheet of FAX, Email or list print. 0: Function off1: Function on
1
Setting mode (08)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
07/04
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 177
2
1927 Network LDAP server attribute name setting for card authentication
ALL eBMUserCard
SYS Up to 32 letters 11
1928 Network Role Based AccessLDAP search index
ALL 0<0-
4294967295>
SYS This code is used to specify the ID for the LDAP server to imple-ment Role-Based Access Control.
5
1929 User interface
Key arrangement for lan-guage 1
ALL 0<0-2>
SYS 0: QWERTY layout (for EUR)
1: QWERTZ layout2: AZERTY layout
1
1930 User interface
Key arrangement for lan-guage 2
ALL 1<0-2>
SYS 0: QWERTY layout (for EUR)
1: QWERTZ layout2: AZERTY layout
1
1931 User interface
Key arrangement for lan-guage 3
ALL EUR: 2UC: 0JPN: 0<0-2>
SYS 0: QWERTY layout (for EUR)
1: QWERTZ layout2: AZERTY layout
1
1932 User interface
Key arrangement for lan-guage 4
ALL 0<0-2>
SYS 0: QWERTY layout (for EUR)
1: QWERTZ layout2: AZERTY layout
1
1933 User interface
Key arrangement for lan-guage 5
ALL 0<0-2>
SYS 0: QWERTY layout (for EUR)
1: QWERTZ layout2: AZERTY layout
1
1934 User interface
Key arrangement for lan-guage 6
ALL 0<0-2>
SYS 0: QWERTY layout (for EUR)
1: QWERTZ layout2: AZERTY layout
1
1935 User interface
Key arrangement for lan-guage 7
ALL 0<0-2>
SYS 0: QWERTY layout (for EUR)
1: QWERTZ layout2: AZERTY layout
1
1936 Network AppleTalk device name ALL MFP-serial
UTY Maximum 32 lettersThe Network-related serial number of the equipment appears at "serial".
12
Setting mode (08)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
10/02
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 178
1937 Network User name and password at user authentication or "Save as file"
ALL 0<0-2>
SYS 0: User name and password of the device
1: User name and password at the user authentication (Template registra-tion information comes first when a template is retrieved.)
2: User name and password at the user authentication (User information of the authentication comes first when a template is retrieved.)
1
1938 General Reformatting process due to a version change of SYS ROM
ALL -<0-2>
- Use this setting to refor-mat the specific parti-tion whose file system has been changed in Ver.2, at the version up/downgrade of the SYS ROM. No reformatting pro-cess shall be used in any cases other than this version change.0: Waiting (No refor-
matting)1: dosFs to catFs (Ver-
sion upgrade from Ver.1 to Ver.2 or later)
2: catFs to dosFs (Ver-sion downgrade from Ver.2 or later to Ver.1)
7
1940 General STAGE port number SCN 20080<0-
65535>
SYS Port number used for the remote scanning is set.
1
1941 Blue-tooth
BluetoothBIP Paper size
ALL EUR: 6UC: 2JPN: 6<0-13>
SYS 0: Ledger 1: Legal2: Letter 3: Computer4: Statement 5: A36: A4 7: A58: A6 9: B410: B5 11: Folio12: Legal13"13: LetterSquare
1950 Network SMB signature for SMB server
ALL 1<0-3>
UTY 1: Auto2: Valid3: Invalid
12
1951 Network SMB signature for SMB cli-ent
ALL 1<0-3>
UTY 1: Auto2: Valid3: Invalid
12
1952 Network Device name for device authentication
ALL - UTY Maximum 128 letters 12
Setting mode (08)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
06/08
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 179
2
1953 Network Password for the device name used for device authentication
ALL - UTY Maximum 128 letters 12
1954 Network PDC2 of user authentica-tion
ALL - UTY Maximum 128 letters 12
1955 Network BDC2 of user authentica-tion
ALL - UTY Maximum 128 letters 12
1956 Network PDC3 of user authentica-tion
ALL - UTY Maximum 128 letters 12
1957 Network BDC3 of user authentica-tion
ALL - UTY Maximum 128 letters 12
1958 Network PDC of device authentica-tion
ALL - UTY Maximum 128 letters 12
1959 Network BDC of device authentica-tion
ALL - UTY Maximum 128 letters 12
1960 General KS Filter operation mode ALL 0<0-1>
SYS 0: Disabled1: Enabled
1
1961 General KS/KSSM setting all clear-ing
ALL - - Does not reset the value of the code 08-1960 but resets those of the codes 08-1963 to 1994.
3
1963 General KS Filter Emulation Mode ALL 0<0-2>
SYS 0: Auto1: KS2: KSSM
1
1964 General KS Filter Paper Size ALL 1<0-5>
SYS 0: A31: A42: B43: B54: Letter5: Legal
1
1965 General KS Filter Orientation ALL 0<0-1>
SYS 0: Portrait1: Landscape
1
1966 General KS Filter Copies ALL 1<1-999>
SYS 1
1967 General KS Paper Source ALL 0<0-1>
SYS 1
1968 General KS Duplex Mode ALL 0<0-2>
SYS 1
1970 General KS CPI (English CPI/ Hangle CPI)
ALL 1<0-10>
SYS 0: (5/10) 1: (6/12) 2: (6.7/13.3)3: (6.9/13.8) 4: (7.5/15) 5: (8.3/16.7)6: (9/18) 7: (10/10) 8: (10/20)9: (12/24) 10: (15/30)
1
1971 General KS LPI ALL 60<30-160>
SYS Key in the value 10 times as the desired font size.(e.g.: Key in "45" for a font size 4.5.)
1
Setting mode (08)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
06/08
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 180
1972 General KS Type Face ALL 0<0-5>
SYS 0: MYUNGJO1: GOTHIC2: GUNGSEO3: GULLIM4: GRAPH5: SAMMUL
1
1973 General KS Font Size ALL 96<96-160>
SYS Key in the value 10 times as the desired font size.(e.g.: Key in "100" for a font size 10.0.)
1
1974 General KS Zoom ALL 100<20-400>
SYS 1
1975 General KS CR/LF Mode ALL 2<0-3>
SYS 0: CR->CR,LF->LF
1: CR->CR+LF,LF->LF
2: CR->CR,LF->CR+LF
3: CR->CR+LF,LF->CR+LF
1
1976 General KS Top Margin ALL 0<0-50>
SYS Key in the value 10 times as the desired font size.(e.g.: Key in "40" for a font size 4.0.)
1
1977 General KS Left Margin ALL 0<0-50>
SYS Key in the value 10 times as the desired font size.(e.g.: Key in "40" for a font size 4.0.)
1
1978 General KS Auto Wrap ALL 0<0-1>
SYS 0: OFF1: ON
1
1979 General KS Han Mode ALL 1<0-1>
SYS 0: OFF1: ON
1
1980 General KS Han Code ALL 0<0-1>
SYS 0: Wansung1: Johap
1
1984 General KSSM CPI (English CPI/ Hangle CPI)
ALL 1<0-10>
SYS 0: (5/10)1: (6/12)2: (6.7/13.3)3: (6.9/13.8)4: (7.5/15)5: (8.3/16.7)6: (9/18)7: (10/10)8: (10/20)9: (12/24)10: (15/30)
1
1985 General KSSM LPI ALL 60<30-160>
SYS Key in the value 10 times as the desired font size.(e.g.: Key in "45" for a font size 4.5.)
1
Setting mode (08)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
07/04
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 181
2
1986 General KSSM Type Face ALL 0<0-5>
SYS 0: MYUNGJO1: GOTHIC2: GUNGSEO3: GULLIM4: GRAPH5: SAMMUL
1
1987 General KSSM Font Size ALL 96<96-160>
SYS Key in the value 10 times as the desired font size.(e.g.: Key in "100" for a font size 10.0.)
1
1988 General KSSM Zoom ALL 100<20-400>
SYS 1
1989 General KSSM CR/LF Mode ALL 2<0-3>
SYS 0: CR->CR,LF->LF
1: CR->CR+LF,LF->LF
2: CR->CR,LF->CR+LF
3: CR->CR+LF,LF->CR+LF
1
1990 General KSSM Top Margin ALL 0<0-50>
SYS Key in the value 10 times as the desired font size.(e.g.: Key in "40" for a font size 4.0.)
1
1991 General KSSM Left Margin ALL 0<0-50>
SYS Key in the value 10 times as the desired font size.(e.g.: Key in "40" for a font size 4.0.)
1
1992 General KSSM Auto Wrap ALL 0<0-1>
SYS 0: OFF1: ON
1
1993 General KSSM Han Mode ALL 1<0-1>
SYS 0: OFF1: ON
1
1994 General KSSM Han Code ALL 0<0-1>
SYS 0: Wansung1: Johap
1
2401-0 Develop-ment
Initial adjust-ment value of K auto-toner output value
Relative humidity 0-29.9%RH
ALL 125<0-255>
M This code changes the controlled developer density by setting the target adjustment volt-age value when auto-matic adjustment of the auto-toner sensor (K) is performed. Changing this code may cause negative effects such as aggravation of toner-scattering, errors in image quality control, background fogging, and carrier offset. Change this code only when told to adjust the density of the devel-oper, otherwise do not do so.
4
2401-1 Relative humidity 30.0-44.9%RH
ALL 127<0-255>
M 4
2401-2 Relative humidity 45.0-59.9%RH
ALL 128<0-255>
M 4
2401-3 Relative humidity 60.0-74.9%RH
ALL 137<0-255>
M 4
2401-4 Relative humidity 75.0-100%RH
ALL 146<0-255>
M 4
Setting mode (08)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
10/06
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 182
2402-0 Develop-ment
K first refill level setting value
Relative humidity 0-29.9%RH
ALL 125<0-255>
M This code changes the density of the developer at the start of toner refilling by setting the auto-toner sensor out-put value. Toner may not be refilled at the right time if this code is changed. Change this code only when told to adjust the toner refilling conditions, otherwise do not do so.
4
2402-1 Relative humidity 30.0-44.9%RH
ALL 127<0-255>
M 4
2402-2 Relative humidity 45.0-59.9%RH
ALL 128<0-255>
M 4
2402-3 Relative humidity 60.0-74.9%RH
ALL 137<0-255>
M 4
2402-4 Relative humidity 75.0-100%RH
ALL 146<0-255>
M 4
2403-0 Develop-ment
K second refill level setting value
Relative humidity 0-29.9%RH
ALL 130<0-255>
M This code changes the density of the developer at the start of toner refilling by setting the auto-toner sensor out-put value. Toner may not be refilled at the right time if this code is changed. Change this code only when told to adjust the toner refilling conditions, otherwise do not do so.
4
2403-1 Relative humidity 30.0-44.9%RH
ALL 131<0-255>
M 4
2403-2 Relative humidity 45.0-59.9%RH
ALL 132<0-255>
M 4
2403-3 Relative humidity 60.0-74.9%RH
ALL 141<0-255>
M 4
2403-4 Relative humidity 75.0-100%RH
ALL 150<0-255>
M 4
Setting mode (08)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
10/06
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 183
2
2404-0 Develop-ment
K third refill level setting value
Relative humidity 0-29.9%RH
ALL 134<0-255>
M This code changes the density of the developer at the start of toner refilling by setting the auto-toner sensor out-put value. Toner may not be refilled at the right time if this code is changed. Change this code only when told to adjust the toner refilling conditions, otherwise do not do so.
4
2404-1 Relative humidity 30.0-44.9%RH
ALL 136<0-255>
M 4
2404-2 Relative humidity 45.0-59.9%RH
ALL 137<0-255>
M 4
2404-3 Relative humidity 60.0-74.9%RH
ALL 146<0-255>
M 4
2404-4 Relative humidity 75.0-100%RH
ALL 155<0-255>
M 4
2405-0 Develop-ment
K fourth refill level setting value
Relative humidity 0-29.9%RH
ALL 139<0-255>
M This code changes the density of the developer at the start of toner refilling by setting the auto-toner sensor out-put value. Toner may not be refilled at the right time if this code is changed. Change this code only when told to adjust the toner refilling conditions, otherwise do not do so.
4
2405-1 Relative humidity 30.0-44.9%RH
ALL 141<0-255>
M 4
2405-2 Relative humidity 45.0-59.9%RH
ALL 142<0-255>
M 4
2405-3 Relative humidity 60.0-74.9%RH
ALL 151<0-255>
M 4
2405-4 Relative humidity 75.0-100%RH
ALL 160<0-255>
M 4
Setting mode (08)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
10/06
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 184
2406-0 Develop-ment
K forcing refill level setting value
Relative humidity 0-29.9%RH
ALL 144<0-255>
M This code changes the density of the developer at the start of toner refilling by setting the auto-toner sensor out-put value. Toner may not be refilled at the right time if this code is changed. Change this code only when told to adjust the toner refilling conditions, otherwise do not do so.
4
2406-1 Relative humidity 30.0-44.9%RH
ALL 145<0-255>
M 4
2406-2 Relative humidity 45.0-59.9%RH
ALL 147<0-255>
M 4
2406-3 Relative humidity 60.0-74.9%RH
ALL 155<0-255>
M 4
2406-4 Relative humidity 75.0-100%RH
ALL 164<0-255>
M 4
2461-0 Develop-ment
BK life correction ALL 0<-128-127>
M This code sets the tar-get control value of the developer density according to how much time has elapsed. Changing this code may cause negative effects such as aggra-vation of toner-scatter-ing, errors in image quality control, back-ground fogging, and carrier offset. Change this code only when told to adjust the density of the developer, other-wise do not do so.
4
2461-1 ALL -1<-128-127>
M 4
2461-2 ALL -2<-128-127>
M 4
2461-3 ALL -2<-128-127>
M 4
2461-4 ALL -3<-128-127>
M 4
2461-5 ALL -3<-128-127>
M 4
2461-6 ALL -3<-128-127>
M 4
2461-7 ALL -3<-128-127>
M 4
2461-8 ALL -3<-128-127>
M 4
2461-9 ALL -3<-128-127>
M 4
Setting mode (08)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
10/06
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 185
2
2461-10 Develop-ment
BK life correction ALL -4<-128-127>
M This code sets the tar-get control value of the developer density according to how much time has elapsed. Changing this code may cause negative effects such as aggra-vation of toner-scatter-ing, errors in image quality control, back-ground fogging, and carrier offset. Change this code only when told to adjust the density of the developer, other-wise do not do so.
4
2461-11 ALL -4<-128-127>
M 4
2461-12 ALL -4<-128-127>
M 4
2461-13 ALL -4<-128-127>
M 4
2461-14 ALL -4<-128-127>
M 4
2461-15 ALL -4<-128-127>
M 4
2461-16 ALL -4<-128-127>
M 4
2461-17 ALL -4<-128-127>
M 4
2461-18 ALL -4<-128-127>
M 4
2461-19 ALL -4<-128-127>
M 4
2461-20 ALL -4<-128-127>
M 4
3635 General Proof copy function setting ALL 1<0~1>
SYS Sets the proof copy function.0: Disabled 1: Enabled
1
3722 Network Device authentication PDC/BDC time-out period (Unit: Seconds)
ALL 60<1-180>
NIC Applied to the device authentication
12
3723 Network User authentication PDC/BDC time-out period (Unit: Seconds)
ALL 30<1-180>
NIC Applied to the user authentication
12
3724 Network Windows domain authenti-cation of device/user authentication
ALL 1<1-3>
NIC 1: Auto2: Kerberos3: NTLMv2
12
3725 Network IPP max connection ALL 16<1-16>
NIC 12
3726 Network IPP active connection ALL 10<1-16>
NIC 12
3727 Network LPD max connection ALL 10<1-16>
NIC 12
3728 Network LPD active connection ALL 10<1-16>
NIC 12
Setting mode (08)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
10/06
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 186
3729 Network ATalk PS max Connection ALL 10<1-16>
NIC 12
3730 Network ATalk PS active Connec-tion
ALL 10<1-16>
NIC 12
3731 Network Raw TCP max connection ALL 10<1-16>
NIC 12
3732 Network Raw TCP active connec-tion
ALL 10<1-16>
NIC 12
3736 Network DNS Client Time Out ALL 60<1-180>
NIC Use when a timeout occurred at DNS client connection
12
3737 Network DDNS Client Time Out ALL 60<1-180>
NIC Use when a timeout occurred at DDNS cli-ent connection
12
3738 Network HTTP Client Time Out ALL 60<1-180>
NIC Use when a timeout occurred at HTTP cli-ent connection
12
3739 Network FTP Client Time Out (SCAN)
ALL 30<1-180>
NIC Use when a timeout occurred at FTP client connection
12
3740 Network SNTP Client Time Out ALL 30<1-180>
NIC Use when a timeout occurred at SNTP client connection
12
3741 Network SMTP Client Time Out ALL 30<1-180>
NIC Use when a timeout occurred at SMTP client connection
12
3742 Network POP3 Client Time Out ALL 30<1-180>
NIC Use when a timeout occurred at POP3 client connection
12
3743 Network LDAP Client Time Out ALL 30<1-180>
NIC Use when a timeout occurred at LDAP cli-ent connection
12
3744 Network POP3 Authentication method
ALL 1<1-3>
NIC POP3 authentication method setting 1: Disable (Default)2: NTLM3: Kerberos
12
3745 General Secure DDNS Primary Login Name
ALL -<1-128>
NIC Login name for login with the Primary DDNS
12
3746 General Secure DDNS Primary Login Password
ALL -<1-128>
NIC Login password for login with the Primary DDNS
12
3747 General Secure DDNS Secondary Login Name
ALL -<1-128>
NIC Login name for login with the Secondary DDNS
12
3748 General Secure DDNS Secondary Login Password
ALL -<1-128>
NIC Login password for login with the Second-ary DDNS
12
3749 General DPWS Friendly Name ALL - NIC MFP name indicated in DPWS search result<Default value> TOSHIBA e-STUDIOxxx [NIC serial number]
12
Setting mode (08)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
07/04
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 187
2
3750 General DPWS Printer Name ALL - NIC Printer name used for installing the printer with DPWS<Default value> TOSHIBA e-STUDIOxxx Printer-[NIC serial number]
12
3751 General DPWS Scanner Name ALL - NIC Scanner name used for installing the printer with DPWS<Default value> TOSHIBA e-STUDIOxxx Scanner-[NIC serial number]
12
3752 General DPWS Printer Information ALL - NIC Information regarding DPWS printer<Default value> NULL
12
3753 General DPWS Scanner Informa-tion
ALL - NIC Information regarding DPWS scanner<Default value> NULL
12
3754 Network Switching DPWS Printer setting
ALL 1<1-3>
NIC DPWS printer /DPWS secure printer function is switched.1: Enabled2: Disabled3: Security enabled
12
3755 Network Switching DPWS Scanner setting
ALL 1<1-2>
NIC DPWS scanner function is switched.1: Enabled2: Disabled
12
3757 Network DPWS Discovery Port Number
ALL 3702<1-
65535>
NIC Port number used for DPWS Discovery
12
3758 Network DPWS Metadata Exchange Port Number
ALL 50081<1-
65535>
NIC Port number used for DPWS Metadata Exchange
12
3759 Network DPWS Print Port Number ALL 50082<1-
65535>
NIC Port number used for DPWS Print
12
3760 Network DPWS Scan Port Number ALL 50083<1-
65535>
NIC Port number used for DPWS Scan
12
3765 Network DPWS Print Max numbers of connection
ALL 10<1-20>
NIC Maximum numbers received from more than one connection request in the DPWS print
12
3766 Network DPWS Print Max numbers of reception
ALL 10<1-20>
NIC Maximum numbers of data received from more than one clients in the DPWS print
12
3767 Network Switching IPv6 setting ALL 2<1-2>
NIC IPv6 function is switched.1: Enabled2: Disabled
12
Setting mode (08)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
09/02
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 188
3768 Network Switching IP(IPv6) Address Acquisition
ALL 2<1-2>
NIC IP(IPv6) Address Acquisition setting is switched.1: Manual2: Auto configuration
12
3769 Network Link Local Address ALL -<0-16>
NIC Link Local Address is displayed. Unique IP address (128 bits) is set using Mac address.
12
3770 Network IPv6 Address ALL 0<0-16>
NIC DHCPv6 Address in Manual/Auto configura-tion is displayed.
12
3771 Network Prefix display setting ALL 0<0-128>
NIC The range of Prefix dis-play is set.
12
3772 Network Default Gateway setting ALL 0<0-16>
NIC Default Gateway of DHCPv6 Address in Manual/Auto configura-tion is set.
12
3773 Network Displaying previous DHCPv6 Address
ALL 0<0-16>
NIC The previous DHCPv6 Address is displayed.
12
3774 Network DHCPv6 Option setting ALL 2<1-2>
NIC DHCPv6 Option is switched when the Manual is set.1: Enabled2: Disabled
12
3775 Network Stateless Address Auto Configuration
ALL 1<1-2>
NIC Stateless Address Auto Configuration is switched.1: Enabled2: Disabled
12
3776 Network Stateless Address setting continuation
ALL 2<1-2>
NIC When Prefix sent from router is changed, Stateless Address is continued to be set.1: Enabled2: Disabled
12
3777 Network Stateless Address setting ALL 2<1-2>
NIC IP Address is acquired by both Stateless and State full Address.1: Enabled2: Disabled
12
3778 Network Acquiring DHCPv6 Option ALL 2<1-2>
NIC When Stateless Address is selected, an option is acquired from DHCPv6 server.1: Enabled2: Disabled
12
3779 Network State full Address setting ALL 2<1-2>
NIC IP Address is acquired from DHCPv6 server.1: Enabled2: Disabled
12
3780 Network State full Option setting ALL 2<1-2>
NIC An option is acquired from DHCPv6 server.1: Enabled2: Disabled
12
3781 Network Primary DNS Server Address Registration
ALL 0<0-16>
NIC Registration of Primary DNS Server Address
12
Setting mode (08)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
07/11
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 189
2
3782 Network Secondary DNS Server Address Registration
ALL 0<0-16>
NIC Registration of Second-ary DNS Server Address
12
3783 Network Selecting SAMBA Protocol ALL 2<2-3>
NIC Either IPv6 or IPv4 is selected to use SAMBA.2: IPv63: IPv4
12
3784 Network DSN Server resolve type ALL 4<1-4>
NIC Either "ip6.arpa" or "ip6.int" is selected for the name resolution in DNS.1: "ip6.arpa" only2: "ip6.int" only3: In case of error with
"ip6.int", "ip6.arpa" is requested.
4: In case of error with "ip6.arpa", "ip6.int" is requested.
12
3785 Network DPWS IPv4 or IPv4 with IPv6
ALL 2<1-2>
NIC Either IPv4 only or IPv6 together with it is selected to operate Print, Scan and Secu-rity related with DPWS.1: Multi (IPv4 and
IPv6)2: IPv4
12
3793 Network Switching LLTD setting ALL 2<1-2>
NIC LLTD function is switched.1: Enabled2: Disabled
12
3794 Network Switching LLMNR setting ALL 2<1-2>
NIC LLMNR function is switched.1: Enabled2: Disabled
12
3796 Network DPWS EventRate ALL 5<1~600>
NIC Sets the value of DPWS event rate from 1 to 600.
12
3804 Scanner List Analysis Logic of Scan to File (FTP)
ALL 0<0-1>
SYS Acquisition of Contents in Host side is switched by Scan to File (FTP).0: NLST1: LIST
1
3805 Scanner Department Management setting by Remote Scan
ALL 3<0-3>
SYS Department Manage-ment is set when Remote Scan is per-formed.0: w/o GUI OFF,
w/ GUI OFF1: w/o GUI ON,
w/ GUI OFF2: w/o GUI OFF,
w/ GUI ON3: w/o GUI ON,
w/ GUI ON
1
Setting mode (08)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
09/02
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 190
3810 Network Direct SMTP communica-tion setting
ALL 0<0-1>
SYS When an Internet Fax is sent, Direct SMTP com-munication is set.0: Disabled1: Enabled
When "0: Disabled" is set, an Internet Fax is sent using an SMTP server.
When "1: Enabled" is set, direct SMTP com-munication is enabled and an Internet Fax is sent to MFPs on the intranet without using an SMTP server. Since no SMTP server is used, the SSL encryp-tion and SMTP-AUTH function cannot be used for internet Fax trans-mission.If "1: Enabled" is set in 08-3810, set "1: Enabled" in 08-3812 as well.
1
3811 Network Image encrypting at the Direct SMTP communica-tion
ALL 0<0-1>
SYS When Direct SMTP communication is per-formed, an attached image is encrypted.0: Disabled1: Enabled
1
3812 Scanner Dummy full mode at the Internet Fax transmission
ALL 0<0-1>
SYS When an Internet Fax is sent, the resolution ratio and the paper size of an attached image are set to the full mode.0: Disabled1: EnabledIf "1: Enabled" is set in 08-3810, set "1: Enabled" in 08-3812 as well.
1
3815 Scanner XPS file thumbnail addition ALL 1<0-1>
SYS Thumbnail is added to the XPS file produced by the Scan function.0: Not added1: Only the top page
added
1
3816 Scanner XPS file paper size setting ALL 1<0-1>
SYS The paper size of the XPS file produced by the Scan function is set.0: Scanned image size 1: Standard size
1
Setting mode (08)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
07/11
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 191
2
3817 Scanner PDF file version setting ALL 4<0, 1, 4>
SYS The version of PDF file produced by the Scan function is set.0: PDF V1.31: PDF V1.44: PDF V1.7
1
3818 Scanner DPWS Scan operation mode
ALL 1<0-1>
SYS The operation mode in the DPWS Scan func-tion is switched.0: Batch type1: Serial type
1
3819 General Network Fax/Internet Fax processing mode (STD)
ALL 2<0-2>
SYS The processing mode of the network Fax/Internet Fax is switched.0: High speed/Low
image quality1: Standard2: Low speed/High
image quality
1
3820 General Network Fax/Internet Fax processing mode (FINE)
ALL 0<0-2>
SYS The processing mode of the network Fax/Internet Fax is switched.0: High speed/Low
image quality1: Standard2: Low speed/High
image quality
1
3821 General Network Fax/Internet Fax processing mode (S-FINE)
ALL 0<0-2>
SYS The processing mode of the network Fax/Internet Fax is switched.0: High speed/Low
image quality1: Standard2: Low speed/High
image quality
1
3822 General Network Fax/Internet Fax processing mode (U-FINE)
ALL 0<0-2>
SYS The processing mode of the network Fax/Internet Fax is switched.0: High speed/Low
image quality1: Standard2: Low speed/High
image quality
1
3823 General Processing mode thresh-old for network Fax/Inter-net Fax (STD) [Standard]
ALL 254<0-255>
SYS Image quality adjust-ment when "Standard" is set for the Network Fax/Internet Fax pro-cessing mode (STD)
1
3824 General Processing mode thresh-old for network Fax/Inter-net Fax (FINE) [Standard]
ALL 254<0-255>
SYS Image quality adjust-ment when "Standard" is set for the Network Fax/Internet Fax pro-cessing mode (FINE)
1
Setting mode (08)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
07/11
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 192
3825 General Processing mode thresh-old for network Fax/Inter-net Fax (S-FINE) [Standard]
ALL 180<0-255>
SYS Image quality adjust-ment when "Standard" is set for the Network Fax/Internet Fax pro-cessing mode (S-FINE)
1
3826 General Processing mode thresh-old for network Fax/Inter-net Fax (U-FINE) [Standard]
ALL 180<0-255>
SYS Image quality adjust-ment when "Standard" is set for the Network Fax/Internet Fax pro-cessing mode (U-FINE)
1
3827 General Processing mode thresh-old for network Fax/Inter-net Fax (STD) [Low speed/High image quality]
ALL 200<0-255>
SYS Image quality adjust-ment when "Low speed/High image quality" is set for the Network Fax/Internet Fax process-ing mode (STD)
1
3828 General Processing mode thresh-old for network Fax/Inter-net Fax (FINE) [Low speed/High image quality]
ALL 204<0-255>
SYS Image quality adjust-ment when "Low speed/High image quality" is set for the Network Fax/Internet Fax process-ing mode (FINE)
1
3829 General Processing mode thresh-old for network Fax/Inter-net Fax (S-FINE) [Low speed/High image quality]
ALL 206<0-255>
SYS Image quality adjust-ment when "Low speed/High image quality" is set for the Network Fax/Internet Fax process-ing mode (S-FINE)
1
3830 General Processing mode thresh-old for network Fax/Inter-net Fax (U-FINE) [Low speed/High image quality]
ALL 161<0-255>
SYS Image quality adjust-ment when "Low speed/High image quality" is set for the Network Fax/Internet Fax process-ing mode (U-FINE)
1
3831 Network Mode switching for Role Based Access Control function
ALL 0<0-1>
SYS 0: Require eBMUser-Role attribute
1: User available LDAP attribute
1
3833 General Home directory function ALL 0<0-1>
SYS Function to store a file in the user's home directory0: Disabled1: Enabled
1
3834 General Backup file encryption ALL 0<0-1>
SYS When the backup file is created from TopAc-cess, it is encrypted.0: Enabled (Encryp-
tion)1: Disabled (No
encryption)
1
3837 General Display switching for the machine name/computer name shown in the notifi-cation
ALL 0<0-1>
SYS The display method of the machine name/computer name shown in the event-related notification is switched.0: IP address1: NetBIOS name/
FQDN
1
Setting mode (08)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
09/02
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 193
2
3840 General Electronic License Key Registration
ALL - - Licenses for Electronic License Key are regis-tered.
3
3841 General Electronic License Key Deletion
ALL - - Registered licenses for Electronic License Key are deleted.
3
3842 General Electronic License Key Display
ALL - - All licenses stored in the ELK jig are dis-played.
3
3845 Network SNMP Trap Enterprise OID mode setting
ALL 0<0-1>
SYS Trap Enterprise OID is enabled for existing models.0: Normal (Not
enabling for exist-ing models)
1: Enabled for existing models
1
3847 FAX FAX mistransmission pre-vention
FAX 0<0-1>
SYS FAX mistransmission prevention function is switched.0: OFF (Disabled)1: ON (Enabled)
1
3848 FAX Restriction on Address Book destination setting
FAX 0<0-1>
SYS Availability of destina-tion selection from the Address Book is switched as one of FAX mistransmission pre-vention functions when setting FAX destina-tions. 0: OFF (Disabled)1: ON (Enabled)
1
3849 FAX Restriction on destination direct entry
FAX 0<0-1>
SYS Availability of direct entry is switched as one of FAX mistransmis-sion prevention func-tions when setting FAX destinations. 0: OFF (Disabled)1: ON (Enabled)
1
3850 General Remote Scan User authentication
ALL 3<0-3>
SYS User authentication on Remote Scan driver is switched according to the availability of GUI. 0: OFF (No GUI) / OFF
(GUI installed) 1: ON (No GUI) / OFF
(GUI installed) 2: OFF (No GUI) / ON
(GUI installed) 3: ON (No GUI) / ON
(GUI installed)
1
3851 User interface
Template display ALL 0<0-1>
SYS The order of displaying templates on the LCD screen is switched.0: Order of IDs1: Alphabetical order
1
Setting mode (08)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 194
3852 General Automatic summer time change
ALL 0<0-1>
SYS Automatic summer time change on the day pre-viously set is switched.0: Disabled 1: Enabled
1
3853 General Summer time mode Offset value
ALL 0<0-7>
SYS Summer time is started as follows when 08-3852 is enabled. 0: +2:00 1: +1:302: +1:00 3: +0:304: -0:30 5: -1:006: -1:30 7: -2:00
1
3854 General Summer time mode Starting month
ALL 1<1-12>
SYS The month in which summer time is started is set.1: January2: February3: March4: April5: May6: June7: July8: August9: September10: October11: November12: December
1
3855 General Summer time modeStarting week
ALL 1<1-5>
SYS The week in which summer time is started is set.1: 1st2: 2nd3: 3rd4: 4th5: Last
1
3856 General Summer time mode Starting day
ALL 0<0-6>
SYS The day on which sum-mer time is started is set.0: Sunday1: Monday2: Tuesday3: Wednesday4: Thursday5: Friday6: Saturday
1
3857 General Summer time modeStarting time
ALL 0<00-23>
SYS The time at which sum-mer time is started is set. 00-23
1
3858 General Summer time modeStarting minute
ALL 0<00-59>
SYS The minute at which summer time is started is set. 00-59
1
Setting mode (08)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 195
2
3859 General Summer time modeEnding month
ALL 1<1-12>
SYS The month in which summer time is ended is set.1: January2: February3: March4: April5: May6: June7: July8: August9: September10: October11: November12: December
1
3860 General Summer time modeEnding week
ALL 1<1-5>
SYS The week in which summer time is ended is set.1: 1st2: 2nd3: 3rd4: 4th5: Last
1
3861 General Summer time modeEnding day
ALL 0<0-6>
SYS The day on which sum-mer time is ended is set.0: Sunday1: Monday2: Tuesday3: Wednesday4: Thursday5: Friday6: Saturday
1
3862 General Summer time modeEnding time
ALL 0<00-23>
SYS The time at which sum-mer time is ended is set.00-23
1
3863 General Summer time modeEnding minute
ALL 0<00-59>
SYS The minute at which summer time is ended is set.00-59
1
3864 Network Disclosing Telnet Server function
ALL 0<0-1>
SYS Disclosure of Telnet Server function is switched. 0: Not disclosed 1: Disclosed
1
3865 Network Availability of Telnet Server ALL 2<1-2>
NIC Availability of Telnet Server is switched. 1: Enabled2: Disabled
12
3866 Network Telnet ServerTCP port number
ALL 23<1-
65535>
NIC A port number for Tel-net Server is set.
12
3867 Network Telnet ServerServer administrator's user name
ALL Admin<Maxi-
mum 15 letters>
NIC A user name for the Tel-net Server administra-tor is confirmed.
12
Setting mode (08)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
09/02
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 196
3868 Network Telnet ServerServer administrator's password
ALL System<Maxi-
mum 15 letters>
NIC A password for the Tel-net Server administra-tor is set.
12
4016-1 Paper feeding
ACC function when a drawer is specified
Printing ALL 0<0~1>
SYS Sets whether the ACC function is enabled only for automatic drawer selection or enabled when a particular drawer is specified as well.0: Enabled only for
automatic drawer selection
1: Enabled when a drawer is specified
4
4621 Paper feeding
Bypass paper size detec-tion setting
PPC/PRT
0<0~1>
M Detects whether the size of paper fed by bypass feeding is the same as the paper size set on the control panel. If the sizes are not the same, the warning mes-sage is displayed (Paper jam does not occur). When the bypass paper size detection is broken, the equipment can be used without the size detec-tion by disabling this setting. After repair, enable this setting.0: Enabled1: Disabled
1
4622 Paper feeding
Bypass paper size detec-tion counter
PPC/PRT
0<0~6553
5>
M This is a counter for bypass paper size detection setting. If the printing is executed with the paper size that dif-fers from the paper size set on the control panel, the counter is counted up.
1
Setting mode (08)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
10/06
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 197
2
6810-0 Counter Number of output pages in black mode / Large size
1-UP / Duplex printing
PPC(black)
0<8 digits>
SYS Counts the number of output pages printed only in the black mode.
4
6810-1 2-UP / Duplex printing
PPC(black)
0<8 digits>
SYS Counts the number of output pages printed in the black mode using [2IN1] or [MAGAZINE SORT].
4
6810-2 2-UP / Simplex printing
PPC(black)
0<8 digits>
SYS Counts the number of sheets printed in the black mode using [2IN1] or [MAGAZINE SORT].
4
6810-3 4-UP / Duplex printing
PPC(black)
0<8 digits>
SYS Counts the number of output pages printed in the black mode using [4IN1].
4
6810-4 4-UP / Simplex printing
PPC(black)
0<8 digits>
SYS Counts the number of sheets printed in the black mode using [4IN1].
4
6810-7 1-UP / Simplex printing
PPC(black)
0<8 digits>
SYS Counts the number of sheets printed only in the black mode.
4
6811-0 Counter Number of output pages in full color mode / Large
1-UP / Duplex printing
PPC(color)
0<8 digits>
SYS Counts the number of output pages printed only in the full color mode.
4
6811-1 2-UP / Duplex printing
PPC(color)
0<8 digits>
SYS Counts the number of output pages printed in the full color mode using [2IN1] or [MAGA-ZINE SORT].
4
6811-2 2-UP / Simplex printing
PPC(color)
0<8 digits>
SYS Counts the number of sheets printed in the full color mode using [2IN1] or [MAGAZINE SORT].
4
6811-3 4-UP / Duplex printing
PPC(color)
0<8 digits>
SYS Counts the number of output pages printed in the full color mode using [4IN1].
4
6811-4 4-UP / Simplex printing
PPC(color)
0<8 digits>
SYS Counts the number of sheets printed in the full color mode using [4IN1].
4
6811-7 1-UP / Simplex printing
PPC(color)
0<8 digits>
SYS Counts the number of sheets printed only in the full color mode.
4
Setting mode (08)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 198
6812-0 Counter Number of output pages in twin color mode / Large
1-UP / Duplex printing
PPC(color)
0<8 digits>
SYS Counts the number of output pages printed only in the twin color mode.
4
6812-1 2-UP / Duplex printing
PPC(color)
0<8 digits>
SYS Counts the number of output pages printed in the twin color mode using [2IN1] or [MAGA-ZINE SORT].
4
6812-2 2-UP / Simplex printing
PPC(color)
0<8 digits>
SYS Counts the number of sheets printed in the twin color mode using [2IN1] or [MAGAZINE SORT].
4
6812-3 4-UP / Duplex printing
PPC(color)
0<8 digits>
SYS Counts the number of output pages printed in the twin color mode using [4IN1].
4
6812-4 4-UP / Simplex printing
PPC(color)
0<8 digits>
SYS Counts the number of sheets printed in the twin color mode using [4IN1].
4
6812-7 1-UP / Simplex printing
PPC(color)
0<8 digits>
SYS Counts the number of sheets printed only in the twin color mode.
4
6813-0 Counter Number of output pages of the printer or BOX / Large
1-UP / Duplex printing
PRT(black)
0<8 digits>
SYS Counts the number of output pages printed in the black mode.
4
6813-1 2-UP / Duplex printing
PRT(black)
0<8 digits>
SYS Counts the number of output pages printed in the black mode using [2IN1] or [MAGAZINE SORT].
4
6813-2 2-UP / Simplex printing
PRT(black)
0<8 digits>
SYS Counts the number of sheets printed in the black mode using [2IN1] or [MAGAZINE SORT].
4
6813-3 4-UP / Duplex printing
PRT(black)
0<8 digits>
SYS Counts the number of output pages printed in the black mode using [4IN1].
4
6813-4 4-UP / Simplex printing
PRT(black)
0<8 digits>
SYS Counts the number of sheets printed in the black mode using [4IN1].
4
6813-5 N-UP / Duplex printing
PRT(black)
0<8 digits>
SYS Counts the number of output pages printed in the black mode using [N IN1].
4
6813-6 N-UP / Simplex printing
PRT(black)
0<8 digits>
SYS Counts the number of sheets printed in the black mode using [N IN1].
4
6813-7 1-UP / Simplex printing
PRT(black)
0<8 digits>
SYS Counts the number of sheets printed only in the black mode.
4
Setting mode (08)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
09/02
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 199
2
6814-0 Counter Number of output pages of the printer or BOX / Large(Full color)
1-UP / Duplex printing
PRT(color)
0<8 digits>
SYS Counts the number of output pages printed only in the full color mode.
4
6814-1 2-UP / Duplex printing
PRT(color)
0<8 digits>
SYS Counts the number of output pages printed in the full color mode using [2IN1] or [MAGA-ZINE SORT].
4
6814-2 2-UP / Simplex printing
PRT(color)
0<8 digits>
SYS Counts the number of sheets printed in the full color mode using [2IN1] or [MAGAZINE SORT].
4
6814-3 4-UP / Duplex printing
PRT(color)
0<8 digits>
SYS Counts the number of output pages printed in the full color mode using [4IN1].
4
6814-4 4-UP / Simplex printing
PRT(color)
0<8 digits>
SYS Counts the number of sheets printed in the full color mode using [4IN1].
4
6814-5 N-UP / Duplex printing
PRT(color)
0<8 digits>
SYS Counts the number of output pages printed in the full color mode using [N IN1].
4
6814-6 N-UP / Simplex printing
PRT(color)
0<8 digits>
SYS Counts the number of sheets printed in the full color mode using [N IN1].
4
6814-7 1-UP / Simplex printing
PRT(color)
0<8 digits>
SYS Counts the number of sheets printed only in the full color mode.
4
6815-0 Counter Number of output pages of the FAX printing / Large
1-UP / Simplex printing
FAX 0<8 digits>
SYS Counts the number of output pages in the default settings.
4
6815-7 1-UP / Duplex printing
FAX 0<8 digits>
SYS 4
8517 General Remote Scan User authen-tication automatic login
ALL 1<0~1>
SYS 0: OFF (A user always enters manually (current method))
1: ON (Previous authentication infor-mation will be used)
1
8535 Network Storing network logs in the HDD
ALL 2<1~2>
SYS Stores the network logs of SRAM in the HDD when network-related trouble occurred.1: Enabled2: Disabled
1
8536 Network Data size when storing net-work logs in the HDD
ALL 30<1~30>
SYS Specifies the size of network logs to be stored in the HDD.1-30:1-30 MB
1
Setting mode (08)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
05/07
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 200
8548 Paper feeding
Operation of cassette size change when printing is interrupted by size mis-match
PRT 0<0~1>
SYS 0: Operation of cassette size change is disabled.1: Operation of cassette size change is enabled.
1
8549 Counter Hardware key control when external counter is installed
ALL 0<0~1>
SYS 0: No control1: Mode switch key is disabled.
1
8823 Network Port number 139 for user authentication
ALL 1<1~2>
NIC If the connection to port number 139 is blocked, attempt to connect to port number 139 is skipped by setting this code to “2: disabled.” This code is enabled when “Windows Domain Authentica-tion” is selected in [User Management Setting] - [Authentication] - [User Management Setting].1: Enabled2: Disabled
12
9047 General Process control flag setting of easy setup (manual unpacking adjustment)
ALL 0<0-2>
SYS 0: No change of man-ual unpacking adjustment
1: OFF status of man-ual unpacking adjustment flag
2: Returns to the initial unpacking mode
1
9051 User interface
Panel calibration setting value display
ALL 0<0~1>
SYS Switches whether the screen for displaying panel calibration set-ting values is displayed or not.0: Disabled (screen
not displayed)1: Enabled (screen
displayed)
1
9117 Network Raw printing job(Blank page will not be printed)
PRT 0<0-1>
SYS 0: OFF1: ON
1
9359 User interface
Printing resume after jam releasing
ALL 0<0-1>
SYS 0: Auto resume1: Resume by users
1
9394 Network Single-page option for stor-ing File and sending Email
ALL 0<0-1>
SYS 0: Sets 1 page as 1 file1: Makes a file based
on the original
1
9629 Network Attribute name for LDAP Role Based Access
ALL eBMUserR
<->
SYS 11
9739 Mainte-nance
Remote serviceToner-end notification
ALL 0<0-2>
SYS 0: RDMS toner empty notified immediately
1: RDMS toner empty notified once a day
2: RDMS toner empty not notified
1
Setting mode (08)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
10/06
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 201
2
9798 Network Temporary communication password setting
ALL - SYS Sets a temporary com-munication password. The password can be entered in alphanu-meric characters (A to Z, a to z, 0 to 9) up to 10 digits. The entered password is displayed with “*” on the touch panel and the self-diag-nostic lists. (Maximum 10 digits, minimum 5 digits)
11
9819 General STAGE SSL ALL 1<0-1>
SYS When remote scanning is performed, the SSL communication is car-ried out.0: Disabled1: Enabled (SSL com-
munication)
1
9822 General STAGE SSL port number ALL 20443<0-
65535>
SYS When remote scanning is performed using SSL communication, the SSL port number is set.
1
9828 General Remote scanning mode ALL 0<0-1>
SYS 0: Batch1: Sequential
1
9829 General Department management limitation setting
ALL 0<0-3>
SYS Decide the default limi-tation setting when the new department code is created. 0: No limit1: Limited only in the
black mode2: Limited in the color
mode3: Limited in the black/
color mode
1
9847 Finisher Hole punching setting ALL 0<0-1>
SYS 0: Invalid1: Valid
1
9880 General Total counter transmission date setting (2)
ALL 0<0-31>
SYS 0 to 31 1
9881 General Day of total counter data transmission
ALL 0<0-127>
- 1 byte 00000000(0)-01111111(127)From the 2nd bit - Sunday, Monday, Tuesday, Wednesday,Thursday, Friday, Saturday
1
9882 General Display mode of the used capacity on the e-Filing administrator page
ALL 1<0-1>
SYS 0: All files search mode
1: Performance priority mode
1
9885 General New/Old FROM identifica-tion
ALL -<-1-1>
- 0: Old FROM1: New FROM-1: Error
2
Setting mode (08)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 202
9886 Scanner Decimal point indication for Enhanced Scan Template
SCN EUR: 0UC: 1JPN: 1<0-1>
SYS 0: Comma1: Period
1
9888 Scanner Permission setting for changing the scan parame-ter when recalling an extension
SCN 0<0-1>
SYS 0: Prohibited1: Accepted
1
9889 General Acceptance of data cloning using USB storage device
ALL 0<0-1>
SYS Acceptance of the usage of the USB data cloning tool0: Accepted1: Not accepted
2
9891 User interface
Warning message on the touch panel when PM (Periodic Maintenance) time has come
ALL 1<0-1>
SYS 0: No warning notifica-tion
1: Warning notification
1
9933 Network Domain participation con-firmation of printing when LDAP authentication is used
ALL 1<0-1>
SYS When LDAP is selected as authentication method for user authen-tication, checking of domain participation of client computer for print job authentication is set. This function is enabled only when department manage-ment is enabled.0: Disabled1: Enabled
1
9946 General E-mail transmission retry number
ALL 3<0-14>
SYS The number of times of E-mail communication retry for Scan to E-mail and Internet Fax is set.
1
9947 General E-mail transmission retry interval
ALL 1<0-15>
SYS When E-mail transmis-sion retry for Scan to E-mail and Internet Fax is performed, the interval is set.0 min - 15 min
1
9980 Network Receiver's address fixing function at authentication
ALL 0<0~1>
SYS Fixes the receiver's address (“To: Destina-tion” field) when the user authentication and E-mail authentication are enabled.0: Disabled1: Enabled
1
Setting mode (08)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
10/06
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 203
2
Note: Note: In this equipment, a toner image is formed on the transfer belt prior to a paper feeding.When the feeding retry occurs and the transport timing is delayed, the toner image on the trans-fer belt is cleaned off without the 2nd transfer since the paper can not be reached for the 2nd transfer process.After that, the toner image formation is retried while the paper is waited.In this case, the toner for this image formation is consumed wastefully since the toner image on the transfer belt is already cleaned off, even though the printing is normally completed.Therefore, note that the excessive toner will be consumed consequently when the upper limit value of feeding retry counter is set larger or set as "0" (no limit).The toner is also consumed wastefully when the paper misfeeding occurs. Replace the roller at earlier timing if the paper misfeedings have occurred frequently.
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 204
<<Pixel counter related code>>(Chap. 2.2.6)
Note: Note: In the pixel counter function, the twin color copy mode is regarded as the full color mode.
Setting mode (08)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
1500 Pixelcounter
Standard paper size setting ALL EUR: 0UC: 1JPN: 0<0-1>
SYS Selects the standard paper size to convert it into the pixel count (%).0: A41: LT
1
1501 Pixelcounter
Pixel counter all clearing ALL - SYS Clears all information related to the pixel counter.
3
1502 Pixelcounter
Service technician refer-ence counter clearing
ALL - SYS Clears all information related to the service technician reference pixel counter.
3
1503 Pixelcounter
Toner cartridge reference counter clearing
ALL - SYS Clears all information related to the toner car-tridge reference pixel counter.
3
1504 Pixelcounter
Pixel counter display set-ting
ALL 1<0-1>
SYS Selects whether or not to display the pixel counter on the LCD screen.0: Displayed1: Not displayed
1
1505 Pixelcounter
Displayed reference set-ting
ALL 0<0-1>
SYS Selects the reference when displaying the pixel counter on the LCD screen.0: Service technician
reference1: Toner cartridge ref-
erence
1
1506 Pixelcounter
Toner empty determination counter setting
ALL 0<0-1>
SYS Selects the counter to determine toner empty.0: Output pages 1: Pixel counter
1
1507 Pixelcounter
Threshold setting for toner empty determination (Out-put pages)
ALL 500<0-999>
SYS Sets the number of out-put pages to determine toner empty. This set-ting is valid when “0” is set at 08-1506.
1
1508 Pixelcounter
Threshold setting for toner empty determination (Pixel counter)
ALL 21500<0-
60000>
SYS Sets the number of out-put pages to determine toner empty. This set-ting is valid when “1” is set at 08-1506.
1
1509 Pixelcounter
Pixel counter clear flag/Service technician refer-ence
ALL 0<0-1>
SYS Becomes “1” when 08-1502 is performed.
2
1510 Pixelcounter
Service technician refer-ence cleared date
ALL - SYS Displays the date on which 08-1502 was per-formed.
2
1511 Pixelcounter
Toner cartridge reference cleared date (Y)
ALL(color)
- SYS Displays the date on which 08-1503 was per-formed.
2
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 205
2
1512 Pixelcounter
Toner cartridge reference cleared date (M)
ALL(color)
- SYS Displays the date on which 08-1503 was per-formed.
2
1513 Pixelcounter
Toner cartridge reference cleared date (C)
ALL(color)
- SYS Displays the date on which 08-1503 was per-formed.
2
1514 Pixelcounter
Toner cartridge reference cleared date (K)
ALL - SYS Displays the date on which 08-1503 was per-formed.
2
1515 Pixelcounter
Toner cartridge reference count started date (Y)
ALL(color)
- SYS Displays the date on which 08-1503 was per-formed.
2
1516 Pixelcounter
Toner cartridge reference count started date (M)
ALL(color)
- SYS Displays the date on which 08-1503 was per-formed.
2
1517 Pixelcounter
Toner cartridge reference count started date (C)
ALL(color)
- SYS Displays the date on which 08-1503 was per-formed.
2
1518 Pixel counter
Toner cartridge reference count started date (K)
ALL - SYS Displays the date on which 08-1503 was per-formed.
2
1547 Pixel counter
Number of output pages/fullcolor(Service technicianrefer-ence)
PPC(color)
<8 digits> SYS Counts the number of output pages con-verted to the standard paper sizein the copy function, full color modeand service tech-nician reference.[Unit. page]
2
1548 Pixel counter
Number of output pages/black (Service technician reference)
PPC(black)
<8 digits> SYS Counts the number of output pages con-verted to the standard paper sizein the copy function, black mode and service technician reference.[Unit. page]
2
1549 Pixel counter
Number of output pages/fullcolor (Service techni-cian reference)
PRT(color)
<8 digits> SYS Counts the number of output pages con-verted to the standard paper size in the printer function, full color mode and service technician reference.[Unit. page]
2
1550 Pixel counter
Number of output pages/black (Service technician reference)
PRT(black)
<8 digits> SYS Counts the number of output pages con-verted to the standard paper size in the printer function, black mode and service technician reference.[Unit. page]
2
Setting mode (08)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 206
1551 Pixel counter
Number of output pages/black (Service technician reference)
FAX(black)
<8 digits> SYS Counts the number of output pages con-verted to the standard paper size in the FAX function, black mode and service technician reference.[Unit. page]
2
1552 Pixel counter
Number of output pages/full color (K) (Toner car-tridge reference)
PPC(color)
<8 digits> SYS Counts the number of output pages con-verted to the standard paper size in the copy function, full color mode, toner K and toner cartridge refer-ence.[Unit. page]
2
1553 Pixel counter
Number of output pages/black (Toner cartridge ref-erence)
PPC(black)
<8 digits> SYS Counts the number of output pages con-verted to the standard paper size in the copy function, black mode and toner cartridge ref-erence.[Unit. page]
2
1554 Pixel counter
Number of output pages/full color (K) (Toner car-tridge reference)
PRT(color)
<8 digits> SYS Counts the number of output pages con-verted to the standard paper size in the printer function, full color mode, toner K and toner cartridge refer-ence.[Unit. page]
2
1555 Pixel counter
Number of output pages/black (Toner cartridge ref-erence)
PRT(black)
<8 digits> SYS Counts the number of output pages con-verted to the standard paper size in the printer function, black mode and toner cartridge ref-erence.[Unit. page]
2
1556 Pixel counter
Number of output pages/black (Toner cartridge ref-erence)
FAX(black)
<8 digits> SYS Counts the number of output pages con-verted to the standard paper size in the FAX function, black mode and toner cartridge ref-erence.[Unit. page]
2
1557 Pixel counter
Number of output pages/full color (Y) (Toner car-tridge reference)
PPC(color)
<8 digits> SYS Counts the number of output pages con-verted to the standard paper size in the copy function, full color mode, toner Y and toner cartridge refer-ence.[Unit. page]
2
Setting mode (08)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 207
2
1558 Pixel counter
Number of output pages/full color (Y) (Toner car-tridge reference)
PRT(color)
<8 digits> SYS Counts the number of output pages con-verted to the standard paper size in the printer function, full color mode, toner Y and toner cartridge refer-ence.[Unit. page]
2
1559 Pixel counter
Number of output pages/full color (M) (Toner car-tridge reference)
PPC(color)
<8 digits> SYS Counts the number of output pages con-verted to the standard paper size in the copy function, full color mode, toner M and toner cartridge refer-ence.[Unit. page]
2
1560 Pixel counter
Number of output pages/full color (M) (Toner car-tridge reference)
PRT(color)
<8 digits> SYS Counts the number of output pages con-verted to the standard paper size in the printer function, full color mode, toner M and toner cartridge refer-ence.[Unit. page]
2
1561 Pixel counter
Number of output pages/full color (C) (Toner car-tridge reference)
PPC(color)
<8 digits> SYS Counts the number of output pages con-verted to the standard paper size in the copy function, full color mode, toner C and toner cartridge refer-ence.[Unit. page]
2
1562 Pixel counter
Number of output pages/full color (C) (Toner car-tridge reference)
ALL(color)
<8 digits> SYS Counts the number of output pages con-verted to the standard paper size in the printer function, full color mode, toner C and toner cartridge refer-ence.[Unit. page]
2
1563 Pixel counter
Toner cartridge Y replace-ment counter
ALL(color)
<3 digits> SYS Counts the number of time of the toner car-tridge Y replacement.
2
1564 Pixel counter
Toner cartridge M replace-ment counter
ALL(color)
<3 digits> SYS Counts the number of time of the toner car-tridge M replacement.
2
1565 Pixel counter
Toner cartridge C replace-ment counter
ALL(color)
<3 digits> SYS Counts the number of time of the toner car-tridge C replacement.
2
1566 Pixel counter
Toner cartridge K replace-ment counter
ALL <3 digits> SYS Counts the number of time of the toner car-tridge K replacement.
2
Setting mode (08)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 208
1577 Pixel counter
Average pixel count/full color (Y+M+C+K) (Service technician reference)
PPC(color)
0<0-
10000>
SYS Displays the average pixel count in the copy function, full color mode, all toner and ser-vice technician refer-ence.[Unit: 0.01%]
2
1578 Pixel counter
Average pixel count/full color (Y) (Service techni-cian reference)
PPC(color)
0<0-
10000>
SYS Displays the average pixel count in the copy function, full color mode, toner Y and ser-vice technician refer-ence.[Unit: 0.01%]
2
1579 Pixel counter
Average pixel count/full color (M) (Service techni-cian reference)
PPC(color)
0<0-
10000>
SYS Displays the average pixel count in the copy function, full color mode, toner M and ser-vice technician refer-ence.[Unit: 0.01%]
2
1580 Pixel counter
Average pixel count/full color (C) (Service techni-cian reference)
PPC(color)
0<0-
10000>
SYS Displays the average pixel count in the copy function, full color mode, toner C and ser-vice technician refer-ence.[Unit: 0.01%]
2
1581 Pixel counter
Average pixel count/full color (K) (Service techni-cian reference)
PPC(color)
0<0-
10000>
SYS Displays the average pixel count in the copy function, full color mode, toner K and ser-vice technician refer-ence.[Unit: 0.01%]
2
1582 Pixel counter
Average pixel count/full color (Y+M+C+K) (Service technician reference)
PRT(color)
0<0-
10000>
SYS Displays the average pixel count in the printer function, full color mode, all toner and ser-vice technician refer-ence.[Unit: 0.01%]
2
1583 Pixel counter
Average pixel count/full color (Y) (Service techni-cian reference)
PRT(color)
0<0-
10000>
SYS Displays the average pixel count in the printer function, full color mode, toner Y and ser-vice technician refer-ence.[Unit: 0.01%]
2
1584 Pixel counter
Average pixel count/full color (M) (Service techni-cian reference)
PRT(color)
0<0-
10000>
SYS Displays the average pixel count in the printer function, full color mode, toner M and ser-vice technician refer-ence.[Unit: 0.01%]
2
Setting mode (08)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 209
2
1585 Pixel counter
Average pixel count/full color (C) (Service techni-cian reference)
PRT(color)
0<0-
10000>
SYS Displays the average pixel count in the printer function, full color mode, toner C and ser-vice technician refer-ence.[Unit: 0.01%]
2
1586 Pixel counter
Average pixel count/full color (K) (Service techni-cian reference)
PRT(color)
0<0-
10000>
SYS Displays the average pixel count in the printer function, full color mode, toner K and ser-vice technician refer-ence.[Unit: 0.01%]
2
1587 Pixel counter
Average pixel count/full color (Y+M+C+K) (Service technician reference)
PPC/PRT
(color)
0<0-
10000>
SYS Displays the average pixel count in the copy/printer function, full color mode, all toner and service technician reference.[Unit: 0.01%]
2
1588 Pixel counter
Average pixel count/full color (Y) (Service techni-cian reference)
PPC/PRT
(color)
0<0-
10000>
SYS Displays the average pixel count in the copy/printer function, full color mode, toner Y and service technician refer-ence.[Unit: 0.01%]
2
1589 Pixel counter
Average pixel count/full color (M) (Service techni-cian reference)
PPC/PRT
(color)
0<0-
10000>
SYS Displays the average pixel count in the copy/printer function, full color mode, toner M and service technician reference.[Unit: 0.01%]
2
1590 Pixel counter
Average pixel count/full color (C) (Service techni-cian reference)
PPC/PRT
(color)
0<0-
10000>
SYS Displays the average pixel count in the copy/printer function, full color mode, toner C and service technician reference.[Unit: 0.01%]
2
1591 Pixel counter
Average pixel count/full color (K) (Service techni-cian reference)
PPC/PRT
(color)
0<0-
10000>
SYS Displays the average pixel count in the copy/printer function, full color mode, toner K and service technician refer-ence.[Unit: 0.01%]
2
1592 Pixel counter
Average pixel count/black (Service technician refer-ence)
PPC(black)
0<0-
10000>
SYS Displays the average pixel count in the copy function, black mode and service technician reference.[Unit: 0.01%]
2
Setting mode (08)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 210
1593 Pixel counter
Average pixel count/black (Service technician refer-ence)
PRT(black)
0<0-
10000>
SYS Displays the average pixel count in the printer function, black mode and service technician reference.[Unit: 0.01%]
2
1594 Pixel counter
Average pixel count/black (Service technician refer-ence)
FAX(black)
0<0-
10000>
SYS Displays the average pixel count in the FAX function, black mode and service technician reference.[Unit: 0.01%]
2
1595 Pixel counter
Average pixel count/black (Service technician refer-ence)
PPC/PRT/FAX
(black)
0<0-
10000>
SYS Displays the average pixel count in the copy/printer/FAX function, black mode and ser-vice technician refer-ence.[Unit: 0.01%]
2
1596 Pixel counter
Latest pixel count/full color (Y+M+C+K) (Service tech-nician reference)
PPC(color)
0<0-
10000>
SYS Displays the latest pixel count in the copy func-tion, full color mode, all toner and service tech-nician reference.[Unit: 0.01%]
2
1597 Pixel counter
Latest pixel count/full color (Y) (Service technician ref-erence)
PPC(color)
0<0-
10000>
SYS Displays the latest pixel count in the copy func-tion, full color mode, toner Y and service technician reference.[Unit: 0.01%]
2
1598 Pixel counter
Latest pixel count/full color (M) (Service technician ref-erence)
PPC(color)
0<0-
10000>
SYS Displays the latest pixel count in the copy func-tion, full color mode, toner M and service technician reference.[Unit: 0.01%]
2
1599 Pixel counter
Latest pixel count/full color (C) (Service technician ref-erence)
PPC(color)
0<0-
10000>
SYS Displays the latest pixel count in the copy func-tion, full color mode, toner C and service technician reference.[Unit: 0.01%]
2
1600 Pixel counter
Latest pixel count/full color (K) (Service technician ref-erence)
PPC(color)
0<0-
10000>
SYS Displays the latest pixel count in the copy func-tion, full color mode, toner K and service technician reference.[Unit: 0.01%]
2
1601 Pixel counter
Latest pixel count/full color (Y+M+C+K) (Service tech-nician reference)
PRT(color)
0<0-
10000>
SYS Displays the latest pixel count in the printer function, full color mode, all toner and ser-vice technician refer-ence.[Unit: 0.01%]
2
Setting mode (08)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 211
2
1602 Pixel counter
Latest pixel count/full color (Y) (Service technician ref-erence)
PRT(color)
0<0-
10000>
SYS Displays the latest pixel count in the printer function, full color mode, toner Y and ser-vice technician refer-ence.[Unit: 0.01%]
2
1603 Pixel counter
Latest pixel count/full color (M) (Service technician ref-erence)
PRT(color)
0<0-
10000>
SYS Displays the latest pixel count in the printer function, full color mode, toner M and ser-vice technician refer-ence.[Unit: 0.01%]
2
1604 Pixel counter
Latest pixel count/full color (C) (Service technician ref-erence)
PRT(color)
0<0-
10000>
SYS Displays the latest pixel count in the printer function, full color mode, toner C and ser-vice technician refer-ence.[Unit: 0.01%]
2
1605 Pixel counter
Latest pixel count/full color (K) (Service technician ref-erence)
PRT(color)
0<0-
10000>
SYS Displays the latest pixel count in the printer function, full color mode, toner K and ser-vice technician refer-ence.[Unit: 0.01%]
2
1606 Pixel counter
Latest pixel count/black (Service technician refer-ence)
PPC(black)
0<0-
10000>
SYS Displays the latest pixel count in the copy func-tion, black mode and service technician refer-ence.[Unit: 0.01%]
2
1607 Pixel counter
Latest pixel count/black (Service technician refer-ence)
PRT(black)
0<0-
10000>
SYS Displays the latest pixel count in the printer function, black mode and service technician reference.[Unit: 0.01%]
2
1608 Pixel counter
Latest pixel count/black (Service technician refer-ence)
FAX(black)
0<0-
10000>
SYS Displays the latest pixel count in the FAX func-tion, black mode and service technician refer-ence.[Unit: 0.01%]
2
1609 Pixel counter
Average pixel count/full color (Y) (Toner cartridge reference)
PPC(color)
0<0-
10000>
SYS Displays the average pixel count in the copy function, full color mode, toner Y and toner cartridge refer-ence.[Unit: 0.01%]
2
Setting mode (08)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 212
1610 Pixel counter
Average pixel count/full color (M) (Toner cartridge reference)
PPC(color)
0<0-
10000>
SYS Displays the average pixel count in the copy function, full color mode, toner M and toner cartridge refer-ence.[Unit: 0.01%]
2
1611 Pixel counter
Average pixel count/full color (C) (Toner cartridge reference)
PPC(color)
0<0-
10000>
SYS Displays the average pixel count in the copy function, full color mode, toner C and toner cartridge refer-ence.[Unit: 0.01%]
2
1612 Pixel counter
Average pixel count/full color (K) (Toner cartridge reference)
PPC(color)
0<0-
10000>
SYS Displays the average pixel count in the copy function, full color mode, toner K and toner cartridge refer-ence.[Unit: 0.01%]
2
1613 Pixel counter
Average pixel count/black (Toner cartridge reference)
PPC(black)
0<0-
10000>
SYS Displays the average pixel count in the copy function, black mode and toner cartridge ref-erence.[Unit: 0.01%]
2
1614 Pixel counter
Average pixel count/full color (K)+black (Toner car-tridge reference)
PPC 0<0-
10000>
SYS Displays the average pixel count in the copy function, full color/black mode, toner K and toner cartridge refer-ence.[Unit: 0.01%]
2
1615 Pixel counter
Average pixel count/full color (Y) (Toner cartridge reference)
PRT(color)
0<0-
10000>
SYS Displays the average pixel count in the printer function, full color mode, toner Y and toner cartridge refer-ence.[Unit: 0.01%]
2
1616 Pixel counter
Average pixel count/full color (M) (Toner cartridge reference)
PRT(color)
0<0-
10000>
SYS Displays the average pixel count in the printer function, full color mode, toner M and toner cartridge refer-ence.[Unit: 0.01%]
2
1617 Pixel counter
Average pixel count/full color (C) (Toner cartridge reference)
PRT(color)
0<0-
10000>
SYS Displays the average pixel count in the printer function, full color mode, toner C and toner cartridge refer-ence.[Unit: 0.01%]
2
Setting mode (08)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 213
2
1618 Pixel counter
Average pixel count/full color (K) (Toner cartridge reference)
PRT(color)
0<0-
10000>
SYS Displays the average pixel count in the printer function, full color mode, toner K and toner cartridge refer-ence.[Unit: 0.01%]
2
1619 Pixel counter
Average pixel count/black (Toner cartridge reference)
PRT(black)
0<0-
10000>
SYS Displays the average pixel count in the printer function, black mode and toner cartridge ref-erence.[Unit: 0.01%]
2
1620 Pixel counter
Average pixel count/full color (K)+black (Toner car-tridge reference)
PRT 0<0-
10000>
SYS Displays the average pixel count in the printer function, full color/black mode, toner K and toner cartridge refer-ence.[Unit: 0.01%]
2
1621 Pixel counter
Average pixel count/full color (Y) (Toner cartridge reference)
PPC/PRT
(color)
0<0-
10000>
SYS Displays the average pixel count in the copy/printer function, full color mode, toner Y and toner cartridge refer-ence.[Unit: 0.01%]
2
1622 Pixel counter
Average pixel count/full color (M) (Toner cartridge reference)
PPC/PRT
(color)
0<0-
10000>
SYS Displays the average pixel count in the copy/printer function, full color mode, toner M and toner cartridge ref-erence.[Unit: 0.01%]
2
1623 Pixel counter
Average pixel count/full color (C) (Toner cartridge reference)
PPC/PRT
(color)
0<0-
10000>
SYS Displays the average pixel count in the copy/printer function, full color mode, toner C and toner cartridge ref-erence.[Unit: 0.01%]
2
1624 Pixel counter
Average pixel count/full color (K)+black (Toner car-tridge reference)
PPC/PRT/FAX
0<0-
10000>
SYS Displays the average pixel count in the copy/printer/FAX function, black mode, toner K and toner cartridge ref-erence.[Unit: 0.01%]
2
1625 Pixel counter
Average pixel count/black (Toner cartridge reference)
FAX(black)
0<0-
10000>
SYS Displays the average pixel count in the FAX function, black mode and toner cartridge ref-erence.[Unit: 0.01%]
2
Setting mode (08)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 214
1626 Pixel counter
Latest pixel count/full color (Y) (Toner cartridge refer-ence)
PPC(color)
0<0-
10000>
SYS Displays the latest pixel count in the copy func-tion, full color mode, toner Y and toner car-tridge reference.[Unit:0.01%]
2
1627 Pixel counter
Latest pixel count/full color (M) (Toner cartridge refer-ence)
PPC(color)
0<0-
10000>
SYS Displays the latest pixel count in the copy func-tion, full color mode, toner M and toner car-tridge reference.[Unit: 0.01%]
2
1628 Pixel counter
Latest pixel count/full color (C) (Toner cartridge refer-ence)
PPC(color)
0<0-
10000>
SYS Displays the latest pixel count in the copy func-tion, full color mode, toner C and toner car-tridge reference.[Unit: 0.01%]
2
1629 Pixel counter
Latest pixel count/full color (K) (Toner cartridge refer-ence)
PPC(color)
0<0-
10000>
SYS Displays the latest pixel count in the copy func-tion, full color mode, toner K and toner car-tridge reference.[Unit: 0.01%]
2
1630 Pixel counter
Latest pixel count/full color (Y) (Toner cartridge refer-ence)
PRT(color)
0<0-
10000>
SYS Displays the latest pixel count in the printer function, full color mode, toner Y and toner cartridge refer-ence.[Unit: 0.01%]
2
1631 Pixel counter
Latest pixel count/full color (M) (Toner cartridge refer-ence)
PRT(color)
0<0-
10000>
SYS Displays the latest pixel count in the printer function, full color mode, toner M and toner cartridge refer-ence.[Unit: 0.01%]
2
1632 Pixel counter
Latest pixel count/full color (C) (Toner cartridge refer-ence)
PRT(color)
0<0-
10000>
SYS Displays the latest pixel count in the printer function, full color mode, toner C and toner cartridge refer-ence.[Unit: 0.01%]
2
1633 Pixel counter
Latest pixel count/full color (K) (Toner cartridge refer-ence)
PRT(color)
0<0-
10000>
SYS Displays the latest pixel count in the printer function, full color mode, toner K and toner cartridge refer-ence.[Unit: 0.01%]
2
1634 Pixel counter
Latest pixel count/black (Toner cartridge reference)
FAX(black)
0<0-
10000>
SYS Displays the latest pixel count in the FAX func-tion, black mode and toner cartridge refer-ence. [Unit: 0.01%]
2
Setting mode (08)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 215
2
1639 Pixel counter
Latest pixel count/black (Toner cartridge reference)
PPC(black)
0<0-
10000>
SYS Displays the latest pixel count in the copy func-tion, black mode and toner cartridge refer-ence.[Unit: 0.01%]
2
1640 Pixel counter
Latest pixel count/black (Toner cartridge reference)
PRT(black)
0<0-
10000>
SYS Displays the latest pixel count in the printer function, black mode and toner cartridge ref-erence.[Unit: 0.01%]
2
1641-0 Pixel counter
Pixel count distribution/full color (Y)
0-5% PPC(color)
<8 digits> SYS The pixel count data are divided into 10 ranges. The number of output pages in each range is displayed. In this code, the distribu-tions in the copy func-tion, full color mode and toner Y are displayed. [Unit: page]
14
1641-1 5.1-10% PPC(color)
<8 digits> SYS 14
1641-2 10.1-15% PPC(color)
<8 digits> SYS 14
1641-3 15.1-20% PPC(color)
<8 digits> SYS 14
1641-4 20.1-25% PPC(color)
<8 digits> SYS 14
1641-5 25.1-30% PPC(color)
<8 digits> SYS 14
1641-6 30.1-40% PPC(color)
<8 digits> SYS 14
1641-7 40.1-60% PPC(color)
<8 digits> SYS 14
1641-8 60.1-80% PPC(color)
<8 digits> SYS 14
1641-9 80.1-100%
PPC(color)
<8 digits> SYS 14
1642-0 Pixel counter
Pixel count distribution/full color (M)
0-5% PPC(color)
<8 digits> SYS The pixel count data are divided into 10 ranges. The number of output pages in each range is displayed. In this code, the distribu-tions in the copy func-tion, full color mode and toner M are displayed. [Unit: page]
14
1642-1 5.1-10% PPC(color)
<8 digits> SYS 14
1642-2 10.1-15% PPC(color)
<8 digits> SYS 14
1642-3 15.1-20% PPC(color)
<8 digits> SYS 14
1642-4 20.1-25% PPC(color)
<8 digits> SYS 14
1642-5 25.1-30% PPC(color)
<8 digits> SYS 14
1642-6 30.1-40% PPC(color)
<8 digits> SYS 14
1642-7 40.1-60% PPC(color)
<8 digits> SYS 14
1642-8 60.1-80% PPC(color)
<8 digits> SYS 14
1642-9 80.1-100%
PPC(color)
<8 digits> SYS 14
Setting mode (08)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 216
1643-0 Pixel counter
Pixel count distribution/full color (C)
0-5% PPC(color)
<8 digits> SYS The pixel count data are divided into 10 ranges. The number of output pages in each range is displayed. In this code, the distribu-tions in the copy func-tion, full color mode and toner C are displayed. [Unit: page]
14
1643-1 5.1-10% PPC(color)
<8 digits> SYS 14
1643-2 10.1-15% PPC(color)
<8 digits> SYS 14
1643-3 15.1-20% PPC(color)
<8 digits> SYS 14
1643-4 20.1-25% PPC(color)
<8 digits> SYS 14
1643-5 25.1-30% PPC(color)
<8 digits> SYS 14
1643-6 30.1-40% PPC(color)
<8 digits> SYS 14
1643-7 40.1-60% PPC(color)
<8 digits> SYS 14
1643-8 60.1-80% PPC(color)
<8 digits> SYS 14
1643-9 80.1-100%
PPC(color)
<8 digits> SYS 14
1644-0 Pixel counter
Pixel count distribution/full color (K)
0-5% PPC(color)
<8 digits> SYS The pixel count data are divided into 10 ranges. The number of output pages in each range is displayed. In this code, the distribu-tions in the copy func-tion, full color mode and toner K are displayed. [Unit: page]
14
1644-1 5.1-10% PPC(color)
<8 digits> SYS 14
1644-2 10.1-15% PPC(color)
<8 digits> SYS 14
1644-3 15.1-20% PPC(color)
<8 digits> SYS 14
1644-4 20.1-25% PPC(color)
<8 digits> SYS 14
1644-5 25.1-30% PPC(color)
<8 digits> SYS 14
1644-6 30.1-40% PPC(color)
<8 digits> SYS 14
1644-7 40.1-60% PPC(color)
<8 digits> SYS 14
1644-8 60.1-80% PPC(color)
<8 digits> SYS 14
1644-9 80.1-100%
PPC(color)
<8 digits> SYS 14
Setting mode (08)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 217
2
1645-0 Pixel counter
Pixel count distribution/full color (Y)
0-5% PRT(color)
<8 digits> SYS The pixel count data are divided into 10 ranges. The number of output pages in each range is displayed. In this code, the distribu-tions in the printer func-tion, full color mode and toner Y are displayed. [Unit: page]
14
1645-1 5.1-10% PRT(color)
<8 digits> SYS 14
1645-2 10.1-15% PRT(color)
<8 digits> SYS 14
1645-3 15.1-20% PRT(color)
<8 digits> SYS 14
1645-4 20.1-25% PRT(color)
<8 digits> SYS 14
1645-5 25.1-30% PRT(color)
<8 digits> SYS 14
1645-6 30.1-40% PRT(color)
<8 digits> SYS 14
1645-7 40.1-60% PRT(color)
<8 digits> SYS 14
1645-8 60.1-80% PRT(color)
<8 digits> SYS 14
1645-9 80.1-100%
PRT(color)
<8 digits> SYS 14
1646-0 Pixel counter
Pixel count distribution/full color (M)
0-5% PRT(color)
<8 digits> SYS The pixel count data are divided into 10 ranges. The number of output pages in each range is displayed. In this code, the distribu-tions in the printer func-tion, full color mode and toner M are displayed. [Unit: page]
14
1646-1 5.1-10% PRT(color)
<8 digits> SYS 14
1646-2 10.1-15% PRT(color)
<8 digits> SYS 14
1646-3 15.1-20% PRT(color)
<8 digits> SYS 14
1646-4 20.1-25% PRT(color)
<8 digits> SYS 14
1646-5 25.1-30% PRT(color)
<8 digits> SYS 14
1646-6 30.1-40% PRT(color)
<8 digits> SYS 14
1646-7 40.1-60% PRT(color)
<8 digits> SYS 14
1646-8 60.1-80% PRT(color)
<8 digits> SYS 14
1646-9 80.1-100%
PRT(color)
<8 digits> SYS 14
Setting mode (08)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
08/04
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 218
1647-0 Pixel counter
Pixel count distribution/full color (C)
0-5% PRT(color)
<8 digits> SYS The pixel count data are divided into 10 ranges. The number of output pages in each range is displayed. In this code, the distribu-tions in the printer func-tion, full color mode and toner C are displayed. [Unit: page]
14
1647-1 5.1-10% PRT(color)
<8 digits> SYS 14
1647-2 10.1-15% PRT(color)
<8 digits> SYS 14
1647-3 15.1-20% PRT(color)
<8 digits> SYS 14
1647-4 20.1-25% PRT(color)
<8 digits> SYS 14
1647-5 25.1-30% PRT(color)
<8 digits> SYS 14
1647-6 30.1-40% PRT(color)
<8 digits> SYS 14
1647-7 40.1-60% PRT(color)
<8 digits> SYS 14
1647-8 60.1-80% PRT(color)
<8 digits> SYS 14
1647-9 80.1-100%
PRT(color)
<8 digits> SYS 14
1648-0 Pixel counter
Pixel count distribution/full color (K)
0-5% PRT(color)
<8 digits> SYS The pixel count data are divided into 10 ranges. The number of output pages in each range is displayed. In this code, the distribu-tions in the printer func-tion, full color mode and toner K are displayed. [Unit: page]
14
1648-1 5.1-10% PRT(color)
<8 digits> SYS 14
1648-2 10.1-15% PRT(color)
<8 digits> SYS 14
1648-3 15.1-20% PRT(color)
<8 digits> SYS 14
1648-4 20.1-25% PRT(color)
<8 digits> SYS 14
1648-5 25.1-30% PRT(color)
<8 digits> SYS 14
1648-6 30.1-40% PRT(color)
<8 digits> SYS 14
1648-7 40.1-60% PRT(color)
<8 digits> SYS 14
1648-8 60.1-80% PRT(color)
<8 digits> SYS 14
1648-9 80.1-100%
PRT(color)
<8 digits> SYS 14
Setting mode (08)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 219
2
1649-0 Pixel counter
Pixel count distribution/black
0-5% PPC(black)
<8 digits> SYS The pixel count data are divided into 10 ranges. The number of output pages in each range is displayed. In this code, the distribu-tions in the copy func-tion and black mode aredisplayed.[Unit: page]
14
1649-1 5.1-10% PPC(black)
<8 digits> SYS 14
1649-2 10.1-15% PPC(black)
<8 digits> SYS 14
1649-3 15.1-20% PPC(black)
<8 digits> SYS 14
1649-4 20.1-25% PPC(black)
<8 digits> SYS 14
1649-5 25.1-30% PPC(black)
<8 digits> SYS 14
1649-6 30.1-40% PPC(black)
<8 digits> SYS 14
1649-7 40.1-60% PPC(black)
<8 digits> SYS 14
1649-8 60.1-80% PPC(black)
<8 digits> SYS 14
1649-9 80.1-100%
PPC(black)
<8 digits> SYS 14
1650-0 Pixel counter
Pixel count distribution/black
0-5% PRT(black)
<8 digits> SYS The pixel count data are divided into 10 ranges. The number of output pages in each range is displayed. In this code, the distribu-tions in the printer func-tion and black mode are displayed.[Unit: page]
14
1650-1 5.1-10% PRT(black)
<8 digits> SYS 14
1650-2 10.1-15% PRT(black)
<8 digits> SYS 14
1650-3 15.1-20% PRT(black)
<8 digits> SYS 14
1650-4 20.1-25% PRT(black)
<8 digits> SYS 14
1650-5 25.1-30% PRT(black)
<8 digits> SYS 14
1650-6 30.1-40% PRT(black)
<8 digits> SYS 14
1650-7 40.1-60% PRT(black)
<8 digits> SYS 14
1650-8 60.1-80% PRT(black)
<8 digits> SYS 14
1650-9 80.1-100%
PRT(black)
<8 digits> SYS 14
Setting mode (08)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
06/08
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 220
1651-0 Pixel counter
Pixel count distribution/black
0-5% FAX(black)
<8 digits> SYS The pixel count data are divided into 10 ranges. The number of output pages in each range is displayed. In this code, the distribu-tions in the FAX func-tion and black mode are dis-played.[Unit: page]
14
1651-1 5.1-10% FAX(black)
<8 digits> SYS 14
1651-2 10.1-15% FAX(black)
<8 digits> SYS 14
1651-3 15.1-20% FAX(black)
<8 digits> SYS 14
1651-4 20.1-25% FAX(black)
<8 digits> SYS 14
1651-5 25.1-30% FAX(black)
<8 digits> SYS 14
1651-6 30.1-40% FAX(black)
<8 digits> SYS 14
1651-7 40.1-60% FAX(black)
<8 digits> SYS 14
1651-8 60.1-80% FAX(black)
<8 digits> SYS 14
1651-9 80.1-100%
FAX(black)
<8 digits> SYS 14
Setting mode (08)
CodeClassifi-cation
ItemsFunc-tion
Default<Accept-
able value>
RAM ContentsPro-
cedure
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 221
2
<<PM support mode related code>>• The management items at PM support mode can also be operated at setting mode (08).
The following items are displayed or set by using sub-codes at PM management setting in the table below.
<Sub-codes>0: Present number of output pages
- Means the present number of output pages.1: Recommended number of output pages for replacement
- Means the recommended number of output pages for replacement.2: Number of output pages at the last replacement
- Means the number of output pages at the last replacement.3: Present driving counts
- Means the present drive counts (1 count = 2 seconds).4: Recommended driving counts to be replaced
- Means the recommended drive counts for replacement (1 count = 2 seconds).5: Driving counts at the last replacement
- Means the drive counts at the last replacement.6: Present output pages for control
- Means the present number of output pages for controlling.7: Present driving counts for control
- Means the present drive counts for controlling (1 count = 2 seconds).8: Number of times replaced
- Counts up when clearing the counter of each unit in the PM Support Mode Screen.
Notes: • Sub-code 0 is equivalent to sub-code 6.• Sub-code 3 is equivalent to sub-code 7.• When the value of sub-code 3 is changed, the value of sub-code 7 is also updated and vice
versa.• When "0" is set at one of sub-codes 0, 3, 6 and 7, the rest of them are automatically updated
to "0".
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 222
ItemsPM management set-ting <Procedure 4>
*Indicated in 8 digits
Date of previous replacement
<Procedure 2>Remarks
Photoconductive drum 1150-0 to 8 1151 <Default values of code 1150(e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c)>Sub-codes 0, 2, 3, 5, 6, 7, 8: 0/0/0Sub-code 1: 130,000/160,000/200,000Sub-code 4: 315,000/315,000/315,000
Drum cleaning blade 1158-0 to 8 1159 <Default values of code 1158(e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c)>Sub-codes 0, 2, 3, 5, 6, 7, 8: 0/0/0Sub-code 1: 130,000/160,000/200,000Sub-code 4: 315,000/315,000/315,000
Drum cleaning brush 1166-0 to 8 1167 <Default values of code 1166(e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c)>Sub-codes 0, 2, 3, 5, 6, 7, 8: 0/0/0Sub-code 1: 130,000/160,000/200,000Sub-code 4: 315,000/315,000/315,000
Main charger grid 1174-0 to 8 1175 <Default values of code 1174(e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c)>Sub-codes 0, 2, 3, 5, 6, 7, 8: 0/0/0Sub-code 1: 130,000/160,000/200,000Sub-code 4: 315,000/315,000/315,000
Main charger wire 1182-0 to 8 1183 <Default values of code 1182(e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c)>Sub-codes 0, 2, 3, 5, 6, 7, 8: 0/0/0Sub-code 1: 130,000/160,000/200,000Sub-code 4: 315,000/315,000/315,000
Main charger wire clean-ing pad
1190-0 to 8 1191 <Default values of code 1190(e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c)>Sub-codes 0, 2, 3, 5, 6, 7, 8: 0/0/0Sub-code 1: 130,000/160,000/200,000Sub-code 4: 315,000/315,000/315,000
Ozone filter 1198-0 to 8 1199 <Default values of code 1198(e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c)>Sub-codes 0, 2, 3, 5, 6, 7, 8: 0/0/0Sub-code 1: 130,000/160,000/200,000Sub-code 4: 315,000/315,000/315,000
Developer material 1200-0 to 8 1201 <Default values of code 1200(e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c)>Sub-codes 0, 2, 3, 5, 6, 7, 8: 0/0/0Sub-code 1: 100,000/120,000/150,000Sub-code 4: 116,000/116,000/116,000
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 223
2
Developer material Y 1202-0 to 8 1203 <Default values of code 1202(e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c)>Sub-codes 0, 2, 3, 5, 6, 7, 8: 0/0/0Sub-code 1: 24,000/30,000/37,500Sub-code 4: 28,000/28,000/28,000
Developer material M 1204-0 to 8 1205 <Default values of code 1204(e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c)>Sub-codes 0, 2, 3, 5, 6, 7, 8: 0/0/0Sub-code 1: 24,000/30,000/37,500Sub-code 4: 28,000/28,000/28,000
Developer material C 1206-0 to 8 1207 <Default values of code 1206(e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c)>Sub-codes 0, 2, 3, 5, 6, 7, 8: 0/0/0Sub-code 1: 24,000/30,000/37,500Sub-code 4: 28,000/28,000/28,000
Transfer belt cleaning blade
1232-0 to 8 1233 <Default values of code 1232(e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c)>Sub-codes 0, 2, 3, 5, 6, 7, 8: 0/0/0Sub-code 1: 130,000/160,000/200,000Sub-code 4: 337,000/337,000/337,000
2nd transfer roller 1240-0 to 8 1241 <Default values of code 1240(e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c)>Sub-codes 0, 2, 3, 5, 6, 7, 8: 0/0/0Sub-code 1: 200,000/240,000/300,000Sub-code 4: 312,000/312,000/312,000
Pressure roller 1250-0 to 8 1251 <Default values of code 1250(e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c)>Sub-codes 0, 2, 3, 5, 6, 7, 8: 0/0/0Sub-code 1: 100,000/120,000/150,000Sub-code 4: 285,000/285,000/285,000
Oil roller 1258-0 to 8 1259 <Default values of code 1258(e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c)>Sub-codes 0, 2, 3, 5, 6, 7, 8: 0/0/0Sub-code 1: 100,000/120,000/150,000Sub-code 4: 285,000/285,000/285,000
Cleaning roller 1260-0 to 8 1261 <Default values of code 1260(e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c)>Sub-codes 0, 2, 3, 5, 6, 7, 8: 0/0/0Sub-code 1: 100,000/120,000/150,000Sub-code 4: 285,000/285,000/285,000
Pressure roller separation finger
1270-0 to 8 1271 <Default values of code 1270(e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c)>Sub-codes 0, 2, 3, 5, 6, 7, 8: 0/0/0Sub-code 1: 100,000/120,000/150,000Sub-code 4: 285,000/285,000/285,000
ItemsPM management set-ting <Procedure 4>
*Indicated in 8 digits
Date of previous replacement
<Procedure 2>Remarks
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 224
Fuser belt 1272-0 to 8 1273 <Default values of code 1272(e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c)>Sub-codes 0, 2, 3, 5, 6, 7, 8: 0/0/0Sub-code 1: 100,000/120,000/150,000Sub-code 4: 285,000/285,000/285,000
Fuser belt guide 1276-0 to 8 1277 <Default values of code 1276(e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c)>Sub-codes 0, 2, 3, 5, 6, 7, 8: 0/0/0Sub-code 1: 100,000/120,000/150,000Sub-code 4: 285,000/285,000/285,000
Pickup roller(RADF)
1282-0, 1, 2, 8 1283 <Default values of code 1282(e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c)>Sub-codes 0, 2, 8: 0/0/0Sub-code 1: 120,000/120,000/120,000
Feed roller(RADF)
1284-0,1,2,8 1285 <Default values of code 1284(e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c)>Sub-codes 0, 2, 8: 0/0/0Sub-code 1: 120,000/120,000/120,000
Separation roller(RADF)
1286-0, 1, 2, 8 1287 <Default values of code 1286(e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c)>Sub-codes 0, 2, 8: 0/0/0Sub-code 1: 120,000/120,000/120,000
Pickup roller(Upper drawer)
1290-0, 1, 2, 8 1291 <Default values of code 1290(e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c)>Sub-codes 0, 2, 8: 0/0/0Sub-code 1: 80,000/80,000/80,000
Pickup roller(Lower drawer)
1292-0,1,2,8 1293 <Default values of code 1292(e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c)>Sub-codes 0, 2, 8: 0/0/0Sub-code 1: 80,000/80,000/80,000
Pickup roller(LCF)
1294-0,1,2,8 1295 <Default values of code 1294(e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c)>Sub-codes 0, 2, 8: 0/0/0Sub-code 1: 160,000/160,000/160,000
Feed roller(Upper drawer)
1298-0,1,2,8 1299 <Default values of code 1298(e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c)>Sub-codes 0, 2, 8: 0/0/0Sub-code 1: 80,000/80,000/80,000
Feed roller(Lower drawer)
1300-0,1,2,8 1301 <Default values of code 1300(e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c)>Sub-codes 0, 2, 8: 0/0/0Sub-code 1: 80,000/80,000/80,000
Feed roller(LCF)
1302-0, 1, 2, 8 1303 <Default values of code 1302(e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c)>Sub-codes 0, 2, 8: 0/0/0Sub-code 1: 160,000/160,000/160,000
ItemsPM management set-ting <Procedure 4>
*Indicated in 8 digits
Date of previous replacement
<Procedure 2>Remarks
06/08
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 225
2
Separation roller(Upper drawer)
1306-0,1,2,8 1307 <Default values of code 1306(e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c)>Sub-codes 0, 2, 8: 0/0/0Sub-code 1: 80,000/80,000/80,000
Separation roller(Lower drawer)
1308-0,1,2,8 1309 <Default values of code 1308(e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c)>Sub-codes 0, 2, 8: 0/0/0Sub-code 1: 80,000/80,000/80,000
Separation roller(LCF)
1310-0,1,2,8 1311 <Default values of code 1310(e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c)>Sub-codes 0, 2, 8: 0/0/0Sub-code 1: 160,000/160,000/160,000
Separation roller(PFP upper drawer)
1312-0,1,2,8 1313 <Default values of code 1312(e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c)>Sub-codes 0, 2, 8: 0/0/0Sub-code 1: 80,000/80,000/80,000
Separation roller(PFP lower drawer)
1314-0,1,2,8 1315 <Default values of code 1314(e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c)>Sub-codes 0, 2, 8: 0/0/0Sub-code 1: 80,000/80,000/80,000
Separation roller(Bypass unit)
1316-0,1,2,8 1317 <Default values of code 1316(e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c)>Sub-codes 0, 2, 8: 0/0/0Sub-code 1: 80,000/80,000/80,000
Feed roller(PFP upper drawer)
1320-0,1,2,8 1321 <Default values of code 1320(e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c)>Sub-codes 0, 2, 8: 0/0/0Sub-code 1: 80,000/80,000/80,000
Feed roller(PFP lower drawer)
1322-0,1,2,8 1323 <Default values of code 1322(e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c)>Sub-codes 0, 2, 8: 0/0/0Sub-code 1: 80,000/80,000/80,000
Feed roller(Bypass unit)
1324-0,1,2,8 1325 <Default values of code 1324(e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c)>Sub-codes 0, 2, 8: 0/0/0Sub-code 1: 80,000/80,000/80,000
Pickup roller(PFP upper drawer)
1328-0,1,2,8 1329 <Default values of code 1328(e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c)>Sub-codes 0, 2, 8: 0/0/0Sub-code 1: 80,000/80,000/80,000
Pickup roller(PFP lower drawer)
1330-0,1,2,8 1331 <Default values of code 1330(e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c)>Sub-codes 0, 2, 8: 0/0/0Sub-code 1: 80,000/80,000/80,000
Pickup roller(Bypass unit)
1332-0, 1, 2, 8 1333 <Default values of code 1332(e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c)>Sub-codes 0, 2, 8: 0/0/0Sub-code 1: 80,000/80,000/80,000
Pressure rollerdischarge brush
1838-0 to 8 1839 <Default values of code 1838 (e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c)>Sub-codes 0, 2, 3, 5, 6, 7, 8: 0/0/0Sub-code 1: 100,000/120,000/150,000Sub-code 4: 285,000/285,000/285,000
ItemsPM management set-ting <Procedure 4>
*Indicated in 8 digits
Date of previous replacement
<Procedure 2>Remarks
06/08
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 226
<<Procedure to copy the total counter value (08-257)>>
(1) Turn ON the power while [0] and [8] are pressed simultaneously.(2) Key in the code “257” with the digital keys and press the [START] button (the following is dis-
played).
Note: Note: Before performing the following operations, note the current counter values.
Fig. 2-3
(3) Key in the value “1” or “2” and press the [START] button.The value entered is displayed on the left of the “%”, and the [ENTER] button is displayed.
Note: Note: The value can be erased by pressing the [CLEAR] button to change as long as the [START] but-ton is not pressed. (The value on the left of the “%” is reset to “0” by pressing the [CLEAR] but-ton.)
• Key in “1” to copy the value of the total counter (LGC board) (A) onto the value of the backup counter (SYS board) (B).
Fig. 2-4
(A) (B)
06/08
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 227
2
(4) Press the [ENTER] button to complete overwriting of the counter value.
Note: Note: The screen returns to the code entry screen without copying (overwriting) the value when the [CANCEL] button is pressed.
• Key in “2” to copy the value of the backup counter (SYS board) (B) onto the value of the total counter (LGC board) (A).
Fig. 2-5
(A) (B)
06/08
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 228
2.2.6 Pixel counter1) Outline
Pixel counter is a function that counts the number of dots emitted by the laser and converts it into the print ratio (%) per standard paper size. This “Print ratio (%) per standard paper size” is called Pixel count (%).
This function enables you to know how each user uses the equipment and to grasp the tendency of toner consumption (number of output pages per cartridge).
2) Factors affecting toner consumptionStandard number of output pages per cartridge shows the average number of output pages under the condition that the data of print ratio 6% is printed on the standard paper size (A4/LT) at a normal temperature and humidity.However, users do not always print under the above condition. As for the type of original, copy/print mode and environment, each user has different tendency, and as a result, the number of output pages per cartridge becomes different depending on the user.
The major factors affecting toner consumption are as follows:- Original/Data coverage- Original/Data density- Original/Print mode- Density settingAlso there are other factors in addition to the above, such as environment, individual difference of equipment, difference in lot quality of materials, toner density and drum surface potential.
07/05
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 229
2
The general relations between the above 4 factors and toner consumption per output page in the copy function are as follows:
Fig. 2-6 Factors affecting toner consumption and the tendency
3) Details of pixel counter- Toner cartridge reference and service technician reference
The pixel counter function in this equipment has 2 references, toner cartridge reference and ser-vice technician reference.
Toner cartridge referenceThis is a system that accumulates data between the installation of a new toner cartridge and next installation.The installation of new toner cartridge is judged when the total number of pixel count or output pages after the detection of toner cartridge empty has exceeded the threshold.The threshold to be used is selectable in the setting mode (08-1506) between the pixel count and output pages (0: Output pages 1: Pixel counter). The threshold of pixel count is set in the setting mode (08-1508) and that of output pages is set in the setting mode (08-1507). When the new toner cartridge is judged as installed, the data related with the previous cartridge is cleared and replaced with the data after the installation of new cartridge. Clearing of the counter of the toner cartridge reference is performed in the setting mode (08-1503).
Toner
consum
ption
Toner
consum
ption
Toner
consum
ption
Toner
consum
ption
Original coverage Original density
Original mode Density setting
TEXT/PHOTO
TEXT PHOTOPRINTED
IMAGEMAP
Manualdensity
-5
Manualdensity
-1
Automaticdensity
ManualdensityCenter
Manualdensity
+1
Manualdensity
+5
06/08
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 230
Service technician referenceThis is a system that accumulates data between clearing the counter of the service technician reference by service technician and subsequently clearing the same counter.Clearing of the counter of the service technician reference is performed in the setting mode (08-1502).
- Print count (number of output pages)The number of output pages shown at the pixel counter is counted after converting all paper sizes to the standard paper size (A4/LT). Printing on other than the standard size is converted by paper area ratio. The standard paper size is set in the setting mode (08-1500).The examples of conversion are as follows:
Ex.)“1” is added to the print count when printing on A4/LT size.
“2” is added to the print count when printing on A3/LD size. (area ratio to A4/LT: 200%)
“1.49” is added to the print count when printing on B4 size. (area ratio to A4: 149%)
“1.27” is added to the print count when printing on LG size. (area ratio to LT: 127%)
- Pixel count (%)Pixel count (%) shows the ratio of laser emitting pixels to all pixels on standard paper.The examples of pixel count are as follows:
Ex.)Printing 5 pages on A4/LT size with solid copy (Laser emits to all pixels.)→ Pixel count: 100%, Print count: 5
Printing 5 pages on A4/LT size with blank copy (Laser never emits.)→ Pixel count: 0%, Print count: 5
Printing 2 pages on A4/LT size with solid copy (Laser emits to all pixels.)Printing 2 pages on A4/LT size with blank copy (Laser never emits.)→ Pixel count: 50%, Print count: 4
Printing 3 pages on A4/LT size with 6% of laser emissionPrinting 1 page on A4/LT size with 2% of laser emission→ Pixel count: 5%, Print count: 4
Printing 2 pages on A3/LD size with solid copy (Laser emits to all pixels.)→ Pixel count: 100%, Print count: 4
Printing 2 pages on A3/LD size with 6% of laser emission→ Pixel count: 6%, Print count: 4
Note: Note: In the following examples, ‘solid copy’ is considered to be 100%. But since the image has 4 margins, it never becomes 100% actually.
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 231
2
- Average pixel count (%) and latest pixel count (%)There are 2 types of the value calculated as the pixel count, average pixel count (%) and latest pixel count (%).
Average pixel count (%)The average value of all pixel count data after each reference data is cleared is calculated and displayed.
Latest pixel count (%)The value is displayed for printing just before the pixel counter is confirmed.
- Type of calculated dataSince this is multifunctional and color equipment, the data of pixel count is calculated for each function and color.The following list is the information that can be confirmed by LCD screen. But actually, more information can be confirmed by the setting mode (08).See after-mentioned “5)-Display in the setting mode (08)” for details.
: With data⎯: Without data
Table 2-201 Type of calculated data
- Setting related with the pixel counter functionStandard paper size settingThe standard paper size (A4 or LT) to convert it into the pixel count is selected (08-1500).
Pixel counter display settingWhether or not to display the pixel counter on the LCD screen is selected (08-1504).
Display reference settingThe reference when displaying the pixel counter on the LCD screen (toner cartridge reference or service technician reference) is selected (08-1505).
Determination counter of toner emptyThis is the counter to determine the replacement of new toner cartridge after the toner empty is detected.After the toner empty is detected by the auto-toner sensor, this counter checks if toner empty is not detected one more time while the specified number of pixel count or output pages is counted.
Pixel counter clearingThere are 3 types for the pixel count clear as follows:08-1501: All information related to the pixel count is cleared.08-1502: All information related to the service technician reference pixel count is cleared.08-1503: All information related to the toner cartridge reference pixel count is cleared.
Toner cartridge reference Service technician reference
YellowMagen
taCyan Black
Full color/Twin colorBlack
Total YellowMagen
taCyan Black
Copier function
Printer function
FAX function - - - - - - - -
Total
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 232
4) Relation between pixel count and toner consumptionThe user’s printing out the image with large coverage or high density may cause the large value of pixel count. And the setting that toner consumption becomes high in the original mode or density setting may cause it as well.In this case, the replacement cycle of toner cartridge is faster than the standard number of output pages. Therefore, this trend needs to be grasped for the service.The relation between pixel count and number of output pages per cartridge is as follows:
Fig. 2-7 Pixel count and number of output pages per cartridge
6% 12% 60%
X
Y
Y/2
X/2
Y/10
X/10
Standard number of output pages (K)
Standard number of output pages (Y, M, C)
Nu
mb
er
of
ou
tpu
t p
ag
es p
er
ca
rtrid
ge
(P
ag
e)
Pixel count (%)
07/11
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 233
2
5) Pixel counter confirmation- Display on LCD screen
Whether or not to display the pixel counter on the LCD screen is selected (0: Displayed, 1: Not displayed) in the setting mode (08-1504), and whether or not to display it at the service techni-cian reference or toner cartridge reference is selected (0: Service technician reference, 1: Toner cartridge reference) in the setting mode (08-1505).
The following screen is displayed when the buttons, [USER FUNCTIONS], [COUNTER] and [PIXEL COUNTER] are pressed in this order after “Displayed” is selected with the code above and the power is, as usual, turned ON. (The displayed buttons are depending on the setting of 08-1505.)
Fig. 2-8
Fig. 2-9 Reference selection screen
When selecting and pressing the button in the above screen, each pixel counter screen is dis-played.[TONER CARTRIDGE] button: Information screen of toner cartridge reference is displayed.[SERVICE (COLOR)] button: Information screen of service technician reference (full color) is dis-played.[SERVICE (BLACK)] button: Information screen of service technician reference (black) is dis-played.
09/02
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 234
The following screen is displayed when pressing the [TONER CARTRIDGE] button.
Fig. 2-10 Information screen of toner cartridge reference
The following screen is displayed when pressing the [SERVICE (COLOR)] button.
Fig. 2-11 Information screen of service technician reference (full color)
The following screen is displayed when pressing the [SERVICE (BLACK)] button.
Fig. 2-12 Information screen of service technician reference (black)
07/04
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 235
2
- Data list printingThe data for pixel counter can be printed in the list print mode (9S).9S-104: The data of the toner cartridge reference is printed.9S-105: The data of service technician reference is printed.
Fig. 2-13 Data list of toner cartridge reference
Fig. 2-14 Data list of service technician reference
PIXEL COUNTER CODE LIST
SERVICEMAN
No
0
1
2
9
10
11
DATE
20050614
20050614
20050614
20050614
20050614
20050614
FAX
- - -
- - -
- - -
12345
12345
12345
PPC
12345
12345
12345
12345
12345
12345
PRN
23456
23456
23456
23456
23456
23456
TOTAL
45678
45678
45678
45678
45678
45678
2005.6.14 09:55
Col.
Y
Y
Y
K
K
K
Print Count [LT/A4]
Average Pixel Count [%]
Latest Pixel Count [%]
Print Count [LT/A4]
Average Pixel Count [%]
Latest Pixel Count [%]
PIXEL COUNTER CODE LIST
TONERCARTRIDGE
No0 1 2
91011
DATE20050614 20050614 20050614
20050614 20050614 20050614
FAX- - - - - - - - -
123451234512345
PPC12345 12345 12345
123451234512345
PRN23456 23456 23456
234562345623456
TOTAL45678 45678 45678
456784567845678
2005.6.14 09:55
Col.YYY
KKK
Print Count [LT/A4]Average Pixel Count [%]Latest Pixel Count [%]
Print Count [LT/A4]Average Pixel Count [%]Latest Pixel Count [%]
07/04
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 236
- Display in the setting mode (08)Information of pixel count can be also checked in the setting mode (08).For details, see P. 2-87 "2.2.5 Setting mode (08)".
Print count, pixel count
Table 2-202 Pixel count code table (toner cartridge reference)
Table 2-203 Pixel count code table (service technician reference)
Full color/Twin color
Black
Black(at color)
+Black
Yellow Magenta Cyan Black
Copierfunction
Print count(page)
1557 1559 1561 1552 1553 -
Average pixel count(%)
1609 1610 1611 1612 1613 1614
Latest pixel count(%)
1626 1627 1628 1629 1639 -
Printerfunction
Print count(page)
1558 1560 1562 1554 1555 -
Average pixel count(%)
1615 1616 1617 1618 1619 1620
Latest pixel count(%)
1630 1631 1632 1633 1640 -
FAX function Print count(page)
- - - - 1556 -
Average pixel count(%)
- - - - 1625 -
Latest pixel count(%)
- - - - 1634 -
Total Average pixel count(%)
1621 1622 1623 - - 1624
Full color/Twin colorBlack
Total Yellow Magenta Cyan Black
Copierfunction
Print count(page)
1547 - - - - 1548
Average pixel count(%)
1577 1578 1579 1580 1581 1592
Latest pixel count(%)
1596 1597 1598 1599 1600 1606
Printerfunction
Print count(page)
1549 - - - - 1550
Average pixel count(%)
1582 1583 1584 1585 1586 1593
Latest pixel count(%)
1601 1602 1603 1604 1605 1607
FAX function Print count(page)
- - - - - 1551
Average pixel count(%)
- - - - - 1594
Latest pixel count(%)
- - - - - 1608
Total Average pixel count(%)
1587 1588 1598 1590 1591 1595
07/04
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 237
2
Pixel count distribution
Table 2-204 Pixel count code table
Other informationToner cartridge replacement counter.The toner cartridge replacement count is displayed.
08-1563: Toner cartridge Y08-1564: Toner cartridge M08-1565: Toner cartridge C08-1566: Toner cartridge K
Toner cartridge reference count started dateThe toner cartridge reference count started date is displayed.
08-1515: Toner cartridge Y08-1516: Toner cartridge M08-1517: Toner cartridge C08-1518: Toner cartridge K
Service technician reference cleared dateThe service technician reference cleared date (08-1510) is displayed.The date (08-1502 was performed) is stored.
Toner cartridge reference cleared dateThe toner cartridge reference cleared date is displayed.The date (08-1503 was performed) is stored.
08-1511: Toner cartridge Y08-1512: Toner cartridge M08-1513: Toner cartridge C08-1514: Toner cartridge K
Full color/Twin colorBlack
Yellow Magenta Cyan Black
Copierfunction
Print count distribution(page)
1641 1642 1643 1644 1549
Printerfunction
Print count distribution(page)
1645 1646 1647 1648 1650
FAX function Print count distribution(page)
- - - - 1651
Note: Note: By entering the sub code at the above code, the pixel count distribution can be displayed divid-ing into 10 ranges. The sub codes are as follows.0: 0 - 5% 1: 5.1 - 10% 2: 10.1 - 15% 3: 15.1 - 20% 4: 20.1 - 25%5: 25.1 - 30% 6: 30.1 - 40% 7: 40.1 - 60% 8: 60.1- 80% 9: 80.1 - 100%
09/02
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 238
2.2.7 Classification List of Adjustment Mode (05) / Setting Mode (08)
Classification Adjustment Mode (05) Setting Mode (08)
User interface [AMS]605
[X in 1] 650
[Color specification] 643, 644
[Indicator] 671
[Edit copying] 645, 646
[Sound] 610, 969, 970
[Counter] 202
[Cascade] 652, 653
[ACS] 268
[Screen] 207, 602
[Administrator] 263
[Feeding setting] 658, 659
[Language] 220, 221
[Original counter] 302
[Original direction] 628
[Copy volume] 300
[Automatic calibration] 632
[Default setting] 276, 277, 278, 279, 280, 281, 282, 283, 284, 285, 286, 289, 331, 503, 585, 587, 588, 603, 604, 607, 618, 642, 1479
[Offsetting between jobs] 682
[Security level] 1708
[Sorting] 627, 634, 641, 649
[Timer] 204, 205, 206
[Template] 1140, 3851
[Image shift] 636, 1429, 1430
[Tray reset] 648
[Panel calibration]9051
[Date] 640
[Annotation] 651, 657
[Displaying number] 342
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 239
2
User interface [Job Build] 1130, 1131
[File] 209, 218, 219
[Department management] 617, 620, 621, 622, 623, 624, 629
[Black-free] 343
[Book duplexing] 611
[Box printing] 951, 953, 954
[Paper size] 613
[Blank copy prevention] 625
[JOB STATUS] 983
[Keyboard layout] 1929, 1930, 1931, 1932, 1933, 1934, 1935
[Jam releasing] 9359
[PM] 9891
Scanner [Log table] 361, 362
[Image position] 305, 306
[Carriage position] 359, 360
[Fixed value] 363, 364
[Shading position] 350, 351
[Distortion] 308
[Reproduction ratio] 340
[E-mail] 272, 273
[Enhanced template] 9886, 9888
Fax [Function]1498, 1926, 3847, 3848, 3849
[Destination] 701
[Default setting] 274
[Priority drawer] 689
Classification Adjustment Mode (05) Setting Mode (08)
09/02
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 240
Image [Binarization] 700, 701, 702
[ACS] 1065, 1066, 1675, 1676
[RGB] 1080, 1081, 1082
[Color deviation correction] 417-0 to 3, 418-0 to 3, 953-0 to 3,954-0 to 3, 955-0 to 3, 956-0 to 3
[Image density] 501, 503, 504, 505, 506, 507, 508, 509, 510, 512, 514, 515, 710, 714, 715, 719, 720, 724, 725, 729, 845, 846, 847, 850, 851, 852, 855, 856, 857, 860, 861, 862, 1550, 1551, 1552, 1553, 1554, 1560, 1561, 1562, 1563, 1564, 1570, 1571, 1572, 1573, 1574, 1580, 1581, 1582, 1583, 1584
[Pixel size] 663
[Color balance] 1010-0 to 2, 1011-0 to 2, 1012-0 to 2, 1013-0 to 2, 1014-0 to 2, 1015-0 to 2, 1016-0 to 2, 1017-0 to 2, 1018-0 to 2, 1019-0 to 2, 1020-0 to 2, 1021-0 to 2, 1022-0 to 2, 1023-0 to 2, 1024-0 to 2, 1025-0 to 2, 1026-0 to 2, 1027-0 to 2, 1028-0 to 2, 1029-0 to 2, 1030-0 to 2, 1031-0 to 2, 1032-0 to 2, 1033-0 to 2, 1034-0 to 2, 1035-0 to 2, 1036-0 to 2, 1037-0 to 2, 1038-0 to 2, 1039-0 to 2, 1040-0 to 2, 1041-0 to 2, 1779-0 to 2, 1780-0 to 2, 1781-0 to 2, 1782-0 to 2, 1783-0 to 2, 1784-0 to 2, 1785-0 to 2, 1786-0 to 2, 1787-0 to 2, 1788-0 to 2, 1789-0 to 2, 1790-0 to 2, 1791-0 to 2, 1792-0 to 2, 1793-0 to 2, 1794-0 to 2, 1795-0 to 2, 1796-0 to 2, 1797-0 to 2, 1798-0 to 2
[Gamma adjustment] 580, 1000, 1001, 1002, 1003, 1642, 1643
[Gamma balance] 590-0 to 2, 591-0 to 2, 592-0 to 2,596-0 to 2, 597-0 to 2, 598-0 to 2,599-0 to 2, 880-0 to 2, 881-0 to 2,882-0 to 2, 883-0 to 2
[Highlight pen] 1769, 1770, 1771, 1772
[Reproduction level adjustment] 1725
[Maximum text density] 1630, 1631, 1632, 1633
[Background/Black density] 1075, 1076, 1077
[Background processing] 600, 601, 602, 848, 853, 858, 1070, 1071, 1072, 1688, 1689, 1690, 1691, 1692, 1693, 1694, 1695, 1696, 1697, 1698, 1699, 1700, 1701, 1702, 1708, 1709, 1710, 1711, 1712
[Sharpness] 604, 605, 606, 667-0 to 4, 840, 841, 842, 843,
1086, 1087, 1088, 1737, 1738, 1739, 1740, 1741, 1757
[ACS] 609-0 to 4
[Image quality] 586, 589
[Gamma correction] 597
[Error diffusion / Dither] 502
[Automatic calibration] 595
[Default setting] 550
[Smoothing] 561, 562
Classification Adjustment Mode (05) Setting Mode (08)
09/02
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 241
2
Image [Smudged/faint text] 648, 654, 655
[Black reproduction switching] 1761
[Toner saving] 664, 665, 1055, 1056, 1057, 1058
[Toner amount] 1046-0 to 1, 1047-0 to 1, 1048-0 to 1, 1049-0 to 1, 1050-0 to 1, 1612, 1613, 1614, 1615, 1616
[Reproduction ratio] 884, 1060
[Margin] 430, 431, 432, 433, 434-0 to 1, 435, 436, 437, 438, 439
[Range correction] 532, 533, 534, 570, 571, 572, 693, 694, 695, 825, 826, 827, 828, 830, 831, 832, 833, 835, 836, 837, 838
Image control [Temperature/Humidity] 393
[Color/Black developer] 338, 339, 372, 373, 386-0 to 3
[Contrast voltage] 330-0 to 3, 332-0 to 3, 380-0 to 3,381-0 to 3, 1800-0 to 3, 1801-0 to 3,1811-0 to 3, 1812-0 to 3, 1815-0 to 3
[Performing] 394, 395, 396, 398-0 to 3
[Sensor] 388, 389, 391-0 to 3, 390-0 to 3, 392
[Main charger] 334, 335, 385-0 to 3, 1805-0 to 3,1806-0 to 3, 1807-0 to 3, 1808-0 to 3, 1809-0 to 3, 1810-0 to 3
[Background voltage] 1804-0 to 3, 1813-0 to 3, 1814-0 to 3
[Laser power] 331-0 to 3, 333-0 to 3, 382-0 to 3,383-0 to 3, 384-0 to 3, 1802-0 to 3,1803-0 to 3, 1816-0 to 3, 1817, 1819, 1820, 1821
[2nd transfer] 544, 545, 546, 548
[Abnormality detection] 573, 574, 575, 576
[Contrast voltage] 554, 556, 558
[Automatic starting] 559, 565, 566, 567, 568, 569, 570, 571, 572
[Smoothing] 560
[Setting] 549, 551
[Drum] 552, 553
[Laser power] 555, 557
Drive system [Exit motor] 424, 425
[Transport motor] 426, 427
[Main motor] 421, 422
Classification Adjustment Mode (05) Setting Mode (08)
09/02
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 242
Feedingsystem
[Aligning amount] 448-0 to 3, 449-0 to 3, 450-0 to 3,452-0 to 3, 455-0 to 2, 457, 458-0 to 2, 460-0 to 2, 461-0 to 2, 462-0 to 3,463-0 to 2, 469-0 to 3, 470-0 to 3,471-0 to 3, 472-0 to 3, 473, 474-0 to 2, 475-0 to 9
[Paper pushing amount] 466-0 to 7, 467
[Feeding setting] 254, 255, 619
[Paper source] 480, 481, 1135, 1431, 4016-0 to 1
[detection] 449, 1492, 4621, 4622
[Setting] 988
[Coated paper Mode] 675-0 to 4, 676, 677-0 to 5
[Paper size] 224, 225, 226, 227, 228, 256, 8548
[Paper type] 697
[Paper dimension] 210, 229, 230, 231, 232, 233, 234, 235, 236, 237, 238, 239, 240, 241, 242, 243, 244, 245, 246, 247, 248, 249, 470, 471
[Paper retry] 463-0 to 1, 464-0 to 1, 465-0 to 1,466-0 to 1, 467-0 to 1, 468-0 to 1, 482, 1390, 1391, 1392, 1393, 1394, 1395, 1396, 1397, 1398, 1399, 1400, 1401
Laser [Write start] 410, 411, 440, 441, 442, 443, 444, 445, 494, 495, 496, 498-0 to 1
[Polygonal motor] 401, 405
[Sideways deviation] 497-0 to 5
[Polygonal motor] 398, 399, 478, 479, 483, 484, 485, 486, 488, 489, 490
Main charger [Grid] 241, 242, 243, 244
[Cleaning] 511, 1389
Developer [Auto-toner] 200, 201, 202, 203, 204, 205, 206
[Color auto-toner] 207, 208
[Timing adjustment] 499
[Color auto-toner] 819-0 to 2, 820-0 to 2, 823-0 to 2, 824-0 to 2, 858-0 to 2, 859-0 to 2, 860-0 to 1, 861-0 to 1, 862-0 to 1, 863-0 to 1, 864, 865, 866-0 to 1, 867, 868, 869, 870, 871, 872, 873-0 to 2, 874, 875-0 to 2, 876-0 to 2, 877-0 to 2,878-0 to 2, 879-0 to 2, 880-0 to 2,881-0 to 2, 1414, 1800-0 to 2, 1801
[K auto-toner]2401-0 to 4, 2402-0 to 4, 2403-0 to 4, 2404-0 to 4, 2405-0 to 4, 2406-0 to 4, 2461-0 to 20
[Stabilization] 821, 822-0 to 2, 1802-0 to 2
[Toner nearly empty] 1415, 1416
Classification Adjustment Mode (05) Setting Mode (08)
10/06
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 243
2
Transfer [1st transfer]210, 245, 250, 251, 281, 1829-0 to 2, 1831, 1832, 1833, 1836, 1847, 1848, 1849, 1850-0 to 3, 1861, 1862-0 to 3, 1863, 1864
[2nd transfer]224, 225, 226, 227-0 to 3, 229-0 to 3,230-0 to 1, 231-0 to 1, 232-0 to 1,234-0 to 3, 236-0 to 3, 237-0 to 1,238-0 to 1, 239-0 to 1, 252, 253, 254, 255, 275, 276, 277-0 to 3, 279-0 to 3, 290-0 to 1, 291-0 to 1, 292-0 to 1, 293-0 to 4, 294-0 to 3, 296-0 to 3, 297-0 to 1, 298-0 to 1, 299-0 to 1, 1822-0 to 4, 1823-0 to 3, 1825-0 to 3, 1826-0 to 1, 1827-0 to 1, 1828-0 to 1, 1839-0 to 1, 1840-0 to 1, 1841-0 to 1, 1842-0 to 3, 1845-0 to 1
[Cleaning] 284, 285
[Temperature/humidity] 247, 248, 270
[1st transfer] 816
[2nd transfer] 487, 817
[Temperature correction] 818
Fuser [Temperature]409, 411, 410-0 to 1, 412-0 to 1,413-0 to 1, 416, 422, 436, 437-0 to 1,438-0 to 1, 458, 460
[Time] 415-0 to 1, 428-0 to 1, 459
[Status counter] 400
[TWD and SAD models] 849
[Transport speed] 430, 431, 432
[Pre-running]417-0 to 1, 439-0 to 1, 440-0 to 1,441-0 to 1, 461, 526-0 to 1, 583-0 to 2, 584
Imageprocessing
[Counter]1370, 1371, 1372, 1378, 1380, 1382, 1385, 1386, 1387, 1388
RADF [Aligning amount]354, 355
[Transporting]357, 358, 365, 366
[Volume]367, 368
[Switchback]462
Finisher [Binding/Folding position]468-0 to 2
[Stapling]704-0 to 1, 1911
[Finisher model switching]1912
[Hole punching]9847
Classification Adjustment Mode (05) Setting Mode (08)
07/11
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 244
Network [AppleTalk]1014, 1015, 1936, 3729, 3730
[Bindery] 1026
[Community] 1065, 1066
[DDNS] 1020, 1112, 3737, 3745, 3746, 3747, 3748
[DHCP] 1755, 1756, 1757, 1762, 3772, 3773, 3774, 3778, 3779, 3780
[Directory] 1028, 1029
[DNS] 1017, 1018, 1019, 3736, 3781, 3782, 3784
[DPWS]3749, 3750, 3751, 3752, 3753, 3754, 3755, 3757, 3758, 3759, 3760, 3765, 3766, 3785, 3796
[E-mail] 265, 1097, 1098, 1477, 1478, 1489, 1491, 3837, 9946, 9947, 9980
[File] 1779, 1782, 1783, 1784, 1785, 1786, 9394
[FTP] 1055, 1059, 1060, 1089, 1090, 1091, 1092, 3739
[HTTP] 1030, 1031, 1032, 3738
[IP Conflict] 1440
[IP Filter] 1720, 1721, 1722, 1723, 1724, 1725, 1726, 1727, 1728, 1729, 1730, 1731, 1732, 1733, 1734, 1735, 1736, 1737, 1738, 1739
[IPP] 1078, 1079, 1080, 1081, 1082, 1083, 1084, 1085, 1086, 1087, 1088, 1447, 1448, 1449, 1450, 1451, 3725, 3726
[IPv6] 3767, 3768, 3770, 3775, 3776, 3770
[IPX] 1011, 1099
[IP address] 1006, 1007, 1008, 1009, 1010, 1767, 1768, 3769
[LDAP]1016, 1138, 1923, 1924, 1927, 3743, 9629, 9933
[LPD] 1075, 1076, 1077, 3727, 3728
[MAC address] 1141
[MIB] 1063
[NDS] 1027
[Netware] 1128, 1129, 1134, 1143, 1144, 1148
[Network logs]8535, 8536
Classification Adjustment Mode (05) Setting Mode (08)
10/06
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 245
2
Network [NIC] 1002
[Novell] 1093, 1094
[PCL setting] 973
[POP3] 1046, 1047, 1048, 1049, 1050, 1051, 1052, 3742, 3744
[RawPort] 945
[Raw/TCP] 1073, 1074, 3731, 3732
[Raw printing] 290, 291, 292, 293, 294, 295, 296, 297, 298, 299, 978, 979, 9117
[Rendezvous] 1103, 1104, 1105
[Role Base Access] 1493, 1928, 3831
[Samba] 1464, 3783, 3833
[SearchRoot] 1095
[SMB] 1023, 1024, 1025, 1117, 1124, 1950, 1951
[SMTP] 1022, 1037, 1038, 1039, 1040, 1041, 1042, 1100, 1101, 1102, 1111, 3741
[SNTP] 1441, 1442, 1444, 1445, 1446, 3740, 3845
[SSL] 1740, 1741, 1742, 1743, 1744, 1745, 1746, 1747, 1748, 1749, 1750, 1751, 9819, 9822
[TRAP] 1069, 1070
[InternetFAX] 266, 1114, 1485, 3812, 3819, 3820, 3821, 3822, 3823, 3824, 3825, 3826, 3827, 3828, 3829, 3830
[Offramp] 1043, 1044, 1045
[Function] 1432, 1435, 1436
[Automatic transferring] 660, 661
[Initialization] 1119
[Scan job] 1781-0 to 1, 1915, 1940, 3804, 3815, 3816, 3817, 3818, 8517
[Direct SMTP] 3810, 3811
[Speed and settings] 1003
[Data retention period] 259, 260, 264
[Domain] 1113, 1121, 1122, 1123
[Authentication] 1139, 1484, 1487, 1920, 1921, 1922, 1925, 1937, 1952, 1953, 1954, 1955, 1956, 1957, 1958, 1959, 3722, 3723, 3724, 8823
Classification Adjustment Mode (05) Setting Mode (08)
10/06
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 246
Network [Print queue] 1096
[Frame type] 1012
[Prefix] 3771
[Temporary communication password]9798
[Local I/F] 614
[LLTD] 3793
[LLMNR] 3794
[Telnet] 3864, 3865, 3866, 3867, 3868
Wireless LAN [Supplicant] 1679, 1681, 1682, 1684, 1685, 1686, 1689, 1690, 1691, 1692, 1693, 1696, 1697, 1699, 1700, 1701, 1704, 1705, 1706, 1707, 1764, 1765, 1766
[Driver] 1661, 1662, 1663, 1664, 1665, 1666, 1667, 1668, 1669, 1670, 1671, 1672, 1673, 1674, 1675, 1676, 1677, 1678
Bluetooth [Data encryption]1715
[Setting] 1710, 1711, 1712, 1713, 1714
[BIP] 1719, 1941
Classification Adjustment Mode (05) Setting Mode (08)
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 247
2
Counter [HDD]390, 391, 392, 393
[External counter] 381, 1126, 8549
[Counter copy] 257
[Count method] 616, 663
[Paper source] 356, 357, 358, 359, 360, 370, 372, 374
[Black toner cartridge drive] 1410
[Paper size] 301-0 to 16, 303-0 to 16, 304-0 to 16,305-0 to 16, 306-0 to 16, 307-0 to 16,308-0 to 16, 309-0 to 16, 310-0 to 16,311-0 to 16, 312-0 to 16, 313-0 to 16,314-0 to 16, 315-0 to 16, 316-0 to 16
[Tab paper] 1412
[Double count] 344, 346, 347, 348, 349, 352, 353
[Large/Small size] 317-0 to 2, 318-0 to 2, 319-0 to 2,320-0 to 2, 321-0 to 2, 322-0 to 2,323-0 to 2, 324-0 to 2, 325-0 to 2,326-0 to 2, 327-0 to 2, 328-0 to 2,329-0 to 2, 330-0 to 2, 332-0 to 2,333-0 to 2, 334-0 to 2, 335-0 to 2
[n-UP printing] 1530-0 to 7, 1531-0 to 7, 1532-0 to 7,1533-0 to 7, 1534-0 to 7, 1535-0 to 7,6810-0 to 7, 6811-0 to 7, 6812-0 to 7,6813-0 to 7, 6814-0 to 7,6815-0 to 7
Version [FAX]915
[HDD] 944
[Engine] 903, 905, 907
[System] 900, 920, 921, 922, 923, 924, 925, 926, 927, 928, 929, 930, 931, 933, 934, 935, 936, 937, 938, 939
[Finisher] 908, 911
Classification Adjustment Mode (05) Setting Mode (08)
10/06
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 248
Maintenance [Equipment number] 976
[Machine information]9960
[FSMS] 258, 999
[HTTP] 726, 727, 728, 729, 730, 731
[PM counter] 223, 251, 252, 375, 376
[Error history] 253
[Equipment number] 995
[Emergency Mode] 710, 711
[Service notification] 702, 703, 707, 715, 716, 717, 718, 719, 720, 721, 723, 767, 768, 769, 770, 771, 772, 773, 774, 775, 776, 777, 778, 780, 781, 782, 783, 784, 785, 786, 787, 788, 789, 790, 791, 792, 793, 794, 795, 796, 1145, 1495, 9739, 9880, 9881
[Supply order] 732, 733, 734, 738, 739, 740, 741, 742, 743, 744, 745, 746, 747, 748, 749, 750, 751, 752, 753, 754, 755, 756, 757, 758, 759, 760, 761, 762, 763, 765
[Downloading] 797
[Telephone] 250
[Panel calibration] 692
Scramblerboard
[HDD]699
[Key code] 698
[Installation] 696
Electronic Filing
[Setting]267, 270, 950, 976, 1497
Data overwrite kit
[HDD]1422, 1424, 1426
[NVRAM] 1427
[SRAM] 1428
[Releasing F200] 633
Classification Adjustment Mode (05) Setting Mode (08)
10/06
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 249
2
General [HDD]271, 670, 690, 691, 693, 694
[SYS ROM] 1938
[TAT partition] 1118
[Address book] 1125
[Data encryption]3834
[Proof copy]3635
[Card authentification]1776, 1777, 1927
[Card reader]1772, 1773, 1774, 1775
[Administrator’s password] 1778
[Clearing] 665, 669
[Summer time] 3852, 3853, 3854, 3855, 3856, 3857, 3858, 3859, 3860, 3861, 3862, 3863
[Destination] 201
[Initialization] 947
[Setting] 949, 975, 986, 1132, 1470, 1471, 1494
[Speed switching] 497
[Data cloning]9889
[Databases] 684, 685, 686
[Partition] 662, 666, 667
[Banner] 678, 679, 680
[Date/Time] 200, 638
[File] 288
[Department management] 672
[BANNER MESSAGE button] 681
[Memory] 615
[Enhanced bold] 1149
[User data management] 1468, 1469, 1472, 1473, 1474, 1481, 1482, 1483, 1496
[Line] 203
[Duplex printing] 683
[File/Email] 1913, 1916
[Extension fields] 1914
Classification Adjustment Mode (05) Setting Mode (08)
10/06
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedERROR CODE AND SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
2 - 250
General [KS/KSSM setting] 1961
[KS] 1960, 1963, 1964, 1965, 1966, 1967, 1968, 1970, 1971, 1972, 1973, 1974, 1975, 1976, 1977, 1978, 1979, 1980
[KSSM] 1984, 1985, 1986, 1987, 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994
[Remote scanning] 3850, 9828
[Filing box] 9882
[FROM] 9885
[Easy setup]9047
[Electronic license key] 3840, 3841, 3842
Classification Adjustment Mode (05) Setting Mode (08)
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cADJUSTMENT
3 - 1
3
3. ADJUSTMENT
3.1 Adjustment Order (Image Related Adjustment)This chapter mainly explains the procedures for image related adjustment. When replacing compo-nents which have other specified instructions for adjustment, those specified instructions are to be obeyed in priority.In the following diagram, the solid lines with arrow lead to essential adjustments, while the dotted lines lead to adjustments to be performed if necessary.
Fig. 3-1
396
Item to be adjusted
3.3 Adjustment of image quality control /
Automatic initialization of image quality control
Code in mode 05
Item to be adjusted Code in mode 05
3.2 Adjustment of the auto-toner sensor 200, 201, 202, 203, 204, 206
Developer material
Image quality sensor
2nd transfer roller
1st transfer roller
Transfer belt
Main charger grid
Main charger wire
Drum
Drum cleaner brush
Drum cleaning blade
Laser optical unit
3.4 Image dimensional adjustment
Items Code in mode 05
448, 449, 450, 452,
455, 457, 458, 459,
460, 461, 462, 463
3.4.2 Paper alignment at the registration roller
Order
2
3
4
5
1
6
9
10
11
12
3.4.4
Scanner
related
adjustment
13
14
15
16
7
8
(a) Image distortion
(b) Reproduction ratio of primary scanning direction
(c) Image location of primary scanning direction
(d) Reproduction ratio of secondary scanning direction
(e) Image location of secondary scanning direction
(f) Top margin
(g)Right margin
(h) Bottom margin
(b) Primary scanning data laser writing start position
(c) Reproduction ratio of secondary scanning direction
(a) Reproduction ratio of primary scanning direction
(d) Transfer belt cleaning unit contact timing adjustment
(e) Transfer belt cleaning unit release timing adjustment
(f) Secondary scanning data laser writing start position
(g) Primary scanning data laser writing start position at
duplexing
3.4.3
Printer
related
adjustment
–
405
306
340
305
430
432
433
498
441, 440, 444
443, 442, 445
401
411
421
284
285
Adjust the image quality if necessary. ( Chapter 3.5, 3.6, 3.7)
END
Code in mode 05
1642, (1643, 580)
1000, 1001, 1002, 1003
Item to be adjusted
3.5.1 Automatic gamma adjustment (PPC)
3.6.1 Automatic gamma adjustment (PRT)
Parts to be replaced
Code in mode 05Item to be adjusted
3.5.2 Color deviation adjustment (PPC)
3.6.1 Color deviation adjustment (PRT)417, 418 (A3/LD)
953, 954, 955, 956 (A4/LT)
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedADJUSTMENT
3 - 2
3.2 Adjustment of the Auto-Toner SensorWhen the developer material is replaced, adjust the auto-toner sensor in the following procedure.
(1) Install the cleaner and developer unit.
Note: Note: Do not install the toner cartridge.
(2) While pressing [0] and [5] simultaneously, turn the power ON. The following message will be dis-played.
(3) Key in a code and press the [START] button.
(4) Adjustment for “K” (Magnetometric sensor control)• The following message will be displayed approx. 2 minutes later.
Code 200: All developer materials 201: Developer material Y 202: Developer material M203: Developer material C 204: Developer material K 206: Developer material Y, M, C
100% A A3
TEST MODE
[0] [5]
[POWER]
100% 200 A3
TEST MODE(Code) [START]
K: xxxV
K: zzzV
(B)
(C)
(A)
(B): Current sensor voltage (V)
(C): No display
(A): Target values (V) for adjustment reference
voltage
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cADJUSTMENT
3 - 3
3
Note: Note: The current sensor voltage (V) shown in (B) automatically changes, gradually approaching the target value for adjustment reference voltage shown in (A).
• In 30 to 60 seconds, the current sensor voltage (V) in (B) is converged. Then the sensor out-put control value (bit value) corresponding to the initial developer material is displayed in (C).
Note: Note: Be careful that the values in (A), (B) and (C) vary with humidity.
• In case of single-color adjustment, press the [ENTER] button to store the adjustment results in memory when the control value is displayed. In case of multiple-color adjustment, it is auto-matically proceeded to the adjustment of next color.
(5) Adjustments for “Y”, “M” and “C” (light sensor control)• In 15 to 45 seconds, the following message will be displayed (The time varies with the num-
ber of colors to be adjusted).
(B): Current sensor voltage (V)
(C): Sensor output control value (bit value)
(A): Target value (V) for adjustment reference voltage
K: xxxV
K: yyy
K: zzzV
(B)
(C)
(A)
(B)
(C)
(A)
(B): Current sensor voltage (V)
(C): No display
(A): Target value (V) for adjustment reference voltage
Y:
Y:
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedADJUSTMENT
3 - 4
Note: Note: The current sensor voltage (V) shown in (B) automatically changes, gradually approaching the target value for adjustment reference voltage shown in (A).
• After approx. 5 seconds have passed, the current sensor voltage (V) in (B) is converged. Then the sensor output control value (bit value) corresponding to the initial developer material is displayed in (C).
• In case of single-color adjustment, press the [ENTER] button to store the adjustment results in memory when the control value is displayed. In case of multiple-color adjustment, it is auto-matically proceeded to the adjustment of next color. When the adjustments of all colors have finished and [ENTER] is lit, press [ENTER] button to store the adjustment results in memory.
(6) Standard of adjustment value range(A): Adjustment reference voltages (V)
Note: Note: Since the adjustments for “Y”, “M” and “C” are controlled by the light sensor, the humidity correc-tion is not performed.
(B): Current sensor voltages (V)
Note: Note: Since the adjustments for “Y”, “M” and “C” are controlled by the light sensor, the humidity correc-tion is not performed.
(7) Turn the power OFF.
(8) Install the toner cartridges.
Humidity(%) K Y M C
29.9 or below 2.47 1.25 1.25 1.25
30.0-44.9 2.49
45.0-59.9 2.50
60.0-74.9 2.69
75.0 or above 2.86
Humidity(%) K Y M C
29.9 or below 2.37-2.57 1.15-1.35 1.15-1.35 1.15-1.35
30.0-44.9 2.39-2.59
45.0-59.9 2.40-2.60
60.0-74.9 2.59-2.79
75.0 or above 2.76-2.96
(B)
(C)
(A)
(B): Current sensor voltage (V)
(C): Sensor output control value (bit value)
(A): Target value (V) for adjustment reference voltage
Y: xxxV
Y: yyy
Y: zzzV
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cADJUSTMENT
3 - 5
3
3.3 Performing Image Quality Control
(1) When unpackingPrior to image dimensional adjustment, perform the “Automatic initialization of image quality con-trol (05-396)” procedure.
(2) When any of the following parts is replaced, be sure to perform the “Automatic initialization of image quality control (05-396)” procedure.• Photoconductive drum • Developer material • Laser optical unit• Image quality sensor • Transfer belt • 1st transfer roller• 2nd transfer roller • Main charger • Main charger grid• Drum cleaning blade • Drum cleaner brush
Note: Note: When performing "Automatic gamma adjustment" in addition, “Automatic initialization of image quality control (05-396)” should be done first.
(3) When performing "Automatic gamma adjustment" in cases no parts written above are replaced, do the “Forced performing of image quality closed-loop control (05-395)” procedure before "Auto-matic gamma adjustment".
Code Item to be adjusted Contents
395 Forced performing of image quality closed-loop control
<Procedure>1) While pressing [0] and [5] simultaneously, turn the power ON.
→ Adjustment Mode2) Key in [395] and press the [START] button.3) "WAIT" is displayed.4) When the adjustment finishes normally, the equipment returns to the
initial state of Adjustment Mode. If an error has occurred, take appro-priate action by referring to “5. TROUBLESHOOTING”.
396 Automatic initialization of image quality control
<Procedure>1) While pressing [0] and [5] simultaneously, turn the power ON.
→ Adjustment Mode2) Key in [396] and press the [START] button.3) "WAIT" is displayed.4) When the adjustment finishes normally, the equipment will return to
initial state of the Adjustment Mode. If an error has occurred, take appropriate action by referring to “5. TROUBLESHOOTING”.
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedADJUSTMENT
3 - 6
3.4 Image Dimensional Adjustment
3.4.1 General descriptionThere are several adjustment items in the image dimensional adjustment, as listed below. Prior to this image dimensional adjustment, perform the "Automatic initialization of image quality control (05-396)".When adjusting these items, the following adjustment order should strictly be observed.
Item to be adjusted Code in mode 05
1) Paper alignment at the registration roller 448, 449, 450, 452, 455, 457, 458, 459, 460, 461, 462, 463
Printer related adjustment
Reproduction ratio of primary scanning direction (Fine adjustment of polygonal motor rotation speed)
401
Primary scanning data laser writing start position 411
Reproduction ratio of secondary scanning direction (Fine adjustment of main motor rotation speed)
421
Transfer belt cleaning unit contact timing adjustment 284
Transfer belt cleaning unit release timing adjustment 285
Secondary scanning data laser writing start position 441, 440, 444, 443, 442, 445
Primary scanning data laser writing start position at duplexing 498
Scanner related adjustment
Image distortion -
Reproduction ratio of primary scanning direction 405
Image location of primary scanning direction 306
Reproduction ratio of secondary scanning direction 340
Image location of secondary scanning direction 305
Top margin 430
Right margin 432
Bottom margin 433
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cADJUSTMENT
3 - 7
3
[Procedure to key in adjustment values]In accordance with the procedure described below, make adjustment of each adjustment item so that the measured values obtained from test copies satisfy the specification. By pressing the [FAX] button, immediately after starting the Adjustment Mode (05), single-sided test copying can be performed (nor-mal copy mode).
Fig. 3-2
1
0 5
POWER
ENTER
INTERRUPT
Digital keys
START
: Key in codes.
<Operation keys> <Display>
Current adjustment value
Adjustment value newly keyed in.
(If no entering, YYY is displayed.)
Power OFF/ON : Exit the Adjustment Mode.
Test copy
Digital keys
FAX
START
: Key in adjustment
values.
Value ZZZ is stored
replacing values YYY.
If the test copy does not
satisfy the specified values,
return to step 1 and
repeat the adjustment
procedure.
or
( CLEAR Use to make corrections)
100% A A3
TEST MODE
100% A
TEST MODE
100% A
Wait Warming Up
100% A
COPYING
Code No.
100%
YYY ZZZ
XXX A3
A3
A3
A3
TEST MODE
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedADJUSTMENT
3 - 8
3.4.2 Paper alignment at the registration rollerThe aligning amount is adjusted by using the following codes in Adjustment Mode (05).
Sub-code
Notes: 1. Long size: 330 mm or longer (13.0 inches or longer)
Middle size: 220-329 mm (8.7-12.9 inches) Short size: 219 mm or shorter (8.6 inches or shorter) Short size 1: 205-219 mm (8.1-8.6 inches or shorter) Short size 2: 204 mm or shorter (8.0 inches or shorter)
2. The adjustment of “Post card” is for Japan only.
<Procedure>
Note: Note: If the aligning amount is too large, abnormal noise (paper-folding noise) or actual paper folding may occur during paper feeding. If the aligning amount is too small, on the other hand, a skew, an image dislocation in feeding direction or a paper exit jam (E010) may occur. Pay attention to the above and select the appropriate value.
Paper type WeightUpper drawer
Lower drawer
PFP upper drawer
PFP lower
drawerLCF ADU
Bypass feed
Black Color
Plain paper 64-80 g/m2
17-20 lb.450 (*4) 452 (*4) 448 (*4) 449 (*4) 457 455 (*1) 458 (*1)
Thick paper 1
81-105 g/m2
21-28 lb.469 (*4) 470 (*4) 471 (*4) 472 (*4) 473 474 (*1) 460 (*1)
Thick paper 2
106-163 g/m2
29-43 lb.- - - - - - 461
(*1)475 (*3)
Thick paper 3
164-209 g/m2
44-55 lb.- - - - - - 462
(*2)475 (*3)
OHP film - - - - - - - 463 (*1)
475 (*3)
(*1) 0: Long size 1: Middle size 2: Short size(*2) 0: Long size 1: Middle size 2: Short size 3: Post card(*3) 0: Long size of thick paper 2 1: Middle size of thick paper 2
2: Short size of thick paper 2 3: Long size of thick paper 34: Middle size of thick paper 3 5: Short size of thick paper 36: Long size of OHP film 7: Middle size of OHP film8: Short size of OHP film 9: Post card
(*4) 0: Long size 1: Middle size 2: Short size 1 3: Short size 2
(*5) 1:3:55:56:57:58:59:60:
Single-sided grid pattern in Black ModeDouble-sided grid pattern in Black ModeGrid pattern of thick paper 2 in Full Color ModeGrid pattern of thick paper 3 in Full Color ModeGrid pattern of OHP film in Full Color ModeSingle-sided grid pattern of thick paper 2 in Black ModeSingle-sided grid pattern of thick paper 3 in Black ModeSingle-sided grid pattern of OHP film in Black Mode
(Code) [START] (Sub-code) [START][0][5]
[Power]
Current value
displayed
Enter new
value
[POWER]
OFF/ON(Exit)
[Drawer
selection](*5) +[FAX]
(Test print)
[SET] or[INTERRUPT]
Stores in memory
(Not necessary for LCF)
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cADJUSTMENT
3 - 9
3
3.4.3 Printer related adjustmentThe printer related adjustment is performed by using the printed out grid pattern.
Fig. 3-3
AdjustmentTolerance
Detail of adjustment
A 200 ± 0.5mm Refer to “[A] Reproduction ratio of primary scanning direction (Fine adjustment of polygonal motor rotation speed (Printer))”
B 52 ± 0.5mm Refer to “[B] Primary scanning data laser writing start position (Printer)”C 200 ± 0.5mm Refer to “[C] Reproduction ratio of secondary scanning direction (Fine adjustment
of main motor rotation speed (Printer))”D 52 ± 0.5mm Refer to “[F] Secondary scanning data laser writing start position”E 52 ± 0.5mm Refer to “[G] Primary scanning data laser writing start position at duplexing”
A21
6
1
B, ED
C
6
22
2
Feedin
g d
irection
05/11
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedADJUSTMENT
3 - 10
[A] Reproduction ratio of primary scanning direction (Fine adjustment of polygonal motor rotation speed (Printer))
(1) While pressing [0] and [5] simultaneously, turn the power ON.→ (Adjustment Mode)(2) Press [1] → [FAX]. (A grid pattern with 10 mm squares is printed out. Use A3/LD from the lower
drawer.)(3) Measure the distance A from the 1st line to the 21st line of the grid pattern.(4) Check if the distance A is within 200±0.5 mm.(5) If not, use the following procedure to change values and measure the distance A again.
<Procedure> (Adjustment Mode) → (Key in the code [401]) → [START]→ (Key in a value (acceptable values: 0 to 255))→ [ENTER] or [INTERRUPT] (Stored in memory)→ "100% A" is displayed.→ Press [1] → [FAX] → (A grid pattern is printed out.)* The larger the adjustment value is, the longer the distance A becomes (approx. 0.1 mm/step).
[B] Primary scanning data laser writing start position (Printer)
(1) While pressing [0] and [5] simultaneously, turn the power ON. → (Adjustment Mode)(2) Press [1] → [FAX]. (A grid pattern with 10 mm squares is printed out. Use A3/LD from the lower
drawer.)(3) Measure the distance B from the left edge of the paper to the 6th line of the grid pattern.(4) Check if the distance B is within 52±0.5 mm.(5) If not, use the following procedure to change values and measure the distance B again.
<Procedure>(Adjustment Mode) → (Key in the code [411]) → [START]→ (Key in a value (acceptable values: 0 to 255))→ [ENTER] or [INTERRUPT] (Stored in memory)→ "100% A" is displayed→ Press [1] → [FAX] → (A grid pattern is printed out.))* The larger the adjustment value is, the longer the distance B becomes (approx. 0.04 mm/
step).
[C] Reproduction ratio of secondary scanning direction (Fine adjustment of main motor rotation speed (Printer))
(1) While pressing [0] and [5] simultaneously, turn the power ON. → (Adjustment Mode)(2) Press [1] → [FAX]. (A grid pattern with 10 mm squares is printed out. Use A3/LD from the lower
drawer.)(3) Measure the distance C from the 2nd line at the leading edge of the paper to the 22nd line of the
grid pattern.* Normally, the 1st line of the grid pattern is not printed.
(4) Check if the distance C is within 200±0.5 mm.(5) If not, use the following procedure to change values and measure the distance C again.
<Procedure>(Adjustment Mode) → (Key in the code [426]) → [START]* Confirm that the input value is [153]. If not, key in [153].→ (Key in [153])→ [ENTER] or [INTERRUPT] (Stored in memory)→ (Key in the code [421]) → [START]→ (Key in a value (recommended values: 110 to 140 / acceptable values: 0 to 255))→ [ENTER] or [INTERRUPT] (Stored in memory)
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cADJUSTMENT
3 - 11
3
* When the value is not within the recommended values, the trailing edge area of the image may be out of position for the paper length or the density at the trailing edge area of the image may become lower. Perform the adjustment confirming the image.
→ “100% A” is displayed→ Press [1] → [FAX] → (A grid pattern is printed out.)* The larger the adjustment value is, the longer the distance C becomes (approx. 0.5 mm/6
steps).
[D] Transfer belt cleaning unit contact timing adjustment
(1) While pressing [0] and [5] simultaneously, turn the power ON. → (Adjustment Mode)(2) According to the input value for “Adjustment of secondary scanning direction reproduction ratio
(421)”, key in the value shown in the following table.* Be sure to key in the correct value because incorrect value may reduce the cleaning effi-
ciency of the transfer belt.
<Procedure> (Adjustment Mode) → (Key in the code [284]) → [START]→ (Key in a value)→ [ENTER] or [INTERRUPT] (Stored in memory)
[E] Transfer belt cleaning unit release timing adjustment
This adjustment has to be performed after “Adjustment of secondary scanning direction reproduction ratio (421)” Acceptable values are 88 to 168. The larger the value is, the later the transfer belt cleaning unit release timing becomes.
(1) While pressing [0] and [5] simultaneously, turn the power ON. → (Adjustment Mode)(2) According to the input value for “Adjustment of secondary scanning direction reproduction ratio
(421)”, key in the value shown in the following table.* Be sure to key in the correct value because incorrect value may reduce the cleaning effi-
ciency of the transfer belt.
<Procedure> (Adjustment Mode) → (Key in the code [285]) → [START]→ (Key in a value)→ [ENTER] or [INTERRUPT] (Stored in memory)
Adjustment (code) Input value
Adjustment of secondary scanning direction reproduction ratio (421) 110 111-120 121-130 131-140
Transfer belt cleaning unit contact timing adjustment (284)
147 143 141 137
Adjustment (code) Input value
Adjustment of secondary scanning directionreproduction ratio (421)
110 111-120 121-130 131-140
Transfer belt cleaning unit release timingadjustment (285) 147 143 141 137
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedADJUSTMENT
3 - 12
[F] Secondary scanning data laser writing start position
This adjustment has to be performed for each paper source.The following table shows the order of the paper source to be adjusted, code, paper size and accept-able values.
(1) While pressing [0] and [5] simultaneously, turn the power ON. → (Adjustment Mode)(2) Press [1] ([3] for duplexing) → [FAX]. (A grid pattern with 10 mm squares is printed out.)(3) Measure the distance D from the leading edge of the paper to the 6th line of the grid pattern.
* Normally, the 1st line of the grid pattern is not printed.* At the duplexing, measure it on the top side of the grid pattern.
(4) Check if the distance D is within 52±0.5 mm.(5) If not, use the following procedure to change values and measure the distance D again.
<Procedure> (Adjustment Mode) → (Key in the code shown above) → [START]→ (Key in an acceptable value shown above)→ [ENTER] or [INTERRUPT] (Stored in memory)→ "100% A" is displayed→ Press [1] ([3] for duplexing)→ [FAX] → (A grid pattern is printed out.)* The larger the adjustment value is, the longer the distance D becomes (approx. 0.2 mm/step).
[G] Primary scanning data laser writing start position at duplexing
Note: Note: Make sure the first line of the grid pattern is printed out since the line is occasionally vanished.
[G-1] Adjustment for long-sized paper
(1) While pressing [0] and [5] simultaneously, turn the power ON. → (Adjustment Mode)(2) Press [3] → [FAX]. (A grid pattern with 10 mm squares is printed out. Use A3/LD from the lower
drawer.)(3) Check the grid pattern on the test print and measure the distance E from the left edge of the
paper to the 6th line of the grid pattern.(4) Check if the distance E is within 52±0.5 mm.(5) If not, use the following procedure to change values and measure the distance E again.
<Procedure> (Adjustment Mode) → (Key in the code [498]) → [START] → [0] → [START]→ (Key in a value (acceptable values: 0 to 255))→ [ENTER] or [INTERRUPT] (Stored in memory)→ "100% A" is displayed.→ Press [3] → [FAX] → (A grid pattern is printed out.)* The larger the adjustment value is, the longer the distance E becomes (approx. 0.04 mm/
step).
Order for adjustment
Paper source
Code Paper sizeAcceptable
valueRemarks
1 Lower drawer 441 A3/LD 0 to 80
2 Upper drawer 440 A4/LT 0 to 40
3 PFP or LCF 444/443 A4/LT 0 to 40
4 Bypass feed 442 A4/LT 0 to 40
5 Duplexing 445 A3/LD 0 to 40 Paper fed from the lower drawer
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cADJUSTMENT
3 - 13
3
[G-2] Adjustment for short-sized paper
(1) While pressing [0] and [5] simultaneously, turn the power ON. → (Adjustment Mode)(2) Press [3] → [FAX]. (A grid pattern with 10 mm squares is printed out. Use A4/LT from the upper
drawer.)(3) Check the grid pattern on the test print and measure the distance E from the left edge of the
paper to the 6th line of the grid pattern.(4) Check if the distance E is within 52±0.5 mm.(5) If not, use the following procedure to change values and measure the distance E again.
<Procedure> (Adjustment Mode) → (Key in the code [498]) → [START] → [1] → [START]→ (Key in a value (acceptable values: 0 to 255))→ [ENTER] or [INTERRUPT] (Stored in memory)→ "100% A" is displayed→ Press [3] → [FAX] → (A grid pattern is printed out.)* The larger the adjustment value is, the longer the distance E becomes (approx. 0.04 mm/
step).
<Adjustment procedure summarization for A to E>[0] [5] [Power ON] → [1] ([3](05-445, 498) for duplexing) → [FAX]
A: 05-401 (Lower drawer, A3/LD) → 200±0.5 mm (0.1 mm/step)B: 05-411 (Lower drawer, A3/LD) → 52±0.5 mm (0.04 mm/step)
→ Key in the same value for 05-410.C: 05-421 (Lower drawer, A3/LD) → 200±0.5 mm (0.5 mm/6 steps)D: 05-440 (Upper drawer, A4/LT) → 52±0.5 mm (0.2 mm/step)
441 (Lower drawer, A3/LD),442 (Bypass feed, A4/LT),443 (LCF, A4/LT), 444 (PFP, A4/LT),445 (Duplexing, A3/LD)
E: 05-498-0 (Lower drawer, A3/LD), → 52±0.5 mm (0.04 mm/step)498-1 (Upper drawer, A4/LT)
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedADJUSTMENT
3 - 14
3.4.4 Scanner related adjustment
[A] Image distortion
Fig. 3-4
(1) While pressing [0] and [5] simultaneously, turn the power ON.(2) Press [FAX] to make a copy of any image on a sheet of A3/LD paper.(3) Key in [308] and press the [START] button to move the carriage to the adjustment position.
Feeding direction
Feeding direction
Step 1
A
Step 2
C
B
D
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cADJUSTMENT
3 - 15
3
(5) Apply the screw locking agents to the adjustment screws. (2 areas)• Recommended screw lock agent
Manufacturer: Three BondProduct name: 1401E
The following adjustments (b) to (e) should be performed with Test Chart No. TCC-1. (Refer to page 3-19.)
(4) Make an adjustment in the order of step 1 and 2.Step 1In case of A:Tighten the mirror-3 adjustment screw (CW).In case of B:Loosen the mirror-3 adjustment screw (CCW).
Step 2In case of C:Tighten the mirror-1 adjustment screw (CW).In case of D:Loosen the mirror-1 adjustment screw (CCW).
Fig. 3-5
Fig. 3-6
Carriage-2
Adjustment screw for the mirror-3 (Rear)
Adjustment screwfor the mirror-1 (Rear)
Carriage-1
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedADJUSTMENT
3 - 16
[B] Reproduction ratio adjustment of primary scanning direction
(1) While pressing [0] and [5] simultaneously, turn the power ON. → (Adjustment Mode)(2) Place Test Chart No. TCC-1 on the original glass (with the arrow positioned at the left rear side).(3) Press [FAX] → [START] to make a copy at the mode of A4/LT, 100%, Black and Text/Photo.(4) Measure the distance A between M1 and M2 on the copy with a ruler.(5) Check if the distance A is within 200±0.5 mm.(6) If not, use the following procedure to change values and repeat step 3. to 5. above.
<Procedure> (Adjustment Mode) → (Key in the code [405]) → [START]→ (Key in a value (acceptable values: 0 to 255) with digital keys)→ [ENTER] or [INTERRUPT] (Stored in memory)
* The larger the adjustment value is, the longer the distance A becomes (approx. 0.1 mm/step).
[C] Image location of primary scanning direction
(1) While pressing [0] and [5] simultaneously, turn the power ON. → (Adjustment Mode)(2) Place Test Chart No. TCC-1 on the original glass (with the arrow positioned at the left rear side).(3) Press [FAX] → [START] to make a copy at the mode of A4/LT, 100%, Black and Text/Photo.(4) Measure the distance B from the left paper edge to the 10 mm line of left grid pattern on the copy
with a ruler.(5) Check if the distance B is within 10±0.5 mm.(6) If not, use the following procedure to change values and repeat step 3. to 5. above.
<Procedure> (Adjustment Mode) → (Key in code [306]) → [START]→ (Key in a value (acceptable values: 0 to 255))→ [ENTER] or [INTERRUPT] (Stored in memory)* The larger the adjustment value is, the longer the distance B becomes (approx. 0.04 mm/
step).
[D] Reproduction ratio of secondary scanning direction
(1) While pressing [0] and [5] simultaneously, turn the power ON. → (Adjustment Mode)(2) Place Test Chart No. TCC-1 on the original glass (with the arrow positioned at the left rear side).(3) Press [FAX] → [START] to make a copy at the mode of A4/LT, 100%, Black and Text/Photo.(4) Measure the distance C between M3 and M4 on the copy with a ruler.(5) Check if the distance C is within 150±0.5 mm.(6) If not, use the following procedure to change values and repeat step 3. to 5. above.
<Procedure>(Adjustment Mode) → (Key in the code [340]) → [START]→ (Key in a value (acceptable values: 0 to 255))→ [ENTER] or [INTERRUPT] (Stored in memory)* The larger the adjustment value is, the longer the distance C becomes (approx. 0.22 %/step).
[E] Image location of secondary scanning direction
(1) While pressing [0] and [5] simultaneously, turn the power ON. → (Adjustment Mode)(2) Place Test Chart No. TCC-1 on the original glass (with the arrow positioned at the left rear side).(3) Press [FAX] → [START] to make a copy at the mode of A4/LT, 100%, Black and Text/Photo.(4) Measure the distance D from the top paper edge to the 10 mm line of top grid pattern on the copy
with a ruler.(5) Check if the distance D is within 10±0.5 mm.
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cADJUSTMENT
3 - 17
3
(6) If not, use the following procedure to change values and repeat step 3. to 5. above.<Procedure>(Adjustment Mode) → (Key in the code [305]) → [START]→ (Key in a value (acceptable values: 92 to 164))→ [ENTER] or [INTERRUPT] (Stored in memory)
* The larger the adjustment value is, the longer the distance D becomes (approx. 0.14 mm/step).
[F] Top margin
(1) While pressing [0] and [5] simultaneously, turn the power ON. → (Adjustment Mode)(2) Open the platen cover or RADF.(3) Press [FAX] → [START] to make a copy at the mode of A3/LD, 100%, Black, Text/Photo and
lower drawer.(4) Measure the blank area E at the leading edge of the copied image.(5) Check if the blank area E is within the range of 3±0.5 mm.(6) If not, use the following procedure to change values and repeat the steps 3. to 5. above.
<Procedure>(Adjustment Mode) → (Key in the code [430]) → [START]→ (Key in a value (acceptable values: 0 to 255))→ [ENTER] or [INTERRUPT] (Stored in memory)→ (“100% A” is displayed.)* The larger the adjustment value is, the wider the blank area becomes (approx. 0.04 mm/
step).
Fig. 3-7
[G] Right margin
(1) While pressing [0] and [5] simultaneously, turn the power ON. → (Adjustment Mode)(2) Open the platen cover or RADF.(3) Press [FAX] → [START] to make a copy at the mode of A3/LD, 100%, Black, Text/Photo and
lower drawer.(4) Measure the blank area F at the right side of the copied image.(5) Check if the blank area F is within the range of 2+1 mm, 2-0.5 mm.
E
Feeding direction
07/04
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedADJUSTMENT
3 - 18
(6) If not, use the following procedure to change values and repeat the steps 3. to 5. above.<Procedure>(Adjustment Mode) → (Key in the code [432]) → [START]→ (Key in a value (acceptable values: 0 to 255))→ [ENTER] or [INTERRUPT] (Stored in memory).→ (“100% A” is displayed.)
* The larger the adjustment value is, the wider the blank area at the right side becomes (approx. 0.04 mm/step).
Fig. 3-8
[H] Bottom margin
(1) While pressing [0] and [5] simultaneously, turn the power ON. → (Adjustment Mode)(2) Open platen cover or RADF.(3) Press the [FAX] → [START] to make a copy at the mode of A3/LD, 100%, Black, Text/Photo and
lower drawer.(4) Measure the blank area G at the trailing edge of the copied image.(5) Check if the blank area G is within the range of 2±0.5 mm.(6) If not, use the following procedure to change values and repeat the steps 2. to 4. above.
<Procedure>(Adjustment Mode) → (Key in the code [433]) → [START]→ (Key in value (acceptable values: 0 to 255))→ [ENTER] or [INTERRUPT] (stored in memory)→ (“100% A” is displayed.)
* The larger the adjustment value is, the wider the blank area at the trailing edge becomes (approx. 0.04 mm/step).
Fig. 3-9
F
Feeding direction
G
Feeding direction
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cADJUSTMENT
3 - 19
3
• Adjustments and Checks using Test Chart No. TCC-1Following items can be checked with the Test Chart No. TCC-1.1) Points to be measured in the chart
Fig. 3-10
<Adjustment order>[0] [5] [Power ON] → (Chart TCC-1) → [FAX] → [START] (A3/LD, 100%, Black and Text/Photo)
A: 05-405 → 200±0.5 mm (0.1 mm/step)B: 05-306 → 5±0.5 mm (0.04 mm/step)C: 05-340 → 150±0.5 mm (0.3 mm/step)D: 05-305 → 10±0.5 mm (0.14 mm/step)
C
D
B
A
Feedin
g d
irection
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedADJUSTMENT
3 - 20
2) Checking areas of the chart and their descriptions
Fig. 3-11
[1] Grid patterns : For adjusting margin (void) and scanner section[2] YMCK patches : For checking uniformity[3] Resolution patterns : For checking resolution[4] Gradation pattern : Gradation pattern of seven colors (Y, M, C, R, G, B and K)
Coverage: 10-100%For adjusting the halftone reproduction and gray balance
[5] Color registration pattern : For checking color registration[6] Pictures : For checking color reproduction and moire[7] Magnification lines : For checking the magnification error of primary and secondary
scanning directions[8] Center lines : Center lines for A4/LT sizes[9] Arrow : A mark for placing the chart properly onto the original glass
(place it to the left rear corner of the original glass.)[10] Halftone band : For checking uniformity[11] White text on the black
solid: For checking the reproduction of white text on black solid
[12] Text : For checking reproduction of text[13] Thin lines : For checking reproduction of the thin lines (line width: 100µm)[14] Note area : For recording the date, conditions, etc.
[6][6]
[11]
[13]
[14]
[7][7]
TOSHIBA COLOR CHART
No.TCC-1
[2]
[2]
[2] [2][3] [3]
[4]
[5]
[9]
[1]
[1] [8] [10]
[1]
[1] [8]
[12]
[7]
[7]
[3]
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cADJUSTMENT
3 - 21
3
3.5 Image Quality Adjustment (Copying Function)
3.5.1 Automatic gamma adjustmentWhen the reproduction of gradation is not appropriate, the gradation reproducibility of all colors Y, M, C and K can be corrected by performing this automatic gamma adjustment. In case the gradation repro-duction of the image checked is not satisfactory, make this adjustment as described below at parts replacement.
(1) When unpacking or any of the following parts has been replaced, be sure to make this adjust-ment:• Laser optical unit • Photoconductive drum • Developer material• Main charger wire • Main charger grid • Transfer belt• 1st transfer roller • Drum cleaning blade • Drum cleaner brush• Image Quality sensor
(2) When any of the following parts are replaced or adjusted, make a copy and check the image to determine if adjustment is necessary:• 2nd transfer roller
Notes: 1. Be sure that this adjustment be made after performing the image adjustment in "3.3 Adjust-
ment of Image Quality Control" and "3.4 Image Dimensional Adjustment".2. Normally, only the adjustment of color/black integrated pattern is needed. When the adjust-
ment of "3.5.12 Beam level conversion setting" is made, color pattern and black pattern need to be adjusted individually.
<Adjustment Mode (05)>Code Item to be adjusted Contents
1642(1643)(580)
Automatic gammaadjustment
<Procedure>1) While pressing [0] and [5] simultaneously, turn the power ON. → Adjustment
Mode
2) Select the A4/LT drawer. Key in the pattern number and press the [FAX] but-ton to output a “Patch chart for gamma adjustment”.
Pattern No. Pattern Remarks4 Color/black integrated When performing code 164210* Black When performing code 5805* Color When performing code 1643* This adjustment is performed only when "3.5.12 Beam level conversion
setting" is performed. Usually, only the adjustment with the color/black integrated pattern (05-1642) is performed.
3) Place the patch chart for adjustment printed in step (2) face down on the original glass. In the cases of patterns 4 and 5, place the chart aligning its side with 2 black squares against the original scale.In the case of pattern 10, place the chart aligning its black side of the grada-tion pattern against the original scale.
4) Key in a code and press the [START] button.→ The scanner reads the chart automatically and performs automatic gamma adjustment calculation (approx. 30 sec.).
5) When the adjustment has finished normally, “ENTER” is shown. Press the [ENTER] button to have the adjustment results reflected.(To cancel the reflection of adjustment results, press the [CANCEL] button.)In the case of an abnormal ending, “ADJUSTMENT ERROR” is shown.Press the [CANCEL] button to clear the error display. When it is cleared, the control panel display will return to the ready state. Then, check if the patch chart on the original glass is placed in the wrong direction or if it is placed inclined on the original glass, and then repeat step (3) and afterward.
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedADJUSTMENT
3 - 22
3.5.2 Color Deviation AdjustmentThe color deviation amount of the secondary scanning direction can be adjusted as follows.
There are 2 methods to adjust color deviation; using "Test pattern 63 (for A3/LD size paper)" or "Test pattern 68 (for A4/LT size paper)" (adjustment method 1), and using "Test pattern 64 (for A3/LD size paper)" (adjustment method 2). Adjust using either one of these methods.* Only adjustment method 1 can be used for A4/LT paper.
Note: Note: Follow the procedure in the order below for the color deviation adjustment.If you start in the middle of the procedure, continue the subsequent steps.E.g.: If you start with step 2 (A3/LD, 2nd sheet), perform steps 3 to 6.
Adjustment method
Type Printing ImagePaper size,
Number of pages Procedures
1 Test pattern 63 (A3/LD) Ladder A3/LD, 2 pages 05-63-[FAX]
Test pattern 68 (A4/LT) Ladder A4/LT, 4 pages 05-68-[FAX]
2 Test pattern 64 (A3/LD) Block A3/LD, 2 pages 05-64-[FAX]
Order Test pattern
1 A3/LD, 1st page
2 A3/LD, 2nd page
3 A4/LT, 1st page
4 A4/LT, 2nd page
5 A4/LT, 3rd page
6 A4/LT, 4th page
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cADJUSTMENT
3 - 23
3
Adjustment method 1<Adjustment procedures (for A3/LD size paper)>Test pattern (Ladder)
Fig. 3-12
This adjustment should be applied for each printout of the test pattern. (Skip this if the test pattern is printed correctly.)The order of the adjustment, test patterns and codes to be used are listed below.
Order Test pattern Code
1 1st page 417
2 2nd page 418
Use the image position of M as areference and align the image positions ofY, C and K with this reference.
Fe
ed
ing
dire
ctio
n
A
B
[Test pattern]
Details of A
Details of B
[Details of adjustment area]
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedADJUSTMENT
3 - 24
(1) While pressing the digital keys [0] and [5] simultaneously, turn the power ON. -> (Adjustment Mode)
(2) Print out the test pattern and adjust its deviation amount (above). Use the image position of magenta (M) as a reference for adjustment. The image positions of yellow (Y), cyan (C) and black (K) must be adjusted with this reference.• Select A3/LD size. Key in “63” and then press the [FAX] button. -> 2 pages of the test pattern
are printed out.• Check the image of the test pattern (above) and specify the color to be adjusted.• Key in the code (listed above) and press the [START] button.• Key in the sub code of the color to be adjusted and press the [START] button.
Sub code 0: Black (K) 1: Cyan (C) 3: Yellow (Y) • Key in the adjustment value and press the [ENTER] or [INTERRUPT] button.
Notes: 1. When the value increases by “1”, the image shifts toward the trailing edge of the paper by
0.0423 mm.2. Adjust the image positions of black (B), cyan (C) and yellow (Y) to align the leading/trailing
edge of each image. If both leading and trailing edges are not aligned, adjust the deviation amount of each edge so that it is uniformed.
(3) Repeat Step (2) until all the test patterns are printed correctly.
Notes: 1. Since the adjusted value is reflected to that of the subsequent steps, be sure to perform the
rest of adjustment.2. Print out the test pattern for each adjustment.
(4) Turn the power OFF.
<Adjustment procedures (for A4/LT size paper)>Use “Test pattern 68” for the adjustment method to adjust a color deviation.* Perform this adjustment after <Adjustment procedures (for A3/LD size paper)> is performed.
This adjustment should be applied for each printout of the test pattern. (Skip this if the test pattern is printed correctly.)
The order of the adjustment, test patterns and codes to be used are listed below.
(1) While pressing the digital keys [0] and [5] simultaneously, turn the power ON. -> (Adjustment Mode)
Order Test pattern Code
1 1st page 953
2 2nd page 954
3 3rd page 955
4 4th page 956
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cADJUSTMENT
3 - 25
3
(2) Print out the test pattern and adjust its deviation amount (above). Use the image position of magenta (M) as a reference for adjustment. The image positions of yellow (Y), cyan (C) and black (K) must be adjusted with this reference.• Select A4/LT size. Key in “68” and then press the [FAX] button. -> 4 pages of the test pattern
are printed out.• Check the image of the test pattern (above) and specify the color to be adjusted.• Key in the code (listed above) and press the [START] button.• Key in the sub code of the color to be adjusted and press the [START] button.
Sub code 0: Black (K) 1: Cyan (C) 3: Yellow (Y)• Key in the adjustment value and press the [ENTER] or [INTERRUPT] button.
Notes: 1. When the value increases by “1”, the image shifts toward the trailing edge of the paper by
0.0423 mm.2. Adjust the image positions of black (B), cyan (C) and yellow (Y) to align the leading/trailing
edge of each image. If both leading and trailing edges are not aligned, adjust the deviation amount of each edge so that it is made uniform.
(3) Repeat Step (2) until all the test patterns are printed correctly.
Notes: 1. Since the adjusted value is reflected in that of the subsequent steps, be sure to perform the
rest of the adjustment.2. Print out the test pattern for each adjustment.
(4) Turn the power OFF.
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedADJUSTMENT
3 - 26
Adjustment method 2Test pattern (Block)
Fig. 3-13
This adjustment should be applied for each printout of the test pattern. (Skip this if the test pattern is printed correctly.)The order of the adjustment, test patterns and codes to be used are listed below.
C MK
KY CY
C MK
C MK
KY CY
C MK
C MK
KY CY
C MK
Adjust the image positions of K, C and Y so that the colors do not overlap.
[Details of adjustment area]
Pattern on the leading edge side
Pattern on the trailing edge side
[Test pattern]
Equal gap between the image
positions of each color is the
optimal condition.
Optimal condition
Fe
ed
ing
dire
ctio
n
The colors overlap(Adjustment is needed).
The colors are allowed to con-
tact each other.Acceptation
Rejection
Gap: approx. 0.169 mm
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cADJUSTMENT
3 - 27
3
(1) While pressing the digital keys [0] and [5] simultaneously, turn the power ON. -> (Adjustment Mode)
(2) Print out the test pattern and adjust its deviation amount (above). Use the image position of magenta (M) as a reference for adjustment. The image positions of yellow (Y), cyan (C) and black (K) must be adjusted with this reference.• Select A3/LD size. Key in “64” and then press the [FAX] button. -> 2 pages of the test pattern
are printed out.• Check the image of the test pattern (above) and specify the color to be adjusted.• Key in the code (listed above) and press the [START] button.• Key in the sub code of the color to be adjusted and press the [START] button.
Sub code 0: Black (K) 1: Cyan (C) 3: Yellow (Y) • Key in the adjustment value and press the [ENTER] or [INTERRUPT] button.
Notes: 1. When the value increases by “1”, the image shifts toward the trailing edge of the paper by
0.0423 mm.2. Adjust the image positions of black (K), cyan (C) and yellow (Y) so that these colors do not
overlap one another.3. If patterns on both leading and trailing edges are not aligned, adjust the deviation amount of
each edge so that it is made uniform. (i.e. Adjust it so as to make the upper-side gap of the pattern on the leading edge and lower-side gap of the pattern on the trailing edge equal, and to make the lower-side gap of the pattern on the leading edge and upper-side gap of the pat-tern on the trailing edge equal.)
(3) Repeat Step (2) until all the test patterns are printed correctly.
Notes: 1. Since the adjusted value is reflected in that of the subsequent steps, be sure to perform the
rest of the adjustment.2. Print out the test pattern for each adjustment.
(4) Turn the power OFF.
Order Test pattern Code
1 1st page 417
2 2nd page 418
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedADJUSTMENT
3 - 28
3.5.3 Density adjustmentThe center density and the density variation controlled by density adjustment keys can be adjusted as follows.
<Adjustment Mode (05)>
<Adjustment Mode (05)>
Make a test copy and compare the image obtained with the current settings; if necessary, make adjust-ment using the following procedure.
Note: Note: Be sure that this adjustment be made after performing "3.5.1 Automatic gamma adjustment".
<Procedure>
(1) While pressing [0] and [5] simultaneously, turn the power ON.(2) Key in a code and press the [START] button.(3) Key in an adjustment value (acceptable values: 0 to 255).
(To correct the value once keyed in, press the [CLEAR] button.)(4) Press the [ENTER] or [INTERRUPT] button to store the value. → The equipment goes back to
the ready state.(5) Press the [FAX] button and then press the [START] button to make a test copy.(6) If the desired image has not been attained, repeat step (2) to (5).
Colormode
Original modeItem to be adjusted
RemarksText/Photo
TextPrinted Image
Photo Map
Full Color
1550 1551 1552 1553 1554 Manual density mode center value
The larger the value is, the darker the image becomes.Acceptable values: 0 to 255 (Default: 128)
1560 1561 1562 1563 1564 Manual density mode dark step value
The larger the value is, the darker the dark side becomes.Acceptable values: 0 to 255 (Default: 20)
1570 1571 1572 1573 1574 Manual density mode light step value
The larger the value is, the lighter the light side becomes.Acceptable values: 0 to 255 (Default: 20)
1580 1581 1582 1583 1584 Automatic density mode
The larger the value is, the darker the image becomes.Acceptable values: 0 to 255 (Default: 128)
Colormode
Original mode Item to be adjusted
RemarksText/Photo Text Photo
Black 503 504 501 Manual density mode center value
The larger the value is, the darker the image becomes.Acceptable values:0 to 255 (Default: 128)
508 510 509 Manual density mode dark step value
The larger the value is, the darker the dark side becomes.Acceptable values:0 to 255 (Default: 20)
505 507 506 Manual density mode light step value
The larger the value is, the lighter the light side becomes.Acceptable values:0 to 255 (Default: 20)
514 515 512 Automatic density mode
The larger the value is, the darker the image becomes.Acceptable values:0 to 255 (Default: 128)
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cADJUSTMENT
3 - 29
3
3.5.4 Color balance adjustmentThe color balance is adjusted by adjusting the density of each color at the Full Color Mode. The adjust-ment is performed by selecting its density area from the following: low density, medium density and high density.
<Adjustment Mode (05)>
Make a test copy and compare the image obtained with the current settings; if necessary, make adjust-ment using the following procedure.
Note: Note: Be sure that this adjustment be made after performing “3.5.1 Automatic gamma adjustment”.
<Procedure>
(1) While pressing [0] and [5] simultaneously, turn the power ON.(2) Key in the code of the mode to be adjusted (color and original mode) and press the [START] but-
ton.(3) Select the density area to be adjusted with digital keys (0, 1 or 2), and press the [START] button.
0: Low density (L) 1: Medium density (M) 2: High density (H)
(4) Key in an adjustment value. (To correct the value once keyed in, press the [CLEAR] button.)(5) Press the [ENTER] or [INTERRUPT] button to store the value in memory.
→ The equipment goes back to the ready state.(6) For resetting the value, repeat step (2) to (5).(7) Press the [FAX] button and then press the [START] button to make a test copy.(8) If the desired image has not been attained, repeat step (2) to (7).
Color
Original modeItem to beadjusted
RemarksText/Photo
TextPrinted Image
Photo Map
Yellow 1779-0 1780-0 1781-0 1782-0 1783-0 Low density The larger the value is, the darker the color to be adjusted becomes.Acceptable values:0 to 255. (Default: 128)
1779-1 1780-1 1781-1 1782-1 1783-1 Medium density
1779-2 1780-2 1781-2 1782-2 1783-2 High density
Magenta 1784-0 1785-0 1786-0 1787-0 1788-0 Low density
1784-1 1785-1 1786-1 1787-1 1788-1 Medium density
1784-2 1785-2 1786-2 1787-2 1788-2 High density
Cyan 1789-0 1790-0 1791-0 1792-0 1793-0 Low density
1789-1 1790-1 1791-1 1792-1 1793-1 Medium density
1789-2 1790-2 1791-2 1792-2 1793-2 High density
Black 1794-0 1795-0 1796-0 1798-0 1798-0 Low density
1794-1 1795-1 1796-1 1798-1 1798-1 Medium density
1794-2 1795-2 1796-2 1798-2 1798-2 High density
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedADJUSTMENT
3 - 30
3.5.5 Gamma balance adjustmentThe density adjustment at the Black Mode is performed by selecting its density area from the following: low density, medium density and high density.
<Adjustment Mode (05)>
Make a test copy and compare the image obtained with the current settings; if necessary, make adjust-ment using the following procedure.
Note: Note: Be sure that this adjustment be made after performing “3.5.1 Automatic gamma adjustment”.
<Procedure>Procedure is same as that of “3.5.4 Color balance adjustment”.
3.5.6 Offsetting adjustment for background processingThe density of background and text can be adjusted as follows.
<Adjustment Mode (05)>
Make a test copy and compare the image obtained with the current settings; if necessary, make adjust-ment using the following procedure.
<Procedure>Procedure is same as that of "3.5.2 Density adjustment".
Colormode
Original modeItem to be adjusted Remarks
Text/Photo Text Photo
Black 590-0 591-0 592-0 Low density The larger the value is, the density of the item to be adjusted becomes darker.Acceptable values: 0 to 255. (Default: 128)
590-1 591-1 592-1 Medium density
590-2 591-2 592-2 High density
Colormode
Original modeItem to be adjusted RemarksText/
PhotoText
Printed Image
Photo Map
Full Color
1688 1689 1690 1691 1692 Automatic density adjustment for back-ground
The larger the value is, the darker the background becomes. (Automatic)Acceptable values: 0 to 255.(Default: 128)
1693 1694 1695 1696 1697 Automatic density adjustment for text
The larger the value is, the darker the text becomes.(Automatic)Acceptable values: 0 to 255. (Default: 128)
1698 1699 1700 1701 1702 Manual density adjustment for back-ground
The larger the value is, the darker the background becomes. (Manual)Acceptable values: 0 to 255. (Default: 128)
1708 1709 1710 1711 1712 Manual density adjustment for text
The larger the value is, the darker the text becomes. (Manual)Acceptable values: 0 to 255. (Default: 128)
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cADJUSTMENT
3 - 31
3
3.5.7 Judgment threshold for ACSThe judgment level is adjusted for the automatic identification of whether the original set on the glass is black or color. Namely, this is to adjust the judgment level used when “Auto Color” is selected at a color mode. The adjustment is available for each of the manually-set original and the original used with the RADF.
<Adjustment Mode (05)>
Make a test copy and compare the image obtained with the current settings; if necessary and make adjustment.
<Procedure>Procedure is same as that of "3.5.3 Density adjustment".
3.5.8 Sharpness adjustmentIf you want to make copy images look softer or sharper, perform the following adjustment. The adjust-ment can be made for each of the color modes and original modes independently.
<Adjustment Mode (05)>
Make a test copy and compare the image obtained with the current settings; if necessary, make adjust-ment.
Note: Note: You have to make adjustment by balancing between moire and sharpness.
<Procedure>Procedure is same as that of "3.5.3 Density adjustment".
Code Item to be adjusted Contents
1675 Item to be adjusted Judgment threshold for ACS when origi-nal is set manually
The larger the value is, the more an original tends to be judged as black even at the Auto Color Mode. The smaller value is, the more it tends to be judged as color.Acceptable values: 0 to 255. (Default: 70)
1676 Judgment threshold for ACS when origi-nal is set on RADF
Code Color mode Original mode Contents
1737 Full Color Text/Photo • The larger the value is, the sharper the image becomes; while the smaller the value is, the softer the image becomes.
• The smaller the value is, the less moire tends to appear.
• The acceptable values are 0 to 31.The center value is 16. However, 0 is equivalent to the center value.
1738 Text
1739 Printed Image
1740 Photo
1741 Map
604 Black Text/Photo
605 Text
606 Photo
1757 Auto Color Text/Photo
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedADJUSTMENT
3 - 32
3.5.9 Setting range correctionThe values of the background peak/text peak in the range correction at the Black Mode can be switched to "varied" or "fixed" in the following codes.If they are fixed, the range correction is performed with standard values.The values of the background peak affects the reproduction of the background density, and the values of the text peak affects that of the text density.
<Adjustment Mode (05)>
Make a test copy and compare the image obtained with the current settings; if necessary, make adjust-ment.
<Procedure>Procedure is same as that of "3.5.3 Density adjustment".
3.5.10 Setting range correction (Adjustment of background peak)The levels of the background peak for the range correction at a Black Mode can be set at the following codes.
<Adjustment Mode (05)>
Make a test copy and compare the image obtained with the current settings; if necessary, make adjust-ment.
<Procedure>Procedure is same as that of "3.5.3 Density adjustment".
Original modeItem to be adjusted Remarks
Text/Photo Photo Text
570 571 572 Range correction for original manually set on the original glass
The following are the default values set for each original mode.Text/Photo: 22, Photo: 12, Text: 22 Each digit stands for:One's place: Automatic density modeTen's place: Manual density modeThe setting conditions possible are as follows:
Background peak Text peak1: fixed fixed2: varied fixed3: fixed varied4: varied varied
693 694 695 Range correction for original set on the RADF
Original modeItem to be adjusted Remarks
Text/Photo Photo Text
532 533 534 Background peak for range correction
When the value increases, the back-ground (low density area) of the image is not output.Acceptable values: 0 to 255.(Default: Text/Photo: 40, Photo: 16, Text: 40)
05/11
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cADJUSTMENT
3 - 33
3
3.5.11 Adjustment of smudged/faint textThe smudge/faint text at a Black Mode can be set at the following codes.
<Adjustment Mode (05)>
Make a test copy and compare the image obtained with the current settings; if necessary, make adjust-ment.
Note: Note: Remember the image specifications and life span of the replacing parts may not meet the stan-dard when the setting value is changed from the default value.
<Procedure>Procedure is same as that of "3.5.3 Density adjustment".
3.5.12 Adaptation to highlighterFour modes of one touch adjustment are performed and each mode can be switched into two modes; highlighter 1 or 2. This adjustment is performed when the reproduction mode for highlighter is needed.
<Adjustment Mode (05)>
Note: Note: The color may not always be reproduced precisely due to the characteristics of fluorescent ink.
Original modeItem to be adjusted Remarks
Text/Photo
648 Adjustment of smudged/ faint text
When the value increases, the faint text is improved. When the value decreases, the smudged text is improved.Acceptable values: 0 to 255.(Default: 30)
Code One touch adjustment Remarks
1769 Vivid 0: Default (Vivid / Clear / Warm / Cool)1: Highlighter 12: Highlighter 21770 Clear
1771 Warm
1772 Cool
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedADJUSTMENT
3 - 34
3.5.13 Beam level conversion settingThe beam level for 4 divided smoothing is set at the Black Mode. This adjustment enables to adjust the dot size.
<Adjustment Mode (05)>
Make a test copy and compare the image obtained with the current settings; if necessary, make adjust-ment using the following procedure.
<Procedure>Procedure is same as that of “3.5.4 Color balance adjustment”.
Notes: 1. When this adjustment is performed, “3.5.1 Automatic gamma adjustment (Black Mode)” (05-
580) needs to be performed since the reproduction of density at Black Mode varies. The result of this adjustment is not reflected to color/black integrated pattern. Namely, each auto-matic gamma adjustment of Black Mode (05-580) or of Color Mode (05-1643) needs to be performed individually after this adjustment.
2. After this adjustment, set “1” in 08-595 so that the correction result of the Black Mode is not reflected on “Automatic Calibration”.
3. The setting value must increase as the beam level number (0 to 4) becomes higher. Do not increase this order when setting the values.
4. Usually, beam level 4 is most effective on all black modes.
3.5.14 Maximum toner density adjustment to paper typeThe maximum toner amount adhering to the paper can be controlled.
<Adjustment Mode (05)>
Note: Note: The larger the value is, the more frequently fusing offsetting occurs.
Code One touch adjustment Remarks
667-0 Beam level 0/4 The smaller the value is, the smaller the beam width becomes. Therefore, the smaller dot is reproduced accord-ingly. Acceptable values: 0 to 255.(Default: Level 0/4: 0, Level 1/4: 63, Level 2/4: 127, Level 3/4: 191, Level 4/4: 255)
667-1 Beam level 1/4
667-2 Beam level 2/4
667-3 Beam level 3/4
667-4 Beam level 4/4
Code Paper type Remarks
1612 Plain paper The smaller the value is, the toner amount adhered decreases of the high density area (ex. prevention of fusing offsetting, etc).Acceptable values : 0 to 255.(Default: Plain paper: 255, Thick paper 1: 249, Thick paper 2: 237, Thick paper 3: 237, OHP film: 249)
1613 Thick paper 1
1614 Thick paper 2
1615 Thick paper 3
1616 OHP film
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cADJUSTMENT
3 - 35
3
3.5.15 Maximum text density adjustmentThe maximum text density of each color at Full Color Mode can be adjusted as follows.
<Adjustment Mode (05)>
Make a test copy and compare the image obtained with the current settings; if necessary, make adjust-ment using the following procedure.
Note: Note: Be sure that this adjustment be made after performing “3.5.1 Automatic gamma adjustment”.
<Procedure>Procedure is same as that of “3.5.3 Density adjustment”.
3.5.16 Text/Photo reproduction level adjustmentText/Photo reproduction level at the Full color mode, Auto color mode and Gray scale mode can be adjusted.Text/Photo reproduction level adjustment can be switched to "Photo oriented 1", "Photo oriented 2", "Text oriented 1" or "Text oriented 2" in the following codes.
<Adjustment Mode (05)>
Notes: • The text reproduction level is lower when the mode is switched from the default value to the
Photo oriented 1 or Photo oriented 2. (The text reproduction level in Photo oriented 2 is lower than that in Photo oriented 1.)
• Changing the setting value from default value to the Text oriented 1 or Text oriented 2 causes image noise in the printed photo image with few lines per inch. (Photo oriented 2 causes more image noise than Photo oriented 1.)
Color Code Item to be adjusted Remarks
Yellow 1630 Maximum text density The larger the value is, the darker the maximum text density of each color to be adjusted becomes.Acceptable values: 0 to 10 (Default: 5)Magenta 1631
Cyan 1632
Black 1633
ModeItem to be adjusted Contents
Text/Photo
1725 Text/Photo reproduc-tion level adjustment
0: Default1: Photo oriented 2 (The printed image reproduction level
higher than that of the Photo oriented 1)2: Photo oriented 1 (The printed image reproduction level
higher than that of the Default)3: Equivalent to the Default4: Text oriented 1 (The text reproduction level higher than
that of the Default)5: Text oriented 2 (The text reproduction level higher than
that of the Text oriented 1)
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedADJUSTMENT
3 - 36
3.5.17 Black reproduction switching at the Twin color copy modeBlack reproduction can be switched at the Twin color (Black/Red) copy mode.
<Adjustment Mode (05)>
Note: Note: The boundary between Red and Black may not be smooth when the setting value is "1".
3.5.18 Background adjustment(Black Mode)Background of the gamma data can be adjusted with the following codes.
<Adjustment Mode (05)>
<Procedure>Procedure is same as that of “3.5.3 Density adjustment”.
Mode
Item to be adjusted ContentsTwin color copy mode(Black/Red)
1761 Black reproduction switching
0: Default1: Black reproduction oriented
Original mode Item to be adjusted
RemarksText/Photo Photo Text
600 602 601 Background adjustment
1 to 9: The larger the value is, the background becomes lighter.
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cADJUSTMENT
3 - 37
3
3.6 Image Quality Adjustment (Printing Function)
3.6.1 Automatic gamma adjustmentWhen the reproduction of gradation is not appropriate, the gradation reproducibility of all colors Y, M, C and K can be corrected by performing this automatic gamma adjustment. In case the gradation repro-duction of the image checked is not satisfactory, make this adjustment as described below at parts replacement.
1) When unpacking or any of the following parts has been replaced, be sure to make this adjustment:• Laser optical unit • Photoconductive drum • Developer material• Main charger wire • Main charger grid • Transfer belt• 1st transfer roller • Drum cleaning blade • Drum cleaner brush• Image Quality sensor
2) When any of the following parts are replaced or adjusted, make a print and check the image to determine if adjustment is necessary:• 2nd transfer roller
Note: Note: Be sure that this adjustment be made after performing the image adjustment in "3.3 Adjustment of Image Quality Control" and "3.4 Image Dimensional Adjustment".
<Adjustment Mode (05)>Color Code Remarks
1000100110021003
Automatic gamma adjustment
<Procedure>1) While pressing [0] and [5] simultaneously, turn the power ON. ? Adjustment
Mode2) Select the A4/LT drawer. Key in the pattern number and press the [FAX] button
to output a “Patch chart for gamma adjustment”.Pattern No. Language/Resolution Remarks47 PS/600x600dpi When performing code 100048* PS/1200x600dpi When performing code 100149 PCL/600x600dpi When performing code 100250* PCL/1200x600dpi When performing code 1003* Perform the adjustment only when the expansion memory has been
installed.3) Place the patch chart for adjustment printed in step (2) face down on the origi-
nal glass, with its side, on which two black squares are present, aligned against the original scale.
4) Key in a code and press the [START] button. ? The scanner reads the chart automatically and performs automatic gamma adjustment calculation (approx. 30 sec.).
5) When the adjustment has finished normally, “ENTER” is shown.Press the [ENTER] button to have the adjustment results reflected.(To cancel the reflection of adjustment results, press the [CANCEL] button.)In the case of an abnormal ending, “ADJUSTMENT ERROR” is shown. Press the [CANCEL] button to clear the error display.When it is cleared, the control panel display will return to the ready state. Then, check if the patch chart on the original glass is placed in the wrong direction or if it is placed inclined on the original glass, and then repeat step (3) and after-ward.
08/04
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedADJUSTMENT
3 - 38
3.6.2 Color deviation adjustmentThe color deviation amount of the secondary scanning direction can be adjusted.
For the adjustment procedures, see Chapter 3.5.2 “Color Deviation Adjustment”.
Note: Note: Since color deviation adjustment in the copying function is in common with that in the printer function, it does not need to be done if already performed in the copying function.
3.6.3 Gamma balance adjustment (Black Mode)The gamma balance is adjusted by adjusting the density at the Black Mode. The adjustment is per-formed by selecting its density area from the following: low density, medium density and high density.
<Adjustment Mode (05)>
<Procedure>
(1) While pressing [0] and [5] simultaneously, turn the power ON.(2) Key in the codes to be adjusted (language and screen) and press the [START] button.(3) Key in the value corresponding to the density area to be adjusted (0, 1 or 2) and press the
[START] button.0: Low density (L) 1: Medium density (M) 2: High density (H)
(4) Key in the adjustment value. (To correct the value once keyed in, press [CLEAR] button.)(5) Press the [ENTER] or [INTERRUPT] button to store the value in memory. ? The equipment goes
back to the ready state.(6) For resetting the value, repeat step (2) to (5).(7) Let the equipment restart and perform printing job.(8) If the image density has not been attained, repeat step (1) to (7).
Colormode
Language and screen
Item to be adjusted RemarksSmooth
(PS)
Detail(PS)
Smooth
(PCL)
Detail(PCL)
Black 596-0 597-0 598-0 599-0 Low density The larger the value is, the density of the item to be adjusted becomes darker.Acceptable values: 0 to 255.(Default: 128)
596-1 597-1 598-1 599-1 Medium density
596-2 597-2 598-2 599-2 High density
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cADJUSTMENT
3 - 39
3
3.6.4 Color balance adjustment (Color Mode)The color balance is adjusted by adjusting the density of each color. The adjustment is performed by selecting its density area from the following: low density, medium density and high density.
<Adjustment Mode (05)>
Note: Note: Be sure that this adjustment be made after performing “3.6.1 Automatic gamma adjustment”.
<Procedure>Procedure is same as that of "3.6.3 Gamma balance adjustment".
3.6.5 Adjustment of smudged/faint textThe smudged/faint text at the Black Mode is adjusted.
<Adjustment Mode (05)>
<Procedure>
(1) While pressing [0] and [5] simultaneously, turn the power ON.(2) Key in the codes to be adjusted and press the [START] button.(3) Key in the adjustment value. (To correct the value once keyed in, press [CLEAR] button.)(4) Press the [ENTER] or [INTERRUPT] button to store the value in memory. ? The equipment goes
back to the ready state.(5) For resetting the value, repeat step (2) to (4).(6) Let the equipment restart and perform printing job.(7) If the desired image has not been attained, repeat step (1) to (6).
Color
PS PCL
Density Remarks600x600dpi 1200x600dpi 600x600dpi 1200x600dpi
Smooth Detail Smooth Detail Smooth Detail Smooth Detail
Yellow 1010-0 1014-0 1018-0 1022-0 1026-0 1030-0 1034-0 1038-0 Low The larger the value is, the darker the color to be adjusted becomes.Acceptablevalues: 0 to 255.(Default: 128)
1010-1 1014-1 1018-1 1022-1 1026-1 1030-1 1034-1 1038-1 Medium
1010-2 1014-2 1018-2 1022-2 1026-2 1030-2 1034-2 1038-2 High
Magenta 1011-0 1015-0 1019-0 1023-0 1027-0 1031-0 1035-0 1039-0 Low
1011-1 1015-1 1019-1 1023-1 1027-1 1031-1 1035-1 1039-1 Medium
1011-2 1015-2 1019-2 1023-2 1027-2 1031-2 1035-2 1039-2 High
Cyan 1012-0 1016-0 1020-0 1024-0 1028-0 1032-0 1036-0 1040-0 Low
1012-1 1016-1 1020-1 1024-1 1028-1 1032-1 1036-1 1040-1 Medium
1012-2 1016-2 1020-2 1024-2 1028-2 1032-2 1036-2 1040-2 High
Black 1013-0 1017-0 1021-0 1025-0 1029-0 1033-0 1037-0 1041-0 Low
1013-1 1017-1 1021-1 1025-1 1029-1 1033-1 1037-1 1041-1 Medium
1013-2 1017-2 1021-2 1025-2 1029-2 1033-2 1037-2 1041-2 High
LanguageRemarks
PS PCL
654 655 When the value increases, the smudged text is improved.When the value decreases, the faint text is improved.Acceptable values: 0 to 9 (Default: 5)
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedADJUSTMENT
3 - 40
3.6.6 Upper limit value at Toner Saving ModeThe upper limit value is adjusted at the Toner Saving Mode.
<Adjustment Mode (05)>
<Procedure>Procedure is same as that of “3.6.5 Adjustment of smudged/faint text”.
3.6.7 Dot size adjustment in black printingThe dot size is adjusted in primary scanning direction in black printing.
<Adjustment Mode (05)>
<Procedure>Procedure is same as that of “3.6.5 Adjustment of smudged/faint text”.
3.6.8 Maximum toner density adjustment to paper typeThe maximum toner amount adhering to the paper can be controlled.
<Adjustment Mode (05)>
<Procedure>Procedure is same as that of “3.6.3 Gamma balance adjustment”.
Note: Note: The larger the value is, the more frequently fusing offsetting occurs.
3.6.9 Image processing: Gamma correction table all clearingThe state of calibration in color printing mode is initialized at the Setting Mode (08-597). This setting is to be performed when a defect occurs in “Automatic gamma adjustment (05-1000 to 1003)”. The cause of defect is presumed as an image failure (jittering or uneven image density) at the patch chart for gamma adjustment.
Black mode Language
RemarksPS PCL
PS PS PCL PCL
600x600dpi 1200x600dpi 600x600dpi 1200x600dpi
664 665 1055 1056 1057 1058 The smaller the value is, the lighter the density of image becomes.Acceptable values: 0 to 255.(Default: 176)
Code Remarks
663 The smaller the value is, the dot size becomes smaller.Acceptable values: 0 to 255. (Default: 255)
CodePaper type Remarks
PS PCL
1046-0 1046-1 Plain paper The smaller the value is, the toner amount adhered decreases of the high density area (ex. prevention of fusing offsetting, etc).Acceptable values: 0 to 255. (Default: Plain paper: 255, Thick paper 1:255, Thick paper 2: 255, Thick paper 3: 255, OHP film: 200)
1047-0 1047-1 Thick paper 1
1048-0 1048-1 Thick paper 2
1049-0 1049-1 Thick paper 3
1050-0 1050-1 OHP film
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cADJUSTMENT
3 - 41
3
3.7 Image Quality Adjustment (Scanning Function)
3.7.1 Gamma balance adjustmentThe gamma balance at the Black Mode is adjusted by adjusting the density. The adjustment is per-formed by selecting its density area from the following: low density, medium density and high density.
<Adjustment Mode (05)>
<Procedure>
(1) While pressing [0] and [5] simultaneously, turn the power ON.(2) Key in the code corresponding to the desired original mode and press the [START] button.(3) Key in the value corresponding to the density area to be adjusted (0, 1 or 2) and press the
[START] button.0: Low density (L), 1: Medium density (M), 2: High density (H)
(4) Key in the adjustment value. (To correct the value once keyed in, press [CLEAR] button.)(5) Press the [ENTER] or [INTERRUPT] button to store the value in memory. The equipment goes
back to the ready state.(6) For resetting the value, repeat step (2) to (5).(7) Let the equipment restart and perform scanning job.(8) If the desired image has not been attained, repeat step (1) to (7).
Item to be adjusted
Original modeGray Scale
modeRemarksBlack
Text/PhotoBlackText
BlackPhoto
Low density 880-0 881-0 882-0 883-0 The larger the value is, the density of the item to be adjusted becomes darker.Acceptable values: 0 to 255. (Default: 128)
Medium density 880-1 881-1 882-1 883-1
High density 880-2 881-2 882-2 883-2
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedADJUSTMENT
3 - 42
3.7.2 Density adjustment (Black Mode)Adjusts the center density and the variation of density adjustment buttons.
<Adjustment Mode (05)>
<Procedure>
(1) While pressing [0] and [5] simultaneously, turn the power ON.(2) Key in a code and press the [START] button.(3) Key in an adjustment value (acceptable values: 0 to 255).
(To correct the value once keyed in, press the [CLEAR] button.)(4) Press the [ENTER] or [INTERRUPT] button to store the value in memory. The equipment goes
back to the ready state.(5) Let the equipment restart and perform scanning job.(6) If the desired image has not been attained, repeat step (1) to (5).
Color mode
Original mode Item to be adjusted
RemarksText/Photo Text Photo
Black 845 846 847 Manual density center value
The larger the value is, the darker the image becomes.Acceptable values: 0 to 255 (Default: 128)
855 856 857 Manual density dark step value
The larger the value is, the darker the dark side becomes.Acceptable values: 0 to 255(Default: 20)
850 851 852 Manual density light step value
The larger the value is, the lighter the light side becomes.Acceptable values: 0 to 255(Default: 20)
860 861 862 Automatic density The larger the value is, the darker the image becomes.Acceptable values: 0 to 255(Default: 128)
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cADJUSTMENT
3 - 43
3
3.7.3 Background adjustment (Gray Scale Mode)The adjustment level of background center value and the control of background adjustment button are adjusted.
<Adjustment Mode (05)>
<Procedure>
(1) While pressing [0] and [5] simultaneously, turn the power ON.(2) Key in the codes and press the [START] button.(3) Key in the adjustment values. Acceptable values : 0 to 255. (To correct the value once keyed in,
press [CLEAR] button.)(4) Press the [ENTER] or [INTERRUPT] button to store the value in memory. ‡ The equipment goes
back to the ready state.(5) Let the equipment restart and perform scanning job.(6) If the desired image has not been attained, repeat step (1) to (5).
3.7.4 Background adjustment (Color Mode)The adjustment level of background center value is adjusted. The control value of background adjust-ment button is automatically adjusted to the same level as the adjusted center value.For example, when the control value of background adjustment key ranges from 0 to 6, the background center value (-2 to +2) is used to be the range from 6 to 14 accordingly.
<Procedure>
(1) While pressing [0] and [5] simultaneously, turn the power ON.(2) Key in the codes and press the [START] button.(3) Key in the adjustment values. Acceptable values : 0 to 50. (To correct the value once keyed in,
press [CLEAR] button.)(4) Press the [ENTER] or [INTERRUPT] button to store the value in memory. The equipment goes
back to the ready state.(5) Let the equipment restart and perform scanning job.(6) If the desired image has not been attained, repeat step (1) to (5).
Code Item to be adjusted Remarks
848 Center value The larger the value is, the background becomes darker. The smaller the value is, the background becomes lighter.Acceptable values: 0 to 255 (Default: 128)
858 Dark step value The larger the value is, the image of the “dark” steps becomes darker.Acceptable values: 0 to 255 (Default: 50)
853 Light step value The larger the value is, the image of the “light” steps becomes lighter.Acceptable values: 0 to 255 (Default: 50)
Code Original mode Remarks
1070 Text The larger the value is, the background becomes lighter.Acceptable values: 0 to 50 (Default: 0)1071 Printed Image
1072 Photo
Before adjustment
After adjustment
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17
+2 +1 0 -1 -2
-1 -2+2 +1 0
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedADJUSTMENT
3 - 44
3.7.5 Judgment threshold for ACSThe judgment level is adjusted for the automatic identification of whether the original set on the glass is black or color. Namely, this is to adjust the judgment level used when “Auto Color” is selected at color modes. The adjustment is available for both the manually-set original and the original used with the RADF.
<Adjustment Mode (05)>
<Procedure>:Procedure is same as that of "3.7.2 Density adjustment (Black Mode)".
3.7.6 Sharpness adjustmentIf you want to make scan images look softer or sharper, perform the following adjustment. The adjust-ment can be made for each of the color modes and original modes independently.
<Adjustment Mode (05)>
Note: Note: You have to make adjustment by balancing between moire and sharpness.
<Procedure>Procedure is same as that of "3.7.2 Density adjustment (Black Mode)".
Code Item to be adjusted Contents
1065 Judgment threshold for ACS when origi-nal is set manually
The larger the value is, the more an original tends to be judged as black even at the Auto Color Mode. The smaller the value is, the more it tends to be judged as color.Acceptable values: 0 to 255 (Default: 70)1066 Judgment threshold
for ACS when origi-nal is set on RADF
Code Color mode Original mode Contents
1086 Full Color Text • The larger the value is, the sharper the image becomes; while the smaller the value is, the softer the image becomes.
• The smaller the value is, the less moire tends to appear.• The acceptable values are 0 to 31.
The center value is 16.However, 0 is equivalent to the center value.
1087 Printed Image
1088 Photo
840 Black Text/Photo
841 Text
842 Photo
843 Gray Scale -
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cADJUSTMENT
3 - 45
3
3.7.7 Setting range correctionThe values of the background peak / text peak in the range correction at the Black Mode can be switched to "varied" or "fixed" in the following codes.If they are fixed, the range correction is performed with standard values.The values of the background peak affects the reproduction of the background density and the values of the text peak affects that of the text density.
<Adjustment Mode (05)>
<Procedure>Procedure is same as that of "3.7.2 Density adjustment (Black Mode)".
3.7.8 Setting range correction (Adjustment of background peak)The levels of the background peak for the range correction at the Black Mode can be set at the follow-ing codes.
<Adjustment Mode (05)>
<Procedure>Procedure is same as that of "3.7.2 Density adjustment (Black Mode)".
Black
Gray Scale
Item to be adjusted
RemarksOriginal mode
Text/Photo
Text Photo
825 826 827 828 Range correc-tion for original manually set on the original glass
The following are the default values set for each origi-nal mode.Photo/Text: 12, Text: 12, Photo: 12, Gray Scale: 12Each digit stands for:Ones place: Automatic density modeTens place: Manual density modeThe setting conditions possible are as follows:
Background peak Text peak1: fixed fixed2: varied fixed3: fixed varied4: varied varied
830 831 832 833 Range correc-tion for original set on the RADF
Black
Gray Scale
Item to be adjusted
RemarksOriginal mode
Text/Photo
Text Photo
835 836 837 838 Background peak for range correction
When the value increases, the background (low density section) of the image is not output.Acceptable vales: 0 to 255(Default: Text/Photo: 56, Text: 48, Photo: 16, Gray Scale: 32)
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedADJUSTMENT
3 - 46
3.7.9 Fine adjustment of black densityThe density of black side on scanned image is adjusted at color-scanning.
<Adjustment Mode (05)>
Note: Note: Be careful for the value not to be too large since the gradation is reproduced worse in darker side.
<Procedure>
(1) While pressing [0] and [5] simultaneously, turn the power ON.(2) Key in the codes and press the [START] button.(3) Key in the adjustment values. Acceptable values : 0 to 4. (To correct the value once keyed in,
press [CLEAR] button.)(4) Press the [ENTER] or [INTERRUPT] button to store the value in memory. ? The equipment goes
back to the ready state.(5) Let the equipment restart and perform scanning job.(6) If the desired image has not been attained, repeat step (1) to (5).
3.7.10 RGB conversion method selectionThe color space conversion method of image is decided at color-scanning.
<Adjustment Mode (05)>
<Procedure>
(1) While pressing [0] and [5] simultaneously, turn the power ON.(2) Key in the codes and press the [START] button.(3) Key in the adjustment values. Acceptable values : 0 to 3. (To correct the value once keyed in,
press [CLEAR] button.)(4) Press the [ENTER] or [INTERRUPT] button to store the value in memory. ? The equipment goes
back to the ready state.(5) Let the equipment restart and perform scanning job.(6) If the desired image has not been attained, repeat step (1) to (5).
Code Original mode Remarks
1075 Text The larger the value is, the black side of the image becomes darker.Acceptable values: 0 to 4 (Default: 0)
1076 Printed Image
1077 Photo
Code Original mode Remarks
1080 Text Remarks0: sRGB, 1: AppleRGB, 2: ROMMRGB, 3: AdobeRGB (Default: 0)
1081 Printed Image
1082 Photo
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cADJUSTMENT
3 - 47
3
3.7.11 Reproduction ratio of primary scanning direction (black)The reproduction ratio of primary scanning direction with the resolution other than 600 dpi is adjusted in Scanning Function for black image.
<Adjustment Mode (05)>
<Procedure>Procedure is same as that of “3.7.2 Density adjustment”.
3.7.12 Reproduction ratio of primary scanning direction (color)The reproduction ratio of primary scanning direction with the resolution other than 600 dpi is adjusted in Scanning Function for color image.
<Adjustment Mode (05)>
<Procedure>Procedure is same as that of “3.7.2 Density adjustment”.
Code Remarks
884 When the value increases, the image is zoomed in.When the value decreases, the image is zoomed out.Acceptable values: 0 to 255 (Default: 128)* 0.1%/step
Code Remarks
1060 When the value increases, the image is zoomed in.When the value decreases, the image is zoomed out.Acceptable values: 0 to 255 (Default: 128)* 0.1%/step
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedADJUSTMENT
3 - 48
3.8 High-Voltage Transformer Setting
3.8.1 General descriptionThe high-voltage transformers (PS-HVT-350) supply high-voltage to the parts related to charging, development, transfer and drum cleaning.The high-voltage transformer has the following high-voltage outputs.
CH1: Main charger wireCH2: Main charger grid biasCH3: Color developer biasCH4: Black developer biasCH5: 1st transfer roller biasCH6: 2nd transfer roller biasCH7: Cleaning blade bias
Note: Note: Never move the variable resistance on the board since the output adjustment has been per-formed at the shipment for the high-voltage transformer supplied as a service part. Also do not perform the setting change when the high-voltage power supply is replaced.
06/08
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cADJUSTMENT
3 - 49
3
3.9 Adjustment of the Scanner Section
3.9.1 Carriages
(1) Installing carriage wiresWhen replacing the carriage wires, refer illustrations below:
[Front side]
Fig. 3-14
[Rear side]
Fig. 3-15
Adjustment of the carriage wire tension is not necessary since a certain tension is applied to the carriage wires by the tension springs.
Note: Note: Make sure the tension applied to the wire is normal.
Carriage-2
Idler pulley
Tension spring
Wire pulley
Bracket for carriage-1
Hook
Carriage wire
Carriage-2
Carriage wire
Bracket for carriage-1
Hook
Wire pulleyTension spring
Idler pulley
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedADJUSTMENT
3 - 50
(2) Adjusting carriages-1 and -2 positions• Move the carriage-2 toward the exit side.• Loosen the screws fixing the front side pulley bracket, make the sections A and B of the car-
riage-2 touch with the inside of the exit side frame and screw them up.
Fig. 3-16
• Put the carriage-1 on the rail, make the sections C and D of it touch with the inside of the exit frame and screw up the front/rear side of the bracket to fix it.
Note: Note: Make sure that the sections A and B of the carriage-2 touch with the exit side frame.
Fig. 3-17
Carriage-2 Pulley bracket
Exit side frame
B A
[Rear] [Front]
Enlarged view of carriage
Carriage-1
Exit side frame
Bracket Bracket
[Rear] [Front]
Enlarged view of carriage
D C
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cADJUSTMENT
3 - 51
3
(3) Assembling carriage wiresWinding the wire around the wire pulley:• Pull the Ø3 ball terminal located at the center of the wire into a hole on the wire pulley.
One end of the wire with a hook attached comes to the outside.• Wind the wires around the wire pulleys of the front and rear sides. The number of turns to be
wound are as follows:- 2 turns toward the opposite side of the boss- 4 turns toward the boss side
Notes: Pay attention to the followings when the wires are wound around the pulleys:• Do not twist the wire.• Wind the wires tightly so that they are in complete contact with the surface of the pulleys.• Each turn should be pushed against the previously wound turn so that there is no space
between them.
Fig. 3-18
• After winding the wires around the pulleys, attach the wire holder jigs not to loosen the wires.
2 turns 4 turns 2 turns4 turns
No space between turns
Ball terminalBall terminal
Color: BlackColor: Silver
Hook Hook
[Rear] [Front]
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedADJUSTMENT
3 - 52
Notes: 1. When the wire holder jig is attached, make sure that the wire is not shifted or loosened.2. The wire should come out of the slot of the wire holder jig and be passed under the arm of it.
Fig. 3-19
Arm
Wire holder jig
Wire holder jig
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cADJUSTMENT
3 - 53
3
3.9.2 Lens unit
(1) Replacing the lens unit• The lens unit must not be readjusted and some part of its components must not be replaced in
the field since the unit is precisely adjusted. If any of the components is defective, replace the whole unit.
• When replacing the unit, do not loosen or remove the 6 screws indicated with the arrows.
Fig. 3-20
• Handle the unit with care. Do not hold the lens and adjusted part (hold the unit as shown below).
Fig. 3-21
(2) Installation of lens unitFollow the procedure below when installing and replacing the lens unit.
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedADJUSTMENT
3 - 54
<Procedure>1) Attach the lens unit and fix it temporarily with 2 screws.2) Match the center scale of the plate in which the unit is to be installed and the rightmost scale of
the adjusting hole on the lens unit plate.
Fig. 3-22
3) Tighten 5 screws securely to fix the lens unit while pushing it to the rear side and fix 2 ground wires with the screws.
Fig. 3-23
Screw
[Rear]
[Front]
[Rear]
[Front]
Screw
Screw
Screw
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cADJUSTMENT
3 - 55
3
3.10 Adjustment of the Paper Feeding System
3.10.1 Sheet sideways deviation caused by paper feeding<Procedure>• The center of the printed image shifts to the front side. → Move the guide to the front side (Arrow (A)
direction in the lower figure).
Fig. 3-24
• The center of the printed image shifts to the rear side. → Move the guide to the rear side (Arrow (B) direction in the lower figure).
Fig. 3-25
Feeding direction
Center
[Rear]
[Front]
Feeding direction
Center
[Rear]
[Front]
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedADJUSTMENT
3 - 56
• Bypass feeding
• Drawer feeding
1) Loosen the screen.2) Move the entire guide to the front or rear side.3) Tighten the screw.
Fig. 3-26
1) Loosen 2 screws.2) Move the entire guide to the front or rear side.3) Tighten the screws.
Fig. 3-27
(A) (B)
(B)
(A)
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cADJUSTMENT
3 - 57
3
3.11 Adjustment of the Developer Unit
3.11.1 Doctor-to-sleeve gap (black developer unit)Adjustment tool to use: Doctor-sleeve jig
Adjusting procedure:
(1) Take off the black developer unit from the equipment.(2) Remove 2 screws and take off the developer
material cover. Then discharge the devel-oper material.
Fig. 3-28
(3) Remove 2 screws, release the hook and take off the doctor blade cover.
Fig. 3-29
Developermaterial cover
Screw
Screw
Screw
Doctor bladecover
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedADJUSTMENT
3 - 58
Notes: 1. When confirming and adjusting the gap between the developer sleeve and the doctor blade,
insert the gauges into the gap after rotating the developer sleeve so that its marking faces the doctor blade.
2. While reattaching the black developer unit cover, set the latches securely.
(4) Loosen 2 doctor blade fixing screws. Insert the gauge “0.55” of the doctor sleeve jig between the developer sleeve and doctor blade to adjust the gap, and tighten the screws.
Fig. 3-30
(5) Insert the gauge “0.50” of the doctor-sleeve jig into the gap between the developer sleeve and doctor blade and make sure that the gauge can move smoothly in the front/rear direction. In addition, confirm that the gauge “0.60” cannot be inserted into the gap.
Fig. 3-31
Doctor-sleeve jig
Developer sleeve
Doctor blade
Screw
Developer sleeve
Doctor-sleeve jig
Doctor blade
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cADJUSTMENT
3 - 59
3
3.11.2 Doctor-to-sleeve gap (color developer unit)Adjustment tool to use : Doctor-sleeve jig
Adjusting procedure:
(1) Take off the color developer unit from the equipment.(2) Remove 2 screws, release 5 hooks and take
off the developer material cover. Then dis-charge the developer material.
Fig. 3-32
(3) Remove 4 screws and the toner-scattering prevention seal holder.
Fig. 3-33
(4) Loosen 2 doctor blade fixing screws. Insert the gauge “0.55” of the doctor-sleeve jig between the developer sleeve and doctor blade to adjust the gap, and tighten the screws.
Fig. 3-34
Screw
Screw
Developer material cover
ScrewToner-scattering preventionseal holder
Doctor-sleeve jig
Developer sleeve
Doctor blade
Screw
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedADJUSTMENT
3 - 60
Notes: 1. When confirming and adjusting the gap between the developer sleeve and the doctor blade,
insert the gauges into the gap after rotating the developer sleeve so that its marking faces the doctor blade.
2. While reattaching the color developer unit cover, set the latches securely.
(5) Insert the gauge “0.50” of the doctor-sleeve jig into the gap between the developer sleeve and doctor blade and make sure that the gauge can move smoothly in the front/rear direction. In addition, confirm that the gauge “0.60” cannot be inserted into the gap.
Fig. 3-35
Developer sleeve
Doctor-sleeve jig
Doctor blade
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cADJUSTMENT
3 - 61
3
3.11.3 Black developer unit lift up/down timing adjustmentPerform this adjustment only when the stop position of the black developer unit lift up/down lever devi-ates from the reference and a CEB0 error occurs.The reference position means that the rib of the developer unit cover and the cutout of the black devel-oper unit lift up/down lever are not overlapped as shown in Figure "A". (The cutout is in the 9 o'clock position.)
Adjustment procedure
(1) Perform 03-460 Black developer unit lifting movement ON/OFF (continuous lifting movement) and check the stop position of the black developer unit lifting lever. At this time, check the devia-tion amount between the rib and the cutout of the lever.
(2) The stop position is "B" (the cutout is lower than the reference position):Make the value of the adjustment code (05-499) smaller so that the stop position is closer to the reference. Making the value smaller by 1 turns the lever circumference by approx. 3 mm.
Note: Note: If the adjustment cannot be performed though 0 is input, the clutch may have failed. Examine the clutch.
(3) The stop position is "C" (the cutout is upper than the reference position):Make the value of the adjustment code (05-499) larger so that the stop position is closer to the reference. Making the value larger by 1 turns the lever circumference by approx. 3 mm.
Note: Note: If the adjustment cannot be performed though 8 is input, the clutch may have failed. Examine the clutch.
Note:If an error occurs even though this adjustment is performed, other causes may be considered. Examine and check the defect according to the methods in troubleshooting.
A
C
B
Rib
Cutout
Black developer unit
lifting lever
05/07
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedADJUSTMENT
3 - 62
Note: Note: Do not input more than 8 for acceptable value. (If a number from 9 to 255 is input, it is processed as 8.)
Relation between adjustment value and changing amount
* CW: ClockwiseCCW: Counter Clockwise
Code to be used for the adjustment
Adjustment mode (05)
Code Classifi-cation
Items Function Default <Accept-
able value>
RAM Contents Proce-dure
499 Develop-ment
Black developer unit lift up/down timing adjustment
ALL 4<0-255>
M Changes the lift up/down timing of the black devel-oper unit when a CEB0 error occurs.
1
Adjustment value
Changing amount for default value(Turning degree of black developer unit lift up/down lever)
0 Turning 32 degrees CW (approx. 12 mm in the lever circumference)
1 Turning 24 degrees CW (approx. 9 mm in the lever circumference)
2 Turning 16 degrees CW (approx. 6 mm in the lever circumference)
3 Turning 8 degrees CW (approx. 3 mm in the lever circumference)
4 Default value
5 Turning 8 degrees CCW (approx. 3 mm in the lever circumference)
6 Turning 16 degrees CCW (approx. 6 mm in the lever circumference)
7 Turning 24 degrees CCW (approx. 9 mm in the lever circumference)
8 Turning 32 degrees CCW (approx. 12 mm in the lever circumference)
05/07
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cADJUSTMENT
3 - 63
3
3.11.4 Adjustment of the drum-sleeve gap
Adjustment jig
1) PLATE-GAP-NO-GO-F: Drum-sleeve gap jig (Front)2) PLATE-GAP-NO-GO-R: Drum-sleeve gap jig (Reart)3) SHAFT-12-NO-GO: Drum-sleeve gap jig (Shaft)
Fig. 3-36
How to use
Insert the jig (PLATE-GAP-NO-GO-F and PLATE-GAP-NO-GO-R) between the drum and the devel-oper-sleeve gap jig (SHAFT-12-NO-GO). If the "GO" area can be inserted, the gap is appropriate, if not, it is too narrow. If the "NO-GO" area can be inserted, the gap is too wide. "Fixing the position by pushing the jig" is used for adjusting the gap to an appropriate dimension.
Fig. 3-37
Adjustment procedure
(1) Remove the color toner cartridge.(2) Remove the color developer unit.(3) Take off the inner tray.
1 2
3
For NO-GO Confirmation
For NO-GO Confirmation
GO GO
NO-GO
For PositioningFor Positioning
For Positioning
NO-GOStep
10/02
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedADJUSTMENT
3 - 64
(4) Take off the process unit, and then remove the transfer belt unit from it.* Refer to the Service Manual.
Fig. 3-38
(5) Loosen the 2 fixing screws of the bushing of the drum, move them to the right and tighten them to keep its position constant.
Fig. 3-39
(6) Remove the drum stay from the drum cleaner unit.
Fig. 3-40
(7) Align the position of the rail and the drum shaft, and insert the drum cleaner unit into the equip-
Transfer belt unit
Bushing
Screw
Drum stay
10/02
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cADJUSTMENT
3 - 65
3
ment. Fix it with 1 screw.
Fig. 3-41
Note: Note: Be careful not to damage the drum when inserting the drum cleaner unit.
(8) Fix the "rear" side (the one with the step) edge of the adjustment shaft temporarily while pushing it against step B of the revolver unit.
Fig. 3-42
Note: Note: When installing, be careful not to mix up the rear side (the one with the step) and the front side.
Screw
Rail
Holder
10/02
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedADJUSTMENT
3 - 66
(9) Push the holder in the direction of the arrow to fix the screws.
Fig. 3-43
(10) Plug in the power cable and close the front cover. While pressing [0] and [3] simultaneously, turn the power ON
(11) Key in the code [459] and press the [START] button.(12) Press the [START] button several times until the color of the unit you want to adjust comes to the
adjustable position. When the position is decided, press the [CLEAR] button.
Note: Note: It could cause injury as your hand or fingers could be caught in the revolver if the [CLEAR] button is not pressed. (After this step, perform the following without turning the power OFF to keep the revolver locked.)
10/02
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cADJUSTMENT
3 - 67
3
(13) Turn PLATE-GAP-NO-GO-F/R upside down and insert them between the drum and SHAFT-12-NO-GO, then drop them by their own weight. Check that they stop at the step area like B of the Criteria. (Be careful not to damage them on the drum by pushing too strongly.)
Fig. 3-44
Notes: • Be careful not to damage the drum during the adjustment.• Do not mix up PLATE-GAP-NO-GO-F and PLATE-GAP-NO-GO-R since their shapes are sim-
ilar.• Pick up PLATE-GAP-NO-GO-F/R lightly to confirm that the drum and the shaft are coherent
and subject to pressure.
* Criteria A: Rejected (Gap: Narrow) B: Accepted (Gap: Correct) C: Rejected (Gap: Wide)
Fig. 3-45
(14) If the gap is too narrow, follow step from (15) to (20). If it is too wide, skip step from (15) to (19) and proceed to (20).
(15) Key in the code [459] and press the [START] button.(16) Press the [START] button several times until the adjustment metal plate comes to the adjustable
position. When the position is decided, press the [CLEAR] button.
A B C
A3/LD Size
10/02
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedADJUSTMENT
3 - 68
(17) Rotate the revolver unit until the specified color developer unit comes to the adjustable position.Loosen the fixing screws of the adjustment metal plates (F/R), press them in the direction of the arrow, and then tighten the screws temporarily.
Fig. 3-46
(18) Key in the code [459] and press the [START] button.(19) Press the [START] button several times until the shaft comes to the measureable position of the
gap. When the position is decided, press the [CLEAR] button.(20) Insert PLATE-GAP-NO-GO-F and PLATE-GAP-NO-GO-R between the drum and SHAFT-12-
NO-GO, loosen the screws slightly and adjust the gap. Then, fix them with screws.
Fig. 3-47
Notes: • Be careful not to damage the drum during the adjustment.• Do not mix up PLATE-GAP-NO-GO-F and PLATE-GAP-NO-GO-R since their shapes are sim-
ilar.• Pick up PLATE-GAP-NO-GO-F/R lightly to confirm that the drum and the shaft are coherent
and subject to pressure.
Screw Screw
Adjustment metal plate (R) Adjustment metal plate (F)
Screw
Screw
10/02
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cADJUSTMENT
3 - 69
3
(21) Turn the power OFF.(22) Install all of the units and parts removed before the adjustment.(23) Turn the power ON.(24) Perform the image quality control.
P.3-5 "3.3 Performing Image Quality Control"(25) Perform the automatic gamma adjustment (for copying functions).
P.3-21 "3.5.1 Automatic gamma adjustment"(26) Perform the automatic gamma adjustment (for printing functions, PS3 / 600 dpi).
P.3-37 "3.6.1 Automatic gamma adjustment"(27) Perform the automatic gamma adjustment (for printing functions, PCL / 600 dpi).
P.3-37 "3.6.1 Automatic gamma adjustment"(28) Turn the power OFF.(29) While pressing [0] and [4] simultaneously, turn the power ON. Key in the code [231] and press
the [START] button to perform test printing for each color. Check whether the images have any problems.
(30) Turn the power OFF. The adjustment is completed.
Note: Note: In step (5), the bushing of the drum is moved to the right and tightened with the screws to keep its position constant. If it is removed when the drum is replaced after this adjustment, be sure to move it to the right and fix it to maintain the same drum-sleeve gap.
10/02
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedADJUSTMENT
3 - 70
3.12 Adjustment of the RADF (MR-3018)
3.12.1 Adjustment of RADF PositionPerform this adjustment when the RADF is not installed in the correct position.
Note: Note: Check if the image adjustment for the equipment is performed properly before this adjustment of the RADF.
[A] Checking
(1) Open the RADF and install 2 positioning pins (the positioning pins are installed to the back side of the hinge which is on the left side of the RADF).
Fig. 3-48
(2) Remove the platen sheet.
Fig. 3-49
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cADJUSTMENT
3 - 71
3
[B] Adjustment
If the pins cannot be fitted into the holes, perform the adjustment according to the following procedure.
(3) Close the RADF and check if the positioning pins fit the holes on the RADF.
Fig. 3-50
(1) Remove the right-hand hinge screw at the rear side.
Fig. 3-51
(2) Loosen the left-hand hinge screw at the rear side.
Fig. 3-52
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedADJUSTMENT
3 - 72
(3) Loosen the hinge screws at the front side.
Fig. 3-53
(4) Position the pins with the holes on the RADF by moving it so that the pins fit into the holes when the RADF is closed.
Fig. 3-54
(5) Tighten the left-hand hinge screw at the rear side.
Fig. 3-55
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cADJUSTMENT
3 - 73
3
(6) Loosen the hole position adjustment screws on the right hand side.
Fig. 3-56
(7) Match the screw hole positions.
Fig. 3-57
(8) Install the right-hand hinge screw at the rear side.
Fig. 3-58
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedADJUSTMENT
3 - 74
(9) Loosen the hinge screws at the front side.
Fig. 3-59
(10) Place the platen sheet on the original glass and align it to the top left corner.Close the RADF gently and open it to check if the platen sheet is attached properly.
Fig. 3-60
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cADJUSTMENT
3 - 75
3
3.12.2 Adjustment of RADF Height
Note: Note: Check if the image adjustment for the equipment is performed properly before this adjustment of the RADF.
[A] Checking
(1) Close the RADF.(2) Light the exposure lamp.
• Turn the power ON while pressing [0] and [3] simultaneously.• Key in [267] and then press the [START] button. The exposure lamp is turned ON for a given
length of time.(3) Visually check the gap between platen guide holder "A" and upper surface of the original glass
"B" from the left hand side of the equipment. If the value is not within the tolerance, perform the adjustment according to the following procedure.
[Tolerance of the gap]Rear side: 0 - 0.5 mmFront side: 0 mm
Fig. 3-61
[B] Adjustment
(1) Close the RADF.
0.2
-0.5
mm
0 m
m
B
A
B
A
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedADJUSTMENT
3 - 76
(2) Adjust it by turning the adjustment screws on the hinges.• Adjust the height on the rear side by means of the screw on the hinge on the feed side of the
RADF.Turn it clockwise ................. HeightenedTurn it counterclockwise ...... Lowered
Fig. 3-62
• Adjust the gap on the rear side by means of the screw on the hinge on the feed side of the RADF.
Turn it clockwis .................... LoweredTurn it counterclockwise ...... Heightened
Fig. 3-63
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cADJUSTMENT
3 - 77
3
3.12.3 Adjustment of Skew
Note: Note: Check if the image adjustment for the equipment is performed properly before this adjustment of the RADF. Also, the RADF position and height shall be adjusted properly.
[A] Checking
Check the image using the chart (original) with vertical and horizontal lines in the following procedure.
Fig. 3-64 Chart (Original)
Simplex copying:
(1) Place the chart provided as an original with its face up on the original tray of the RADF, select [1 Sided -> 1 Sided] and press the [START] button.
(2) Superimpose the chart on the copy and check the inclination of the copy image.
Duplex copying:
(1) Place the chart provided as an original with its face up on the original tray of the RADF, select [2 Sided -> 2 Sided] and press the [START] button.
(2) Superimpose the chart on the copy and check the inclination of the copy image.
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedADJUSTMENT
3 - 78
[B] Adjustment
Simplex copying:
(1) Shift the aligning plate with the scale as the guide shown in the figure below to adjust the skew.
Fig. 3-65
(2) If the image skew is "C" as shown in the figure below, shift the aligning plate in the direction of "+", and if "D", shift it to "-".
Fig. 3-66 Fig. 3-67
Shift the aligning plate in the direction of "+". Shift the aligning plate in the direction of "-".
C
D
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cADJUSTMENT
3 - 79
3
Duplex copying:
(1) Shift the aligning plate with the scale as the guide shown in the figure below to adjust the skew.
Fig. 3-68
(2) If the image skew is "C" as shown in the figure below, shift the aligning plate in the direction of "-", and if "D", shift it to "+".
Fig. 3-69 Fig. 3-70
Shift the aligning plate in the direction of "-". Shift the aligning plate in the direction of "+".
C
D
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedADJUSTMENT
3 - 80
3.12.4 Adjustment of the Leading Edge Position
Note: Note: Check if the image adjustment for the equipment is performed properly before this adjustment of the RADF. Also, the RADF position and height shall be adjusted properly.
[A] Checking
Check the image using the chart (original) with vertical and horizontal lines in the following procedure.
Simplex copying:
(1) Place the chart provided as an original with its face up on the original tray of the RADF, select [1 Sided -> 1 Sided] and press the [START] button.
(2) Superimpose the chart on the copy and check the leading edge E of the chart and F of the copy.
Duplex copying:
(1) Place the chart provided as an original with its face up on the original tray of the RADF, select [2 Sided -> 2 Sided] and press the [START] button.
(2) Superimpose the chart on the copy and check the leading edge E of the chart and F of the copy.
[B] Adjustment
Simplex copying:
(1) Turn the power ON while pressing [0] and [5] simultaneously, key in [365] and then press the [START] button.
(2) Enter the value.• If the leading edge (F) margin of the copy image is larger than the (E) margin of the chart,
enter a value smaller than the current one.
Note: Note: Changing one value shifts the copy image by 0.1 mm.
• If the leading edge (F) margin of the copy image is smaller than the (E) margin of the chart, enter a value larger than the current one.
Note: Note: Changing one value shifts the copy image by 0.1 mm.
(3) Press the [ENTER] button.
Fig. 3-71 Chart (Original) Fig. 3-72 Copy
E F
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cADJUSTMENT
3 - 81
3
Duplex copying:
(1) Turn the power ON while pressing [0] and [5] simultaneously, key in [366] and then press the [START] button.
(2) Enter the value.• If the leading edge (F) margin of the copy image is larger than the (E) margin of the chart,
enter a value smaller than the current one.
Note: Note: Changing one value shifts the copy image by 0.1 mm.
• If the leading edge (F) margin of the copy image is smaller than the (E) margin of the chart, enter a value larger than the current one.
Note: Note: Changing one value shifts the copy image by 0.1 mm.
(3) Press the [ENTER] button.
3.12.5 Adjustment of Horizontal Position
Note: Note: Check if the image adjustment for the equipment is performed properly before this adjustment of the RADF. Also, the RADF position and height shall be adjusted properly.
[A] Checking
Check the image using the chart (original) with a center line in the following procedure.
(1) Place the chart provided as an original with its face up on the original tray of the RADF.(2) Press the [START] button.(3) Fold the copy in half and check if the center line is misaligned.
[B] Adjustment
(1) Turn the power ON while pressing [0] and [5] simultaneously.(2) Key in [358] and then press the [START] button.
• If the center line of the copy image is shifted to the front side of the equipment, enter a value larger than the current one.
Note: Note: Changing one value shifts the copy image by 0.042 mm.
Fig. 3-73
• If the center line of the copy image is shifted to the rear side of the equipment, enter a value smaller than the current one.
G
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedADJUSTMENT
3 - 82
Note: Note: Changing one value shifts the copy image by 0.042 mm.
Fig. 3-74
(3) Press the [ENTER] button.
H
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cADJUSTMENT
3 - 83
3
3.12.6 Adjustment of Copy Ratio
Note: Note: Check if the image adjustment for the equipment is performed properly before this adjustment of the RADF. Also, the RADF position and height shall be adjusted properly.
[A] Checking
Check the image using the chart (original) with vertical and horizontal lines in the following procedure.
(1) Place the chart provided as an original with its face up on the original tray of the RADF.(2) Press the [START] button.(3) Superimpose the chart on the copy and check the image dimension “I”.
[B] Adjustment
(1) Turn the power ON while pressing [0] and [5] simultaneously.(2) Key in [357] and then press the [START] button.
• If the copy image dimension “I” is larger than the chart dimension, enter a value smaller than the current one.
• If the copy image dimension “I” is smaller than the chart dimension, enter a value larger than the current one.
Fig. 3-75
(3) Press the [ENTER] button.
I
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedADJUSTMENT
3 - 84
3.12.7 Adjustment of RADF Opening/Closing SensorAdjust the bracket position so that the sensor is turned ON when the height “A” becomes 100 mm or less (within the empty weight falling limit).
Fig. 3-76
Fig. 3-77
A
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cADJUSTMENT
3 - 85
3
3.13 Adjustment of the Finisher (MJ-1022)
3.13.1 Adjusting the jogging plate width
(1) Remove the right inner cover and the rear cover.
(4) Measure the jogging width (standard at 317 mm).
(2) Adjust the front jogging plate to the home position.• Set SW1 on the finisher controller PC
board as shown in Fig. 3-1301.• Press SW2 twice on the finisher controller
PC board.- The front jogging plate moves to the
home position. Fig. 3-78
(3) Adjust the rear jogging plate to the home position.• Set SW1 on the finisher controller PC
board as shown in Fig. 3-1302.
• Press SW2 twice on the finisher controller PC board.- The rear jogging plate moves to the
home position.
Fig. 3-79
Fig. 3-80
ON
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
ON
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
Rear jogging plate home position
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedADJUSTMENT
3 - 86
(5) Remove the processing tray.(6) Loosen the screw on the home position sen-
sor plate at the front.
Fig. 3-81
(7) Adjust the position of the front jogging plate home position sensor (S6) with reference to the index.EX. 1If the width is 319 mm in step (2), the differ-ence from the standard is +2 mm, it requires relocation of the sensor [3] in the direction of arrow A by 2 mm.EX. 2If the width is 316 mm in step (2), the differ-ence from the standard is -1 mm; it requires relocation of the sensor [3] in the direction of arrow B by 1 mm.
Fig. 3-82
Screw
Home position
sensor plate
Sensor
A B
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cADJUSTMENT
3 - 87
3
3.13.2 Adjusting the angle of the jogging plate
(3) With reference to the rear jogging plate adjusted in step (2), adjust the front jogging plate in the same manner.
(1) Without removing the processing tray unit, loosen the 2 mounting screws of the rear jog-ging plate.
Fig. 3-83
(2) Place several sheets of A4/LT paper on the processing tray, and adjust the rear jogging plate. (At this time, adjust the gap between the paper and the front end of the rear jog-ging plate so that it is 0 mm to 0.5 mm.)
Fig. 3-84
Screw Rear jogging plate
Paper
Butted
0 mm to 0.5 mm
Screw
Rear jogging
plate
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedADJUSTMENT
3 - 88
3.13.3 Adjusting the overlap of the sensor flagIf the overlap between the sensor and the flag is wrong for some reason, perform the following adjust-ment.
(1) Remove the processing tray unit.(2) Loosen the mounting screw of the front/rear
jogging plate adjusting plate; then, move the adjusting plate to the left and the right.
Fig. 3-85
(3) Tighten the screw so that the overlap between the flag of the front/rear jogging rack plate and the sensor is 1.5 mm to 2.0 mm.
Fig. 3-86
Jogging plate
adjusting plate Screw
Adjusting plate Screw Jogging plate
adjusting plateAdjusting plate
Sensor Sensor flag
1.5 mm to 2.0 mm
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cADJUSTMENT
3 - 89
3
3.13.4 Adjusting the tension of the stack processing motor belt
(1) Remove the right inner cover and the rear cover.(2) Remove the 2 mounting screws, and detach
the grip unit.
Fig. 3-87
(3) Loosen the screw on the tension arm plate. (The tension arm plate will be pulled under tension by the tension spring.)
Fig. 3-88
Screw Grip unit Screw
Screw Tension arm plate
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedADJUSTMENT
3 - 90
(4) Move the returning roller shaft to its lower limit (the slack of a belt is lightly taken); then, tighten the screw on the tension arm plate.
Fig. 3-89
(5) Check to make sure that the returning roller shaft moves smoothly.
Fig. 3-90
Screw Tension armplate
Returningroller shaft
Returningroller shaft
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cADJUSTMENT
3 - 91
3
3.13.5 Releasing the stack tray guide lever fixing plate
(1) Remove the right inner cover and the rear cover.(2) Remove the finisher control PC board, PC board bracket and sensor PC board.(3) Remove the stack tray.(4) Remove the stack tray drive unit.
Note: Note: When removing the mounting screw, be sure to hold the stack tray guide lever up from below.
Fig. 3-92
(5) Place the stack tray guide lever fixing plate so that it is in view through the hole in the side plate (front, rear). Then remove the fix-ing screw. (Perform the same for the front and the rear.)
Fig. 3-91
Screw
Stack tray guide leverfixing plate
Stack trayguide lever
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedADJUSTMENT
3 - 92
3.13.6 Adjustment of the upper tray angle
(1) Remove the front cover.
Fig. 3-93
(2) Loosen the screw denoted with the arrow.
Fig. 3-94
(3) The tension becomes loose.While pushing the bracket down, hold the tray and move it up or down, to adjust the angle so that the tray becomes parallel by a visual check.
Fig. 3-95
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cADJUSTMENT
3 - 93
3
Note: Note: If the fixing screw of the bracket is not fixed, the belt is loosened which may cause a skipped tooth.
(4) After the height adjustment, tighten the fixing screw of the bracket.
Fig. 3-96
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedADJUSTMENT
3 - 94
3.13.7 DIP switch functionsYou can simulate various functions by setting the DIP switch (SW1) on the finisher controller PC board appropriately.
Initiating Operations1) Remove any obstacles from the area of operation.2) Set the DIP switch (SW1) as shown, and turn ON the power (so that LED1 will start to blink).3) Press the pushing switch (SW2) twice to initiate the operation in question. (LED2 will remain on dur-
ing operation).Setting Item Operation To stop
Delivery motor The delivery roller rotates in a specific speed.
• Press SW2 again.• Turn OFF the joint
sensor (S4).
Stack processing motor (stack delivery lever)
The stack delivery lever moves to its home position and stops.
• Turn OFF the joint sensor (S4).
Stack processing motor (returning roller)
The returning roller moves to the home position and stops.
• Turn OFF the joint sensor (S4).
Front jogging plate motor
When not at the home position
The front jogging plate moves to its home position and stops.
• Turn OFF the joint sensor (S4).
When at the home position
The front jogging plate moves over a specific position and stops at the home position.
• Turn OFF the joint sensor (S4).
Rear jogging plate motor
When not at the home position
The rear jogging plate moves to the home position and stops.
• Turn OFF the joint sensor (S4).
When at the home position
The rear jogging plate moves over a specific distance and stops.
• Turn OFF the joint sensor (S4).
Upper stack tray motor (up)
The upper stack tray moves up and stops when the upper stack tray upper limit sensor turns ON.
• Press SW2 again.• Turn OFF the joint
sensor (S4).
Upper stack tray motor (down)
The upper stack tray moves down and stops when the lower stack tray lower limit sensor turns ON.
• Press SW2 again.• Turn OFF the joint
sensor (S4).
Lower stack tray motor (up)
The lower stack tray moves up and stops when the lower stack tray upper limit sensor is turned ON.
• Press SW2 again.• Turn OFF the joint
sensor (S4).
ON
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
ON
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
ON
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
ON
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
ON
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
ON
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
ON
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
ON
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cADJUSTMENT
3 - 95
3
Note: Note: Perform the shipping position operation when the finisher is packed again.
Lower stack tray motor (down)
The lower stack tray moves down and stops when the lower stack tray lower limit sensor is turned ON.
• Press SW2 again.• Turn OFF the joint
sensor (S4).
Stapler motor The stapler motor stops after the stapling operation.
• Press the stapler safety switch (S14).
• Turn OFF the joint sensor (S4).
Shipping posi-tion operation
The upper and lower stack trays move to the shipping position and stop.
• Turn OFF the joint sensor (S4).
Setting Item Operation To stop
ON
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
ON
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
ON
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedADJUSTMENT
3 - 96
3.14 Adjustment of the Finisher (MJ-1023/1024)
3.14.1 Adjusting the alignment position (Finisher unit)Perform this adjustment after replacing the finisher controller PC board or when the alignment position must be changed for some reason.
(1) Remove the rear cover of the finisher unit.(2) Check that the power is OFF and set SW104 on the finisher controller PC board as follows
according to the paper used for adjustment.
Fig. 3-97
(3) Turn ON the power.(4) Press SW103 on the finisher controller PC board.
• When SW103 is pressed, the swing guide opens and the alignment plate moves to prescribed position.
(5) Place ten sheets of A4/LT paper between the alignment plates and push them against the stop-per.
(6) Press SW101 or SW102 on the finisher controller PC board and push the alignment plate against the paper.• When SW101 is pressed, alignment plate moves 0.42 mm forward.• When SW102 is pressed, alignment plate moves 0.42 mm backward.
(7) When adjustment is complete, remove paper and press SW103 on the finisher controller PC board once to store the adjustment in memory.
(8) Turn OFF all bits of finisher controller PC board SW104.(9) Turn OFF the power and install the rear cover of the finisher unit.
ON
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
ON
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
A4 paper LT paper
06/08
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cADJUSTMENT
3 - 97
3
3.14.2 Adjusting the staple position (Finisher unit)Perform this adjustment after replacing the finisher controller PC board or when the staple position must be changed for some reason. This adjustment adjusts the front/rear stitches with A4/A4-R when the paper used for adjustment is AB type and with LT/LT-R when the paper is INCH type.
(1) Remove the rear cover of the finisher unit.(2) Check that the power is OFF and set SW104 on the finisher controller PC board as follows
according to paper/stitch position used for adjustment.
Fig. 3-98
(3) Turn ON the power.(4) Press SW103 on the finisher controller PC board.
• When SW103 is pressed, the swing guide opens and the alignment plate moves to prescribed position.
(5) Place a sheet of paper between the alignment plates. Push it against the stopper and push the rear edge of the paper against the rear alignment plate. If the gap between the front alignment plate and front edge of the paper is 1 mm or greater, stop the staple position adjustment and repeat the staple position adjustment after completing alignment plate adjustment.
(6) Press SW103 on the finisher controller PC board once to staple. However, remove the stapled paper manually because the paper is not ejected. Press SW103 on the finisher controller PC board once again.
(7) Verify the staple position. If any adjustment is needed, proceed to the step 8). If no adjustment is needed, proceed to the step 9).
(8) Press SW101 or SW102 on the finisher controller PC board to adjust the staple position.• When SW101 is pressed, the staple position shifts 0.49 mm to the front side.• When SW102 is pressed, the staple position shifts 0.49 mm to the rear side.Repeat the steps 5) to 7).
ON
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
ON
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
ON
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
ON
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
ON
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
ON
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
ON
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
ON
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
A4/front stitch A4/rear stitch
A4-R/front stitch A4-R/rear stitch
LT/front stitch LT/rear stitch
LT-R/front stitch LT-R/rear stitch
06/08
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedADJUSTMENT
3 - 98
(9) After confirming that the staple position is adjusted correctly, place a sheet of paper between the alignment plates and push it against the stopper and push the rear edge of the paper against the rear alignment plate. Then press SW103 once. (Stapling is performed and the adjustment value is stored in memory.)• The staple position adjustment is completed.
(10) Turn OFF all bits of SW104 on the finisher controller PC board.(11) Turn OFF the power and install the rear cover of the finisher unit.
3.14.3 Adjusting the folding position (Saddle stitcher unit)The folding position is adjusted by changing setting of bits 6 through 8 of SW504 on the saddle stitcher controller PC board to match the stitching position (adjusting the distance over which the paper posi-tioning plate is moved to the folding position from the stitching position).If you have replaced the saddle stitcher controller PC board, be sure to set the new SW504 so that the settings will be the same as those on the old SW504. Perform this adjustment if, for any reason, you must change the folding position.
(1) Check that the power is OFF and separate the finisher from the host machine. If the optional puncher unit is installed, remove it from the finisher.
(2) Remove the PC board cover and set bits 1 through 4 of SW504 on the saddle stitcher controller PC board as follows:
Fig. 3-99
(3) Remove the rear cover, open the inlet cover of the saddle stitcher unit and tape the actuator of inlet cover sensor (PI9) and inlet door switch (SW1).
ON
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
Do not change bits 5 through 8.
06/08
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cADJUSTMENT
3 - 99
3
(4) Before inserting the paper, mark the top of the paper. You will be using two sheets of A3 or LD paper.
Fig. 3-100
(5) Turn ON the power.(6) Press SW1 on the saddle stitcher controller PC board so that the feed motor (M1) starts to rotate.
(Press SW1 three seconds or more if LD paper is used.)(7) Open the inlet cover and insert two sheets of paper. Push them in by hand until the front edge of
the sheets push against the paper positioning plate.(8) Close the inlet cover.(9) Press SW1 on the saddle stitcher controller PC board.
• The saddle stitcher unit will “stitch” the sheets, and fold and deliver the stack automatically.
Mark
A3/LD paper
Insert direction
06/08
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedADJUSTMENT
3 - 100
(10) Measure the distance (L) between the stitching position and the folding position. Then perform “positive width adjustment” or “negative width adjustment” to suit the relationship between the stitching position and the folding position.• If the stitching position is below the folding position, perform “positive width adjustment.”• If the stitching position is above the folding position, perform “negative width adjustment.”
Fig. 3-101
(11) Change the settings of bits 6 through 8 on SW504 referring to the following table.• If the width adjustment is 0
The stitching position and the folding position match, requiring no change.• If for “positive width adjustment”
Set SW504 so that the difference resulting from subtraction of the interval from the appropri-ate setting in the table below is provided.Example: If SW504 is currently set to +2 and the interval is +1 mm, set SW504 to reflect - 2.
• If for “negative width adjustment”Set SW504 so that the sum resulting from addition of the interval from the appropriate setting in the table below is provided.Example: If SW504 is currently set to -1 and the interval is -0.5mm, set SW504 to reflect +1.
(12) Set SW504 bits 1 to 4 to OFF.
DIPSW1 bit settings Setting(in units of 0.5 mm)Bit 6 Bit 7 Bit 8
OFF ON ON +3
OFF ON OFF +2
OFF OFF ON +1
OFF OFF OFF 0
ON OFF ON -1
ON ON OFF -2
ON ON ON -3
Do not use the following setting
Bit 6 Bit 7 Bit 8
ON OFF OFF
Mark
Stitching positionFolding position
Unit: mm
Example: If L is 0.5 mm, provide "-0.5 mm".
Mark
Folding positionStitching position
Unit: mm
Example: If L is 1 mm, provide "+1 mm".
Positive Width Adjustment Negative Width Adjustment
L
L
06/08
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cADJUSTMENT
3 - 101
3
3.14.4 Fine adjustment of binding/folding position (Saddle stitcher unit)The binding position/folding position can be adjusted in the following (05) codes.
Increase the adjustment value when the sheet of paper which has exited is "A".Decrease the adjustment value when the sheet of paper which has exited is "B".
Fig. 3-102
3.14.5 Sensor output adjustment (Puncher unit)Perform this adjustment when replacing the punch controller PC board, transmittance sensor (photo-sensor PC board/LED PC board), or deflection sensor (scrap full detector PC board unit).
(1) Check that the power is OFF and then remove the rear cover of the puncher.(2) Set SW601 on the punch controller PC board as shown below.
Fig. 3-103
(3) Turn ON the power.(4) Press SW602 on the punch controller PC board. Sensor output is adjusted automatically when
the switch is pressed.• Adjustment is complete if LED601 and LED602 on the punch controller PC board blinks alter-
nately.(5) Press SW602 or SW603 on the punch controller PC board to end the adjustment mode and set
all bits of SW601 to OFF.(6) Turn OFF the power.
Code Paper size Remarks
468-0 A4-R / LT-R When the value increases, the binding/folding position shifts toward the right page. (0.25mm/step)Acceptable values: -14 to 14 (Default: 0)468-1 B4
468-2 A3 / LD
A: When the upper side of the folding
is longer than the lower side
B: When the upper side of the folding is
shorter than the lower side
Paper feeding direction Paper feeding direction
ON
1 2 3 4
06/08
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedADJUSTMENT
3 - 102
3.14.6 Registering the number of punch holes (Puncher unit)This operation registers which puncher unit is attached to the IC on the punch driver PC board so that the puncher unit can be identified by the finisher. For this reason, this operation must be performed when the punch driver PC board has been replaced.
(1) Check that the power is OFF and then remove the rear cover of the puncher.(2) Set SW601 on the punch controller PC board as shown below.
Fig. 3-104
(3) Turn ON the power.(4) Press SW602 on the punch controller PC board to select the number of punch holes.
• The items in the following table are displayed repeatedly from top to bottom each time SW602 is pressed.
(5) Press SW603 on the punch controller PC board. The number of punch holes is registered to the punch controller PC board each time the switch is pressed.• Registration is complete if LED601 and LED602 on the punch controller PC board blinks
alternately.(6) Press SW602 or SW603 on the punch controller PC board to end the adjustment mode and set
all bits of SW601 to OFF.(7) Turn OFF the power.
Number of punch holes LED601/LED602
2 hole (E) Blinks 1 times per cycle
2/3 hole (N) Blinks 2 times per cycle
4 hole (F) Blinks 3 times per cycle
4 hole (S) Blinks 4 times per cycle
ON
1 2 3 4
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cADJUSTMENT
3 - 103
3
3.15 Adjustment of the Finisher (MJ-1101)Note: Note:
Before performing each adjustment, make sure that all covers (incl. those of the finisher and host machine) are closed. Otherwise, the power is not supplied to the finisher and the adjustment may not be performed properly.
3.15.1 Adjusting the Alignment PositionPerform this adjustment after replacing the Finisher control board or when the alignment position must be changed for some reason.
(1) Turn OFF the power of the equipment.
(2) Remove 1 screw and take off the board access cover.
(3) Set the SW1 on the Finisher control board as shown in the figures below.
Fig. 3-105
Fig. 3-106
(4) Turn ON the power of the equipment while [0] button and [8] button are pressed simultaneously.The alignment plate moves to the A4 or LT size position and stops.(It stops at the position of -5 steps from the center value of the adjustment range.)
SW1
Access cover
ON
1 2 3 4
ON
1 2 3 4
Adjusting forA4 size paper
Adjusting forLT size paper
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedADJUSTMENT
3 - 104
(5) Press the [Button1] to adjust the alignment position.Every time the [Button1] is pressed, the alignment plate shifts 1 step (0.419 mm/step) toward the “+ “direction. (The gap between the alignment plates becomes narrower.)Adjustment range is from -5 to +5 steps.If the [Button1] is pressed when the alignment position is at the “+5 step”, the plate will return to the home position and then moves to the position of “-5 step”.
Fig. 3-107
(6) When the adjustment is completed, press the [Button2] on the finisher control panel to store the adjustment value in memory.When the value is stored normally, the [LED1] on the control panel will blink for a number of times that corresponds to the adjustment value set for the equipment.See the following table for the number of times the [LED1] blinks and its corresponding adjust-ment value.
(7) Turn OFF the power of the equipment.
(8) Turn OFF all bits of the SW1 on the Finisher control board.
(9) Install the board access cover.
Number of Blinking Adjustment Value
1 -5
2 -4
3 -3
4 -2
5 -1
6 0
7 +1
8 +2
9 +3
10 +4
11 +5
LED3 LED2 LED1
Button2Button1
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cADJUSTMENT
3 - 105
3
3.15.2 Adjusting the Stapling PositionPerform this adjustment after replacing the Finisher control board or when the stapling position must be changed for some reason.
(1) Turn OFF the power of the equipment.
(2) Remove 1 screw and take off the board access cover.
(3) Set the SW1 on the Finisher control board as shown in the figures below.
Fig. 3-108
Fig. 3-109
(4) Turn ON the power of the equipment while [0] button and [8] button are pressed simultaneously.The alignment plate moves to the rear or front side stapling position and stops. (It stops at the position of -20 steps from the center value of the adjustment range.)
SW1
Access cover
ON
1 2 3 4
ON
1 2 3 4
ON
1 2 3 4
ON
1 2 3 4
When adjusting the rear side for A4 size paper
When adjusting the rear side for LT size paper
When adjusting the front side for A4 size paper
When adjusting the front side for LT size paper
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedADJUSTMENT
3 - 106
(5) Press [Button 1] to adjust the stapling position.Every time [Button 1] is pressed, the alignment plate shifts 4 steps (0.45 mm) toward the "+" direction. (It moves toward the rear side.)Adjustment range is from -20 to +20 steps. If [Button 1] is pressed when the alignment position is at the “+20 steps”, the plate will return to the home position and then moves to the position of “-20 steps”.
Note: Note: Stapling for checking the position can be done by pressing [Button 2] with sheets placed on the finishing tray. (stapled on the rear side)
Fig. 3-110
(6) When the adjustment is completed, press [Button 2] on the finisher control panel to store the adjustment value in memory without sheets on the finishing tray.When the value is stored normally, [LED 1] on the control panel will blink for a number of times that corresponds to the adjustment value set for the equipment.See the following table for the number of times [LED 1] blinks and its corresponding adjustment value.
(7) Turn OFF the power of the equipment.
(8) Turn OFF all bits of the SW1 on the Finisher control board.
(9) Install the board access cover.
Number of blinking Adjustment value
1 -20
2 -16
3 -12
4 -8
5 -4
6 0
7 +4
8 +8
9 +12
10 +16
11 +20
LED3 LED2 LED1
Button2Button1
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cADJUSTMENT
3 - 107
3
3.15.3 B4-size recycled paper mode settingsSet this mode if the trailing edge of the paper gets caught by the exit section of the finisher while B4-size recycled paper is used. This mode increases the paper exiting speed when the paper exits to the movable tray in the sort mode, or to the stationary tray in the non-sort mode.
(1) Turn OFF the power of the equipment.
(2) Remove 1 screw and take off the board access cover.
(3) Set the SW1 on the Finisher control board as shown in the figures below.
Fig. 3-111
Fig. 3-112
(4) Turn ON the power of the equipment while [0] button and [8] button are pressed simultaneously.
SW1
Access cover
ON
1 2 3 4
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedADJUSTMENT
3 - 108
(5) Press [Button1] and [Button2] as described in the following table to set the B4-size recycled paper mode. Press [Button1] and [Button2] on the control panel as below to set the B4-size recy-cled paper mode.
Note: Note: Be sure to press [Button1] and [Button2] the correct number of times.Press [Button1] and [Button2] simultaneously to cancel the operation.
Fig. 3-113
Note: Note: To change settings from the B4-size recycled paper mode to the normal mode, perform steps (1) through (4), and then press [Button1] and [Button2] on the control panel as shown below to set the normal mode.
(6) When the settings are stored normally, [LED1] on the control panel is lit. [LED1] blinks, if an error occurs. In this case, turn the power OFF and make the settings again from step (4).
(7) Turn OFF the power of the equipment.
(8) Turn OFF all bits of the SW1 on the Finisher control board.
(9) Install the board access cover.
B4-size recycled paper mode
Step Buttons Number of pressing Remarks
1 Button1 1
2 Button2 1 Confirms the input value
3 Button1 8
4 Button2 1 Confirms the input value
Normal mode
Step Buttons Number of pressing Remarks
1 Button1 1
2 Button2 1 Confirms the input value
3 Button1 6
4 Button2 1 Confirms the input value
LED3 LED2 LED1
Button2Button1
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cPREVENTIVE MAINTENANCE (PM)
4 - 1
4
4. PREVENTIVE MAINTENANCE (PM)
4.1 PM Support Mode
4.1.1 General descriptionThe timing for the parts replacement usually depends on the number of output pages / develop counts after they were replaced before. However, the life span of them changes depending on the general use of users and the environment in which the equipment is placed. Therefore, it is necessary to consider not only the number of output pages but also the drive counts when deciding the timing for the parts replacement in order to utilize the parts and materials effectively.In addition, the drum rotates 4 times at color modes to transfer the images of 4 colors on the transfer belt, overlaying one after another. Therefore, the number of output pages is counted as “4” for 1 page for printing at color mode.This equipment has the PM support mode, which makes it possible to see the general use of each part (the number of output pages, develop counts and drive counts) and replacement record and to do a counter clearing operation more efficiently when replacing.The replacement record can be printed out in the list printing mode (9S-103).
4.1.2 Operational flow and operational screen
[ 1 ] Operational flow
Fig. 4-1
PM support mode activated
[6]+[START]+[POWER]ON
Main screen
Main unit list displayed
Sub screen
Sub unit list displayed
Clear screen
Counter clearconfirmation displayed
Counter clear performed
[RETURN]pressed
[CANCEL] pressed
[RETURN] pressed
[CANCEL]pressed
[INITIALIZE]pressed
Clear finished
Clear finished
[2]
Main unit chosen [SUB UNIT] pressed
Main unit chosen [RESET]
[START]
Sub unit chosen
[RESET] pressed
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedPREVENTIVE MAINTENANCE (PM)
4 - 2
* The screen goes back to the main screen when the counter clear is performed or the [CANCEL] button is pressed after moving from the main screen, while it goes back to the sub screen after moving from the sub screen.
[ 2 ] Operational screen1) Main screen
Fig. 4-2
Displaying of the main unit name
Back to the PM support mode activation screen
Moving to the clear screen to clear the selected unit counters and , including all sub unit (parts) counters belonging to that unit When the unit is not selected, all counters are cleared.
Moving to the sub screen of the selected unit
Moving to the next/previous page
Displaying of the standard number of output pages / develop counts (x1,000) to replace the unit partsDisplaying of the present drive counts (x1,000)“*” is displayed next to the present number when the number of drive counts has exceeded its PM standard number.
Displaying of the standard number of drive counts (x1,000) to replace the unit parts
Displaying of the present number of output pages/develop counts (x1,000)When there are differences among the sub units (parts), “_” is displayed and “CHECK SUB-UNIT” is displayed at the top“*” is displayed next to the present number when the number of output pages or develop counts has exceeded its PM standard number.Displaying of the number of output pages / develop counts (Page/D. cnt), drive counts (Cnt.) and previous replacement date (Chg.) for a chosen unitWhen the replacement date for the sub unit is different, press the [SUB UNIT] button to move to the sub screen and see each information, otherwise information is not displayed
1
2 3 4 5 6
910
7 8
1
2
3 9 7
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cPREVENTIVE MAINTENANCE (PM)
4 - 3
4
Notes: 1. “—” is always displayed at the drive counts section for the reversing automatic document
feeder (RADF) and feed unit.2. “—” is displayed at the numeric section for the paper source which is not installed since the
paper source is different depending on the structure of options.
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedPREVENTIVE MAINTENANCE (PM)
4 - 4
2) Sub screen
Fig. 4-3
Displaying of the sub unit (parts) name
Back to the main screen
Moving to the clear screen to clear the selected unit (parts) counters
Moving to the next/previous page
Displaying of the present number of output pages / develop counts (x1,000)“*” is displayed next to the present number when the number of output pages or develop counts has exceeded its PM standard number.
Displaying of the standard number of output pages / develop counts (x1,000) to replace the sub unit (parts)
Displaying of the present drive counts (x1,000)“*” is displayed next to the present number when the number of drive counts has exceeded its PM standard number.
Displaying of the standard number of drive counts (x1,000) to replace the sub unit (parts)
Displaying of the number of output pages, develop counts and drive counts and previous replacement date for a chosen sub unit
1
2 3 4 5 6
9
7 8
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cPREVENTIVE MAINTENANCE (PM)
4 - 5
4
3) Clear screen
Fig. 4-4
When the [CANCEL] button is pressed, the counter is not cleared and the display returns to the main or sub screen..
When the [INITIALIZE] button is pressed, “Present number of output pages/develop counts” and Present driving counts” are cleared and “Previous replacement date” is updated.
21
1
2
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedPREVENTIVE MAINTENANCE (PM)
4 - 6
[ 3 ] Access tree
Note: Note: The name inside [ ] is displayed on the LCD screen.
Main screen Sub-screen
Drum/cleaner unit[CLEANER/DRUM]
Drum [DRUM]Drum cleaning blade [DRUM BLADE]Drum cleaner brush [DRUM BRUSH]
Main charger unit[MAIN CHARGER]
Main charger grid [GRID]Main charger wire [MAIN CHARGER WIRE]Main charger wire pad [WIRE CLEANING PAD]
Ozone filter[FILTER]
Ozone filter [OZONE FILTER]
Black developer unit[BLACK DEVELOPER]
Developer material K [BLACK DEVELOPER]
Color developer unit[COLOR DEVELOPER]
Developer material Y [YELLOW DEVELOPER]Developer material M [MAGENTA DEVELOPER]Developer material C [CYAN DEVELOPER]
Transfer belt cleaning unit[TRANSFER BELT CLEANER]
Transfer belt cleaning blade [BELT CLEANING BLADE]
2nd transfer roller unit[2nd TRANSFER]
2nd transfer roller [2nd TRANSFER ROLLER]
Fuser unit[FUSER]
Fuser belt [FUSER BELT]Pressure roller [PRESS ROLLER]Oil roller [OIL ROLLER]Cleaning roller [CLEANING ROLLER]Separation finger [PRESS ROLLER FINGER]Fuser belt guide [BELT GUIDE]Pressure roller discharge brush [PRESS ROLLER ERASER BRUSH]
Upper drawer[1st CST.]
Pickup roller [PICK UP ROLLER(1st CST.)]Feed roller [FEED ROLLER(1st CST.)]Separation roller [SEP ROLLER(1st CST.)]
Lower drawer[2nd CST.]
Pickup roller [PICK UP ROLLER(2nd CST.)]Feed roller [FEED ROLLER(2nd CST.)]Separation roller [SEP ROLLER(2nd CST.)]
Bypass unit[SFB]
Pickup roller [PICK UP ROLLER(SFB)]Feed roller [FEED ROLLER(SFB)]Separation roller [SEP ROLLER(SFB)]
RADF[RADF]
Pickup roller [PICK UP ROLLER(RADF)]Feed roller [FEED ROLLER(RADF)]Separation roller [SEP ROLLER(RADF)]
LCF[LCF]
Pickup roller [PICK UP ROLLER(LCF)]Feed roller [FEED ROLLER(LCF)]Separation roller [SEP ROLLER(LCF)]
PFP upper drawer[3rd CST.]
Pickup roller [PICK UP ROLLER(3rd CST.)]Feed roller [FEED ROLLER(3rd CST.)]Separation roller [SEP ROLLER(3rd CST.)]
PFP lower drawer[4th CST.]
Pickup roller [PICK UP ROLLER(4th CST.)]Feed roller [FEED ROLLER(4th CST.)]Separation roller [SEP ROLLER(4th CST.)]
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cPREVENTIVE MAINTENANCE (PM)
4 - 7
4
Note: Note: When the counter value of any of the pickup roller, feed roller and separation roller in each unit is reset, the value of the feeding retry counter is also reset simultaneously. When the [RESET] but-ton is pressed after selecting the feed unit in the Main Screen, the value of the feeding retry counter is also reset simultaneously.
The feeding retry counter:• Upper drawer Reset the feeding retry counter (08-1390)• Lower drawer Reset the feeding retry counter (08-1391)• PFP upper drawer Reset the feeding retry counter (08-1392)• PFP lower drawer Reset the feeding retry counter (08-1393)• Bypass unit Reset the feeding retry counter (08-1394)• LCF Reset the feeding retry counter (08-1395)
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedPREVENTIVE MAINTENANCE (PM)
4 - 8
4.1.3 Work flow of parts replacementThe timing for the parts replacement usually depends on the number of output pages / develop counts after they were replaced before. However, its drive counts is also to be considered when replacing the parts. Even if the number of output pages has reached the level of replacement, for instance, the part may still be usable with its drive counts not reaching the specified drive counts. On the other hand, the part may need replacement even if the number of output pages has not reached the level of replace-ment with its driving time exceeding the specified drive counts. The life span of some parts such as feed roller is heavily dependent on the number of output pages rather than the drive counts.The following work flow diagram shows how to judge the timing of replacement with the number of out-put pages and the drive counts.The number of output pages is counted as “4” for 1 page for printing at color modes. This “4” is “develop counts”.
Example 1:When the number of output pages has reached the specified level
Fig. 4-5
Example 2:When the image failure occurred before the number of output pages has reached the specified level
Fig. 4-6
• The parts in RADF
• The parts in feeding system
• The parts in the drum/cleaner unit
• The parts in the transfer belt unit
• The parts in the 2nd transfer unit
• Developer material
• The parts in the fuser unit
Replace the part.
Replace the part.
Check the drive counts at PM
support mode.
Does it exceed the specified
drive counts?
Replace the part after the drive
counts has reached the specified
count.
Yes
No
The part is still usable.
Replace the part.Yes
No
Check the drive counts of all parts at PM support mode.
Does it exceed the specified drive count?
Check the part and equipment according to the “TROUBLESHOOTING”.
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cPREVENTIVE MAINTENANCE (PM)
4 - 9
4
4.2 General Descriptions for PM Procedure
(1) Preparation• Ask the user about the current conditions of the equipment and note them down.• Before starting maintenance, make some sample copies and store them.• See the replacement record and check the parts to be replaced in the PM support mode (6S-
2) or list printing mode (9S-103).6S-2 : [6] + [START] + [POWER] ON [2] [START]9S-103 : [9] + [START] + [POWER] ON [103] [START]
Fig. 4-7
• Turn OFF the power and make sure to unplug the equipment.
(2) Perform a preventive maintenance using the following checklist and illustrations. Refer to the Service Manual if necessary.
(3) Plug in the equipment after the maintenance has been finished. Then turn ON the power and make some copies to confirm that the equipment is working properly.
PM SUPPORT CODE LIST
XX-XX-'XX 11:28
UNIT OUTPUT PAGES/ PM OUTPUT PAGE/ DRIVE COUNTS PM DRIVE COUNTS DEVELOP COUNTS DEVELOP COUNTS
DRUM 22220 200000 30948 320000DRUM BLADE 22220 200000 30948 320000DRUM BRUSH 22220 200000 30948 320000GRID 22220 200000 30948 320000MAIN CHARGER WIRE 22220 200000 30948 320000WIRE CLEANING PAD 22220 200000 30948 320000
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedPREVENTIVE MAINTENANCE (PM)
4 - 10
4.3 Operational Items in OverhaulingOverhaul each equipment with the following timing.e-STUDIO281c: When the number of output pages has reached 300,000 or 2.5 years have
passed from the start of use (Whichever is earlier.)e-STUDIO351c: When the number of output pages has reached 360,000 or 2.5 years have
passed from the start of use (Whichever is earlier.)e-STUDIO451c: When the number of output pages has reached 450,000 or 2.5 years have
passed from the start of use (Whichever is earlier.)
(1) Replace all the supplies.(2) Check the components in the drive section (gears, pulleys, timing belts, etc.). Replace them with
new ones if they are damaged.(3) Check all the adhesives such as tape and Mylar if they are damaged or have become unstuck.
Replace them with new ones if necessary.(4) Check the performance of all the switches and sensors. Replace them with new ones if neces-
sary.(5) Clean inside the equipment thoroughly.
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cPREVENTIVE MAINTENANCE (PM)
4 - 11
4
4.4 Preventive Maintenance ChecklistSymbols/value used in the checklist
[Preventive Maintenance Checklist]
Notes: 1. Perform cleaning and lubricating in the following timing. Exceptionally, the lubrication for the
drum unit, main charger, color developer unit and 1st transfer unit must follow the PM cycle of each unit.
e-STUDIO251c:every 100,000 sheetse-STUDIO351c:every 120,000 sheetse-STUDIO451c:every 150,000 sheets
2. Value under "Replacement" indicates the replacement cycle, and when the cycle is different for each product, values are indicated in the order of e-STUDIO251c, e-STUDIO351c and e-STUDIO451c.(KS= x 1,000 sheets, KD= x 1,000 developments)
3. The replacement cycle of the parts for the charge, development and 1st transfer in copying process is not indicated by the number of output pages (sheet), but the develop counts (development). The number of output pages is counted as “4 developments” for 1 page for printing at color mode, and “1 development” at black-and-white mode.
4. The replacement cycle of the parts in the feeding section equals to the number of sheets fed from each paper source.
5. Be careful not to put oil on the rollers, belts and belt pulleys when lubricating.6. Page-Item (P-I) is described in the column of the Parts list.
A. Scanner
Cleaning Lubrication/Coating Replacement Operation check
A: Clean with alcoholB: Clean with soft pad,
cloth or vacuum cleaner
L: Launa 40SI: Silicon oilW1: White grease
(Molykote X5-6020)W2: White grease
(Molykote HP-300)AV: Alvania No.2FL: Floil (GE-334C)
Value:Replacement cycle(output pages or develop counts)
R: Replace if deformed or damaged
O: After cleaning or replacement, confirm there is no problem.
Items to check CleaningLubrication/
CoatingReplacement
(KS)Operation
checkParts list
<P-I>Remarks
A1 Original glass B or A 25-1 *a1
A2 ADF original glass B 25-2 *a1
A3 Mirror-1 B
A4 Mirror-2 B
A5 Mirror-3 B
A6 Reflector B
A7 Lens B 11-10
A8 Exposure lamp R O 26-6
A9 Automatic original detection sensor
B O 11-12
A10 Slide sheet (front and rear)
B or A R
05/11
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedPREVENTIVE MAINTENANCE (PM)
4 - 12
B. Laser unit
C. Feed unit
D. Automatic duplexing unit
E. Bypass feed unit
Items to check CleaningLubrication/
CoatingReplacement
(KS)Operation
checkParts list
<P-I>Remarks
B1 LSU slit glass B
Items to check CleaningLubrication/
CoatingReplacement
(KS)Operation
checkParts list
<P-I>Remarks
C1 Pickup roller 80 18-20
C2 Feed roller 80 18-24
C3 Separation roller AV, W2 80 18-5 *c1
C4 Transport roller A R
C5 Paper guide B
C6 Drive gear(tooth face and shaft)
W1 *c2
C7 GCB bushing bearing L
C8 One side of the plastic bushing to which the shaft is inserted
W1
C9 Registration roller A R 23-15,34
C10 Paper dust removal brush
B R 23-2,30 *c10
Items to check CleaningLubrication/
CoatingReplacement
(KS)Operation
checkParts list
<P-I>Remarks
D1 Transport roller (upper, middle and lower)
A R 43-7,36,56
D2 One side of the GCB bushing to which the shaft is inserted
L
D3 One side of the plastic bushing to which the shaft is inserted
W1
D4 Paper guide B 43-46
Items to check CleaningLubrication/
CoatingReplacement
(KS)Operation
checkParts list
<P-I>Remarks
E1 Pickup roller 80 22-26
E2 Feed roller 80 22-37
E3 Separation roller AV, W2 80 21-1 *e1
E4 Bypass tray B
E5 Drive gear (shaft) W1
E6 GCB bushing bearing L
E7 Transport roller A R 22-4,40
05/07
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cPREVENTIVE MAINTENANCE (PM)
4 - 13
4
F. Main charger
G. Drum/Cleaner related section
Note: Note: Check the color deviation after replacing G1 and G4.
H. Toner bag
Items to check CleaningLubrication/
CoatingReplacement
(KD)Operation
checkParts list
<P-I>Remarks
F1 Main charger case B *f1
F2 Main charger wire 130/160/200 O 28-15 *f1
F3 Contact point of termi-nals
B 28-4,9
F4 Charger wire cleaning pad
130/160/200 28-12
F5 Main charger grid 130/160/200 28-21
Items to check CleaningLubrication/
CoatingReplacement
(KD)Operation
checkParts list
<P-I>Remarks
G1 Photoconductive drum 130/160/200 103-1 Refer to Chapter
4.8.2
G2 Drum stay B *g1
G3 Whole cleaner unit B
G4 Drum cleaning blade 130/160/200 32-10 *g2
G5 Drum cleaner brush 130/160/200 32-5 *g2
G6 Recovery blade B R 32-26 *g3
G7 Used toner auger drive section
W1
G8 Discharge LED B 28-32
G9 Ozone filter 130/160/200 14-31
Items to check CleaningLubrication/
CoatingReplacement
(KD)Operation
checkParts list
<P-I>Remarks
H1 Toner bag 50 103-6
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedPREVENTIVE MAINTENANCE (PM)
4 - 14
I. Black developer unit
J. Color developer unit / Revolver unit
Items to check CleaningLubrication/
CoatingReplacement
(KS)Operation
checkParts list
<P-I>Remarks
I1 Whole black developer unit
B
I2 Black developer unit drive section
W1
I3 Developer material (K) 100/120/150 103-2 *i1
I4 Front shield B R 34-39
I5 Oil seal (4 pcs.) AV R 34-3,15 *i2
I6 Guide roller B or A 34-17
I7 Toner cartridge drive gear
W1
I8 Side shield B R 34-37,38
I9 Front bearings of mix-ers
AV R 34-8 *i3
Items to check CleaningLubrication/
CoatingReplacement
(KS)Operation
checkParts list
<P-I>Remarks
J1 Whole color developer unit (Y, M and C)
B
J2 Color developer unit drive section (Y, M and C)
W1
J3 Developer material (Y, M, and C)
24/30/37.5 103-3 *j1
J4 Front shield (Y, M and C)
B R 33-24
J5 Oil seal (4 pcs. for each color)
AV R 33-4,14 *j2
J6 Toner cartridge drive gear (Y, M and C)
W1
J7 Revolver drive gear W1
J8 Color auto-toner sen-sor
B AV 36-18 *j3
J9 Side shield B R 33-39,40
J10 Polarity adjustment plate
FL 33-9 *j4
J11 Color toner cartridge sensor
B 36-104 *j5
J12 Front bearings of mix-ers
AV R 33-12 *j6
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cPREVENTIVE MAINTENANCE (PM)
4 - 15
4
K. Transfer belt unit / Transfer belt cleaning unit
Note: Note: Check the color deviation after replacing K1, K2 and K6.
L. 2nd transfer roller unit
Note: Note: Check the color deviation after replacing L1.
Items to check CleaningLubrication/
CoatingReplacement
(KD)Operation
checkParts list
<P-I>Remarks
K1 Transfer belt B R 29-31
K2 1st transfer roller R 29-14
K3 Drive roller A R 30-7 *k1
K4 2nd transfer facing roller
A R 30-15 *k1
K5 Transfer belt home position sensor(2 pcs.)
B 29-9 *k2
K6 Transfer belt cleaning blade
130/160/200 31-8
K7 Transfer belt recovery blade
B R 31-16 *k3
K8 Blade seal (front side) 130/160/200 31-10
K9 Blade seal (rear side) 130/160/200 31-12
K10 Blade Mylar (front side)
130/160/200 31-9
K11 Blade Mylar (rear side) 130/160/200 31-11
Items to check CleaningLubrication/
CoatingReplacement
(KS)Operation
checkParts list
<P-I>Remarks
L1 2nd transfer roller 200/240/300 13-19
L2 Paper guide B
L3 Image quality sensor B 23-24 *l1
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedPREVENTIVE MAINTENANCE (PM)
4 - 16
M. Fuser unit
N. RADF (MR-3018)
O. PFP (KD-1011)
Items to check CleaningLubrication/
CoatingReplacement
(KS)Operation
checkParts list
<P-I>Remarks
M1 Fuser belt 100/120/150 39-1
M2 Pressure roller 100/120/150 42-5
M3 Separation finger 100/120/150 42-25 *m1
M4 Oil roller 100/120/150 42-22
M5 Cleaning roller 100/120/150 42-11
M6 Thermistor (3 pcs.) A R *m2
M7 Fuser unit drive gear W1
M8 Exit roller A
M9 Fuser belt guide 100/120/150 42-18
M10 Separation roller W2 41-2 *m3
M11 Pressure roller dis-charge brush
100/120/150 39-1
Items to check CleaningLubrication/
CoatingReplacement
(KS)Operation
checkParts list
<P-I>Remarks
1 Pickup roller A 120 5-1
2 Separation roller A 120 4-10
3 Feed roller A 120 5-1
4 Registration roller A
5 Intermediate transfer roller
A
6 Front read roller A
7 Platen roller A
8 Rear read roller A
9 Reverse registration roller
A
10 Exit/reverse roller A
11 Platen sheet B or A
Items to check CleaningLubrication/
CoatingReplacement
(KS)Operation
checkParts list
<P-I>Remarks
O1 Pickup roller (upper/lower)
A 80 5-29
O2 Feed roller (upper/lower)
A 80 5-26
O3 Separation roller (upper/lower)
A AV, W2 80 5-112 *o1
O4 Drive gear (tooth face)
W1
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cPREVENTIVE MAINTENANCE (PM)
4 - 17
4
P. LCF (KD-1012)
Q. Finisher (MJ-1101)
Items to check CleaningLubrication/
CoatingReplacement
(KS)Operation
checkParts list
<P-I>Remarks
P1 Pickup roller A 160 4-30
P2 Feed roller A 160 4-28
P3 Separation roller A 160 5-12
P4 Drive gear (tooth face)
W1
Items to check Cleaning LubricationReplacement
(x1,000)Operation
checkParts list
(P-I)Remarks
Q1 Stack transport roller-1 A
Q2 Stack transport roller-2 A
Q3 Buffer roller A
Q4 Exit roller A
Q5 Entrance roller A
Q6 Transport roller A
Q7 Paddle 1,000
Q8 Paper holder cam W3 *q1
Q9 Buffer tray shaft W3 *q2
Q10 Stapler carrier shaft W3 *q3
Q11 Rack & pinion gear (Aligning plate)
W3 *q4
Q12 Movable tray drive gear W3 *q5
Q13 Buffer tray guide W3 *q6
Q14 Finishing tray shaft W3 *q7
06/08
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedPREVENTIVE MAINTENANCE (PM)
4 - 18
Fig. 4-8 Front side
A2 A4 A8 A6 A1
A9
A10A7A3A5
J8
J1
J3
J4
J5
J9
J10
J12
I1
I3
I4
I5
I6
I8
I9
E4
K3 K5 K2
G3
M8 M3
D1
E1
C4
C2
C3C4
C5C1K1G8F1F3
F2F4
F5 B1
C2
C3
E2
E3
C9, C10
E7
M2M11
G5
G6G1
G7
G4M6
L2
M4
M5
K6K7K8K9K10K11
J11
D1
D1
L1
K5
K4
D4
G9
M1
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cPREVENTIVE MAINTENANCE (PM)
4 - 19
4
Fig. 4-9
Fig. 4-10 Paper Feed Pedestal (PFP)
N1N3
N7 N8
N4 N2
N6
N5 N9
N10 N11
O1 O2
O3
O3
O1
O2
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedPREVENTIVE MAINTENANCE (PM)
4 - 20
Fig. 4-11 Large Capacity Feeder (LCF)
Fig. 4-12 Finisher (MJ-1101)
P1 P2
P3
[Front side] [Rear side]
Q1
Q2
Q14
Q3
Q6
Q12
Q9
Q7Q11
Q13
Q5
Q8
Q10
Q4
06/08
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cPREVENTIVE MAINTENANCE (PM)
4 - 21
4
Remarks “*” in the Preventive Maintenance Check List* a1. Original glass, ADF original glass
Clean both sides of the original glass and ADF original. Make sure that there is no dust on the mirrors-1, -2, -3 and lens after cleaning. Then install the original glass and ADF original glass.
Note: Note: Make sure that there is no fingerprints or oil staining on part of the original glass on where the original scale is mounted since the shading correction plate is located below the scale to be scanned.
* c1, o1. Separation roller (Feed unit, PFP)Apply an even coat of grease (Alvania No.2) to all round the inside of the spring.When replacing the separation roller, apply adequate amount of white grease (Molykote HP-300) on the places of the holder shown in the figure (4 places).
Note: Note: Make sure that the grease does not adhere to the roller surface. Wipe it off with alcohol if adhered.
* c2. Drive gears in the paper feeding section (teeth of gears and shafts)Apply some white grease (Molykote X5-6020) to the teeth of gears and shafts of the drive gears.
Note: Note: Make sure that oil is not running over or scattered around as the gear is rotated coming into the clutch after applying molykote to the gear which is located near the clutch. The quantity of moly-cote should be smaller than that to be applied to the other parts.
Fig. 4-13
Fig. 4-14
Apply grease on theinner surface
Apply white grease
05/07
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedPREVENTIVE MAINTENANCE (PM)
4 - 22
* c10. When installing the intermediate guide after cleaning the paper dust removal brush attached to it, check whether 2 hooks are fitted in and boss "A" in the figure is inserted into its groove correctly.
Fig. 4-15
* e1. Separation roller (SFB)Apply an even coat of grease (Alvania No.2) to all round the inside of the spring.When replacing the separation roller, apply adequate amount of white grease (Molykote HP-300) on the places of the holder shown in the figure (4 places).
Note: Note: Make sure that the grease does not adhere to the roller surface. Wipe it off with alcohol if adhered.
* f1. Main charger case / Main charger wireClean the main charger case and wire with a cloth soaked in water and squeezed tightly, and then wipe them with a dry cloth.
Note: Note: Be careful of the following when attaching a new wire (length: 373 mm).
- Insert the wire securely into the V-grooves of the front and rear sides.- Do not twist the wire.- Do not touch the wire with your bare hand.
Fig. 4-16 Fig. 4-17
A A A
Apply grease on theinner surface
Apply white grease
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cPREVENTIVE MAINTENANCE (PM)
4 - 23
4
* g1. Drum stayIf toner accumulates on the drum stay, take off the drum stay from the process unit and clean it with an electric vacuum cleaner. Also, remove any toner stains around the drum stay with a cloth.
Fig. 4-18
* g2. Drum cleaning blade / Drum cleaner brushSince the edge of the blade is vulnerable and can be easily damaged by factors such as the adherence of paper dust. Replace the cleaning blade and brush with new ones if poor images are copied due to the damaged blade regardless of the number of output pages which have been made.
* g3. Recovery bladeReplace the recovery blade regardless the number of output pages if the edge of the blade get damaged.
* i1, j1. Developer materialAfter replacing the developer material, be sure to perform the auto-toner adjustment and then image quality control initialization (Ch.3.2).
* i2, j2. Oil sealMixer unit (Rear side of mixers-1 & -2) 2 pcs.Developer sleeve 2 pc.
Notes: 1. Lubricate the oil seal only when the oil seal is replaced2. When exchanging the oil seal of the mixer unit, replace "i3, j6. Front bearings of mixer" at the
same time.
Drum stay
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedPREVENTIVE MAINTENANCE (PM)
4 - 24
During replacement, coat the oil seal with grease (Alvania No.2).
* i3, j6. Front bearings of mixersWhen exchanging the oil seals (rear side of mixer-1 and -2) replace the front bearings of mixer-1 and -2 at the same time. Since the oil seal is attached to the front bearings of mixer-1 and -2, apply grease when replacing them referring to *i2, j2.
* j3. Color auto-toner sensorClean the color auto-toner sensor as follows:1) Pull the sensor case of the color auto-toner sensor unit toward you, then remove 1
screw to take off the sensor shutter. Clean the surface of the sensor with a cotton swab or soft cloth with sufficient alcohol filled in.
Fig. 4-20
2) Clean the reference plate of the sensor shutter by blowing off the toner dust with the blower brush or the air spray cleaner etc.
(1) Push in a new oil seal parallel to the mount-ing hole section of the developer frame or outside of the nozzle mixer.* Pay attention to the direction in which the
oil seal is attached. (See figure on right.)(2) Apply an even coat of grease to the inside of
the oil seal.• Amount: About two small drops
(3) Wipe off any grease exuded from the inside.
Fig. 4-19
Outside
Inside
Developer frame(Nozzle mixer)
Grease
Oil seal
Sensor shutter
Sensor case
Color auto-toner sensor
05/11
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cPREVENTIVE MAINTENANCE (PM)
4 - 25
4
Note: Note: When you clean the reference plate, never touch it directly with the cleaning brush etc. as the surface of the reference plate is fragile.
Fig. 4-21
* j4. Polarity adjustment plateApply two-rice-grain-amount of FLOIL (GE-334C) to the polarity adjustment plate (feeding terminal).
Fig. 4-22
* j5. Color toner cartridge sensorPerform the cleaning of the surface of the color toner cartridge sensor when you replace the color developer unit (e-STUDIO281c: 24,000 sheets / e-STUDIO351c: 30,000 sheets / e-STUDIO451c: 37,500 sheets).
* k1. Transfer belt drive roller -1, -2Fully clean up the toner and such adhered to the roller with alcohol since an image failure may occur if there are any bolts remaining on the roller.
Fig. 4-23
Reference plate
Blot
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedPREVENTIVE MAINTENANCE (PM)
4 - 26
* k2. Transfer belt home position sensorClean each surface of transfer belt home position sensors (2 pcs.) with a dry cloth when replacing the transfer belt.
Fig. 4-24
Fig. 4-25
* k3. Transfer belt recovery bladeClean the surface of transfer belt recovery blade with a cloth soaked in water and tightly squeezed, and the wipe it with a dry cloth when replacing the transfer belt cleaning blade.If the edge of recovery blade is damaged, replace the blade regardless of the number of output pages.
* l1. Area around image quality sensorClean the shutter of the image quality sensor and around it. Do not touch the sensor head inside the shutter.
* m1. Separation fingerThe paper jam may be caused if the tip of the finger is damaged or deformed. If there is any problem with it, replace the finger with a new one regardless of the number of output pages which have been made. Do not damage the tip of the finger during the cleaning. The finger may be damaged if the toner adhering to the tip of it is scraped off forcibly. Replace the finger if the toner is sticking to it heavily.
Transfer belt
home position sensor-1
Transfer belt
home position sensor-2
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cPREVENTIVE MAINTENANCE (PM)
4 - 27
4
* m2. ThermistorClean the thermistor with alcohol if the toner or dirt is sticking to it when the fuser roller is replaced. Do not deform or damage the thermistor during the cleaning. Replace the ther-mistor with a new one if it is damaged or deformed regardless of degree.
* m3. Separation rollerWhen replacing the transfer belt, apply some White Molykote (HP-300) on both ends of the separation roller shaft.
Fig. 4-26
* q1. Paper holder camApply an adequate amount of white grease (Molykote EM-30L) all around the paper holder cam.
Fig. 4-27
Paper holder cam
06/08
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedPREVENTIVE MAINTENANCE (PM)
4 - 28
* q2. Buffer tray shaftApply an adequate amount of white grease (Molykote EM-30L) to the entire buffer tray shaft.
Fig. 4-28
* q3. Stapler carrier shaftApply an adequate amount of white grease (Molykote EM-30L) to the entire stapler carrier shaft.
Fig. 4-29
Buffer tray shaft
Stapler carrier shaft
06/08
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cPREVENTIVE MAINTENANCE (PM)
4 - 29
4
* q4. Rack gear, pinion gear (Aligning plate)* q5. Finishing tray shaft
1) Take off the metal shield plate.* If the hole punch unit is installed, take it off beforehand.2) Apply oil as follows through the opening which shows up when the metal shield plate
has been removed.Apply an adequate amount of white grease (Molykote EM-30L) to the gear teeth of the rack and pinion gears which drive the aligning plate, and the entire finishing tray shaft.
Fig. 4-30
* q6. Movable tray drive gearApply an adequate amount of white grease (Molykote EM-30L) to the gear teeth of the gear-A and gear-B.
Fig. 4-31
Finishing tray shaft
Rack gear
Pinion gear
Gear A
Gear B
06/08
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedPREVENTIVE MAINTENANCE (PM)
4 - 30
* q7. Buffer tray guideApply an adequate amount of white grease (Molykote EM-30L) to the entire buffer tray guide (inside of the folded section of the plate).
Fig. 4-32
Buffer tray guide
06/08
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cPREVENTIVE MAINTENANCE (PM)
4 - 31
4
4.5 PM KIT
* The following seals and Mylar sheets are attached to the Belt cleaning blade.
KIT name Component Part name Qty.
EPU-KIT-281C Drum cleaning blade BL-3511D 1
Main charger wire WIRE-CHARGR-373 1
Main charger grid GRID-220 1
Drum cleaner brush B-281C 1
Ozone filter FILTER-OZ-SPB-600 1
Charger wire cleaning pad ASYS-PAD-CHARGR-350 1
Belt cleaning blade* BL-281CTR 1
DEV-KIT-281CCLR Developer material (Y) D-281C-Y 1
Developer material (M) D-281C-M 1
Developer material (C) D-281C-C 1
Cleaning jig JIG-CLEAN-DOC 1
DEV-KIT-281C Developer material (K) D-3511-K 1
Cleaning jig JIG-CLEAN-DOC 1
2nd transfer roller CR-281CTR2 1
FR-KIT-281C Fuser belt BT-3511-FU 1
Pressure roller HR-3511-L 1
Separation finger SCRAPER-FUS-350 1
Oil roller SR-281CU 1
Cleaning roller B-281CU 1
Fuser belt guide COLOR-HR-IN-N 2
Pressure roller discharge brush BRUSH-FUS-PR 1
ROL-KIT-16CST Pick up roller ROLLER-PICK-AT 1
Feed roller K-ROLL-FEED 1
Separation roller K-ROLL-SPT 1
ROL-KIT-1010 Pick up roller ROL-PICK-UP 1
Feed roller ROL-PAPER-FED-F 1
Separation roller ROL-PAPER-FED-S 1
DF-KIT-3018 Pick up roller ASYS-ROL-FEED 1
Feed roller ASYS-ROL-FEED 1
Separation roller ASYS-ROL-RET 1
Name Part name Qty.
Blade seal (front side) SEAL-SIDE-CLN-TBU-F-1 1
Blade seal (rear side) SEAL-SIDE-CLN-TBU-R-1 1
Blade Mylar (front side) ASYS-SEAL-SIDE-CLT-F-1 1
Blade Mylar (rear side) ASYS-SEAL-SIDE-CLT-R-1 1
09/06
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedPREVENTIVE MAINTENANCE (PM)
4 - 32
4.6 Jig List
ItemParts list
Page Item
Door switch jig 101 1
Test chart (A4) 101 3
Test chat (LT) 101 3
Test chart No. TCC-1 (A4) 101 2
Test chart No. TCC-1 (LT) 101 2
Doctor blade cleaning jig 101 4
Downloading jig (DLM board) 102 1
Wire holder jig 101 5
Download JIG-2 (6 Flash ROMs) 102 2
Download JIG-1 (2 Flash ROMs) 102 3
ROM writer adapter (For 1881) 102 4
ROM writer adapter (For 1931) 102 5
Doctor sleeve jig 101 7
Developer material nozzle 101 8
Belt tension jig (spring) 101 20
Drum-sleeve gap jig (Front) 101 21
Drum-sleeve gap jig (Rear) 101 22
Drum-sleeve gap jig (Shaft) 101 23
10/02
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cPREVENTIVE MAINTENANCE (PM)
4 - 33
4
4.7 Grease List
Grease name Part name Volume ContainerParts list
Page Item
SI Silicon oil ASM-SILICONE-1M 100 cc Bottle 101 8
L Launa 40 OIL-LAUNA40-100 100 cc Oiler 101 9
W1 White grease (Molykote X5-6020) MOLYKOTE-100 100 g Tube 101 12
W2 White grease (Molykote HP-300) ASM-PG-HP300-S 100 g Bottle 101 10A
W2 White grease (Molykote HP-300) GREASE-HP-S 10 g Bottle 101 10B
AV Alvania No.2 ASM-PG-ALV2 100 g Tube 101 11
FL Floil (GE-334C) ASM-PG-GE334C-S 20 g Bottle 101 13
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedPREVENTIVE MAINTENANCE (PM)
4 - 34
4.8 Precautions for Storing and Handling Supplies
4.8.1 Precautions for storing TOSHIBA supplies1) Toner/Developer
Toner and developer should be stored in a place where the ambient temperature is between 10°C to 35°C (no condensation), and should also be protected against direct sunlight during transportation.
2) Photoconductive drumLike the toner and developer, photoconductive drum should be stored in a dark place where the ambient temperature is between 10°C to 35°C (no condensation). Be sure to avoid places where drums may be subjected to high humidity, chemicals and/or their fumes.
3) Drum cleaning blade / Transfer belt cleaning bladeThis item should be stored in a flat place where the ambient temperature is between 10°C to 35°C, and should also be protected against high humidity, chemicals and/or their fumes.
4) Transfer belt / Transfer roller / Fuser belt / Pressure rollerAvoid places where the rollers may be subjected to high humidity, chemicals and/or their fumes.
5) Oil roller / Cleaning rollerAvoid places where the rollers may be subjected to high humidity, chemicals and/or their fumes.They should also be stored “horizontally” on a flat surface.
6) PaperAvoid storing copy paper in places where it may be subjected to high humidity.After a package is opened, be sure to place and store it in a storage bag.
4.8.2 Checking and cleaning of photoconductive drum1) Use of gloves
If fingerprints or oil adhere to the drum surface, the property of the photosensitive drum may degrade, affecting the quality of the copy image. So, do not touch the drum surface with your bare hands.
2) Handling precautionsAs the photoconductive drum surface is very sensitive, be sure to handle the drum carefully when installing and removing it so as not damage its surface.Be sure to apply “patting powder” (lubricant) to the entire surface of the drum (including both ends of the drum where OPC is not coated) when replacing the drum. When the drum has been replaced with a new one, the drum counter (setting mode (08-1150-0, 3, 6 and 7) must be cleared to 0 (zero).This clearing can be performed in PM support mode.
Notes: 1. Application of patting powder is for reducing the friction between the drum and cleaning blade.
If the application of patting powder is neglected, the drum and cleaning blade may be dam-aged.
2. When paper fibers or thread adhere to the cleaning blade edge, they may reduce the cleaning efficiency and, in addition, may damage the blade and the drum. Be sure to remove any fibers found adhering to the blade.
08/04
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cPREVENTIVE MAINTENANCE (PM)
4 - 35
4
3) Installation of equipment and storage of drumAvoid installing the equipment where it may be subjected to high temperature, high humidity, chemi-cals and/or their fumes.Do not place the drum in a location where it is exposed to direct sunlight or high intensity light such as near a window. Otherwise the drum will fatigue, and will not produce sufficient image density immediately after being installed in the equipment.
4) Cleaning the drumAt periodic maintenance calls, wipe the entire surface of the drum clean using the designated clean-ing cotton. Use sufficiently thick cleaning cotton (dry soft pad) so as not to scratch the drum surface inadvertently with your fingertips or nails. Also, remove your rings and wristwatch before starting cleaning work to prevent accidental damage to the drum.Do not use alcohol, selenium refresher and other organic solvents or silicon oil as they will have an adverse effect on the drum.
5) Scratches on photoconductive drum surfaceIf the surface is scratched in such a way that the aluminum substrate is exposed, no copy image will be produced on this area. In addition, the cleaning blade will be damaged so replacement with a new drum will be necessary.
6) Collecting used photoconductive drumsRegarding the recovery and disposal of used photoconductive drums, we recommend following the relevant local regulations or rules.
4.8.3 Checking and cleaning of drum cleaning blade and transfer belt cleaning blade
1) Handling precautionsPay attention to the following points as the cleaning blade life is determined by the condition of its edge:- Do not allow hard objects to hit or rub against blade edge.- Do not rub the edge with a cloth or soft pad.- Do not leave oil (or fingerprints, etc.) on the edge.- Do not apply solvents such as paint thinner to the blade.- Do not allow paper fibers or dirt to contact the blade edge.- Do not place the blade near a heat source.
2) Cleaning procedureClean the blade edge with a cloth moistened with water and squeezed lightly.
4.8.4 Handling of drum cleaner brushDo not touch the brush surface with bare hands.
4.8.5 Handling of transfer belt1) Do not touch the transfer belt surface with bare hands.2) Prevent oil or other foreign matter from adhering to the transfer belt surface.3) Do not touch the transfer belt with alcohol or any other organic solvent.4) Do not apply external pressure that might scratch the transfer belt.5) When replacing the belt and transfer belt cleaning unit, apply patting powder sufficiently and evenly.
Otherwise, it may reduce the cleaning efficiency.6) When replacing the transfer belt, clean the drive roller-1 drive roller-2, and tension roller with a sol-
vent such as alcohol, and then attach the transfer belt.
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedPREVENTIVE MAINTENANCE (PM)
4 - 36
4.8.6 Checking and cleaning of fuser belt and pressure roller1) Handling precautions
Fuser belt- Do not touch the fuser belt surface with bare hands.- Prevent oil or other foreign matter from staining the fuser belt surface.- Do not allow alcohol or any other organic solvent to contact with the fuser belt.- Do not apply external pressure that might scratch the fuser belt.
Pressure roller- Do not leave any oil (fingerprints, etc.) on the pressure roller.- Be careful not to allow any hard object to hit or rub against the pressure roller, or it may be dam-
aged, possibly resulting in poor cleaning.
2) Checking- Check for stain and damage on the fuser belt and pressure roller, and clean if necessary.- Check the separation guide and fingers and check for chipped tips.- Check the cleaning effect of the cleaning roller.- Check the thermistors for proper contact with the pressure roller.- Check the fused and fixed condition of the toner.- Check the gap between the inlet guide and pressure roller.- Check the fuser belt for proper transportation.- Check the pressure roller for proper rotation.
3) Cleaning procedureWhen the fuser belt and pressure roller become dirty, they will cause jamming. If this happens, wipe the surface clean with a suitable cloth. For easier cleaning, clean the belt and roller while they are still warm.
Note: Note: Be careful not to rub the fuser belt and pressure roller surface with your nails or hard objects because it can be easily damaged. Do not use silicone oil on the fuser belt and pressure roller.
4) Checking after the assembly of the fuser belt unitAfter the assembly, rotate the fuser belt for a round to confirm that the belt is neither folded nor scratched.A folded or scratched belt may be broken when it is in use.
Note: Note: Never rotate the fuser belt in the reverse direction as it will cause deformation of the thermistor and discharge brush.
4.8.7 Checking and replacing the oil roller and cleaning roller1) Handling precautions
Never allow solvents such as paint thinner to touch to the oil/cleaning rollers.
2) Poor cleaning and corrective treatmentJudgment should be made depending on how much toner has been deposited on the fuser belt sur-face. When its surface is stained with toner, check the oil roller and cleaning roller. If toner is heavily adhered on the oil/cleaning rollers, it means the cleaning performance is declined and the oil/clean-ing rollers should be replaced with new ones.The oil/cleaning rollers are gradually degraded due to subjection to the heat from the fuser belt over a long period of time. Replace them after the specified number of output pages have been made.
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cPREVENTIVE MAINTENANCE (PM)
4 - 37
4
4.8.8 Checking and cleaning of discharge brush1) Handling precautions
Be careful not to bend the end bristle of the brush as it may cause the bad contact with the pressure roller.
2) CheckingReplace the discharge brush with a new one if toner is stick to it regardless of the number of output pages, as the performance of the brush may have been deteriorated.
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedPREVENTIVE MAINTENANCE (PM)
4 - 38
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cTROUBLESHOOTING
5 - 1
5
5. TROUBLESHOOTING
When any of the PC boards or the HDD requires replacement, refer to “5.3 Replacement of PC Boards and HDD”.
5.1 Diagnosis and Prescription for Each Error Code
5.1.1 Paper transport jam (paper exit section)[E010] Jam not reaching the exit sensor
Open the jam access cover. Is there any paper on the transport path?|
YES 1) Remove the paper.2) Check if the intermediate guide is installed properly. (Chap. 4.4 *c10)
NOIs the paper clinging to the transfer belt entering under the receiving tray? YES Remove the paper.
NOIs the intermediate guide installed properly? (Chap. 4.4 *c10) NO Install the intermediate guide correctly.
YESIs there any paper jammed in the fuser unit?
|
YES 1) Remove the paper.2) Check if there is any abnormality on the paper transport path.
NOIs the exit sensor working? (Perform the input check: 03-[FAX]OFF/[7]/[H])
|||||||||
NO 1) Check if the connector of the exit sensor is disconnected.2) Check if the connector CN334 on the LGC board is disconnected.3) Check if the connector pins are disconnected or the harnesses are open
circuited.4) Check if the conductor pattern on the LGC board is short circuited or open
circuited.5) Replace the exit sensor.6) Replace the LGC board.
YESIs the registration clutch working? (Perform the output check: 03-108/158)
|||||||||
NO 1) Check if the connector of the registration clutch is disconnected.2) Check if the connector CN339 on the LGC board is disconnected.3) Check if the connector pins are disconnected or the harnesses are open
circuited.4) Check if the conductor pattern on the LGC board is short circuited or open
circuited.5) Replace the registration clutch.6) Replace the LGC board.
YESCheck the registration roller. Replace it if it is worn out.
05/07
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedTROUBLESHOOTING
5 - 2
[E020] Stop jam at the exit sensorOpen the jam access cover. Is there any paper on the transport path? YES Remove the paper.
NOIs the exit sensor working? (Perform the input check: 03-[FAX]OFF/[7]/[H])
|||||||||
NO 1) Check if the connector of the exit sensor is disconnected.2) Check if the connector CN334 on the LGC board is disconnected.3) Check if the connector pins are disconnected or the harnesses are open
circuited.4) Check if the conductor pattern on the LGC board is short circuited or open
circuited.5) Replace the exit sensor.6) Replace the LGC board.
YESCheck the exit roller. Replace it if it is worn out.
05/07
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cTROUBLESHOOTING
5 - 3
5
5.1.2 Paper misfeeding[E110] ADU misfeeding (paper not reaching the registration sensor)
Open the jam access cover. Is there any paper in front of the registration sensor? YES Remove the paper.
NOIs the registration sensor working? (Perform the input check:03-[FAX]ON/[9]/[E])
|||||||||
NO 1) Check if the connector of the registration sensor is disconnected.2) Check if the connector CN338 on the LGC board is disconnected.3) Check if the connector pins are disconnected or the harnesses are open
circuited.4) Check if the conductor pattern on the LGC board is short circuited or open
circuited.5) Replace the registration sensor.6) Replace the LGC board.
YESIs the ADU clutch working?
|||||||||
NO 1) Check if the connector of the ADU clutch is disconnected.2) Check if the connector CN340 on the LGC board is disconnected.3) Check if the connector pins are disconnected or the harnesses are open
circuited.4) Check if the conductor pattern on the LGC board is short circuited or open
circuited.5) Replace the ADU clutch.6) Replace the LGC board.
YESCheck the rollers in the ADU. Replace them if they are worn out.
06/08
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedTROUBLESHOOTING
5 - 4
[E120] Bypass misfeeding (paper not reaching the registration sensor)Open the jam access cover. Is there any paper in front of the registration sensor? YES Remove the paper.
NOIs the registration sensor working? (Perform the input check: 03-[FAX]ON/[9]/[E])
|||||||||
NO 1) Check if the connector of the registration sensor is disconnected.2) Check if the connector CN338 on the LGC board is disconnected.3) Check if the connector pins are disconnected and the harnesses are open
circuited.4) Check if the conductor pattern on the LGC board is short circuited or open
circuited.5) Replace the registration sensor.6) Replace the LGC board.
YESAre the bypass feed clutch and bypass feed sensor working? (Perform the output check: 03-204 and the input check: 03-[FAX]ON/[9]/[D])
||||||||||
NO 1) Check if the connector of the bypass feed clutch is disconnected.2) Check if the connector CN340 on the LGC board is disconnected.3) Check if the connector pins are disconnected or the harnesses are open
circuited.4) Check if the conductor pattern on the LGC board is short circuited or open
circuited.5) Replace the bypass feed clutch.6) Replace the bypass feed sensor.7) Replace the LGC board.
YESCheck the rollers in the ADU. Replace them if they are worn out.
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cTROUBLESHOOTING
5 - 5
5
[E130] Upper drawer misfeeding (paper not reaching the upper drawer feed sensor)Open the jam access cover. Is there any paper in front of the upper drawer feed sensor? YES Remove the paper.
NOIs the upper drawer feed sensor working? (Perform the input check: 03-[FAX]ON/[3]/[H])
|||||||||
NO 1) Check if the connector of the upper drawer feed sensor is disconnected.2) Check if the connector CN338 on the LGC board is disconnected.3) Check if the connector pins are disconnected or the harnesses are open
circuited.4) Check if the conductor pattern on the LGC board is short circuited or open
circuited.5) Replace the upper drawer feed sensor.6) Replace the LGC board.
YESIs the upper drawer feed clutch working? (Perform the output check: 03-201)
|||||||||
NO 1) Check if the connector of the upper drawer feed clutch is disconnected.2) Check if the connector CN341 on the LGC board is disconnected.3) Check if the connector pins are disconnected or the harnesses are open
circuited.4) Check if the conductor pattern on the LGC board is short circuited or open
circuited.5) Replace the upper drawer feed clutch.6) Replace the LGC board.
YESCheck the upper drawer feed roller, separation roller and pickup roller. Replace them if they are worn out.
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedTROUBLESHOOTING
5 - 6
[E140] Lower drawer misfeeding (paper not reaching the lower drawer feed sensor)Open the side cover. Is there any paper in front of the lower drawer feed sensor? YES Remove the paper.
NOIs the lower drawer feed sensor working? (Perform the input check: 03-[FAX]ON/[3]/[G])
|||||||||
NO 1) Check if the connector of the lower drawer feed sensor is disconnected.2) Check if the connector CN338 on the LGC board is disconnected.3) Check if the connector pins are disconnected or the harnesses are open
circuited.4) Check if the conductor pattern on the LGC board is short circuited or open
circuited.5) Replace the lower drawer feed sensor.6) Replace the LGC board.
YESIs the lower drawer feed clutch working? (Perform the output check: 03-202)
|||||||||
NO 1) Check if the connector of the lower drawer feed clutch is disconnected.2) Check if the connector CN341 on the LGC board is disconnected.3) Check if the connector pins are disconnected or the harnesses are open
circuited.4) Check if the conductor pattern on the LGC board is short circuited or open
circuited.5) Replace the lower drawer feed clutch.6) Replace the LGC board.
YESCheck the lower drawer feed roller, separation roller and pickup roller. Replace them if they are worn out.
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cTROUBLESHOOTING
5 - 7
5
[E150] PFP upper drawer misfeeding (paper not reaching the PFP upper drawer feed sensor)Open the PFP side cover. Is there any paper in front of the PFP upper drawer feed sensor? YES Remove the paper.
NOIs the PFP upper drawer feed sensor working? (Perform the input check: 03-[FAX]OFF/[2]/[D])
||||||||||||||
NO 1) Check if the connector of the PFP upper drawer feed sensor is discon-nected.
2) Check if either of the connectors CN241 or CN243 on the PFP board is dis-connected.
3) Check if the connector CN344 on the LGC board is disconnected.4) Check if the connector pins are disconnected or the harnesses are open
circuited.5) Check if the conductor patterns on the PFP board and LGC board are short
circuited or open circuited.6) Replace the PFP upper drawer feed sensor.7) Replace the PFP board.8) Replace the LGC board.
YESIs the PFP upper drawer feed clutch working? (Perform the output check: 03-226)
||||||||||||||
NO 1) Check if the connector of the PFP upper drawer feed clutch is discon-nected.
2) Check if any of the connectors CN241, CN242 and CN244 on the PFP board is disconnected.
3) Check if the connector CN344 on the LGC board is disconnected.4) Check if the connector pins are disconnected or the harnesses are open
circuited.5) Check if the conductor patterns on the PFP board and LGC board are short
circuited or open circuited.6) Replace the PFP upper drawer feed clutch.7) Replace the PFP board.8) Replace the LGC board.
YESCheck the PFP upper drawer feed roller, separation roller and pickup roller. Replace them if they are worn out.
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedTROUBLESHOOTING
5 - 8
[E160] PFP lower drawer misfeeding (paper not reaching the PFP lower drawer feed sensor)Open the PFP side cover. Is there any paper in front of the PFP lower drawer feed sensor? YES Remove the paper.
NOIs the PFP lower drawer feed sensor working? (Perform the input check: 03-[FAX]OFF/[4]/[D])
||||||||||||||
NO 1) Check if the connector of the PFP lower drawer feed sensor is discon-nected.
2) Check if either of the connectors CN241 or CN243 on the PFP board is dis-connected.
3) Check if the connector CN344 on the LGC board is disconnected.4) Check if the connector pins are disconnected or the harnesses are open
circuited.5) Check if the conductor patterns on the PFP board and LGC board are short
circuited or open circuited.6) Replace the PFP lower drawer feed sensor.7) Replace the PFP board.8) Replace the LGC board.
YESIs the PFP lower drawer feed clutch working? (Perform the output check: 03-228)
||||||||||||||
NO 1) Check if the connector of the PFP lower drawer feed clutch is discon-nected.
2) Check if any of the connectors CN241, CN242 and CN244 on the PFP board is disconnected.
3) Check if the connector CN344 on the LGC board is disconnected.4) Check if the connector pins are disconnected or the harnesses are open
circuited.5) Check if the conductor patterns on the PFP board and LGC board are short
circuited or open circuited.6) Replace the PFP lower drawer feed clutch.7) Replace the PFP board.8) Replace the LGC board.
YESCheck the PFP lower drawer feed roller, separation roller and pickup roller. Replace them if they are worn out.
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cTROUBLESHOOTING
5 - 9
5
[E190] LCF misfeeding (paper not reaching the LCF feed sensor)Open the LCF side cover. Is there any paper in front of the LCF feed sensor? YES Remove the paper.
NOIs the LCF feed sensor working? (Perform the input check: 03-[FAX]OFF/[5]/[G])
|||||||||||||
NO 1) Check if the connector of the LCF feed sensor is disconnected.2) Check if either of the connectors CN100 or CN104 on the LCF board is dis-
connected.3) Check if the connector CN344 on the LGC board is disconnected.4) Check if the connector pins are disconnected or the harnesses are open
circuited.5) Check if the conductor patterns on the LCF board and LGC board are short
circuited or open circuited.6) Replace the LCF feed sensor.7) Replace the LCF board.8) Replace the LGC board.
YESIs the LCF feed clutch working? (Perform the output check: 03-209)
|||||||||||||
NO 1) Check if the connector of the LCF feed clutch is disconnected.2) Check if any of the connectors CN100, CN101 and CN103 on the LCF
board is disconnected.3) Check if the connector CN344 on the LGC board is disconnected.4) Check if the connector pins are disconnected or the harnesses are open
circuited.5) Check if the conductor patterns on the LCF board and LGC board are short
circuited or open circuited.6) Replace the LCF feed clutch.7) Replace the LCF board.8) Replace the LGC board.
YESCheck the LCF feed roller, separation roller and pickup roller. Replace them if they are worn out.
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedTROUBLESHOOTING
5 - 10
5.1.3 Paper transport jam[E200] Upper drawer transport jam (not reaching the registration sensor)[E210] Lower drawer transport jam (not reaching the registration sensor)[E300] PFP upper drawer transport jam (not reaching the registration sensor)[E330] PFP lower drawer transport jam (not reaching the registration sensor)[E3C0] LCF transport jam (not reaching the registration sensor)
Open the jam access cover. Is there paper in front of the registration sensor? YES Remove the paper.
NOIs the registration sensor working? (Perform the input check: 03-[FAX]ON/[9]/[E])
|||||||||
NO 1) Check if the connector of the registration sensor is disconnected.2) Check if the connector CN338 on the LGC board is disconnected.3) Check if the connector pins are disconnected or the harnesses are open
circuited.4) Check if the conductor pattern on the LGC board is short circuited or open
circuited.5) Replace the registration sensor.6) Replace the LGC board.
YESAre the upper transport clutches (high/low speed) working?(Perform the output check: 03-439, 440)
||||||||||
NO 1) Check if the connectors of the upper transport clutches (high/low speed) are disconnected.
2) Check if the connector CN339 on the LGC board is disconnected.3) Check if the connector pins are disconnected or the harnesses are open
circuited.4) Check if the conductor pattern on the LGC board is short circuited or open
circuited.5) Replace the upper transport clutches (high/low speed).6) Replace the LGC board.
YES1) Check the condition of the feed roller, separation roller and pickup roller of each paper
source, and replace them if they are worn out.2) Check the transport roller. Replace it if it is worn out.
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cTROUBLESHOOTING
5 - 11
5
[E220] Lower drawer transport jam (not reaching the upper drawer feed sensor)[E310] PFP upper drawer transport jam (not reaching the upper drawer feed sensor)[E340] PFP lower drawer transport jam (not reaching the upper drawer feed sensor)[E3D0] LCF transport jam (not reaching the upper drawer feed sensor)
Open the jam access cover. Is there paper in front of the upper drawer feed sensor? YES Remove the paper.
NOIs the upper drawer feed sensor working? (Perform the input check: 03-[FAX]ON/[3]/[H])
|||||||||
NO 1) Check if the connector of the upper drawer feed sensor is disconnected.2) Check if the connector CN338 on the LGC board is disconnected.3) Check if the connector pins are disconnected or the harnesses are open
circuited.4) Check if the conductor pattern on the LGC board is short circuited or open
circuited.5) Replace the upper drawer feed sensor.6) Replace the LGC board.
YESAre the lower transport clutches (high/low speed) working?(Perform the output check: 03-203, 205)
||||||||||
NO 1) Check if the connectors of the lower transport clutches (high/low speed) are disconnected.
2) Check if the connector CN341 on the LGC board is disconnected.3) Check if the connector pins are disconnected or the harnesses are open
circuited.4) Check if the conductor pattern on the LGC board is short circuited or open
circuited.5) Replace the lower transport clutches (high/low speed).6) Replace the LGC board.
YES1) Check the condition of the feed roller, separation roller and pickup roller of each paper
source, and replace them if they are worn out.2) Check the transport roller. Replace it if it is worn out.
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedTROUBLESHOOTING
5 - 12
[E320] PFP upper drawer transport jam (not reaching the lower drawer feed sensor)[E350] PFP lower drawer transport jam (not reaching the lower drawer feed sensor)[E3E0] LCF transport jam (not reaching the lower drawer feed sensor)
Open the side cover. Is there paper in front of the lower drawer feed sensor? YES Remove the paper.
NOIs the lower drawer feed sensor working? (Perform the input check: 03-[FAX]ON/[3]/[G])
|||||||||
NO 1) Check if the connector of the lower drawer feed sensor is disconnected.2) Check if the connector CN338 on the LGC board is disconnected.3) Check if the connector pins are disconnected or the harnesses are open
circuited.4) Check if the conductor pattern on the LGC board is short circuited or open
circuited.5) Replace the lower drawer feed sensor.6) Replace the LGC board.
YESAre the lower transport clutches working? (Perform the output check: 03-203, 205)
||||||||||
NO 1) Check if the connectors of the lower transport clutches (high/low speed) are disconnected.
2) Check if the connector CN341 on the LGC board is disconnected.3) Check if the connector pins are disconnected or the harnesses are open
circuited.4) Check if the conductor pattern on the LGC board is short circuited or open
circuited.5) Replace the lower transport clutches (high/low speed).6) Replace the LGC board.
YESWhen the paper fed from the PFP:Is the PFP transport clutch working? (Perform the output check: 03-225)
||||||||||||
NO 1) Check if the connector of the PFP transport clutch is disconnected.2) Check if any of the connectors CN241, CN242 and CN244 on the PFP
board is disconnected.3) Check if the connector CN344 on the LGC board is disconnected.4) Check if the connector pins are disconnected or the harnesses are open
circuited.5) Check if the conductor patterns on the PFP board and LGC board are short
circuited or open circuited.6) Replace the PFP transport clutch.7) Replace the PFP board.8) Replace the LGC board.
YES1) Check the condition of the feed roller, separation roller and pickup roller of each paper
source, and replace them if they are worn out.2) Check the transport roller. Replace it if it is worn out.
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cTROUBLESHOOTING
5 - 13
5
[E360] PFP lower drawer transport jam (not reaching the PFP upper drawer feed sensor)Open the PFP side cover. Is there any paper in front of the PFP upper drawer feed sensor? YES Remove the paper.
NOIs the PFP upper feed sensor working? (Perform the input check: 03-[FAX]OFF/[2]/[D])
||||||||||||||
NO 1) Check if the connector of the PFP upper drawer feed sensor is discon-nected.
2) Check if either of the connectors CN241 or CN243 on the PFP board is dis-connected.
3) Check if the connector CN344 on the LGC board is disconnected.4) Check if the connector pins are disconnected or the harnesses are open
circuited.5) Check if the conductor patterns on the PFP board and LGC board are short
circuited or open circuited.6) Replace the PFP upper drawer feed sensor.7) Replace the PFP board.8) Replace the LGC board.
YESIs the PFP transport clutch working? (Perform the output check: 03-225)
|||||||||||||
NO 1) Check if the connector of the PFP transport clutch is disconnected.2) Check if any of the connectors CN241, CN242 and CN244 on the PFP
board is disconnected.3) Check if the connector CN344 on the LGC board is disconnected.4) Check if the connector pins are disconnected or the harnesses are open
circuited.5) Check if the conductor patterns on the PFP board and LGC board are short
circuited or open circuited.6) Replace the PFP transport clutch.7) Replace the PFP board.8) Replace the LGC board.
YES1) Check the condition of the feed roller, separation roller and pickup roller of each paper
source, and replace them if they are worn out.2) Check the PFP transport roller. Replace it if it is worn out.
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedTROUBLESHOOTING
5 - 14
[E510] ADU transport stop jamOpen the ADU. Is there any paper in front of the ADU entrance sensor? YES Remove the paper.
NOIs the ADU entrance sensor working? (Perform the input check: 03-[FAX]OFF/[8]/[H])
|||||||||||||
NO 1) Check if the connector of the ADU entrance sensor is disconnected.2) Check if either of the connectors CN211 or CN214 on the ADU board is dis-
connected.3) Check if the connector CN340 on the LGC board is disconnected.4) Check if the connector pins are disconnected or the harnesses are open
circuited.5) Check if the conductor patterns on the ADU board and LGC board are short
circuited or open circuited.6) Replace the ADU entrance sensor.7) Replace the ADU board.8) Replace the LGC board.
YESIs the exit motor (rotating in reverse) working? (Perform the output check: 03-121/171)
|||||||||||||
NO 1) Check if the connector of the exit motor is disconnected.2) Check if the connectors CN437 and CN434 on the DRV board is discon-
nected.3) Check if the connector CN331 on the LGC board is disconnected.4) Check if the connector pins are disconnected or the harnesses are open
circuited.5) Check if the conductor patterns on the DRV board and LGC board are short
circuited or open circuited.6) Replace the exit motor.7) Replace the DRV board.8) Replace the LGC board.
YESIs the ADU motor working? (Perform the output check: 03-110/160)
||||||||||||
NO 1) Check if the connector of the ADU motor is disconnected.2) Check if any of the connectors CN211, CN212 and CN215 on the ADU
board is disconnected.3) Check if the connector CN340 on the LGC board is disconnected.4) Check if the connector pins are disconnected or the harnesses are open
circuited.5) Check if the conductor patterns on the ADU board and LGC board are short
circuited or open circuited.6) Replace the ADU motor.7) Replace the ADU board.8) Replace the LGC board.
YESCheck the rollers in the ADU and the exit roller of the equipment. Replace them if they are worn out.
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cTROUBLESHOOTING
5 - 15
5
[E520] Stop jam in the ADUOpen the ADU. Is there any paper in front of the ADU exit sensor? YES Remove the paper.
NOIs the ADU exit sensor working? (Perform the input check: 03-[FAX]OFF/[8]/[G])
|||||||||||||
NO 1) Check if the connector of the ADU exit sensor is disconnected.2) Check if either of the connectors CN211 or CN213 on the ADU board is dis-
connected.3) Check if the connector CN340 on the LGC board is disconnected.4) Check if the connector pins are disconnected or the harnesses are open
circuited.5) Check if the conductor patterns on the ADU board and LGC board are short
circuited or open circuited.6) Replace the ADU exit sensor.7) Replace the ADU board.8) Replace the LGC board.
YESIs the ADU clutch working?
|||||||||
NO 1) Check if the connector of the ADU clutch is disconnected.2) Check if the connector CN340 on the LGC board is disconnected.3) Check if the connector pins are disconnected or the harnesses are open
circuited.4) Check if the conductor pattern on the LGC board is short circuited or open
circuited.5) Replace the ADU clutch.6) Replace the LGC board.
YESCheck the rollers in the ADU. Replace them if they are worn out.
06/08
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedTROUBLESHOOTING
5 - 16
[EB50] Paper remaining on the transport path due to multiple feedingWhen the paper is fed from any of the upper drawer, bypass feed unit or ADU:
Open the jam access cover. Is there any paper in front of the registration sensor? YES Remove the paper.
NOWhen the paper is fed from the upper drawer:Is the upper drawer feed sensor working? (Perform the input check: 03-[FAX]ON/[3]/[H])
||||||||
NO 1) Check if the connector of the upper drawer feed sensor is disconnected.2) Check if the connector CN338 on the LGC board is disconnected.3) Check if the connector pins are disconnected or the harnesses are open
circuited.4) Check if the conductor pattern on the LGC board is short circuited or open
circuited.5) Replace the upper drawer feed sensor.6) Replace the LGC board.
YESWhen the paper is fed from the bypass feed unit:Is the bypass feed sensor working? (Perform the input check: 03-[FAX]ON/[9]/[D])
||||||||
NO 1) Check if the connector of the bypass feed sensor is disconnected.2) Check if the connector CN340 on the LGC board is disconnected.3) Check if the connector pins are disconnected or the harnesses are open
circuited.4) Check if the conductor pattern on the LGC board is short circuited or open
circuited.5) Replace the bypass feed sensor.6) Replace the LGC board.
YESWhen the paper is fed from the ADU:Is the ADU exit sensor working? (Perform the input check: 03-[FAX]OFF/[8]/[G])
|||||||||||
NO 1) Check if the connector of the ADU exit sensor is disconnected.2) Check if either of the connectors CN211 or CN213 on the ADU board is dis-
connected.3) Check if the connector CN340 on the LGC board is disconnected.4) Check if the connector pins are disconnected or the harnesses are open
circuited.5) Check if the conductor patterns on the ADU board and LGC board are short
circuited or open circuited.6) Replace the ADU exit sensor.7) Replace the ADU board.8) Replace the LGC board.
YESIs the registration sensor working? (Perform the input check: 03-[FAX]ON/[9]/[E])
|||||||||
NO 1) Check if the connector of the registration sensor is disconnected.2) Check if the connector CN338 on the LGC board is disconnected.3) Check if the connector pins are disconnected or the harnesses are open
circuited.4) Check if the conductor pattern on the LGC board is short circuited or open
circuited.5) Replace the registration sensor.6) Replace the LGC board.
YESCheck the rollers. Replace them if they are worn out.
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cTROUBLESHOOTING
5 - 17
5
[EB60] Paper remaining on the transport path due to multiple feeding
When the paper is fed from any of the lower drawer, PFP or LCF:Open the jam access cover. Is there any paper in front of the upper drawer feed sensor? YES Remove the paper.
NOAre the upper/lower drawer feed sensors working?(Perform the input check: 03-[FAX]ON/[3]/[H], /[3]/[G])
||||||||||
NO 1) Check if the connectors of the upper/lower drawer feed sensors are discon-nected.
2) Check if the connector CN338 on the LGC board is disconnected.3) Check if the connector pins are disconnected or the harnesses are open
circuited.4) Check if the conductor pattern on the LGC board is short circuited or open
circuited.5) Replace the upper/lower drawer feed sensors.6) Replace the LGC board.
YESCheck the rollers. Replace them if they are worn out.
Open the jam access cover. Is there any paper in front of the registration sensor? YES Remove the paper.
NOIs the registration sensor working? (Perform the input check: 03-[FAX]ON/[9]/[E])
|||||||||
NO 1) Check if the connector of the registration sensor is disconnected.2) Check if the connector CN338 on the LGC board is disconnected.3) Check if the connector pins are disconnected or the harnesses are open
circuited.4) Check if the conductor pattern on the LGC board is short circuited or open
circuited.5) Replace the registration sensor.6) Replace the LGC board.
YESCheck the rollers. Replace them if they are worn out.
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedTROUBLESHOOTING
5 - 18
5.1.4 Other paper jam[E030] Power-ON jam
Relation between the jamming area and the corresponding sensors/covers.(If a jam is occurring in the ADU, LCF or PFP, check the board in each unit.)
[E061] Incorrect paper size setting for upper drawer[E062] Incorrect paper size setting for lower drawer[E063] Incorrect paper size setting for PFP upper drawer[E064] Incorrect paper size setting for PFP lower drawer[E065] Incorrect paper size setting for bypass tray
Open the cover of the unit/area whose picture is flashing on the control panel. Is there any paper on the transport path? (Refer to the following table) YES Remove the paper.
NOIs the sensor in the jamming area working?(Perform the input check: Refer to the following table.)
|||||||||
NO 1) Check if the connector of the sensor is disconnected.2) Check if any of the connectors on the LGC board is disconnected.3) Check if the connector pins are disconnected or the harnesses are open
circuited.4) Check if the conductor pattern on the LGC board is short circuited or open
circuited.5) Replace the sensor.6) Replace the LGC board.
NOReplace the LGC board.
Jamming area Cover Sensor Test Mode/Input checkRegistration area Jam access cover Registration sensor 03-[FAX]ON/[9]/[E]
Upper drawer feed sensor 03-[FAX]ON/[3]/[H]Exit area Fuser cover Exit sensor 03-[FAX]OFF/[7]/[H]ADU ADU ADU entrance sensor 03-[FAX]OFF/[8]/[H]
ADU exit sensor 03-[FAX]OFF/[8]/[G]Feeding area (equipment)
Side cover Lower drawer feed sensor 03-[FAX]ON/[3]/[G]
Bypass unit Bypass unit Bypass feed sensor 03-[FAX]ON/[9]/[D]LCF LCF side cover LCF feed sensor 03-[FAX]OFF/[5]/[G]PFP PFP side cover PFP upper drawer feed sensor 03-[FAX]OFF/[2]/[D]
PFP lower drawer feed sensor 03-[FAX]OFF/[4]/[D]Bridge unit Bridge unit Bridge unit transport sensor-1 03-[FAX]ON/[0]/[C]
Bridge unit transport sensor-2 03-[FAX]ON/[0]/[A]
If any paper remains in the equipment or drawer, remove it. Match the paper size of the drawer setting and the one in the drawer.
* Paper size detection is performed at the first sheet of paper when the drawer is opened or closed, or when the power of the equipment is turned ON.
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cTROUBLESHOOTING
5 - 19
5
[E090] Image data delay jam
[E550] Paper remaining on the transport path
Relation between the jamming area and the corresponding sensors/covers(If a jam is occurring in the ADU, LCF or PFP, check the board in each unit.)
1) Remove the paper remained in front of the registration sensor.2) Check if the error is cleared by turning the power OFF and then back ON.3) Check if the connectors connecting the SYS board, SLG board and PLG board are dis-
connected.4) Check if the connectors of the HDD are disconnected.5) Check if the harnesses connecting the SYS board, SLG board and PLG board are open-
circuited.6) Replace the HDD, SYS board, SLG board and PLG board.
Open the cover of the unit/area whose picture is flashing on the control panel. Is there any paper on the transport path? YES Remove the paper.
NOIs the sensor in the jamming area working?(Perform the input check: Refer to the following table)
|||||||||
NO 1) Check if the connector of the sensor is disconnected.2) Check if any of the connectors on the LGC board is disconnected.3) Check if the connector pins are disconnected or the harnesses are open
circuited.4) Check if the conductor pattern on the LGC board is short circuited or open
circuited.5) Replace the sensor.6) Replace the LGC board.
YESReplace the LGC board.
Jamming area Cover Sensor Test Mode/Input checkRegistration area Jam access cover Registration sensor 03-[FAX]ON/[9]/[E]
Upper drawer feed sensor 03-[FAX]ON/[3]/[H]Exit area Fuser cover Exit sensor 03-[FAX]OFF/[7]/[H]ADU ADU ADU entrance sensor 03-[FAX]OFF/[8]/[H]
ADU exit sensor 03-[FAX]OFF/[8]/[G]Bypass unit Bypass unit Bypass feed sensor 03-[FAX]ON/[9]/[D]Feeding area (equipment)
Side cover Lower drawer feed sensor 03-[FAX]ON/[3]/[G]
LCF LCF side cover LCF feed sensor 03-[FAX]OFF/[5]/[G]PFP PFP side cover PFP upper drawer feed sensor 03-[FAX]OFF/[2]/[D]
PFP lower drawer feed sensor 03-[FAX]OFF/[4]/[D]Bridge unit Bridge unit Bridge unit transport sensor-1 03-[FAX]ON/[0]/[C]
Bridge unit transport sensor-2 03-[FAX]ON/[0]/[A]Finisher Finisher door Sensors in the finisher -
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedTROUBLESHOOTING
5 - 20
5.1.5 Cover open jam[E400] Jam access cover open
[E410] Front cover open jam
Is the jam access cover open? YES Remove paper if there is any, then shut the cover.
NOIs the voltage of 24V being supplied from the power supply unit?(Perform the input check: 03-[FAX] ON/[1]/[H])
||||||||
NO 1) Check if the connector for 24V power supply is disconnected.2) Check if the connector CN335 on the LGC board is disconnected.3) Check if the connector pins are disconnected or the harnesses are open
circuited.4) Check if the conductor pattern on the LGC board is short circuited or open
circuited.5) Replace the LGC board.
YESReplace the LGC board.
Is the front cover open? YES Shut the cover.
NOIs the voltage of 24V being supplied from the power supply unit?(Perform the input check: 03-[FAX] ON/[1]/[H])
||||||||
NO 1) Check if the connector for 24V power supply is disconnected.2) Check if the connector CN335 on the LGC board is disconnected.3) Check if the connector pins are disconnected or the harnesses are open
circuited.4) Check if the conductor pattern on the LGC board is short circuited or open
circuited.5) Replace the LGC board.
YESIs the front cover opening/closing switch working?(Perform the input check: 03-[FAX]OFF/[7]/[F])
||||||||||
NO 1) Check if the connector of the front cover opening/closing switch is discon-nected.
2) Check if the connector CN338 on the LGC board is disconnected.3) Check if the connector pins are disconnected or the harnesses are open
circuited.4) Check if the conductor pattern on the LGC board is short circuited or open
circuited.5) Replace the front cover opening/closing switch.6) Replace the LGC board.
YESReplace the LGC board.
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cTROUBLESHOOTING
5 - 21
5
[E420] PFP side cover open jam
[E430] ADU open jam
Is the PFP side cover open? YES Remove the paper if there is any, then shut the cover.
NOIs the PFP side cover opening/closing switch working?(Perform the input check: 03-[FAX]OFF/[2]/[F])
||||||||||||||
NO 1) Check if the connector of the PFP side cover opening/closing switch is dis-connected.
2) Check if either of the connectors CN241 or CN243 on the PFP board is dis-connected.
3) Check if the connector CN344 on the LGC board is disconnected.4) Check if the connector pins are disconnected or the harnesses are open
circuited.5) Check if the conductor patterns on the PFP board and LGC board are short
circuited or open circuited.6) Replace the PFP side cover opening/closing switch.7) Replace the PFP board.8) Replace the LGC board.
YES1) Replace the PFP board.2) Replace the LGC board.
Is the ADU open? YES Remove the paper if there is any, then shut the ADU.
NOIs the ADU opening/closing switch working?(Perform the input check: 03-[FAX]OFF/[8]/[F])
|||||||||||||
NO 1) Check if the connector of the ADU opening/closing switch is disconnected.2) Check if either of the connectors CN211 or CN217 on the ADU board is dis-
connected.3) Check if the connector CN340 on the LGC board is disconnected.4) Check if the connector pins are disconnected or the harnesses are open
circuited.5) Check if the conductor patterns on the ADU board and LGC board are short
circuited or open circuited.6) Replace the ADU opening/closing switch.7) Replace the ADU board.8) Replace the LGC board.
YES1) Replace the ADU board.2) Replace the LGC board.
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedTROUBLESHOOTING
5 - 22
[E440] Side cover open jam
[E450] LCF side cover open jam
Is the side cover open? YES Remove the paper if there is any, then shut the cover.
NOIs the side door switch working?(Perform the input check: 03-[FAX]OFF/[7]/[E])
|||||||||
NO 1) Check if the connector of the side door switch is disconnected.2) Check if the connector CN338 on the LGC board is disconnected.3) Check if the connector pins are disconnected or the harnesses are open
circuited.4) Check if the conductor pattern on the LGC board is short circuited or open
circuited.5) Replace the side door switch.6) Replace the LGC board.
YESReplace the LGC board.
Is the LCF side cover open? YES Remove the paper if there is any, then shut the cover.
NOIs the LCF side cover opening/closing switch working?(Perform the input check: 03-[FAX]OFF/[5]/[D])
||||||||||||||
NO 1) Check if the connector of the LCF side cover opening/closing switch is dis-connected.
2) Check if either of the connectors CN100 or CN106 on the LCF board is dis-connected.
3) Check if the connector CN344 on the LGC board is disconnected.4) Check if the connector pins are disconnected or the harnesses are open
circuited.5) Check if the conductor patterns on the LCF board and LGC board are short
circuited or open circuited.6) Replace the LCF side cover opening/closing switch.7) Replace the LCF board.8) Replace the LGC board.
YES1) Replace the LCF board.2) Replace the LGC board.
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cTROUBLESHOOTING
5 - 23
5
[E480] Bridge unit open jamIs the Bridge unit open? YES Remove the paper if there is any, then close the unit.
NOIs the bridge unit cover opening/closing detection switch working?(Perform the input check: 03-[FAX]ON/[0]/[B])
||||||||||
NO 1) Check if the connector of the bridge unit cover opening/closing detection switch is disconnected.
2) Check if the connector CN353 on the LGC board is disconnected.3) Check if the connector pins are disconnected or the harnesses are open
circuited.4) Check if the conductor pattern on the LGC board is short circuited or open
circuited.5) Replace the bridge unit cover opening/closing detection switch.6) Replace the LGC board.
YESReplace the LGC board.
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedTROUBLESHOOTING
5 - 24
5.1.6 RADF jam[E712] Jam not reaching the original registration sensor
[E713] Cover open jam in the read ready status
Are the pickup roller, feed roller and separation roller stained or worn out? YES Clean the rollers or replace them.
NOIs the original excessively curled or folded? YES Flatten and set it again.
NOIs the original registration sensor working?(Perform the input check: 03-[FAX]ON/[7]/[H])
|||||||||
NO 1) Check if the connector of the original registration sensor is disconnected.2) Check if the connector CN74 on the RADF board is disconnected.3) Check if the connector pins are disconnected or the harnesses are open
circuited.4) Check if the conductor pattern on the RADF board is short circuited or open
circuited.5) Replace the original registration sensor.6) Replace the RADF board.
YESReplace the RADF board.
Are the RADF jam access cover or front cover opened in read ready status? YES Close the cover
NOIs the original excessively curled or folded? YES Flatten and set it again.
NOIs the RADF jam access cover sensor working? (Perform the input check: 03-[FAX]ON/[7]/[C])
|||||||||
NO 1) Check if the connector of the RADF jam access cover sensor is discon-nected.
2) Check if the connector CN75 on the RADF board is disconnected.3) Check if the connector pins are disconnected or the harnesses are open
circuited.4) Check if the conductor pattern on the RADF board is short circuited or open
circuited.5) Replace the RADF jam access cover sensor.6) Replace the RADF board.
YESReplace the RADF board.
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cTROUBLESHOOTING
5 - 25
5
[E714] Feed signal reception jam
[E721] Jam not reaching the read sensor
Is the empty sensor working? (Perform the input check: 03-[FAX]ON/[7]/[B]) YES Clean the rollers or replace them.
NOIs the original excessively curled or folded? YES Flatten and set it again.
NOAre the original length sensor and registration sensor working?(Perform the input check: 03-[FAX]ON/[8]/[E], [7]/[H])
||||||||||
NO 1) Check if the lever of empty sensor is working normally.2) Check if the connector of the empty sensor is disconnected.3) Check if the connector CN75 on the RADF board is disconnected.4) Check if the connector pins are disconnected or the harnesses are open
circuited.5) Check if the conductor pattern on the RADF board is short circuited or open
circuited.6) Replace the empty sensor.7) Replace the RADF board.
YESReplace the RADF board.
Are the registration roller and read roller stained? YES Clean the rollers.
NOIs the read sensor working? (Perform the input check: 03-[FAX]ON/[7]/[G])
|||||||||
NO 1) Check if the connector of the read sensor are disconnected.2) Check if the connector CN75 on the RADF board is disconnected.3) Check if the connector pins are disconnected or the harnesses are open
circuited.4) Check if the conductor pattern on the RADF board is short circuited or open
circuited.5) Replace the read sensor.6) Replace the RADF board.
YESReplace the RADF board.
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedTROUBLESHOOTING
5 - 26
[E722] Jam not reaching the exit sensor (during scanning)[E723] Jam not reaching the reverse sensor (during scanning)
[E724] Stop jam at the registration sensor
Is the read roller stained? YES Clean the roller.
NOAre the exit sensor and reverse sensor working?(Perform the input check: 03-[FAX]ON/[7]/[E], [7]/[F])
||||||||||
NO 1) Check if the connectors of the exit sensor and reverse sensor are discon-nected.
2) Check if the connector CN75 on the RADF board is disconnected.3) Check if the connector pins are disconnected or the harnesses are open
circuited.4) Check if the conductor pattern on the RADF board is short circuited or open
circuited.5) Replace the exit sensor and reverse sensor.6) Replace the RADF board.
YESReplace the RADF board.
Is the registration roller stained? YES Clean the roller.
NOIs the registration sensor working? (Perform the input check: 03-[FAX]ON/[7]/[H])
|||||||||
NO 1) Check if the connector of the registration sensor is disconnected.2) Check if the connector CN74 on the RADF board is disconnected.3) Check if the connector pins are disconnected or the harnesses are open
circuited.4) Check if the conductor pattern on the RADF board is short circuited or open
circuited.5) Replace the registration sensor.6) Replace the RADF board.
YESReplace the RADF board.
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cTROUBLESHOOTING
5 - 27
5
[E725] Stop jam at the read sensor
[E731] Stop jam at the exit sensor
[E860] RADF jam access cover open
Is the read roller stained? YES Clean the roller.
NOIs the read sensor working? (Perform the input check: 03-[FAX]ON/[7]/[G])
|||||||||
NO 1) Check if the connector of the read sensor is disconnected.2) Check if the connector CN75 on the RADF board is disconnected.3) Check if the connector pins are disconnected or the harnesses are open
circuited.4) Check if the conductor pattern on the RADF board is short circuited or open
circuited.5) Replace the read sensor.6) Replace the RADF board.
YESReplace the RADF board.
Is the exit roller stained? YES Clean the roller.
NOIs the exit sensor working? (Perform the input check: 03-[FAX]ON/[7]/[E])
|||||||||
NO 1) Check if the connector of the exit sensor is disconnected.2) Check if the connector CN75 on the RADF board is disconnected.3) Check if the connector pins are disconnected or the harnesses are open
circuited.4) Check if the conductor pattern on the RADF board is short circuited or open
circuited.5) Replace the exit sensor.6) Replace the RADF board.
YESReplace the RADF board.
Is the RADF jam access cover opened? YES Remove the original, if any, and close the jam access cover.
NOIs the RADF jam access cover switch working? (Perform the input check: 03-[FAX]ON/[7]/[C])
|||||||||
NO 1) Check if the connector of the RADF jam access cover switch is discon-nected.
2) Check if the connector CN72 on the RADF board is disconnected.3) Check if the connector pins are disconnected or the harnesses are open
circuited.4) Check if the conductor pattern on the RADF board is short circuited or open
circuited.5) Replace the RADF jam access cover switch.6) Replace the RADF board.
YESReplace the RADF board.
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedTROUBLESHOOTING
5 - 28
[E870] RADF open jamIs the RADF opened? YES Remove the original, if any, and close the RADF.
NOIs the RADF opening/closing sensor adjusted within the specified range? NO Adjust the RADF opening/closing sensor.
YESIs the RADF opening/closing sensor working? (Perform the input check: 03-[FAX]ON/[7]/[D])
||||||||||
NO 1) Check if the connector of the RADF opening/closing sensor is discon-nected.
2) Check if the connector CN75 on the RADF board is disconnected.3) Check if the connector pins are disconnected or the harnesses are open
circuited.4) Check if the conductor pattern on the RADF board is short circuited or open
circuited.5) Replace the RADF opening/closing sensor.6) Replace the RADF board.
YESReplace the RADF board.
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cTROUBLESHOOTING
5 - 29
5
5.1.7 Finisher jam
[ 1 ] Jam in bridge unit[E910] Paper not reaching the bridge unit transport sensor-1[E920] Paper stopping at the bridge unit transport sensor-1[E930] Paper not reaching the bridge unit transport sensor-2[E940] Paper stopping at the bridge unit transport sensor-2
Is there any paper remaining inside the bridge unit? YES Remove the paper.
NOAre the bridge unit transport sensors-1 and -2 working?(Perform the input check:03-[FAX]ON/[0]/[C], /[0]/[A])
|||||||||||
NO 1) Check if the connectors of the bridge unit transport sensors-1 and -2 are disconnected.
2) Check if the connector J510 of the bridge unit is disconnected.3) Check if the connector CN353 on the LGC board is disconnected.4) Check if the connector pins are disconnected or the harnesses are open
circuited.5) Check if the conductor pattern on the LGC board is short circuited or open
circuited.6) Replace the bridge unit transport sensors-1 and -2.7) Replace the LGC board.
YESIs the bridge unit gate solenoid working? (Perform the output check: 03-232)
|||||||
NO 1) Check if the connector J510 of the bridge unit is disconnected.2) Check if the connector CN353 on the LGC board is disconnected.3) Check if the connector pins are disconnected or the harnesses are open
circuited.4) Replace the bridge unit gate solenoid.5) Replace the LGC board.
YESDoes the transport roller of the bridge unit work when the main motor is rotated?(Perform the output check: 03-101/151) NO Check the drive system of the equipment and bridge unit.
YESCheck if the rollers in the bridge unit are worn out.
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedTROUBLESHOOTING
5 - 30
[ 2 ] Paper jam in finisher section[EA10] Paper transport delay jamMJ-1022
Is there any paper remaining on the transport path in the finisher or equipment? YES Remove the paper.
NOIs the connector J10 on the finisher controller PC board disconnected?Is the harness connecting the finisher controller PC board and inlet sensor (S2) open cir-cuited? YES Connect the connector securely. Replace the harness.
NOIs the inlet sensor working normally? (Check the movement of the actuator.)
|||
NO 1) Connect the connector of the inlet sensor securely.2) Attach the actuator securely if its shaft is out of place.3) Replace the inlet sensor.
YESReplace the finisher controller PC board.
MJ-1023/1024Is there any paper remaining on the transport path in the finisher or equipment? YES Remove the paper.
NOIs the connector J708 on the finisher controller PC board disconnected?Is the harness connecting the finisher controller PC board and inlet sensor (PI33) open cir-cuited? YES Connect the connector securely. Replace the harness.
NOIs the inlet sensor working properly? (Check the movement of the actuator.)
|||
NO 1) Connect the connector of the inlet sensor securely.2) Attach the actuator securely if its shaft is out of place.3) Replace the inlet sensor.
YESReplace the finisher controller PC board.
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cTROUBLESHOOTING
5 - 31
5
MJ-1101Is there any paper remaining on the transport path in the finisher or equipment?
YES Remove the paper.
NOIs there a disconnection of the connector, incorrect installation or breakage of the entrance sensor (S1)?
ll
YES • Reconnect the connector securely.• Reinstall the sensor correctly. • Replace the sensor.
NOIs the gap between the flapper and entrance roller shaft other than 0.60±0.20mm when the gate solenoid (SOL2) is pulled?
YES Adjust the gap.
NOIs the harness between the entrance motor (M1) and the finisher control PC board (CN7) dis-connected or open circuited?Is the harness between the gate solenoid (SOL2) and the finisher control PC board (CN22) disconnected or open circuited?
l
YES • Reconnect the connector securely.• Replace the harness.
NOReplace the finisher controller PC board.
06/08
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedTROUBLESHOOTING
5 - 32
[EA20] Paper transport stop jamMJ-1022
Is there any paper remaining on the transport path in the finisher or equipment? YES Remove the paper.
NOIs the connector J10 on the finisher controller PC board disconnected?Is the harness connecting the finisher controller PC board and inlet sensor (S2) open cir-cuited? YES Connect the connector securely. Replace the harness.
NOIs the inlet sensor working properly? (Check the movement of the actuator.)
|||
NO 1) Connect the connector of the inlet sensor securely.2) Attach the actuator securely if its shaft is out of place.3) Replace the inlet sensor.
YESReplace the finisher controller PC board.
MJ-1023/1024Is there any paper remaining on the transport path in the finisher or equipment? YES Remove the paper.
NOIs any of the connectors (J707, J708 and J722B) on the finisher controller PC board discon-nected?Is the harness between the finisher controller PC board and each sensor (the inlet sensor [PI33], the transport path sensor [PI34], the processing tray sensor [PI38]) open circuited? YES Connect the connectors securely. Replace the harnesses.
NOIs each of the sensors (the inlet sensor, the transport path sensor and the processing tray sen-sor) working properly? (Check the movement of the actuator.)
|||
NO 1) Connect the connectors of the sensors securely.2) Attach the actuators securely if their shafts are out of place.3) Replace the sensors.
YESReplace the finisher controller PC board.
MJ-1101Is there any paper remaining on the transport path in the finisher or equipment?
YES Remove the paper.
NOIs there a disconnection of the connector, incorrect installation or breakage of the transport sensor (S2)?
ll
YES • Connect the connector securely.• Reinstall the sensor correctly. • Replace the sensor.
NOReplace the finisher control PC board.
06/08
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cTROUBLESHOOTING
5 - 33
5
[EA21] Paper size error jamMJ-1101
Is there any paper remaining on the transport path in the finisher or equipment?
YES Remove the paper.
NOIs the paper size used shorter than the size specified in the specifications?
YES Use the paper size specified in the specifications.
NOIs there a disconnection of the connector, incorrect installation or breakage of the entrance sensor (S1)?Is there a disconnection of the connector, incorrect installation or breakage of the transport sensor (S2)?
ll
YES • Connect the connector securely.• Reinstall the sensor correctly. • Replace the sensor.
NOIs the harness between the entrance motor (M1) and the finisher control PC board (CN7) dis-connected or open circuited?Is the harness between the transport sensor (S2) and the finisher control PC board (CN22) disconnected or open circuited?
l
YES • Reconnect the connector securely.• Replace the harness.
NOReplace the finisher control PC board.
06/08
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedTROUBLESHOOTING
5 - 34
[EA30] Power-ON jamMJ-1022
Is there any paper remaining on the transport path in the finisher? YES Remove the paper.
NOIs the connector J10 on the finisher controller PC board disconnected?Is the harness connecting the finisher controller PC board and inlet sensor (S2) open cir-cuited? YES Connect the connector securely. Replace the harness.
NOIs the inlet sensor working properly? (Check the movement of the actuator.)
|||
NO 1) Connect the connector of the inlet sensor securely.2) Attach the actuator securely if its shaft is out of place.3) Replace the inlet sensor.
YESReplace the finisher controller PC board.
MJ-1023/1024Is there any paper remaining on the transport path in the finisher? YES Remove the paper.
NOIs any of the connectors J707, J708 and J722B on the finisher controller PC board discon-nected?Is the harness between the finisher controller PC board and each sensor (the inlet sensor [PI33], the transport path sensor [PI34], the processing tray sensor [PI38], open circuited? YES Connect the connectors securely. Replace the harnesses.
NOIs each of the sensors (the inlet sensor, the transport path sensor and the processing tray sen-sor) working properly? (Check the movement of the actuator.)
|||
NO 1) Connect the connectors of the sensors securely.2) Attach the actuators securely if their shafts are out of place.3) Replace the sensors.
YESReplace the finisher controller PC board.
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cTROUBLESHOOTING
5 - 35
5
[EA31] Transport path paper remaining jam
[EA32] Exit paper remaining jam
MJ-1101Is there any paper remaining on the transport path in the finisher or equipment?
YES Remove the paper.
NOIs there a disconnection of the connector, incorrect installation or breakage of the transport sensor (S2)?
ll
YES • Connect the connector securely.• Reinstall the sensor correctly. • Replace the sensor.
NOIs the harness between the transport sensor (S2) and the finisher control PC board (CN22) disconnected or open circuited?
l
YES • Reconnect the connector securely.• Replace the harness.
NOReplace the finisher control PC board.
MJ-1101Is there any paper remaining on the transport path in the finisher or equipment?
YES Remove the paper.
NOIs there a disconnection of the connector, incorrect installation or breakage of the finishing tray paper detection sensor (S12)?
ll
YES • Connect the connector securely.• Reinstall the sensor correctly. • Replace the sensor.
NOIs the harness between the finishing tray paper detection sensor (S12) and the finisher control PC board (CN11) disconnected or open circuited?
l
YES • Reconnect the connector securely.• Replace the harness.
NOReplace the finisher control PC board.
06/08
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedTROUBLESHOOTING
5 - 36
[EA40] Door open jamMJ-1022
Is there any paper remaining on the transport path in the finisher or equipment? YES Remove the paper.
NOIs the finisher connected with the equipment? NO Connect the finisher with the equipment.
YESIs the connector J11 on the finisher controller PC board disconnected?Is the harness connecting the finisher controller PC board and joint sensor (S4) open cir-cuited? YES Connect the connector securely. Replace the harness.
NOIs the joint sensor working properly?
||
NO 1) Connect the connector of the joint sensor securely.2) Replace the joint sensor.
YESReplace the finisher controller PC board.
MJ-1023/1024Is there any paper remaining on the transport path in the finisher or equipment? YES Remove the paper.
NOIs either of the covers upper or front of the finisher closed? NO Close the door.
YESIs any connectors J707 and J708 on the finisher controller PC board disconnected?Is the harness connecting the finisher controller PC board and upper/front cover opening sen-sors (PI31 and PI32) open circuited? YES Connect the connector securely. Replace the harness.
NOIs the upper/front cover opening sensor working properly?
||
NO 1) Connect the connector of the upper/front cover opening sensor securely.2) Replace the upper/front cover opening sensor.
YESIs the connector J719 on the finisher controller PC board disconnected?Is the harness connecting the finisher controller PC board and front cover switch (MS31) open circuited?
|
YES Connect the connector securely. Replace the harness.
NOIs the front cover switch working properly?
||
NO 1) Connect the connector of the front cover switch securely.2) Replace the front cover switch.
YESIs the connector J5 on the punch controller PC board disconnected?Is the harness connecting the punch controller PC board and upper door switch (MSW61) open circuited?Is the harness connecting the punch controller PC board and front door switch (MSW62) open circuited?
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cTROUBLESHOOTING
5 - 37
5
YES Connect the connector securely. Replace the harness.
NOAre the upper and front door switches working properly?
||
NO 1) Connect the connectors of the upper and front door switches securely.2) Replace the upper/front door switches.
YESReplace the finisher controller PC board.
MJ-1101Is the front cover or stationary tray cover opened?
l
YES • Close the front cover.• Close the stationary tray cover.
NOIs there any breakage of the front cover hook which switches the front cover switch (SW1) to ON?
YES Replace the handle cover.
NOIs there a disconnection of the connector, incorrect installation or breakage of the front cover switch (SW1)?Is there an incorrect installation or breakage of the stationary tray cover opening/closing switch (SW2)?
ll
YES • Connect the connector securely.• Reinstall the sensor correctly. • Replace the sensor.
NOIs the harness between the front cover switch (SW1) / stationary tray opening/closing switch (SW2) and the finisher control PC board (CN16) disconnected or open circuited?
l
YES • Reconnect the connector securely.• Replace the harness.
NOReplace the finisher control PC board.
06/08
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedTROUBLESHOOTING
5 - 38
[EA50] Stapling jamMJ-1022
Is there any paper remaining on the transport path in the finisher or equipment or on the sta-pling tray? YES Remove the paper.
NOIs the jam cleared by taking off the staple cartridge from the finisher and removing the staple sheet slid from the staple case? YES End.
NOIs the connector J8 on the finisher controller PC board disconnected?Is the harness connecting the finisher controller PC board and stapling home position sensor (S17) open circuited? YES Connect the connector securely. Replace the harness.
NOIs the stapling home position sensor working properly?
||
NO 1) Connect the connector of the stapling home position sensor securely.2) Replace the stapling home position sensor.
YESReplace the finisher controller PC board.
MJ-1023/1024Is there any paper remaining on the transport path in the finisher or equipment or on the sta-pling tray? YES Remove the paper.
NOIs the jam cleared by taking off the staple cartridge from the finisher and removing the staple sheet slid from the staple case? YES End.
NOIs the connector J721B on the finisher controller PC board disconnected?Is the harness connecting the finisher controller PC board and staple home position sensor (PI40) open circuited? YES Connect the connector securely. Replace the harness.
NOIs the staple home position sensor working properly?
||
NO 1) Connect the connector of the staple home position sensor securely.2) Replace the staple home position sensor.
YESReplace the finisher controller PC board.
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cTROUBLESHOOTING
5 - 39
5
MJ-1101Is there any paper remaining on the transport path in the finisher or equipment, or on the fin-ishing tray?
YES Remove the paper.
NOIs the jam cleared by taking off the staple cartridge from the finisher and removing the staple sheet slid from the staple case?
YES End.
NOIs there any mechanical problem when the actuator of the stapler interference sensor (S11) is moved?
YES Reinsert the clip which fixes the actuator from the side of it.
NOIs the harness between the stapler and the finisher control PC board (CN2) disconnected or open circuited?
l
YES • Reconnect the connector securely.• Replace the harness.
NOAre the harnesses in the stapler disconnected or open circuited?
l
YES • Reconnect the connector securely.• Replace the harness.
NOReplace the finisher control PC board.
06/08
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedTROUBLESHOOTING
5 - 40
[EA60] Early arrival jamMJ-1022
Is there any paper remaining on the transport path in the finisher or equipment? YES Remove the paper.
NOIs the connector J10 on the finisher controller PC board disconnected?Is the harness connecting the finisher controller PC board and inlet sensor (S2) open cir-cuited? YES Connect the connector securely. Replace the harness.
NOIs the inlet sensor working properly? (Check the movement of the actuator.)
|||
NO 1) Connect the connector of the inlet sensor securely.2) Attach the actuator securely if its shaft is out of place.3) Replace the inlet sensor.
YESReplace the finisher controller PC board.
MJ-1023/1024Is there any paper remaining on the transport path in the finisher or equipment? YES Remove the paper.
NOIs the connector J708 on the finisher controller PC board disconnected?Is the harness connecting the finisher controller PC board and inlet sensor (PI33) open cir-cuited? YES Connect the connector securely. Replace the harness.
NOIs the inlet sensor working properly? (Check the movement of the actuator.)
|||
NO 1) Connect the connector of the inlet sensor securely.2) Attach the actuator securely if its shaft is out of place.3) Replace the inlet sensor.
YESReplace the finisher controller PC board.
MJ-1101Is there any paper remaining on the transport path in the finisher or equipment?
YES Remove the paper.
NOIs there a disconnection of the connector, incorrect installation or breakage of the entrance sensor (S1)?
ll
YES • Connect the connector securely.• Reinstall the sensor correctly. • Replace the sensor.
NOIs the harness between the entrance sensor (S1) and the finisher control PC board (CN7) dis-connected or open circuited?
l
YES • Reconnect the connector securely.• Replace the harness.
NOReplace the finisher control PC board.
06/08
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cTROUBLESHOOTING
5 - 41
5
[EA70] Stack delivery jam
[EA70] Stack exit belt home position error
MJ-1022Is there any paper remaining on the transport path in the finisher or equipment? YES Remove the paper.
NOIs the connector J9 on the finisher controller PC board disconnected?Is the harness connecting the finisher controller PC board and stack delivery lever home posi-tion sensor (S8) open circuited? YES Connect the connector securely. Replace the harness.
NOIs the stack delivery lever home position sensor working properly?
|||
NO 1) Connect the connector of the stack delivery lever home position sensor securely.
2) Replace the stack delivery lever home position sensor.
YESReplace the finisher controller PC board.
MJ-1101Is there a disconnection of the connector, incorrect installation or breakage of the stack exit belt home position sensor (S9)?
ll
YES • Connect the connector securely.• Reinstall the sensor correctly. • Replace the sensor.
NOIs the harness between the stack exit belt home position sensor (S9) and the finisher control PC board (CN11) disconnected or open circuited?
l
YES • Reconnect the connector securely.• Replace the harness.
NOIs the harness between the stack transport motor (M5) and the finisher control PC board (CN10) disconnected or open circuited?
l
YES • Reconnect the connector securely.• Replace the harness.
NOReplace the finisher control PC board.
06/08
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedTROUBLESHOOTING
5 - 42
[EAF0] Stack return jamMJ-1022
Is there any paper remaining on the transport path in the finisher or equipment? YES Remove the paper.
NOIs the connector J10 on the finisher controller PC board disconnected?Is the harness connecting the finisher controller PC board and returning roller home position sensor (S3) open circuited? YES Connect the connector securely. Replace the harness.
NOIs the returning roller home position sensor working properly?
|||
NO 1) Connect the connector of the returning roller home position sensor securely.
2) Replace the returning roller home position sensor.
YESReplace the finisher controller PC board.
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cTROUBLESHOOTING
5 - 43
5
[ 3 ] Paper jam in saddle stitcher section[EA80] Stapling jam
[EA90] Door open jam
MJ-1024Is there any paper remaining on the transport path or the stapling tray in the finisher, saddle stitcher section or equipment? YES Remove the paper.
NOIs the jam cleared by taking off the staple cartridge from the finisher and removing the staples stuck in the stapling unit? YES End.
NOIs the connector J8 on the saddle stitcher controller PC board disconnected?Is the harness connecting the saddle stitcher controller PC board and stitcher home position switch (rear: SW5, front: SW7 open circuited? YES Connect the connector securely. Replace the harness.
NOAre the stitcher home position switches working properly?
||
NO 1) Connect the connectors of the stitcher home position switches securely.2) Replace the stitcher home position switches.
YESReplace the saddle stitcher controller PC board.
MJ-1024Is there any paper remaining on the transport path in the finisher, saddle stitcher section or equipment? YES Remove the paper.
NOIs the saddle stitcher door closed? NO Close the door.
YESIs either of the connectors J10 or J11 on saddle stitcher controller PC board disconnected?Are the harnesses between the saddle stitcher controller PC board and cover opening sensors (delivery cover sensor [PI3], inlet cover sensor [PI9]) open circuited? YES Connect the connector securely. Replace the harness.
NOIs each of the sensors (delivery cover sensor, inlet cover sensor) working properly?
||
NO 1) Connect the connectors of the each sensor securely.2) Replace the sensors.
YESReplace the finisher controller PC board.
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedTROUBLESHOOTING
5 - 44
[EAA0] Power-ON jam
[EAB0] Paper transport stop jam
MJ-1024Is there any paper remaining on the transport path in the finisher or saddle stitcher section? YES Remove the paper.
NOIs any of the connectors J9, J10 and J13 on the saddle stitcher controller PC board discon-nected?Is the harness between the saddle stitcher controller PC board and each sensor (No.1 paper sensor [PI18], No.2 paper sensor [PI19], No.3 paper sensor [PI20], the vertical path paper sen-sor [PI17] and the delivery sensor[PI11]) open circuited? YES Connect the connectors securely. Replace the harnesses.
NOIs each of the sensors (No.1 paper sensor, No.2 paper sensor, No.3 paper sensor, the vertical path paper sensor, and the delivery sensor) working properly? (Check the movement of the actuator.)
|||
NO 1) Connect the connectors of the sensors securely.2) Attach the actuators securely if their shafts are out of place.3) Replace the sensors.
YESReplace the saddle stitcher controller PC board.
MJ-1024Is there any paper remaining on the transport path in the finisher, saddle stitcher section or equipment? YES Remove the paper.
NOIs the connector J708 on finisher controller PC board disconnected?Is the harness between the finisher controller PC board and inlet sensor [PI33] open circuited?Is either of the connectors J9 or J10 on the saddle stitcher controller PC board disconnected?Is the harness between the saddle stitcher controller PC board and each sensor (No.1 paper sensor [PI18], No.2 paper sensor [PI19], No.3 paper sensor [PI20] and the delivery sensor [PI11]) open circuited? YES Connect the connectors securely. Replace the harnesses.
NOIs each of the sensors (the inlet sensor, No.1 paper sensor, No.2 paper sensor, No.3 paper sensor and the delivery sensor) working properly? (Check the movement of the actuator.)
|||
NO 1) Connect the connectors of the sensors securely.2) Attach the actuators securely if their shafts are out of place.3) Replace the sensors.
YESReplace the saddle stitcher controller PC board.
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cTROUBLESHOOTING
5 - 45
5
[EAC0] Transport delay jamMJ-1024
Is there any paper remaining on the transport path in the finisher, saddle stitcher section or equipment? YES Remove the paper.
NOIs the connector J708 on the finisher controller PC board disconnected?Is the harness connecting the finisher controller PC board and inlet sensor (PI33) open cir-cuited? YES Connect the connector securely. Replace the harness.
NOIs the inlet sensor working properly? (Check the movement of the actuator.)
|||
NO 1) Connect the connector of the sensor securely.2) Attach the actuator securely if its shaft is out of place.3) Replace the sensor.
YESReplace the finisher controller PC board.
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedTROUBLESHOOTING
5 - 46
[ 4 ] Paper jam in puncher unit[E9F0] Punching jamMJ-1023/1024
Is there any paper remaining on the transport path in the finisher or equipment? YES Remove the paper.
NOIs the connector J605A on the punch controller PC board disconnected?Is the harness connecting the punch controller PC board and punch home position sensor (PI63) open circuited? YES Connect the connector securely. Replace the harness.
NOIs the punch home position sensor working properly?
||
NO 1) Connect the connector of the punch home position sensor securely.2) Replace the punch home position sensor.
YESReplace the punch controller PC board.
MJ-1101 (When MJ-6101 is installed)Is there any paper remaining on the transport path?
YES Remove the paper.
NORotate the punch motor (M3). Does it rotate smoothly?
NO Fix the mechanism.
YESAre the punch home position sensor (S4) and its wiring correct?
NO Replace the sensor. Correct the wiring.
YESIs the wiring between the hole punch control PC board (HP) and punch motor (M3) correct?
NO Correct the wiring.
YES1) Replace the punch motor (M3).2) Replace the hole punch control PC board (HP).
06/08
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cTROUBLESHOOTING
5 - 47
5
[ 5 ] Other paper jam[EAD0] Print end command time-out jam
[EAE0] Receiving time-out jam
[EB30] Ready time-out jam
Is the main motor rotating normally?
NO1) Replace the SYS board.2) Replace the LGC board.
Is the finisher working? YES Replace the finisher controller PC board.
NO1) Check if the voltage (24V) is being supplied to the finisher.2) Check the connection of the LGC board and IPC board.3) Check if the harness connecting the IPC board and finisher I/F connector of the equipment
side is open circuited.4) Check if the harness connecting the I/F connector of the finisher side and finisher controller
PC board is open circuited.5) Replace the finisher controller PC board.
Is there paper in the equipment? NO Replace the LGC board.
YESAre the IPC board and LGC board properly connected to each other? NO Connect them properly.
YESIs the harness securely connected to the IPC board? NO Connect the harness properly.
YESIs any of the connector pins of the harness connecting the equipment and finisher discon-nected or any of those harnesses open circuited? NO Connect the pin or replace the harness.
YES1) Replace the IPC board.2) Replace the LGC board.3) Replace the finisher controller PC board.
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedTROUBLESHOOTING
5 - 48
[ED10] Skew adjustment motor (M1) home position detection abnormality
[ED11] Sideways adjustment motor (M2) home position detection error
MJ-1101 (When MJ-6101 is installed)Is there any paper remaining on the transport path?
YES Remove the paper.
NORotate the skew adjustment motor (M1). Does it rotate smoothly?
NO Fix the mechanism.
YESAre the skew home position sensor (S2) and its wiring correct?
NO Replace the sensor. Correct the wiring.
YESIs the wiring between the hole punch control PC board (HP) and skew adjustment motor (M1) correct?
NO Correct the wiring.
YES1) Replace the skew adjustment motor (M1).2) Replace the hole punch control PC board (HP).
MJ-1101 (When MJ-6101 is installed)Is there any paper remaining on the transport path?
YES Remove the paper.
NORotate the sideways adjustment motor (M2). Does it rotate smoothly?
NO Fix the mechanism.
YESAre the sideways deviation home position sensor (S3) and its wiring correct?
NO Replace the sensor. Correct the wiring.
YESIs the wiring between the hole punch control PC board (HP) and punch sideways adjustment motor (M2) correct?
NO Correct the wiring.
YES1) Replace the sideways adjustment motor (M2).2) Replace the hole punch control PC board (HP).
07/11
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cTROUBLESHOOTING
5 - 49
5
[ED12] Shutter home position error
[ED13] Front alignment plate home position error
MJ-1101Is there any mechanical problem when the shutter is opened/closed?
YES Fix the mechanism.
NOIs there a disconnection of the connector, incorrect installation or breakage of the shutter open-ing/closing sensor (S4)?
ll
YES • Connect the connector securely.• Reinstall the sensor correctly. • Replace the sensor.
NOIs the harness between the shutter opening/closing sensor (S4) and the finisher control PC board (CN13) disconnected or open circuited?
l
YES • Reconnect the connector securely.• Replace the harness.
NOIs the harness between the shutter clutch (CLT1) and the finisher control PC board (CN5) dis-connected or open circuited?
l
YES • Reconnect the connector securely.• Replace the harness.
NOReplace the finisher control PC board.
MJ-1101Is there any mechanical problem when the front alignment plate is moved?
YES Fix the mechanism.
NOIs there a disconnection of the connector, incorrect installation or breakage of the front align-ment plate home position sensor (S7)?
ll
YES • Connect the connector securely.• Reinstall the sensor correctly. • Replace the sensor.
NOIs the harness between the front alignment plate home position sensor (S7) and the finisher control PC board (CN11) disconnected or open circuited?
l
YES • Reconnect the connector securely.• Replace the harness.
NOIs the harness between the front alignment motor (M9) and the finisher control PC board (CN10) disconnected or open circuited?
l
YES • Reconnect the connector securely.• Replace the harness.
NOReplace the finisher control PC board.
06/08
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedTROUBLESHOOTING
5 - 50
[ED14] Rear alignment plate home position error
[ED15] Paddle home position error
MJ-1101Is there any mechanical problem when the rear alignment plate is moved?
YES Fix the mechanism.
NOIs there a disconnection of the connector, incorrect installation or breakage of the rear align-ment plate home position sensor (S8)?
ll
YES • Connect the connector securely.• Reinstall the sensor correctly. • Replace the sensor.
NOIs the harness between the rear alignment plate home position sensor (S8) and the finisher control PC board (CN11) disconnected or open circuited?
l
YES • Reconnect the connector securely.• Replace the harness.
NOIs the harness between the rear alignment motor (M10) and the finisher control PC board (CN10) disconnected or open circuited?
l
YES • Reconnect the connector securely.• Replace the harness.
NOReplace the finisher control PC board.
MJ-1101Is there any mechanical problem when the paddle is rotated?
YES Fix the mechanism.
NOIs there a disconnection of the connector, incorrect installation or breakage of the paddle home position sensor (S3)?
ll
YES • Connect the connector securely.• Reinstall the sensor correctly. • Replace the sensor.
NOIs the harness between the paddle home position sensor (S3) and the finisher control PC board (CN5) disconnected or open circuited?
l
YES • Reconnect the connector securely.• Replace the harness.
NOIs the harness between the paddle motor (M8) and the finisher control PC board (CN6) discon-nected or open circuited?
l
YES • Reconnect the connector securely.• Replace the harness.
NOReplace the finisher control PC board.
06/08
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cTROUBLESHOOTING
5 - 51
5
[ED16] Buffer tray home position errorMJ-1101
Is there any mechanical problem when the buffer tray guide is opened/closed?
YES Fix the mechanism.
NOIs there a disconnection of the connector, incorrect installation or breakage of the buffer tray home position sensor (S5)?
ll
YES • Connect the connector securely.• Reinstall the sensor correctly. • Replace the sensor.
NOIs the harness between the buffer tray home position sensor (S5) and the finisher control PC board (CN18) disconnected or open circuited?
l
YES • Reconnect the connector securely.• Replace the harness.
NOIs the harness between the buffer tray guide motor (M3) and the finisher control PC board (CN18) disconnected or open circuited?
l
YES • Reconnect the connector securely.• Replace the harness.
NOReplace the finisher control PC board.
06/08
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedTROUBLESHOOTING
5 - 52
5.1.8 Drive system related service call[C010] Main motor abnormality
[C020] Developer motor abnormality
[C030] Transport motor abnormality
Is the main motor working? (Perform the output check: 03-101/151)|||||||||
NO 1) Check if the connector J581 of the main motor is disconnected.2) Check if the connector CN336 on the LGC board is disconnected.3) Check if the connector pins are disconnected or the harnesses are open
circuited.4) Check if the conductor patterns on the main motor board and LGC board
are short circuited or open circuited.5) Replace the main motor.6) Replace the LGC board.
YES1) Check if the PLL lock signal CN336-8 pin output from the LGC board is always level “L”.2) Check if the voltage supplied to the ASIC input terminal IC40-152 pin is always “L”.3) Replace the LGC board.
Is the developer unit motor working? (Perform the output check: 03-112/162)|||||||||
NO 1) Check if the connector J578 of the developer motor is disconnected.2) Check if the connector CN337 on the LGC board is disconnected.3) Check if the connector pins are disconnected or the harnesses are open
circuited.4) Check if the conductor patterns on the developer motor board and LGC
board are short circuited or open circuited.5) Replace the developer motor.6) Replace the LGC board.
YES1) Check if the PLL lock signal CN337-B6 pin output from the LGC board is always level “L”.2) Check if the voltage supplied to the ASIC input terminal IC40-150 pin is always “L”.3) Replace the LGC board.
Is the transport motor working? (Perform the output check: 03-123/173)|||||||||
NO 1) Check if the connector J582 of the transport motor is disconnected.2) Check if the connector CN337 on the LGC board is disconnected.3) Check if the connector pins are disconnected or the harnesses are open
circuited.4) Check if the conductor patterns on the transport motor board and LGC
board are short circuited or open circuited.5) Replace the transport motor.6) Replace the LGC board.
YES1) Check if the PLL lock signal CN337-A7 pin output from the LGC board is always level “L”.2) Check if the voltage supplied to the ASIC input terminal IC40-149 pin is always “L”.3) Replace the LGC board.
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cTROUBLESHOOTING
5 - 53
5
5.1.9 Paper feeding system related service call[C040] PFP motor abnormality
Is the PFP motor working? (Perform the output check: 03-109/159)|||||||||||||||||
NO 1) Check if the signal line connector CN503 of the PFP motor is disconnected.2) Check if the power line connector CN502 of the PFP motor is disconnected.3) Check if the connector CN246 on the PFP board is disconnected.4) Check if the signal line connector CN241 on the PFP board is discon-
nected.5) Check if the power line connector CN242 on the PFP board is discon-
nected.6) Check if the connector CN332 on the LGC board is disconnected.7) Check if the connector pins are disconnected or the harnesses are open
circuited.8) Check if the conductor patterns on the PFP motor board, PFP board and
LGC board are short circuited or open circuited.9) Replace the PFP motor.10)Replace the PFP board.11)Replace the LGC board.
YESIs the LED on the PFP motor board lit without flashing?
||||||||
NO 1) Check if the connector pins are disconnected or the harnesses are open circuited.
2) Check if the conductor patterns on the PFP motor board, PFP board and LGC board are short circuited or open circuited.
3) Replace the PFP motor.4) Replace the PFP board.5) Replace the LGC board.
YES1) Check if the PLL lock signal CN246-8 pin output from the PFP board is always “L” level.2) Check if the voltage supplied to the microcomputer input terminal IC5-17 pin is always “L”
level.3) Replace the PFP board.4) Replace the LGC board.
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedTROUBLESHOOTING
5 - 54
[C130] Upper drawer tray abnormality[C140] Lower drawer tray abnormality
Does the tray go up? (Perform the output check: 03-242, 243)||||||||
NO 1) Check if the connector of the tray-up motor is disconnected.2) Check if the connector CN341 on the LGC board is disconnected.3) Check if the connector pins are disconnected or the harnesses are open
circuited.4) Check if the conductor pattern on the LGC board is short circuited or open
circuited.5) Replace the tray-up motor.6) Replace the LGC board.
YESIs the tray-up sensor working? (Perform the input check: 03-[FAX]OFF/[6]/[H], /[6]/[G])
||||||||||
NO 1) Check if the connector of the sensor is disconnected.2) Check if the connector CN341 on the LGC board is disconnected.3) Check if the slit reaches the sensor.4) Check if the connector pins are disconnected or the harnesses are open
circuited.5) Check if the conductor pattern on the LGC board is short circuited or open
circuited.6) Replace the tray-up sensor.7) Replace the LGC board.
YES1) Check if the conductor pattern on the LGC board is short circuited or open circuited.2) Replace the LGC board.
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cTROUBLESHOOTING
5 - 55
5
[C150] PFP upper drawer tray abnormality[C160] PFP lower drawer tray abnormality
Does the tray go up? (Perform the output check: 03-278, 280)||||||||||||
NO 1) Check if the connector of the tray-up motor is disconnected.2) Check if any of the connectors CN241, CN242 and CN244 on the PFP
board is disconnected.3) Check if the connector CN344 on the LGC board is disconnected.4) Check if the connector pins are disconnected or the harnesses are open
circuited.5) Check if the conductor patterns on the PFP board and LGC board are short
circuited or open circuited.6) Replace the tray-up motor.7) Replace the PFP board.8) Replace the LGC board.
YESIs the tray-up sensor working? (Perform the input check: 03-[FAX]OFF/[2]/[H], /[4]/[H])
|||||||||||||
NO 1) Check if the connector of the sensor is disconnected.2) Check if any of the connectors CN241, CN247 and CN248 on the PFP
board is disconnected.3) Check if the connector CN344 on the LGC board is disconnected.4) Check if the slit reaches the sensor.5) Check if the connector pins are disconnected or the harnesses are open
circuited.6) Check if the conductor patterns on the PFP board and LGC board are short
circuited or open circuited.7) Replace the tray-up sensor.8) Replace the PFP board.9) Replace the LGC board.
YES1) Check if the conductor pattern on the LGC board is short circuited or open circuited.2) Replace the LGC board.
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedTROUBLESHOOTING
5 - 56
[C180] LCF tray-up motor abnormalityDoes the tray move? (Perform the output check: 03-271)
||||||||||||
NO 1) Check if the connector of the LCF tray-up motor is disconnected.2) Check if any of the connectors CN100, CN101 and CN103 on the LCF
board is disconnected.3) Check if the connector CN344 on the LGC board is disconnected.4) Check if the connector pins are disconnected or the harnesses are open
circuited.5) Check if the conductor patterns on the LCF board and LGC board are short
circuited or open circuited.6) Replace the LCF tray-up motor.7) Replace the LCF board.8) Replace the LGC board.
YESAre the LCF tray-up sensor and LCF tray bottom sensor working? (Perform the input check: 03-[FAX]OFF/[5]/[F], /[3]/[A])
|||||||||||||
NO 1) Check if the connectors of the sensors are disconnected.2) Check if any of the connectors CN100, CN104 and CN105 on the LCF
board is disconnected.3) Check if the connector CN344 on the LGC board is disconnected.4) Check if the slit reaches the sensors.5) Check if the connector pins are disconnected or the harnesses are open
circuited.6) Check if the conductor patterns on the LCF board and LGC board are short
circuited or open circuited.7) Replace the sensor.8) Replace the LCF board.9) Replace the LGC board.
YES1) Check if the conductor pattern on the LGC board is short circuited or open circuited.2) Replace the LGC board.
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cTROUBLESHOOTING
5 - 57
5
[C1A0] LCF end fence motor abnormalityIs the LCF end fence motor working? (Perform the output check: 03-207)
||||||||||||
NO 1) Check if the connector of the LCF end fence motor is disconnected.2) Check if any of the connectors CN100, CN101 and CN103 on the LCF
board is disconnected.3) Check if the connector CN344 on the LGC board is disconnected.4) Check if the connector pins are disconnected or the harnesses are open
circuited.5) Check if the conductor patterns on the LCF board and LGC board are short
circuited or open circuited.6) Replace the LCF end fence motor.7) Replace the LCF board.8) Replace the LGC board.
YESAre the LCF end fence home/stop position sensors working?(Perform the input check: 03-[FAX]OFF/[5]/[A], /[5]/[B])
|||||||||||||
NO 1) Check if the connectors of the sensors are disconnected.2) Check if either of the connectors CN100 or CN107 on the LCF board is dis-
connected.3) Check if the connector CN344 on the LGC board is disconnected.4) Check if the slit reaches the sensors.5) Check if the connector pins are disconnected or the harnesses are open
circuited.6) Check if the conductor patterns on the LCF board and LGC board are short
circuited or open circuited.7) Replace the sensors.8) Replace the LCF board.9) Replace the LGC board.
YES1) Check if the conductor pattern on the LGC board is short circuited or open circuited.2) Replace the LGC board.
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedTROUBLESHOOTING
5 - 58
[C1B0] LCF transport motor abnormalityIs the LCF transport motor working? (Perform the output check: 03-122/172)
||||||||||||||||
NO 1) Check if the connector CN112 of the LCF transport motor is disconnected.2) Check if the connector CN102 on the LCF board is disconnected.3) Check if the signal line connector CN100 on the LCF board is discon-
nected.4) Check if the power line connector CN101 on the LCF board is discon-
nected.5) Check if the connector CN344 on the LGC board is disconnected.6) Check if the connector pins are disconnected or the harnesses are open
circuited.7) Check if the conductor patterns on the LCF transport motor board, LCF
board and LGC board are short circuited or open circuited.8) Replace the LCF transport motor.9) Replace the LCF board.10)Replace the LGC board.
YES1) Check if the connector pins are disconnected or the harnesses are open circuited.2) Check if the conductor patterns on the LCF transport motor board, LCF board and LGC
board are short circuited or open circuited.3) Check if the PLL lock signal CN102-3 pin output from the LCF board is always “L” level.4) Check if the voltage supplied to the microcomputer input terminal IC103-17 pin is always
“L” level.5) Replace the LCF transport motor.6) Replace the LCF board.7) Replace the LGC board.
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cTROUBLESHOOTING
5 - 59
5
5.1.10 Scanning system related service call[C260] Peak detection error
[C270] Carriage home position sensor not going OFF within a specified time
Remove the original glass and move the carriages to the paper feeding side. Turn ON the power and check the following items.
[C280] Carriage home position sensor not going ON within a specified time
Remove the original glass and move the carriages to the paper feeding side. Turn ON the power and check the following items.
Does the exposure lamp light? (Perform the output check: 03-267)|||||||||
YES 1) Check if the connectors on the CCD and SLG boards are disconnected.2) Check if the shading correction plate is dirty.3) Check if the conductor pattern on the CCD board is short circuited or open
circuited.4) Check if the conductor pattern on the SLG board is short circuited or open
circuited.5) Replace the lens unit.6) Replace the SLG board.
NO1) Check if the connectors of the exposure lamp and inverter are disconnected.2) Check the SLG board if the connector pin CN21 is disconnected or the harness is short cir-
cuited or open circuited.3) Check if the conductor pattern on the SLG board is short circuited or open circuited.4) Replace the SLG board.5) Replace the inverter.6) Replace the exposure lamp.
Are the carriages slightly moved to the feeding direction?/Are the carriages staying at a posi-tion other than home position? YES Check if the circuits of the SLG board are abnormal.
NO1) Check if the connector pin is disconnected or the harness is short circuited or open cir-
cuited.2) Check if the conductor pattern on the SLG board is short circuited or open circuited.3) Replace the SLG board.
Do the carriages make a big noise after they arrive at the home position?|||
YES The carriage home position sensor is not turned ON.1) Check if the connector of the sensor is disconnected.2) Check if the circuits of the SLG board are abnormal.
NOThe carriages are stopped at the home position and do not move.1) Check if the connector pins are disconnected or the harnesses are short circuited or open
circuited.2) Check if the conductor pattern on the SLG board is short circuited or open circuited.3) Replace the SLG board.
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedTROUBLESHOOTING
5 - 60
5.1.11 Fuser unit related service call
[C411/C412] Thermistor/heater abnormality at power-ON1.Check the power voltage
(1) Check if the power voltage is normal.(Is the voltage during the operation ±10% of the rated volt-age?)
2.Check the thermistors
(1) Check if the connectors are disconnected.(2) Check if the center and side thermistors (front, rear) are in contact with the surface of the fuser
roller properly?(3) Check if the harnesses of the center and side thermistors (front, rear) are open circuited.
3. Check the heater
(1) Check if the IH coil is broken.(2) Check if the connector of the IH coil is disconnected.(3) Check if the thermostat is blown.(4) Check if the connectors on the IH control board are disconnected (AC input connector and LGC
I/F connectors CN455).(5) Check if the IH control board is abnormal.
• Replace the IH control board.
4. Check the LGC board
(1) Check if the connectors CN334 are disconnected.(2) Check if the conductor pattern on the LGC board is short circuited or open circuited.(3) Replace the LGC board.
5. Clear the status counterAfter repairing the matter which caused the error [C411/C412], perform the following:
(1) Turn ON the power while [0] and [8] are pressed simultaneously.(2) Key in "400", then press [START].(3) Change the current status counter value "1" or "2" to "0", then press [ENTER] or [INTERRUPT]
(to cancel [C411/C412]).(4) Turn the power OFF and then back ON. Make sure that the equipment enters the normal ready
state.
Note: Note: Be sure to turn OFF the power and unplug the power cable beforehand when checking the IH control cir-cuit and IH coil.The fuser unit itself or the part of the unit remains heated and the capacitors are still charged after a while the power cable is unplugged. So make sure the unit is cooled down enough before checking.
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cTROUBLESHOOTING
5 - 61
5
[C443/C445/C446/C447/C449] Heater abnormality after abnormality judgment1,2.3. Check the thermistors, Heater and LGC boardCheck the above components following the procedures 1, 2 and 3 for [C411/C412].
4. Clear the status counterChange the current status counter value (08-400) "3", "5" , "6" , "9" , "19" , "21" , "22" , "23" , "24" , "25" , "27" or "29" to "0" for [C44X], taking the same procedure as that for [C41X].
• The status counter value is as follows in the following cases.- The error occurred during warming-up: "3", "5" or "6"- The error occurred after the equipment has become ready: "7"- The temperature detected by the center thermistor is 240°C or higher, the temperature
detected by the side thermistor is 250°C or higher or the temperature detected by the edge thermistor is 270°C or higher: "9", "19", "21", "22", "23", "25", "27" or "29".
- The error occurred during printing: "24" or "25"- The error occurred during energy saving: "26" or "27"- A paper jam occurred: "28" or "29"
[C471/472/475] IH power voltage abnormality or IH initial abnormality1. Check the AC input voltageCheck if the AC input voltage is within the specified range.(especially when the heater becomes ON after the power is turned ON (the copier is warming up))
2. Check the thermostatCheck if the thermostat is blown.
3. Check the IH control board
(1) Check if the AC input connector on the IH control board, the LGC I/F connectors CN455 is dis-connected?
(2) Check if the fuse on the IH control board has blown.(3) Replace the IH control board.
4. Check the LGC board
(1) Check if the connector CN334 are disconnected.(2) Check if the conductor pattern on the board is short- or open-circuited.(3) Replace the LGC board.
5. Clear the status counterChange the values "10", "11", "12" of the status counter (08-400) to "0".
[C480] Overheating of IGBT
1. Check the operation of the IH control board cooling fanCheck if the IH control board cooling fan is rotating normally. (Is the connector securely connected?)
2. Check the IH board
(1) Check if the IGBT or IGBT radiation plate is normal. (Is the radiation plate securely attached?)(2) Check if the conductor pattern on the board is short circuited or open circuited.(3) Replace the IH board.
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedTROUBLESHOOTING
5 - 62
3. Clear the status counterChange the values “12”, “15” or “18” of the status counter (08-400) to “0”.* The status counter value is as follows in the following cases. Change them to "0" respectively.• The error occurred before the temperature of the fuser roller reaches 40°C: "12"• The error occurred before the equipment has become ready: "15"• The error occurred when the equipment is in the ready state: "18"
(When the only one side of IH coil is energized continuously for 15 seconds)
[C490] IH control circuit or IH coil abnormality
1. Check the IH board
(1) Check if the conductor pattern on the board is short circuited or open circuited.(2) Replace the IH board.
2. Check the IH coil
(1) Check if the coil is broken or short out.(2) Replace the IH coil.
3. Clear the status counterChange the values “13”, “16” or “19” of the status counter (08-400) to “0”.* The status counter value is as follows in the following cases. Change them to "0" respectively.• The error occurred before the temperature of the fuser roller reaches 40°C: "13"• The error occurred before the equipment has become ready: "16"• The error occurred when the equipment is in the ready state: "19"
[C4B0] IGBT overheating abnormality1. Check the LGC board
(1) Check if the conductor pattern on the board is short circuited or open circuited.(2) Check if NVRAM is mounted.(3) Replace the LGC board.
When the problem is solved, [C470], [C480] and [C490] can be cleared by turning OFF and ON the main switch so the status counter does not have to be changed to "0".The value of the status counter remains the same until the next service call overwrites the value.
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cTROUBLESHOOTING
5 - 63
5
5.1.12 Communication related service call
[C550] RADF I/F error
(1) Check if the harness connecting the RADF board and SLG board is disconnected or open cir-cuited.
(2) Check if the conductor pattern on the RADF board is short circuited or open circuited.(3) Check if the conductor pattern on the SLG board is short circuited or open circuited.(4) Replace the RADF board.(5) Replace the SLG board.
[C570] Communication error between Engine-CPU and IPC board
(1) Check if the LGC board and IPC board are connected properly.(2) Check if the conductor pattern on the IPC board is short circuited or open circuited.(3) Check if the conductor pattern on the LGC board is short circuited or open circuited.(4) Replace the IPC board.(5) Replace the LGC board.
[C580] Communication error between IPC board and finisher
(1) Check the setting of 08-1912.(2) Check if the specified finisher is attached.(3) Check if the harness connecting the IPC board and the finisher controller PC board is discon-
nected or open circuited.(4) Check if the conductor pattern on the IPC board is short circuited or open circuited.(5) Check if the conductor pattern on the finisher controller PC board is short circuited or open cir-
cuited.(6) Replace the IPC board.(7) Replace the finisher controller PC board.
[F070] Communication error between System-CPU and Engine-CPU
(1) Check if the harness connecting the SYS board and LGC board is disconnected or open cir-cuited.
(2) Check the version of the system ROM on the SYS board.(3) Check the version of the engine ROM version on the LGC board.(4) Replace the SYS board.(5) Replace the LGC board.
[F110] Communication error between System-CPU and Scanner-CPU
[F111] Scanner response abnormality
(1) Check if the harness connecting the SYS board and SLG board is disconnected or open cir-cuited.
(2) Check the version of the system ROM on the SYS board.(3) Check the version of the scanner ROM version on the SLG board.(4) Replace the SYS board.(5) Replace the SLG board.
10/02
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedTROUBLESHOOTING
5 - 64
5.1.13 RADF related service callNo service call for the RADF (MR-3018).
5.1.14 Circuit related service call
[C900] Connection error between the SYS board and the LGC board
(1) Check if the connector CN117 on the SYS board is completely inserted or not disconnected.(2) Check if the connector CN357 on the LGC board is completely inserted or not disconnected.(3) Check if the harness connecting the SYS board (CN117) and the LGC board (CN357) is open
circuited.(4) Check if the conductor pattern on each board is short circuited or open circuited.(5) Replace the SYS board.(6) Replace the LGC board.
[C940] Engine-CPU abnormality
[C950] Memory of the LGC board abnormality, ID abnormality
(1) Check if the connectors CN331 and CN 343 on the SYS board are completely inserted or not dis-connected.
(2) Check if the connector CN434 on the DRV board is completely inserted or not disconnected.(3) Check if the conductor pattern on each board is short circuited or open circuited.(4) Replace the NVRAM.(5) Replace the LGC board.(6) Replace the DRV board.(7) Replace the SYS board.(8) Ask a specialist for a repair (Abnormal ID).
[C960] Connection error between the LGC board and the DRV board, ID abnormality
(1) Check if the connectors CN331 and CN343 on the LGC board are completely inserted or not dis-connected.
(2) Check if the connector CN434 on the DRV board is completely inserted or not disconnected.(3) Check if the harness connecting the DRV board (J434) and the LGC board (CN360) is open cir-
cuited.(4) Check if the harness connecting the LGC board (CN331) and the high-voltage transformer
(J480) is open circuited.(5) Check if the conductor pattern on each board is short circuited or open circuited.(6) Replace the DRV board.(7) Replace the LGC board.(8) Ask a specialist for a repair (Abnormal ID).
Does service call still occur even after turning OFF the main switch then back ON? NO Leave it for a while and see how.
YES1) Check if the conductor pattern between the Engine-CPU and FROM is short circuited
or open circuited.2) Replace the LGC board if it frequently occurs.
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cTROUBLESHOOTING
5 - 65
5
[C9E0] Connection error between the SLG board and the SYS board
(1) Check if the connector CN18 of the SLG board is completely inserted or not disconnected.(2) Check if the connector CN102 of the SYS board is completely inserted or not disconnected.(3) Check if the harness connecting the SLG board (CN18) and the SYS board (CN102) is open cir-
cuited.(4) Check if the conductor pattern on each board is short circuited or open circuited.(5) Replace the SLG board.(6) Replace the SYS board.
[F090] SRAM abnormality on the SYS board
(1) Turn the power OFF and start up the Setting Mode (08).(2) When the message “SRAM ERROR DOES IT INITIALIZE?” is displayed on the LCD, press the
[INITIALIZE] button. (SRAM is cleared.)(3) Turn the power OFF and then back ON. If the error is not recovered, replace the SYS board.
[F091] NVRAM abnormality on the SYS board
(1) Take off the FAX board if installed.(2) Turn the power OFF and start up with the Setting Mode (08).
Note: Note: Be sure to start up with the Setting Mode (08), not the normal mode immediately after the NVRAM replacement or clearing, and then perform the following steps.
(3) When “NVRAM ERROR DOES IT INITIALIZE” is displayed on the LCD, check the destination and then press the [START] button. If the destination is not correct, key in the correct one and then press the [START] button.
(4) After the confirmation message is displayed, press the [INTERRUPT] button.(5) Perform the panel calibration (08-692).(6) Perform the counter copying (08-257 Sub-code: 1).(7) Perform the initialization at the software version upgrade (08-947).(8) Check the serial number after performing “Equipment number display” (08-995). If the number is
different from the one on the label attached to the rear cover of the equipment, enter the correct serial number again with 08-995.
Note: Note: The MAC address of the equipment is generated based on this serial number. Entering the incor-rect serial number may result in an inability to access the network due to an invalid MAC address.
(9) Initialize the NIC information (08-693).(10) Turn the power OFF and then start up with the Adjustment mode (05).(11) Perform “Data transfer of characteristic value of scanner” (05-364).(12) Perform “Automatic gamma adjustment” <PPC> (05-1642). (using [4][FAX] test pattern)(13) Perform “Automatic gamma adjustment” <PRT-PS> (05-1000). (using [47][FAX] test pattern)(14) Perform “Automatic gamma adjustment” <PRT-PCL> (05-1002). (using [49][FAX] test pattern)(15) Turn the power OFF.(16) Install the FAX board taken off in step (1).
* If the FAX board has not been installed, the following steps are not necessary.(17) Start up with the Setting Mode (08).(18) Set the destination with “Destination setting of FAX machine” (08-701).(19) Start up with the FAX Clearing Mode (1*).(20) Perform “FAX Set Up” (1*-100).
09/01
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedTROUBLESHOOTING
5 - 66
(21) Turn the power OFF.(22) Turn the power ON.(23) Set the dial type. [USER FUNCTIONS] [ADMIN] [FAX] [INITIAL SETUP](24) Turn the power OFF and then back ON. If the error is not recovered, replace the NVRAM on the
SYS board.
[F092] SRAM/NVRAM abnormality on the SYS board
(1) Take off the FAX board if installed.(2) Turn the power OFF and start up with the Setting Mode (08).
Note: Note: Be sure to start up with the Setting Mode (08), not the normal mode immediately after the NVRAM replacement or clearing, and then perform the following steps.
(3) When “NVRAM/SRAM ERROR DOES IT INITIALIZE” is displayed on the LCD, enter the number for the model type and then press the [START] button. Select “1” for a system ROM version ear-lier than V3.3, and “2” for V3.3 or later.
(4) Check the destination displayed on the LCD and then press the [START] button. If the destina-tion is incorrect, key in the correct number and then press the [START] button.
(5) After the confirmation message is displayed, press the [INTERRUPT] button.(6) Perform the panel calibration (08-692).(7) Perform the counter copying (08-257 Sub-code: 1).(8) Perform the initialization at the software version upgrade (08-947).(9) Check the serial number after performing “Equipment number display” (08-995). If the number is
different from the one on the label attached to the rear cover of the equipment, enter the correct serial number again with 08-995.
Note: Note: The MAC address of the equipment is generated based on this serial number. Entering the incor-rect serial number may result in an inability to access the network due to an invalid MAC address.
(10) Initialize the NIC information (08-693).(11) Turn the power OFF and then start up with the Adjustment mode (05).(12) Perform “Data transfer of characteristic value of scanner” (05-364).(13) Perform “Automatic gamma adjustment” <PPC> (05-1642). (using [4][FAX] test pattern)(14) Perform “Automatic gamma adjustment” <PRT-PS> (05-1000). (using [47][FAX] test pattern)(15) Perform “Automatic gamma adjustment” <PRT-PCL> (05-1002). (using [49][FAX] test pattern)(16) Turn the power OFF.(17) Install the FAX board taken off in step (1).
* If the FAX board has not been installed, the following steps are not necessary.(18) Start up with the Setting Mode (08).(19) Set the destination with “Destination setting of FAX machine” (08-701).(20) Start up with the FAX Clearing Mode (1*).(21) Perform “FAX Set Up” (1*-100).(22) Turn the power OFF.(23) Turn the power ON.(24) Set the dial type. [USER FUNCTIONS] [ADMIN] [FAX] [INITIAL SETUP](25) Turn the power OFF and then back ON. If the error is not recovered, replace the NVRAM on the
SYS board.
[F350] SLG board abnormality
(1) Check if the conductor pattern on the SLG board is short circuited or open circuited.(2) Replace the SLG board.
09/02
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cTROUBLESHOOTING
5 - 67
5
5.1.15 Laser optical unit related service call[CA10] Polygonal motor abnormality
[CA20] H-Sync detection error
Is the polygonal motor rotating?|||||||
NO 1) Check if the connector CN342 on the LGC board is disconnected.2) Check if the harness is open circuited or the connector pin is disconnected.3) Check if the conductor pattern on the LGC board is short circuited or open
circuited.4) Replace the laser optical unit.5) Replace the LGC board.
YESIs the printed image distorted?
||||||||||
YES 1) Check if the connector CN342 on the LGC board is almost disconnected.2) Check if the harness is almost open circuited or the connector pin is almost
disconnected.3) Check if the conductor pattern on the LGC board is short circuited or open
circuited.4) Check if the laser unit cooling fan is stopped.5) Check if the suction area of laser unit cooling fan is plugged up.6) Replace the laser optical unit.7) Replace the LGC board.
NO1) Check if the conductor pattern on the LGC board is short circuited or open circuited.2) Check if the units with high-voltage (developer unit, transfer belt unit and 2nd transfer roller
unit) are securely grounded.3) Check if the bias supply joints of the units with high-voltage are securely connected or they
are not stained.4) Check if the plate in paper transport system is securely grounded.5) Check if the equipment is grounded.6) Check if the laser unit cooling fan is stopped.7) Check if the suction area of laser unit cooling fan is plugged up.8) Replace the laser optical unit.9) Replace the LGC board.
Is the cable (flexible flat type) between the connector (CN345) on the LGC board and connec-tor (CN201) on the LDR board open circuited, broken or disconnected?
|||
YES 1) Reconnect the cable.2) Check if the connector on the LGC board hold the cable securely.3) Replace the laser optical unit.
NO1) Check if the units with high-voltage (developer unit, transfer belt unit and 2nd transfer roller
unit) are securely grounded.2) Check if the bias supply joints of the units with high-voltage are securely connected or they
are not stained.3) Check if the plate in paper transport system is securely grounded.4) Check if the equipment is grounded.5) Check if the conductor pattern is short circuited or open circuited.6) Replace the LGC board.7) Replace the laser optical unit.
06/08
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedTROUBLESHOOTING
5 - 68
5.1.16 Finisher related service call[CB10] Entrance motor abnormality
[CB11] Buffer tray guide motor abnormality
[CB12] Buffer roller drive motor abnormality
MJ-1101Is there any mechanical problem when the entrance roller is rotated?
YES Fix the mechanism.
NOIs the harness between the entrance motor (M1) and the finisher control PC board (CN7) dis-connected or open circuited?
l
YES • Reconnect the connector securely.• Replace the harness.
NO1) Replace the entrance motor (M1).2) Replace the finisher control PC board.
* You receive a [CB11] error when the [ED16] error occurs three times in succession.MJ-1101
Is there any mechanical problem when the buffer tray guide is opened/closed while the buffer roller is lifted up?
YES Fix the mechanism.
NOIs the harness between the buffer tray guide motor (M3) and the finisher control PC board (CN18) disconnected or open circuited?
l
YES • Reconnect the connector securely.• Replace the harness.
NO1) Replace the buffer tray guide motor (M3).2) Replace the finisher control PC board.
MJ-1101Is there any mechanical problem when the buffer roller is rotated?
YES Fix the drive mechanism.
NOIs the harness between the buffer roller drive motor (M6) and the finisher control PC board (CN18) disconnected or open circuited?
l
YES • Reconnect the connector securely.• Replace the harness.
NO1) Replace the buffer roller drive motor (M6).2) Replace the finisher control PC board.
06/08
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cTROUBLESHOOTING
5 - 69
5
[CB20] Delivery motor abnormality
[CB30] Tray 1/2 shift motor abnormality
[CB30] Movable tray shift motor abnormality
MJ-1022Rotate the delivery roller by hand. Does it rotate smoothly? NO Fix the mechanism.
YESIs the wiring between the finisher controller PC board and delivery motor (M1) correct? NO Correct the wiring.
YESIs the delivery motor clock sensor (S1) working properly? NO Replace the sensor.
YES1) Replace the delivery motor.2) Replace the finisher controller PC board.
MJ-1023/1024Are the tray 1 shift area sensors 1-3 and tray 2 shift area sensors 1-3 normal? NO Replace the tray 1/2 shift area sensor boards.
YESAre the wirings between the finisher controller PC board and the tray 1/2 shift motors (M37/M38) correct? NO Correct the wirings.
YESIs there any problem with the tray lift mechanism? NO Fix the lift mechanism.
YES1) Replace the tray 1/2 shift motors.2) Replace the finisher controller PC board.
MJ-1101Is there any mechanical problem when the movable tray is moved?
YES Fix the mechanism.
NOIs the harness between the movable tray shift motor (M7) and the finisher control PC board (CN8) disconnected or open circuited?
l
YES • Reconnect the connector securely.• Replace the harness.
NOIs there a disconnection of the connector, incorrect installation or breakage of the movable tray position A, B, and C sensors (S13, S14, and S15)?
l
YES • Replace the harness.• Reinstall the sensor correctly.• Replace the sensor.
NO1) Replace the movable tray shift motor (M7).2) Replace the finisher control PC board.
06/08
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedTROUBLESHOOTING
5 - 70
[CB31] Movable tray paper-full detection error
[CB40] Rear aligning plate motor abnormality
[CB40] Front alignment motor abnormality
MJ-1101Is there any mechanical problem when the actuator of the movable tray paper-full detection sensor (S17) is moved?
YES Fix the mechanism.
NOIs there a disconnection of the connector, incorrect installation or breakage of the movable tray paper-full detection sensor (S17)?
ll
YES • Connect the connector securely.• Reinstall the sensor correctly. • Replace the sensor.
NOIs the harness between the movable tray paper-full detection sensor (S17) and the finisher control PC board (CN13) disconnected or open circuited?
l
YES • Reconnect the connector securely.• Replace the harness.
NOReplace the finisher control PC board.
MJ-1023/1024Is the rear aligning plate home position sensor (PI37) normal? NO Correct the wiring.
YESIs there any mechanical problem with the path of aligning plate? NO Fix the mechanism.
YES1) Replace the rear aligning plate motor.2) Replace the finisher controller PC board.
* You receive a [CB40] error when the [ED13] error occurs three times in succession.MJ-1101
Is there any mechanical problem when the front alignment plate is moved?
YES Fix the mechanism.
NOIs the harness between the front alignment motor (M9) and the finisher control PC board (CN10) disconnected or open circuited?
l
YES • Reconnect the connector securely.• Replace the harness.
NOReplace the front alignment motor (M9).
06/08
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cTROUBLESHOOTING
5 - 71
5
[CB50] Staple motor abnormality
[CB50] Stapler home position error
[CB51] Stapler shift home position error
MJ-1022/1023/1024Is the wiring between the stapler and finisher controller PC board correct? NO Correct the wiring.
YES1) Replace the stapler.2) Replace the finisher controller PC board.
* You receive a [CB50] error when the [EA50] error occurs three times in succession.MJ-1101
Is the harness between the stapler and the finisher control PC board (CN2) disconnected or open circuited?
l
YES • Reconnect the connector securely.• Replace the harness.
NOAre the harnesses in the stapler disconnected or open circuited?
l
YES • Reconnect the connector securely.• Replace the harness.
NOReplace the finisher control PC board.
MJ-1101Is there any mechanical problem when the stapler is moved?
YES Fix the mechanism.
NOIs there a disconnection of the connector, incorrect installation or breakage of the stapler unit home position sensor (S10)?
ll
YES • Connect the connector securely.• Reinstall the sensor correctly. • Replace the sensor.
NOIs the harness between the stapler unit home position sensor (S10) and the finisher control PC board (CN1) disconnected or open circuited?
l
YES • Reconnect the connector securely.• Replace the harness.
NOIs the harness between the stapler unit shift motor (M4) and the finisher control PC board (CN5) disconnected or open circuited?
l
YES • Reconnect the connector securely.• Replace the harness.
NOReplace the finisher control PC board.
06/08
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedTROUBLESHOOTING
5 - 72
[CB60] Stapler unit shift motor abnormality
[CB80] Backup RAM data abnormality
[CB80] RAM abnormality
MJ-1023/1024Is the stapler shift home position sensor (PI40) working normally? NO Replace the sensor.
YESIs the wiring between the finisher controller PC board and the stapler shift motor (M35) cor-rect? NO Correct the wiring.
YESIs there any mechanical problem with the stapler stand motion path? YES Fix the lift mechanism.
NO1) Replace the stapler shift motor.2) Replace the finisher controller PC board.
MJ-1101Is there any mechanical problem when the stapler is moved?
YES Fix the mechanism.
NOIs the harness between the stapler unit shift motor (M4) and the finisher control PC board (CN5) disconnected or open circuited?
l
YES • Reconnect the connector securely.• Replace the harness.
NO1) Replace the stapler unit shift motor (M4).2) Replace the finisher control PC board.
MJ-1023/1024Is the problem solved by turning the power of the equipment OFF and ON? YES End.
NO1) Replace the finisher controller PC board.2) Replace the punch controller PC board.
MJ-1101Is the error recovered when the power of the equipment is turned OFF and then back ON?
YES End.
NOReplace the finisher control PC board.
06/08
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cTROUBLESHOOTING
5 - 73
5
[CB81] Flash ROM abnormality
[CB90] Paper pushing plate motor abnormality
[CBA0] Stitch motor (front) abnormality[CBB0] Stitch motor (rear) abnormality
[CBC0] Alignment motor abnormality
MJ-1101Is the error recovered when the power of the equipment is turned OFF and then back ON?
YES End.
NO1) Check if the conductor pattern on the finisher controller PC board is open circuited or short
circuited.2) Replace the finisher control PC board.
MJ-1024Are the paper pushing plate home position sensor (PI14), paper pushing plate top position sensor (PI15) and paper pushing plate motor clock sensor (PI1) working normally? NO Replace the sensor.
YESIs the paper pushing plate drive mechanism normal? NO Fix the mechanism.
YES1) Replace the paper pushing plate motor (M8).2) Replace the saddle stitcher controller PC board.
MJ-1024Are the front and rear stitchers and their stands installed properly? NO Install them properly.
YESAre the stitcher home position switches (SW7/SW5) and stitcher motors (M7/M6) on the front and rear stitchers working normally? NO Replace the front or rear stitcher.
YESReplace the saddle stitcher controller PC board.
MJ-1024Is the alignment plate home position sensor (PI5) working normally? NO Replace the sensor.
YESIs the alignment plate drive mechanism normal? NO Fix the mechanism.
YES1) Replace the alignment motor (M5).2) Replace the saddle stitcher controller PC board.
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedTROUBLESHOOTING
5 - 74
[CBD0] Guide motor abnormality
[CBE0] Paper folding motor abnormality
[CBF0] Paper positioning plate motor abnormality
MJ-1024Is the guide home position sensor (PI13) working normally? NO Replace the sensor.
YESIs the guide plate drive mechanism normal? NO Fix the mechanism.
YES1) Replacing the guide motor (M3).2) Replace the saddle stitcher controller PC board.
MJ-1024Are the paper folding motor clock sensor (PI4) and paper folding home position sensor (PI21) working normally? NO Replace the sensors.
YESIs the paper folding roller drive mechanism normal? NO Fix the mechanism.
YES1) Replacing the paper folding motor (M2).2) Replace the saddle stitcher controller PC board.
MJ-1024Is the paper positioning plate home position sensor (PI7) working normally? NO Replace the sensor.
YESIs the paper positioning plate drive mechanism normal? NO Fix the mechanism.
YES1) Replacing the paper positioning plate motor (M4).2) Replace the saddle stitcher controller PC board.
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cTROUBLESHOOTING
5 - 75
5
[CC00] Sensor connector abnormality
[CC10] Microswitch abnormality
[CC20] Communication error between finisher and saddle stitcher
MJ-1024Are the guide home position sensor (PI13), paper pushing plate home position sensor (PI14) and paper pushing plate top position sensor (PI15) connected to the saddle stitcher controller PC board? NO Connect them to the board.
YESIs the wiring between the sensors and the saddle stitcher correct? NO Correct the wiring.
Is 5V DC being supplied from the connector pins J9-7, -10 and -13 on the saddle stitcher con-troller PC board? NO Replace the saddle stitcher controller PC board.
YESAre the connector pins J9-8, -11 and -14 on the saddle stitcher controller PC board correctly connected to the ground? NO Replace the saddle stitcher controller PC board.
YESEnd.
MJ-1024Are the front cover switch (MS31), inlet door switch (SW1) and delivery door switch (SW3) nor-mal? NO Replace the switches.
YESMeasure the voltage between J704-1 (+) and J704-2 (-) on the finisher controller PC board. Is it 24V? NO Replace the finisher controller PC board.
Is the wiring between J704 on the finisher controller PC board and J1 on the saddle stitcher controller PC board correct? NO Correct the wiring.
YESReplace the saddle stitcher controller PC board.
MJ-1024Is the problem solved by turning OFF and ON the power switch of the equipment? YES End.
NOIs the wiring between the finisher controller PC board and the saddle stitcher controller PC board connected? NO Connect the wiring.
YES1) Replace the finisher controller PC board.2) Replace the saddle stitcher controller PC board.
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedTROUBLESHOOTING
5 - 76
[CC30] Stack processing motor abnormalityMJ-1022
[Procedure 1]Is the tension of the drive belt normal? NO Loosen the adjustment screw to adjust its tension.
YESDoes the bushing attached to the returning roller shaft smoothly move up and down?
|
NO Apply grease on the cut-out part of the front side frame with where the bushing contacts.
Is the spring of the returning roller detached? YES Attach the spring.
NOIs the wiring between the finisher controller PC board and stack processing motor (M2) cor-rect? NO Correct the wiring.
YESIs the stack delivery lever home position sensor (S8) working properly? NO Replace the sensor.
YES1) Replacing the stack processing motor.2) Replace the finisher controller PC board.
[Procedure 2]Does the bushing attached to the returning roller shaft smoothly move up and down?
|
NO Apply grease on the cut-out part of the front side frame with where the bushing contacts.
YESIs the spring of the returning roller detached? YES Attach the spring.
NOIs the tension of the stack processing motor drive belt normal? NO Loosen the adjustment screw to adjust its tension.
YESIs the returning roller home position sensor (S3) working properly? NO Replace the sensor.
YES1) Replace the stack processing motor.2) Replace the finisher controller PC board.
06/08
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cTROUBLESHOOTING
5 - 77
5
[CC30] Stack transport motor abnormality
[CC31] Transport motor abnormality
[CC40] Swing motor abnormality
* You receive a [CC30] error when the [EA70] error occurs three times in succession.MJ-1101
Is there any mechanical problem when the stack transport belt is moved?
YES Fix the mechanism.
NOIs the harness between the stack transport motor (M5) and the finisher control PC board (CN10) disconnected or open circuited?
l
YES • Reconnect the connector securely.• Replace the harness.
NO1) Replace the stack transport motor (M5).2) Replace the finisher control PC board.
* You receive a [CC31] error when the [ED12] error occurs three times in succession.MJ-1101
Is there any mechanical problem when the stack transport roller -1 and -2 are rotated?
YES Fix the mechanism.
NOIs the harness between the transport motor (M2) and the finisher control PC board (CN5) dis-connected or open circuited?
l
YES • Reconnect the connector securely.• Replace the harness.
NO1) Replace the transport motor (M2).2) Replace the finisher control PC board.
MJ-1023/1024Is the swing unit home position sensor (PI35) normal? NO Replace the sensor.
YESIs the wiring between the finisher controller PC board and the swing motor (M36) correct? NO Correct the wiring.
YESIs the swing mechanism normal? NO Fix the mechanism.
YES1) Replace the swing motor.2) Replace the finisher controller PC board.
06/08
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedTROUBLESHOOTING
5 - 78
[CC41] Paper holder cam home position abnormality
[CC50] Horizontal registration motor abnormality
[CC51] Sideways adjustment motor (M2) abnormality
MJ-1101Is there any mechanical problem when the paper holder cam is rotated?
YES Fix the mechanism.
NOIs the harness between the paper holder home position sensor (S6) and the finisher control PC board (CN17) disconnected or open circuited?
l
YES • Reconnect the connector securely.• Replace the harness.
NO1) Replace the paper holder home position sensor (S6).2) Replace the finisher control PC board.
MJ-1023/1024 (when MJ-6004 is installed)Is the horizontal registration home position sensor (PI61) working normally? NO Replace the sensor.
YESIs the wiring between the horizontal registration home position sensor and finisher controller PC board correct? NO Correct the wiring.
YESIs the horizontal registration mechanism normal? NO Fix the mechanism.
YES1) Replace the horizontal registration motor (M62).2) Replace the punch controller PC board.3) Replace the finisher controller PC board.
* The [CC51] error will be displays when the [ED11] error occurs three times in succession or during the initial operation. MJ-1101 (When MJ-6101 is installed)
Is there any paper remaining on the transport path?
YES Remove the paper.
NORotate the sideways adjustment motor (M2). Does it rotate smoothly?
NO Fix the mechanism.
YESAre the sideways deviation home position sensor (S3) and its wiring correct?
NO Replace the sensor. Correct the wiring.
YESIs the wiring between the hole punch control PC board (HP) and sideways adjustment motor (M2) correct?
NO Correct the wiring.
YES1) Replace the punch sideways adjustment motor (M2). 2) Replace the hole punch control PC board (HP).
06/08
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cTROUBLESHOOTING
5 - 79
5
[CC52] Skew adjustment motor (M1) abnormality
[CC60] Punch motor abnormality
* The [CC52] error will be displays when the [ED10] error occurs three times in succession or during the initial operation. MJ-1101 (When MJ-6101 is installed)
Is there any paper remaining on the transport path?
YES Remove the paper.
NORotate the skew adjustment motor (M1). Does it rotate smoothly?
NO Fix the mechanism.
YESAre the skew home position sensor (S2) and its wiring correct?
NO Replace the sensor. Correct the wiring.
YESIs the wiring between the hole punch control PC board (HP) and skew adjustment motor (M1) correct?
NO Correct the wiring.
YES1) Replace the skew adjustment motor (M1). 2) Replace the hole punch control PC board (HP).
MJ-1023/1024 (when MJ-6004 is installed)Are the punch home position sensor (PI63) and punch motor clock sensor (PI62) working nor-mally? NO Replace the sensors.
YESIs the wiring between the sensors and finisher controller PC board correct? NO Correct the wiring.
YESIs the punching mechanism normal? NO Fix the mechanism.
YES1) Replace the punch motor (M61).2) Replace the punch controller PC board.3) Replace the finisher controller PC board.
06/08
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedTROUBLESHOOTING
5 - 80
[CC61] Punch motor (M3) home position detection error
[CC71] Punch ROM checksum error
[CC72] Punch RAM read/write error
* The [CC61] error will be displays when the [E9F0] error occurs three times in succession or during the initial operation. MJ-1101 (When MJ-6101 is installed)
Is there any paper remaining on the transport path?
YES Remove the paper.
NORotate the punch motor (M3). Does it rotate smoothly?
NO Fix the mechanism.
YESAre the punch home position sensor (S4) and its wiring correct?
NO Replace the sensor. Correct the wiring.
YESIs the wiring between the hole punch control PC board (HP) and punch motor (M3) correct?
NO Correct the wiring.
YES1) Replace the punch motor (M3). 2) Replace the hole punch control PC board (HP).
MJ-1101 (When MJ-6101 is installed)Is the conductor pattern on the hole punch control PC board (HP) open circuited or short cir-cuited?
YES Replace the hole punch control PC board (HP).
NOReplace the finisher control PC board.
MJ-1101 (When MJ-6101 is installed)Is the conductor pattern on the hole punch control PC board (HP) open circuited or short cir-cuited?
YES Replace the hole punch control PC board (HP).
NOReplace the finisher control PC board.
06/08
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cTROUBLESHOOTING
5 - 81
5
[CC80] Front jogging motor abnormality/Front aligning plate motor abnormality
[CC80] Rear alignment motor abnormality
MJ-1022 (Front jogging motor abnormality)Is the front jogging plate home position sensor (S6) working properly? NO Replace the sensor.
YESIs the wiring between the finisher controller PC board and front jogging motor (M3) correct? NO Correct the wiring.
YESHas the rack run over the stopper of the roll? YES Fix it.
NO1) Replace the front jogging motor.2) Replace the finisher controller PC board.
MJ-1023/1024 (Front aligning plate motor abnormality)Is the front aligning plate home position sensor (PI36) normal? NO Replace the sensor.
YESIs the wiring between the finisher controller PC board and the front aligning plate motor (M33) correct? NO Correct the wiring.
YESIs there any mechanical problem with the path of aligning plate? NO Fix the mechanism.
YES1) Replace the front aligning plate motor.2) Replace the finisher controller PC board.
* You receive a [CC80] error when the [ED14] error occurs three times in succession. MJ-1101
Is there any mechanical problem when the rear alignment plate is moved?
YES Fix the mechanism.
NOIs the harness between the rear alignment motor (M10) and the finisher control PC board (CN10) disconnected or open circuited?
l
YES • Reconnect the connector securely.• Replace the harness.
NO1) Replace the rear alignment motor (M10).2) Replace the finisher control PC board.
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedTROUBLESHOOTING
5 - 82
[CC90] Upper stack tray lift motor abnormalityMJ-1022
Is the wiring between the finisher controller PC board and upper stack tray lift motor (M5) cor-rect? NO Correct the wiring.
YESAre the front and rear sides of the upper stack tray leveled? NO Level them.
YESIs the upper stack tray lift motor clock sensor (S19) working properly? NO Level them.
YESIs the stack tray paper height sensor (S10) working properly? NO Replace the sensor.
YESAre the upper stack tray upper limit sensor (S25), upper stack tray full sensor (S23) and stack processing safety switch (S26) working properly? NO Replace the sensor or sensor controller PC board.
YESDoes the voltage between the pins J14-1 and -2 on the finisher controller PC board become 24V when the upper stack tray lift motor starts rotating? NO Replace the finisher controller PC board.
YESCheck the wiring between the upper stack tray lift motor and finisher controller PC board. If there is no problem, replace the upper stack tray lift motor.
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cTROUBLESHOOTING
5 - 83
5
[CCA0] Lower stack tray lift motor abnormality
[CCB0] Rear jogging motor abnormality
MJ-1022Is the wiring between the finisher controller PC board and lower stack tray lift motor (M7) cor-rect? NO Correct the wiring.
YESAre the front and rear sides of the lower stack tray leveled? NO Level them.
YESIs the lower stack tray lift motor clock sensor (S9) working properly? NO Replace the sensor.
YESIs the stack tray paper height sensor (S10) working properly? NO Replace the sensor.
YESAre the lower stack tray upper limit sensor (S13) and lower stack tray full sensor (S23) working properly? NO Replace the sensor or sensor controller PC board.
YESDoes the voltage between the pins J3-1 and -2 on the finisher controller PC board become 24V when the lower stack tray lift motor starts rotating? NO Replace the finisher controller PC board.
YESCheck the wiring between the upper stack tray lift motor and finisher controller PC board. If there is no problem, replace the motor.
MJ-1022Is the rear jogging plate home position sensor (S7) working properly? NO Replace the sensor.
YESIs the wiring between the finisher controller PC board and rear jogging motor (M4) correct? NO Correct the wiring.
YESHas the rack run over the stopper of the roll? YES Fix it.
NO1) Replace the rear jogging motor.2) Replace the finisher controller PC board.
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedTROUBLESHOOTING
5 - 84
[CCD0] Stack ejection motor abnormality
[CCE0] Rear end assist motor abnormality
[CCF0] Gear change motor abnormality
MJ-1023/1024Is the shutter home position sensor (PI45) normal? NO Replace the sensor.
YESAre the wirings between the finisher controller PC board and the stack ejection motor (M32)/shutter clutch (CL31) correct? NO Correct the wirings.
YESIs there any problem with the shutter mechanism? YES Fix the shutter mechanism.
NO1) Replace the stack ejection motor and shutter clutch.2) Replace the finisher controller PC board.
MJ-1023/1024Is the rear end assist guide home position sensor (PI39) normal? NO Replace the sensor.
YESIs the wiring between the finisher controller PC board and the rear end assist motor (M39) cor-rect? NO Correct the wiring.
YESIs there any problem with the rear end assist mechanism? YES Fix the rear end assist mechanism.
NO1) Replace the rear end assist motor.2) Replace the finisher controller PC board.
MJ-1023/1024Is the gear change home position sensor (PI49) normal? NO Replace the sensor.
YESIs the wiring between the finisher controller PC board and the gear change motor (M40) cor-rect? NO Correct the wiring.
YESIs there any problem with the gear change mechanism? YES Fix the gear change mechanism.
NO1) Replace the gear change motor.2) Replace the finisher controller PC board.
06/08
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cTROUBLESHOOTING
5 - 85
5
[CDE0] Paddle motor abnormality
[CE00] Communication error between finisher and puncher unit
[CE00] Punch communication error
* You receive a [CDE0] error when the [ED15] error occurs three times in succession or during the initial operation. MJ-1101
Is there any mechanical problem with the paddle is rotated?
YES Fix the mechanism.
NOIs the harness between the paddle motor (M8) and the finisher control PC board (CN6) discon-nected or open circuited?
l
YES • Reconnect the connector securely.• Replace the harness.
NO1) Replace the paddle motor (M8).2) Replace the finisher control PC board.
MJ-1023/1024 (When MJ-6004 is installed)Is the problem solved by turning OFF and ON the power of the equipment? YES End.
NOIs the wiring between the finisher controller PC board and punch controller PC board correct? NO Correct the wiring.
YES1) Replace the finisher controller PC board.2) Replace the punch controller PC board.
MJ-1101 (When MJ-6101 is installed)Is the harness between the hole punch control PC board (HP) and the finisher control PC board disconnected or open circuited?
YES Replace the harness. Correct the wiring.
NOIs the conductor pattern on the hole punch control PC board (HP) open circuited or short cir-cuited?
YES Replace the hole punch control PC board (HP).
NOReplace the finisher control PC board.
07/04
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedTROUBLESHOOTING
5 - 86
[CF10] <Undefined error code processing>MJ-1022/1023/1024
1) Is the error recovered when the power of the equipment is turned OFF and then back ON?2) If not as in step 1, check if the LGC board and IPC board are connected correctly.3) If the error has still not been recovered in step 2, check if there is any defect in the LGC
board, IPC board or finisher control board. If not, replace the LGC board, IPC board or fin-isher control board.
<Communication module SRAM writing failure>MJ-1101
1) Is the error recovered when the power of the equipment is turned OFF and then back ON?2) Check if the MJ-1101 (08-1912) is set as the specified finisher on the equipment.3) Check if the harness connecting the converter PC board and the finisher controller PC
board is disconnected or open circuited.4) Check if the conductor pattern on the converter PC board is open circuited or short cir-
cuited.5) Check if the conductor pattern on the finisher controller PC board is open circuited or short
circuited.6) Try to update the finisher firmware again.7) Replace the converter PC board.8) Replace the finisher control PC board.
MJ-1101 (when MJ-6101 is connected)1) Is the error recovered when the power of the equipment is turned OFF and then back ON?2) Check if the MJ-1101 (08-1912) is set as the specified finisher on the equipment.3) Check if the harness connecting the converter PC board and the finisher controller PC
board is disconnected or open circuited.4) Check if the harness connecting the hole punch control PC board and the finisher control
PC board is disconnected or open circuited.5) Check if the conductor pattern on the converter PC board is open circuited or short cir-
cuited.6) Check if the conductor pattern on the finisher controller PC board is open circuited or short
circuited.7) Check if the conductor pattern on the hole punch control PC board is open circuited or
short circuited.8) Try to update the finisher firmware again.9) Replace the converter PC board.10)Replace the finisher control PC board.11)Replace the hole punch control PC board.
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cTROUBLESHOOTING
5 - 87
5
5.1.17 Image control related service call
(1) Based on the procedure of [CE10], [CE20] and [CE40] described below, check the status and take appropriate actions. And then perform the forced performing of image quality closed-loop control according to the following procedure.
(2) After confirming the items in (1), clear the abnormal detection counter of image quality control.
[CE10] Image quality sensor abnormality (OFF level)
1. While pressing [0] and [5] simultaneously, turn ON the power.
2. Key in [395], and then press the [START] button. Confirm that the image quality control has finished normally.
1. While pressing [0] and [8] simultaneously, turn ON the power.
2. Key in [573], and then press the [START] button.
3. Rewrite the displayed status counter from "1" - "16" to "0", and then press the [ENTER] or [INTERRUPT] button.
4. Key in [574], and then press the [START] button.
5. Rewrite the displayed status counter from "1" - "16" to "0", and then press the [ENTER] or [INTERRUPT] button.
6. Key in [575], and then press the [START] button.
7. Rewrite the displayed status counter from "1" - "16" to "0", and then press the [ENTER] or [INTERRUPT] button.
8. Key in [576], and then press the [START] button.
9. Rewrite the displayed status counter from "1" - "16" to "0", and then press the [ENTER] or [INTERRUPT] button.
Is the connector of the image quality sensor, or the connector CN338 on the LGC board dis-connected?Is the harness between the LGC board and the image quality sensor, or the harness between the LGC board and the switching power supply open circuited? YES Connect the connector securely. Replace the harness.
NOIs the output voltage from the 12V-power supply normal? NO Check the power supply system and replace the switching power supply.
YES1) Replace the image quality sensor.2) Replace the LGC board.
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedTROUBLESHOOTING
5 - 88
[CE20] Image quality sensor abnormality (no pattern level)1) Check if the transfer belt or transfer belt unit are securely installed.2) Check for any abnormal stain caused by poor cleaning, large flaw or break on the transfer belt sur-
face.3) Check if the drum and the transfer belt are rotating. If any abnormality is found, correct any mechan-
ical problem.Is the connectors CN338 on the LGC board disconnected?Is the connector of the image quality sensor disconnected or the surface of the sensor stained?Is the harness between the LGC board and the image quality sensor open circuited?Is the shutter of image quality sensor opening and closing normally? Is the shutter damaged?
||||||||||||||
YES <Procedure>1) Take off the transfer belt unit so that the image quality sensor unit can be
easily seen.2) While pressing the digital keys [0] and [3] simultaneously, turn the power
ON.3) Key in “430”.4) The shutter is opened and closed repeatedly by pressing the [START] but-
ton repeatedly.
Connect the connector securely. Replace the harness. Clean the sensor.Replace the shutter if it is damaged.Replace the shutter solenoid if its operation is defective.
NOIs the output voltage from the 12V-power supply normal?
|
NO Check the power supply system, and replace the switching power supply.
YES1) Replace the image quality sensor.2) Replace the LGC board.
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cTROUBLESHOOTING
5 - 89
5
[CE40] Image quality control test pattern abnormality
(1) Use "Image quality control abnormal detection counter Y to K display/0 clearing (08-573 to 576)" to check the abnormal occurring condition for each color.
(2) Check “Output value display of image quality sensor / Low-density pattern (05-391-0 to 3)” to check if the low-density pattern abnormality occurs for each color. The values under 320 for Y, M and C, and under 220 for K are defined as low-density pattern abnormality.
(3) Check “Output value display of image quality sensor / High-density pattern (05-390-0 to 3)” to check if the high-density pattern abnormality occurs for each color and identify the color which pattern is abnormal. If the value is 630 or above, it is defined as high-density pattern abnormality.
(4) Set the values of “Image quality closed-loop control / Contrast voltage (08-556)” and “Image quality closed-loop control / Laser power (08-557)” to “0” (Invalid).
(5) Perform “Enforced performing of image quality open-loop control (05-394)”.
(6) Output the image quality control test pattern (04-270) more than one time and check the patch of the color identified in step (3) to see if the image is abnormal (Note).
(7) Replace the image quality sensor.
(8) Set the values of “Image quality closed-loop control / Contrast voltage (08-556)” and “Image quality closed-loop control / Laser power (08-557)” to “1” (Valid).
(9) Perform “Enforced performing of image quality open-loop control (05-394)” and make sure it is completed normally. (Error [CE40] does not appear.) Then perform “Automatic gamma adjust-ment“ ( Chapter 3.5.1 and 3.6.1).
(10) Clear all "Image quality control abnormal detection counter Y to K display/0 clearing (08-573 to 576)".
Note: Note: Abnormal image:Blank print, Solid print, White banding, Color banding, White spots, Poor transfer, Uneven image density, Faded image (low density), Uneven light distribution, Blotched image.
||||||||||
320 or above (Y, M and C)220 or above (K)
||
Under 320 (Y, M and C)Under 220 (K)
Low-density pattern abnormalityCheck the transfer belt. If the cleaning is poor, correct the transfer belt around its cleaning blade.
|
To (9)
||||||
Normal |
Abnormal
Correct the items related to the image.|
To (9)
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedTROUBLESHOOTING
5 - 90
[CE50] Temperature/humidity sensor abnormality
[CE90] Drum thermistor abnormality
Is the connector CN333 on the LGC board or the connector of the temperature/humidity sen-sor disconnected?Is the harness between the LGC board and the temperature/humidity sensor disconnected ? YES Connect the connector securely. Replace the harness.
NO1) Replace the temperature/humidity sensor.2) Replace the LGC board.
Is the connector CN333 on the LGC board, or the connector of the drum thermistor discon-nected?Is the harness between the LGC board and the drum thermistor disconnected? YES Connect the connector securely. Replace the harness.
NO1) Replace the drum thermistor.2) Replace the LGC board.
05/07
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cTROUBLESHOOTING
5 - 91
5
5.1.18 Copy process related service call
[C360] Charger cleaner motor abnormality
(1) Check if the main charger is installed normally.(2) Check if the charger wire is broken.(3) Check if any of the connector pins of the charger cleaner front/rear position detection switch is
disconnected.(4) Check if the cleaning pads are damaged or removed.(5) Check if any of the connector pins of the charger cleaner motor is disconnected.(6) Replace the charger cleaner motor.(7) Replace the LGC board.
[C970] High-voltage transformer abnormality
(1) Is the main charger installed securely?(2) Check if the spring of high-voltage supply contact point is deformed.(3) Check if the charger wire is broken or the main charger grid is deformed.(4) Check if any foreign matter is on the charger wire or main charger grid.
[CEA0] Revolver home position detection abnormalityIs the revolver home position sensor working properly? (Perform the input check: 03-[FAX]ON/[2]/[C])
||||||||||
NO 1) Check if the connector or joint connector of the revolver home position sen-sor is disconnected.
2) Check if the connector CN331 on the LGC board is disconnected.3) Check if the connector pins are disconnected or the wires of harnesses are
open circuited.4) Check if the conductor pattern on the LGC board is short circuited or open
circuited.5) Replace the revolver home position sensor.6) Replace the LGC board.
YES1) Check if the conductor pattern on the LGC board is short circuited or open circuited.2) Replace the LGC board.
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedTROUBLESHOOTING
5 - 92
[CEB0] Black developer unit lifting movement abnormalityCheck the timing of the black developer lifting clutch (stop position), and adjust it if it deviates.( P. 3-61 "3.11.3 Black developer unit lift up/down timing adjustment")
Is the black developer lifting clutch working properly? (Perform the output check: 03-433)|||||||||
NO 1) Check if the connector of the black developer lifting clutch is disconnected.2) Check if the connector CN339 on the LGC board is disconnected.3) Check if the connector pins are disconnected or the wires of harnesses are
open circuited.4) Check if the conductor pattern on the LGC board is short circuited or open
circuited.5) Replace the black developer lifting clutch.6) Replace the LGC board.
YESAre the black developer contact position detection sensor and black developer contact timing detection sensor working properly? (Perform the input check: 03-[FAX]ON/[1]/[C], /[1]/[B]
|||||||||||||
NO 1) Check if the connectors of the black developer contact position detection sensor or black developer contact timing detection sensor are discon-nected.
2) Check if the connector CN333 on the LGC board is disconnected.3) Check if the connector pins are disconnected or the wires of harnesses are
open circuited.4) Check if the conductor pattern on the LGC board is short circuited or open
circuited.5) Replace the black developer contact position detection sensor and black
developer contact timing detection sensor.6) Replace the LGC board.
YES1) Check if the conductor pattern on the LGC board is short circuited or open circuited.2) Replace the LGC board.
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cTROUBLESHOOTING
5 - 93
5
[CEC0] 2nd transfer roller position detection abnormalityIs the 2nd transfer roller contact clutch working properly? (Perform the output check: 03-435)
||||||||||
NO 1) Check if the connector or joint connectors of the 2nd transfer contact clutch are disconnected.
2) Check if the connector CN338 on the LGC board is disconnected.3) Check if the connector pins are disconnected or the wires of harnesses are
open circuited.4) Check if the conductor pattern on the LGC board is short circuited or open
circuited.5) Replace the 2nd transfer roller contact clutch.6) Replace the LGC board.
YESIs the 2nd transfer roller position detection sensor working properly? (Perform the input check:03-[FAX]ON/[1]/[A])
||||||||||
NO 1) Check if the connector or joint connectors of the 2nd transfer roller position detection sensor are disconnected.
2) Check if the connector CN345 on the LGC board is disconnected.3) Check if the connector pins are disconnected or the wires of harnesses are
open circuited.4) Check if the conductor pattern on the LGC board is short circuited or open
circuited.5) Replace the 2nd transfer roller position detection sensor.6) Replace the LGC board.
YES1) Check if the conductor pattern on the LGC board is short circuited or open circuited.2) Replace the LGC board.
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedTROUBLESHOOTING
5 - 94
[CEE0] Transfer belt position detection abnormality (Normal speed)[CEE1] Transfer belt position detection abnormality (When decelerating)If the error [CEE0] has occurred, check the transfer belt home position sensor-1. If the error [CEE1] has occurred, check the transfer belt home position sensor-2.
[CEF0] Revolver motor abnormality
Is there any stain or scratch on the reflection tape inside the transfer belt?|
YES Clean the transfer belt or replace it.Replace the cleaning pad if it is excessively stained.
NOAre the transfer belt home position sensors-1 and -2 stained? YES Clean them.
NOAre the transfer belt home position sensors-1 and -2 working properly? (Perform the input check:03-[FAX]ON/[9]/[H])
||||||||||
NO 1) Check if the connectors or joint connectors of the transfer belt home posi-tion sensors-1 and -2 are disconnected.
2) Check if the connector CN361 on the LGC board is disconnected.3) Check if the connector pins are disconnected or the wires of harnesses are
open circuited.4) Check if the conductor pattern on the LGC board is short circuited or open
circuited.5) Replace the transfer belt home position sensor-1 and -2.6) Replace the LGC board.
YES1) Check if the conductor pattern on the LGC board is short circuited or open circuited.2) Replace the LGC board.
Is the revolver motor working? (Perform the output check: 03-450)||||||||||||
NO 1) Check if the connector of the revolver motor is disconnected.2) Check if the connectors CN435 and CN434 on the DRV board are discon-
nected.3) Check if the connector CN331 on the LGC board is disconnected.4) Check if the connector pins are disconnected or the harnesses are open cir-
cuited.5) Check if the conductor patterns on the DRV board and LGC board are short
circuited or open circuited.6) Replace the revolver motor.7) Replace the DRV board and LGC board.
YES1) Check if the teeth of the revolver motor gear or the revolver unit gear do not get chipped or
cracked.2) Check if the conductor patterns on the DRV board and LGC board are short circuited or
open circuited.3) Replace the DRV board and LGC board.
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cTROUBLESHOOTING
5 - 95
5
5.1.19 Toner density control related service call[CF20] Toner density detection voltage abnormality
(1) Specify the developer unit with the abnormality by checking the setting values of 08-824-0 to 08-824-2. (When the value is “1”, an abnormality occurs.)
(2) Correct the defective section of the unit specified in (1) with the following procedure.
(3) When the correction is completed, reset the values of 08-824-0 to 08-824-2 from “1” to “0” to clear the abnormality.
Is the developer material transported properly? Is the form of magnetic brush is normal?
||||
NO 1) Check if the amount of the developer material is normal or any foreign matter is mixed in.
2) Correct the transport mechanism of developer material.3) Check the polar position and correct if necessary.
YESIs the color auto-toner sensor stained? YES Clean it.
NOIs the color auto-toner sensor shutter solenoid working normally? (Perform the output check: 03-125/175)Is the color auto-toner sensor working?
|||||||||||||
NO 1) Check if the connectors or joint connectors of the color auto-toner sensor shutter solenoid and color auto-toner sensor are disconnected.
2) Check if the connector CN332 on the LGC board is disconnected.3) Check if the connector pins are disconnected or the harnesses are open cir-
cuited.4) Replace the color auto-toner sensor shutter solenoid.5) Check if the conductor pattern on the LGC board is short circuited or open
circuited.6) Replace the LGC board.7) Replace the color auto-toner sensor and perform “Enforced correction of
color auto-toner sensor light amount (05-208)”.
YESIs the color auto-toner sensor shutter opening position correct? (Perform the output check: 03-125/175)
||
NO Adjust the install position of solenoid so that the sensor holder will touch and face the positioning component when opening the shutter.
YES1) Check if the conductor pattern on the LGC board is short circuited or open circuited.2) Replace the LGC board.
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedTROUBLESHOOTING
5 - 96
[CF30] Reference plate detection voltage abnormalityAre the reference plate and color auto-toner sensor stained? YES Clean them.
NOIs the color auto-toner sensor shutter solenoid working normally? (Perform the output check: 03-125/175)Is the color auto-toner sensor working?
|||||||||||||
NO 1) Check if the connectors or joint connectors of the color auto-toner sensor shutter solenoid and color auto-toner sensor are disconnected.
2) Check if the connector CN332 on the LGC board is disconnected.3) Check if the connector pins are disconnected or the harnesses are open
circuited.4) Replace the color auto-toner sensor shutter solenoid.5) Check if the conductor pattern on the LGC board is short circuited or open
circuited.6) Replace the LGC board.7) Replace the color auto-toner sensor and perform “Enforced correction of
color auto-toner sensor light amount (05-208)”.
YESIs the color auto-toner sensor shutter closing position correct? (Perform the output check: 03-125/175)
||
NO Adjust the install position of solenoid so that the gap between the sensor holder and stopper will be 1.0 mm when closing the shutter.
YES1) Replace the LGC board.2) Replace the reference plate and perform “Initialization of color auto-toner sensor light
amount correction target value (05-207)”.
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cTROUBLESHOOTING
5 - 97
5
[CF40] Light amount correction voltage abnormality
(1) Specify the developer unit with the abnormality by checking the setting values of 08-823-0 to 08-823-2. (When the value is “1”, an abnormality occurs.)
(2) Correct the defective section of the unit specified in (1) with the following procedure.
(3) When the correction is completed, reset the values of 08-823-0 to 08-823-2 from “1” to “0” to clear the abnormality.
Is the developer unit inserted properly? NO Insert it properly.
YESIs the developer material transported properly? Is the form of magnetic brush is normal?
||||
NO 1) Check if the amount of the developer material is normal or any foreign matter is mixed in.
2) Correct the transport mechanism of developer material.3) Check the polar position and correct if necessary.
YESIs the color auto-toner sensor stained? YES Clean it.
NOIs the color auto-toner sensor shutter solenoid working normally? (Perform the output check: 03-125/175)Is the color auto-toner sensor working?
|||||||||||||
NO 1) Check if the connectors or joint connectors of the color auto-toner sensor shutter solenoid and color auto-toner sensor are disconnected.
2) Check if the connector CN332 on the LGC board is disconnected.3) Check if the connector pins are disconnected or the harnesses are open cir-
cuited.4) Replace the color auto-toner sensor shutter solenoid.5) Check if the conductor pattern on the LGC board is short circuited or open
circuited.6) Replace the LGC board.7) Replace the color auto-toner sensor and perform “Enforced correction of
color auto-toner sensor light amount (05-208)”.
YESIs the color auto-toner sensor shutter opening position correct? (Perform the output check: 03-125/175)
||
NO Adjust the install position of solenoid so that the sensor holder will touch and face the positioning component when opening the shutter.
YES1) Replace the LGC board.2) Replace the reference plate and perform “Initialization of color auto-toner sensor light
amount correction target value (05-207)”.
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedTROUBLESHOOTING
5 - 98
[CF50] Color auto-toner sensor abnormalityAre the connector of color auto-toner sensor, joint connector and connector CN356 on the LGC board connected normally?
|||
NO 1) Reconnect the connectors.2) Correct or replace if the connector pins are disconnected or harnesses are
open circuited.
YESAre the color auto-toner sensor and reference plate stained? YES Clean them.
NOIs the color auto-toner sensor shutter solenoid working normally?(Perform the output check: 03-125/175)
||||||||||
NO 1) Check if the connectors or joint connectors of the color auto-toner sensor shutter solenoid and color auto-toner sensor are disconnected.
2) Check if the connector CN332 on the LGC board is disconnected.3) Check if the connector pins are disconnected or the harnesses are open cir-
cuited.4) Check if the conductor pattern on the LGC board is short circuited or open
circuited.5) Replace the color auto-toner sensor shutter solenoid.6) Replace the LGC board.
YESIs the color auto-toner sensor shutter closing position correct? (Perform the output check: 03-125/175)
||
NO Adjust the install position of solenoid so that the gap between the sensor holder and stopper will be 1.0 mm when closing the shutter.
YES1) Check if the conductor pattern on the LGC board is short circuited or open circuited.2) Replace the LGC board.3) Replace the reference plate and perform “Initialization of color auto-toner sensor light
amount correction target value (05-207)”.4) Replace the color auto-toner sensor and perform “Enforced correction of color auto-toner
sensor light amount (05-208)”.
05/11
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cTROUBLESHOOTING
5 - 99
5
5.1.20 Other service call
[F100] HDD format error
(1) Check if the HDD is mounted.(2) Check if the specified HDD is mounted.(3) Check if the connector pins of the HDD are bent.(4) Check if the connectors CN112, CN113 on the SYS board is disconnected.(5) Replace the harness.(6) Format the HDD. (Key in "2" at 08-690.)(7) Replace the HDD.(8) Replace the SYS board.
[F101] HDD unmounted[F102] HDD start error[F103] HDD transfer time-out[F104] HDD data error[F105] HDD other error
(1) Check if the connectors of the HDD are disconnected.(2) Check if the connector pins are disconnected or the wires of harnesses are open circuited.(3) Perform the bad sector check (08-694). If the check result is OK, recover the data in the HDD. If
the check result is failed, replace the HDD.(4) Replace the SYS board.
[F106] Point and Print partition damage
(1) Turn the power OFF and start up the Setting Mode (08).(2) Key in “662” and press the [START] button. (Partition clearing is performed.)(3) Restart the equipment.(4) Access TopAccess. Click the [Administration] tab, and then click the Maintenance Menu to open.
Then install the “Point and Print” driver.
[F107] / SHR partition damageInitialize the Electronic Filing using the Setting Mode (08-666).
[F108] /SHA partition damageInitialize the shared folder using the Setting Mode (08-667).
[F120] Database abnormality
(1) Rebuild the databases. (Perform 08-684.)(2) If the error is not recovered, initialize the HDD. (Key in “2” at 08-690.)
* When “Rebuilding all databases (08-684)” is performed, all data in the Address Book and Mail-box are deleted. Make sure to back up these data in advance of rebuilding and restore the data after rebuilding.
[F130] Invalid MAC address Compare the serial number of the equipment with a number displayed in 08-995. If they are different, enter the correct serial number at 08-995.
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedTROUBLESHOOTING
5 - 100
[F200] Data overwrite kit (GP-1060) is taken off
Clear the service call “F200”. (Key in “0” at 08-633.) * When the Data overwrite kit (GP-1060) is taken off from the equipment, the service call “F200”
occurs.
5.1.21 Error in Internet FAX / Scanning Function
[ 1 ] Internet FAX related error[1C10] System access abnormality[1C32] File deletion failureTurn the power OFF and then back ON. Perform the job in error again.If the error still occurs, first, check if there are no jobs existing and then perform the HDD formatting (08-690).
[1C11] Insufficient memoryWhen there are running jobs, perform the job in error again after the completion of the running jobs.If the error still occurs, turn the power OFF and then back ON, and perform the job again.
[1C12] Message reception error[1C13] Message transmission errorTurn the power OFF and then back ON. Perform the job in error again.
[1C14] Invalid parameterWhen a template is used, form the template again.If the error still occurs, turn the power OFF and then back ON, and perform the job again.
[1C15] Exceeding file capacityReset and extend the "Maximum send to E-mail/iFAX size" or reduce the number of pages and perform the job again.
[1C20] System management module access abnormality[1C21] Job control module access abnormality[1C22] Job control module access abnormalityTurn the power OFF and then back ON. Perform the job in error again.Check if there are no other running jobs and perform the HDD formatting (08-690).If the recovery is still not completed, replace the SYS board.
Notes: 1. When initializing the Electronic Filing (Setting Mode (08-666)), all data in the Electronic
Filing are erased. Back up the data in the Electronic Filing by using the Electronic Filing Function of TopAccess before the initialization.
2. When initializing the shared folder (Setting Mode (08-667)), all data in the shared folder are erased. Back up the data in the shared folder by using Explorer before the initializa-tion.
3. When formatting the HDD (Setting Mode (08-690)), all data in the shared folder, Electronic Filing, Address Book, template, etc. are erased. Back up these data before the initializa-tion. Note that some of data cannot be backed up ( Page 5-1).
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cTROUBLESHOOTING
5 - 101
5
[1C30] Directory creation failure[1C31] File creation failure[1C33] File access failureCheck if the access privilege to the storage directory is writable.Check if the server or local disk has a sufficient space in disk capacity.
[1C40] Image conversion abnormalityTurn the power OFF and then back ON. Perform the job in error again.Replace the main memory and perform the job again.
[1C60] HDD full failure during processingReduce the number of pages of the job in error and perform the job again.Check if the server or local disk has a sufficient space in disk capacity.
[1C61] Address Book reading failureTurn the power OFF and then back ON. Perform the job in error again.Reset the data in the Address Book and perform the job again.
[1C62] Memory acquiring failureCheck if there is any job being performed and perform the job in error again.Turn the power OFF and then back ON. Perform the job in error again.Replace the main memory and perform the job again.
[1C63] Terminal IP address unsetReset the Terminal IP address.Turn the power OFF and then back ON. Perform the job in error again.
[1C64] Terminal mail address unsetReset the Terminal mail address.Turn the power OFF and then back ON. Perform the job in error again.
[1C65] SMTP address unsetReset the SMTP address and perform the job.Turn the power OFF and then back ON. Perform the job in error again.
[1C66] Server time-out errorCheck if the SMTP server is operating properly.
[1C67] NIC time-out error[1C68] NIC access error[1C6D] System errorTurn the power OFF and then back ON. Perform the job in error again.If the error still occurs, replace the SYS board.
[1C69] SMTP server connection errorReset the login name or password of SMTP server and perform the job again.Check if the SMTP server is operating properly.
[1C6A] HOST NAME errorCheck if there is an illegal character in the device name.Delete the illegal character and reset the appropriate device name.
07/11
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedTROUBLESHOOTING
5 - 102
[1C6B] Terminal mail address errorCheck if the SMTP authentication method is correct. Check if there are any illegal characters in the Terminal mail address. Select the correct SMTP authentication method. Delete the illegal characters and reset the mail address. Then try again.
[1C6C] Destination mail address errorCheck if there is an illegal character in the Destination mail address.Delete the illegal character and reset the appropriate Destination mail address, then perform the job again.
[1C70] SMTP client OFFSet the SMTP valid and perform the job again.
[1C71] SMTP authentication ERRORCheck that SMTP authentication method, login name and password are correct, then perform authenti-cation again.
[1C72] POP Before SMTP ERRORCheck that both the POP Before SMTP setting and POP3 setting are correct, then perform authentica-tion again.
[1C80] Internet FAX transmission failure when processing E-mail job receivedReset the "Received InternetFax Forward".
[1C81] Onramp Gateway transmission failureReset the mail box.
[1C82] Internet FAX transmission failure when processing FAX job receivedReset the "Received Fax Forward".
[1CC1] Power failureCheck if the power cable is connected properly and it is inserted securely.Check if the power voltage is unstable.
07/11
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cTROUBLESHOOTING
5 - 103
5
[ 2 ] RFC related error[2500] HOST NAME error (RFC: 500) / Destination mail address error (RFC: 500) / Terminal mail address error (RFC: 500)[2501] HOST NAME error (RFC: 501) / Destination mail address error (RFC: 501) / Terminal mail address error (RFC: 501) Check if the Terminal mail address and Destination mail address are correct.Check if the mail server is operating properly.Turn the power OFF and then back ON. Perform the job in error again.
[2503] Destination mail address error (RFC: 503)[2504] HOST NAME error (RFC: 504)[2551] Destination mail address error (RFC: 551)Check if the mail server is operating properly.Turn the power OFF and then back ON. Perform the job in error again.If the error still occurs, replace the SYS board.
[2550] Destination mail address error (RFC: 550)Check the state of the mail box in the mail server.
[2552] Terminal/Destination mail address error (RFC: 552)Check the capacity of the mail box in the mail server. Select “Text “of the original modes for the original data or lower the resolution level and then retransmit. Or divide the original data into several pieces and retransmit them.
[2553] Destination mail address error (RFC: 553)Check if there is an illegal character in the mail box in the mail server.
07/11
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedTROUBLESHOOTING
5 - 104
[ 3 ] Electronic Filing related error[2B10] No applicable job error in Job control module[2B11] JOB status abnormality[2B20] File library function error[2B30] Insufficient disk space in BOX partition[2BC0] Fatal failure occurred[2BC1] System management module resource acquiring failureErase some data in the Electronic Filing and perform the job in error again (in case of [2B30]).Turn the power OFF and then back ON. Perform the job in error again.Check if there are no other running jobs and perform the HDD formatting (08-690).If the recovery is still not completed, replace the SYS board.
[2B21] Exceeding file capacityReset and extend the "Maximum send to E-mail/iFAX size" or reduce the number of pages and perform the job again.
[2B50] Image library error[2B90] Insufficient memory capacityTurn the power OFF and then back ON. Perform the job in error again.If the error still occurs, replace the main memory.Perform the job in error again.Check if there are no other running jobs and initialize the Electronic Filing using the Setting Mode (08-666).
[2B31] Status of specified Electronic Filing or folder is undefined or being created/deletedCheck if the specified Electronic Filing or folder exists. (If no, this error would not occur.)Delete the specified Electronic Filing or folder.Perform the job in error again.If the specified Electronic Filing or folder can not be deleted, initialize the Electronic Filing using the Set-ting Mode (08-666).
[2B32] Electronic Filing printing failure: Specified document can not be printed because of cli-ent's access (being edited, etc.)Check if the specified document exists. (If no, this error would not occur.)Delete the specified document.Perform the job in error again.If the specified document can not be deleted, initialize the Electronic Filing using the Setting Mode (08-666).
[2B51] List library errorCheck if the Function List can be printed out.If it can be printed out, perform the job in error again.If it can not be printed out, replace the main memory.If the recovery is still not completed, perform the HDD formatting (08-690).
[2BA0] Invalid Box passwordCheck if the password is correct.Reset the password.When this error occurs when printing the data in the Electronic Filing, perform the printing with the administrator's password.If the recovery is still not completed or in case of invalid password for the operation other than printing (opening the file, etc.), initialize the Electronic Filing using the Setting Mode (08-666).
07/11
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cTROUBLESHOOTING
5 - 105
5
[2BA1] A paper size or a color mode not supported in the Electronic Filing function is being selectedCheck the paper size or color mode.
[2BB1] Power failure[2BD0] Power failure occurred during restoring of Electronic FilingCheck if the power cable is connected properly and it is inserted securely.Check if the power voltage is unstable.
[2BE0] Machine parameter reading errorTurn the power OFF and then back ON. Perform the job in error again.
[2BF0] Exceeding maximum number of pagesReduce the number of inserting pages and perform the job again.
[2BF1] Exceeding maximum number of documentsBackup the documents in the box or folder to PC or delete them.
[2BF2] Exceeding maximum number of foldersBackup the folders in the box or folder to PC or delete them.
07/11
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedTROUBLESHOOTING
5 - 106
[ 4 ] E-mail related error[2C10] System access abnormality[2C32] File deletion failureTurn the power OFF and then back ON. Perform the job in error again.If the error still occurs, first, check if there are no jobs existing and then perform the HDD formatting (08-690).
[2C11] Insufficient memoryWhen there are running jobs, perform the job in error again after the completion of the running jobs.If the error still occurs, turn the power OFF and then back ON, and perform the job again.
[2C12] Message reception error[2C13] Message transmission errorTurn the power OFF and then back ON. Perform the job in error again.
[2C14] Invalid parameterWhen a template is used, form the template again.If the error still occurs, turn the power OFF and then back ON, and perform the job again.
[2C15] Exceeding file capacityReset and extend the "Maximum send to E-mail/iFAX size" or reduce the number of pages and perform the job again.
[2C20] System management module access abnormality[2C21] Job control module access abnormality[2C22] Job control module access abnormalityTurn the power OFF and then back ON. Perform the job in error again.Check if there are no other running jobs and perform the HDD formatting (08-690).If the recovery is still not completed, replace the SYS board.
[2C30] Directory creation failure[2C31] File creation failure[2C33] File access failureCheck if the access privilege to the storage directory is writable.Check if the server or local disk has a sufficient space in disk capacity.
[2C40] Image conversion abnormality[2C62] Memory acquiring failureTurn the power OFF and then back ON. Perform the job in error again.Replace the main memory and perform the job again.
[2C43] Encryption errorTurn the power OFF and then back ON. Perform the job in error again.
[2C44] Encryption PDF enforced mode errorReset the encryption and perform the job in error again.If an image file not encrypted is created, consult your administrators.
[2C60] HDD full failure during processingReduce the number of pages of the job in error and perform the job again.Check if the server or local disk has a sufficient space in disk capacity.
07/11
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cTROUBLESHOOTING
5 - 107
5
[2C61] Address Book reading failureTurn the power OFF and then back ON. Perform the job in error again.Reset the data in the Address Book and perform the job again.
[2C63] Terminal IP address unsetReset the Terminal IP address.Turn the power OFF and then back ON. Perform the job in error again.
[2C64] Terminal mail address unsetReset the Terminal mail address.Turn the power OFF and then back ON. Perform the job in error again.
[2C65] SMTP address unsetReset the SMTP address and perform the job.Turn the power OFF and then back ON. Perform the job in error again.
[2C66] Server time-out errorCheck if the SMTP server is operating properly.
[2C67] NIC time-out error[2C68] NIC access error[2C6D] NIC system errorTurn the power OFF and then back ON. Perform the job in error again.If the error still occurs, replace the SYS board.
[2C69] SMTP server connection errorReset the login name and password of SMTP server and perform the job again.Check if the SMTP server is operating properly.
[2C6A] HOST NAME error (No RFC error)Check if there is an illegal character in the device name.Delete the illegal character and reset the appropriate device name.
[2C6B] Terminal mail address errorCheck if there is an illegal character in the Terminal mail address.Delete the illegal character and reset the appropriate Terminal mail address, then perform the job again.
[2C6C] Destination mail address error (No RFC error)Check if there is an illegal character in the Destination mail address.Delete the illegal character and reset the appropriate Destination mail address, then perform the job again.
[2C70] SMTP client OFFSet the SMTP valid and perform the job again.
[2C71] SMTP authentication ERRORCheck that SMTP authentication method, login name and password are correct, then perform authenti-cation again.
[2C72] POP Before SMTP ERRORCheck that both the POP Before SMTP setting and POP3 setting are correct, then perform authentica-tion again.
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedTROUBLESHOOTING
5 - 108
[2C80] E-mail transmission failure when processing E-mail job receivedReset the "Received InternetFax Forward".
[2C81] Process failure of FAX job receivedReset the setting of the mail box or "Received InternetFax Forward".
[2CC1] Power failureCheck if the power cable is connected properly and it is inserted securely.Check if the power voltage is unstable.
07/11
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cTROUBLESHOOTING
5 - 109
5
[ 5 ] File sharing related error[2D10] System access abnormality[2D32] File deletion failure[2DA6] File deletion failure[2DA7] Resource acquiring failureDelete some files in the shared folder by using Explorer because of automatic/manual file deletion fail-ure (in case of [2DA6])Turn the power OFF and then back ON. Perform the job in error again.If the error still occurs, first, check if there are no jobs existing and then perform the HDD formatting (08-690).
[2D11] Insufficient memoryWhen there are running jobs, perform the job in error again after the completion of the running jobs.If the error still occurs, turn the power OFF and then back ON, and perform the job again.
[2D12] Message reception error[2D13] Message transmission errorTurn the power OFF and then back ON. Perform the job in error again.
[2D14] [2D61] Invalid parameterWhen a template is used, form the template again.If the error still occurs, turn the power OFF and then back ON, and perform the job again.
[2D15] Exceeding document numberDelete some documents in the folder, and then perform the job in error again.
[2D20] System management module access abnormality[2D21] Job control module access abnormality[2D22] Job control module access abnormality[2D60] File library access abnormalityTurn the power OFF and then back ON. Perform the job in error again.Check if there are no other running jobs and perform the HDD formatting (08-690).If the recovery is still not completed, replace the SYS board.
[2D30] Directory creation failure[2D31] File creation failure[2D33] File access failureCheck if the access privilege to the storage directory is writable.Check if the server or local disk has a sufficient space in disk capacity.
[2D40] Image conversion abnormalityTurn the power OFF and then back ON. Perform the job in error again.Replace the main memory and perform the job again.If the error still occurs, first, check if there are no jobs existing and then initialize the shared folder using the Setting Mode (08-667).
[2D43] Encryption errorTurn the power OFF and then back ON. Perform the job in error again.
[2D44] Encryption PDF enforced mode errorReset the encryption and perform the job in error again.If an image file not encrypted is created, consult your administrators.
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedTROUBLESHOOTING
5 - 110
[2D62] File server connection errorCheck the IP address or path of the server.Check if the server is operating properly.
[2D63] Invalid network pathCheck the network path.If the path is correct, turn the power OFF and then back ON, and perform the job again.[2D64] Login failureReset the login name and password. Perform the job.Check if the account of the server is properly set up.
[2D65] Exceeding documents in folder: Creating new document is failedDelete some documents in the folder.
[2D66] HDD full failure during processingReduce the number of pages of the job in error and perform the job again.Check if the server or local disk has a sufficient space in disk capacity.
[2D67] FTP service not availableCheck if the setting of FTP service is valid.
[2D68] File sharing service not availableCheck if the setting of SMB is valid.
[2DC1] Power failureCheck if the power cable is connected properly and it is inserted securely.Check if the power voltage is unstable.
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cTROUBLESHOOTING
5 - 111
5
[ 6 ] E-mail reception related error[3A10] [3A11] [3A12] E-mail MIME errorThe format of the mail is not corresponding to MIME 1.0.Request the sender to retransmit the mail in the format corresponding to MIME 1.0.
[3A20] [3A21] [3A22] E-mail analysis error[3B10] [3B11] [3B12] E-mail format error[3B40] [3B41] [3B42] E-mail decode errorThese errors occur when the mail data is damaged from the transmission to the reception of the mail.Request the sender to retransmit the mail.
[3A30] Partial mail time-out errorThe partial mail is not received in a specified period of time.Request the sender to retransmit the partial mail, or set the time-out period of the partial mail longer.
[3A40] Partial mail related errorThe format of the partial mail is not corresponding to this equipment.Request the sender to remake and retransmit the partial mail in RFC2046 format.
[3A50] [3A51] [3A52] Insufficient HDD capacity error[3A60] [3A61] [3A62] Warning of insufficient HDD capacityThese errors occur when the HDD capacity is not sufficient for a temporary concentration of the jobs, etc.Request the sender to retransmit after a certain period of time, or divide the mail into more than one.Insufficient HDD capacity error also occurs when printing is disabled for no printing paper.In this case, supply the printing paper.
[3A70] Warning of partial mail interruptionThis error occurs when the partial mail reception setting becomes OFF during the partial mail reception.Reset the partial mail reception setting ON and then request the sender to retransmit the mail.
[3A80] [3A81] [3A82] Partial mail reception setting OFFReset the partial mail reception setting ON and then request the sender to retransmit the mail.
[3B20] [3B21] [3B22] Content-Type errorThe format of the attached file is not supported by this equipment (TIFF-FX).Request the sender to retransmit the file in TIFF-FX.
[3B30] [3B31] [3B32] Charset errorThese errors occur when the standard of the Charset is other than ISO-8559-1 or ISO-8559-2.Request the sender to reformat the Charset into either of the standards described above and then retransmit the mail.
[3C10] [3C11] [3C12] [3C13] TIFF analysis errorThese errors occur when the mail data is damaged from the transmission to the reception of the mail, or when the format of the attached file is not supported by this equipment (TIFF-FX).Request the sender to retransmit the mail.
[3C20] [3C21] [3C22] TIFF compression errorThe compression method of the TIFF file is not acceptable for this equipment. (Acceptable: MH/MR/MMR/JBIG)Request the sender to retransmit the file in the acceptable compression method.
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedTROUBLESHOOTING
5 - 112
[3C30] [3C31] [3C32] TIFF resolution errorThe resolution of the TIFF file is not acceptable for this equipment. (Acceptable: 200 x 100, 200 x 200, 200 x 400, 400 x 400, 300 x 300 or equivalent)Request the sender to retransmit the file in the acceptable resolution.
[3C40] [3C41] [3C42] TIFF paper size errorThe paper size of the TIFF file is not acceptable for this equipment. (Acceptable: A4, B4, A3, B5, LT, LG, LD or ST)Request the sender to retransmit the file in the acceptable paper size.
[3C50] [3C51] [3C52] Offramp destination errorThese errors occur when the FAX number of the offramp destination is incorrect.Request the sender to correct the FAX number of offramp destination and then retransmit the mail.
[3C60] [3C61] [3C62] Offramp security errorThese errors occur when the FAX number of the offramp destination is not on the Address Book.Check if the FAX number of the offramp destination is correctly entered or the number has not been changed.
[3C70] Power failure errorCheck if the mail is recovered after turning ON the power again.Request the sender to retransmit the mail if it is not recovered.
[3D10] Destination address errorCheck if the setting of the server or DNS is correct. Correct if any of the setting is incorrect.When the content of the setting is correct, confirm the sender if the destination is correct.
[3D20] Offramp destination limitation errorInform the sender that the transfer of the FAX data over 40 is not supported.
[3D30] FAX board errorThis error occurs when the FAX board is not installed or the FAX board has an abnormality.Check if the FAX board is correctly connected.[3E10] POP3 server connection errorCheck if the IP address or domain name of the POP3 server set for this equipment is correct, or check if POP3 server to be connected is operating properly.
[3E20] POP3 server connection time-out errorCheck if POP3 server to be connected is operating properly.Check if the LAN cable is correctly connected.
[3E30] POP3 login errorCheck if the POP3 server login name and password set for this equipment are correct.
[3E40] POP3 Login Type ERRORCheck that the login type (Auto, POP3 or APOP) to the POP3 server is correct.[3F00] [3F10] [3F20] [3F30] [3F40] File I/O errorThese errors occur when the mail data is not transferred properly to the HDD.Request the sender to retransmit the mail.Replace the HDD if the error still occurs after retransmission.
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cTROUBLESHOOTING
5 - 113
5
[402F] Page memory size errorThis error occurs when the expansion memory is not installed or the expansion memory has an abnor-mality.Check if the expansion memory exists or not, or it is correctly installed.
[4031] HDD full failure during printingReduce the number of pages of the job in error and perform the job again.Check if the server or local disk has a sufficient space in disk capacity.
[4032] Private-print-only errorSelect "Private", and then perform the printing again.
[4033] Printing data storing limitation errorSelect "Print", and then perform the printing again.
[4034] e-Filing storing limitation errorSelect "Print", and then perform the printing again.
[4035] Local file storing limitation errorSelect "Remote" (SMB/FTP) for the destination of the file to save.
[4036] User authentication errorPerform the authentication or register as a user, and then perform the printing again.
[A221] Print job cancellationThis message appears when deleting the job on the screen.
[A222] Print job power failureWhen there are running jobs, perform the job in error again after the completion of the running jobs.If the error still occurs, turn the power OFF and then back ON, and perform the job again.
[A290] Limit over error (black)[A291] Limit over error (black)[A292] Limit over error (black)Clear the limit counter (black).
[A2A0] Limit over error (color)[A2A1] Limit over error (color)[A2A2] Limit over error (color)Clear the limit counter (color).
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedTROUBLESHOOTING
5 - 114
5.2 Troubleshooting for the Image1) Color deviation<Symptoms>
Original mode Location Phenomena
All modes Color blurred in outline of white text or illustration on a colored background
Color deviation
Fig. 5-1
Text ModeText/Photo Mode
Outline in black text on a colored background
White void
Photo ModeMap Mode
Color blurred in outline of line or text Color deviation
Cause/Section Step Check Item Measure Remark1 Test printing (A3/LD) Output the built-in grid pattern For the fol-
lowing checks
Drum rotation abnormality
2 Check the main motor operation in the test mode (03) to see if there is any rotation abnormality of the drum.
Replace the main motor.
3 Check the main motor operation in the test mode (03) to see if there is any rotation abnormality of the drum.
Reconnect the connectors.Replace the harnesses. Replace the LGC board.
Inadequate main motor rotation speed
4 Check the value set for main motor rotation speed. (Is the value signifi-cantly different from the default value?)
Reset main motor speed to 128.
Drum coupling and coupling on the equip-ment side
5 Loose coupling, damage, deforma-tion
Check if they are installed prop-erly or replace the couplings.
Transfer belt 6 Deformation or damage of the trans-fer belt or stains on the transfer belt.
Clean or replace the transfer belt.
7 Is there any abnormality of the trans-fer belt home position sensor?
Clean or replace the sensor.
8 The reflection tape is stained or dam-aged.
Clean or replace the transfer belt.
9 Are the couplings on the transfer belt side loosen, damaged or deformed?
Tighten the screws if they loosen, or replace the couplings.
10 Stain or damage of the drive roller Clean or replace the drive roller.11 Does the rib of the transfer belt over-
lap the collar on both edge of the drive roller?
Adjust the position of the transfer belt.
12 Is the belt edge damaged or stained? Clean or replace the transfer belt.13 Peeling of the cleaning blade
(Large driving load)Replace the cleaning blade.
14 Is the transfer belt unit installed nor-mally?(Is the unit properly grounded?)
Check and correct the installing.
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cTROUBLESHOOTING
5 - 115
5
* If the desired image has not been obtained with the above measures or the more qualified image is needed, adjustment the "deviation amount" in the adjustment mode (05). (Refer to 3.5.2 Color devi-ation adjustment)
Laser optical unit
15 Check the grid pattern. Are the lines of the primary scanning direction warped?
Replace the laser optical unit. Fθ lens characteris-tic defect or reflection mirror warp
High-voltage transformer
16 Check the connection of the high-voltage supply terminal of the 1st or 2nd transfer rollers.
Correct or replace the terminal if it is loosened or damaged.
Cause/Section Step Check Item Measure Remark
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedTROUBLESHOOTING
5 - 116
2) Uneven pitch and jitter image<Symptoms>
Original mode Location Phenomena
All modes Occurs cyclically at right angles to paper feeding direction
Uneven pitch
Fig. 5-2
Cause/Section Step Check Item Measure Remark
1 Test printing (A3/LD) Output the built-in halftone and grid patterns.
For the following checks
Drum 2 Are there uneven pitches approx. 283 mm?
Replace the main motor.
3 Is there any damage on the drum surface?
Clean or replace the drum.
Drum rotation abnormality
4 Check the main motor operation in the test mode (03) to see if there is any rotation abnormality of the drum.
Replace the main motor.
5 Check the main motor operation in the test mode (03) to see if there is any rotation abnormality of the drum.
Reconnect the connec-tors.Replace the harnesses. Replace the LGC board.
Inadequate main motor rotation speed
6 Check the value set for main motor rotation speed. (Is the value signifi-cantly different from the default value?)
Reset main motor speed to 128.
Drum coupling 7 Loose coupling, damage, deforma-tion
Tighten the screws if they loosen. Or replace the couplings.
Transfer belt 8 Is the belt tension of the driving unit normal?
Adjust the tension of the transfer belt.
Check the halftone pattern.(Uneven pitch: approx. 2.5 mm)
9 Deformation or damage of the trans-fer belt
Replace the transfer belt. Check the halftone pattern. (Uneven pitch: approx. 75 mm)
10 Stain or damage of the drive roller Clean or replace the drive roller.
Check the halftone pattern.(Uneven pitch: approx. 75 mm)
11 Large driving load due to the peeling of the cleaning blade
Replace the cleaning blade.
Laser optical unit
12 Check the halftone pattern to see if there are uneven pitches of approx. 0.3 mm each in the whole image.
Replace the laser optical unit.
Check the halftone pattern.(Uneven pitch: approx. 0.3 mm)
Feeding
direction
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cTROUBLESHOOTING
5 - 117
5
3) Poor image density, color reproduction and gray balance
Fig. 5-3
Cause/Section Step Check items Measures Remarks
Density / Colorreproduction / Gray balance
1 Check the image density / colorreproduction / gray balance.
Perform the enforced performing of image quality closed-loop control (05-395) and then automatic gamma adjustment.
Printer density 2 Check the density of printer output image.
Output the test patterns and check them.Color: using 04-231 for each colorBlack: using 04-113
See step 5 if defect occurs.
Scanner 3 Check if the original glass, mirrors or lens is dirty.
Clean it.
Parameter adjustment value
4 Check the image processing parameters.
Adjust the color balance (color).Adjust the image density.
Printer output image abnormal
5 Is there any faded image (low den-sity)?
Perform the troubleshooting proce-dures against the faded image.
Is there any fog in the background? Perform the troubleshooting proce-dures against the background fog-ging.
Is there any blotch image? Perform the troubleshooting proce-dures against the blotch image.
Is there any poor transfer? Perform the troubleshooting proce-dures against the poor transfer.
Is there any poor cleaning of the transfer belt? (Check inside the equipment.)
Correct the transfer belt area.(Refer to Service Manual)
Check color reproduction. Check color reproduction.
Check image density.Check gray balance.
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedTROUBLESHOOTING
5 - 118
4) Background fogging
Fig. 5-4
Cause/Section Step Check items Measures Remarks
Density repro-duction
1 Check the gradation reproduction. Perform the forced performing of image quality closed-loop control (05-395) and then automatic gamma adjustment.
Printer section 2 Check the printer output image. Output the test patterns and check them.Color: using 04-231 for each colorBlack: using 04-113
See step 6 if defects occur.
Scanner 3 Check if the original glass, mirrors or lens is dirty.
Clean it.
Parameter adjustment value
4 Check the image processing parameters.
Check the value of offsetting adjustment for background pro-cessing (color), background adjust-ment (black) and background peak adjustment for range correction (black).
5 Adjust the image processing parameters.
While checking the above encircled image, adjust the reproduction level by the offsetting adjustment for background processing (color), background adjustment (black) and background peak adjustment for range correction (black).
Cover 6 Is the cover installed properly? (Is the drum exposed to the exter-nal light?)
Correct it.
Auto-toner 7 Is the auto-toner sensor normal? Check the operation of autotoner sensor and readjust.
8 Is the toner supply operating con-stantly?
Check the motor and circuits.
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cTROUBLESHOOTING
5 - 119
5* If the trouble is not solved at the step 1 and the step 2 or followings (excluding the parameter adjust-
ment) are performed, make sure to perform “Enforced performing of image quality closed-loop con-trol” and then “Automatic gamma adjustment” after taking a measure.
Main charger output
9 Is the main charger output normal? Check the circuits.
Developer bias 10 Is the developer bias proper? Check the circuits.
Developer unit 11 Is the contact between the drum and developer material proper?
Check the doctor-to-sleeve gap and pole position.
Developer mate-rial/Toner/Drum
12 Using the specified developer material, toner and drum?
Use the specified developer mate-rial, toner and drum.
13 Have the developer material and drum reached their PM life?
Replace the developer material and drum.
14 Is the storage environment of the toner cartridge 35oC or less without dew?
Use the toner cartridge stored in the environment within specifica-tion.
Drum cleaning blade
15 Is the drum cleaned properly? Check the drum cleaning blade pressure.
Transfer belt cleaning blade
16 Is the transfer belt cleaning blade contacted and released properly?
Check if the spring of the transfer belt cleaner clutch is removed or if any connector is disconnected.Otherwise replace the clutch.
17 Is the transfer belt cleaning blade in proper contact with the transfer belt?
Check if the blade pressure spring is installed.
Toner dusting 18 Is the toner accumulated on the seals of the developer unit?
Remove the toner and clean the seals.
Cause/Section Step Check items Measures Remarks
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedTROUBLESHOOTING
5 - 120
5) Moire/lack of sharpness
Fig. 5-5
Moire
Lack of sharpness
* If the trouble is not solved at the step 1 and the step 2 or followings (excluding the parameter adjust-ment) are performed, make sure to perform “Enforced performing of image quality closed-loop con-trol” and then “Automatic gamma adjustment” after taking a measure.
Cause/Section Step Check items Measures RemarksDensity repro-duction
1 Check the gradation reproduction.
Perform the forced performing of image quality closed-loop control (05-395) and then automatic gamma adjustment.
Parameter adjustment value
2 Check the image process-ing parameters.
Check the sharpness adjustment value.
3 Adjust the image process-ing parameters.
While checking the above encir-cled images A and B, decrease moire by sharpness adjustment.
Printer section 4 Check the printer output image.
Output the test patterns and check them.Color: using 04-231 for each colorBlack: using 04-113
When defects occur, perform the corre-sponding trouble-shooting procedures.
Cause/Section Step Check items Measures RemarksDensity repro-duction
1 Check the gradation reproduction.
Perform the forced performing of image quality closed-loop control (05-395) and then automatic gamma adjustment.
Parameter adjustment value
2 Check the image process-ing parameters.
Check the sharpness adjustment value.
3 Adjust the image process-ing parameters.
While checking the above encir-cled image A, increase sharpness by sharpness adjustment.
A
B
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cTROUBLESHOOTING
5 - 121
5
6)Toner offset
Fig. 5-6
Toner offset (Shadow image appears approx. 173 mm behind the high density image.)Cause/Section Step Check items Measures Remarks
Fuser unit 1 Is the pressure between the fuser belt and pressure roller proper?
Check the pressure removal parts and pressure mechanism.
2 Is the thermostat in contact? Establish its contact.3 Is there scratch on the fuser belt
or pressure roller surface?Replace the fuser belt or the pressure roller.
4 Has the fuser belt or pressure roller reached its PM life?
Replace the fuser belt or the pressure roller.
5 Is the fuser roller temperature proper?
Check and correct the control cir-cuit.
Paper 6 Is the paper type corresponding to its mode?
Use the proper type of paper or select the proper mode.
7 Using recommended paper? Use the recommended paper.Developer mate-rial
8 Is the specified developer used? Use the specified developer and toner.
Scanner 9 Are the mirrors, original glass or lens dirty?
Clean them.
Image quality control
10 Is the control activated? Check the image quality control related codes.
Density 11 Is the density too high? Perform the forced performing of image quality closed-loop control (05-395) and then automatic gamma adjustment.
Printer density 12 Check the density of printer out-put image.
Output the test patterns and check them.Color: using 04-231 for each colorBlack: using 04-113
When defects occur, perform the correspond-ing trouble-shooting procedures.
Fee
ding
dire
ctio
n
Approx.173 mm
Shadow image
Black solid
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedTROUBLESHOOTING
5 - 122
7) Blurred image
Fig. 5-7
Toner offset (Shadow image appears approx. 173 mm behind the high density image.)Cause/Section Step Check items Measures
Scanner 1 Is the scanner bedewed? Clean it.
Drum 2 Is the drum bedewed or dirty? Wipe the drum with dry cloth.* Be sure never use alcohol or other
organic solvents because they have bad effect on the drum.
Ozone exhaust 3 Is the ozone exhaust fan operating prop-erly?
Check the connection of the connector.
4 Is the ozone filter stained or damaged? Replace it.
Fe
ed
ing
dire
ctio
n
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cTROUBLESHOOTING
5 - 123
5
8) Poor fusing
Fig. 5-8
Toner offset (Shadow image appears approx. 173 mm behind the high density image.)Cause/Section Step Check items Measures
IH electric power/control abnormal
1 Check if the connector contacts properly. Correct it.
2 Is the IH coil shorted or broken?Is the IH control board normal?
Replace the IH coil or IH control board.
3 Are the connectors on the LGC board and joint connectors connected properly?
Reconnect them.
4 Is the LGC board normal? Replace the LGC board.
5 Is the harness between the LGC board and IH board short circuited or open cir-cuited?
Replace the harness.
Pressure between fuser belt and pres-sure roller improper
6 Are the pressure springs working prop-erly?
Check/adjust the pressure springs.
Fuser roller tem-perature
7 Is the temperature of fuser roller too low? Check/correct the setting value of fuser roller temperature.Clean or replace the thermistors.Check/correct the related circuit.
Developer mate-rial and toner
8 Using the specified developer material and toner?
Use the specified developer material and toner.
Paper 9 Is the paper damp? Change the paper.
10 Is the paper type corresponding to its mode?
Use the proper type of paper or select the proper mode.
11 Using the recommended paper? Use the recommended paper.
Fe
ed
ing
dire
ctio
n
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedTROUBLESHOOTING
5 - 124
9) Blank print
Fig. 5-9
Cause/Section Step Check items Measures
High-voltage transformer (1st/2nd transfer roller and devel-oper bias)
1 Is the high-voltage transformer output defective?
Adjust the output and correct the circuit, or replace the transformer.
2 Are the connector of the high-voltage har-ness securely connected? Is the harness open circuited?
Reconnect the harness securely.Replace the high-voltage harness.
Developer unit 3 Is the developer unit installed securely? Check/correct the developer sleeve cou-pling engaging.
4 Do the developer sleeve and mixer rotate?
Check/correct the developer drive sys-tem.
5 Is the developer material properly trans-ported?
Remove foreign matter from the devel-oper material, if any.
6 Is there any magnetic brush phase error? Check the developer pole position.
7 Is the doctor sleeve gap incorrect? Adjust the gap with the doctor-sleeve jig.
Drum 8 Is the drum rotating? Check that the drum shaft is inserted. Check the drum drive system.
9 Is the drum grounded? Check the contact of the grounding plate.
Transfer unit 10 Is the transfer belt in proper contact with the drum?
Check if the contact releasing lever is at releasing position. Check the installation of the transfer belt.
11 Is the transport of the transfer belt nor-mal?
Check the installation of the transfer belt or transport mechanism.
12 Is the releasing movement of the transfer belt cleaner is normal? (Does the cleaning blade stay in contact?)
Check the installation of the transfer belt cleaning blade. Check the operation of the transfer belt cleaner clutch.
13 Is the 2nd transfer roller contacted and released properly?
Check the connection of the connector of 2nd transfer roller contact clutch and open circuit of harness.
Fe
ed
ing
dire
ctio
n
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cTROUBLESHOOTING
5 - 125
5
Switching power supply
14 Is the power supply output (5.1VD) nor-mal?
Replace the switching power supply.
Harnesses for SLG, SYS, LGC and LDR boards
15 Are the connectors securely connected? Is any harness between the boards open circuited?
Reconnect the connectors securely.Replace the harness.
Laser optical unit 16 Was the protection seal of slit removed when replacing the unit?
Remove the protection seal.
Cause/Section Step Check items Measures
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedTROUBLESHOOTING
5 - 126
10)Solid print
Fig. 5-10
Cause/Section Step Check items Measures
Exposure lamp Inverter
1 Does the exposure lamp light? Check the contact of the inverter connec-tor.If the inverter does not work, replace it. If the lamp does not work, replace it.
Main charger 2 Is the main charger securely installed? Reinstall it securely.
3 Is the main charger wire open circuited? Replace it.
High-voltage transformer (main charger wire/grid bias)
4 Is the high-voltage transformer output defective?
Adjust the output and correct the circuit, or replace the high-voltage transformer.
5 Are the connector of the high-voltage har-ness securely connected? Is the harness open circuited?
Reconnect the harness securely.Replace the high-voltage harness.
Harnesses for SLG, SYS and LGC boards
6 Are the connectors securely connected? Is any harness between the boards open circuited?
Reconnect the connectors securely.Replace the harness.
Scanner 7 Is there foreign matter in the optical path? Remove it.
Bedewing of scanner and drum
8 Is the scanner or the drum bedewed? Clean the mirrors, lens and drum.Keep the power cord plugged so that the damp heater can work.
Fe
ed
ing
dire
ctio
n
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cTROUBLESHOOTING
5 - 127
5
11)White banding (in feeding direction)
Fig. 5-11
Cause/Section Step Check items MeasuresLaser optical unit 1 Is there foreign matter or dust on the slit
glass?Clean the slit glass.
Main charger grid
2 Is there foreign matter on the charger grid?
Remove foreign matter.
Developer unit 3 Is there foreign matter inside the doctor blade?
Remove foreign matter.
4 Is there foreign matter on the drum seal? Remove foreign matter.5 Is the drum seal of developer unit in
proper contact with the drum?Modify the position of drum seal or replace it.
Drum 6 Is there scratch or foreign matter on the drum surface?
Replace the drum.
Transfer unit 7 Is there scratch or foreign matter on the transfer belt surface?
Replace the transfer belt.
8 Are the harness or foreign matters in con-tact with the transfer belt surface?
Correct or remove them.
9 Is the transfer belt cleaning blade con-tacted and released properly?
Check if the spring of the transfer belt cleaner clutch is removed or if any con-nector is disconnected. Otherwise replace the clutch.
10 Is the transfer belt cleaning blade in proper contact with the transfer belt?
Check if the blade pressure spring is installed.
11 Is there any scratch or hole on the 1st/2nd transfer roller?
Replace the 1st/2nd transfer roller.
Transport path 12 Does the toner image touch foreign mat-ter after transfer, before entering the fuser unit?
Remove foreign matter.
Discharge lamp 13 Has any LED of discharge lamp gone out?
Replace the discharge lamp.
Scanner 14 Is there foreign matter or dust in the opti-cal path?
Clean the lens and mirrors.
Fe
ed
ing
dire
ctio
n
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedTROUBLESHOOTING
5 - 128
12)White banding (at right angles to feeding direction)
Fig. 5-12
Cause/Section Step Check items Measures
Main charger 1 Is there foreign matter on the charger? Remove foreign matter.
2 Is the terminal contact poor? Clean or adjust the terminals.
Drum 3 Is there any abnormalities on the drum surface?
Replace the drum.
4 Is the drum grounded? Check the contact of the grounding plate.
Discharge lamp 5 Is the discharge lamp lighting properly? Replace the discharge lamp or clean ter-minals.
Developer unit 6 Is the developer sleeve rotating correctly?Is there any abnormalities on the sleeve surface?
Check the developer drive system, or clean the sleeve surface.
7 Is the connection of developer bias supply terminal normal?
Correct it.
Drive systems 8 Is the drum, scanner or transfer belt jit-tery?
Check each drive system.
High-voltage transformer (main charger wire/grid, 1st/2nd transfer roller and devel-oper bias)
9 Is the high-voltage transformer output defective?
Check/correct any electric leakage and related circuits.If the high-voltage transformer does not work, replace it.
Fe
ed
ing
dire
ctio
n
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cTROUBLESHOOTING
5 - 129
5
13)Skew (slantwise copying)
Fig. 5-13
Cause/Section Step Check items Measures
Drawer/LCF 1 Is the drawer or LCF properly installed? Reinstall the drawer or LCF properly.
2 Is too much paper loaded in the drawer or LCF?
Reduce paper to 550 sheets or less.(2500 sheets or less/stack for LCF)
3 Is the paper corner folded? Change the paper direction and reinsert it.
4 Are the drawer or LCF side guides prop-erly set?
Adjust the side guides.
Paper feed roller 5 Is the surface of paper feed roller dirty? Clean the roller surface with alcohol, or replace the roller.
Rollers 6 Is each roller improperly fixed to the shaft?
Check and reinstall E-rings, pins, clips and setscrews.
Aligning amount 7 Is the aligning amount proper? Increase the aligning amount.
Registration roller
8 Is the registration roller spring removed? Mount the spring correctly. Clean the roller if it is dirty.
Pre-registration guide
9 Is the pre-registration guide improperly installed?
Correct it.
2nd transfer front guide
10 Is the 2nd transfer front guide installed properly?
Correct it.
RADF 11 Is the RADF installed and adjusted prop-erly?
Reinstall and readjust it.
Fe
ed
ing
dire
ctio
n
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedTROUBLESHOOTING
5 - 130
14)Color banding (in feeding direction)
Fig. 5-14
Cause/Section Step Check items MeasuresScanner 1 Is there foreign matter in the optical path? Clean the slit, lens and mirrors.
2 Is there dust or stain on the shading cor-rection plate or ADF original glass?
Clean it.
Main charger 3 Is there foreign matter on the charger grid?
Remove foreign matter.
4 Is the charger grid dirty or deformed? Clean or replace the charger grid.5 Is there foreign matter on the main
charger?Remove foreign matter.
6 Is the charger wire dirty or deformed? Clean or replace the charger wire.7 Is there foreign matter inside the charger
case?Remove foreign matter.
8 Is the inner surface of charger case dirty? Clean inside.9 Are the pads of charger wire cleaner stop-
ping at the position other than their home position?
Correct the position.
Cleaner 10 Is there paper dust on the cleaning blade edge?
Clean or replace the paper dust removal brush for the registration roller.Clean or replace the cleaning blade.
11 Is the cleaning blade contact improper? Correct it.12 Is toner recovery defective? Clean the toner recovery auger section.
Transfer unit 13 Are the harness or foreign matters in con-tact with the transfer belt surface?
Correct or remove them.
14 Is there paper dust on the edge of transfer belt cleaning blade?
Clean or replace it.
15 Is the transfer belt cleaning blade con-tacted and released properly?
Check if the spring of the transfer belt cleaner clutch is removed or if any con-nector is disconnected. Otherwise replace the clutch.
16 Is the transfer belt cleaning blade in proper contact with the transfer belt?
Check if the blade pressure spring is installed.
Fe
ed
ing
dire
ctio
n
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cTROUBLESHOOTING
5 - 131
5
Fuser unit 17 a. Is there dirt or scratches on the fuser belt and pressure roller surface?
b. Is the thermistor dirty?
a. Clean or replace them.b. Clean the thermistor.
Drum 18 Are there scratches on the drum surface? Replace the drum.Laser optical unit 19 Is there foreign matter or dust on the slit
glass?Remove foreign matter or dust.
Cause/Section Step Check items Measures
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedTROUBLESHOOTING
5 - 132
15)Color banding (at right angles to feeding direction)
Fig. 5-15
Cause/Section Step Check items Measures
Main charger 1 Is the charger wire dirty or deformed? Clean or replace the charger wire.
Fuser unit 2 Is the fuser belt, pressure roller or oil roller dirty?
Clean them.
High-voltage transformer (main charger wire/grid and transfer roller bias)
3 Is the high-voltage transformer output defective?
Check the circuit and replace the highvolt-age transformer if not working.
4 Is each joint of high-voltage output loos-ened? (Check if any electric leakage is causing noise.)
Reconnect each joint.
Drum 5 Is there deep scratch on the drum sur-face?
Replace the drum, especially if the scratch has reached the aluminum base.
6 Are there fine scratches on the drum sur-face (drum pitting)?
Check and correct the contact of cleaning blade and recovery blade.
7 Is the drum grounded? Check the contact of the grounding plate.
2nd transfer roller
8 Is the 2nd transfer roller rotating nor-mally?
Clean the roller area or replace the roller.
Scanner 9 Is there foreign matter on the carriage rail?
Remove foreign matter.
Fe
ed
ing
dire
ctio
n
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cTROUBLESHOOTING
5 - 133
5
16)White spots
Fig. 5-16
Cause/Section Step Check items MeasuresDeveloper unit/Toner cartridge
1 Is the toner density of developer material proper?
Check and correct the auto-toner sensor and toner supply operation.Check if the amount of toner is sufficient in the toner cartridge.
2 Is the doctor-sleeve gap proper? Adjust the gap.Developer mate-rial/Toner/Drum
3 Using the specified developer material, toner and drum?
Use the specified developer material, toner and drum.
4 Have the developer material and drum reached their PM life?
Replace the developer material and drum.
5 Is the storage environment of the toner cartridge 35oC or less without dew?
Use the toner cartridge stored in the envi-ronment within specification.
6 Is there any dent on the surface of the drum?
Replace the drum.
7 Is there any film forming on the drum? Clean or replace the drum.8 Is the drum bedewed? Wipe the drum surface with a piece of dry
cloth.Transfer unit 9 Is there foreign matter on the transfer belt
surface?Remove foreign matter.
10 Is there foreign matter on the transfer belt drive roller?
Clean the transfer belt unit.
Main charger 11 Is there foreign matter on the charger? Remove it.12 Is the charger wire dirty or deformed? Clean or replace the charger wire.
High-voltage transformer (main charger wire/grid, devel-oper 1st/2nd transfer roller bias)
13 Is the high-voltage transformer output defective?
Adjust the output.
Paper 14 Is the paper type corresponding to its mode?
Use the proper type of paper or select the proper mode.
Fe
ed
ing
dire
ctio
n
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedTROUBLESHOOTING
5 - 134
17)Poor transfer
Fig. 5-17
Cause/Section Step Check items Measures
Transfer unit 1 Is the transfer belt or 1st/2nd transfer roll-ers dirty?
Clean it.
2 Is the transfer belt in proper contact with the drum ?
Correct it.
3 Is the 2nd transfer roller in proper contact with the transfer belt?
Correct it.
4 Is there any deformation or abnormalities on the transfer belt?
Replace the belt.
5 Is the high-voltage fed to the 2nd transfer roller correctly?
If any contact failure occurs in the feeding area (e.g. the conductive bushing and spring come off), correct it.
Paper 6 Is paper in the drawer or LCF curled? Reinsert paper with reverse side up or change paper.
7 Is paper in the drawer or LCF damp? Change paper.* Avoid storing paper in damp place.
Registration roller
8 Is the registration roller malfunctioning? Clean the roller, remount the spring, or replace defective clutch-related parts.
Aligning amount 9 Is the aligning amount proper? Inckease the aligning amount
High-voltage transformer (1st/2nd transfer roller bias)
10 Is the high-voltage transformer output defective?
Check the circuit and adjust the trans-former output.
11 Are the high-voltage harness and termi-nals in proper contact?
Correct them if loosened.
Fe
ed
ing
dire
ctio
n
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cTROUBLESHOOTING
5 - 135
5
18)Uneven image density
Fig. 5-18
Cause/Section Step Check items Measures
Main charger 1 Is the main charger dirty? Clean it or replace the charger wire.
Transfer unit 2 Is the transfer belt or 1st/2nd transfer roll-ers dirty?
Clean the belt.
3 Is the transfer belt in proper contact with the drum?
Correct it.
4 Is 2nd transfer roller in proper contact with the transfer belt? (Is the roller tilted?)
Correct it.
5 Is there any abnormalities or deformation on the transfer belt?
Replace the transfer belt.
Laser optical unit 6 Is there foreign matter or dust on the slit glass?
Clean the slit glass.
Discharge lamp 7 Is the discharge lamp dirty? Clean it.
8 Has any LED of discharge lamp gone out?
Replace it.
Developer unit 9 Is the magnetic brush in proper contact with the drum?
Adjust the doctor-sleeve gap.
10 Is the developer unit pressure mechanism malfunctioning?
Check the mechanism.
11 Is the transport of developer material poor?
Remove foreign matter if any.
Scanner section 12 a. Is the platen cover or RADF open?b. Is the original glass, mirrors, or lens
dirty?
a. Close the platen cover or RADF.b. Clean them.
Fe
ed
ing
dire
ctio
n
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedTROUBLESHOOTING
5 - 136
19)Faded image (low density)
Fig. 5-19
Cause/Section Step Check items Measures
Toner emptyAuto-toner circuit
1 Is the “ADD TONER” symbol blinking? Replace the toner cartridge.
2 Is there enough toner in the cartridge? Check the auto-toner circuit function.
3 Is the toner density of developer material too low?
Toner motor 4 Is the toner motor malfunctioning? Check the motor drive circuit.
Toner cartridge 5 Are there any abnormalities in the toner cartridge?
Replace the toner cartridge.
Developer mate-rial
6 Has the developer material reached its PM life?
Replace developer material.
Developer unit 7 Is the magnetic brush in proper contact with the drum?
Check the developer unit installation.Check the doctor-sleeve gap and pole position.
Main charger 8 Is the main charger dirty? Clean it or replace the charger wire.
Drum 9 Is there film forming on the drum surface? Clean or replace the drum.
10 Has the drum reached its PM life? Replace the drum.
Transfer unit 11 Has the transfer belt, 1st or 2nd transfer roller reached its PM life?
Replace the transfer belt, 1st or 2nd trans-fer roller.
High-voltagetransformer(developer bias)
12 Is the high-voltage transformer output set-tings improper?
Adjust the high-voltage transformer out-put.
13 Are the connector of the high-voltage har-ness securely connected? Is the harness open circuited?
Reconnect the harness securely.Replace the high-voltage harness.
Fe
ed
ing
dire
ctio
n
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cTROUBLESHOOTING
5 - 137
5
20)Image dislocation in feeding direction
Fig. 5-20
Cause/Section Step Check items Measures
Adjustment error of scanner or printer section
1 Is same dislocation on every copy? Adjust the scanner/printer using the Adjustment Mode.
Registration roller 2 Is the registration roller dirty, or is the spring removed?
Clean the roller with alcohol.Reinstall the spring.
3 Is the registration motor malfunctioning? Adjust or replace the gears, etc. if they are not engaged properly.
4 Is the registration roller clutch operating normally? (Is the timing of operation delaying?)
Replace the registration roller clutch.
Paper feed clutch, Transport clutch
5 Are the paper feed clutch and transport clutch malfunctioning?
Check the circuit or the clutch and replace them if necessary.
Aligning amount 6 Is the aligning amount proper? Decrease the aligning amount.
Pre-registration guide
7 Is the pre-registration guide improperly installed?
Reinstall the guide.
Transfer belt 8 Is there any stain or scratch on the reflec-tion tape?
Clean or replace it.
9 Is the lens of the transfer belt home posi-tion sensor stained?
Clean or replace it.
Fe
ed
ing
dire
ctio
n
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedTROUBLESHOOTING
5 - 138
21)Image jittering
Fig. 5-21
Cause/Section Step Check items Measures
- 1 Is the toner image on the drum proper? If proper, perform step 1 to 3; otherwise perform step 4 and after.
Registration roller
2 Is the registration roller rotating normally? Check the registration roller section and its springs.
Transfer unit 3 Is the transfer belt or 2nd transfer roller operating normally?
Check the drive system and replace the transfer belt or 2nd transfer roller if neces-sary.
Fuser unit 4 Are the fuser roller and pressure roller rotation proper?Is the fuser belt transportation proper?
Check the drive system.Replace the fuser belt, fuser roller and pressure roller if necessary.
Drum 5 Is there large scratch on the drum? Replace the drum.
Scanner 6 Is the slide sheet defective? Replace it.
7 Are there any abnormalities on the car-riage feet?
Replace the feet.
8 Is the tension of timing belt inappropriate? Correct the tension.
9 Is the carriage drive system malfunction-ing?
Check the carriage drive system.
10 Are any mirrors loosely installed? Install them properly.
Drum drive sys-tem
11 Is the drum drive system malfunctioning? Check the drum drive system.Clean or replace the belts, pulleys, bush-ings if they have dirt or scratches.
Fe
ed
ing
dire
ctio
n
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cTROUBLESHOOTING
5 - 139
5
22)Poor cleaning
Note: Note: Poor cleaning may occur in feeding direction.
Fig. 5-22
Cause/Section Step Check items Measures
Developer mate-rial
1 Is the specified developer material used? Use the specified developer material and toner.
Cleaner 2 Is there paper dust on the drum cleaning blade edge?
Clean it.
3 Is the drum cleaning blade peeled? Replace the blade.Check and replace the drum.
4 Is the cleaning brush rotating normally? Check the brush driving section. Clean the brush area.
5 Is the cleaning brush damaged? Is there foreign matter on the brush?
Replace the brush and clean the brush area. Check the drum and replace if there is any abnormality.
Transfer belt cleaner
6 Is there paper dust on the edge of transfer belt cleaning blade?
Clean or replace it.
7 Is the transfer belt cleaning blade peeled? Replace the blade.
8 Is the transfer belt cleaning blade con-tacted and released properly?
Check if the spring of the transfer belt cleaner clutch is removed or if any con-nector is disconnected. Otherwise replace the clutch.
9 Is the transfer belt cleaning blade in proper contact with the transfer belt?
Check if the blade pressure spring is installed.
Toner recovery auger
10 Is the toner recovery defective? Clean the toner recovery auger.Check the cleaning blade pressure.
Fe
ed
ing
dire
ctio
n
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedTROUBLESHOOTING
5 - 140
Fuser unit 11 Is the cleaning roller or the oil roller dam-aged? Have the roller reached their PM life?
Replace them.
12 Is there any bubble-like defect on the fuser belt (173 mm pitch on the image)?
Replace the fuser belt. Check and modify the heater control circuit.
13 Have the fuser belt and pressure roller reached their PM life?
Replace them.
14 Is the pressure between the fuser belt and pressure roller proper?
Check and adjust the pressure mecha-nism.
15 Is the temperature of fuser roller proper? Check/correct the setting value of fuser roller temperature.Clean or replace the thermistors.Check and correct the circuit.
Cause/Section Step Check items Measures
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cTROUBLESHOOTING
5 - 141
5
23)Uneven light distribution
Fig. 5-23
Cause/Section Step Check items Measures
Original glass 1 Is the original glass dirty? Clean the glass.
Main charger 2 Are the main charger wire, grid and case dirty?
Clean or replace them.
Discharge lamp 3 Is the discharge lamp dirty? Clean it.
Scanner 4 Are the reflector, exposure lamp, mirrors, lens, etc. dirty?
Clean them.
Exposure lamp 5 Is the exposure lamp tilted? Adjust the installed position of the lamp.
6 Is the lamp discolored or degraded? Replace it.
Fe
ed
ing
dire
ctio
n
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedTROUBLESHOOTING
5 - 142
24)Blotched image
Fig. 5-24
Cause/Section Step Check items Measures
Paper 1 Is the paper type corresponding to its mode?
Check the paper type and mode.
2 Is paper too dry? Change paper.
Transfer unit 3 Is the transfer belt in proper contact with the drum?
Correct it.
4 Is the 2nd transfer roller in proper contact with the transfer belt?
Correct it.
5 Are there any abnormalities on the trans-fer belt?
Clean or replace the transfer belt.
High-voltage transformer (1st/2nd transfer roller bias)
6 Is the high-voltage transformer output abnormal?
Adjust the output. Replace the trans-former, if necessary.
Fe
ed
ing
dire
ctio
n
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cTROUBLESHOOTING
5 - 143
5
25)Stain on the paper back side
Fig. 5-25
The edge of image
cut off.
Fe
ed
ing
dire
ctio
nF
ee
din
g d
ire
ctio
n
Printing side of 1st page
Back side of 2nd page
06/08
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedTROUBLESHOOTING
5 - 144
Cause/Section Step Check items Measures
Image adjust-ment/setting
1 Is the margin adjustment of image cor-rect?
Adjust the margin.
2 Is the margin adjustment of image correct when the paper size is not selected in bypass feeding?
Adjust the margin.
3 Is the margin adjustment of image at duplexing correct?
Adjust the margin. (05-434)
4 Is the image location in primary/second-ary scanning direction correct?
Adjust the location.
5 Is the reproduction ratio of image in pri-mary/secondary scanning direction cor-rect?
Adjust the reproduction ratio.
6 Is the tab setting correct? Correct the setting.
Paper feeding /Transport area
7 Does the size of paper in the drawer or LCF correspond to the setting?
Use the appropriate paper size or correct the size setting.
8 Is the width between the slides in the drawer correct (too wide)?
Correct the position of the slides.
9 Is the width between the slides of the bypass tray correct (too wide)?
Correct the width.
10 Is the sideways deviation adjustment for drawers or slides of the bypass tray cor-rect?
Adjust the deviation.
11 Is the paper aligning amount sufficient? Adjust the aligning amount.
12 Are the feed roller and transport roller dirty or worn out?
Clean or replace the rollers.
13 Does the paper mode correspond to the paper type?
Use the appropriate paper type or paper mode.
14 Using the recommended paper? Use the recommended paper.
Transfer unit 15 Is there any stain caused by a poor clean-ing, etc. on the transfer belt?
Clean the transfer belt.
16 Is the transfer belt cleaning blade in proper contact with the transfer belt?
Check if the blade pressure spring is installed.
17 Is the transfer belt cleaning blade con-tacted or released properly?
Check if the spring of the transfer belt cleaner clutch is removed or if any con-nector is disconnected. Otherwise replace the clutch.
18 Is the 2nd transfer roller rotating properly? Clean the area around the roller.Otherwise replace the roller.
19 Is there any foreign matter or stain on the 2nd transfer roller?
Clean or replace the roller.
20 Has the 2nd transfer roller reached to its PM life?
Replace the 2nd transfer roller.
Fuser unit 21 Are the fuser belt and pressure roller dirty?
Clean the fuser belt and pressure roller.
22 Is the rib of transport guide dirty? Clean the rib.
06/08
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cTROUBLESHOOTING
5 - 145
5
26)Paper wrinkling in the fuser unit
Is the paper placed correctly?|
NO Place the paper correctly.
YESDoes the paper absorb moisture?
|
YES Use dry paper.
NOIs thin paper such as recycled paper used?
|||
YES Change the mode to "Recycled Paper". (Choose the "Recycled Paper" in the paper type.) If paper wrinkling still occurs after the mode is changed to "Recycled Paper", go to "NO".
NOIs paper wrinkling cleared after the entrance guide (a set of the black guide and the plate) of the fuser unit is adjusted? (Refer to Fig.5-26)
||||||||||||||||||
Adjustment method1) Move 2 fixing screws of the entrance guide to the elongated holes as indi-
cated by the arrow (C).2) Adjust the entrance guide in the direction of the arrow (D).* (There is a higher possibility that paper wrinkling is eliminated when the
entrance guide is adjusted in the + direction.If the paper wrinkle still appears, proceed to NO.
Fig. 5-26
NOIs paper wrinkling eliminated after the height of the fuser unit is adjusted? (Refer to Fig.5-27)
DC C
A: Entrance guide
B: Drive gear
10/02
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedTROUBLESHOOTING
5 - 146
Adjustment method1) Loosen 2 screws (E).2) Move the fixing position of the screw (F) to the elongated hole as indicated
by the arrow (G).3) Adjust the fixing position of the fixing plate (H) in the fuser unit in the vertical
direction.4) Fix the screws (E) and (F).
Fig. 5-27
H: Fixing plate in the fuser unitEE
FG
10/02
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cTROUBLESHOOTING
5 - 147
5
5.3 Replacement of PC Boards and HDD
<CAUTION IN REPLACING PC BOARDS>The ID for each equipment is registered on the LGC board, the DRV board, the SYS board and the SLG board. So, if their replacement is required, be sure to replace only one board at a time.
If more than one of the LGC board, the DRV board and the SYS board require replacement, replace them in the following procedure.
1) First, replace one of the board to be replaced.2) Turn the power ON and confirm that "READY" is displayed.3) Turn the power OFF.4) Replace another board that requires replacement.5) Repeat steps 2 to 4.
The LGC board and DRV board can be replaced without other settings.When the HDD requires replacement, see “5.3.1 Replacing HDD”.When the SYS board requires replacement, see “5.3.2 Replacing SYS board”.When the SLG board requires replacement, see “5.3.3 Replacing SLG board”.When NVRAM requires replacement or clearing, see “5.3.4 NVRAM replacing and clearing”.
5.3.1 Replacing HDD
<CAUTION IN REPLACING HDD>When the HDD is replaced, it is necessary to back up the data in the HDD before replacing and to recover them after replacing.
Notes: 1. To maintain the security, ask users to perform the backup/restore for users’ data/information
in the HDD. The service technician can perform them only when users permit it.2. Some data in the HDD cannot be backed up and can be kept only on the paper.3. When 08-690 is performed, the HDD self-certificate is not available, so the SSL-related set-
ting becomes disabled.
The procedure for replacing the HDD is as follows.
05/11
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedTROUBLESHOOTING
5 - 148
(1) Ask users to back up the data in the HDD. See the following for the item of data, and the possibil-ity and the measure of the backup.• Image data in the Electronic Filing
- Archive them in the “e-Filing” of TopAccess.As for the backup in Box data, all data (selectable by the box) can be backed up / restored in one go by using "e-Filing Backup/Restore Utility".
• F-code information, Template registration information, Address book- Back them up in the “Administrator” menu of TopAccess.
• Department management data- Export them in “Administrator” menu of TopAccess.
• Log data (Print, Scan, FAX (Transmission/Reception))- Export them in the “Administrator” menu of TopAccess. (Import cannot be performed.)
• Data in the shared folder (Scanned data, Saved data of copy / FAX transmission)- Copy them to the client computer via the network. (The data which have been copied to
the client computer cannot be copied to the shared folder.)• Print waiting data (Copying data and FAX reception data that are waiting to be printed due to
the paper run-out and jam, etc.)- Finish printing them after the paper supply and the jam release, etc. (The data cannot be
kept.)• Print job (Private print data, Schedule print data)
- If any jobs are left, print them. (The data cannot be backed up.)• FAX saved data (Confidential / Bulletin board data)
- Print them. (The data cannot be backed up.)• Registration data for FAX transmission (Delayed transmission / Recovery transmission)
- The data cannot be backed up.
(2) Print out the “FUNCTION LIST FOR MAINTENANCE” (content of Function Mode (13) setting) list.• Press the [USER FUNCTIONS] button and then the [USER] button.• Press the [LIST] button.• Key in [*] [#] [*] [*] [3] [3] and then press the [START] button. The list is outputted.
(3) Print out the “FUNCTION” list.• Press the [USER FUNCTIONS] button.• Press the [ADMIN] button, enter the password, and then press the [ENTER] button.• Press the [LIST/REPORT] button and then the [LIST] button.• Press the [FUNCTION] button. The list is outputted.
(4) Replace the HDD.
(5) Update of HDD program data and UI data.• Create partitions. (In case of using the download jig, this is not necessary.)
While pressing [3] and [CLEAR] button, turn the power ON. When “Firmware Version Up Mode” appears on the LCD, key in [3] and press the [START] button.
• Update with the USB storage. See “6. FIRMWARE UPDATING” for details.• Format the HDD. (Setting Mode (08-690: 2))
* When the FAX unit (GD-1150) is installed. Start up with the FAX Clearing Mode (1*). Per-form the 1*-100 (FAX Set Up), 1*-102 (Clearing the image data) of the FAX Clearing Mode.
• Perform the gamma automatic adjustment of the printer. See “3.6.1 Automatic gamma adjust-ment” for details.
09/01
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cTROUBLESHOOTING
5 - 149
5
(6) Ask users to reset the user’s setting items and to restore the data/information. See the following for the reset and the restore.• Printer driver
- Upload them in the “Administrator” menu of TopAccess.• F-code information, Template registering information, Address book
- Restore them in the “Administrator” menu of TopAccess• Department management data
- Import them in the “Administrator” menu of TopAccess.• Image data in the Electronic Filing
- Upload them in the “e-Filing” of TopAccess. • When the SSL is enabled, perform the setting of the following items again with "Create self-
certificate" of TopAccess.Country NameState or Province NameLocality NameOrganization NameOrganizational Unit NameCommon NameEmail Address
• When wireless LAN is used, perform the setting again on the LCD panel. (only when security with a certificate is used)Also, upload the following certificate file with "Install Certificate for Wireless LAN" of TopAc-cess.
CA certificateUser certificate
(7) Referring to the “FUNCTION LIST FOR MAINTENANCE” list which was printed beforehand, per-form the re-setting.• Print out the “FUNCTION LIST FOR MAINTENANCE” list after the formatting. (Refer to the
procedure of (2).)• While pressing [1] and [3] simultaneously, turn the power ON. (Function Mode)• Compare the lists which were printed before and after the formatting to check the setting
items having the different setting values. Set the value which was set before the formatting.• Turn the power OFF.
(8) Referring to the “FUNCTION” list which was printed beforehand, perform the re-setting of the default setting of the FAX function.• Press the [USER FUNCTIONS] button.• Press the [ADMIN] button, enter the password, and then press the [ENTER] button.• Press the [FAX] button and then the [TERMINAL ID] button to set each item.• Press the [INITIAL SETUP] button to set each item.
09/01
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedTROUBLESHOOTING
5 - 150
5.3.2 Replacing SYS board
<<CAUTION IN REPLACING the SYS board>>Perform the following procedures and settings when the SYS board is replaced.
<After replacing the SYS board>
(1) Install DIMM (main memory) to the new SYS board (from the old SYS board).
(2) Install NVRAM to the new SYS board (from the old SYS board).
(3) Update the version of system ROMs (System Firmware, OS data, UI data) (The ROMs had been used for the old SYS board).* See “6. FIRMWARE UPDATING” for the details of System ROM update.
(4) Turn the power OFF and start up with the Setting Mode (08).
Note: Note: Be sure to start up with the Setting Mode (08), not the normal mode immediately after the System ROM update, and then perform the following steps.
(5) When the message “SRAM ERROR DOES IT INITIALIZE?” is displayed on the LCD, press the [INITIALIZE] button.* SRAM is cleared* If SRAM is not performed, F090 error occurs when starting up.
Notes: • When SRAM is cleared, following items need to be re-set, so make sure the contents of set
tings are kept as a record.<FAX settings>Terminal IDDefault setting of fax<E-mail settings>Setting of properties for E-mail message<Internet Fax>Setting of properties for Internet Fax
• When SRAM is cleared, the toner cartridge consumed count of Automatic ordering function of supplies becomes 0, however, it cannot be re-set.
(6) [If a scrambler board has already been installed]Perform 08-698 (Entering the key code for scrambler board). Have the user enter the key code.
(7) Perform 08-200 (date and time setting) to set Date/Time.
(8) Check the serial number after performing 08 Code 995. If the number is different from the num-ber on the label attached on the rear cover of the machine, re-input the correct number with 08 Code 995.
(9) Perform 08-693 (initialization of the NIC information).
(10) Turn the power OFF.* If the FAX board has not been installed, skip to step (14).
(11) Start up with the FAX Clearing Mode (1*)
08/12
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cTROUBLESHOOTING
5 - 151
5
(12) Perform 1*-102 (Clearing the image data).
Notes: Following image data are deleted when 1*-102 is performed.• Images of fax polling transmission• Images of fax Mailbox and box information• Images of fax transmission• Images of fax reception
(13) Turn the power OFF.
(14) Turn the power ON.
(15) Set the dial type. [USER FUNCTIONS] → [ADMIN] → [FAX] → [INITIAL SETUP]
5.3.3 Replacing SLG board
<CAUTION IN REPLACING SLG BOARD>When the SLG board has been replaced, “Data transfer of characteristic value of scanner / SYS board→ SLG board (05-363)” must be performed.
5.3.4 Replacing or clearing NVRAM<<Caution in replacing or clearing NVRAM>>When NVRAM has been replaced or cleared (“System all clearing (08-669)”), the setting must be per-formed according to the following procedure.
(1) Take off the FAX board if installed.
(2) Turn the power OFF and start up with the Setting Mode (08).
Note: Note: Be sure to start up with the Setting Mode (08), not the normal mode immediately after the NVRAM replacement or clearing, and then perform the following steps.
(3) Perform the panel calibration (08-692).
(4) Perform the counter copying (08-257 Sub-code: 1).
(5) Perform the initialization at the software version upgrade (08-947).
(6) Check the serial number after performing “Equipment number display” (08-995). If the number is different from the one on the label attached to the rear cover of the equipment, enter the correct serial number again with 08-995.
Note: Note: The MAC address of the equipment is generated based on this serial number. Entering the incor-rect serial number may result in an inability to access the network due to an invalid MAC address.
(7) Initialize the NIC information (08-693).
(8) Turn the power OFF and then start up with the Adjustment mode (05).
(9) Perform “Data transfer of characteristic value of scanner” (05-364).
05/07
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedTROUBLESHOOTING
5 - 152
(10) Perform “Automatic gamma adjustment” <PPC> (05-1642). (using [4][FAX] test pattern)
(11) Perform “Automatic gamma adjustment” <PRT-PS> (05-1000). (using [47][FAX] test pattern)
(12) Perform “Automatic gamma adjustment” <PRT-PCL> (05-1002). (using [49][FAX] test pattern)
(13) Turn the power OFF.
(14) Install the FAX board taken off in step (1).* If the FAX board has not been installed, the following steps are not necessary.
(15) Start up with the Setting Mode (08).
(16) Set the destination with Destination setting of FAX machine (08-701).
(17) Start up with the FAX Clearing Mode (1*).
(18) Perform “FAX Set Up” (1*-100).
(19) Turn the power OFF.
(20) Turn the power ON.
(21) Set the dial type. [USER FUNCTIONS] [ADMIN] [FAX] [INITIAL SETUP]
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cTROUBLESHOOTING
5 - 153
5
5.3.5 Cautions when Data overwrite kit (GP-1060) is installed When the Data overwrite kit (GP-1060) is installed, follow the cautions below.
<<Cautions when disposing of the HDD>> Before disposing of the HDD of the equipment, be sure to perform 08-1426 (forcible HDD data clearing) and confirm that deleting of the HDD data is completed.
• Check that the percentage is 100% and “HDD Erase [OK]” appears on the upper left of the screen.• Check that the version (SYS V1.0) is displayed on the lower right of the screen.
* When the scrambler board is installed, data in the HDD are overwritten with encrypted data and erased.
<<Caution when disposing of the SYS board>> Before the SYS board is disposed, the following codes can be performed. • 08-1427 (Forcible NVRAM data all clearing) • 08-1428 (Forcible SRAM backup data all clearing)
If these codes are performed, the equipment cannot be started up.
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedTROUBLESHOOTING
5 - 154
5.3.6 HDD information displayThis code displays the HDD operation history, which is recorded in the HDD, on the control panel. HDD failure can be diagnosed or predicted with the information displayed.
1) DisplayThe following screen is displayed with setting code 08-670.
- Items supported differ depending on the HDD manufacturer.- "---" is displayed on the VALUE, NAV and Worst columns if items are not supported.
2) UsageThe combination of the values of ID=05 and c5 is used to diagnose whether or not the HDD has a physical failure when HDD failure is suspected (service call F100-108 or 120 occurred).
3) ID=05 and c5
ResultDescription Diagnosis
ID VALUE05 0 Low possibility of physical failure HDD replacement
is not required.c5 005 From 1 to 999 Defective sector has been reassigned and HDD is recovered. HDD replacement
is not required.c5 005 Any value High possibility of defective sector existence. (There will be a
possibility of physical failure depending on the use of HDD.)HDD replacement is recommended.c5 1 or more
05 Either one is at least 1000.
High possibility of physical failure HDD replacement is recommended.c5
05 All values are dis-played as "-------".
High possibility of physical failure (A HDD connector, harness or SYS board may be one of the causes.)
HDD replacement is recommended.c5
ID Name Description Remarks
05 Re-allocated Sector Count The number of sectors reassigned This value tends to increase at HDD failure.
c5 Current Pending Sector Count The number of candidate sectors to be reassigned
This value tends to increase at HDD failure.
HDD manufacturer Model name HDD serial number
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cTROUBLESHOOTING
5 - 155
5
4) Description of each ID
ID Name Meaning
01 Read Error Rate This attribute is a measure of the read error rate.
02 Throughput Performance This attribute is a measure of the throughput performance.
03 Spin Up Time This attribute is a measure of how quickly the drive is able to spin up from a spun down condition.
04 Spin Start/Stop Count This attribute is a measure of the total number of spin ups from a spun down condition.
05 Re-allocated Sector Count This attribute is a measure of the total number of reallocated sectors.
07 Seek Error Rate This is a measure of the seek error rate.
08 Seek Time Performance This attribute is a measure of a drive's seek performance dur-ing normal online operations.
09 Power-On Hours This attribute is a measure of the total time (hours or minutes depending on disk manufacturer) the drive has been on.
0a Spin Retry Count This attribute is a measure of the total number of spin retries.
0c Power Cycle Count This attribute is a measure of the number of times the drive has been turned on.
c0 Power off Retract Count This attribute is a measure of the total number of emergency unloads.
c1 Load Cycle Count This attribute is a measure of the total number of load/unloads.
c2 Temperature This attribute is a measure of the temperature in the HDD.
c3 ECC On the Fly Count This attribute is a measure of the total number of the ECC On the Fly.
c4 Reallocation Event Count This attribute is a measure of the total number of the reallo-cation events.
c5 Current Pending Sector Count This attribute is a measure of the total number of candidate sectors to be reallocated.
c6 Off-Line Scan Uncorrectable Sector Count This attribute is a measure of the total number of uncorrect-able sectors found during the off-line scan.
c7 Ultra DMA CRC Error Count (Rate) This attribute is a measure of the total number of errors found in data transfer in the Ultra-DMA mode.
c8 Write Error Rate This attribute is a measure of the write error rate.
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedTROUBLESHOOTING
5 - 156
5.4 Other errors1) Operation cannot be performed (operation from the control panel is not successful) after installing
the option(s) such as Wireless LAN module, Scrambler board and/or Parallel board.- Check if the optional board is installed properly.
2) The connection to the Wireless LAN cannot be made even though it is set to “Enabled”.- The connection state and settings of the Wireless LAN can be checked with [USER FUNC-
TIONS] → [ADMIN] → [WIRELESS LAN] → [SETTING CHECK].Confirm the settings with the administrator.* “NIC INITIALIZING” does not disappear at the time of the power being turned ON and it dis-
appears after 6 minutes with the NIC initializing time-out. In this case, the connection to the Wireless LAN did not succeed even though “NIC INITIALIZING” disappears.
* The connection to the Wireless LAN cannot be made if the Access Point to be connected is not found or security settings are not correct.
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cFIRMWARE UPDATING
6 - 1
6
6. FIRMWARE UPDATING
In this equipment, following firmware is written on the ROM on each board.
When you want to update the firmware above or the equipment becomes inoperative status due to some defectives of the firmware, updating the firmware is available by the following actions.
• Updating with the download jig P. 6-2 "6.1 Firmware Updating with Download Jig"
• Updating with the USB Storage Device P. 6-37 "6.2 Firmware Updating with USB Storage Device"
Notes: • Before updating the firmware, check the FROM basic section software version (perform the
code 08-920).• For updating with the USB Storage Device; The firmware can be updated to the latest version
by storing the update program together with the firmware data file for updating in the USB Storage Device.
• For updating with the download jig; Before the FROM basic section software is updated from "V1.00 / 8.22" or earlier version to the latest one, update it to "V1.01 / 2.30" first. Select all of the SYS, OS, UI and HDD when updating "V1.00 / 8.22" or earlier versions.
• Written firmware varies depending on the kinds of the boards provided as service parts. For updating, only the minimum firmware is installed on the system control PC board, logic PC board, and scanning section control PC board. No firmware is installed on the FAX board. The latest version of the firmware at the delivery is written on the RADF control PC board and fin-isher control PC board.When any of above boards is replaced with a new one in the field, confirm the other firmware version used with and then write the suitable version of the firmware.
• The firmware (master data) is not installed on the hard disk provided as a service part. When the hard disk is replaced with a new one, confirm the other firmware version used with and then write the suitable version of the firmware.
Firmware Stored Update method
Master data(HDD program data, UI data)
Hard disk USB Storage Device
System ROM(System firmware, OS data, UI data)
System control PC board(SYS board)* The system firmware is stored
into the hard disk from the FROM basic section software version “V1.01/2.30”.
USB Storage Device * When replacing the system
control PC board (SYS board), update with Download jig.
Engine ROM(Machine firmware)
Logic PC board(LGC board)
USB Storage Device* Update with Download jig also
possible.
Scanner ROM(Scanner firmware)
Scanning section control PC board(SLG board)
USB Storage Device* Update with Download jig also
possible.
RADF ROM(RADF firmware)
RADF control PC board(MR-3018)
Download jig
Finisher ROM(Finisher firmware)
Finisher control PC board(MJ-1101/MJ-1023/ MJ-1024)
Download jig
Finisher ROM(Saddle stitcher firmware)
Finisher control PC board(MJ-1024)
Download jig
Hole punch unit ROM(Hole punch unit firmware)
Hole punch control PC board(MJ-6101)
Download jig
FAX ROM(FAX firmware)
FAX board(GD-1200/1201)
Download jig
08/12
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedFIRMWARE UPDATING
6 - 2
6.1 Firmware Updating with Download JigIn this equipment, it is feasible to update the firmware automatically by connecting the download jig using the dedicated connector and turning ON the equipment.The download jig consists of the ROM, in which the program is written, and the jig board.Two types of the download jigs are available for each type of the firmware. For updating the firmware, in addition to the current ways such as updating each firmware individually, the batch update of the firmware of the equipment is available (except the hard disk and the option).
Refer to the following for the details to update with each download jig. P. 6-4 "6.1.1 PWA-DWNLD-350-JIG2 (48 MB)" P. 6-20 "6.1.3 K-PWA-DLM-320"
Firmware StoredDownload jig
Batch update Individual update
System ROM System control PC board (SYS board)* The system firmware is
stored into the hard disk from the FROM basic sec-tion software version “V1.01/2.30”.
PWA-DWNLD-350-JIG2 (48 MB)<Two download jigs are needed.>
-
Engine ROM Logic PC board(LGC board)
K-PWA-DLM-320
Scanner ROM Scanning section control PC board (SLG board)
K-PWA-DLM-320
RADF ROM RADF control PC board (MR-3018)
- K-PWA-DLM-320
Finisher ROM(Finisher firmware)
Finisher control PC board (MJ-1101/MJ-1023/MJ-1024)
- K-PWA-DLM-320
Finisher ROM(Saddle stitcher firmware)
Finisher control PC board (MJ-1024)
- K-PWA-DLM-320
Hole punch unit ROM(Hole punch unit firmware)
Hole punch control PC board(MJ-6101)
- K-PWA-DLM-320
FAX ROM FAX board (GD-1200/1201) - K-PWA-DLM-320
08/12
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cFIRMWARE UPDATING
6 - 3
6
PWA-DWNLD-350-JIG2 (48MB)
Fig. 6-1 Jig board: PWA-DWNLD-350-JIG2 (48 MB)
Important: • To perform update, two download jigs (PWA-DWNLD-350-JIG2) are needed. • The download jig (PWA-DWNLD-350-JIG) is the jig in which the Flash ROM is mounted on
the board directly. Therefore, ROM writer adapter (PWA-DL-ADP-350) is required to write the data to these Flash ROMs. Refer to the following to write the data. P. 6-18 "6.1.2 Writing the data to the download jig (PWA-DWNLD-350-JIG)"
K-PWA-DLM-320
Fig. 6-2 Jig board: K-PWA-DLM-320
Important: Be sure that the ROM is installed in the correct direction.
ROM4
ROM5
ROM6
ROM1
ROM2
ROM3
Connector(for SYS boardconnection)
Connector(for ROM writeradapter connection)
Connector Mark for ROMinstallation direction
ROM
LED
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedFIRMWARE UPDATING
6 - 4
6.1.1 PWA-DWNLD-350-JIG2 (48 MB)The firmware of the equipment except for the hard disk and the option can be updated individually or in a batch by using PWA-DWNLD-350-JIG2 (48 MB). Update the ROM data written on each board according to the need such as the case of replacing the system control PC board, logic PC board or scanning section control PC board.
The data to be overwritten by this update are as follows.<Updating System ROM>• System firmware (System firmware data, FROM internal program data)• OS data (FROM basic section software)• UI data (fixed section data, common section data, UI data in FROM displayed at power ON)
<Updating Engine ROM>Engine ROM data
<Updating Scanner ROM>Scanner ROM data
[A] Update procedure
Important: • Use two “PWA-DWNLD-350-JIG2” for the download jigs. • Turn OFF the power before installing and removing the download jig.• Do not turn OFF the power during the update. The data could be damaged and not be oper-
ated properly.
(1) Write the ROM data to be updated to the download jig. P. 6-18 "6.1.2 Writing the data to the download jig (PWA-DWNLD-350-JIG)"
(2) Shut down the equipment.
(3) Take off the connector cover.
Fig. 6-3
Connector cover
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cFIRMWARE UPDATING
6 - 5
6
(4) Connect the download jig with the jig connector (CN105, CN106) on the SYS board.
Fig. 6-4
(5) Turn ON the power while [8] button and [9] button are pressed simultaneously.The screen for selecting the items to be updated is displayed. “*” is displayed next to the items to be updated. (All items are selected in the default settings.)
When the FROM basic section software version to be updated is "V1.00 / 8.22" or earlier:
Fig. 6-5
Download jig number Connector name
Download jig 0 CN105
Download jig 1 CN106
Connector
Download jig 0
Download jig 1
06/08
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedFIRMWARE UPDATING
6 - 6
When the FROM basic section software version to be updated is "V1.01 / 2.30" or later:
Fig. 6-6
(6) Select the item with the digital keys.“*” is displayed next to the selected item. Display or delete the “*” by pressing the number of the item. All items are selected in the default settings.• Select all items to update the firmware of the equipment in a batch.• Select items as follows to update it individually.
Example: Updating the system ROMWhen the FROM basic section software version to be updated is "V1.00 / 8.22" or earlier:
Fig. 6-7
Types of Firmware
Items <Items vary depending on the FROM basic section software
version to be updated.>
"V1.00/8.22" or earlier: "V1.01/2.30" or later
System ROM 0. OS Update1. UI Update2. System Firmware Update
1. OS UI Update
Engine ROM 3. Engine Firmware Update 2. Engine Firmware Update
Scanner ROM 4. Scanner Firmware Update 3. Scanner Firmware Update
06/08
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cFIRMWARE UPDATING
6 - 7
6
When the FROM basic section software version to be updated is "V1.01 / 2.30" or later:
Fig. 6-8
(Updating all the items is taken as an example and explained in the following procedures.)
(7) Press the [START] button.Updating starts and the processing status is displayed on the LCD screen.
When the FROM basic section software version to be updated is "V1.00 / 8.22" or earlier:
Fig. 6-9
Status display during update Status display when update is completed
OS Update ....... OS Update ......................Completed
UI Data Update ....... UI Data Update ...............Completed
SysFirm Update ....... SysFirm Update ..............Completed
Engine MAIN Update ......Flash Update Engine MAIN Update ......Completed
Scanner Firm Update......Flash Update Scanner Firm Update......Completed
06/08
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedFIRMWARE UPDATING
6 - 8
When the FROM basic section software version to be updated is "V1.01 / 2.30" or later:
Fig. 6-10
(8) “Update Completed.” is displayed at the bottom of the LCD screen after the updating is com-pleted properly.
When the FROM basic section software version to be updated is "V1.00 / 8.22" or earlier:
Fig. 6-11
Status display during update Status display when update is completed
OS UI Update ....... OS UI Update.................Completed
Engine MAIN Update......Flash Update Engine MAIN Update..... Completed
Scanner Firm Update..... Flash Update Scanner Firm Update..... Completed
06/08
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cFIRMWARE UPDATING
6 - 9
6
When the FROM basic section software version to be updated is "V1.01 / 2.30" or later:
Fig. 6-12
“Update Failed.” is displayed at the bottom of the LCD screen when the updating is not com-pleted properly. “Failed” appears next to the failed item on the status display. Turn OFF the power, and then check the following items. After confirming and cleaning the problems, restart updating from the beginning.• Is the download jig connected properly?• Is the updating data written to the download jig properly?• Do the download jig and the equipment operate properly?
When the FROM basic section software version to be updated is "V1.00 / 8.22" or earlier:
Fig. 6-13
06/08
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedFIRMWARE UPDATING
6 - 10
When the FROM basic section software version to be updated is "V1.01 / 2.30" or later:
Fig. 6-14
(9) Turn OFF the power, remove the download jig and install the cover plate and the connector cover.
(10) Perform the initialization of the updating data.• Turn ON the power while [0] button and [8] button are pressed simultaneously.• Key in “947”, and then press the [START] button.• Press the [INITIALIZE] button.
[B] Confirmation of the updated data
After the updating is completed, check each data version in the Setting Mode (08) to confirm that the data was overwritten properly.
<Updating System ROM>08-900: System ROM version08-920: FROM basic section software version08-921: FROM internal program version08-922: UI data fixed section version08-923: UI data common section version08-930: Version of UI data in FROM displayed at power ON
<Updating Engine ROM>08-903: Engine ROM version
<Updating Scanner ROM>08-905: Scanner ROM version
06/08
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cFIRMWARE UPDATING
6 - 11
6
[C] Display during the update (When the FROM basic section software version to be updated is "V1.00 / 8.22" or earlier)
Update is performed in parallel as shown in the transition diagram below.
Below is an example of the changes of the LCD screen during update. Note that the screen order may be different from the actual one, because a parallel update is performed in the process.
Select items to be updated and press the [START] button to start updating the [System ROM], [Engine ROM] and [Scanner ROM] in parallel.
Item Selection Screen for Update
0. OS Update
1. UI Data Update
2. System Firmware Update
[System ROM]
Update Completed
[Engine ROM]
4. Scanner Firmware Update
[Scanner ROM]
3. Engine Firmware Update
Turn ON the power while [8] button and [9] button are pressed simultaneously
06/08
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedFIRMWARE UPDATING
6 - 12
When the [System ROM]-[OS Update] has been updated, “OS Update…Completed” is displayed and the [UI Update] update will start.
When the [System ROM]-[UI Update] has been updated, “UI Data Update…Completed” is dis-played and the [System Firmware Update] update will start.
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cFIRMWARE UPDATING
6 - 13
6
When the [Engine ROM] has been updated, “Engine MAIN Update..Flash Update” is changed to “Engine MAIN Update..Completed”.
When the [System ROM]-[System Firmware Update] has been updated, “SysFirm Update…Completed” is displayed.
When the [Scanner ROM] has been updated, “Scanner Firm Update..Flash Update” is changed to “Scanner Firm Update..Completed”.
When all data has been updated, “Update Completed” is displayed.
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedFIRMWARE UPDATING
6 - 14
* “Update Failed.” is displayed at the bottom of the LCD screen when the updating is not completed properly. “Failed” appears next to the failed item on the status display.
Failed items Error message
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cFIRMWARE UPDATING
6 - 15
6
[D] Display during the update (When the FROM basic section software version to be updated is "V1.01 / 2.30" or later)
Update is performed in parallel as shown in the transition diagram below.
Below is an example of the changes of the LCD screen during update.
Select items to be updated and press the [START] button.
Item Selection Screen for Update
1. OS UI Update
[System ROM]
Update Completed
[Engine ROM]
3. Scanner Firmware Update
[Scanner ROM]
2. Engine Firmware Update
Turn ON the power while [8] button and [9] button are pressed simultaneously
06/08
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedFIRMWARE UPDATING
6 - 16
When the [System ROM]-[OS Update] has been updated, “OS UI Update…Completed” is displayed.
When the [Engine ROM] has been updated, “Engine MAIN Update..Flash Update” is changed to “Engine MAIN Update..Completed”.
06/08
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cFIRMWARE UPDATING
6 - 17
6
When the [Scanner ROM] has been updated, “Scanner Firm Update..Flash Update” is changed to “Scanner Firm Update..Completed”.
When all data has been updated, “Update Completed” is displayed.
* “Update Failed.” is displayed at the bottom of the LCD screen when the updating is not completed properly. “Failed” appears next to the failed item on the status display.
Failed items Error message
06/08
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedFIRMWARE UPDATING
6 - 18
6.1.2 Writing the data to the download jig (PWA-DWNLD-350-JIG)The download jig (PWA-DWNLD-350-JIG) is the jig in which the Flash ROM is mounted on the board directly. The ROM writer adapter (PWA-DL-ADP-350) is required to write data to these Flash ROMs. Connect the download jig with the ROM writer via ROM writer adapter to write data. For the procedure to write data, refer to the download procedure, instruction manual of each ROM writer, or others.
Fig. 6-15
Note: Note: There are two types of the ROM writer adapter. Use the proper one according to the ROM writer to be used. Applicable type of the adapter for the ROM writer can be confirmed by the model name indicated on the board. Confirm that the adapter is available for the ROM writer to be used before connecting them. If an unapplied adapter is connected, the application of the ROM writer judges it as an error and writing the data cannot be implemented. Applicable combinations of the ROM writer and adapter are as follows.
ROM writer ROM writer adapter
Minato Electronics MODEL 1881XP/1881UXP(or equivalent)
PWA-DL-ADP-350-1881 (model 1881)
Minato Electronics MODEL 1893/1895/1931/1940 (or equivalent)
PWA-DL-ADP-350-1931 (model 1931)
Fig. 6-16 PWA-DL-ADP-350-1881 Fig. 6-17 PWA-DL-ADP-350-1931
PC
Download jig(PWA-DWNLD-350-JIG)
ROM writer
ROM writer adapter(PWA-DL-ADP-350)
model 1881
[PWA-DL-ADP-350-1881]
model 1931
(LV650)
[PWA-DL-ADP-350-1931]
08/04
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cFIRMWARE UPDATING
6 - 19
6
• Precaution when writing the data- Consider two download jigs (PWA-DWNLD-350-JIG2) as “Download jig 0” and “Down load jig 2”
and do not mix them up when writing. - Set the writing voltage (VID) to 3.3 V.- When writing the data, set the address from 0 to 3FFFFF. The data may not be written correctly if
it is not set.- The Flash ROM in which the data will be written, on the download jig is selected by switching the
rotary switch on the adapter. Be sure to switch the rotary switch on the adapter depending on the data (file) to be written.
Important: When an error such as "Over current detects" appears while the data are being written to the download jig and the writing cannot be finished, set the writing voltage (VID) to 12 V and then write them.
Note: Note: Be sure not to confuse different ROM Versions since the file name is identical although the ROM version is different.
Rotary SwitchFile Name
Flash ROMDownload jig 0 Download jig 1
1 jigu0-1.bin jigu0-0.bin ROM1
2 jigu1-1.bin jigu1-0.bin ROM2
3 jigu2-1.bin jigu2-0.bin ROM3
4 N/A N/A ROM4
5 N/A N/A ROM5
6 N/A N/A ROM6
08/04
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedFIRMWARE UPDATING
6 - 20
6.1.3 K-PWA-DLM-320The firmware of the equipment (engine ROM, scanner ROM) and the option (RADF ROM, Finisher ROM, FAX ROM) can be updated individually by using K-PWA-DLM-320. Update the ROM data written on each board according to the need such as the case of replacing the board.
The data to be overwritten by this update are as follows.<Updating Engine ROM>Engine ROM data
<Updating Scanner ROM>Scanner ROM data
<Updating RADF ROM>RADF ROM data
<Updating Finisher ROM>• Finisher firmware• Saddle stitcher firmware
<Updating FAX ROM>FAX ROM data
[A] Update Procedure
Since the procedure differs depending on the data, see the each procedure below.
Important: • Turn OFF the power before installing or removing the download jig.• Do not turn OFF the power during the update. The data could be damaged and not be oper-
ated properly.
<Updating Engine ROM>
(1) Install the ROM to the download jig.Make sure the direction is correct ( P. 6-3 " K-PWA-DLM-320").
(2) Shut down the equipment.
(3) Take off the connector cover.
Fig. 6-18
Connector cover
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cFIRMWARE UPDATING
6 - 21
6
(4) Remove the cover plate.
Fig. 6-19
(5) Connect the download jig with the jig connector (CN344) on the logic PC board (LGC board).
Fig. 6-20
(6) Turn ON the power while [0] button and [8] button are pressed simultaneously.Updating starts automatically and the LED on the download jig lights.
(7) When the update is completed properly, the LED on the download jig blinks. The LED starts blinking in approx. 20 sec. since the update starts. It is assumed that the update is failed if it does not start blinking even though 1 min. has passed. In this case, turn OFF the power and check the following items. Then, clear the problem and restart updating from the beginning.• Is the download jig connected properly?• Is the ROM installed to the download jig properly?• Is the updating data written on the ROM of the download jig properly?• Do the download jig and the equipment operate properly?
(8) Turn OFF the power, remove the download jig and install the cover plate and the connector cover.
Cover plate
Connector
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedFIRMWARE UPDATING
6 - 22
<Updating Scanner ROM>
(1) Install the ROM to the download jig.Make sure the direction is correct ( P. 6-3 " K-PWA-DLM-320").
(2) Shut down the equipment.
(3) Take off the right upper cover.
Fig. 6-21
(4) Remove the cover plate.
Fig. 6-22
Right upper cover
Cover plate
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cFIRMWARE UPDATING
6 - 23
6
(5) Connect the download jig with the jig connector (CN16) on the scanning section control PC board (SLG board).
Fig. 6-23
(6) Turn ON the power while [0] button and [8] button are pressed simultaneously.Updating starts automatically and the LED on the download jig lights.
(7) After the update is completed properly, the LED on the download jig blinks. The LED starts blink-ing in approx. 20 sec. since the update starts. It is assumed that the update is failed if it does not start blinking even though 1 min. has passed. In this case, turn OFF the power and check the fol-lowing items. Then, clear the problem and restart updating from the beginning.• Is the download jig connected properly?• Is the ROM installed to the download jig properly?• Is the updating data written on the ROM of the download jig properly?• Do the download jig and the equipment operate properly?
(8) Turn OFF the power, remove the download jig and install the cover plate and the right upper cover.
Connector
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedFIRMWARE UPDATING
6 - 24
<Updating RADF ROM>
(1) Install the ROM to the download jig.Make sure the direction is correct ( P. 6-3 " K-PWA-DLM-320").
(2) Shut down the equipment.(3) Take off the RADF rear cover.
Fig. 6-24
(4) Connect the download jig with the jig connector (CN81) on the RADF control PC board.
Fig. 6-25
(5) Turn ON the power while [0] button and [8] button are pressed simultaneously.Updating starts automatically and the LED on the download jig lights.
(6) After the update is completed properly, the LED on the download jig blinks slowly (at an interval of approx. 0.8 sec.). The LED starts blinking in approx. 15 sec. since the update starts. It is assumed that the update is failed if it does not start blinking even though 1 min. has passed or the LED blinks fast (at an interval of approx. 0.1 sec.). In this case, turn OFF the power and check the following items. Then, clear the problem and restart updating from the beginning.• Is the download jig connected properly?• Is the ROM installed to the download jig properly?• Is the updating data written on the ROM of the download jig properly?• Do the download jig and the equipment operate properly?
(7) Turn OFF the power, remove the download jig and install the RADF rear cover.
RADF rear cover
Connector
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cFIRMWARE UPDATING
6 - 25
6
<Updating Finisher ROM (MJ-1023/1024)>Finisher firmware (MJ-1023/1024) and saddle stitcher firmware (MJ-1024 only) are written on the fin-isher ROM. These two kinds of firmware can be updated individually by installing the download jig to the finisher control PC board.
Remark: The following updates are needed according to the finisher model.
• MJ-1023 (Console type):Only the update of “Finisher firmware” is needed.
• MJ-1024 (Console type with the saddle stitcher):Two kinds of update “Finisher firmware” and “Saddle stitcher firmware” are needed.
(1) Install the ROM to the download jig.Make sure the direction is correct ( P. 6-3 " K-PWA-DLM-320").
(2) Shut down the equipment.
(3) Take off the finisher rear cover.
Fig. 6-26
* Connect the finisher interface cable with the equipment after removing the finisher rear cover.
Finisher rear cover Finisher rear cover
[MJ-1023] [MJ-1024]
06/08
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedFIRMWARE UPDATING
6 - 26
(4) Connect the download jig with the jig connector on the finisher control PC board.
Fig. 6-27
(5) Change the setting of the DIP switch on the finisher control PC board.Change the setting of the DIP switch as follows according to the firmware to be updated.
Note: Note: Record the current settings of the DIP switch before changing them. After the updating is com-pleted, return the DIP switch to the status as record.
Fig. 6-28
<Updating Finisher Firmware>Change all the setting of the DIP switch (1-8) to OFF.
<Updating Saddle Stitcher Firmware>Change the setting of the DIP switch 1-6 to OFF and 7-8 to ON.
Connector
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cFIRMWARE UPDATING
6 - 27
6
(6) Turn ON the power while [0] button and [8] button are pressed simultaneously.Updating starts automatically and the LED on the download jig lights.
Important: The processing status can be confirmed by the lighting of the LED (LED 101-103) on the finisher control board.
Fig. 6-29
(7) After the update is completed properly, the LED on the download jig blinks slowly (at interval of 0.8 sec). The LED starts blinking in approx. 30 sec. (finisher section) or 2 min. 30 sec. (saddle stitcher section) since the update starts. It is assumed that the update is failed if it does not start blinking even though 1 min. has passed (finisher section) or 3 min. (saddle stitcher section), or LED flashes fast (at interval of 0.1 sec.). In this case, turn OFF the power and check the following items. Then, clear the problem and restart updating from the beginning.• Is the download jig connected properly?• Is the ROM installed to the download jig properly?• Is the updating data written on the ROM of the download jig properly?• Do the download jig and the equipment operate properly?• Is the DIP switch on the finisher control PC board set properly according to the download sec-
tion (finisher or saddle stitcher)?
(8) Turn OFF the power, remove the download jig and return the DIP switch to the status before updating.
(9) Install the finisher rear cover.
Processing statusLED
LED103 LED102 LED101
0% or above OFF OFF ON
15% or above OFF ON OFF
30% or above OFF ON ON
45% or above ON OFF OFF
60% or above ON OFF ON
75% or above ON ON OFF
90% or above ON ON ON
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedFIRMWARE UPDATING
6 - 28
<Updating Finisher ROM (MJ-1101)>
(1) Attach the ROM to the download jigMake sure that the ROM and its direction are correct. P. 6-3 " K-PWA-DLM-320"
(2) Turn OFF the power of the equipment.
(3) Remove 1 screw and take off the board access cover.
Fig. 6-30
(4) Connect the download jig with the jig connector (CN9) on the Finisher control board.
Fig. 6-31
(5) Turn ON the power while pressing [0] and [8] simultaneously.Updating starts and the LED on the download jig lights
Board access cover
Download jig
06/08
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cFIRMWARE UPDATING
6 - 29
6
(6) When the update completes normally, the LED on the download jig starts blinking.
The LED on the download jig starts blinking in approx. 12 seconds after the update started.It is assumed that the update is failed if the LED does not start blinking even after 20 seconds have elapsed.In this case, turn the power OFF and check the following items.Then, clear the problem and restart updating from the beginning.• Is the downloading jig connected properly? • Is the ROM attached to the downloading jig properly?• Has the update data been written correctly to the ROM on the jig?• Is the download jig or the equipment damaged?
(7) Turn the power OFF and remove the download jig.
(8) Install the board access cover.
06/08
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedFIRMWARE UPDATING
6 - 30
<Updating Hole punch unit ROM (MJ-6101)>
1. Checking the hole punch positionFollow the procedure below to check the stopping position of the paper transport during the punching operation before updating the firmware, as the value for the position is defaulted when the firmware is updated.
(1) Turn the power of the equipment OFF.
(2) Remove the finisher board access cover and change the setting of the DIP-SW1 (SW1) on the finisher control PC board as shown in the figure below.
Fig. 6-32
(3) The LED1 on the finisher control panel starts blinking as you turn the power of the equipment ON. Count the number of times the LED1 blinks. When the number of blinks is "6", this indicates that the value for the stopping position is defaulted. If the number is other than "6", record the number of blinks, because it will be needed to reset the value after the firmware is updated.
2. Firmware updateUpdate the firmware using the download jig (K-PWA-DLM-320).
(1) Attach the ROM to the download jig.Make sure that the ROM and its direction are correct. P. 6-3 " K-PWA-DLM-320"
(2) Turn OFF the power of the equipment.
SW1
ON
1 2 3 4
06/08
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cFIRMWARE UPDATING
6 - 31
6
(3) Remove 1 screw and take off the finisher board access cover.
Fig. 6-33
(4) Release the latches and take off the rear lower cover of the hole punch unit.
Fig. 6-34
(5) Remove 3 screws and take off the rear cover of the hole punch unit.
Fig. 6-35
Board access cover
Rear lower cover
Rear cover
06/08
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedFIRMWARE UPDATING
6 - 32
(6) Connect the download jig with the jig connector (CN9) on the finisher control PC board.
Fig. 6-36
(7) Set the DIP-SW4 on the hole punch control PC board to ON.
Fig. 6-37
(8) Turn the power ON while pressing [0] and [8] simultaneously. Updating starts and the LED on the download jig lights.
(9) When the update is completed normally, the LED on the download jig starts blinking. The LED on the download jig starts blinking in approx. 20 seconds after the update started. It is assumed that the update is failed if the LED does not start blinking even after 30 seconds have elapsed.In this case, turn the power OFF and check the following items. Then, clear the problem and restart updating from the beginning. • Is the downloading jig connected properly?• Is the ROM attached to the downloading jig properly?• Is the DIP-SW4 on the hole punch control PC board set properly?• Has the update data been written correctly to the ROM on the jig?• Is the download jig or the equipment damaged?• Is the connector (CN12) on the finisher control PC board connected properly?• Are the connector (CN15) on the finisher control PC board and the connector (CN1) on the
hole punch control PC board connected properly?
(10) Turn the power OFF and remove the download jig.
Download jig
ON
1 2 3 4
06/08
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cFIRMWARE UPDATING
6 - 33
6
(11) Set the DIP-SW4 on the hole punch control PC board to OFF.
Note: Note: When the number of blinks is other than "6" (which indicates that the adjustment value is "0") at the section "1. Checking the hole punch position", follow the steps of "5.1 Stopping Position Adjustment" in the MJ-6101 Service Manual to adjust the value to the one that has been set before the update.
(12) Change the settings of the DIP-SW1 and -SW2 on the hole punch control PC board according to the model as shown in the figure below.
Fig. 6-38
(13) Install the rear cover of the hole punch unit.
(14) Install the rear lower cover of the hole punch unit.
(15) Install the finisher board access cover.
ON
1 2 3 4
ON
1 2 3 4
ON
1 2 3 4
ON
1 2 3 4
MJ-6101E MJ-6101N
MJ-6101F MJ-6101S
06/08
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedFIRMWARE UPDATING
6 - 34
<Updating FAX ROM>
Important: • Before updating the FAX ROM, make sure to print out the current Function list for mainte-
nance, Function list (ADMIN), Phone book number information and Group number informa-tion. In case the updating is failed and the registered information of the users is lost for some reason, re-register the user information referring to the lists and recover it.
• Confirm the following items before turning OFF the power of the equipment. Turning OFF the power may clear the data below.- Confirm that the “MEMORY RX” LED is OFF and there are no memory reception data.- Print the “Mailbox/Relay box report” and then confirm that there are no F code data.- Press the [JOB STATUS] button to display the screen and then confirm that there are no
memory transmission data.
(1) Install the ROM to the download jig. Make sure the direction is correct ( P. 6-3 " K-PWA-DLM-320").
(2) Shut down the equipment.
(3) Take off the connector cover.
Fig. 6-39
(4) Remove the cover plate.
Fig. 6-40
Connector cover
Cover plate
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cFIRMWARE UPDATING
6 - 35
6
(5) Connect the download jig with the jig connector (CN602) on the FAX board.
Fig. 6-41
(6) Turn ON the power while [0] button and [8] button are pressed simultaneously.Updating starts automatically and the LED on the download jig lights.
(7) After the update is completed properly, the LED on the download jig blinks. The LED starts blink-ing in approx. 30 sec. since the update starts. It is assumed that the update is failed if it does not start blinking even though 1 min. has passed. In this case, turn OFF the power and check the fol-lowing items. Then, clear the problem and restart updating from the beginning.• Is the download jig connected properly?• Is the ROM installed to the download jig properly?• Is the updating data written on the ROM of the download jig properly?• Do the download jig and the equipment operate properly?
(8) Turn OFF the power, remove the download jig and install the cover plate and the connector cover.
(9) In the FAX Clearing Mode, perform the “FAX Set Up”.• Confirm the destination setting is correct in the Setting Mode (08).
08-201: Destination setting of the equipment08-701: Destination setting of the FAX machine
• Turn ON the power while [1] button and [*] button are pressed simultaneously.• Key in “100”.• Press the [START] button.
Notes: If the equipment does not work properly after the operation (9), follow the procedure below and then perform the “Clearing the image data” in the FAX Clearing Mode to erase the image data in the memory.• Confirm the destination setting is correct in the Setting Mode (08).
08-201: Destination setting of the equipment08-701: Destination setting of the FAX machine
• Turn ON the power while [1] button and [*] button are pressed simultaneously.• Key in “102”.• Press the [START] button.
Connector
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedFIRMWARE UPDATING
6 - 36
[B] Confirmation of the updated data
After the updating is completed, check each data version in Setting Mode (08) to confirm that the data was overwritten properly.
<Updating Engine ROM>08-903: Engine ROM version
<Updating Scanner ROM>08-905: Scanner ROM version
<Updating RADF ROM>08-907: RADF ROM version
<Updating Finisher ROM>08-908: Finisher ROM version
<Updating FAX ROM>08-915: FAX ROM version
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cFIRMWARE UPDATING
6 - 37
6
6.2 Firmware Updating with USB Storage DeviceIn this equipment, it is feasible to update the firmware by connecting the USB storage device on which the firmware data is written to the USB connector mounted on the system control PC board and turning ON the power.The type of firmware to be updated can be selected on the LCD screen in this method. This allows to update only the necessary firmware individually or to update all firmware in a batch.The type of firmware which can be updated with this method are as follows in the table below.
Firmware StoredModel specific
folder nameData file name
Master data Hard disk
28_451C
1, 2, 3 ... n* The file name should be consecutive
numbers from 1 to “n” without file extension. The capacity of each file is approx. 8 MB. However, the file capacity of “n” (last number) may be less than 8 MB.
System ROM System control PC board(SYS board)* The system firmware is stored
into the hard disk from the FROM basic section software version “V1.01/2.30”.
firmImage0.bin, firmImage1.bin
Engine ROM Logic PC board(LGC board)
firmImage2.bin
Scanner ROM Scanning section control PC board(SLG board)
06/08
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedFIRMWARE UPDATING
6 - 38
Important: • Only the USB storage device which meets the following conditions should be used for updat-
ing. Be careful since updating with any device other than the above is never guaranteed.- A combination USB storage device with a flash memory (to be connected directly to the
USB port) and its capacity is between 64 MB to 512 MB (or 1 GB).- Operation of the USB storage device used for updating has been confirmed at the input
check of this equipment (Test mode 03).( P. 2-27 "2.2.1 Input check (Test mode 03)")
- A USB storage device which is complied with the following standards regulated by USB-IF (USB Implementers Forum)Class number: 8 (=08h) (Mass-storage class)Sub-class number: 6 (=06h) (SCSI transfer command set)Protocol number: 80 (=50h) (Bulk-Only)* Most common USB storage devices are complied with the specification above and can
be used for updating. However, the operation in all the Multi Functional Digital Color Systems and Multi Functional Digital Systems is not necessarily guaranteed since the most of these devices are developed based on the use in PC environment (Windows or Macintosh). Therefore, confirm thoroughly that the device is operational in the equip-ment for which the updating will be performed when purchasing the device.
• The data file for updating is stored in the model specific folder.Never change the model specific folder name since it is used for discriminating the data file when the updating data files for multiple models are stored in the USB storage device.
• Store the model specific folder in the root directory of the USB storage device.
• Storing the data file directly in the root directory is possible when the updating data files for one specific model is stored in the USB storage device.However, if the model specific folder for the same model as that of the data file stored in the root directory already exists, the model specific folder will have the priority.
• The USB storage device complied with USB1.1 and USB2.0 can be used for updating. How-ever, the update is performed in the speed of USB1.1 when the device complied with USB2.0 is used.
• Do not update the firmware by any storage device other than a flash memory (such as a USB connection type memory card reader, CD/DVD drive or hard disk) since it is never guaran-teed.
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cFIRMWARE UPDATING
6 - 39
6
Update programThe firmware can be updated to the latest version without considering the current one by storing the update program together with the firmware data file for updating in the USB Storage Device.
Fig. 6-42
Important: • The "mentusb.o" file stored in the root of the USB storage device is a common file in e-
STUDIO850 Series, e-STUDIO452 Series and e-STUDIO282 Series. To save the firmware of more than one model into one USB storage device, one "mentusb.o" file stored in the root of USB storage device is sufficient.
• Be careful not to mix up the "mentusb.o" file because there is a file whose name is the same in the localization tool.
Name File name Stored
Tool object for updating mentusb.o root
Update program dlFirmWare_28_451C [28_451c] folder(Model specific folder)
USB Storage Device
28_451c
dlFirmWare_28_451C
firmImage0.bin
1
3:
2
firmImage1.binfirmImage2.bin
mentusb.o
07/05
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedFIRMWARE UPDATING
6 - 40
[A] Update procedure
Important: • The file system of USB storage device should be formatted in FAT format. Be careful since
the devices formatted in FAT32 or NTFS format will not be operated. The file system can be confirmed on the properties in applications such as Explorer of Windows.
• Do not turn OFF the power during the update. The data could be damaged and not to be operated properly.
(1) Connect the USB storage device to the PC and write the model specific folder in which the data file is stored.• Confirm the model specific folder name and data file name before writing the data ( P. 6-37
"6.2 Firmware Updating with USB Storage Device").• The file system of USB storage device should be formatted in FAT format.• Windows 95 and NT do not support USB. Be careful since the data can not be written on the
devices in the PCs with these operating systems.
(2) Shut down the equipment.
(3) Take off the cover plate.
Fig. 6-43
(4) Connect the USB storage device to the USB connector (host) on the SYS board.
Fig. 6-44
Cover plate
USB connector (host)
USB storage device
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cFIRMWARE UPDATING
6 - 41
6
(5) Turn ON the power while [4] button and [9] button are pressed simultaneously.When the update program is used, the following screen appears.
Fig. 6-45
After the update program is finished being loaded, the following screen appears.
Fig. 6-46
Note: Note: If the "dlFirmWare_28_451C" file of the update program is not stored in the USB storage device though "mentusb.o" file exists, or the loading of the update program fails, the following screen appears. In this case, check if the update program is correctly stored and repeat step (5) and after.
Fig. 6-47
07/05
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedFIRMWARE UPDATING
6 - 42
(6) Check the items to be updated.The screen for selecting the items to be updated is displayed after 3 minutes. “*” is displayed next to the items to be updated. (When the FROM basic section software version of the equip-ment is "V1.00 / 8.22" or earlier: All items other than "0. OS Update" are selected in the default settings. When the FROM basic section software version of the equipment is "V1.01 / 2.30" or later: All items are selected in the default settings.)
When the FROM basic section software version of the equipment is "V1.00 / 8.22" or earlier:
Fig. 6-48
Note: Note: The display of items on this screen varies depending on the types of data written on the USB storage device. Each item is displayed only when each data file is written on the USB storage device in the following conditions.
Item Condition
0. OS Update firmImage0.bin is written.
1. HDD Update All master data files (1, 2, 3 ... n) are written.
2. UI Data Update firmImage0.bin is written.
3. System Firmware Update firmImage0.bin and firmImage1.bin are written.
4. Engine Firmware Update firmImage2.bin is written.
5. Scanner Firmware Update firmImage2.bin is written.
07/05
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cFIRMWARE UPDATING
6 - 43
6
When the FROM basic section software version of the equipment is "V1.01 / 2.30" or later:
Fig. 6-49
Note: Note: The display of items on this screen varies depending on the types of data written on the USB storage device. Each item is displayed only when each data file is written on the USB storage device in the following conditions.
If the USB storage device is not recognized properly, the following message is displayed. In this case, disconnect the USB storage device and connect it again within 3 minutes, or turn OFF the power of the equipment and connect the device properly. Then repeat the procedure from (5).
Fig. 6-50
Item Condition
1. OS UI Update firmImage0.bin, firmImage1.bin are written.
2. HDD SYS Update All master data files (1, 2, 3 ... n) are written.
3. Engine Firmware Update firmImage2.bin is written.
4. Scanner Firmware Update firmImage2.bin is written.
06/08
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedFIRMWARE UPDATING
6 - 44
If the updating data file does not exist or a data file for other model is stored, the following mes-sage is displayed. In this case, turn OFF the power of the equipment and confirm if the data file stored in the USB storage device is correct. Then repeat the procedure from (5).
Note: Note: "If you still want to continue, Please Push Start Key" will not be displayed if the FROM basic sec-tion software version of the equipment is "V1.01 / 2.30" or later.
Fig. 6-51
If an attempt to update the FROM basic section software "V1.00 / 8.22" or earlier version to the latest firmware version without the update program, the following screen appears. In this case, store "mentusb.o" and "dlFirmWare_28_451C", which are the files for update program, in the specified folder and repeat step (5) and after.
Fig. 6-52
07/05
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cFIRMWARE UPDATING
6 - 45
6
(7) Select the item with the digital keys.“*” is displayed next to the selected item. Display or delete the “*” by pressing the number of the item. All items are selected in the default settings.• Select all items to update the firmware of the equipment in a batch.• Select items as follows to update individually.
Example: Updating the master data and system ROMWhen the FROM basic section software version of the equipment is "V1.00 / 8.22" or earlier:
Fig. 6-53
When the FROM basic section software version of the equipment is "V1.01 / 2.30" or later:
Fig. 6-54
(Updating all the items is taken as an example and explained in the following procedures.)
Types of Firmware
Items <Items vary depending on the FROM basic section software
version of the equipment>
"V1.00/8.22" or earlier "V1.01/2.30" or later
System ROM(OS data)
0. OS Update 1. OS UI Update
System ROM(UI data)
2. UI Data Update
Master data 1. HDD Update 2. HDD SYS Update
System ROM(System firmware)
3. System Firmware Update
Engine ROM 4. Engine Firmware Update 3. Engine Firmware Update
Scanner ROM 5. Scanner Firmware Update 4. Scanner Firmware Update
06/08
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedFIRMWARE UPDATING
6 - 46
(8) Press the [START] button.Updating starts and the processing status is displayed on the LCD screen.
When the FROM basic section software version of the equipment is "V1.00 / 8.22" or earlier:
Fig. 6-55
When the FROM basic section software version of the equipment is "V1.01 / 2.30" or later:
Fig. 6-56
Status display during update Status display when update is completed
OS Update ....... OS Update .................... Completed
HD Data Update ....... HD Data Update ............Completed
UI Data Update ....... UI Data Update ..............Completed
SysFirm Update ....... SysFirm Update .............Completed
Engine MAIN Update .....Flash Update Engine MAIN Update .... Completed
Scanner Firm Update..... Flash Update Scanner Firm Update..... Completed
Status display during update Status display when update is completed
OS UI Update....... OS UI Update...................... Completed
HDD SYS Update....... HDD SYS Update ............... Completed
Engine MAIN Update .....Flash Update Engine MAIN Update........... Completed
Scanner Firm Update..... Flash Update Scanner Firm Update ..........Completed
06/08
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cFIRMWARE UPDATING
6 - 47
6
(9) “Update Completed.” is displayed at the bottom of the LCD screen after the updating is com-pleted properly.
When the FROM basic section software version of the equipment is "V1.00 / 8.22" or earlier:
Fig. 6-57
When the FROM basic section software version of the equipment is "V1.01 / 2.30" or later:
Fig. 6-58
06/08
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedFIRMWARE UPDATING
6 - 48
“Update Failed.” is displayed at the bottom of the LCD screen when the updating is not com-pleted properly. “Failed” appears next to the failed item on the status display. Turn OFF the power, and then check the following items. After confirming and clearing the problems, restart updating from the beginning.• Does the USB storage device meet the conditions to be used for updating ( P. 6-37 "6.2
Firmware Updating with USB Storage Device")?• Is the data file written properly on the USB storage device?• Is the USB storage device installed properly?• Do the USB storage device and equipment operate properly?
When the FROM basic section software version of the equipment is "V1.00 / 8.22" or earlier:
Fig. 6-59
When the FROM basic section software version of the equipment is "V1.01 / 2.30" or later:
Fig. 6-60
(10) Turn OFF the power, remove the USB storage device and install the cover plate.
(11) Perform the initialization of the updating data.• Turn ON the power while [0] button and [8] button are pressed simultaneously.• Key in “947”, and then press the [START] button.• Press the [INITIALIZE] button.
06/08
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cFIRMWARE UPDATING
6 - 49
6
[B] Confirmation of the updated data
After the updating is completed, check each data version in the Setting Mode (08) to confirm that the data was overwritten properly.
<Updating Master data>08-924: Version of UI data language 1 in HDD08-925: Version of UI data language 2 in HDD08-926: Version of UI data language 3 in HDD08-927: Version of UI data language 4 in HDD08-928: Version of UI data language 5 in HDD08-929: Version of UI data language 6 in HDD08-931: Version of UI data language 7 in HDD08-933: HDD unit data version08-934: Version of Web UI data language 1 in HDD08-935: Version of Web UI data language 2 in HDD08-936: Version of Web UI data language 3 in HDD08-937: Version of Web UI data language 4 in HDD08-938: Version of Web UI data language 5 in HDD08-939: Version of Web UI data language 6 in HDD
<Updating System ROM>08-900: System ROM version08-922: UI data fixed section version08-923: UI data common section version08-930: Version of UI data in FROM displayed at power ON
<Updating Engine ROM>08-903: Engine ROM version
<Updating Scanner ROM>08-905: Scanner ROM version
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedFIRMWARE UPDATING
6 - 50
[C] Display during the update (When the FROM basic section software version of the equip-ment is "V1.00 / 8.22" or earlier)
Update is performed in parallel as shown in the transition diagram below.
Below is an example of the changes of the LCD screen during update.Note that the screen order may be different from the actual one, because a parallel update is performed in the process.
The initial screen is displayed and the recogni-tion of the USB storage device connected to the equipment is started.
When the device is recognized properly, the screen for selecting update items is displayed.
Item Selection Screen for Update
Update Completed
[System ROM] [Engine ROM] [scanner ROM]
4. EngineFirmware Update
[Master data]
5. Scanner
Firmware Update0. OS Update 1. HDD Update
2. UI Data Update
3. SystemFirmware Update
Turn ON the power while [4] button and [9] button are pressed simultaneously
06/08
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cFIRMWARE UPDATING
6 - 51
6
Select items to be updated and press the [START] button to start updating the [System ROM], [Master Data], [Engine ROM] and [Scanner ROM] in parallel.
When the [System ROM]-[OS Update] has been updated, “OS Update…Completed” is displayed and the [UI Update] update will start.
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedFIRMWARE UPDATING
6 - 52
When the [System ROM]-[UI Update] has been updated, “UI Data Update…Completed” is dis-played and the [System Firmware Update] update will start.
When the [Engine ROM] has been updated, “Engine MAIN Update..Flash Update” is changed to “Engine MAIN Update..Completed”.
When the [System ROM]-[System Firmware Update] has been updated, “SysFirm Update…Completed” is displayed.
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cFIRMWARE UPDATING
6 - 53
6
When the [Master Data] has been updated, “HD Data Update…Completed” is displayed.
When the [Scanner ROM] has been updated, “Scanner Firm Update..Flash Update” is changed to “Scanner Firm Update..Completed”.
When all data has been updated, “Update Completed” is displayed.
File name of master data
Total files
Copies
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedFIRMWARE UPDATING
6 - 54
* If the USB storage device is not recognized properly, the following message is displayed and the update is interrupted.
* “Update Failed.” is displayed at the bottom of the LCD screen when the updating is not completed properly. “Failed” appears next to the failed item on the status display.
Error messageFailed items
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cFIRMWARE UPDATING
6 - 55
6
[D] Display during the update (When the FROM basic section software version of the equip-ment is "V1.01 / 2.30" or later)
Update is performed in parallel as shown in the transition diagram below.
Below is an example of the changes of the LCD screen during update.
The initial screen is displayed and the recogni-tion of the USB storage device connected to the equipment is started.
When the device is recognized properly, the screen for selecting update items is displayed.
Item Selection Screen for Update
Update Completed
[System ROM] [Engine ROM] [Scanner ROM]
3. EngineFirmware Update
[Master data]
4. Scanner
Firmware Update1. OS UI Update 2. HDD SYS Update
Turn ON the power while [4] button and [9] button are pressed simultaneously
06/08
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedFIRMWARE UPDATING
6 - 56
Select items to be updated and press the [START] button.
When the [OS data] / [UI data] has been updated, “OS UI Update…Completed” is dis-played.
06/08
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cFIRMWARE UPDATING
6 - 57
6
When the [Engine ROM] has been updated, “Engine MAIN Update..Flash Update” is changed to “Engine MAIN Update..Completed”.
When the [Master Data] / [System firmware] has been updated, “HDD SYS Update…Completed” is displayed.
When the [Scanner ROM] has been updated, “Scanner Firm Update..Flash Update” is changed to “Scanner Firm Update..Completed”.
When all data has been updated, “Update Completed” is displayed.
File name of master data
Total files
Copies
06/08
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedFIRMWARE UPDATING
6 - 58
* If the USB storage device is not recognized properly, the following message is displayed and the update is interrupted.
* “Update Failed.” is displayed at the bottom of the LCD screen when the updating is not completed properly. “Failed” appears next to the failed item on the status display.
Error messageFailed items
06/08
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cFIRMWARE UPDATING
6 - 59
6
6.2.1 Appendix
[A] Assist Mode
This equipment has the Assist Mode to enable the following functions.
(1) NVRAM flag clearing (“Clear NvRAM flags.”)Even if the firmware downloading has been completed normally, the Recovery Mode may acci-dentally start up when the power is turned ON again. In this case, clear the NVRAM flags used in the download process with this function. (Normally, the flags are automatically cleared in the download process.)Also in the case the Recovery Mode accidentally starts up after the replacement of NVRAM on the SYS board, the flags are cleared with this function.
(2) Data storage partition formatting (“Format Loader Partition.”)When a defection occurs on the UI data, etc. which are stored in the HDD, the partition with the stored UI data, etc. is formatted with this function. (Do not use this function since it is not nor-mally necessary.)
(3) HDD partition creation (“All Partition Delete and Create Loader Partition.”)When the HDD is replaced or UI data, etc. are downloaded using the USB storage, it is neces-sary to format a partition in the HDD before downloading. In this case, the partition is created in the HDD with this function.
Notes: 1. When downloading with a download jig, it is not necessary to format a partition in advance.2. Perform the HDD partition formatting only when a new HDD and scrambler board are installed
since all data in the current HDD are erased by this operation.
[B] Operating Procedure of Assist Mode
(1) Turn ON the power while [3] button and [CLEAR] button are pressed simultaneously.• The following screen is displayed.
Fig. 6-61
(2) Select the item with the digital keys and press the [START] button.
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedFIRMWARE UPDATING
6 - 60
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cPOWER SUPPLY UNIT
7 - 1
7
7. POWER SUPPLY UNIT
7.1 Output ChannelThe followings are three output channels which are not linked with the cover switch.
1) +3.3V+3.3VA: CN464 Pins 9, 10 and 11
Output to the SYS board+3.3VB: CN464 Pins 15 and 16
Output to the SYS board+3.3VB: CN466 Pin 3
Output to the LGC board+3.3VB: CN467 Pins 17 and 18
Output to the SLG board
2) +5.1V+5.1VA: CN464 Pins 21, 22, 23 and 24
Output to the SYS board+5.1VB: CN464 Pin 19
Output to the SYS board+5.1VB: CN466 Pin 1
Output to the LGC board, PFP/LCF (via LGC board), Bridge unit (via LGC board)+5.1VB: CN467 Pins 5 and 6
Output to the RADF+5.1VB: CN467 Pins 21 and 22
Output to the SLG board+5.1VB: CN468 Pin 4
Output to the finisher+5.1VB: CN469 Pin 5
Output to the FIL board
3) +12V+12VA: CN464 Pin 5
Output to the SYS board+12VB: CN464 Pin 3
Output to the SYS board+12VB: CN466 Pin 16
Output to the LGC board+12VB: CN471 Pin 1
Output to the FAX unit
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedPOWER SUPPLY UNIT
7 - 2
The followings are two output channels which are linked with the cover switch.
1) +5.1V+5.1VD: CN466 Pin 11
Output to the LGC board
2) +24V+24VD1: CN465 Pins 1 and 2
Output to the LGC board, Bridge unit (via LGC board)+24VD1: CN469 Pins 1 and 2
Output to the PFP/LCF+24VD1: CN470 Pin 1
Output to the power supply cooling fan+24VD2: CN465 Pins 5 and 6
Output to the DRV board+24VD3: CN467 Pins 1 and 2
Output to the RADF+24VD4: CN467 Pins 10, 12 and 14
Output to the SLG board+24VD5: CN468 Pin 2
Output to the finisher
Output voltage by the type of connectorMain switch line
Cover switch line
Connector Destination Voltage
CN464 SYS board +3.3VA, +3.3VB, +5.1VA, +5.1VB, +12VA, +12VB
CN466 LGC board, PFP/LCF (via LGC board), Bridge unit (via LGC board)
+3.3VB, +5.1VB, +12VB
CN467 SLG board, RADF +3.3VB, 5.1VB
CN468 Finisher +5.1VB
CN469 FIL board +5.1VB
CN471 FAX unit +12VB
Connector Destination Voltage
CN465 LGC board, DRV board, PFP/LCF (via LGC board), Bridge unit (via LGC board)
+24VD1, +24VD2
CN466 LGC board +5.1VD
CN467 SLG board, RADF +24VD3, +24VD4
CN468 Finisher +24VD5
CN469 PFP/LCF +24VD1
CN470 Power supply cooling fan +24VD1
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cPOWER SUPPLY UNIT
7 - 3
7
7.2 FuseWhen the power supply secondary fuse is blown out, confirm that there is no abnormally with each part using the following table.
Voltage Board/Unit Part Fuse type+24VD1 LGC Polygonal motor F3:8A (Semi time-lag)
Tray-up motorADU motorMain motorDeveloper motorTransport motorDrum cleaner brush motorTransfer belt cleaner auger motorToner motorLaser unit cooling fanIH control board cooling fanOzone exhaust fanInternal cooling fan2nd transfer roller contact clutchBypass feed clutchRegistration clutchUpper transport clutch (high speed)Upper transport clutch (low speed)Lower transport clutch (high speed)Lower transport clutch (low speed)Upper drawer feed clutchLower drawer feed clutchADU clutchColor developer toner supply clutchColor developer drive clutchBlack developer drive clutchBlack developer lifting clutchTransfer belt cleaner contact clutchBypass pickup solenoidImage quality sensor shutter solenoidColor auto-toner sensor shutter solenoidDischarge LEDKey copy counter / Copy key cardCharger cleaner motor
Power supply Power supply cooling fan PFP/LCF Bridge unit
+24VD2 DRV Revolver motor F4:8A (Semi time-lag)Exit motor
+24VD3 RADF+24VD4 SLG Exposure lamp (lamp inverter) F5:8A (Semi time-lag)
CCD drive circuit (CCD board)Scanner unit cooling fanScan motor
+24VD5 Finisher
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedPOWER SUPPLY UNIT
7 - 4
7.3 Configuration of Power Supply Unit
Fig. 7-1
IH
F1
F2
Regulator Regulator
+2
4V
D1
C
N4
70
P
ow
er
su
pp
ly c
oo
ling
fa
n
+2
4V
D4
C
N4
67
S
LG
bo
ard
+5
.1V
D
CN
46
6
LG
C b
oa
rd
+3
.3V
A
CN
46
4
SY
S b
oa
rd
+5
.1V
A
CN
46
4
SY
S b
oa
rd
+1
2V
B
CN
46
6
LG
C b
oa
rd
+1
2V
A
CN
46
4
SY
S b
oa
rd
+2
4V
D5
C
N4
68
F
inis
he
r
+2
4V
D3
C
N4
67
R
AD
F
+1
2V
B
CN
46
4
SY
S b
oa
rd
+1
2V
B
CN
47
1
FA
X u
nit
+2
4V
D2
C
N4
65
D
RV
bo
ard
+3
.3V
B
CN
46
4
SY
S b
oa
rd
+3
.3V
B
CN
46
6
LG
C b
oa
rd
+3
.3V
B
CN
46
7
SL
G b
oa
rd
+5
.1V
B
CN
46
4
SY
S b
oa
rd
+5
.1V
B
CN
46
6
LG
C b
oa
rd,
PF
P/L
CF
(via
LG
C b
oa
rd),
B
rid
ge
un
it (
via
LG
C b
oa
rd)
+5
.1V
B
CN
46
7
SL
G b
oa
rd,
RA
DF
+5
.1V
B
CN
46
8
Fin
ish
er
+5
.1V
B
CN
46
9
FIL
bo
ard
+2
4V
D1
C
N4
65
L
GC
bo
ard
, B
rid
ge
un
it (
via
LG
C b
oa
rd)
+2
4V
D1
C
N4
69
P
FP
/LC
F
CN460 CN460
Liv
e
Ma
in s
witch
Co
ve
ro
pe
nin
g/c
losin
gin
terlo
ck s
witch
Sw
itch
ing
re
gu
lato
r
No
ise
filte
r
No
ise
filte
r
Ne
utr
al
Bre
ake
r
F4
F3
F5
FIL
bo
ard
ICP
1
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cREMOTE SERVICE
8 - 1
8
8. REMOTE SERVICE
There are following functions as Remote Service.
(1) Auto Supply OrderAutomatically orders the toner and used toner container by FAX or E-mail.
(2) Service NotificationNotifies the status of the equipment to the service technician by E-mail or FAX.
8.1 Auto Supply Order
8.1.1 OutlineAutomatically orders the toner and used toner container.
(1) Placing an OrderThere are two ways to place an order.
• FAXInstallation of the FAX board is required.If the FAX board has not been installed, it is regarded as OFF setting.
• E-mail (E-mail body + TIFF image)
(2) Order IntervalsWhen the toner empty occurs, the number of occurrences is counted. And when it reaches the specified number for CONDITION, the order is placed automatically.With regard to the used toner container, it is done according to the number of the used toner con-tainer full detection.The number of the CONDITION can be set respectively for the toner and used toner container.
(3) If Order Failure OccursIf some problems occur and the order cannot be placed after registering an order as a job, refer to the standard countermeasure for the FAX/E-mail transmission failure.
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedREMOTE SERVICE
8 - 2
8.1.2 Setting ItemTo enable Auto Supply Order, the following settings are required.
Note: Note: When selecting E-mail to place an order, it is required that sending and receiving E-mails are available. Confirm the details to the administrator.
(1) Self-diagnosis (08) SettingAs the default setting, the Auto Supply Order setting screen is not displayed on the touch panel.To display it, switching the Valid/Invalid setting (08-765) is required. 0: Valid (FAX/Internet FAX) 1: Valid (FAX/Internet FAX/HTTP)* 2: Invalid (Default)When changing the setting value from "2" (default) to "0", the Auto Supply Order setting screen is displayed. (* HTTP has not been supported yet.)
(2) Touch Panel SettingEach item is set from the Auto Supply Order screen on the touch panel.
Entering the password and customer information is required because the setting is made from the ADMIN screen. Setting it with the administrator is a must.
• Basic setting[ADMIN] > [SERVICE] > [SUPPLY ORDER SETUP] > [ORDER INFORMATION]
*1 HTTP has not been supported yet.*2 Even when "FAX" is selected, the order is not placed without entering the FAX number.*3 Even when "MAIL" is selected, the order is not placed without entering the E-mail address.
AUTO SUPPLY ORDER Ordered by: [FAX], [MAIL], [HTTP] (*1)
FAX NUMBER FAX number of supplier (*2)
E-MAIL E-mail address of supplier (*3)
CUSTOMER Customer information
NAME
TEL NUMBER
ADDRESS
SUPPLIER Supplier information
NAME
ADDRESS
SERVICE TECNICIAN Service technician information
NUMBER
NAME
TEL NUMBER
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cREMOTE SERVICE
8 - 3
8
• Detailed setting for the order[ADMIN] > [SERVICE] > [SUPPLY ORDER SETUP] > [TONER ORDERING]
* The order is placed when the number of replacement reaches the number specified for the CONDITION.
• FAX number of this equipment (common information)[ADMIN] > [FAX] > [TERMINAL ID]
• E-mail information of this equipment (common information)[ADMIN] > [E-MAIL]
* When sending an E-mail, validity of the address is checked. If the address is invalid, it is not sent.
(3) Output of setting list of the Auto Supply Order Keying in the following buttons and keys prints the setting list.[USER FUNCTIONS] [USER] [LISTS] [*] [#] [*] [*] [3] [8] [START]
***** TONER ORDER Order information (TONER /USED TONER CONTAINER)
PART NUMBER Part number to be ordered
CONDITIOIN The number of conditions (*)
QUANTITY The quantity to be ordered
AUTO ORDER ON/OFF setting of order for each part
ID NAME ID name of this equipment
FAX NUMBER FAX number of this equipment
FROM ADDRESS E-mail address of this equipment (*)
FROM NAME E-mail username of this equipment
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedREMOTE SERVICE
8 - 4
8.1.3 Setting procedure
(1) Start up the self-diagnosis setting mode 08-765, and then change the setting value to "0".
(2) Turn the power OFF, and then ON.
(3) Press the [USER FUNCTIONS] button to enter the user function screen.
(4) Press the [ADMIN] button.• When the Administrator Password has been set, ADMINISTRATOR PASSWORD screen is
displayed.
Fig. 8-1
(5) Press the [PASSWORD] button and the screen is switched to a full keyboard. Then key in the Administrator Password and press the [ENTER] button.* Confirm the password to the administrator.
Fig. 8-2
(6) Press the [SERVICE] button in the ADMIN screen.
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cREMOTE SERVICE
8 - 5
8
(7) The SERVICE screen is displayed.
Fig. 8-3
(8) Press the [SUPPLY ORDER SETUP] button.
Fig. 8-4
(9) Press the [ORDER INFORMATION] button.
(10) The ORDER INFORMATION screen is displayed.
Fig. 8-5
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedREMOTE SERVICE
8 - 6
(11) Press the buttons on the screen of ORDER INFORMATION to set the required item.
(12) Press the [NEXT] button.(Press the [ENTER] button to register, and then the screen returns to the (7) SERVICE screen.Press the [CANCEL] button to cancel this register, and then the screen returns to the (7) SER-VICE screen.)
(13) The CUSTOMER/SUPPLIER screen is displayed.
Fig. 8-6
(14) Press the buttons of the screen of CUSTOMER/SUPPLIER to set the required item.CUSTOMER[NAME] Input the name of customer.[TEL NUMBER] Input the telephone number of customer.[E-MAIL] Input the E-mail address of customer.[ADDRESS] nput the address of customer.
SUPPLIER[NAME] Input the name of supplier.[ADDRESS] Input the address of supplier.
(15) Press the [NEXT] button.
[FAX]/[MAIL]/[OFF] Select the [FAX] or the [MAIL] button for the transmitting way of order. (HTTP has not been supported yet.)[OFF]: Turn off the AUTO SUPPLY ORDER function.
[FAX NUMBER] Input the FAX number of supplier.(To transmit by FAX, the order cannot be placed automatically if you do not input the number.)
[E-MAIL] Input the E-mail address of supplier.(To transmit by E-mail, the order cannot be placed automatically if you do not input the address.)
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cREMOTE SERVICE
8 - 7
8
(16) The SERVICE TECHNICIAN/ RESULT PRINTING screen is displayed.
Fig. 8-7
(17) Press a button on the screen of SERVICE TECHNICIAN/ RESULT PRINTING to set the required item.SERVICE TECHNICIAN[NUMBER] Input the number of SERVICE TECHNICIAN.[NAME] Input the name of SERVICE TECHNICIAN.[TEL NUMBER] Input the telephone number of SERVICE TECHNICIAN.[E-MAIL] Input the E-mail address of SERVICE TECHNICIAN.[DESCRIPTION] Input the remarks if you want to register.
RESULT PRINTING[OFF] / [ALWAYS] / [ON ERROR]
Whichever you press, the result list is printed.
(18) Press the [ENTER] button to register and complete the order information setting.
(19) The SERVICE screen is returned.
Fig. 8-8
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedREMOTE SERVICE
8 - 8
(20) Press the [SUPPLY ORDER SETUP] button.
Fig. 8-9
(21) Press the [TONER ORDERING] button.
(22) The TONER ORDERING screen is displayed.
Fig. 8-10
(23) Press the [YELLOW(Y)] button. (Select the part to be ordered.)
Fig. 8-11
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cREMOTE SERVICE
8 - 9
8
(24) Input the order information of TONER.
AUTO ORDER
(25) Press the [ENTER] button to register the setting of toner order.
(26) The TONER ORDERING screen is displayed.
Fig. 8-12
(27) Press the [MAGENTA(M)] / [CYAN(C)] / [BLACK(K)] / [USED TONER CONTAINER] button, and then input the order information in the same way.
Fig. 8-13
(28) Press the [ENTER] button to register the order information.
(29) The screen returns to the TONER ORDERING.
(30) Press the [USER FUNCTION] button to be switched from the ADMIN screen on touch panel and returned to the BASIC screen, so that the setting of Auto Supply Order is finished.
[PART NUMBER] Toner number[CONDITION] The order is placed when the number of toner empty reaches the number
specified for the CONDITION.[QUANTITY] Quantity to be ordered
[ON]/[OFF] Allows you to select whether each part to be ordered is placed automati-cally or not.
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedREMOTE SERVICE
8 - 10
Note: Note: Auto Supply Order setting is also available from the following setting mode (08).
Items 08 code Contents
The transmitting way of order[FAX]/[MAIL] /[OFF]
732 0: Ordered by FAX1: Ordered by E-mail2: Ordered by HTTP3: OFF
SUPPLIER[FAX NUMBER]
733 Maximum 32 digits
SUPPLIER[E-MAIL]
734 Maximum 192 letters
CUSTOMER[NAME]
738 Maximum 50 letters
CUSTOMER[TEL NUMBER]
739 Maximum 32 digits
CUSTOMER[E-MAIL]
740 Maximum 192 letters
CUSTOMER[ADDRESS]
741 Maximum 100 letters
SUPPLIER[NAME]
746 Maximum 50 letters
SUPPLIER[ADDRESS]
747 Maximum 100 letters
SERVICE TECHNICIAN[NUMBER]
742 Maximum 5 digits
SERVICE TECHNICIAN[NAME]
743 Maximum 50 letters
SERVICE TECHNICIAN[TEL NUMBER]
744 Maximum 32 digits
SERVICE TECHNICIAN[E-MAIL]
745 Maximum 192 letters
Remarks[DESCRIPTION]
748 Maximum 128 letters
YELLOW(Y) TONER[PART NUMBER]
755 Maximum 20 digits
YELLOW(Y) TONER[CONDITION]
757 1-99
YELLOW(Y) TONER[QUANTITY]
756 1-99
MAGENTA(M) TONER[PART NUMBER]
752 Maximum 20 digits
MAGENTA(M) TONER[CONDITION]
754 1-99
MAGENTA(M) TONER[QUANTITY]
753 1-99
CYAN(C) TONER[PART NUMBER]
749 Maximum 20 digits
CYAN(C) TONER[CONDITION]
751 1-99
CYAN(C) TONER[QUANTITY]
750 1-99
BLACK(K) TONER[PART NUMBER]
758 Maximum 20 digits
07/11
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cREMOTE SERVICE
8 - 11
8
8.1.4 Order Sheet FormatThe sample of order sheet is as follows.
(1) FAX (This format is the same as that of TIFF image attached E-mail.)*1 Part not to be ordered is not output. (Less space between the lines)
Fig. 8-14
BLACK(K) TONER[CONDITION]
760 1-99
BLACK(K) TONER[QUANTITY]
759 1-99
USED TONER CONTAINER[PART NUMBER]
761 Maximum 20 digits
USED TONER CONTAINER[CONDITION]
763 1-99
USED TONER CONTAINER[QUANTITY]
762 1-99
Items 08 code Contents
DATE & TIME :99-99-'99 99:99
CUSTOMER NUMBER :XXX
CUSTOMER NAME :XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX
CUSTOMER ADDRESS :XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX
CUSTOMER TEL NUMBER :XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX
CUSTOMER E-MAIL ADDRESS :XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX
SERVICE TECHNICIAN TEL NUMBER :XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX
SERVICE TECHNICIAN E-MAIL :XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX
SUPPLIER NAME :XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX
SUPPLIER ADDRESS :XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX
PART NUMBER QUANTITY
TONER CARTRIDGE
CYAN : XXXXXXXXXXXX 99
MAGENTA : XXXXXXXXXXXX 99
YELLOW : XXXXXXXXXXXX 99
BLACK : XXXXXXXXXXXX 99
USED TONER CONTAINER : XXXXXXXXXXXX 99
DESCRIPTION AREA ..............................................
.................................................................
DEVICE DESCRIPTION :XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX
SERIAL NUMBER :XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX
DEVICE FAX NUMBER :XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX
DEVICE E-MAIL ADDRESS :XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX
TOTAL BLACK TWIN COLOR FULL COLOR
PRINT COUNTER 999999999 999999999 999999999 999999999
SCAN COUNTER 999999999 999999999 999999999 999999999
(*1)
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedREMOTE SERVICE
8 - 12
(2) E-MAIL (TIFF image attached with the E-mail is the same format with that of the FAX order sheet.)SUBJECT: SUPPLY ORDER REQUEST*1 Part not to be ordered is not output. (Less space between the lines)
Fig. 8-15
(3) Result list*1 Part not to be ordered is not output. (Less space between the lines)
Fig. 8-16
Date&Time: '05-06-14 00:17
Customer Number: S01 MachineName: TOSHIBA e-STUDIO451c
SerialNumber: 1234567890
Device FAX Number:
Device Email: [email protected]
OrderInformation:
YELLOW PartNumber: YELLOW-03 Quantity:17
CounterInformation:
PrintCounter(Small) FullColor: 0 TwinColor: 0 Black: 141
PrintCounter(Large) FullColor: 0 TwinColor: 0 Black: 0
ScanCounter FullColor: 0 TwinColor: 0 Black: 7
(*1)
ORDER XXXXXXXXX
DATE & TIME :99-99-'99 99:99
CUSTOMER NUMBER :XXX
CUSTOMER NAME :XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX
CUSTOMER ADDRESS :XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX
CUSTOMER TEL NUMBER :XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX
CUSTOMER E-MAIL ADDRESS :XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX
SERVICE TECHNICIAN
TEL NUMBER :XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX
SERVICE TECHNICIAN E-MAIL :XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX
SUPPLIER NAME :XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX
SUPPLIER ADDRESS :XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX
PART NUMBER QUANTITY
TONER CARTRIDGE
CYAN : XXXXXXXXXXXX 99
MAGENTA : XXXXXXXXXXXX 99
YELLOW : XXXXXXXXXXXX 99
BLACK : XXXXXXXXXXXX 99
USED TONER CONTAINER : XXXXXXXXXXXX 99
DESCRIPTION AREA ..............................................
.................................................................
DEVICE DESCRIPTION :XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX
SERIAL NUMBER :XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX
DEVICE FAX NUMBER :XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX
DEVICE E-MAIL ADDRESS :XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX
TOTAL BLACK TWIN COLOR FULL COLOR
PRINT COUNTER 999999999 999999999 999999999 999999999
SCAN COUNTER 999999999 999999999 999999999 999999999
(*1)
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cREMOTE SERVICE
8 - 13
8
8.2 Service Notification
8.2.1 OutlineThis function automatically notifies the status of the equipment to the service technician by E-mail or FAX. The following three are the items to be notified.
• Total Counter TransmitWhen this function is effective, it notifies each counter information periodically (on the set date and time every month).
• Service Call Transmit (E-mail only)When this function is effective, it notifies the corresponding error code and such at a service call error.
• PM Counter TransmitWhen this function is effective, it notifies that the PM timing has come when the present PM sheet count has reached to its setting value, or the present PM driving count has reached to its setting value.
8.2.2 Setting
Note: Note: When using this function, it is required that sending and receiving E-mails or FAXes are avail-able. Confirm the details to the administrator.
[ 1 ] PreparationThe screen to set this function is not displayed at the default setting.Set this screen to be displayed with the following code (08).
08-774 Setting of notification display0: Invalid (Default)1: Valid
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedREMOTE SERVICE
8 - 14
[ 2 ] Setting procedure
(1) Press the [USER FUNCTIONS] button and select the [ADMIN] button. Then enter the password and press the [ENTER] button.• Confirm the password to the administrator.
Fig. 8-17
(2) Press the [SERVICE] button.
Fig. 8-18
(3) Press the [SERVICE NOTIFICATION] button.
Fig. 8-19
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cREMOTE SERVICE
8 - 15
8
(4) Press the [E-MAIL] or [FAX] button in "SERVICE NOTIFICATION".• When the [OFF] button is pressed, all functions related Service Notification become ineffec-
tive.
Fig. 8-20
(5) Enter the E-mail address or FAX number of the destination.• When pressing the [E-MAIL] button, the screen is switched to a full keyboard. Then enter the
E-mail addresses and press the [ENTER] button. (Maximum 3 addresses can be set.)
Fig. 8-21
• Press the [FAX NUMBER] button, key in the FAX number and then press the [ENTER] button.
Fig. 8-22
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedREMOTE SERVICE
8 - 16
(6) Press the [ON] button to notify or the [OFF] button not to notify each item for E-mail and FAX.When Total Count Transmit is set to ON, the screen to set the notification date is displayed.Then set the notification date with the following procedure.
Fig. 8-23
Set the date and time of the Total Counter.The following 3 items can be specified for the date setting, and more than one day of the week also can be selected.• Day of the week (More than one day can be selected.)• Notify Date 1• Notify Date 2
You can send the Total Counter immediately without the above settings by pressing the [SEND NOW] button.
• Day of the week ([Sunday] to [Saturday] buttons)Pressing the buttons ([Sunday] to [Saturday]) of the desired day makes transmission on every specified day. More than one day can be selected.* This does not affect the settings of "Notify Date 1" and "Notify Date 2".
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cREMOTE SERVICE
8 - 17
8
• Notify Date 1 and Notify Date 2 ([DATE] button)Pressing the [DATE] button sets up to 2 dates on which you wand to send data.* This is not affected by the specified day of the week.
Fig. 8-24
Key in the date (acceptable values: 0-31) in "Notify Date 1" or "Notify Date 2" and press the [SET] button. ([SET] button not pressed: Correct the value after pressing the [CLEAR] button.[SET] button already pressed: Correct the value after pressing the [RESET] button to move the cursor back to the digit to be rectified.)
• Time setting ([CHANGE] button)Pressing the [CHANGE] button sets the time at which you wand to send data.This is the time when data are sent with "Day of the week", "Notify Date 1" and "Notify Date 2".
Fig. 8-25
Key in the time (acceptable values: 00:00-23:59) in "Time".Key in the time in the hour column of "Time", press the [SET] button, key in the time in the minute column of "Time" and press the [SET] button.([SET] button not pressed: Correct the value after pressing the [CLEAR] button.[SET] button already pressed: Correct the value after pressing the [RESET] button to move the cursor back to the digit to be rectified.)
After all the settings are completed, press the [ENTER] button. The display returns to the screen in step (5).
07/05
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedREMOTE SERVICE
8 - 18
(7) Press the [ENTER] button. The setting completes.
Note: Note: Service Notification setting is also available from the following setting mode (08).
Items 08 code Contents
Service Notification setting 767 0: OFF (Invalid) 1:E-mail 2:FAX
E-mail address 1 768 Maximum 192 letters
E-mail address 2 777 Maximum 192 letters
E-mail address 3 778 Maximum 192 letters
FAX number 1145 Maximum 32 digits
Total Counter Transmit setting 769 0: OFF (Invalid) 1: ON (Valid)
Total counter transmission date setting 770 0 to 31
Total counter transmission date setting(2) 9880 0 to 31
Day of total counter data transmission 9881 1 byte00000000(0)-01111111(127)From the 2nd bit - Sunday, Monday, Tuesday, Wednesday, Thursday, Fri-day, Saturday
Total counter transmission interval setting(Hour/Hour/Minute/Minute)
776 00:00-23:59
Service Call Transmit setting 775 0: OFF (Invalid) 1: ON (Valid)
PM Counter Transmit setting 771 0: OFF (Invalid) 1: ON (Valid)
07/05
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cREMOTE SERVICE
8 - 19
8
8.2.3 Items to be notifiedThe items to be notified are shown below.1) Total Counter Transmit / PM Counter Transmit by E-mail (XML file attached to E-mail has also the
same format.)Subject: Counter Notification(In case of the PM Counter Transmit, it is shown as "Periodical Maintenance Notification".)
Fig. 8-26
3
7
8
11
12
13
15
16
17
18
1920
21
22
23
2
4
1
5
6
9
10
14
24
2526
27
282930
31
Date : 01/01/2007 12:34 Machine Model : TOSHIBA e-STUDIO451cSerialNumber : 1234567890Total Counter : 00004787 Supplier: Name : SUPPLIER_NAME Tel Number : 1122334455 E-Mail : [email protected] Address : SUPPLIER_ADDRESS Customer: Name : CUSTOMER_NAME Tel Number : 1234567890 E-Mail : [email protected] Address : CUSTOMER_ADDRESS Service Technician: Number : svc12 Name : SERVICE_TECHNICIAN_NAME Tel Number : 0987654321 E-Mail : [email protected] ChargeCounterFormat: LargeSizeChargeCount 1 LargeSizeChargePaperDefinition 1 PMCounterFormat: LargeSizePMCount 1 LargeSizePMPaperDefinition 0 Charge Counter: Large Small <Print Counter> Full Color ------------------------------------- Copy 00000000 00000000 Print 00000000 00000000 Twin Color ------------------------------------ Copy 00000000 00000000 Black ------------------------------------------ Copy 00000000 00000000 Print 00000000 00000000 List 00000000 00000000 FAX 00000000 00000000 <Scan Counter> Full Color ------------------------------------- Copy Scan 00000000 00000000 Net Scan 00000000 00000000 Twin Color ------------------------------------ Copy Scan 00000000 00000000 Black ------------------------------------------ Copy Scan 00000000 00000000 FAX Scan 00000000 00000000 Net Scan 00000000 00000000 <FAX Counter> Transmit 00000000 00000000 Receive 00000000 00000000 Periodical Maintenance Counter: Set PM 00150000 Current PM 00004787 Set PMTime 00000000 CurrentPMTime 00000000 Printer Error History: Date Time ErrorCode ----------------------------------------------- 12/13/2006 16:44 F110 12/12/2006 22:28 F110 12/12/2006 22:23 F110 11/15/2006 22:23 F110 10/25/2006 11:12 F110
(*1)
07/05
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedREMOTE SERVICE
8 - 20
Date
Machine model name
Serial number
Total counter value
Supplier information
Customer information
Service technician information
Count setting of large-sized paper (Fee charging system counter)
Definition setting of large-sized paper (Fee charging system counter)
Count setting of large-sized paper (PM)
Definition setting of large-sized paper (PM)
Number of output pages in the Copier Function (FULL COLOR)
Number of output pages in the Printer Function (FULL COLOR)
Number of output pages in the Copier Function (TWIN COLOR)
Number of output pages in the Copier Function (BLACK)
Number of output pages in the Printer Function (BLACK)
Number of output pages at the List Print Mode (BLACK)
Number of output pages in the FAX Function (BLACK)
Number of scanning pages in the Copier Function (FULL COLOR)
Number of scanning pages in the Network Scanning Function (FULL COLOR)
Number of scanning pages in the Copier Function (TWIN COLOR)
Number of scanning pages in the Copier Function (BLACK)
Number of scanning pages in the FAX Function (BLACK)
Number of scanning pages in the Network Scanning Function (BLACK)
Number of transmitted pages in the FAX Function (BLACK)
Number of received pages in the FAX Function (BLACK)
PM sheet counter setting value
PM sheet counter present value
PM driving counter setting value
PM driving counter present value
History of error
*1 The latest 20 errors are displayed.
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
130
131
07/05
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cREMOTE SERVICE
8 - 21
8
2) Total Counter Transmit / PM Counter Transmit by FAX*1 In case of the PM Counter Transmit, the title is replaced to "PERIODICAL MAINTENANCE
NOTIFICATION".
Fig. 8-27
3
12
13
14
16
23
24
25
26
27
28
33
29
3031
32
2
4
1
5
6
9
8
10 11
15
19
20
21
17
18
22
7
CHARGE COUNTER FORMAT PM COUNTER FORMAT
LARGE SIZE CHARGE COUNT : 1 LARGE SIZE PM COUNT : 1
LARGE SIZE CHARGE PAPER DEFINITION : 1 LARGE SIZE PM PAPER DEFINITION : 0
CHARGE COUNTER
PRINT COUNTER SCAN COUNTER
FULL COLOR LARGE SMALL FULL COLOR LARGE SMALL
COPY 00000000 00000000 COPY SCAN 00000000 00000000
PRINT 00000000 00000000 NET SCAN 00000000 00000000
TWIN/MONO COLOR LARGE SMALL TWIN/MONO COLOR LARGE SMALL
COPY 00000000 00000000 COPY SCAN 00000000 00000000
PRINT 00000000 00000000 NET SCAN 00000000 00000000
BLACK LARGE SMALL BLACK LARGE SMALL
COPY 00000000 00000000 COPY SCAN 00000000 00000000
PRINT 00000000 00000000 FAX SCAN 00000000 00000000
LIST 00000000 00000000 NET SCAN 00000000 00000000
FAX 00000000 00000000
FAX COUNTER PERIODICAL MAINTENANCE COUNTER
LARGE SMALL
TRANSMIT 00000000 00000000 SET PM : 00000000
RECEIVE 00000000 00000000 CURRENT PM : 00000000
SET PM TIME : 00000000
CURRENT PM TIME : 00000000
PRINTER ERROR HISTORY
DATE TIME ERROR CODE DATE TIME ERROR CODE
06/12/13 16:44 F110
06/12/12 22:28 F110
06/12/12 22:23 F110
06/11/15 22:23 F110
06/10/25 11:12 F110
(*2)
COUNTER NOTIFICATION (*1)
COUNTER NOTIFICATION (*1)
DATE : '07-01-01 12:34
MACHINE MODEL : TOSHIBA e-STUDIO451c
SERIAL NUMBER : 1234567890
TOTAL COUNTER : 00004787
CUSTOMER NAME : CUSTOMER_NAME
CUSTOMER ADDRESS : CUSTOMER_ADDRESS
CUSTOMER TEL NUMBER : 1234567890
CUSTOMER E-MAIL ADDRESS : [email protected]
SUPPLIER NAME : SUPPLIER_NAME
SUPPLIER ADDRESS : SUPPLIER_ADDRESS
SUPPLIER FAX NUMBER : 5544332211
SUPPLIER E-MAIL : [email protected]
SERVICE TECHNICIAN NUMBER : svc12
SERVICE TECHNICIAN NAME : SERVICE_TECHNICIAN_NAME
SERVICE TECHNICIAN TEL NUMBER : 0987654321
SERVICE TECHNICIAN E-MAIL : [email protected]
Sheet 1
Sheet 2
07/05
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedREMOTE SERVICE
8 - 22
Date
Machine model name
Serial number
Total counter value
Customer information
Service technician information
Supplier information
Count setting of large-sized paper (Fee charging system counter)
Definition setting of large-sized paper (Fee charging system counter)
Count setting of large-sized paper (PM)
Definition setting of large-sized paper (PM)
Number of output pages in the Copier Function (FULL COLOR)
Number of output pages in the Printer Function (FULL COLOR)
Number of output pages in the Copier Function (TWIN COLOR)
Number of output pages in the Printer Function (TWIN COLOR)
Number of output pages in the Copier Function (BLACK)
Number of output pages in the Printer Function (BLACK)
Number of output pages at the List Print Mode (BLACK)
Number of output pages in the FAX Function (BLACK)
Number of scanning pages in the Copier Function (FULL COLOR)
Number of scanning pages in the Network Scanning Function (FULL COLOR)
Number of scanning pages in the Copier Function (TWIN COLOR)
Number of scanning pages in the Network Scanning Function (TWIN COLOR)
Number of scanning pages in the Copier Function (BLACK)
Number of scanning pages in the FAX Function (BLACK)
Number of scanning pages in the Network Scanning Function (BLACK)
Number of transmitted pages in the FAX Function (BLACK)
Number of received pages in the FAX Function (BLACK)
PM sheet counter setting value
PM sheet counter present value
PM driving counter setting value
PM driving counter present value
History of error
*2 The latest 20 errors are displayed.
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
130
131
32
33
07/05
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cREMOTE SERVICE
8 - 23
8
3) Service Call TransmitSubject: Service Call Notification
Fig. 8-28
4
5
6
1
2 3
7
8
9
10
11
Date: 01/01/2007 12:34
Machine Name: e-STUDIO451c SerialNumber:1234567890
Function: Printer
Severity: Error
ErrorCode: XXXX
Message:
XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX
Supplier:
Name : SUPPLIER_NAME
Tel Number : 1122334455
E-Mail : [email protected]
Address : SUPPLIER_ADDRESS
Customer:
Name : CUSTOMER_NAME
Tel Number : 1234567890
E-Mail : [email protected]
Address : CUSTOMER_ADDRESS
Service Technician:
Number : svc12
Name : SERVICE_TECHNICIAN_NAME
Tel Number : 0987654321
E-Mail : [email protected]
Printer Error History:
Date Time ErrorCode
------------------------------------------
12/13/2006 16:44 F110
12/12/2006 22:28 F110
12/12/2006 22:23 F110
11/15/2006 22:23 F110
10/25/2006 11:12 F110
(*1)
07/05
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedREMOTE SERVICE
8 - 24
Date (When an error occurs)
Machine model name
Serial number
Function: Fixed at "Printer"
Severity: Fixed at "Error"
Error code
Error message: The content of error is displayed.
Supplier information
Customer information
Service technician information
History of error
*1 The latest 20 errors are displayed.
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
07/05
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cDATA CLONING with USB STORAGE DEVICE
9 - 1
9
9. DATA CLONING with USB STORAGE DEVICE
In this equipment, the user data, setting items and SRAM data can be backed up / restored by turning the power ON after connecting the USB storage device on which the data cloning programs have been written to the USB connector mounted on the SYS board.The type of data to be backed up/restored can be selected on the LCD screen in this method.This allows you to back up/restore only the necessary data individually or to back up/restore all data in a batch.Programs needed for data cloning with this method are given in the following table.
Important: • It is assumed that data cloning is to be performed when equipment is installed or options are
installed. If the address book has been registered, do not perform data cloning. Registered / set data are lost.
• The USB storage device for the data cloning must meet the following conditions. A data clon-ing operation with any devices other than the following will not be guaranteed.- A combination USB storage device with a flash memory (to be connected directly to the
USB port) and its capacity is between 128 MB and 512 MB (or 1 GB).- A device compliant with the following specifications established by USB-IF (USB Imple-
menters Forum)Class number: 8 (=08h) (Mass storage class)Sub-Class number: 6 (=06h) (SCSI transfer command set)Protocol number: 80 (=50h) (Bulk-only)
* Most of the common USB storage devices are compliant with the above specifications and are therefore applicable to this data cloning. However, most of these devices were origi-nally developed to be used in an environment for PCs (e.g. Windows or Macintosh) and thus operations exclusively with this equipment have not been fully guaranteed. Therefore, the user must thoroughly check in advance whether there will be any problem in operating with this equipment when adopting one of these devices.
• The USB storage devices compliant with both USB 1.1 and USB 2.0 can be used for this data cloning. However, the operating speed when using a device compliant with USB 2.0 is equiv-alent to the one with a device compliant with USB 1.1.
• Data cloning with any storage devices other than a flash memory (e.g. USB-connectable memory card reader, CD/DVD drive, hard disk) will never be guaranteed. Therefore never use them for this operation.
• Be sure to unplug the LAN cable and Fax line before data are backed up / restored. Also, do not use the RADF and open the cover, drawer, etc. during the data cloning.
• Data can be backed up / restored only for the same model and version. If the version is differ-ent, update the firmware and back up / restore data in the same version.
• Restore data to equipment which has the same options as when the data are backed up.• If "Department management" or "User management information" is restored, the counter val-
ues are copied as well, so clear all of them. However, the total counter is not copied.• Before starting data cloning, check that “Acceptance of data cloning using USB storage
device (08-9889)” is set at "0" (Accepted). If this is set at "1" (Not accepted), data cloning is disabled. In this case, ask the administrator to enable it on the TopAccess menu.
• Delete the backed up data in the USB storage device after the data cloning.
Storage location Program file nameRoot directory rootusb, clone_28_451c
07/11
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedDATA CLONING with USB STORAGE DEVICE
9 - 2
[A] Data cloning procedure (Backup)
Important: • The file system for the USB storage device should be in the FAT format. Note that any device
formatted in FAT32 or NTFS will not be operated. Its file system can be confirmed by opening the properties of the device from Windows Explorer.
• Never turn the power of the equipment OFF during data cloning, or the data could be dam-aged and the operation not carried out properly.
• Back up or restore SRAM data only for the same equipment in the same ROM version. If SRAM data are restored into the other equipment, problems such as overlapping serial num-bers may occur.
(1) Connect the USB storage device to the PC and delete all data in the USB storage device.• The file system for the USB storage device should be in the FAT format.• Windows95 and NT do not support USB. The data cannot be written into the device with the
PC in which these OS are installed.
(2) Write the program file.• Write the data cloning program into the root directory.
(3) Shut down the equipment.
(4) Connect the USB storage device to the USB connector (host) on the SYS board.
Fig. 9-1
USB connector (host)
USB storage device
07/11
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cDATA CLONING with USB STORAGE DEVICE
9 - 3
9
<User Data Backup>
(5) Turn the power ON while pressing the [5] and [9] button simultaneously.The screen to select the backup/restore items is displayed.
Fig. 9-2
Note: Note: When “Disable” is set for the [Data Cloning Function] in TopAccess, the following screen is dis-played. Contact and ask the administrator to change the setting on TopAccess.
Fig. 9-3
(6) Select the items to be performed with the digital keys.• In case of backup, select one of the following items.
<Backing up User data>Select "1: User Data Back Up".
<Backing up Setting item>Select "3: Setting Back Up".
<Backing up SRAM data>Select "5: SRAM Data Back Up".
Note: Note: After the item is selected with the digital keys, displaying the next menu may take a long time.
07/11
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedDATA CLONING with USB STORAGE DEVICE
9 - 4
(7) Press the [1] button.The screen to select the user data backup item is displayed. In this screen, the items to be backed up are shown after the mark "*". (The items "4", "5" and "6" are selected in the screen by default.)
Fig. 9-4
05/11
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cDATA CLONING with USB STORAGE DEVICE
9 - 5
9
(8) Select the items to be backed up with the digital keys.The mark "*" is shown on the selected item. The mark "*" can be deleted or added each time the corresponding digital key is pressed.• To back up the data in a batch, select "4", "5" or "6". (Selecting "4" performs "1", "2" and "3"
together.)• To back up the data individually, select the following items.
<Backing up Address book>Select "1: Address Book" only.
<Backing up Mail box>Select "2: Mail Box" only.
<Backing up Template>Select "3: Template" only.
<Backing up 1: Address Book, 2: Mail Box and 3: Template in a batch>Select "4: Combined" only.
<Backing up Department management>Select "5: Department Code" only.
<Backing up User management information>Select "6: User Info" only.
E.g.:In case of backing up the department management and user management information
Fig. 9-5
05/11
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedDATA CLONING with USB STORAGE DEVICE
9 - 6
(The following screens are given as an example of when all items are backed up.)
(9) Press the [Start] button.The backup starts and the backing up status is displayed on the LCD screen.
Fig. 9-6
(10) "Back Up Completed" is displayed on the LCD screen when the backup has been properly com-pleted.
Fig. 9-7
(11) Turn the power OFF and remove the USB storage device.
05/11
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cDATA CLONING with USB STORAGE DEVICE
9 - 7
9
<Setting Backup>
(12) Connect the USB storage device to the USB connector (host) on the SYS board.
(13) Turn the power ON while pressing the [5] and [9] button simultaneously.The screen to select the backup/restore items is displayed.
Fig. 9-8
Notes: • After the item is selected with the digital keys, displaying the next menu may take a long time.• When “Disable” is set for the [Data Cloning Function] in TopAccess, the following screen is
displayed. Contact and ask the administrator to change the setting on TopAccess.
Fig. 9-9
07/11
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedDATA CLONING with USB STORAGE DEVICE
9 - 8
(14) Press the [3] button.The screen to select the setting backup item is displayed. In this screen, the items to be backed up are shown after the mark "*". (No items are selected in the screen by default.)
Fig. 9-10
(15) Select the items to be backed up with the digital keys.The mark "*" is shown on the selected item. The mark "*" can be deleted or added each time the corresponding digital key is pressed.• To back up the data individually, select the following items.
<Backing up TopAccess: Network/Print Service>Select "1: Network/Print Service" only.
<Backing up TopAccess: SaveAsFile/Email/InternetFAX>Select "2: SaveAsFile/Email/InternetFAX" only.
<Backing up TopAccess: Notification >Select "3: Notification" only.
<Backing up TopAccess: Directory Service>Select "4: Directory Service" only.
<Backing up Option: Fax setting>Select "5: FAX Kit" only.
<Backing up Option: WirelessLAN/Bluetooth setting>Select "6: WirelessLAN/Bluetooth Kit" only.
05/11
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cDATA CLONING with USB STORAGE DEVICE
9 - 9
9
(The following screens are given as an example of when all TopAccess items are backed up.)
(16) Press the [Start] button.The backup starts and the backing up status is displayed on the LCD screen.
Fig. 9-11
(17) "Back Up Completed" is displayed on the LCD screen when the backup has been properly com-pleted.
Fig. 9-12
(18) Turn the power OFF and remove the USB storage device.
05/11
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedDATA CLONING with USB STORAGE DEVICE
9 - 10
<SRAM Data Backup>
(19) Connect the USB storage device to the USB connector (host) on the SYS board.
(20) Turn the power ON while pressing the [5] and [9] button simultaneously.The screen to select the backup/restore items is displayed.
Fig. 9-13
Notes: • After the item is selected with the digital keys, displaying the next menu may take a long time.• When “Disable” is set for the [Data Cloning Function] in TopAccess, the following screen is
displayed. Contact and ask the administrator to change the setting on TopAccess.
Fig. 9-14
07/11
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cDATA CLONING with USB STORAGE DEVICE
9 - 11
9
(21) Press the [5] button.The screen to select the SRAM data backup item is displayed. In this screen, the item to be backed up is shown after the mark "*". (The item is not selected in the screen by default.)
Fig. 9-15
(22) Select the item to be backed up with the digital keys.The mark "*" is shown on the selected item. The mark "*" can be deleted or added each time the corresponding digital key is pressed.• To back up the data individually, select the following item.
<Backing up SRAM Data>Select "1. SRAM".
Note: Note: The backup/restore of the SRAM data can be performed only for the same model.The ROM version must be the same when the data are backed up and restored.
(The following screens are given as an example of when SRAM data are backed up.)
(23) Press the [Start] button.The backup starts and the backing up status is displayed on the LCD screen.
Fig. 9-16
05/11
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedDATA CLONING with USB STORAGE DEVICE
9 - 12
(24) "Back Up Completed" is displayed on the LCD screen when the backup has been properly com-pleted.
Fig. 9-17
(25) Turn the power OFF and remove the USB storage device.
05/11
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cDATA CLONING with USB STORAGE DEVICE
9 - 13
9
[B] Data cloning procedure (Restore)
Important: • The file system for the USB storage device should be in the FAT format. Note that any device
formatted in FAT32 or NTFS will not be operated. Its file system can be confirmed by opening the properties of the device from Windows Explorer.
• Never turn the power of the equipment OFF during data cloning, or the data could be dam-aged and the operation not carried out properly.
(1) Shut down the equipment.
(2) Connect the USB storage device to the USB connector (host) on the SYS board.
Fig. 9-18
USB connector (host)
USB storage device
05/11
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedDATA CLONING with USB STORAGE DEVICE
9 - 14
<User Data Restore>
(3) Turn the power ON while pressing the [5] and [9] button simultaneously.The screen to select the backup/restore items is displayed.
Fig. 9-19
Note: Note: When “Disable” is set for the [Data Cloning Function] in TopAccess, the following screen is dis-played. Contact and ask the administrator to change the setting on TopAccess.
Fig. 9-20
(4) Select the items to be performed with the digital keys.• In case of restore, select the following items.
<Restoring User data>Select "2: User Data Restore".
<Restoring Setting item>Select "4: Setting Restore".
<Restoring SRAM data>Select "6: SRAM Data Restore".
Note: Note: After the item is selected with the digital keys, displaying the next menu may take a long time.
07/11
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cDATA CLONING with USB STORAGE DEVICE
9 - 15
9
(5) Press the [2] button.The screen to select the user data restore item is displayed. In this screen, the items to be restored are shown after the mark "*". (The items "4", "5" and "6" are selected in the screen by default.)
Fig. 9-21
05/11
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedDATA CLONING with USB STORAGE DEVICE
9 - 16
(6) Select the items to be restored with the digital keys.The mark "*" is shown on the selected item. The mark "*" can be deleted or added each time the corresponding digital key is pressed.• To restore the data in a batch, select "4", "5" or "6". (Selecting "4" performs "1", "2" and "3"
together.)• To restore the data individually, select the following items.
Be sure to select the same item as the one backed up individually.<Restoring Address book>
Select "1: Address Book" only.<Restoring Mail box>
Select "2: Mail Box" only.<Restoring Template>
Select "3: Template" only.<Restoring 1: Address Book, 2: Mail Box and 3: Template in a batch>
Select "4: Combined" only.<Restoring Department management>
Select "5: Department Code" only.<Restoring User management information>
Select "6: User Info" only.
E.g.:In case of restoring the department management and user management information
Fig. 9-22
05/11
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cDATA CLONING with USB STORAGE DEVICE
9 - 17
9
(The following screens are given as an example of when all items are restored.)
(7) Press the [Start] button.The restore starts and the restoring status is displayed on the LCD screen.
Fig. 9-23
(8) "Restore Completed" is displayed on the LCD screen when the restore has been properly com-pleted.
Fig. 9-24
(9) Turn the power OFF and remove the USB storage device.
(10) Clear the counter (in case of restoring "Department Code" and "User Info").Since the counter values are also copied, clear all of them. However, the total counter is not cop-ied.<Procedure>Press the buttons as follows: [USER FUNCTION] → [ADMIN] → Enter the password → [COUNTER] → [DEPARTMENT SETTING] → Enter the password → [RESET ALL COUNTERS]* Enable the department management when the [RESET ALL COUNTERS] button is set to be
disabled.
05/11
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedDATA CLONING with USB STORAGE DEVICE
9 - 18
<Setting Restore>
(11) Connect the USB storage device to the USB connector (host) on the SYS board.
(12) Turn the power ON while pressing the [5] and [9] button simultaneously.The screen to select the backup/restore items is displayed.
Fig. 9-25
Notes: • After the item is selected with the digital keys, displaying the next menu may take a long time.• When “Disable” is set for the [Data Cloning Function] in TopAccess, the following screen is
displayed. Contact and ask the administrator to change the setting on TopAccess.
Fig. 9-26
07/11
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cDATA CLONING with USB STORAGE DEVICE
9 - 19
9
(13) Press the [4] button.The screen to select the setting restore item is displayed. In this screen, the items to be restored are shown after the mark "*". (No items are selected in the screen by default.)
Fig. 9-27
(14) Select the items to be restored with the digital keys.The mark "*" is shown on the selected item. The mark "*" can be deleted or added each time the corresponding digital key is pressed.• To restore the data individually, select the following items.
<Restoring TopAccess: Network/Print Service>Select "1: Network/Print Service" only.
<Restoring TopAccess: SaveAsFile/Email/InternetFAX>Select "2: SaveAsFile/Email/InternetFAX" only.
<Restoring TopAccess: Notification >Select "3: Notification" only.
<Restoring TopAccess: Directory Service>Select "4: Directory Service" only.
<Restoring Option: Fax setting>Select "5: FAX Kit" only.
<Restoring Option: WirelessLAN/Bluetooth setting>Select "6: WirelessLAN/Bluetooth Kit" only.
Note: Note: Be sure to restore the same option items in the same condition as when the option items were backed up.
05/11
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedDATA CLONING with USB STORAGE DEVICE
9 - 20
(The following screens are given as an example of when all TopAccess items are restored.)
(15) Press the [Start] button.The restore starts and the restoring status is displayed on the LCD screen.
Fig. 9-28
(16) "Restore Completed" is displayed on the LCD screen when the restore has been properly com-pleted.
Fig. 9-29
(17) Turn the power OFF and remove the USB storage device.
05/11
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cDATA CLONING with USB STORAGE DEVICE
9 - 21
9
<SRAM Data Restore>
(18) Connect the USB storage device to the USB connector (host) on the SYS board.
(19) Turn the power ON while pressing the [5] and [9] button simultaneously.The screen to select the backup/restore items is displayed.
Fig. 9-30
Notes: • After the item is selected with the digital keys, displaying the next menu may take a long time.• When “Disable” is set for the [Data Cloning Function] in TopAccess, the following screen is
displayed. Contact and ask the administrator to change the setting on TopAccess.
Fig. 9-31
07/11
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedDATA CLONING with USB STORAGE DEVICE
9 - 22
(20) Press the [6] button.The screen to select the SRAM data restore item is displayed. In this screen, the item to be restored is shown after the mark "*". (The item is not selected in the screen by default.)
Fig. 9-32
(21) Select the item to be restored with the digital keys.The mark "*" is shown on the selected item. The mark "*" can be deleted or added each time the corresponding digital key is pressed.• To restore the data individually, select the following item.
<Restoring SRAM Data>Select "1. SRAM".
Note: Note: The backup/restore of the SRAM data can be performed only for the same model.The ROM version must be the same when the data are backed up and restored.
(The following screens are given as an example of when SRAM data are restored.)
(22) Press the [Start] button.The restore starts and the restoring status is displayed on the LCD screen.
Fig. 9-33
05/11
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cDATA CLONING with USB STORAGE DEVICE
9 - 23
9
(23) "Restore Completed" is displayed on the LCD screen when the restore has been properly com-pleted.
Fig. 9-34
(24) Turn the power OFF and remove the USB storage device.
05/11
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedDATA CLONING with USB STORAGE DEVICE
9 - 24
[C] Confirmation of the error
"Back Up ERROR X" (X: Error number) is displayed at the top of the LCD screen when the data have not been properly backed up / restored. In this case, turn the power OFF and then check the following items. After confirming and solving the problem, back up / restore the data again from the beginning.
• Does the USB storage device meet the conditions being used for this cloning?• Is the updated program file written on the USB storage device properly?• Is the USB storage device installed properly?• Is the USB storage device or the equipment damaged?
Fig. 9-35
Error number Error contentERROR 1 Copy errorERROR 2 I/F errorERROR 3 USB memory full errorERROR 4 Working folder errorERROR 5 File not found errorERROR 6 Security errorERROR 7 Checksum errorERROR 8 Model check errorERROR 9 Version check errorERROR 10 Destination check errorERROR 11 Serial number check error
05/11
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cDATA CLONING with USB STORAGE DEVICE
9 - 25
9
[D] Backup file
Backed up data files are encrypted.
<User data file>The folder "user_data" is created in the root directory and the following files are stored in it.
<Setting data file>The folder "setting_data" is created in the root directory and the following files are stored in it.
<SRAM data file>The folder "sram_data" is created in the root directory and the following file is stored in it.
* In addition to the backed up data, the following files are created in each folder.
<Contents of file>
• File format (user_data.txt, setting_data.txt, sram_data.txt: all in common)Line 1: VersionLine 2: Serial numberLine 3: Date
Data item File nameAddress book BACKUP_ADDR.sctMailbox BACKUP_MBOX.sctTemplate BACKUP_TEMP.sctBack up the Address book, Mailbox and Template in a batch BACKUP_ALL.sctDepartment management information BACKUP_Department.sctUser management information BACKUP_User.sct
Data item File nameNetwork / Print service network.sctSaveAsFile / Email / InternetFAX scan.sctNotification setting notice.sctDirectory Service ldap.sctFAX setting fax.sctWireless LAN setting / Bluetooth setting wl.sct, bl.sct
Data item File nameSRAM sram.sct
Back up item File nameUser data user_data.txtSetting item data setting_data.txtSRAM data sram_data.txt
Version: VTD08.100 J
Serial Number: 0123456789
Date: MON SEP 26 18:34:40 2005
05/11
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedDATA CLONING with USB STORAGE DEVICE
9 - 26
© 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reserved e-STUDIO281c/351c/451cWIRE HARNESS CONNECTION DIAGRAMS
10 - 1
10
10. WIRE HARNESS CONNECTION DIAGRAMS
10.1 AC Wire Harness
Fig. 10-1
1 2
1 2
1 2
1 2
RY
Scanner
TH
ER
MO
-SC
N-D
H
11
22
SC
N-L
-DH
SC
N-R
-DH
1
2
3
1
2
3
J652
J657
J595
J655
J653
J622
J60
J63
J64
J61
J62
AC
( N:S
CN
)
AC
( L:S
CN
)
TH
ER
MO
-DR
M-D
H
TH
ER
MO
-FS
R
+5.1
VB
SG
+5.1
VB
SG
IH-C
OIL
PS
-AC
C
2 1
DR
M-N
( DC
LIN
E)
DR
M-L
AC
( MA
IN)
AC
( MA
IN)
AC
( N:M
AIN
)
AC
( L:M
AIN
)
AC
( N:M
AIN
)
AC
( L:M
AIN
)
AC
( N:D
OO
R)
AC
( L:D
OO
R)
AC
-IN
-YH
M( N
)
AC
-IN
-YH
M( N
)
AC
-IN
-YH
M( N
)
AC
-IN
( L)
J650
DR
M-D
H
PS
-IH
AC
-DC
DC
NF
AC
-DC
DC
NF
B A
D C
1B
2B
1 23 6654321
1 4
2A
1A
J469
J647
J460
J546
J643
J642
J644
J644
CN
453
F1
F2
CN
452
CN
451
CN
450
CN
454
3
A B
1
3
22 1
A
GF
B C
N GN
D
L
1234
CN
493
CN
433 N
ot used
CN
432
SG
+5.1
VB
AC
( N)
AC
( L)
PW
A-F
-FIL
1 2 31 2 3 4 5 6
AC
( N)
AC
( L)
DH
-SC
N-L
DH
-SC
N-N
13 2
CN
497
Not used
Inle
t( A
C IN
)
FG
BR
EA
KE
R
MA
IN-S
W( M
ain
sw
itch
)
CO
V-I
NT
LC
K-S
W
(Cover
openin
g/c
losin
g )
inte
rlock s
witch
Fuser
AS
D/A
UD
/CN
D/S
AD
/A
SU
/TW
D/K
RD
model:
Sta
ndard
NA
D/M
JD
model:
Option
05/11
e-STUDIO281c/351c/451c © 2005 - 2010 TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All rights reservedWIRE HARNESS CONNECTION DIAGRAMS
10 - 2
05/11
10.2 DC Wire Harness1
A C D E F G HB
A C D E F G HB
34
25
67
8
13
42
56
78
FA
XF
AX
po
we
r re
lay
po
we
r re
lay
bo
ard
bo
ard
PWA-F-DSP PWA-F-DSP
(DSP) (DSP)
PWA-F-KEY PWA-F-KEY
(KEY) (KEY)
PWA-F-DSP
(DSP)
PWA-F-KEY
(KEY)
PW
A-F
-SF
BP
WA
-F-S
FB
(SF
B)
(SF
B)
PW
A-F
-AD
UP
WA
-F-A
DU
(AD
U)
(AD
U)
PW
A-F
-SN
SP
WA
-F-S
NS
(SN
S)
(SN
S)
PW
A-F
-LD
RP
WA
-F-L
DR
(LD
R)
(LD
R)
SGSG
+5.1VB +5.1VB
AD0 AD0
AD2 AD2
AD4 AD4
AD6 AD6
I/F0 I/F0
I/F01 I/F01
I/F03 I/F03
I/F05 I/F05
I/F07 I/F07
SGSG
I/F2 I/F2
I/F4 I/F4
I/F6 I/F6
SGSG
WE WE
CSIP2 CSIP2
+5.1VB +5.1VB
+5.1VB +5.1VB
SGSG
IPCSW IPCSW
AD1 AD1
AD3 AD3
AD5 AD5
AD7 AD7
OEOE
IPRST IPRST
+5.1VB +5.1VB
SGSG FA
N1C
N3
33
J5
22
A1
+2
4V
D1
A2
TE
MP
SA
3S
GA
4H
UM
ISA
5+
5.1
VB
A6
+5
.1V
BA
7U
ST
FL
2A
8S
GA
9
DR
TM
P+
A1
0D
RT
MP
-A
11
AT
SD
ET
A1
2P
GA
13
AT
SA
14
+2
4V
D1
A1
5A
TS
VR
A1
6S
GA
17
+2
4V
D1
B1
ER
SL
PB
2+
5.1
VB
B3
BL
KB
4S
GB
5+
5.1
VB
B6
KD
SB
7S
GB
8
+5
.1V
BB
9M
AR
KS
B1
0S
GB
11
BM
BC
OR
B1
2+
24
VD
1B
13
+5
.1V
BB
14
MA
RK
LB
15
SG
B1
6N
CB
17
A1
A2
A3
A4
A5
A6
A7
A8
A9
A1
0
A1
1
A1
2
A1
3
A1
4
A1
5
A1
6
A1
7
B1
B2
B3
B4
B5
B6
B7
B8
B9
B1
0
B1
1
B1
2
B1
3
B1
4
B1
5
B1
6
B1
7
A1
7
A1
6
A1
5
A1
4
A1
3
A1
2
A1
1
A1
0
A9
A8
A7
A6
A5
A4
A3
A2
A1
B1
7
B1
6
B1
5
B1
4
B1
3
B1
2
B1
1
B1
0
B9
B8
B7
B6
B5
B4
B3
B2
B1
NC
NC
NCC
N3
32
J5
12
J6
69
J5
29
J6
41
A1
SG
A2
NC
A3
DV
CT
NR
A4
AG
A5
DV
TN
AL
DA
6+
5.1
VB
A7
SL
DV
TN
AA
8+
24
VD
1A
9S
LD
VT
NB
A1
0C
KS
LS
A1
1
ST
FA
NB
1+
24
VD
2B
2
+2
4V
D1
B3
CL
BU
CP
B4
SG
B5
CT
NR
B6
+5
.1V
BB
7N
CB
8N
CB
9N
CB
10
NC
B1
1
NC
NC
NC
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 2 1 1 2
1 2
1 2 3 4
4 3 2 1
3 2 1
AT
TN
R-
SH
UT
-SO
L(S
OL
1)
23 1
23 1J5
80
CO
LR
-AT
TN
R-S
NR
(S1
0)
34 2 1
J5
79
8910 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
NC
SG
/CP
SW
2
CO
LR
-TN
R-S
NR
(S9
)
J5
14
TR
BL
T-C
LN
-CL
T(C
LT
1)
INT
RN
L-F
AN
-MO
T(M
20
)
2 1M
21 3
J6
61
23 1
TR
BL
T-H
P-S
NR
1(S
15
)
TR
BL
T-H
P-S
NR
2(S
16
)
J5
75 23 1
J6
5921 3
K-D
EV
-TIM
-SN
R(S
12
)
K-D
EV
-PO
S-S
NR
(S1
1)
J5
3721 3
J5
39234 1
K-A
TT
NR
-SN
R(S
13
)
J5
76
234
5
16
52
61 43 145
54 876
J6
37
678
21 3
3 2J5
54
321
910
109
128
4 765 8
7 56 4 3
J6
36
2 1
2 1
LS
U-F
AN
-MO
T(M
16
)
J5
89
M
1 2
BE
LT
-CL
N-M
OT
(M2
)
J5
30
M
234 1
TE
MP
/HU
MI-
SN
R(S
19
)
J6
21
1 2
TH
MS
-DR
M(T
HM
4)
J6
382 1
LP
-ER
S(E
RS
)
J5
96
2 14 36 57
6 74 52 31
2 14 35
4 52 31
1 2
FR
NT
-CO
V-S
W(S
42
)
FR
DS
W
SG
+2
4V
D1
AG
TN
LE
D
TN
LV
L2
TN
LV
L1
TN
RE
F
AG
+1
2V
B
SL
TB
TN
A
SG
CT
LF
ED
+5
.1V
B
SD
CS
W
SG
NC
NC
NC
NC
NC
NC
NC
NC
NC
NC
NC
NC
NC
NC
SG
CT
UF
ED
+5
.1V
B
SG
PS
TP
C
+5
.1V
B
SG
KT
ND
ET
KT
NR
1A
KT
NR
1B
SG
PS
TR
PD
+5
.1V
B
CL
TR
P
+2
4V
D1
CU
PE
1
+5
.1V
B
SG
CL
MF
DL
+2
4V
D1
CL
MF
CL
+2
4V
D1
TU
P1
TU
P2
NC
NC
CL
FE
D1
+2
4V
D1
SG
CU
FL
S
+5
.1V
B
CL
SW
SG
CU
SW
SG
SG
CL
EM
P
+5
.1V
B
SG
CL
TO
P
+5
.1V
B
CL
FE
D2
+2
4V
D1
SG
CL
FL
S
+5
.1V
B
+5
.1V
B
CU
TO
P
SG
+5
.1V
B
CU
EM
P
SG
NC
J5
77
1 2
1 2
TN
LV
L-S
HU
T-S
OL
(SO
L2
)
J5
43
1 2
SID
E-C
OV
-SW
(S4
4)
21 3J5
28
J5
66
3 25 46
4 5
162 31J5
27
J5
6513 24
42 31J6
40
21 3
RG
ST
-SN
R(S
22
)
J5
55
23 1
TN
R-M
OT
(M3
)
TR
2-P
OS
-SN
R(S
18
)
2T
R-C
ON
T-C
LT
(CL
T5
)
J5
34
21 3
FE
D-U
-SN
R(S
23
)
J5
56
6 74 521 3T
NL
VL
-SN
R(S
17
)
J5
42
J6
25
6 58 710 911 13 24
1 32 54 6 87 109 11J5
11
CN
33
8
CN
34
1
3 25 4
2 14 3
7 68
6 7
184 52 31J5
2542 31
J6
18
3 25 47 62 14 36 5 8
6 7
184 52 31J6
39
64 52 31
J5
70
J5
17
-1
2 14 36 5
6 7
7
4 52 31
J5
68
J5
16
-1
2 14 36 5
2 14 36 5 6 7
7
4 52 31
64 52 31
J5
69
J5
16
-2
J5
67
J5
17
-1
FE
D-L
-SN
R(S
24
)
21 3J5
61
NE
MP
-L-S
NR
(S3
2)
21 3J6
20
CS
T-U
-TR
Y-S
NR
(S2
7)
23 1J5
19
EM
P-U
-SN
R(S
29
)23 1J5
18
EM
P-L
-SN
R(S
30
)21 3J5
18
NE
MP
-U-S
NR
(S3
1)
23 1J6
20
CS
T-L
-TR
Y-S
NR
(S2
8)
21 3J5
19
1 2
K-T
NR
-SW
(S1
4)
J5
32
1 2
CS
T-L
-SW
(S3
4)
J5
52
1 2
CS
T-U
-SW
(S3
3)
J5
53
1 2
1 2J5
59
CL
ING
-SN
R(S
45
)23 1J6
75
TR
Y-M
OT
(M1
0)
2 1J5
71
CS
T-L
-TR
-L-C
LT
(CL
T1
5)
CS
T-L
-TR
-H-C
LT
(CL
T1
6)
2 1
2 1
J5
21
1 2
1 2
J5
21
1 2
1 2
J5
73
1 2
1 2
J5
72
CS
T-U
-FE
ED
-CL
T(C
LT
2)
CS
T-L
-FE
ED
-CL
T(C
LT
3)
MM
B1
B2
B3
B4
B5
B6
B7
B8
B9
B1
0
B1
1
B1
2
B1
B2
B3
B4
B5
B6
B7
B8
B9
B1
0
B1
1
B1
2
B1
3
B1
4
B1
5
B1
6
B1
7
B1
3
B1
4
B1
5
B1
6
B1
7
B1
8
B1
9
B2
0
A1
A2
A3
A4
A5
A6
A7
A8
A9
A1
0
A1
1
A1
2
A2
A3
A4
A5
A6
A7
A8
A9
A1
0
A1
1
A1
2
A1
3
A1
4
A1
5
A1
6
A1
7
A1
8
A1
3
A1
4
A1
5
A1
6
A1
7
A1
9
A1
A2
0
1stdrawer
2nddrawer
2nddrawer
2nd drawer1stdrawer
1st drawer
JP
D m
od
el o
nly
SG
SW
1
SW
2
2 14 34
5
5 6
6
2 31
J6
172
2
1
13
3J5
20
US
D-T
NR
-FLL-S
NR
(S2
0)
21 3J5
74 C
OLR
-DE
V-T
NR
-CLT
(CL
T8
)
1 2
1 2
J5
38
CO
LR
-DE
V-C
LT
(CL
T9
)
1 2
1 2
J5
49
RG
ST
-CL
T(C
LT
12
)
1 2J5
26
CS
T-U
-TR
-L-C
LT
(CL
T1
3)
CS
T-U
-TR
-H-C
LT
(CL
T1
4)
1 2J5
57
1 2
1 21 21 2
J5
58
J5
36
K-D
EV
-LIF
T-C
LT
(CL
T1
1)
1 2J5
50
K-D
EV
-CL
T(C
LT
10
)
1 2
1 2
J5
51
DR
M-C
LN
-MO
T(M
8)
1 2
1 2 1 2M
12345678910
11
12
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
NC
NC
NC
CL
MC
W
SG
23
24
25
CL
MC
CW
CN
33
9
26
15
14
13
CL
CT
NS
CL
RG
ST
+2
4V
D1
+2
4V
D1
CL
CD
VR
CL
MF
DH
+2
4V
D1
+2
4V
D1
CL
KD
VR
CL
MF
CU
+2
4V
D1
+2
4V
D1
BM
DR
CB
SG
DR
CL
B
US
TF
L
CL
KD
VP
+5
.1V
B
+2
4V
D1
2 14 34
5
5 6
6
2 31
J6
65
2 14 34
5
5 6
6
2 31
J6
74
22
3
31
1J6
66
2 1J6
67
2 1
CC
L-F
-PO
S-S
W(S
25
)
CC
L-R
-PO
S-S
W(S
26
)
J6
68
CC
L-M
OT
(M1
3)
M
PW
A-F
-SF
B(S
FB
)
SG
SG
SF
SZ
0
SF
SZ
1
SF
SZ
2
SF
SZ
3
+5
.1V
B
SF
BS
W
SG
+2
4V
D1
CL
SF
B
+2
4V
D1
SO
LS
FB
SG
SF
BF
ED
+5
.1V
B
PG
PG
+2
4V
D1
+2
4V
D1
AD
M2
D
AD
M2
B
AD
M2
C
AD
M2
A
CR
TD
OW
N
AD
TR
2
+5
.1V
B
SG
AD
CN
T
AD
TR
T
AD
CO
V
+2
4V
D1
AD
UC
L
SF
SS
W
NC
NC
18
16
17
14
15
13
6
654321
13
14
15
16
17
18
17
1
16
2
15
3
14
4
4321
215432154321
6
651432
321321
13
5
12
6
11
7
10
8
99
81
0
71
1
61
2
51
3
41
4
31
5
21
6
1
11
10987654321
17
7 8 9 10
11
12
12
11
10 9 8 7 45 23 1
4
4
5
5
2
2
33
1
1
CN
34
0
J5
07
J5
45
CN
21
1
J5
44
CN
21
3S
G
AD
UF
L
+5
.1V
B
SG
AD
UF
U
+5
.1V
B
+2
4V
D1
FD
MA
FD
MB
FD
MC
FD
MD
+2
4V
D1
CO
VS
W
SG
CN
21
4
CN
21
5
CN
21
6
CN
21
7
CN
21
2
23 1 2345 1
SF
B-S
NR
(S3
5)
J6
3021 3
SF
B-F
ED
-SN
R(S
36
)
J6
3123 1
AD
U-T
RL
-SN
R(S
39
)
J3
12 23 1
AD
U-T
RU
-SN
R(S
38
)
J5
92
J5
94
2 1
SF
B-F
EE
D-C
LT
(CL
T6
)
J6
28
J6
192 1
AD
U-S
ET
-SW
(S3
7)
PW
A-F
-AD
U
(AD
U)
J5
93
2 1
2 12 1
SF
B-S
OL
(SO
L3
)
J6
29
2 1
2 1
AD
U-C
LT
(CL
T7
)
J5
64
AD
U-M
OT
(M5
)
Au
tom
atic d
up
lexin
g u
nit
Byp
ass u
nit
M
B1
B2
B3
B4
B5
B6
B7
B8
B9
B1
0
B1
1
B1
2
B1
3
B1
4
B1
5
B1
6
B1
7
A1
A2
A3
A4
A5
A6
A7
A8
A9
A1
0
A1
1
A1
2
A1
3
A1
4
A1
5
A1
6
A1
7
FG
FG
FG
FG
FG
FG
NC
+5
.1V
B
EX
TS
W
SG
FU
SS
W
NC
NC
MT
H+
MT
H-
ET
H+
ET
H-
ST
H+
ST
H-
+5
VS
W
NC
TH
MS
-SU
B-F
BL
T(T
HM
3)
Fu
se
r
PS
-IH
PS
-IH
(IH
)(I
H)
PS
-IH
(IH
)
TH
MS
-ED
GE
-FB
LT
(TH
M1
)
TH
MS
-MA
IN-F
BL
T(T
HM
2)
NC
EX
IT-S
NR
(S4
0)
J6
35CN
45
6
CN
45
5C
N3
34
J6
26
+5
.1V
B
EX
TS
W
SG
FU
SS
W
NC
NC
TH
MU
+
TH
MU
-
SS
TH
+
SS
TH
-
ST
HU
+
ST
HU
-
+5
VS
W
H1
ER
R2
H1
ER
R1
IHD
UT
Y
SG
IH1
ON
H2
PW
R3
H2
PW
R2
H2
PW
R1
H1
PW
R3
H1
PW
R2
H1
PW
R1
+5
VS
W
IH2
ON
3 2 1
321 4 5321 4 5 6 7 8 78 6 511
12
13
10 9 34 2 1
76 8 9321 4 5 11
10
12
13
B1
3
B1
2
B1
1
B1
0
B9
A1
3
A1
2
A1
1
A1
0
A9
B8
B7
B6
B5
B4
B3
B2
B1
A8
A7
A6
A5
A4
A3
A2
A1
B1
B2
B3
B4
B5
B6
B7
B8
B9
B1
0
B1
1
B1
2
B1
3
B1
3
B1
2
B1
1
B1
0
B9
B8
B7
B6
B5
B4
B3
B2
B1
A1
A1
3
A2
A1
2
A3
A1
1
A4
A1
0
A5
A9
A8
A7
A6
A5
A4
A3
A2
A1
A6
A7
A8
A9
A1
0
A1
1
A1
2
A1
3
CN
34
5
CN
34
2
19
20
17
18
15
16
13
14
11
129 107 85 63 41 2
CN
20
1
CN
20
2
Ke
y c
op
y c
ou
nte
r21 3 4
J5
83
PW
A-F
-SN
S(S
NS
)21 3
2 13
CN
20
3
CN
35
1
SG
KT
CR
C
+2
4V
D1
KT
CR
0J6
48 321 4
234 1
21 3 4 5
M/D
C-P
OL
(M4
)
J2
04
M
1234512345 678910
11
12
16
17
18
19
20
15
14
13
1234
PW
A-F
-LD
R
(LD
R)
SG
SG
BE
AM
DT
+5
.1V
B
SG
+5
.1V
D
+5
.1V
D
SG
SH
DW
N
WR
AP
C
SG
PID
T0
PID
T1
SG
SG
WR
LV
L
SG
+5
.1V
D
+5
.1V
D
+5
.1V
B
BE
AM
DT
SG
SG
PO
MP
L
PO
MO
N
PO
MC
K
PG
+2
4V
D1
Op
tio
n
2 1
1 2
MA
IN-S
W(S
41
)
J6
46
J6
46
CN
35
4
J5
91
FA
NO
Z
+2
4V
RS
TS
W
+2
4V
D1
FA
NIH
+2
4V
D1
2 1
IH-F
AN
-MO
T(M
17
)M
J5
90
2 1
2 12 1
OZ
N-F
AN
-MO
T(M
18
)M
3 4 5 61 2
2 1
NC
NC
NC
NC
CN
35
3
J5
10
TR
SP
-MO
T(M
9)
DE
V-M
OT
(M1
1)
CN
33
6J5
81
CN
33
7J5
78
J5
82
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
11
12
13
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
11
12
13
14
15
B1
B2
B3
B4
B5
B6
B7
B8
B9
B1
0
B1
1
B1
2
NC
+2
4V
D1
+2
4V
D1
PG
PG
FD
MG
A
FD
MP
L
FD
MC
W
FD
MC
K
FD
MO
N
SG
+5
.1V
B
SG
+5
.1V
B
DE
VM
ON
DV
MC
LK
DV
MC
W
DV
MP
L
NC
PG
PG
+2
4V
D1
+2
4V
D1
NC
NC
11
1098765432112345678910
11
12
12345678910
11
12
13
A6
A7
A8
A9
A1
0
A1
1
A1
2
A1
A2
A3
A4
A5
Jo
b s
ep
ara
tor
/
Off
se
t tr
ay /
Brid
ge
un
it
M M
MA
IN-M
OT
(M6
)
NC
+2
4V
D1
MA
MB
L
+2
4V
D1
PG
PG
MA
MG
A
MA
MP
L
MA
MC
W
MA
MC
LK
MA
MO
N
SG
+5
.1V
B
12
13
11
10987654321
M
RL
C2
S
+5
.1V
B
RL
HS
W
SG
JS
PS
W
RL
CN
T
NC
RL
CS
W
RL
TR
S
NC
GA
SO
L
+2
4V
D1
PG
Op
tio
n
PG
+2
4V
D1
HV
TS
TS
EC
ON
TC
2V
R
TC
2O
N
TC
1V
R
TC
1O
N
KD
VV
R
KD
VA
ON
KD
VD
ON
CD
VV
R
CD
VA
ON
CD
VD
ON
GV
R
CC
ON
HV
CL
K
CN
48
1
CN
48
2
CN
48
3
CN
48
4
CN
48
5
CN
48
6
CN
48
7
J6
15
J6
16
J6
11
J6
12
J6
13
J6
10
J6
14
PS
-HV
TP
S-H
VT
(HV
T)
(HV
T)
PS
-HV
T
(HV
T)
CN
48
0C
N3
56
12345678
1 1 1 1 1 1 1
1M
ain
ch
arg
er
wire
bia
s
1M
ain
ch
arg
er
grid
bia
s
1D
eve
lop
er
bia
s (
co
lor)
De
ve
lop
er
bia
s (
bla
ck)
1 1T
ran
sfe
r b
ias (
1st)
1T
ran
sfe
r b
ias (
2n
d)
1C
lea
nin
g b
lad
e b
ias
910
11
12
18
19
15
14
17
16
13
12
11
10987654321 17
16
TC
1L
V
TC
1M
ON
19
18
15
14
13
CL
KC
CL
KB
SC
SW
C
DR
V7
DR
V6
DR
V5
DR
V4
DR
V3
DR
V2
DR
V1
DR
V0
PF
RS
T
+5
.1V
B
SG
SIZ
E0
SIZ
E1
SIZ
E2
SIZ
E3
RE
TS
0
RE
TS
1
RE
TS
2
RE
TS
3
RE
TS
4
RE
TS
5
RE
TS
6
RE
TS
7
SC
SW
B
LC
CN
TN
C
NC
SG
RV
LH
P
+5
.1V
B
+5
.1V
B
EE
PC
LK
EE
PC
S
SG
EX
TC
1
EX
TM
C
EX
TM
A
SG
RV
MP
HC
RV
MP
HA
RV
MP
HB
RV
MP
HD
RV
MC
1
SG
EX
TM
D
EX
TM
B
+5
VS
W
EE
PD
OU
T
EE
PD
IN
SG
NC
NC
NC
Op
tio
n
J6
49 PG
PG
24
VD
1
24
VD
1
CN
34
4J5
84
CN
33
1
J4
34
1357
1234911
13
15
17
19
21
23
30
28
26
24
22
20
29
27
25
18
108642 12
14
16
12345678910
11
12
16
17
18
19
20
15
14
23
24
25
26
27
28
22
21
13
B1
0
B9
B8
B7
B6
B5
B4
B3
B2
B1
A5
A4
A3
A2
A1
A1
0
A9
A8
A7
A6
A1
A2
A3
A4
A5
A6
A7
A8
A9
A1
0
A1
1
A1
2
A1
3
B1
B2
B8
B9
B1
0
B1
1
B1
2
B1
3
B3
B4
B5
B6
B7
CN
43
5J5
87
CN
43
6
+2
4V
D2
RV
MA
RV
MC
RV
MD
RV
MB
+2
4V
D2
RE
VL
V-M
OT
(M1
2)
M
1 2 3 4 5 6
1 2 3 4 5 6
CN
43
7J5
88
EX
TM
C
+2
4V
D2
+2
4V
D2
PG
PG
NC
+2
4V
D2
EX
TM
A
EX
TM
B
+2
4V
D2
EX
TM
D
EX
IT-M
OT
(M7
)M
1 2 3 4
1 2 3 4 5
5 6
1 2 3 4 5 6
PF
P/L
CF
PW
A-F
-DR
VP
WA
-F-D
RV
(DR
V)
(DR
V)
PW
A-F
-DR
V
(DR
V)
321
123
23 1
RE
VL
V-H
P-S
NR
(S8
)
J5
13
J6
45
IPC
bo
ard
IPC
bo
ard
(Fin
ish
er)
(Fin
ish
er)
Co
in c
on
tro
ller
Co
py k
ey c
ard
Op
tio
n
IPC
bo
ard
(Fin
ish
er)
CN349
J2
CN352
RX
DF
GJ5
98 SG
TX
D
SG
FG
F-C
NT
CN
T-G
ND
+5
.1V
B
SG
NC
+2
4V
D5
PG
RXD
SG
TXD
SG
F-CNT
NC
CNT-GND
SG
+5.1VB
AD0
AD2
AD4
AD6
I/F0
I/F01
I/F03
I/F05
I/F07
SG
I/F2
I/F4
I/F6
SG
WE
CSIP2
+5.1VB
+5.1VB
SG
IPCSW
AD1
AD3
AD5
AD7
OE
IPRST
+5.1VB
SG
3
2
1
4
7
6
5
8
9
10
4321 8765 12
11
109
4 3 2 1
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
J1
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
MNCTR
FLCTR
SG
+24VD1
CTRON
EXTCTR
MCRUM
CTRCNT
PG
BKCTR
SIZE0
SIZE1
SIZE2
SIZE3
+5.1VB
CTRCNT2
A1
A2
A3
A4
A5
A6
A7
A8
B1
B2
B3
B4
B5
B6
B7
B8
+5
.1V
B
SG
+2
4V
D5
PG
CN
46
8
Op
tio
n Fin
ish
er
NC
NC
NC
Download jig (LGC)
Download jig (FAX)
D[0
]D
[0]
D[2
]D
[2]
D[4
]D
[4]
D[6
]D
[6]
RD
-0R
D-0
A[0
]A
[0]
A[2
]A
[2]
A[4
]A
[4]
A[6
]A
[6]
A[8
]A
[8]
A[1
0]
A[1
0]
A[1
2]
A[1
2]
A[1
4]
A[1
4]
A[1
6]
A[1
6]
A[1
8]
A[1
8]
SG
SG
SG
SG
D[1
]D
[1]
D[3
]D
[3]
D[5
]D
[5]
D[7
]D
[7]
CS
2-0
CS
2-0
A[1
]A
[1]
A[3
]A
[3]
A[5
]A
[5]
A[7
]A
[7]
A[9
]A
[9]
A[1
1]
A[1
1]
A[1
3]
A[1
3]
A[1
5]
A[1
5]
A[1
7]
A[1
7]
RO
MD
T-0
RO
MD
T-0
+5
.1V
B+
5.1
VB
RO
ML
D-1
RO
ML
D-1
CN
34
8
34
33
32
31
30
29
25
24
23
22
21
20
26
27
28
19
15
14
13
12
11
16
17
181 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
34
33
32
31
30
29
25
24
23
22
21
20
26
27
28
19
15
14
13
12
11
16
17
181 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
D[0
]
D[2
]
D[4
]
D[6
]
RD
-0
A[0
]
A[2
]
A[4
]
A[6
]
A[8
]
A[1
0]
A[1
2]
A[1
4]
A[1
6]
A[1
8]
SG
SG
D[1
]
D[3
]
D[5
]
D[7
]
CS
2-0
A[1
]
A[3
]
A[5
]
A[7
]
A[9
]
A[1
1]
A[1
3]
A[1
5]
A[1
7]
RO
MD
T-0
+5
.1V
B
RO
ML
D-1
+5
.1V
B
SG
+3
.3V
B
SG
PW
RF
NL
SG
PD
WN
PW
RF
NH
NC
SG
+5
.1V
D
NC
NC
1 2 3 14 1 2 3 425 6
1 2 3 4 5 6 1 2 3 4 5 67 8
7 8 9 10
AG
NC
+1
2V
B1
6
15
141 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
11
12
13
+2
4V
D1
+2
4V
D1
PG
PG
+2
4V
D2
+2
4V
D2
PG
PG
+2
4V
D1
+2
4V
D1
PG
PG
+5
.1V
B
SG
J6
50
CN
49
5+
5.1
VB
SG
NC
NC
NC
CN
46
6
CN
46
5
CN
46
9
1 2
+2
4V
D1
FA
N-A
CC
CN
47
0
CN
34
6
CN
35
0
CN
33
5
PS
-FA
N-M
OT
(M1
9)
M
PS
-AC
CP
S-A
CC
(PS
)(P
S)
PS
-AC
C
(PS
)
PW
A-F
-FIL
(FIL
)
PW
A-F
-FIL
PW
A-F
-FIL
(FIL
)(F
IL)
PW
A-F
-FIL
(FIL
)
1 2 3
1 2 3
1 2 3
12345678910
11
12
16
16
17
17
18
18
19
20
15
15
14
14
23
24
22
21
19
20
23
24
22
21
13
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
11
12
13
A6
A7
A8
A9
A1
0
A1
1
A1
2
A1
3
A1
4
A1
5
A1
6
A1
7
A1
A2
A3
A4
A5
A1
9
A2
0
A2
1
A2
2
A2
3
A2
4
A2
5
A2
6
A2
7
A2
8
A2
9
A3
0
A1
8
B6
B7
B8
B9
B1
0
B1
1
B1
2
B1
3
B1
4
B1
5
B1
6
B1
7
B1
B2
B3
B4
B5
B1
9
B2
0
B2
1
B2
2
B2
3
B2
4
B2
5
B2
6
B2
7
B2
8
B2
9
B3
0
B1
8
A6
A7
A8
A9
A1
0
A1
1
A1
2
A1
3
A1
4
A1
5
A1
6
A1
7
A1
A2
A3
A4
A5
A1
9
A2
0
A2
1
A2
2
A2
3
A2
4
A2
5
A2
6
A2
7
A2
8
A2
9
A3
0
A1
8
B6
B7
B8
B9
B1
0
B1
1
B1
2
B1
3
B1
4
B1
5
B1
6
B1
7
B1
B2
B3
B4
B5
B1
9
B2
0
B2
1
B2
2
B2
3
B2
4
B2
5
B2
6
B2
7
B2
8
B2
9
B3
0
B1
8
SG
MC
NT
IDT
A0
IDT
A1
IDT
A2
IDT
A3
SG
IDT
A4
IDT
A5
IDT
A6
IDT
A7
SG
IDT
A8
IDT
A9
IDT
A1
0
IDT
A1
1
SG
IDT
A1
2
IDT
A1
3
IDT
A1
4
IDT
A1
5
SG
IPO
S0
IPO
S1
IPO
S2
IPO
S3
+3
.3V
B
CC
OD
E0
CC
OD
E1
SG
SG
MM
PI1
+5
.1V
B
CB
SY
CM
D
SA
CK
SE
RR
SB
SY
ST
S
CA
CK
CE
RR
SG
PE
FC
LK
-M
SG
IRC
LK
1
SG
IVS
YN
C0
SG
INS
YN
C0
SG
IDC
LK
SG
IHD
EN
0
SG
IVD
EN
0
SG
NC
(RE
SE
RV
E1
)
RE
SE
RV
E2
AR
ST
0
SG
PW
RD
N
PW
RE
N
SG
+1
2V
B
SG
+1
2V
A
SG
SG
+3
.3V
A
+3
.3V
A
SG
+3
.3V
A
SG
SG
+3
.3V
B
+3
.3V
B
SG
SG
SG
+5
.1V
B
+5
.1V
A
+5
.1V
A
+5
.1V
A
+5
.1V
A
CN
11
3C
N3
57
CN
11
7C
N4
64
31 2
+1
2V
B
PG
NCC
N4
71
Download jig (SLG)
CN
15
J3
0
SC
AN
-MO
T(M
1)
M
54321
+2
4V
D4
SC
NM
-AB
SC
NM
-B
+2
4V
D4
SC
NM
-BB
6
54321 6
54321 6S
CN
M-A
CN
21
54321
CN
1
54321C
N2
4321
FG
+2
4V
D4
LM
PO
N-0
A
PG
LA
NP
NC
NC
LA
MP
PG
PW
A-F
-SL
GP
WA
-F-S
LG
(SL
G)
(SL
G)
PWA-F-CCD PWA-F-CCD
(CCD) (CCD)
21 3
PL
TN
-SN
R(S
7)
21 3
HO
ME
-SN
R(S
6)
23 1
AP
S1
(S1
)
A4
se
rie
s o
nly
PWA-F-CCD
(CCD)
INV
-EX
PIN
V-E
XP
(IN
V)
(IN
V)
INV
-EX
P(I
NV
)
FA
Xp
ow
er
rela
yb
oa
rd
PW
A-F
-SL
G
(SL
G)
LP
-EX
PO
(EX
P)
AP
S2
(S2
)
AP
S3
(S3
)
AP
S-C
(S4
)
AP
S-R
(S5
)
23 123 123 123 1
40
39
38
37
36
35
34
33
32
31
30
29
25
24
23
22
21
20
26
27
28
50
49
45
44
43
42
41
46
47
48
60
59
58
57
56
55
54
53
52
51
70
69
65
64
63
62
61
66
67
68
80
79
75
74
73
72
71
76
77
78
19
15
14
13
12
11
16
17
181 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
40
39
38
37
36
35
34
33
32
31
30
29
25
24
23
22
21
20
26
27
28
50
49
45
44
43
42
41
46
47
48
60
59
58
57
56
55
54
53
52
51
70
69
65
64
63
62
61
66
67
68
80
79
75
74
73
72
71
76
77
78
19
15
14
13
12
11
16
17
181 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
34
33
32
31
30
29
25
24
23
22
21
20
26
27
28
19
15
14
13
12
11
16
17
181 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
34
33
32
31
30
29
25
24
23
22
21
20
26
27
28
19
15
14
13
12
11
16
17
181 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8 7 6 5 4 3 2
8
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
9
10
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
1
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
1
2
10
11
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
1245678910
124
335678910
12345678910
11
12
22
21
20
19
18
17
16
15
14
13
12
11
22
21
20
19
18
17
16
15
14
13
12
11
22
21
24
23
20
19
18
17
16
15
14
13
12
11
16
17
18
15
14
19
20
11
12
13
16
17
18
15
14
19
20
11
12
13
A6
A7
A8
A9
A1
0
A1
1
A1
2
A1
3
A1
4
A1
5
A1
6
A1
7
A1
A2
A3
A4
A5
A1
9
A2
0
A1
8
B6
B7
B8
B9
13
14
15
B1
0
B1
1
B1
2
B1
3
B1
4
B1
5
B1
6
B1
7
B1
B2
B3
B4
B5
B1
9
B2
0
B1
8
A6
A7
A8
A9
A1
0
A1
1
A1
2
A1
3
A1
4
A1
5
A1
6
A1
7
A1
A2
A3
A4
A5
A1
9
A2
0
A1
8
B6
B7
B8
B9
B1
0
B1
1
B1
2
B1
3
B1
4
B1
5
B1
6
B1
7
B1
B2
B3
B4
B5
B1
9
B2
0
B1
8
3 4 5 6 161 2 7 8 9 12
10
11
TX
OU
T3
+
13
14
FG
FG
FG
FG
J4
1N
C
NC
NC
NC
CN
71
CN71J42
J5
0
J4
9
CN11
CN
13
DFCNT-0A
DFRQ-0A
DFRRQ-0A
DFRAK-0A
SG
DFTXD-0A
SG
DFRXD-0A
DFSCST-0A
DFAK-0A
SG
PL
TN
-1A
+5
.1V
B
SG
HO
ME
-1A
+5
.1V
B
+2
4V
D4
FA
NS
LG
SG
SD
CL
KO
UT
0-
TX
OU
T2
+
SG
TX
OU
T1
-
TX
OU
T0
+
SG
MS
RC
KO
UT
-
PH
SY
NC
+
SG
VS
YN
C-
SC
NT
-1
NC
MA
D[1
7]
MA
D[1
7]
LE
D-0
LE
D-0
+5
.1V
B+
5.1
VB
RO
MD
T-0
RO
MD
T-0
MA
D[1
5]
MA
D[1
5]
MA
D[1
3]
MA
D[1
3]
MA
D[1
1]
MA
D[1
1]
MA
D[9
]M
AD
[9]
MA
D[7
]M
AD
[7]
MA
D[5
]M
AD
[5]
DL
AD
[3]
DL
AD
[3]
DL
AD
[1]
DL
AD
[1]
DL
AD
[2]
DL
AD
[2]
DL
AD
[0]
DL
AD
[0]
CS
O2
-0C
SO
2-0
MD
T[7
]M
DT
[7]
MD
T[5
]M
DT
[5]
MD
T[3
]M
DT
[3]
MD
T[1
]M
DT
[1]
SG
SG
SG
SG
MA
D[1
8]
MA
D[1
8]
MA
D[1
6]
MA
D[1
6]
MA
D[1
4]
MA
D[1
4]
MA
D[1
2]
MA
D[1
2]
MA
D[1
0]
MA
D[1
0]
MA
D[8
]M
AD
[8]
MA
D[6
]M
AD
[6]
MA
D[4
]M
AD
[4]
MR
D-0
AM
RD
-0A
MD
T[6
]M
DT
[6]
MD
T[4
]M
DT
[4]
MD
T[2
]M
DT
[2]
MD
T[0
]M
DT
[0]
MA
D[1
7]
LE
D-0
+5
.1V
B
RO
MD
T-0
MA
D[1
5]
MA
D[1
3]
MA
D[1
1]
MA
D[9
]
MA
D[7
]
MA
D[5
]
DL
AD
[3]
DL
AD
[1]
DL
AD
[2]
DL
AD
[0]
CS
O2
-0
MD
T[7
]
MD
T[5
]
MD
T[3
]
MD
T[1
]
SG
SG
MA
D[1
8]
MA
D[1
6]
MA
D[1
4]
MA
D[1
2]
MA
D[1
0]
MA
D[8
]
MA
D[6
]
MA
D[4
]
MR
D-0
A
MD
T[6
]
MD
T[4
]
MD
T[2
]
MD
T[0
]
SG
AP
S1
-0A
+5
VA
PS
SG
AP
S2
-0A
+5
VA
PS
J4
4
J4
3
J4
5
CN
20
CN
19
SG
SG
SG
SG
+1
0.5
V
+1
0.5
V
SG
SG
RS
-0
CP
-0
SH
CO
LO
R-0
SH
MO
NO
-0
CK
1-1
CK
2-0
CC
DS
W
SH
-0
SG
SG
SG
+5
.1V
B
+5
.1V
B
+5
.1V
B
SG
SG
AD
CL
K-1
AC
LP
-0
BL
KC
LP
-0
SH
P-0
SH
D-0
CE
RE
D-0
SD
O-0
SC
LK
-0
CE
GR
EE
N-0
SD
O-0
SC
LK
-0
CE
BL
UE
-0
SD
O-0
SC
LK
-0
RD
I(0
)
RD
I[1
]
RD
I[2
]
RD
I[3
]
RD
I[4
]
RD
I[5
]
RD
I[6
]
RD
I[7
]
RD
I[8
]
RD
I[9
]
GD
I[0
]
GD
I[1
]
GD
I[2
]
GD
I[3
]
GD
I[4
]
GD
I[5
]
GD
I[6
]
GD
I[7
]
GD
I[8
]
GD
I[9
]
BD
I[0
]
BD
I[1
]
BD
I[2
]
BD
I[3
]
BD
I[4
]
BD
I[5
]
BD
I[6
]
BD
I[7
]
BD
I[8
]
BD
I[9
]
SG
SG
SG
SG
NC
SG
+3
.3V
A
+3
.3V
A
+3
.3V
A
+3
.3V
A
SG
SG
CN
16
J4
6
J4
7
SG
AP
S3
-0A
+5
VA
PS
SG
AP
SC
-0A
+5
VA
PS
SG
AP
SR
-0A
+5
VA
PS
NC
NC
SG
SG
SG
SG
NC
TX
OU
T3
-
SD
CL
KO
UT
+
SG
TX
OU
T2
-
TX
OU
T1
+
SG
TX
OU
T0
-
MS
RC
KO
UT
+
SG
PH
SY
NC
-
VS
YN
C+
SG
SY
SC
NT
-0
SY
SR
ST
-0
SC
TS
-0
SR
TS
-0A
MM
PIO
-1
ST
XD
-1A
SR
XD
-1
+3
.3V
B
SG
SG
+5
.1V
B
+5
.1V
B
SG
SG
+3
.3V
B
+3
.3V
B
NC
NC
+2
4V
D4
PG
PG
+2
4V
D4
PG
SG
SG
+5
.1V
B
+5
.1V
B
PG
PG
+2
4V
D3
+2
4V
D3
+2
4V
D4
CN
18
CN
12
CN
10
0
CN
10
2
12
1
J5
5
SC
AN
-FA
N-M
OT
(M1
5)
M
RA
DF
Op
tio
n
CN
46
7J4
0
2 1
HD
D-F
AN
-MO
T(M
21
)M
2 1
40
39
38
37
36
35
34
33
32
31
30
29
25
24
23
22
21
20
26
27
28
19
15
14
13
12
11
16
17
181 2 3 41 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
40
39
38
37
36
35
34
33
32
31
30
29
25
24
23
22
21
20
26
27
28
19
15
14
13
12
11
16
17
181 2 3 41 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
+1
2V
A
/RE
SE
T
SG
DD
7
DD
8
DD
6
DD
9
DD
5
DD
10
DD
4
DD
11
DD
3
DD
12
DD
2
DD
13
DD
1
DD
14
DD
0
DD
15
SG
MD
AR
Q
SG
/DIO
W
SG
/DIO
R
SG
IOR
DY
SG
/DM
AC
K
SG
INT
RQ
RE
SE
RV
ED
DA
1
/PD
IAG
DA
0
DA
2
/CS
0
/CS
1
/DA
SP
SG
SG
SG
+5
.1V
A
CN
11
8
CN
11
4
1 2
SG
+1
2V
CN
12
0
1 2
CN
12
4
HD
D
(HD
D)
NC
(KE
Y)
AS
tan
da
rd
FA
X b
oa
rdF
AX
bo
ard
DA
CK
D2
-0D
AC
KD
2-0
DR
EQ
D2
-1D
RE
QD
2-1
CE
P2
CS
-0C
EP
2C
S-0
+5
.1V
B+
5.1
VB
+5
.1V
B+
5.1
VB
IOW
R2
-0IO
WR
2-0
IOR
D2
-0IO
RD
2-0
+5
.1V
B+
5.1
VB
+5
.1V
B+
5.1
VB
CE
P2
INT
-1C
EP
2IN
T-1
CP
UR
ST
-0C
PU
RS
T-0
ME
MW
RL
2-0
ME
MW
RL
2-0
ME
MW
RH
2-0
ME
MW
RH
2-0
RX
EN
2-1
RX
EN
2-1
SG
SG
MO
D2
RS
T-0
MO
D2
RS
T-0
MO
D2
CS
-0M
OD
2C
S-0
MD
2IN
T-1
MD
2IN
T-1
AG
AG
-12
VB
-12
VB
AG
AG
D[1
3]
D[1
3]
D[1
1]
D[1
1]
D[9
]D
[9]
D[7
]D
[7]
D[5
]D
[5]
D[3
]D
[3]
D[1
]D
[1]
A[1
]A
[1]
A[3
]A
[3]
A[5
]A
[5]
A[7
]A
[7]
A[9
]A
[9]
A[1
1]
A[1
1]
A[1
3]
A[1
3]
A[1
5]
A[1
5]
A[1
7]
A[1
7]
A[1
8]
A[1
8]
D[1
5]
D[1
5]
RX
IN2
RX
IN2
DA
CK
C2
-0D
AC
KC
2-0
DR
EQ
C2
-1D
RE
QC
2-1
SG
SG
MO
D2
DE
T-0
MO
D2
DE
T-0
SG
SG
D[1
4]
D[1
4]
D[1
2]
D[1
2]
D[1
0]
D[1
0]
D[8
]D
[8]
D[6
]D
[6]
D[4
]D
[4]
D[2
]D
[2]
D[0
]D
[0]
SG
SG
CE
PC
LK
CE
PC
LK
SG
SG
+5
.1V
B+
5.1
VB
CE
P1
RS
T-0
CE
P1
RS
T-0
+5
.1V
B+
5.1
VB
A[0
]A
[0]
A[2
]A
[2]
A[4
]A
[4]
A[6
]A
[6]
A[8
]A
[8]
A[1
0]
A[1
0]
A[1
2]
A[1
2]
A[1
4]
A[1
4]
A[1
6]
A[1
6]
+5
.1V
B+
5.1
VB
TX
EN
2-1
TX
EN
2-1
CL
KO
E-1
CL
KO
E-1
ME
MR
D2
-0M
EM
RD
2-0
+5
.1V
B+
5.1
VB
ME
M2
CS
-0M
EM
2C
S-0
SG
SG
MO
D2
DM
A-1
MO
D2
DM
A-1
+3
.3V
B+
3.3
VB
+1
2V
B+
12
VB
+5
VA
+5
VA
TX
OU
T2
TX
OU
T2
+1
2V
B+
12
VB
AG
AG
-12
VB
-12
VB
+5
VA
+5
VA
AG
AG
+5
.1V
A+
5.1
VA
NC
NC
NC
NC
NC
NC
NC
NC
AN
SD
ET
AN
SD
ET
CI
CI
AG
AG
16
Hz
16
Hz
+1
2V
B+
12
VB
NC
NC
AG
AG
-12
VB
-12
VB
AG
AG
RG
CL
KR
GC
LK
RE
VB
RE
VB
RE
VA
RE
VA
RL
AD
J1
RL
AD
J1
RL
AD
J2
RL
AD
J2
AT
T3
DB
AT
T3
DB
ER
/HK
ER
/HK
LD
LD
CM
LC
ML
RX
INR
XIN
TX
BT
XB
D[0
]D
[0]
D[2
]D
[2]
D[4
]D
[4]
D[6
]D
[6]
RD
-0R
D-0
A[0
]A
[0]
A[2
]A
[2]
A[4
]A
[4]
A[6
]A
[6]
A[8
]A
[8]
A[1
0]
A[1
0]
A[1
2]
A[1
2]
A[1
4]
A[1
4]
A[1
6]
A[1
6]
A[1
8]
A[1
8]
SG
SG
SG
SG
D[1
]D
[1]
D[3
]D
[3]
D[5
]D
[5]
D[7
]D
[7]
BO
OT
CS
-0B
OO
TC
S-0
A[1
]A
[1]
A[3
]A
[3]
A[5
]A
[5]
A[7
]A
[7]
A[9
]A
[9]
A[1
1]
A[1
1]
A[1
3]
A[1
3]
A[1
5]
A[1
5]
A[1
7]
A[1
7]
RO
MD
ET
0-0
RO
MD
ET
0-0
+5
.1V
B+
5.1
VB
LE
DD
L-0
LE
DD
L-0
PG
PG
+2
4V
B+
24
VB
+1
2V
B+
12
VB
AG
AG
-12
VB
-12
VB
+5
VA
+5
VA
AG
AG
+5
.1V
A+
5.1
VA
FX
TH
OO
KF
XT
HO
OK
INT
HO
OK
INT
HO
OK
AN
SD
ET
AN
SD
ET
CI
CI
AG
AG
16
Hz
16
Hz
+2
4V
B+
24
VB
+1
2V
B+
12
VB
AG
AG
-12
VB
-12
VB
AG
AG
RG
CL
KR
GC
LK
RE
VB
RE
VB
RE
VA
RE
VA
RL
AD
J1
RL
AD
J1
RL
AD
J2
RL
AD
J2
AT
T3
DB
AT
T3
DB
EX
TR
GE
XT
RG
LD
LD
CM
LC
ML
RX
INR
XIN
TX
OU
TT
XO
UT
NCU board [Line1] NCU board [Line1] NCU board [Line2] NCU board [Line2]
MODEM board MODEM board
FA
X b
oa
rd
40
39
38
37
36
35
34
33
32
31
30
29
25
24
23
22
21
20
26
27
28
50
49
45
44
43
42
41
46
47
48
19
15
14
13
12
11
16
17
181 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
40
39
38
37
36
35
34
33
32
31
30
29
25
24
23
22
21
20
26
27
28
50
49
45
44
43
42
41
46
47
48
19
15
14
13
12
11
16
17
181 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
34
33
32
31
30
29
25
24
23
22
21
20
26
27
28
19
15
14
13
12
11
16
17
181 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
34
33
32
31
30
29
25
24
23
22
21
20
26
27
28
19
15
14
13
12
11
16
17
181 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
NC
NC
PG
+2
4V
40
39
38
37
36
35
34
33
32
31
30
29
25
24
23
22
21
20
26
27
28
50
49
45
44
43
42
41
46
47
48
60
59
58
57
56
55
54
53
52
51
70
69
65
64
63
62
61
66
67
68
80
79
75
74
73
72
71
76
77
78
19
15
14
13
12
11
16
17
181 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
40
39
38
37
36
35
34
33
32
31
30
29
25
24
23
22
21
20
26
27
28
50
49
45
44
43
42
41
46
47
48
60
59
58
57
56
55
54
53
52
51
70
69
65
64
63
62
61
66
67
68
80
79
75
74
73
72
71
76
77
78
19
15
14
13
12
11
16
17
181 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
30
29
25
24
23
22
21
20
26
27
28
19
15
14
13
12
11
16
17
181 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
30
29
25
24
23
22
21
20
26
27
28
19
15
14
13
12
11
16
17
181 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
DA
CK
D2
-0
DR
EQ
D2
-1
CE
P2
CS
-0
+5
.1V
B
+5
.1V
B
IOW
R2
-0
IOR
D2
-0
+5
.1V
B
+5
.1V
B
CE
P2
INT
-1
CP
UR
ST
-0
ME
MW
RL
2-0
ME
MW
RH
2-0
RX
EN
2-1
SG
MO
D2
RS
T-0
MO
D2
CS
-0
MD
2IN
T-1
AG
-12
VB
AG
D[1
3]
D[1
1]
D[9
]
D[7
]
D[5
]
D[3
]
D[1
]
A[1
]
A[3
]
A[5
]
A[7
]
A[9
]
A[1
1]
A[1
3]
A[1
5]
A[1
7]
A[1
8]
D[1
5]
RX
IN2
DA
CK
C2
-0
DR
EQ
C2
-1
SG
MO
D2
DE
T-0
SG
D[1
4]
D[1
2]
D[1
0]
D[8
]
D[6
]
D[4
]
D[2
]
D[0
]
SG
CE
PC
LK
SG
+5
.1V
B
CE
P1
RS
T-0
+5
.1V
B
A[0
]
A[2
]
A[4
]
A[6
]
A[8
]
A[1
0]
A[1
2]
A[1
4]
A[1
6]
+5
.1V
B
TX
EN
2-1
CL
KO
E-1
ME
MR
D2
-0
+5
.1V
B
ME
M2
CS
-0
SG
MO
D2
DM
A-1
+3
.3V
B
+1
2V
B
+5
VA
TX
OU
T2
CN
60
0C
N4
01
CN
9 o
r C
N4
+1
2V
B
AG
-12
VB
+5
VA
AG
+5
.1V
A
NC
NC
NC
NC
AN
SD
ET
CI
AG
16
Hz
+1
2V
B
NC
AG
-12
VB
AG
RG
CL
K
RE
VB
RE
VA
RL
AD
J1
RL
AD
J2
AT
T3
DB
ER
/HK
LD
CM
L
RX
IN
TX
B
NC
NC
SG
SG
FX
WU
P
NC
DM
AR
Q
/RE
SE
T
/DL
DC
S0
/DM
AC
K
/DIO
W
/DIO
R
DD
15
DD
14
DD
13
DD
11
DD
10
DD
8
DD
7
DD
5
DD
4
DD
2
DD
1
IDE
CS
DA
2
DA
0
+1
2V
B
SG
-12
VB
+5
.1V
A
+3
.3V
B
INT
RQ
+3
.3V
B
SG
SG
SG
SG
SG
SG
DD
12
SG
DD
9
+5
.1V
B
DD
6
+5
.1V
B
DD
3
+5
.1V
B
DD
0
+5
.1V
B
DA
1
+5
.1V
BCN
10
1C
N7
01
CN
60
2
D[0
]
D[2
]
D[4
]
D[6
]
RD
-0
A[0
]
A[2
]
A[4
]
A[6
]
A[8
]
A[1
0]
A[1
2]
A[1
4]
A[1
6]
A[1
8]
SG
SG
D[1
]
D[3
]
D[5
]
D[7
]
BO
OT
CS
-0
A[1
]
A[3
]
A[5
]
A[7
]
A[9
]
A[1
1]
A[1
3]
A[1
5]
A[1
7]
RO
MD
ET
0-0
+5
.1V
B
LE
DD
L-0
PG
+2
4V
B
+1
2V
B
AG
-12
VB
+5
VA
AG
+5
.1V
A
FX
TH
OO
K
INT
HO
OK
AN
SD
ET
CI
AG
16
Hz
+2
4V
B
+1
2V
B
AG
-12
VB
AG
RG
CL
K
RE
VB
RE
VA
RL
AD
J1
RL
AD
J2
AT
T3
DB
EX
TR
G
LD
CM
L
RX
IN
TX
OU
T
CN
50
1
-+CN
50
3
Sp
ea
ke
r
Op
tio
n
NCU board [Line1]
30
29
25
24
23
22
21
20
26
27
28
19
15
14
13
12
11
16
17
181 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
1 2
CN
70
2
JP
D m
od
el o
nly
JP
D m
od
el o
nly
1 2 3
1 2 3
-12
VB
+1
2V
B
NCC
N4
01
1 2 3
NC
NC
NC
4 5 6
SG
AG
7 8
NC
PG
+1
2V
BCN
81
0
CN
81
1
4 3 2 1
CN
81
2
1 2 3
30
29
25
24
23
22
21
20
26
27
28
19
15
14
13
12
11
16
17
181 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
CN
9 o
r C
N4
CN
50
2
NCU board [Line2]
MODEM board
1
2 3
2
13
J6
34
PG
NC
NC
+1
2V
B
DIMM [1]
SG
SG
DQ
0D
Q0
DQ
1D
Q1
DQ
2D
Q2
DQ
3D
Q3
+3
.3V
A+
3.3
VA
DQ
4D
Q4
DQ
5D
Q5
DQ
6D
Q6
DQ
7D
Q7
DQ
8D
Q8
SG
SG
DQ
9D
Q9
DQ
10
DQ
10
DQ
11
DQ
11
DQ
12
DQ
12
DQ
13
DQ
13
+3
.3V
A+
3.3
VA
DQ
14
DQ
14
DQ
15
DQ
15
NC
NC
NC
NC
SG
SG
NC
NC
NC
NC
+3
.3V
A+
3.3
VA
/WE
/WE
DQ
MB
0D
QM
B0
DQ
MB
1D
QM
B1
/CS
0/C
S0
NC
NC
SG
SG
A0
A0
A2
A2
A4
A4
A6
A6
A8
A8
A1
0A
10
BA
1B
A1
+3
.3V
A+
3.3
VA
+3
.3V
A+
3.3
VA
CL
K0
CL
K0
SG
SG
NC
NC
/CS
2/C
S2
DQ
MB
2D
QM
B2
DQ
MB
3D
QM
B3
NC
NC
+3
.3V
A+
3.3
VA
NC
NC
NC
NC
NC
NC
NC
NC
SG
SG
DQ
16
DQ
16
DQ
17
DQ
17
DQ
18
DQ
18
DQ
19
DQ
19
+3
.3V
A+
3.3
VA
DQ
20
DQ
20
NC
NC
NC
NC
CK
E1
CK
E1
SG
SG
DQ
21
DQ
21
DQ
22
DQ
22
DQ
23
DQ
23
SG
SG
DQ
24
DQ
24
DQ
25
DQ
25
DQ
26
DQ
26
DQ
27
DQ
27
+3
.3V
A+
3.3
VA
DQ
28
DQ
28
DQ
29
DQ
29
DQ
30
DQ
30
DQ
31
DQ
31
SG
SG
CL
K2
CL
K2
NC
NC
NC
(WP
)N
C(W
P)
SD
AS
DA
SC
LS
CL
+3
.3V
A+
3.3
VA
SG
SG
DQ
32
DQ
32
DQ
33
DQ
33
DQ
34
DQ
34
DQ
35
DQ
35
+3
.3V
A+
3.3
VA
DQ
36
DQ
36
DQ
37
DQ
37
DQ
38
DQ
38
DQ
39
DQ
39
DQ
40
DQ
40
SG
SG
DQ
41
DQ
41
DQ
42
DQ
42
DQ
43
DQ
43
DQ
44
DQ
44
DQ
45
DQ
45
+3
.3V
A+
3.3
VA
DQ
46
DQ
46
DQ
47
DQ
47
NC
NC
NC
NC
SG
SG
NC
NC
NC
NC
+3
.3V
A+
3.3
VA
/CA
S/C
AS
DQ
MB
4D
QM
B4
DQ
MB
5D
QM
B5
/CS
1/C
S1
/RA
S/R
AS
SG
SG
A1
A1
A3
A3
A5
A5
A7
A7
A9
A9
A1
1A
11
BA
0B
A0
+3
.3V
A+
3.3
VA
CL
K1
CL
K1
A1
2A
12
SG
SG
CK
EC
KE
/CS
3/C
S3
DQ
MB
6D
QM
B6
DQ
MB
7D
QM
B7
A1
3A
13
+3
.3V
A+
3.3
VA
NC
NC
NC
NC
NC
NC
NC
NC
SG
SG
DQ
48
DQ
48
DQ
49
DQ
49
DQ
50
DQ
50
DQ
51
DQ
51
+3
.3V
A+
3.3
VA
DQ
52
DQ
52
NC
NC
NC
NC
NC
NC
SG
SG
DQ
53
DQ
53
DQ
54
DQ
54
DQ
55
DQ
55
SG
SG
DQ
56
DQ
56
DQ
57
DQ
57
DQ
58
DQ
58
DQ
59
DQ
59
+3
.3V
A+
3.3
VA
DQ
60
DQ
60
DQ
61
DQ
61
DQ
62
DQ
62
DQ
63
DQ
63
SG
SG
CL
K3
CL
K3
NC
NC
SA
0S
A0
SA
1S
A1
SA
2S
A2
+3
.3V
A+
3.3
VA
CN
12
3 40
39
38
37
36
35
34
33
32
31
30
29
25
24
23
22
21
20
26
27
28
19
15
14
13
12
11
16
17
181 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
80
79
78
77
76
75
74
73
72
71
70
69
65
64
63
62
61
60
66
67
68
59
55
54
53
52
51
56
57
58
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
10
0
10
1
10
2
10
3
10
4
10
5
10
6
10
7
10
8
10
9
11
0
11
1
11
2
11
3
11
4
11
5
11
6
11
7
11
8
11
9
12
0
12
1
12
2
12
3
12
4
12
5
12
6
12
7
12
8
12
9
13
0
13
1
13
2
13
3
13
4
13
5
13
6
13
7
13
8
13
9
14
0
14
1
14
2
14
3
14
4
14
5
14
6
14
7
14
8
14
9
15
0
15
1
15
2
15
3
15
4
15
5
15
6
15
7
15
8
15
9
16
0
16
1
16
2
16
3
16
4
16
5
16
6
16
7
16
8
99
95
94
93
92
91
96
97
98
81
82
83
84
85
86
87
88
89
90
SG
DQ
0
DQ
1
DQ
2
DQ
3
+3
.3V
A
DQ
4
DQ
5
DQ
6
DQ
7
DQ
8
SG
DQ
9
DQ
10
DQ
11
DQ
12
DQ
13
+3
.3V
A
DQ
14
DQ
15
NC
NC
SG
NC
NC
+3
.3V
A
/WE
DQ
MB
0
DQ
MB
1
/CS
0
NC
SG
A0
A2
A4
A6
A8
A1
0
BA
1
+3
.3V
A
+3
.3V
A
CL
K0
SG
NC
/CS
2
DQ
MB
2
DQ
MB
3
NC
+3
.3V
A
NC
NC
NC
NC
SG
DQ
16
DQ
17
DQ
18
DQ
19
+3
.3V
A
DQ
20
NC
NC
CK
E1
SG
DQ
21
DQ
22
DQ
23
SG
DQ
24
DQ
25
DQ
26
DQ
27
+3
.3V
A
DQ
28
DQ
29
DQ
30
DQ
31
SG
CL
K2
NC
NC
(WP
)
SD
A
SC
L
+3
.3V
A
SG
DQ
32
DQ
33
DQ
34
DQ
35
+3
.3V
A
DQ
36
DQ
37
DQ
38
DQ
39
DQ
40
SG
DQ
41
DQ
42
DQ
43
DQ
44
DQ
45
+3
.3V
A
DQ
46
DQ
47
NC
NC
SG
NC
NC
+3
.3V
A
/CA
S
DQ
MB
4
DQ
MB
5
/CS
1
/RA
S
SG
A1
A3
A5
A7
A9
A1
1
BA
0
+3
.3V
A
CL
K1
A1
2
SG
CK
E
/CS
3
DQ
MB
6
DQ
MB
7
A1
3
+3
.3V
A
NC
NC
NC
NC
SG
DQ
48
DQ
49
DQ
50
DQ
51
+3
.3V
A
DQ
52
NC
NC
NC
SG
DQ
53
DQ
54
DQ
55
SG
DQ
56
DQ
57
DQ
58
DQ
59
+3
.3V
A
DQ
60
DQ
61
DQ
62
DQ
63
SG
CL
K3
NC
SA
0
SA
1
SA
2
+3
.3V
A
DIMM [0]
CN
12
2
Op
tio
n
Op
tio
nScrambler board Parallel interface kit
SE
LE
CT
NA
CK
NF
AU
LT
PE
ER
R
DA
TA
[0]
DA
TA
[1]
DA
TA
[2]
DA
TA
[3]
BU
SY
DA
TA
[4]
DA
TA
[5]
DA
TA
[6]
DA
TA
[7]
NIN
IT
NS
TR
OB
NS
EL
IN
NA
UT
DF
HL
H
SG
SG
SG
SG
SG
SG
SG
SG
SG
SG
SG
SG
SG
SG
SG
SG
SG
PL
H
GN
D
GN
D
RX
IN-
TX
D-
TX
D+
RX
IN+
GN
D
GN
D
+5
.1V
A
+5
.1V
A
+3
.3V
A
SG
+3
.3V
A
SG
SG
+3
.3V
A
PA
R
SG
SG
+3
.3V
A
+3
.3V
A
ST
OP
SG
TR
DY
SG
FR
AM
E
+3
.3V
A
SG
+3
.3V
A
+3
.3V
A
SG
+3
.3V
A
PM
E
PC
IRS
T
SG
+3
.3V
A
+3
.3V
A
+3
.3V
A
+3
.3V
A
+5
.1V
A
+5
.1V
A
+1
2V
A
+1
2V
A
SG
+3
.3V
A
+3
.3V
A
+3
.3V
A
SG
+5
.1V
A
+3
.3V
A
SG
+3
.3V
A
SG
M6
6E
N
SG
+3
.3V
A
SE
RR
+3
.3V
A
PE
RR
LO
CK
DE
VS
EL
SG
+3
.3V
A
IRD
Y
SG
+3
.3V
A
SG
+3
.3V
A
SG
+3
.3V
A
SG
SG
SG
+3
.3V
A
+5
.1V
A
+5
.1V
A
-12
VA
-12
VA
SG
+3
.3V
A
+3
.3V
A
+3
.3V
A
AD
[0]
AD
[2]
AD
[4]
AD
[6]
AD
[9]
AD
[11
]
AD
[13
]
AD
[15
]
AD
[16
]
AD
[18
]
AD
[20
]
AD
[22
]
AD
[24
]
AD
[26
]
AD
[28
]
AD
[30
]
AD
[1]
AD
[3]
AD
[5]
AD
[8]
AD
[7]
AD
[12
]
AD
[14
]
AD
[17
]
AD
[19
]
AD
[21
]
AD
[23
]
AD
[25
]
AD
[27
]
AD
[29
]
AD
[31
]
PC
ICL
K(3
)
IDS
EL
1
OP
BIN
T(0
)
IDS
EL
0
AD
[10
]
PC
ICL
K(4
)
OP
BIN
T(1
)
C/B
E[0
]
GN
T(0
)
GN
T(1
)
C/B
E[1
]
C/B
E[2
]
C/B
E[3
]
RE
Q(0
)
RE
Q(1
)
20
19
15
14
13
12
11
16
17
181 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
11
12
16
17
18
19
20
15
14
13 678910 5
CN
11
6 DE
TA
CH
NC
SG
NC
NC
/RE
SE
T
NC
NC
NC
NC
NC
NC
SG
124 3
NC
NC
D+
D-
NC
NC
VD
D
Bluetooth module
VD
D
DM
2
A1
1
DQ
21
SG
A1
2
DQ
20
NC
DM
0
VD
D
VD
D
CK
E1
DQ
15
DQ
14
VD
D
DM
1
DQ
13
DQ
14
VD
D
NC
NC
NC
SG
DQ
7
DQ
6
DQ
5
DQ
4
SG
DQ
38
DM
4
VD
D
DQ
37
DQ
36
SG
CB
7
VD
D
DQ
29
DQ
28
CB
6
A1
0
DM
B
SG
/CK
0
CK
0
VD
D
CB
5
CB
4
DQ
31
SG
DQ
30
A3
DM
3
VD
D
A6
SG
DQ
23
A8
DQ
22
VD
D
DQ
63
DQ
62
DM
7
VD
D-S
PD
SA
2
SA
1
SA
0
SG
DQ
61
DQ
60
NC
/CS
0
VD
D
VD
D
DQ
S5
DQ
S4
DM
6
VD
D
NC
DQ
S3
DQ
S2
VD
D
NC
DQ
47
DQ
46
SG
DM
S
/CS
1
DQ
45
/RA
S
DQ
44
SG
DQ
39
VD
D
A7
DQ
18
A9
SG
DQ
S2
DQ
17
DQ
16
VD
D
DQ
2
VD
D
CK
E0
DQ
11
DQ
10
SG
/CK
1
CK
1
VD
D
DQ
S1
DQ
9
DQ
8
SG
NC
NC
DQ
3
DQ
S0
DQ
1
SG
DQ
0
VR
EF
DQ
35
BA
0
SG
DQ
34
DQ
S4
DQ
33
VD
D
DQ
32
A4
DQ
S3
BA
1
CB
3
SG
CB
2
A0
DQ
S8
VD
D
CB
1
CB
0
A1
SGA2
DQ
27
DQ
26
VD
D
DQ
25
SG
DQ
24
A5
DQ
19
NC
SG
DQ
59
DQ
58
DQ
S7
VD
D
DQ
57
DQ
56
DQ
55
SG
VD
D-I
D
SG
DQ
51
DQ
50
DQ
S6
VD
D
CK
2
/CK
2
SG
DQ
49
DQ
48
NC
VD
D
DQ
43
DQ
42
/CA
S
DQ
41
/WE
VD
D
DQ
40
SC
L
SD
A
CN
10
7C
N1
07
30
29
25
24
23
22
21
20
26
27
28
19
15
14
13
12
11
16
17
181 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
VD
D
A7
DQ
18
A9
SG
DQ
S2
DQ
17
DQ
16
VD
D
DQ
2
VD
D
CK
E0
DQ
11
DQ
10
SG
/CK
1
CK
1
VD
D
DQ
S1
DQ
9
DQ
8
SG
NC
NC
DQ
3
DQ
S0
DQ
1
SG
DQ
0
VR
EF
60
59
55
54
53
52
51
50
56
57
58
49
45
44
43
42
41
46
47
48
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
DQ
35
BA
0
SG
DQ
34
DQ
S4
DQ
33
VD
D
DQ
32
A4
DQ
S3
BA
1
CB
3
SG
CB
2
A0
DQ
S8
VD
D
CB
1
CB
0
A1
SGA2
DQ
27
DQ
26
VD
D
DQ
25
SG
DQ
24
A5
DQ
19
90
89
85
84
83
82
81
80
86
87
88
79
75
74
73
72
71
76
77
78
61
62
63
64
65
66
67
68
69
70
NC
SG
DQ
59
DQ
58
DQ
S7
VD
D
DQ
57
DQ
56
DQ
55
SG
VD
D-I
D
SG
DQ
51
DQ
50
DQ
S6
VD
D
CK
2
/CK
2
SG
DQ
49
DQ
48
NC
VD
D
DQ
43
DQ
42
/CA
S
DQ
41
/WE
VD
D
DQ
40
12
0
11
9
11
5
11
4
11
3
11
2
11
1
11
0
11
6
11
7
11
8
10
9
10
5
10
4
10
3
10
2
10
1
10
6
10
7
10
8
91
92
93
94
95
96
97
98
99
10
0
VD
D
DM
2
A1
1
DQ
21
SG
A1
2
DQ
20
NC
DM
0
VD
D
VD
D
CK
E1
DQ
15
DQ
14
VD
D
DM
1
DQ
13
DQ
14
VD
D
NC
NC
NC
SG
DQ
7
DQ
6
DQ
5
DQ
4
SG
SC
L
SD
A
15
0
14
9
14
5
14
4
14
3
14
2
14
1
14
0
14
6
14
7
14
8
13
9
13
5
13
4
13
3
13
2
13
1
13
6
13
7
13
8
12
1
12
2
12
3
12
4
12
5
12
6
12
7
12
8
12
9
13
0
DQ
38
DM
4
VD
D
DQ
37
DQ
36
SG
CB
7
VD
D
DQ
29
DQ
28
CB
6
A1
0
DM
B
SG
/CK
0
CK
0
VD
D
CB
5
CB
4
DQ
31
SG
DQ
30
A3
DM
3
VD
D
A6
SG
DQ
23
A8
DQ
22
18
0
17
9
17
5
17
4
17
3
17
2
17
1
17
0
17
6
17
7
17
8
16
9
16
5
16
4
16
3
16
2
16
1
16
6
16
7
16
8
15
1
15
2
15
3
15
4
15
5
15
6
15
7
15
8
15
9
16
0
VD
D
DQ
63
DQ
62
DM
7
18
4
18
3
18
1
18
2
VD
D-S
PD
SA
2
SA
1
SA
0
SG
DQ
61
DQ
60
NC
/CS
0
VD
D
VD
D
DQ
S5
DQ
S4
DM
6
VD
D
NC
DQ
S3
DQ
S2
VD
D
NC
DQ
47
DQ
46
SG
DM
S
/CS
1
DQ
45
/RA
S
DQ
44
SG
DQ
39
VD
D
DM
2
A1
1
DQ
21
SG
A1
2
DQ
20
NC
DM
0
VD
D
VD
D
CK
E1
DQ
15
DQ
14
VD
D
DM
1
DQ
13
DQ
14
VD
D
NC
NC
NC
SG
DQ
7
DQ
6
DQ
5
DQ
4
SG
DQ
38
DM
4
VD
D
DQ
37
DQ
36
SG
CB
7
VD
D
DQ
29
DQ
28
CB
6
A1
0
DM
B
SG
/CK
0
CK
0
VD
D
CB
5
CB
4
DQ
31
SG
DQ
30
A3
DM
3
VD
D
A6
SG
DQ
23
A8
DQ
22
VD
D
DQ
63
DQ
62
DM
7
VD
D-S
PD
SA
2
SA
1
SA
0
SG
DQ
61
DQ
60
NC
/CS
0
VD
D
VD
D
DQ
S5
DQ
S4
DM
6
VD
D
NC
DQ
S3
DQ
S2
VD
D
NC
DQ
47
DQ
46
SG
DM
S
/CS
1
DQ
45
/RA
S
DQ
44
SG
DQ
39
DDR DIMM
CN
12
1
30
29
25
24
23
22
21
20
26
27
28
19
15
14
13
12
11
16
17
181 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
60
59
55
54
53
52
51
50
56
57
58
49
45
44
43
42
41
46
47
48
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
90
89
85
84
83
82
81
80
86
87
88
79
75
74
73
72
71
76
77
78
61
62
63
64
65
66
67
68
69
70
12
0
11
9
11
5
11
4
11
3
11
2
11
1
11
0
11
6
11
7
11
8
10
9
10
5
10
4
10
3
10
2
10
1
10
6
10
7
10
8
91
92
93
94
95
96
97
98
99
10
0
PC interface (IEEE1284)
40
39
38
37
36
35
34
33
32
31
30
29
25
24
23
22
21
20
26
27
28
19
15
14
13
12
11
16
17
181 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
80
79
78
77
76
75
74
73
72
71
70
69
65
64
63
62
61
60
66
67
68
59
55
54
53
52
51
56
57
58
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
12
0
11
9
11
8
11
7
11
6
11
5
11
4
11
3
11
2
11
1
11
0
10
9
10
5
10
4
10
3
10
2
10
1
10
0
10
6
10
7
10
8
99
95
94
93
92
91
96
97
98
81
82
83
84
85
86
87
88
89
90
A6
A7
A8
A9
A1
0
A1
1
A1
4
A1
5
A1
6
A1
7
A1
A2
A3
A4
A5
A1
9
A2
0
A2
1
A2
2
A2
3
A2
4
A2
5
A2
6
A2
7
A2
8
A2
9
A3
0
A1
8
A3
6
A3
7
A3
8
A3
9
A4
0
A4
1
A4
2
A4
3
A4
4
A4
5
A4
6
A4
7
A3
1
A3
2
A3
3
A3
4
A3
5
A4
9
A5
0
A5
1
A5
2
A5
3
A5
4
A5
5
A5
6
A5
7
A5
8
A5
9
A6
0
A6
1
A6
2
A4
8
B6
B7
B8
B9
B1
0
B1
1
B1
4
B1
5
B1
6
B1
7
B1
B2
B3
B4
B5
B1
9
B2
0
B2
1
B2
2
B2
3
B2
4
B2
5
B2
6
B2
7
B2
8
B2
9
B3
0
B1
8
B3
6
B3
7
B3
8
B3
9
B4
0
B4
1
B4
2
B4
3
B4
4
B4
5
B4
6
B4
7
B3
1
B3
2
B3
3
B3
4
B3
5
B4
9
B5
0
B5
1
B5
2
B5
3
B5
4
B5
5
B5
6
B5
7
B5
8
B5
9
B6
0
B6
1
B6
2
B4
8
+5
.1V
A
+5
.1V
A
+3
.3V
A
SG
+3
.3V
A
SG
SG
+3
.3V
A
PA
R
SG
SG
+3
.3V
A
+3
.3V
A
ST
OP
SG
TR
DY
SG
FR
AM
E
+3
.3V
A
SG
+3
.3V
A
+3
.3V
A
SG
+3
.3V
A
PM
E
PC
IRS
T
SG
+3
.3V
A
+3
.3V
A
+3
.3V
A
+3
.3V
A
+5
.1V
A
+5
.1V
A
+1
2V
A
+1
2V
A
SG
+3
.3V
A
+3
.3V
A
+3
.3V
A
SG
+5
.1V
A
+3
.3V
A
SG
+3
.3V
A
SG
M6
6E
N
SG
+3
.3V
A
SE
RR
+3
.3V
A
PE
RR
LO
CK
DE
VS
EL
SG
+3
.3V
A
IRD
Y
SG
+3
.3V
A
SG
+3
.3V
A
SG
+3
.3V
A
SG
SG
SG
+3
.3V
A
+5
.1V
A
+5
.1V
A
-12
VA
-12
VA
SG
TR
ST
#
+1
2V
A
Slo
t [0
] :
CN
80
2
Slo
t [1
] :
CN
80
3
CN
80
1T
MS
TD
1
+5
.1V
A
INT
A#
INT
C#
+5
.1V
A
+3
.3V
A
RE
SE
RV
ED
RE
SE
RV
ED
+3
.3V
AU
X
RS
T#
+3
.3V
A
GN
T#
SG
PM
E#
+3
.3V
A
SG
IDS
EL
+3
.3V
A
SG
+3
.3V
A
FR
AM
E#
SG
TR
DY
#
SG
ST
OP
#
+3
.3V
A
RE
SE
RV
ED
RE
SE
RV
ED
SG
PA
R
+3
.3V
A
SG
SG
SG
+3
.3V
A
SG
+3
.3V
A
RE
Q6
4#
+5
.1V
A
+5
.1V
A
-12
VA
TC
K
SG
TD
O
+5
.1V
A
+5
.1V
A
INT
B#
INT
D#
PR
SN
T1
#
RE
SE
RV
ED
PR
SN
T2
#
RE
SE
RV
ED
SG
CL
K
SG
RE
Q#
+3
.3V
A
SG
+3
.3V
A
SG
+3
.3V
A
SG
IRD
Y#
+3
.3V
A
DE
VS
EL
#
SG
LO
CK
#
PE
RR
#
+3
.3V
A
SE
RR
#
+3
.3V
A
SG
M6
6E
N
SG
SG
+3
.3V
A
SG
AD
[01
]
AD
[03
]
AD
[05
]
AD
[07
]
AD
[08
]
AD
[10
]
AD
[12
]
AD
[17
]
AD
[19
]
AD
[21
]
AD
[23
]
AD
[25
]
AD
[27
]
AD
[29
]
AD
[31
]
AD
[00
]
AD
[02
]
AD
[04
]
AD
[06
]
AD
[11
]
AD
[09
]
AD
[13
]
AD
[15
]
AD
[16
]
AD
[18
]
AD
[20
]
AD
[22
]
AD
[24
]
AD
[26
]
AD
[28
]
AD
[30
]
AD
[14
]
C/B
E[1
]#
C/B
E[2
]#
C/B
E[3
]#
C/B
E[0
]#
+3
.3V
A
AC
K6
4#
+5
.1V
A
+5
.1V
A
+3
.3V
A
+3
.3V
A
+3
.3V
A
AD
[0]
AD
[2]
AD
[4]
AD
[6]
AD
[9]
AD
[11
]
AD
[13
]
AD
[15
]
AD
[16
]
AD
[18
]
AD
[20
]
AD
[22
]
AD
[24
]
AD
[26
]
AD
[28
]
AD
[30
]
AD
[1]
AD
[3]
AD
[5]
AD
[8]
AD
[7]
AD
[12
]
AD
[14
]
AD
[17
]
AD
[19
]
AD
[21
]
AD
[23
]
AD
[25
]
AD
[27
]
AD
[29
]
AD
[31
]
PC
ICL
K(3
)
IDS
EL
1
OP
BIN
T(0
)
IDS
EL
0
AD
[10
]
PC
ICL
K(4
)
OP
BIN
T(1
)
C/B
E[0
]
GN
T(0
)
GN
T(1
)
C/B
E[1
]
C/B
E[2
]
C/B
E[3
]
RE
Q(0
)
RE
Q(1
)
40
39
38
37
36
35
34
33
32
31
30
29
25
24
23
22
21
20
26
27
28
19
15
14
13
12
11
16
17
181 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
Scrambler board
PCI slot
Parallel interface kit
A
36
35
34
33
32
31
30
29
25
24
23
22
21
20
26
27
28
19
15
14
13
12
11
16
17
181 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
SE
LE
CT
NA
CK
NF
AU
LT
PE
ER
R
DA
TA
[0]
DA
TA
[1]
DA
TA
[2]
DA
TA
[3]
BU
SY
CN
2
CN
2
DA
TA
[4]
DA
TA
[5]
DA
TA
[6]
DA
TA
[7]
NIN
IT
NS
TR
OB
NS
EL
IN
NA
UT
DF
HL
H
SG
SG
SG
SG
SG
SG
SG
SG
SG
SG
SG
SG
SG
SG
SG
SG
SG
PL
H
To
Slo
t [0
]
To
Slo
t [0
] o
r [1
]
Op
tio
n
+3
.3V
A
GN
T
RE
Q
+3
.3V
A
SG
RS
T
CL
K
+3
.3V
A
BP
MJ-7
BP
MJ-2
RS
V
RS
V
INT
A
+3
.3V
A
+5
.1V
A
INT
B
RS
V
CH
SC
ND
LE
D2
YE
LN
EN
AB
LE
/DIS
AB
LE
LE
D2
YE
LP
LE
D1
GR
NP
BP
MJ-5
BP
MJ-8
BP
MJ-4
BP
MJ-6
BP
MJ-1
BP
MJ-3
RIN
G
TIP
AD
[16
]
C/B
E[2
]
AD
[18
]
AD
[17
]
PA
R
SG
AD
[20
]
AD
[19
]
SG
RS
V
AD
[22
]
AD
[21
]
SG
SG
IDS
EL
AD
[23
]
AD
[24
]
C/B
E[3
]
AD
[26
]
RS
V
AD
[28
]
AD
[25
]
+3
.3V
A
AD
[27
]
AD
[30
]
AD
[29
]
PM
E
AD
[31
]
SG
SG
+3
.3V
A
IRD
Y
AD
[05
]
+3
.3V
A
+3
.3V
A
AD
[07
]
C/B
E[0
]
AD
[08
]
AD
[09
]
SG
ST
OP
SE
RR
SG
AD
[10
]
AD
[11
]
AD
[12
]
AD
[13
]
SG
AD
[15
]
AD
[14
]
SG
C/B
E[1
]
DE
VS
EL
PE
RR
+3
.3V
A
+3
.3V
A
SG
TR
DY
CL
KR
UN
FR
AM
E
AU
DIO
GN
D
AU
DIO
GN
D
SY
S A
UD
IO I
N G
ND
SY
S A
UD
IO
OU
T G
ND
SY
S A
UD
IO I
N
SY
S A
UD
IO O
UT
SG
AU
DIO
GN
D
+5
.1V
A
AD
[00
]
RS
V
MO
D A
UD
IO M
ON
AC
RE
SE
T
AC
CO
DE
C I
D1
AC
CO
DE
C I
D0
AC
BIT
CL
K
AC
SD
AT
A O
UT
AC
SD
AT
A I
N
M6
6E
N
AC
SY
NC
SG
SG
RS
V W
IP
AD
[01
]
RS
V W
IP
AD
[03
]
AD
[02
]
RS
V
AD
[04
]
AD
[06
]
+3
.3V
A
VC
C5
V
MP
C1
AC
T
RS
V
CN
11
9
30
29
25
24
23
22
21
20
26
27
28
19
15
14
13
12
11
16
17
181 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
+3
.3V
A
GN
T
RE
Q
+3
.3V
A
SG
RS
T
CL
K
+3
.3V
A
BP
MJ-7
BP
MJ-2
RS
V
RS
V
INT
A
+3
.3V
A
+5
.1V
A
INT
B
RS
V
CH
SC
ND
LE
D2
YE
LN
EN
AB
LE
/DIS
AB
LE
LE
D2
YE
LP
LE
D1
GR
NP
BP
MJ-5
BP
MJ-8
BP
MJ-4
BP
MJ-6
BP
MJ-1
BP
MJ-3
RIN
G
TIP
60
59
55
54
53
52
51
50
56
57
58
49
45
44
43
42
41
46
47
48
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
AD
[16
]
C/B
E[2
]
AD
[18
]
AD
[17
]
PA
R
SG
AD
[20
]
AD
[19
]
SG
RS
V
AD
[22
]
AD
[21
]
SG
SG
IDS
EL
AD
[23
]
AD
[24
]
C/B
E[3
]
AD
[26
]
RS
V
AD
[28
]
AD
[25
]
+3
.3V
A
AD
[27
]
AD
[30
]
AD
[29
]
PM
E
AD
[31
]
SG
SG
90
89
85
84
83
82
81
80
86
87
88
79
75
74
73
72
71
76
77
78
61
62
63
64
65
66
67
68
69
70
+3
.3V
A
IRD
Y
12
0
11
9
11
5
11
4
11
3
11
2
11
1
11
0
11
6
11
7
11
8
10
9
10
5
10
4
10
3
10
2
10
1
10
6
10
7
10
8
91
92
93
94
95
96
97
98
99
10
0
AD
[05
]
+3
.3V
A
+3
.3V
A
AD
[07
]
C/B
E[0
]
AD
[08
]
AD
[09
]
SG
ST
OP
SE
RR
SG
AD
[10
]
AD
[11
]
AD
[12
]
AD
[13
]
SG
AD
[15
]
AD
[14
]
SG
C/B
E[1
]
DE
VS
EL
PE
RR
+3
.3V
A
+3
.3V
A
SG
TR
DY
CL
KR
UN
FR
AM
E
12
1
12
2
12
3
12
4
AU
DIO
GN
D
AU
DIO
GN
D
SY
S A
UD
IO I
N G
ND
SY
S A
UD
IO
OU
T G
ND
SY
S A
UD
IO I
N
SY
S A
UD
IO O
UT
SG
AU
DIO
GN
D
+5
.1V
A
AD
[00
]
RS
V
MO
D A
UD
IO M
ON
AC
RE
SE
T
AC
CO
DE
C I
D1
AC
CO
DE
C I
D0
AC
BIT
CL
K
AC
SD
AT
A O
UT
AC
SD
AT
A I
N
M6
6E
N
AC
SY
NC
SG
SG
RS
V W
IP
AD
[01
]
RS
V W
IP
AD
[03
]
AD
[02
]
RS
V
AD
[04
]
AD
[06
]
+3
.3V
A
VC
C5
V
MP
C1
AC
T
RS
V
Wireless LAN module
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
GN
D
GN
D
RX
IN-
TX
D-
TX
D+
RX
IN+
GN
D
GN
D
CN
11
0
LA
N c
on
ne
cto
r
(10
BA
SE
-T/
10
0B
AS
E-T
X)
+5
.1V
A
+5
.1V
A
+3
.3V
A
SG
+3
.3V
A
SG
SG
+3
.3V
A
PA
R
SG
SG
+3
.3V
A
+3
.3V
A
ST
OP
SG
TR
DY
SG
FR
AM
E
+3
.3V
A
SG
+3
.3V
A
+3
.3V
A
SG
+3
.3V
A
PM
E
PC
IRS
T
SG
+3
.3V
A
+3
.3V
A
+3
.3V
A
+3
.3V
A
+5
.1V
A
+5
.1V
A
+1
2V
A
+1
2V
A
SG
+3
.3V
A
+3
.3V
A
+3
.3V
A
SG
+5
.1V
A
+3
.3V
A
SG
+3
.3V
A
SG
M6
6E
N
SG
+3
.3V
A
SE
RR
+3
.3V
A
PE
RR
LO
CK
DE
VS
EL
SG
+3
.3V
A
IRD
Y
SG
+3
.3V
A
SG
+3
.3V
A
SG
+3
.3V
A
SG
SG
SG
+3
.3V
A
+5
.1V
A
+5
.1V
A
-12
VA
-12
VA
SG
+3
.3V
A
+3
.3V
A
+3
.3V
A
AD
[0]
AD
[2]
AD
[4]
AD
[6]
AD
[9]
AD
[11
]
AD
[13
]
AD
[15
]
AD
[16
]
AD
[18
]
AD
[20
]
AD
[22
]
AD
[24
]
AD
[26
]
AD
[28
]
AD
[30
]
AD
[1]
AD
[3]
AD
[5]
AD
[8]
AD
[7]
AD
[12
]
AD
[14
]
AD
[17
]
AD
[19
]
AD
[21
]
AD
[23
]
AD
[25
]
AD
[27
]
AD
[29
]
AD
[31
]
PC
ICL
K(3
)
IDS
EL
1
OP
BIN
T(0
)
IDS
EL
0
AD
[10
]
PC
ICL
K(4
)
OP
BIN
T(1
)
C/B
E[0
]
GN
T(0
)
GN
T(1
)
C/B
E[1
]
C/B
E[2
]
C/B
E[3
]
RE
Q(0
)
RE
Q(1
)
Do
wn
loa
d jig
(S
YS
1)
RMSL
SG
SG
/WRX
+3.3VA
/CS
A22
A02
A04
A06
A08
A10
+3.3VA
+3.3VA
A12
A14
A16
A18
A20
DATA15
DATA13
DATA11
DATA9
DATA7
DATA5
DATA3
DATA1
SG
SG
CS0-B
CS0-A
RDX
A03
A05
A07
A09
A11
A13
A15
A17
A19
A21
DATA14
DATA12
DATA10
DATA8
DATA6
DATA4
DATA2
DATA0
CN106
50
49
48
47
46
45
41
40
39
38
37
36
42
43
44
35
31
30
29
28
27
32
33
34
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
RMSL
SG
SG
/WRX
+3.3VA
/CS
A22
A02
A04
A06
A08
A10
+3.3VA
+3.3VA
A12
A14
A16
A18
A20
DATA15
DATA13
DATA11
DATA9
DATA7
DATA5
DATA3
DATA1
SG
SG
CS0-B
CS0-A
RDX
A03
A05
Do
wn
loa
d jig
(S
YS
2)
16
15
11
10
9
8
7
6
12
13
14
5
1
2
3
4
50
49
48
47
46
45
41
40
39
38
37
36
42
43
44
35
31
30
29
28
27
32
33
34
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
16
15
11
10
9
8
7
6
12
13
14
5
1
2
3
4
A07
A09
A11
A13
A15
A17
A19
A21
DATA14
DATA12
DATA10
DATA8
DATA6
DATA4
DATA2
DATA0
RMSL
SG
SG
/WRX
+3.3VA
/CS
A22
A02
A04
A06
A08
A10
+3.3VA
+3.3VA
A12
A14
A16
A18
A20
DATA15
DATA13
DATA11
DATA9
DATA7
DATA5
DATA3
DATA1
SG
SG
CS0-B
CS0-A
RDX
A03
A05
A07
A09
A11
A13
A15
A17
A19
A21
DATA14
DATA12
DATA10
DATA8
DATA6
DATA4
DATA2
DATA0
RMSL
SG
SG
/WRX
+3.3VA
/CS
A22
A02
A04
A06
A08
A10
+3.3VA
+3.3VA
A12
A14
A16
A18
A20
DATA15
DATA13
DATA11
DATA9
DATA7
DATA5
DATA3
DATA1
SG
SG
CS0-B
CS0-A
RDX
A03
A05
A07
A09
A11
A13
A15
A17
A19
A21
DATA14
DATA12
DATA10
DATA8
DATA6
DATA4
DATA2
DATA0
CN105
50
49
48
47
46
45
41
40
39
38
37
36
42
43
44
35
31
30
29
28
27
32
33
34
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
RMSL
SG
SG
/WRX
+3.3VA
/CS
A22
A02
A04
A06
A08
A10
+3.3VA
+3.3VA
A12
A14
A16
A18
A20
DATA15
DATA13
DATA11
DATA9
DATA7
DATA5
DATA3
DATA1
SG
SG
CS0-B
CS0-A
RDX
A03
A05
16
15
11
10
9
8
7
6
12
13
14
5
1
2
3
4
50
49
48
47
46
45
41
40
39
38
37
36
42
43
44
35
31
30
29
28
27
32
33
34
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
16
15
11
10
9
8
7
6
12
13
14
5
1
2
3
4
A07
A09
A11
A13
A15
A17
A19
A21
DATA14
DATA12
DATA10
DATA8
DATA6
DATA4
DATA2
DATA0
RMSL
SG
SG
/WRX
+3.3VA
/CS
A22
A02
A04
A06
A08
A10
+3.3VA
+3.3VA
A12
A14
A16
A18
A20
DATA15
DATA13
DATA11
DATA9
DATA7
DATA5
DATA3
DATA1
SG
SG
CS0-B
CS0-A
RDX
A03
A05
A07
A09
A11
A13
A15
A17
A19
A21
DATA14
DATA12
DATA10
DATA8
DATA6
DATA4
DATA2
DATA0
CN
11
9
1 2 3 4 5 6 730
29
25
24
23
22
21
20
26
27
28
19
15
14
13
12
11
16
17
181 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
1 2 3 1 2 3 4 12
111 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
111 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
111 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
12
13
14
15
16
111 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
111 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
12
13
14
15
16
B6
B7
B8
B9
B1
0
B1
1
B1
2
B1
3
B1
4
B1
5
B1
B2
B3
B4
B5
A6
A7
A8
A9
A1
0
A1
0
A1
1
A1
1
A1
2
A1
2
A1
3
A1
3
A1
4
A1
4
A1
5
A1
5A
1
A2
A3
A4
A5
B6
B7
B8
B9
B1
0
B1
1
B1
2
B1
3
B1
4
B1
5
B1
B2
B3
B4
B5
A6
A7
A8
A9
A1
0
A1
1
A1
2
A1
3
A1
4
A1
5
A1
A2
A3
A4
A5
A6
A7
A8
A9
A1
A2
A3
A4
A5
B6
B7
B8
B9
B1
0
B1
1
B1
2
B1
3
B1
4
B1
5
B1
B2
B3
B4
B5
XS
CL
-1AC
N1
03
J5
26
J4
23
J4
22
J4
24
J4
26
J4
25
J4
29
J4
28
YD
XL
XR
YU
FR
AW
E
LO
AD
CP
SG
+5
.1V
A
SG
VE
E
D0
D1
D2
D3
SC
N1
5
SC
N1
4
SC
N1
3
SC
N1
2
SC
N1
1
RE
T0
RE
T1
RE
T2
RE
T3
RE
T8
RE
T9
LD
FC
-1
LD
FC
-2
LD
FC
-4
LD
FC
-5
LD
FC
-6
LD
FC
-7
LD
FC
-8
LD
FC
-9
LD
FC
-10
LD
FC
-11
LD
FC
-12
LD
FC
-13
LD
FC
-15
LD
ON
0
LD
ON
1
SG
J5
23
J5
27
J4
27
LP
-1A
WF
-1A
YD
-1A
INV
GN
D
BZ
ON
-0A
CP
PO
W-1
A
LD
CL
K-1
A
LD
DA
T-1
A
LD
LT
H-1
A
LD
ON
1-0
A
LD
ON
0-0
A
SG
+5
.1V
A
+5
.1V
A
+5
.1V
A
+5
.1V
A
CP
RS
T-0
A
SG
RT
S0
-0A
CT
S0
-0A
SO
UT
[0]
SIN
[0]
SG
UD
3-1
A
UD
2-1
A
UD
1-1
A
UD
0-1
A
SG
LC
DE
N-1
A
L/S
FU
LL
-C
MO
NO
-C
B/W
+5
.1V
A
SG
NCC
N1
04
LCD back light
Co
in c
on
tro
ller
/
Co
py k
ey c
ard
LCD
(LCD)Touch panel
Op
tio
n
CC
FL
+
CC
FL
-
D.O
FF
VB
US
1
SG D-
D-
VB
US
0
D+
D+
SG
VB
US
1
SG D-
D-
VB
US
0
D+
D+
SG
SGD-
VB
US
D+
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
VB
US
1
SG D-
D-
VB
US
0
D+
D+
SG
CN
11
1
US
B c
on
ne
cto
r( H
ost)
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
VB
US
1
SG D-
D-
VB
US
0
D+
D+
SG
CN
11
2
Inte
rna
l
US
B c
on
ne
cto
r( f
or
Da
ta o
ve
rwrite
kit)
1 2 3 4S
GD-
VB
US
D+
CN
11
5
US
B c
on
ne
cto
r( D
evic
e)
PW
A-F
-SY
SP
WA
-F-S
YS
(SY
S)
(SY
S)
PW
A-F
-SY
S
(SY
S)
PW
A-F
-LG
CP
WA
-F-L
GC
(LG
C)
(LG
C)
PW
A-F
-LG
C
(LG
C)
No
t u
se
d
No
t u
se
d
No
t u
se
d
05/11
Motors
Lamps and heaters
Sensors and Switches
Electromagnetic spring clutches
Solenoids
Transformer
PC boards
Thermistors and thermostats
Others
Symbol Name FigureWire harness
location
M1SCAN-MOTScan motor
[B-1] 4-G
M2BELT-CLN-MOTTransfer belt cleaner auger motor
[D-1] 7-F
M3TNR-MOTToner motor
[D-2] 8-G
M4M/DC-POLPolygonal motor
[E] 8-B
M5ADU-MOTADU motor
[I] 6-G
M6MAIN-MOTMain motor
[K] 6-B
M7EXIT-MOTExit motor
[K] 6-G
M8DRM-CLN-MOTDrum cleaner brush motor
[K] 8-D
M9TRSP-MOTTransport motor
[K] 6-C
M10TRY-MOTTray-up motor
[K] 8-F
M11DEV-MOTDeveloper motor
[K] 6-B
M12REVLV-MOTRevolver motor
[K] 6-F
M13CCL-MOTCharger cleaner motor
[B-1] 8-C
M15SCAN-FAN-MOTScanner unit cooling fan
[B-1] 4-F
M16LSU-FAN-MOTLaser unit cooling fan
[D-1] 7-D
M17IH-FAN-MOTIH control board cooling fan
[K] 8-A
M18OZN-FAN-MOTOzone exhaust fan
[K] 8-A
M19PS-FAN-MOTPower supply cooling fan
[L] 5-H
M20INTRNL-FAN-MOTInternal cooling fan
[D-1] 7-D
M21HDD-FAN-MOTHDD cooling fan
[L] 5-A
Symbol Name FigureWire harness
location
EXPLP-EXPOExposure lamp
[B-1] 3-G
ERSLP-ERSDischarge LED
[D-2] 7-E
IH-COILIH-COILIH coil
[J] AC wire harness
DH1
SCN-L-DHScanner damp heater (Left)* Optional for NAD/MJD model, standard for other
models
[B-2] AC wire harness
DH2
SCN-R-DHScanner damp heater (Right)* Optional for NAD/MJD model, standard for other
models
[B-2] AC wire harness
DH3
DRM-DHDrum damp heater* Optional for NAD/MJD model, standard for other
models
[D-2] AC wire harness
DH4CST-DHDrawer damp heater* Only for JPD model of all equipments
[F] AC wire harness
Symbol Name FigureWire harness
location
S1-5APS 1-3, APS-C, APS-RAutomatic original detection sensor
[B-1]4-E4-F
S6HOME-SNRCarriage home position sensor
[B-1] 4-F
S7PLTN-SNRPlaten sensor
[B-1] 4-F
S8REVLV-HP-SNRRevolver home position sensor
[D-1] 6-F
S9COLR-TNR-SNRColor toner cartridge sensor
[D-1] 7-D
S10COLR-ATTNR-SNRColor auto-toner sensor
[D-1] 7-C
S11K-DEV-POS-SNRBlack developer contact position detection sensor
[D-1] 7-E
S12K-DEV-TIM-SNRBlack developer contact timing detection sensor
[D-1] 7-E
S13K-ATTNR-SNRBlack auto-toner sensor
[D-2] 7-E
S14K-TNR-SWBlack toner cartridge switch
[D-2] 8-G
S15TRBLT-HP-SNR1Transfer belt home position sensor-1
[D-1] 7-F
S16TRBLT-HP-SNR2Transfer belt home position sensor-2
[D-1] 7-F
S17TNLVL-SNRImage quality sensor
[D-2] 8-H
S18TR2-POS-SNR2nd transfer roller position detection sensor
[G] 8-G
S19TEMP/HUMI-SNRTemperature/humidity sensor
[D-1] 7-D
S20USD-TNR-FLL-SNRToner bag full detection sensor
[D-2] 8-C
S22RGST-SNRRegistration sensor
[G] 8-G
S23FED-U-SNRUpper drawer feed sensor
[G] 8-G
S24FED-L-SNRLower drawer feed sensor
[G] 8-G
S25CCL-F-POS-SWCharger cleaner front position detection switch
[D-3] 8-C
S26CCL-R-POS-SWCharger cleaner rear position detection switch
[D-3] 8-C
S27CST-U-TRY-SNRUpper drawer tray-up sensor
[F] 8-E
S28CST-L-TRY-SNRLower drawer tray-up sensor
[F] 8-E
S29EMP-U-SNRUpper drawer empty sensor
[F] 8-E
S30EMP-L-SNRLower drawer empty sensor
[F] 8-E
S31NEMP-U-SNRUpper drawer paper stock sensor
[F] 8-E
S32NEMP-L-SNRLower drawer paper stock sensor
[F] 8-F
S33CST-U-SWUpper drawer detection switch
[F] 8-E
S34CST-L-SWLower drawer detection switch
[F] 8-E
S35SFB-SNRBypass paper sensor
[H] 6-H
S36SFB-FED-SNRBypass feed sensor
[H] 6-G
S37ADU-SET-SWADU opening/closing switch
[I] 6-G
S38ADU-TRU-SNRADU entrance sensor
[I] 6-F
S39ADU-TRL-SNRADU exit sensor
[I] 6-F
S40EXIT-SNRExit sensor
[J] 6-C
S41MAIN-SWMain switch
[B-2]8-A
AC wire harness
S42FRNT-COV-SWFront cover opening/closing switch
[G] 8-H
S43COV-INTLCK-SWCover opening/closing interlock switch
[G] AC wire harness
S44SIDE-COV-SWSide cover opening/closing switch
[G] 8-G
S45CLING-SNRPaper clinging detection sensor* Only for JPD model of all equipments
[G] 8-F
Symbol Name FigureWire harness
location
CLT1TRBLT-CLN-CLTTransfer belt cleaner clutch
[D-1] 7-D
CLT2CST-U-FEED-CLTUpper drawer feed clutch
[F] 8-D
CLT3CST-L-FEED-CLTLower drawer feed clutch
[F] 8-F
CLT52TR-CONT-CLT2nd transfer roller contact clutch
[G] 8-F
CLT6SFB-FEED-CLTBypass feed clutch
[H] 6-H
CLT7ADU-CLTADU clutch
[I] 6-F
CLT8COLR-DEV-TNR-CLTColor developer toner supply clutch
[K] 8-D
CLT9COLR-DEV-CLTColor developer drive clutch
[K] 8-D
CLT10K-DEV-CLTBlack developer drive clutch
[K] 8-D
CLT11K-DEV-LIFT-CLTBlack developer lifting clutch
[K] 8-C
CLT12RGST-CLTRegistration clutch
[K] 8-D
CLT13CST-U-TR-L-CLTUpper transport clutch (Low speed)
[K] 8-D
CLT14CST-U-TR-H-CLTUpper transport clutch (High speed)
[K] 8-D
CLT15CST-L-TR-L-CLTLower transport clutch (Low speed)
[K] 8-F
CLT16CST-L-TR-H-CLTLower transport clutch (High speed)
[K] 8-F
Symbol Name FigureWire harness
location
SOL1ATTNR-SHUT-SOLColor auto-toner sensor shutter solenoid
[D-1] 7-D
SOL2TNLVL-SHUT-SOLImage quality sensor shutter solenoid
[D-2] 8-H
SOL3SFB-SOLBypass pickup solenoid
[H] 6-G
Symbol Name FigureWire harness
location
HVTPS-HVTHigh-voltage transformer
[K] 6-D
Symbol Name FigureWire harness
location
Symbol Name FigureWire harness
location
CCDPWA-F-CCDCCD driving PC board (CCD board)
[B-2] 3-F
SLGPWA-F-SLGScanning section control PC board (SLG board)
[B-2] 4-G
DSPPWA-F-DSPDisplay PC board (DSP board)
[C] 1-G
KEYPWA-F-KEYKey control PC board (KEY board)
[C] 1-H
LDRPWA-F-LDRLaser driving PC board (LDR board)
[E] 8-B
SNSPWA-F-SNSH-sync signal detection PC board (SNS board)
[E] 8-B
SFBPWA-F-SFBBypass tray slide guide width detection PC board (SFB board)
[H] 6-H
ADUPWA-F-ADUADU driving PC board (ADU board)
[I] 7-G
IHPS-IHIH control PC board (IH board)
[K]7-B
AC wire harness
DRVPWA-F-DRVDriving PC board (DRV board)
[K] 6-G
SYSPWA-F-SYSSystem control PC board (SYS board)
[L] 3-A
LGCPWA-F-LGCLogic PC board (LGC board)
[L] 6-A
FILPWA-F-FILFilter PC board (FIL board)
[L]6-H
AC wire harness
Symbol Name FigureWire harness
location
THM1THMS-EDGE-FBLTFront edge thermistor
[J] 7-C
THM2THMS-MAIN-FBLTMain thermistor
[J] 7-C
THM3THMS-SUB-FBLTSub thermistor
[J] 7-C
THM4THMS-DRMDrum thermistor
[D-2] 7-F
THMO1THERMO-FSRFuser thermostat
[J] AC wire harness
THMO2THERMO-SCN-DHScanner damp heater thermostat
[B-2] AC wire harness
THMO3THERMO-DRM-DHDrum damp heater thermostat
[D-2] AC wire harness
Symbol Name FigureWire harness
location
INVINV-EXPInverter board
[B-2] 4-G
LCDLCDLCD panel
[C] 1-G
HDDHDDHard disk
[L] 5-B
PSPS-ACCSwitching regulator
[L]5-G
AC wire harness
BRKBREAKERBreaker
[L] AC wire harness
[A] Unit construction [B] Scanner unit[B-1] Motor, sensor, lamp
A4 series
LT series
[B] Scanner unit[B-2] Switch, PC board, heater, thermostat, other parts
[C] Control panel unit [D] Process unit[D-1] Motor, sensor, switch, clutch, solenoid
Drive unit
PC board unit
Process unit
Laser unitPaper feeder unit
Transport unit
Bypass unit
Front side
Scanner unit
Control panel unit
Fuser unit
Automatic
duplexing
unit
S5
S4
S3
S2
S1EXP
M15
M1
S6
S7
Front side
Front side
S5
S4
S3
S2
EXP
M15
M1
S6
S7
Front side
CCD
SLG
S41
DH1*
INV
DH2*
THMO2*
Front side
KEY
DSP
LCD
Front side
S15
S16
S19
M16
S11
S12
M20
S10
SOL1
CLT1
S8
S9
M2
[D] Process unit[D-2] Motor, sensor, switch, solenoid, heater, ther-
mistor, thermostat
[D] Process unit[D-3] Motor, switch
[E] Laser unit [F] Paper feeder unit [G] Transport unit
Front side
S17
SOL2
S14M3
ERS
S13
THM4
DH3*
THMO3*
S20
Front side
M13
S26
S25
Front sideM4
LDR
SNS
Front side
S28
S27S29
CLT3
S30
DH4*
CLT2S31
S33
S32
S34
Front side
CLT5
S43
S42
S24
S44
S23
S18
S22
S45*
[H] Bypass unit [I] Automatic duplexing unit [J] Fuser unit [K] Drive unit [L] PC board unit
Front side
S36
S35
SOL3
SFB
CLT6
Front side
S39
S38S37
CLT7
ADU
M5
Front side
S40
THM1THM3
THM2
THMO1
IH-COIL
Front side
CLT11
M10
CLT16
CLT15
CLT13
CLT14
CLT12
M9
M8
M18
M7
IH
HVT
M11
CLT10
CLT9
CLT8
M12
DRV
M17
M6
Front side
FIL
BRK
M19
SYS
M21
PS
LGC
HDD
10.3 Electric Parts Layout